Bee Everything - Merged
Bee Everything - Merged
Bee Everything - Merged
Unit IV
Part (a): POLYPHASE A.C. CIRCUITS
1 Three phase star connected balanced c. Three times the corresponding line
system the magnitude of line current voltage
is equal to d. 1.73 times phase voltage
a. One-third the phase current ans: b
b. Equal to the corresponding phase
current 5 In a balanced three-phase load, each
c. Three times the corresponding phase phase has
current a. An equal amount of power
d. Zero b. One-third of total power
c. Two-thirds of total power
ans: b d. A power consumption equal to
√3VL IL
2 Three phase star connected balanced
system the magnitude of line voltage ans: a
is equal to
a. One-third the line voltage 6 In a three-phase system, the voltages
b. Equal to the corresponding line are separated by
voltage a. 450
c. Three times the corresponding line b. 900
voltage c. 1200
d. 1.73 times phase voltage d. 1800
ans: d ans: c
Page 1
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
Page 2
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
(4 + j 3) Ohm/phase is connected to a
3 phase 400 V supply. Calculate Line 18 A balanced star-connected load of 5
current 36.860 Ohm per phase is connected
a. 80 Amp to a 3-phase, 400 V supply. Calculate
b. 138.56 Amp power factor
c. 50 Amp a. 0.6 lagging
d. 150 Amp b. 0.6 leading
c. 0.8 lagging
ans: b d. 0.8 leading
Page 3
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
Page 4
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
11. Electrical power is transformed from one 16. The concentric cylindrical winding is used
coil to other coil in transformer for
a. Physically a. Core type transformer
b. Electrically b. Shell type transformer
c. Magnetically c. Berry type transformer
d. Electromagnetically d. None of these
ans:d ans:a
Page 5
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
20. The main function of transformer iron core 25. A transformer in which the primary voltage
is to is more than the secondary voltage is called a
a. Provide strength to the winding transformer.
b. To decrease hysteresis loss a. step-down
c. Decrease the reluctance of magnetic path b. step-up
d. Reduce eddy current loss c. Isolation
ans:c d. Auto
ans:a
21. The emf induced in the primary of a
transformer 26. Any transformer flux that does not follow
a. is in phase with the flux the core and escapes into the surrounding air is
b. lags behind the flux by 90 degree called
c. leads the flux by 90 degree a. magnetizing flux
d. is in phase opposition to that of flux b. coupling flux
ans:b c. leakage flux
d. reactance flux
22.The transformer turns ratio ans:c
determines
a. the ratio of primary and secondary voltages 27. A transformer that does not isolate the
b. the ratio of primary and secondary currents output from the input is called
c. The resistance on other side transformer
d. all of the above a. Distribution
ans:a b. step-up
c. Auto
23. Turns ratio of single phase transformer is d. Control
given as ans:c
a. N2/N1
b. N1/N2 28. Ideal transformer assumptions do not
c. (N1xN2)/N1 include
d. (N1xN2)/N2 a. Zero reactance of the winding
ans:b b. Zero resistance of the winding
c. No leakage flux
24. A transformer in which the secondary d. No saturation of the core
voltage is more than the primary voltage is ans:a
called a transformer
a. step-down 29.The efficiency of the transformer is normally
b. step-up is normally in the range of
c. Isolation a. 50 to 70%
d. Auto b. 60 to 75 %
ans:b c. 80 to 90 %
d. 90 to 98%
ans:d
Page 6
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
Page 7
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
b.1 c. 9 to 12%
c. Less than 1 d. 12 to 20%
d.0 ans:a
ans:c
46. Transformer oil is used in transformer to
41. The primary and secondary voltages in provide
transformer are a. Cooling and insulation
a. Always in Phase b. Cooling and lubrication
b. 1800 out of phase c. Insulation and lubrication
c. 900 out of phase d. Insulation, cooling and lubrication
d. 300 or 600 out of phase ans:a
ans:b
47. What is the typical use of
42. The induced emf in transformer secondary autotransformer ?
depends on a. Toy transformer
a. Maximum flux in core b. Control transformer
b. Frequency c. Variable transformer
c. No of turns on secondary d. Isolating transformer
d. all of the above ans:c
ans:d
48. In any transformer the voltage per turn in
43. Transformer rating usually expressed primary and secondary remains
in a. Always different
a.kW b. Always the same
b.kVA c. Always in ratio of K
c. kV d. Sometimes same
d. kWh ans:b
ans:b
49. Full load copper loss in a transformer is 400
44. In a transformer if secondary turns are Watt. At half load, copper losses will
doubled, at the same time primary voltage is be
reduced by half, the secondary voltage a. 400 Watt
will b. 100 Watt
a. Be halved c. 200 Watt
b. Not change d. 50 Watt
c. Be four times ans:b
d. Be reduced to quarter 50. A transformer is working with its maximum
ans:b efficiency. If the iron losses are 500 W, the
45. The no load current in terms of full load copper loss will
current is usually a. 300 W
a. 1 to 3% b. 350 W
b. 3 to 9 % c. 250 W
Page 8
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
d. 500 W
ans:d 𝑉2𝐼2𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
d.
𝑉1𝐼1 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠
ans:a
51. If we increase the flux density in case
transformer
55. For 100 kVA, 11000V/110V single phase
a. The size of transformer will reduce
transformer, the primary full load current
b. The distortion in transformer will reduce
is
c. Hysteresis and eddy current losses will reduce
a. 909.09 Amp
d. None of these will be true
b. 90.90 Amp
ans:a
c. 9.09 Amp
d. 9090.9 Amp
52. The direct loading test is performed on
ans:c
transformer to find its
a. Regulation
56. For 100 kVA, 11000V/110V single phase
b. Efficiency
transformer, the secondary full load current
c. Both
is
d. None of these
a. 90.90 Amp
ans:c
b. 9090.9 Amp
c. 909.0 Amp
53. The regulation of transformer is calculated
d. 9.09 Amp
as
ans:c
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
a. 57. The disadvantage of auto transformer
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
is
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
b. a. No separation between primary & secondary
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
b. Size is more than normal transformer for
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 same rating
c.
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 c. More costlier than normal transformer
d. All
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
d. ans:d
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
ans:a
58. In a transformer the voltage regulation will
54. The efficiency of single phase transformer is be near to zero when it operates
at
calculated as
𝑉2𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅ a. unity p.f.
a.
𝑉2𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠 b. leading p.f.
c. lagging p.f.
𝑉1𝐼1 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
b. d. full load.
𝑉2𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠
ans:b
𝑉1𝐼1𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
c.
𝑉1𝐼1 𝐶𝑜𝑠 ∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠
Page 9
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
59. A transformer steps up voltage by a factor 64. Hysteresis loss in transformer depends
of 100. The ratio of current in the primary to on
that in secondary a. both voltage and frequency
a.1 b. voltage alone
b.100 c. frequency alone
c.0.01 d. none of these
d.0.1 ans:a
ans:b
65. Eddy current loss depends
60. An ideal transformer does not on
change a. both current and frequency
a. Voltage b. current alone
b. Power c. frequency alone
c. current d. none of these
d. None of these ans:a
ans:b
66.The flux involved in EMF equation of a
61. The flux in transformer core transformer has
a. increases with load a. RMS Value
b. decreases with load b. Average Value
c. remains constant irrespective of load c. Total Value
d. none of these d. maximum Value
ans:c ans:d
63. If the supply frequency in transformer is 68. If primary of the transformer is connected
doubled, then to dc supply, then
a. hysteresis loss also doubles a. Primary draws small current
b. eddy current loss also doubles b. primary leakage reactance is increased
c. iron losses doubles c. core losses are increased
d. copper losses doubles d. primary may burn out
ans:a ans:d
Page 10
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
Page 11
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
Page 12
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
Page 13
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
Page 14
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
106. At relatively light loads, the transformer 110. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase
efficiency is low because transformer has to be worked at a maximum
a. secondary output is low flux density of 1.1 web/m2 in the core. The
b. transformer losses are high effective cross sectional area of the core is 145
c. fixed loss is high in proportion to the output
cm2. The no of secondary turns
d. copper loss is small.
a.71 turns
ans:c
b.75 turns
c.932 turns
107.A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase
d.923 turns
transformer is built on a core having an
ans:a
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 60
turns on the secondary winding. The value of
111. A 80 kVA, 6000 V/ 400 V, 50 Hz single
maximum flux density
phase transformer has 80 turns on the
a.1.25 Tesla
secondary winding. The value of maximum flux
b.1.52 Tesla
in the core
c.1.3 Tesla
a.25.22mwb
d.none of the above
b.22.52mwb
ans:a
c.52.22mwb
d. none of these
108. A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase
ans:b
transformer is built on a core having an
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 60 112. A 6600 V/220 V, 50 Hz, step down single
turns on the secondary winding. The number of phase transformer has 1500 turns on its
turns on the high voltage winding primary side. If its maximum flux density is 1.2
a. 600 turns Tesla, then the effective cross sectional area of
b. 900 turns core is
c. 300 turns a.16.516 10–3 m2
d. 450 turns b.61.516 10–3 m2
ans:b
c.26.516 10–3 m2
d.62.516 10–3 m2
109. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase ans:a
transformer has to be worked at a maximum
flux density of 1.1 wb/m2 in the core. The 113. A 10 kVA, 3300/240 V, single phase, 50 Hz
effective cross sectional area of the core is 145 transformer has a core area of 300 sq. cm. The
cm2. The no of primary turns flux density is 1.3 tesla. The primary full load
a. 930 turns current is
b. 950 turns a. 3.03 amp
c. 932 turns b. 33.03 amp
d. 923 turns c. 30.3 amp
ans:c d. 0.303 amp
ans:a
Page 15
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
Page 16
MCQ’s_UNIT_03
Single Phase AC Circuits
13. All the rules and laws of D.C. circuit also apply to A.C. circuit
containing
(a) capacitance only
(b) inductance only
(c) resistance only
(d) all above
Ans: c
35. Pure inductive circuit takes power from the A.C. line when
(a) applied voltage decreases but current increases
(b) applied voltage increases but current decreases
(c) both applied voltage and current increase
(d) both applied voltage and current decrease
Ans: a
47. The safest value of current the human body can carry for
more than 3 second is
(a) 4 mA
(b) 9 mA
(c) 15 mA
(d) 25 mA
Ans: b
69. A phasor is
(a) a line which represents the magnitude and phase of an
alternating quantity
(b) a line representing the magnitude and direction of an
alternating quantity
(c) a coloured tag or band for distinction between different
phases of a 3-phase supply
(d) an instrument used for measuring phases of an unbalanced
3-phase load
Ans: a
75. The phosphors for which of the following pair are 180° out
of phase for VL, VC and VR?
(a) Vc and VR
(b) VL and VR
(c) Vc and VL
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
78. The product of apparent power and cosine of the phase angle
between circuit voltage and current is
(a) true power
(b) reactive power
(c) volt-amperes
(d) instantaneous power
Ans: a
Conclusion:
We can see that, When inductance (L) was 0.02, then circuit
current were 18.64 A, and Circuit power factor was (Cos θ) =
0.85.
Hence proved,
In inductive circuit, when inductive reactance XL increases, the
circuit current decreases, but the circuit power factor also
Decreases.
5. In inductive circuit, when Inductance (L) or inductive
reactance (XL) increases, the circuit current ________?
MCQ’s_UNIT_03
Single Phase AC Circuits
1. Also Increases
2. Decreases
3. Remain Same
4. None of the above
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer:…2…Decreases
We know that, I = V / R,
but in inductive circuit, I = V/XL
So Current in inversely proportional to the Current ( in
inductive circuit.
Let’s check with an example..
Suppose, when Inductance (L) = 0.02H
V=220, R= 10 Ω, L=0.02 H, f=50Hz.
Conclusion:
We can see that, When inductance (L) was 0.02, then circuit
current were 18.64 A,
MCQ’s_UNIT_03
Single Phase AC Circuits
But, when Circuit inductance increased from 0.02H to 0.04 H,
then current decreased from13.70 A to 18.64A.
Hence proved,
In inductive circuit, when inductive reactance XL increases, the
circuit current decreases, and Vice Virsa.
6. In case of Capacitive circuit, Frequency is
___________Proportional to the Capacitance (C) or Capacitive
reactance (XC).
1. Directly
2. Inversely
3. No Effect
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: 2. Inversely
Explanation:
In capacitive circuit,
I = V/Xc……(1)
Hence proved,
In inductive circuit, when Capacitance C increases, the circuit
current also increases, moreover, the circuit power factor also
increases.
10. In a Capacitive circuit, when Capacitive reactance
increases, then the circuit power factor ________?
1. Increases
2. Decreases
3. Remain Same
4. None of the above
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: 2. Decreases
Explanation:
Suppose, when Capacitive reactance (Xc) = 6 Ω
V=220, R= 10 Ω, Xc = 6 Ω
V=220, R= 10 Ω, Xc = 10 Ω
Conclusion:
We can see that, When Capacitive reactance (Xc) = 6 Ω, then
circuit power factor was (Cos θ) = 0.85.
Hence proved,
In Capacitive circuit, when Capacitive reactance (Xc) increases,
then the circuit power factor also increases.
11. If Current and Voltage are 90 Degree Out of Phase, Then
The Power (P) will be__________.
1. Infinite
2. Maximum
3. Normal
4. Minimum
5. Zero
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: 5. Zero
Explanation:If Current and Voltage are 90 Degree Out of Phase,
Then The Power (P) will be zero. The reason is that,
MCQ’s_UNIT_03
Single Phase AC Circuits
We know that Power in AC Circuit
P= V I Cos φ
if angle between current and Voltage are 90 ( φ = 90) Degree.
then
Power P = V I Cos ( 90) = 0
[ Note that Cos (90) = 0] So if you put Cos 90 = 0→Then Power
will be Zero
12. In pure inductive circuit, the power is __________?
1. Infinite
2. Maximum
3. Normal
4. Minimum
5. Zero
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer 5. Zero
Explanation: We know that in Pure inductive circuit, current is
lagging by 90 degree from voltage ( in other words, Voltage is
leading 90 Degree from current) i.e the pahse difference
between current and voltage is 90 degree.
So If Current and Voltage are 90 Degree Out of Phase, Then
The Power (P) will be zero. The reason is that,
We know that Power in AC Circuit
P= V I Cos φ
if angle between current and Voltage are 90 ( φ = 90) Degree.
then
Power P = V I Cos ( 90) = 0
MCQ’s_UNIT_03
Single Phase AC Circuits
[ Note that Cos (90) = 0] So if you put Cos 90 = 0→Then Power
will be Zero (In pure Inductive circuit)
13. In pure capacitive circuit, the power is __________?
1. Infinite
2. Maximum
3. Normal
4. Minimum
5. Zero
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: 5. Zero
Explanation:
We know that in Pure capacitive circuit, current is leading by
90 degree from voltage ( in other words, Voltage is lagging 90
Degree from current) i.e the phase difference between current
and voltage is 90 degree.
So If Current and Voltage are 90 Degree Out of Phase, Then
The Power (P) will be zero. The reason is that,
We know that Power in AC Circuit
P= V I Cos φ
if angle between current and Voltage are 90 ( φ = 90) Degree.
then
Power P = V I Cos ( 90) = 0
[ Note that Cos (90) = 0] So if you put Cos 90 = 0→Then Power
will be Zero (In pure capacitive circuit)
14. If Power factor = Cos θ = 1, it means that _____________.
4. Input = Output
5. PIN = POUT
MCQ’s_UNIT_03
Single Phase AC Circuits
6. The circuit is resistive only
7. The angle (θ) between Voltage and Current is Zero.
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: 4. Theangle θ between Voltage and Current is
Zero
Explanation: We know that Power factor = Cos θ
Given value of Power factor is = 1.
But, this is only possible when θ = 0 ( in case of Power factor =
Cos θ).
I.e, Cosθ = Cos (0) = 1.
15. Using P=VI Cos φ Formula, We Can Find_______.
1. Power of Single phase Circuit.
2. Voltage of Single Phase Circuit
3. Current of Single phase Circuit.
4. Power Factor of Single Phase Circuit
5. All of the above
6. None of the above
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: 5. All of the above
Explanation: As we know that it depends of the given values or
data. but generally we can find all these quantity this way by
this formula.
For Power: P=VI Cos φ
Y = 1/Z
= 1/ (V/I)
= I/V———> I=VY
i = Im sinθ
For a small segment of thickness dθ, the area would be: idθ
MCQ’s_UNIT_03
Single Phase AC Circuits
Integrating for a half cycle, the area would
be:
P = VIcos∅
1. 1
MCQ’s_UNIT_03
Single Phase AC Circuits
2. 0.8
3. 0.9
4. 0.5
Show Explanatory Answer
Ans: ( 2 )
We have the following parameters given
Now, power factor for only the coil, cosθ = RL/ZL = 0.3
Voltage across coil, VL = IZL = 49.425 Volts
Power Consumed by the coil, PL = VLIcosθ = 22.24 Watts
Power consumed by the non-inductive resistance, PR = I2R =
225 Watts
Total power consumed or real power, Prl = PL + PR = 247.4 Watts
Total input power, PA = VI = 300 Watts
MCQ’s_UNIT_03
Single Phase AC Circuits
Hence, total power factor, pf = Prl/PA = 0.8
2. Which, among the following qualities, is not affected by the magnetic field?
a) Moving charge
b) Change in magnetic flux
c) Current flowing in a conductor
d) Stationary charge
Answer: d
Explanation: A stationary charge is not affected by a magnetic field because
stationary charges do not have any velocity. Magnetic field cannot occur in a
particle having zero velocity.
3. When a charged particle moves at right angles to the magnetic field, the variable
quantity is?
a) Momentum
b) Speed
c) Energy
d) Moment of inertia
Answer: a
Explanation: When a charged particle moves perpendicular to the field, its speed
remains the same whereas its velocity keeps on changing. Momentum is the
product of the mass of the particle and the velocity if the particle, hence since
velocity varies, momentum also varies.
MCQ
UNIT 1
4. If the flow of electric current is parallel to the magnetic field, the force will be
______
a) Zero
b) Infinity
c) Maximum
d) Half the original value
Answer: a
Explanation: Force is a cross product. A cross product involves the sine of the
angle between them. If two quantities are parallel to each other, the angle
between them is zero. Sin(0) is zero, hence force is zero.
5. The ratio of magnetic force to electric force on a charged particle getting undeflected
in a field is?
a) 1
b) 0
c) 2
d) 4
Answer: a
Explanation: When a charged particle is undeflected in a field, the magnitude of the
magnetic force and electric force acting on the particle is the same, hence the ratio is 1.
Advertisement
11. Which of the following is used to determine the direction of magnetic field in a
current carrying conductor?
a) Left hand thumb rule
b) Right hand thumb rule
c) Right hand palm rule
d) Left hand palm rule
Answer: b
Explanation: The right hand thumb rule determines the direction of a magnetic
field in a current carrying conductor. The rule states that when we align our right
thumb in the direction of the current and curl our fingers around it, the direction of
our fingers is the direction of the magnetic field.
12. According to Fleming’s left hand rule, the index finger denotes?
a) Direction of magnetic field
b) Direction of current
c) Direction of force
d) Direction of force as well as current
Answer: a
Explanation: According to Fleming’s left hand rule, the index finger denotes the
direction of the magnetic field, the thumb denoted the direction of force and the
middle finger denoted the direction of the current.
MCQ
UNIT 1
13. According to Fleming’s left hand rule, the middle finger denotes?
a) Direction of magnetic field
b) Direction of current
c) Direction of force
d) Direction of force as well as current
Answer: b
Explanation: According to Fleming’s left hand rule, the index finger denotes the
direction of the magnetic field, the thumb denoted the direction of force and the
middle finger denoted the direction of the current.
15. The relation between the direction of force and the direction of magnetic field is
_________
a) Same direction
b) Opposite direction
c) Perpendicular
d) Unrelated
Answer: c
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force
developed in the conductor, the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in
the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each other.
16. The relation between the direction of current and the direction of magnetic field is
________
MCQ
UNIT 1
a) Same direction
b) Opposite direction
c) Perpendicular
d) Unrelated
Answer: c
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force
developed in the conductor, the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in
the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each other.
17. The relation between the direction of current and the direction of the force is
_________
a) Same direction
b) Opposite direction
c) Perpendicular
d) Unrelated
Answer: c
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force
developed in the conductor, the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in
the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each other.
19. Magnetic field lines form _________ loops from pole to pole.
a) Open
MCQ
UNIT 1
b) Closed
c) Branched
d) either closed or branched
Answer: b
Explanation: Magnetic field lines form closed loops from pole to pole. There is no
discontinuity in the magnetic flux lines.
22. Lines of magnetic flux which are parallel and in the same direction __________
each other.
a) Attract
b) Repel
c) Intersect
MCQ
UNIT 1
d) Cancel
Answer: b
Explanation: Lines of magnetic flux which are parallel to each other and in the
same direction repel each other because they tend to act as like poles and like
poles repel each other.
23. More the number of magnetic flux lines _______ is the force of the magnet.
a) Greater
b) Lesser
c) Either greater or lesser
d) Neither greater nor lesser
Answer: a
Explanation: More the number of magnetic flux lines, greater is the force of the
magnet. This is because the magnetic flux lines denote the strength of the field of
the magnet.
25. The force existing between two infinite parallel conductors is inversely
proportional to ________
a) Radius of the conductors
b) Current in one of the conductors
c) The product of the current in the two conductors
d) The distance between the two conductors
Answer: d
MCQ
UNIT 1
Explanation: When current is flowing in two different conductors, the force
between the two conductors is directly proportional to the product of the current in
the two conductors and inversely proportional to the distance between the two
conductors.
26. When the distance of operation between the two conductors increases, what
happens to the force between the two conductors?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) becomes zero
Answer: b
Explanation: When the distance of separation increases, the force between the
two conductors decrease because the force between two conductors is inversely
proportional to the distance of separation between them.
27. Magnetic field at a point d distance away from long wire due to electric current i in
it is ____________
a) µ0i/2r
b) µ0i/r
c) µ0i/2πr
d) µ0i/πr
Answer: c
Explanation: Magnetic field at distance d from long wire with carrying current i is
given by-
B = µ0i/2πr.
28. The force per unit length existing between two infinite parallel conductors is given
by ___________
a) µ0i1i2/2πd
b) µ0i1i2/2d
c) µ0i1/2πdi2
d) µ0i1i2/d
MCQ
UNIT 1
Answer: a
Explanation: Force of infinite conductor is given by Bil if B, i, l are mutually
perpendicular
F/l = Bi = µ0i1i2/2πd if d is separation of two infinite parallel conductors.
29. If the radius of the current carrying conductor increases, what is the effect on the
force?
a) Increases
b) decreases
c) remain same
d) become zero
Answer: c
Explanation: Force of the infinite conductor is given by Bil if B, i, l are mutually
perpendicular
F/l = Bi = µ0i1i2/2πd if d is separation of two infinite parallel conductors. It doesn’t
depend on the radius of conductor so force remains the same.
31. If length of current carrying conductor increases, what is the effect on the force?
a) increases
b) decreases
c) remain same
MCQ
UNIT 1
d) become zero
Answer: a
Explanation: Force of infinite conductor is given by Bil if B, i, l are mutually
perpendicular
F/l = Bi = µ0i1i2/2πd if d is a separation of two infinite parallel conductors. So, as
length of conductor increases force increases.
32. The magnetic field strength of a solenoid can be increased by inserting which of
the following materials as the core?
a) Copper
b) Silver
c) Iron
d) Aluminium
Answer: c
Explanation: The Magnetic field of a solenoid increases when we insert an iron
core because iron is a ferromagnetic material and ferromagnetic materials help in
increasing the magnetic property.
33. If a coil is wound around a steel core and electric current is passed through the
coil, the steel core acts as a?
a) Electromagnet
b) Permanent magnet
c) Neither electromagnet nor permanent magnet
d) Either electromagnet or permanent magnet
Answer: b
Explanation: When a coil is wound around a steel core, the steel core behaves
like a permanent magnet because it is a ferromagnetic material and once it
becomes magnetic it does not lose its magnetic property.
34. What is the formula for the magnetic field due to a solenoid?
a) μnI
MCQ
UNIT 1
b) μn 2
c) μNI
d) μN2I2
Answer: a
Explanation: The magnetic field due to a solenoid is:
B= μnI, where μ is the permeability, n is the number of turns per unit length and I
is the current in the solenoid.
35. What happens to the magnetic field in the solenoid when the number of turns
increases?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains constant
d) Becomes zero
Answer: a
Explanation: The magnetic field of a solenoid is directly proportional to the
number of turns in it. Hence as the number of turns increases, the magnetic field
also increases.
36. What happens to the magnetic field in the solenoid when the current increases?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains constant
d) Becomes zero
Answer: a
Explanation: The magnetic field of a solenoid is directly proportional to the current
in it. Hence as the current increases, the magnetic field also increases.
37. What happens to the magnetic field in the solenoid when the length of the
solenoid increases?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
MCQ
UNIT 1
c) Remains constant
d) Becomes zero
Answer: b
Explanation: The magnetic field of a solenoid is inversely proportional to the
length. Hence as the length increases, the magnetic field decreases.
38. The current in a solenoid is 30A, the number of turns per unit length is 500 turns
per metre. Calculate the magnetic field if the core is air.
a) 18.84T
b) 18.84mT
c) 1.84T
d) 1.84mT
Answer: b
Explanation: The magnetic field in a solenoid is given by:
B=μnI
Substituting the values in the given values in the equation, B=18.84mT.
39. The magnetic field of the solenoid is 18.84mT, the number of turns per unit length
is 500 turns per metre. Calculate the current if the core is air.
a) 300A
b) 30A
c) 3A
d) 300mA
Answer: b
Explanation: The magnetic field in a solenoid is given by:
B=μnI
Substituting the values in the given values in the equation, I=30A.
40. The magnetic field of the solenoid is 18.84mT, the current is 30A. Calculate the
number of turns per unit length if the core is air.
a) 1500 turns/m
b) 1000 turns/m
MCQ
UNIT 1
c) 500 turns /m
d) 2000 turns/m
Answer: c
Explanation: The magnetic field in a solenoid is given by:
B=μnI
Substituting the values in the given values in the equation n=500 turns/m.
43. Force in a conductor is __________ to the square of the distance between the
charges.
a) Directly proportional
MCQ
UNIT 1
b) Inversely proportional
c) Not related
d) Cannot be determined
Answer: b
Explanation: The force in a current carrying conductor is directly proportional to
the product of the two charges and inversely proportional to the square of the
distance between them.
44. Calculate the force between two charges having magnitude 3nC and 2nC
separated by a distance of 2micro m.
a) 13.5N
b) 13.5kN
c) 1.35N
d) 1.35kN
Answer: b
Explanation: From the expression:
F=Kq1q2/r2, the value of K being 9*109, we get F=13.5kN.
45. If the flow of electric current is parallel to the magnetic field, the force will be?
a) Zero
b) Infinity
c) Maximum
d) Half the original value
Answer: a
Explanation: Force is a cross product. A cross product involves the sine of the
angle between them. If two quantities are parallel to each other, the angle
between them is zero. Sin(0) is zero, hence force is zero.
46. The ratio of magnetic force to electric force on a charged particle getting
undeflected in a field is ______
a) 1
b) 0
c) 2
MCQ
UNIT 1
d) 4
Answer: a
Explanation: When a charged particle is undeflected in a field, the magnitude of
the magnetic force and electric force acting on the particle is the same, hence the
ratio is 1.
48. The relation between the direction of force and the direction of magnetic field is
__________
a) Same direction
b) Opposite direction
c) Perpendicular
d) Unrelated
Answer: c
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force
developed in the conductor, the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in
the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each other.
49. The relation between the direction of current and the direction of the force is
________
a) Same direction
b) Opposite direction
c) Perpendicular
d) Unrelated
MCQ
UNIT 1
Answer: c
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force
developed in the conductor, the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in
the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each other.
50. Which among the following, is the correct expression for force in a current
carrying conductor if magnetic field is perpendicular to it?
a) F=Bi
b) F=B2il
c) F=Bil
d) F=Bl2
Answer: c
Explanation: The correct expression for force in a current carrying conductor in a
magnetic field perpendicular to it is F=Bil, where B is the magnetic field, i is the
current in the conductor and l is the length of the conductor.
51. When the current in the current carrying conductor increases, what happens to
the force in the conductor which is at right angles to the magnetic field?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) Becomes zero
Answer: a
Explanation: The force at right angles to the magnetic field of a current carrying
conductor increases when the current increases because it is directly proportional
to the force.
52. When the length of the conductor in the current carrying conductor increases,
what happens to the force in the conductor which is at right angles to the
magnetic field?
a) Increases
MCQ
UNIT 1
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) Becomes zero
Answer: a
Explanation: The force at right angles to the magnetic field of a current carrying
conductor increases when the length of the conductor increases because it is
directly proportional to the force.
53. When the magnetic field intensity in the current carrying conductor increases,
what happens to the force in the conductor which is at right angles to the
magnetic field?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) Becomes zero
Answer: a
Explanation: The force at right angles to the magnetic field of a current carrying
conductor increases when the magnetic field intensity increases because it is
directly proportional to the force.
55. If net force is zero on a particle in magnetic field what is relation between velocity
and magnetic field?
MCQ
UNIT 1
a) v=E*B
b) v=E/B
c) v=B/E
d) v=1/(E*B)
Answer: b
Explanation: Since net force is zero on the particle.
Electric force = Magnetic force
QE = QvB => E=vB or v=E/B.
56. If the intensity of the magnetic field is 100T, the length of the conductor is 10m
and the magnitude of force perpendicular to the magnetic field is 10kN,calculate
the current in the conductor.
a) 100 A
b) 100 mA
c) 10 A
d) 10 mA
Answer: c
Explanation: The formula for calculating the value of the force which is
perpendicular to the magnetic field is:
F=Bil
Substituting the values from the question, we get i = 10A.
57. If the intensity of the magnetic field perpendicular to current carrying conductor is
100T, the length of the conductor is 3m and the current in the conductor is 10A,
calculate the magnitude of force perpendicular to the electric field.
a) 300N
b) 30N
c) 30kN
d) 3kN
Answer: d
Explanation: The formula for calculating the value of the force which is
perpendicular to the magnetic field is:
MCQ
UNIT 1
F=Bil
Substituting the values from the question, we get F=3kN.
Q3. In a three phase AC circuit, the sum of all three generated voltages is _______ ?
1. Infinite (∞)
2. Zero (0)
3. One (1)
4. None of the above
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: 2. Zero (0)
Explanatory Answer:
Three phase voltages are generated by having an alternator with three armature
windings such that each winding is displaced from the other by 120 degrees. When
these windings are placed in a rotating magnetic field or rotated in a stationary
magnetic field, electromotive force is generated in each coil, of same magnitude and
direction. Consider the below diagram
Polyphase A.C. Circuits
As seen EMF generated in coil R-R1 is eR, which is the reference in this case. EMF
generated in coil Y-Y1 is eY which is 120° degrees ahead of eR and EMF generated in
coil B-B1 is eB which is 240° degrees ahead of eR.
Therefore the voltage equations are as given below;
eR=Em sin wt
eY= Em sin (wt – 120°)
eB= Em sin (wt – 240) = Em sin (wt + 120°)
Explanatory Answer:
Polyphase A.C. Circuits
VRY = √3 VPH
Since the line conductor is in series with the phase winding, same current will flow
through the line conductor as through the phase windings, hence phase current is
equal to phase current.
Explanatory Answer:
A delta connected AC circuit is achieved by connecting the start end of a winding to
the finish end of another winding such that all three windings form a mesh. Since each
end of the windings forms the line connection, voltage across each winding is equal to
the potential difference between the corresponding lines taken from that winding.
Hence the phase voltage is equal to the line voltage.
Q6. For a star connection network, consuming power of 1.8kW and power factor 0.5,
the inductance and resistance of each coil at a supply voltage of 230 Volts, 60 Hz is
______?
1. 0.1H, 8 Ohms
2. 0.5H, 10 Ohms
3. 0.3H, 7.4 Ohms
4. 1H, 7 Ohms
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: 3. 03H, 7.4 Ohms
Explanatory Answer:
Given values are:
Q7. For a three-phase delta connected load, fed from a star connected network, the
power transferred to the load is _____?
1. 3 kW
2. 4.7 kW
3. 5 kW
4. 7 kW
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: 2. 4.7 kW
Explanatory Answer:
Given values:
Explanatory Answer:
Power is measured using a Wattmeter which consists of two coils – Current coil,
connected in series with the load, carrying the load current and Voltage coil, connected
in parallel to the load.
Q9. For a polyphase system, the number of Wattmeter required to measure power is
equal to ——
1. Number of wires
2. One less than number of wires
3. Number of phases
4. None of the above
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: 2. One less than number of wires
Explanatory Answer:
The number of Wattmeter required to measure power in a polyphase system is
determined using Blondell’s theorem. According to this, the number of Wattmeter
required is equal to one less than the number of wires in the circuit. For example, in a
three phase, four wire system (Star network), the number of Wattmeter required is
three.
Q10. For the below star connected network of equal resistances, if the Wattmeter
reading is 5kW and ammeter reading is 25 Amperes, the power factor, resistance and
Q11. For a three phase, three wire system, the two Wattmeter read 4000 Watts and
2000 Watts respectively. The power factor when both meters give direct reading is
_______ ?
1. 1
2. 0.5
3. 0.866
4. 0.6
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: 3. 0.866
Explanatory Answer:
Reading of Wattmeter 1, W1 = 4000 Watts
Reading of Wattmeter 2, W2 = 2000 Watts
Phase angle;
Q12. For a balanced three phase, three wire system with input power of 10kW, at 0.9
power factor, the readings on both wattmeter are ————– respectively
1. 7kW, 3kW
Polyphase A.C. Circuits
2. 6350W, 3650W
3. 5000W, 5000W
4. 7600W, 1200W
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: 2. 6350W, 3650W
Explanatory Answer:
Let reading of one Wattmeter = W1
Reading of second Wattmeter = W2
Input Power, P = W1+W2 = VL IL cosφ = 10 kW ……………… (1)
Power Factor, cos φ = 0.9
Q14. In a three phase AC circuit, the sum of all three generated voltages is ———
—
1. Infinite
2. Zero
3. One
4. None of the above
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: (2)
Polyphase A.C. Circuits
Explanatory Answer:
Three phase voltages are generated by having an alternator with three armature
windings such that each winding is displaced from the other by 120 degrees. When
these windings are placed in a rotating magnetic field or rotated in a stationary
magnetic field, electromotive force is generated in each coil, of same magnitude and
direction. Consider the below diagram.
Q17. For a star connection network, consuming power of 1.8kW and power factor
0.5, the inductance and resistance of each coil at a supply voltage of 230 Volts, 60
Hz is ——-
1. 0.01H, 8 Ohms
2. 0.05H, 10 Ohms
3. 0.03H, 7.4 Ohms
4. 1H, 7 Ohms
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: (3)
Explanatory Answer:
Given values are:
Reactance of Coil,
Substituting values, we get Reactance
Q18. For a three-phase delta connected load, fed from a star connected network,
the power transferred to the load is_
1. 3 KW
2. 7 KW
3. 5 KW
4. 7KW
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: (2)
Explanatory Answer:
Given values:
For the delta connected load, Phase Voltage, VphLd = VL = 398.37 Volts
Therefore, current through each phase of load, IphLd = VphLd/ZphLd = 8.9 Amperes
Line current for delta connected load, IL = √3IphLd = 15.41 Amperes
Power Factor, pfs = RphLd/ZphLd = 0.44
Thus, power supplied to load, PL =√3 VLILpfs = 4.7 KW
Q20. For a polyphase system, the number of Wattmeter required to measure power
is equal to ——
1. Number of wires
2. One less than number of wires
3. Number of phases
4. None of the above
Show Explanatory Answer
Explanatory Answer:
The number of Wattmeter required to measure power in a polyphase system is
determined using Blondell’s theorem. According to this, the number of Wattmeter
required is equal to one less than the number of wires in the circuit. For example, in
a three phase, four wire system (Star network), the number of Wattmeter required is
three.
Q21. For the below star connected network of equal resistances, if the Wattmeter
reading is 5kW and ammeter reading is 25 Amperes, the power factor, resistance
and inductanceis ————respectively
Polyphase A.C. Circuits
1. 1, 5 Ohms, 0.1H
2. 0.866, 8 Ohms, 0.02H
3. 0.5, 10 Ohms, 0.01H
4. 0.4, 8 Ohms, 0.02H
Show Explanatory Answer
Explanatory Answer:
Given
Line Voltage, VL = 400 Volts
Frequency, f = 60 Hz
Reactance,
Therefore, Inductance, L = 0.02H
Q22. For a three phase, three wire system, the two Wattmeter read 4000 Watts and
2000 Watts respectively. The power factor when both meters give direct reading is—
——–
1. 1
2. 0.5
3. 0.866
4. 0.6
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: (3)
Polyphase A.C. Circuits
Explanatory Answer:
Reading of Wattmeter 1, W1 = 4000 Watts
Q23. For a balanced three phase, three wire system with input power of 10kW, at
0.9 power factor, the readings on both wattmeter are ————– respectively
1. 7kW, 3kW
2. 6350W, 3650W
3. 5000W, 5000W
4. 7600W, 1200W
Show Explanatory Answer
Answer: (2)
Explanatory Answer:
Let reading of one Wattmeter = W1
24. In three phase system, the three voltages (currents) differ in phase by
__________electrical degrees from each other in a particular sequence.
A. 30
B. 60
C. 90
D. 120
Answer: D
Polyphase A.C. Circuits
Clarification: In general a three phase system of voltages is merely a combination of
three single phase systems of voltages. In three phase system, the three voltages
(currents) differ in phase by 120⁰ from each other in a particular sequence.
25.In three phase system at any given instant, the algebraic sum ofthree voltages
must be?
A. 0
B. 1
C. 2
D. 3
Answer: A
Clarification: For three phase alternator the three voltages are ofsame magnitude and
frequency. In three phase system at anygiven instant, the algebraic sum of three
voltages must be zero.Algebraic sum of three voltages = 0.
28. In delta connected system, the potential difference between line outers is
Answer: A
29.The expression for total power output of a delta connected system in terms
of phase voltage and current is given by
a. 3VpIpcos∅
b. √3VpIpcos∅
c. 1/√ 3VpIpcos∅
d. 1/3 x VpIpcos∅
Answer: A
30.In a star connected system, the current flowing through the line is
Answer: b
31. In a 3 - phase star connected balanced induction motor, the line voltage is
equal to the
Answer: b
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
Unit II
Part (a) ELECTROSTATICS
d. 2.4s ans: a
ans: b
15. The unit of capacitance is
10. Three capacitors of values 3 µF, 6 µF, and 12 a. Volts/Coulomb
µF are connected in parallel across an a.c. b. Coulomb/Volt
source. The maximum current pass through c. Ohms
________________ d. Henry/Wb
a.3 µF ans: b
b.6 µF
c.12 µF 16. There is repulsive force between two
d. all the capacitors charged objects when
ans:c a. Charges of unlike sign
b. they have the same number of protons
11.As per Coulomb’s law___________________ c. charges are of same sign
a. F= Q1Q2 / εoεrd2 d. they have the same number of protons
b. F= Q1Q2 / 4𝜋d2 ans: c
c. F= Q1Q2 / 4𝜋 εoεrd2
d. F= Q1Q2 /4𝜋 εoεrd 17. The capacitance of a capacitor is not
ans: c affected by
a. distance between plates
12. Electric field intensity at any point in an b. area of plates
electric field is equal to_______ c. thickness of plates
a. potential gradient d. all of the above
b. (potential gradient)2 ans: c
c. (potential gradient)1/2
d. (potential gradient)1/3 18. When there is an equal amount of positive
ans: a and negative charges on an object the object is
a. Positively charged
13. The lines of forces due to isolated charged b. negatively charged
particle are___________ c. neutral
a. always straight d. supercharged
b. always curved ans:c
c. sometimes curved
d. none of the above 19. Which of the following statements is
ans: a correct?
a. Air capacitors have a black band to indicate
14. The direction of electric field due to positive the outside foil
charge is___ b. Electrolytic capacitor must be connected in
a. away from the charge the correct polarity
b. towards the charge c. Ceramic capacitors must be connected in the
c. both (a) and (b) correct polarity
d. none of the above
30. The unit of capacitance is 35. The absolute permittivity of free space is
a. Henry given by
b. Ohm a. 8.854 x 10-9 F/m
c. Farad b. 8.854 x 10-10 F/m
d. Farad/m c. 8.854 x 10-11 F/m
ans:c d. 8.854 x 10-12 F/m
ans:d
31. A capacitor charged to 200V has 2000 µC of
charge. The value of capacitance will be 36. The relative permittivity of free space is
a. 10 F given by
b. 10 µF a. 1
c. 100 µF b. 10
d. 1000 µF c. 100
ans:b d. 1000
ans:a
32. Voltage across capacitor at any time‘t’
during charging from a D.C. source of voltage V 37. When 4 Volt e.m.f. is applied across a 1
is given by Farad capacitor, it will store energy of
a. ν = Ve-t/λ a. 2 Joule
b. ν = V(1-e-t/λ) b. 4 Joule
c. ν = V2e-t/λ c. 6 Joule
d. ν = V2(1-e-t/λ) d. 8 Joule
ans:b ans:d
33. The ratio of electric flux density to electric 38. The capacitor preferred for high frequency
field intensity is called ………. of the medium circuits is
a. permeability a. air capacitor
b. permittivity b. mica capacitor
c. reluctance c. electrolytic capacitor
d. capacitance d. paper capacitor
ans:b ans:b
42. The time constant of an R-C circuit is 47. The relative permittivity of air is__________
defined as the time during which capacitor a.0
charging voltage actually rises to ---------------- b.1.0006
percent of its ---------- value c. 8.854 × 10−12
a.37, initial d. none of the above
b.63.2, initial ans:b
c.63.2, final
d.37, final 48. The relative permittivity of a material is 10.
ans: c Its absolute permittivity will be
a. 8.854 × 10−11 𝐹/𝑀
43. The time constant of an R-C circuit is b. 9 × 108 𝐹/𝑀
defined as the time during which capacitor c. 5 × 10−5 𝐹/𝑀
charging current actually falls to ---------------- d. 9 × 105 𝐹/𝑀
percent of its initial maximum value ans: a
a.37
b.63 49. The capacitance of a capacitor is ………
c.42 relative permittivity
d.73
ans:b
63. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
59. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm potential difference of 100V across its
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm
Determine the initial rate of rise of voltage resistor. Find discharging current at 2m Sec.
across the capacitor. a. - 0.0818A
a. 0.1V/s b. - 0.01A
b. 10V/s c. - 0.00818A
c. 0.01V/s d. - 1A
d. 1V/s ans:a
ans:b
64. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
60. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm potential difference of 100V across its
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm
Determine the capacitor voltage after a time resistor. Find initial rate of fall in voltage across
equal to the time constant. capacitor.
a.36V a. 10 4 V/s
b.36.6V b. -10 4 V/s
c.63.2V c. -1 4 V/s
d.63 V d. 10A
ans:c ans:b
61. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm 65. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. potential difference of 100V across its
Determine the voltage across the capacitor terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm
3sec. after switch on. resistor. Find time constant of the circuit.
a.25.92V a. 0.1sec
b.259.2V b. 1sec
c.2.592V c. 0.01sec
d.25V d. 0.001sec
ans:a ans:c
62. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a 66. A capacitor consists of two similar plates
potential difference of 100V across its each 10cm x 10cm mounted parallel and
terminals. It is discharged through 1 KΩ resistor. opposite to each other. What is the value of
Find Initial discharging current. capacitance when distance between them is
a.1A 1cm and dielectric used is air.
b.10A a. 8.854 pF
c.0.01A b. 8.854 µF
d.0.1A c. 8.854 mF
ans:d d. 8.854 F
ans: a
a. magnetic field
67. The capacitance of capacitor formed by two b. electric field
parallel plates each 200 cm2 in area separated c. magnetic field and electric field
by dielectric of 4mm thick is 0.0004µF. If d. neither magnetic field nor electric field
voltage of 20000 V is applied then the total ans: b
charge on the plate is
a. 8µC 72. One Farad is the same as
b. 8mC a. One Coulomb/Volt
c. 8nC b. One Joule/Coulomb
d. 8pC c. One Joule/Volt
ans: a d. One Coulomb /Joule
ans: a
68. A parallel plate capacitor has plate area of
2m2 spaced by three slabs of dielectric 73 . If Q be the charge and C be the capacitance
materials. The relative permittivity’s are 2,3 and then the energy stored in the capacitor is
6 respectively and thickness are 0.4mm, 0.6mm a. 1/2QC
and 0.12 mm respectively. Find the combined b. 1/QC
capacitance. c. Q2/2C
a. 0.000295 x 10-6 F d. Q/2C
b. 0.00295 x 10-6 F ans: c
c. 0.0295 x 10-6 F
d. 0. 295 x 10-6 F 74.What capacitance must be placed in series
ans: b with a 15µF capacitor to give a total capacitance
of 5µF
69. What is the unit of charge? a. 4µF
a. Volt-Amp b. 7.5µF
b. Henery c. 10µF
c. Farad d. 25µF
d. Coulomb ans: b
ans: d 75. One Coulomb charge equals the charge on
a. 6.42 x 10 18 electrons
70. What will be the capacitance of four b. 6.24 x 10 18 atoms
capacitors of equal capacitance ‘C’ when c 6.24 x 10 12electrons
connected in parallel d. none of these
a. 4C ans: a
b. C/4
c. 3C/4 76. The capacitance of parallel plate capacitor is
d. C given as
ans: a a. C = Є0 A / d
b. C = Є0 d / A
71. A region around a stationary electric charge
has
Unit II
Part (b) AC FUNDAMENTALS
b.282.6 V a. 150 V
c.400 V b. 216.5 V
d.565.5 V c. 125 V
ans:a d.108.25 V
ans:b
11. The form factor of a sine wave is_____
a.1.01 16. An alternating current is given by the
𝜋
b.1.11 expression 𝑖 = 200 sin(314𝑡 + ) amperes.
3
c.1.21 The maximum value and frequency of the
d. none of the above current are_________
ans:b a. 200 A, 50 Hz
b. 100√2, 50 Hz
12. A current is said to be alternating when it c. 200 A, 100 Hz
changes in_______ d. 200 A, 25 Hz
a. magnitude only ans:a
b. direction only
c. both magnitude and direction 17.The average value of the current 𝑖 =
d. neither magnitude nor direction 𝜋
200 sin 𝑡 from 𝑡 = 0 to 𝑡 = is ______
2
ans:c
a. 400 π
400
13. An alternating current of 50 Hz frequency b. 𝜋
1
and 100 A maximum value is given by______ c.400
a.𝑖 = 200 𝑠𝑖𝑛628𝑡 𝜋
d.400
b.𝑖 = 100 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
ans:b
c.𝑖 = 100√2 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
d.𝑖 = 100√2 𝑠𝑖𝑛157𝑡 18. When two quantities are in quadrature, the
ans:b phase angles between them will be________
a.45°
14. An alternating current of 50 Hz frequency b.90°
has a maximum value of 100 A. Its value 1/600 c.135°
second after the instant current is zero will d.60°
be________ ans:b
a. 25 A
b. 12.5 A 19.The alternating voltage 𝑒 = 200 sin 314𝑡 is
c. 50 A applied to a device which offers an ohmic
d. 75 A resistance of 20 Ω to the flow of current in one
ans:c direction while entirely preventing the flow in
the opposite direction. The average value of the
15.A sinusoidal voltage varies from zero to a current will be_________
maximum of 250 V. The voltage at the instant of a.5 A
60° of the cycle will be________ b.3.18 A
40.The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 45.The average value of sin2θ over a complete
10 A. Its peak value is_________ cycle is_________
a. 7.07 A a. +1
b. 14.14 A b. -1
1
c. 10 A c. 2
d. 28.28 A d. zero
ans:b ans:c
41. If A=10∠45° and B=5∠15°, then the value of 46.The average value of sinθ over a complete
A/B will be_________ cycle is_________
a. 50∠60° a. zero
b. 2∠60° b. +1
c. 2∠-30° c. -1
d. 2∠30° 1
d.
2
ans:d
ans:a
b. 30 Hz a. mean value
c. 40 Hz b. rms value
d. 50 HZ c. peak value
ans:d d. average value
ans:b
59. An ac current is given by 𝑖 = 200 𝑠𝑖𝑛100𝜋𝑡.
It will achieve a value of 100A 64. The rms value and mean value is the same
after_____second. in the case of_______
1 a. traingular wave
a.900
1 b. sine wave
b.
800 c. square wave
1
c. d. half wave rectified sine wave
700
1 ans:c
d.600
ans:d
65. For the same peak value which of the
following wave will have the highest rms value?
60. A heater is rated as 230V, 10KW, AC. The
a.square wave
value of 230V refers to___________
b.half wave rectified sine wave
a. average voltage
c.triangular wave
b. rms voltage
d.sine wave
c. peak voltage
ans:a
d. none of the above
ans:b
66. For the same peak value which of the
following wave will have the least mean value?
61. The peak value of a sine wave is 200V. Its
a. half wave rectified sine wave
average value is_______
b. triangular wave
a.127.4V
c. sine wave
b.141.4V
d. square wave
c.282.8V
ans:a
d.200V
ans:a
67. For a sine wave with peak value Imax, the rms
value is_______
62. The rms value of a sine wave is 100A. Its
a. 0.5Imax
peak value is _______
b. 0.707Imax
a.70.7A
c. 0.9Imax
b.141.4A
d. 1.414Imax
c.150A
ans:b
d.282.8A
ans:b
68. Form factor is the ratio of_________
a. average value/rms value
63. The voltage of domestic supply is 220V. This
b. average value/peak value
figure represents________
c. rms value/average value
68. For a sine wave with peak value Emax, the 73. A sine wave of voltage varies from zero to
average value is______ maximum of 200V. How much is the voltage at
a. 0.636 Emax the instant of 30° of the cycle?
b. 0.707Emax a.50V
c. 0.434 Emax b.82.8V
d. 1.414Emax c.100V
ans:a d.173.2V
ans:c
69. The current in a circuit is given by: 𝑖 =
100 sin 314𝑡 amperes. The maximum value and 74. How much rms current does a 300W, 200V
frequency of current are_________ bulb take from the 200V, 50 Hz power line?
a.50√2 A, 100 Hz a.0.5 A
b.100√2 A, 100 Hz b.1.5 A
c. 100 A, 50 Hz c.2 A
d. 70.7 A, 50 Hz d. 3 A
ans:c ans:b
70. For a frequency of 200 Hz, the time period 75. The rms value of a half-wave rectified
will be_________ current is 100 A. Its value for full-wave
a. 0.05 S rectification would be_________amperes.
b. 0.005 S a.141.4
c. 0.0005 S b.200
d. 0.5 S c. 200/π
ans:b d. 40/π
ans:a
71. An ac voltage of 50 Hz has a maximum value
of 50 V. Its value after 1/600 second after the 76. The rms value of a sinusoidal ac current is
instant the current is zero will be_________ equal to its value at an angle of ______degrees.
a.5V a.90
b.12.5V b.60
c.25V c.45
d.43.8V d.30
ans:c ans:c
72. For 200V rms value triangular wave, the 77. The rms value of alternating current is given
peak voltage will be______ by steady (dc) current which when flowing
a.200V through a given circuit for a given time
b.222V produces________
c.282V
86. An alternating voltage is given in volts by supplied 500 W output (i.e. no losses) at the
expression 𝑣 = 326 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. Its rms value and new voltage it will supply_________
frequency are____ a. 2500 W
a.230V,50 Hz b. 2000 W
b. 230V,100 Hz c. 500 W
c. 326V,50 Hz d. 250 W
d. 326V,100 Hz ans:b
ans:a
91. The direction of current in an ac
87. According to which of the alternating circuit________
current values in the cross sectional area of a a. is from positive to negative
conductor with regard to the heating effect is b. is always in one direction
selected? c. varies from instant to instant
a. peak value d. can not be determined
b. half peak value ans:c
c. average value
d. rms value 92. The angular frequency of an alternating
ans:d quantity is a mathematical quantity obtained by
multiplying the frequency “f” of the alternating
88. The frequency of an alternating current quantity by a factor_________
𝜋
is________ a.
2
a. the speed with which the alternator runs b.π
b. the number of cycles generated in one c.2π
minute d.4π
c. the number of waves passing through a point ans:c
in one second
d. the number of electrons passing through a 93. The average value of an unsymmetrical
point in one second alternating quantity is calculated over
ans:c the_________
a. whole cycle
89. The equation of 50 Hz current sine wave b. half cycle
having rms value of 60 A is______ c. unsymmetrical part of the waveform
a.60 sin 25𝑡 d. first two cycles
b.60 sin 50𝑡 ans:a
c.84.84 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
d42.42 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. 94. The mean value of the current 𝑖 = 20 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝜃
ans:c 𝜋
from θ=0 to θ=2 is_______
a.40π
90. An electric iron designed for 110 V AC 40
supply was rated at 500 W. It was put across a b. 𝜋
1
220 V supply. Assuming that at 110 V, it c.
40
𝜋
d.40 b. 10 A, 17.07 A
ans:b c. 10 A, 12.25 A
d. 16.36 A, 12.2 A
95. A constant current of 2.8A exists in a ans:c
resistor. The rms value of current is______
a. 2.8 A 100. The size (cross-sectional area) of a
b. about 2 A conductor, with regard to the heating effect, is
c. 1.4 A determined on the basis of ……….. value of
d. undefined current to be carried by it
ans:a a. average value
b. peak value
96. An alternating current is represented as 𝑖 = c. rms value
𝜋 d. peak to peak value
70.7 sin(520𝑡 + 6 ) . The frequency and rms
ans:c
value of the current are_________
a. 82.76 Hz, 50 A
101. The form factor for dc supply voltage is
b. 41.38 Hz, 25 A
always
c. 41.38 Hz, 50 A
a. zero
d. 82.76 Hz, 25 A
b. unity
ans:a
c. infinity
d. any value between 0 and 1
97. The time period or periodic time T of an
ans:b
alternating quantity is the time taken in seconds
to complete_____________
102. The ________ varying alternating quantity
a. one cycle
can be represented as phasor.
b. alternation
a) circular
c. none of the above
b) sinusoidally
d. Half cycle
c) rectangular
ans: a
d) triagular
ans:b
98. The time period of an alternating quantity is
0.02 second. Its frequency will be________
103. The phasors are assumed to be rotated in
a. 25 Hz
_________ direction.
b. 50 Hz
a) clockwise
c. 100 Hz
b) anticlockwise
d. 0.02 Hz
c) circular
ans: b
d) all above
ans:b
99. An ac current is given as i = 10 + 10 sin 314 t,
the average and rms values of the current
104. In practice, alternating quantities are
are____
represented by their _______ values
a. 16.36 A, 17.07 A
a. rms
b. average
c. rectangular
d. polar
ans:a
112. The difference between the phase of two 117. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt-Φ), the
alternating quantities is called the________. ‘v’ is said to _______ ‘i’ by angle Φ
a. phase difference a. in phase
b. sine difference b. lagging
c. length difference c. leading
d. none of the above d. all above
ans:a ans:c
113. When phase difference between the two 118. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ), the
alternating quantities is zero, the two quantities ‘i’ is said to _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ
are said to be in _____ a. in phase
a. tandom b. lagging
b. length c. leading
c. phase d. all above
d. time ans:c
ans:c
119. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ), the
114. When ____________ between the two ‘v’ is said to _______ ‘i’ by angle Φ
alternating quantities is zero, the two quantities a. in phase
are said to be in phase. b. lag
a. time difference c. lead
b. length difference d. all above
c. phase difference ans:b
d. none of the above
ans:c 120. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin ωt, the ‘i’ is
said to _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ
115. When phase difference between the two a. in phase
alternating quantities is _______, the two b. lag
quantities are said to be in phase. c. lead
a. one d. all above
b. unity ans:a
c. zero
d. π/2 121. With respect to reference, plus sign of
ans:c angle indicates _______
a. leading
116. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt-Φ), the ‘i’ b. lagging
is said to be _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ c. in phase
a. in phase d. none of the above
b. lagging ans:a
c. leading
d. all above 122. With respect to reference, minus sign of
ans:b angle indicates _______
126. The diagram in which different sinusoidal 131. Two currents I1 = 1050 and I2 = 5 -100 A
alternating quantities of the same _____, are flow in single phase AC circuit. Then I1+I2 =
represented by individual phasors indicating ________
exact phase relationship is called phasor a. 5.5596+ j4.924 A
diagram. b. 5.55964.924 A
a. time c. 7.296+ j12.58 A
b. frequency d. None of the above
c. sign ans:a
d. shape
ans:b
142.When a phasor is multiplied by j and –j, it is 147. In the complex number 4+j7, 7 is called the
rotated through ______ degrees in the ______ component
anticlockwise direction respectively. a. real
a.90, 270 b. imaginary
b.90, 90 c. in-phase
c.90, 180 d. none of the above`
d.270, 90 ans:d
ans:a
148. The reciprocal of a complex number is
143. If e1 = 100 sin2πf and e2 = 100 sin(2πf-Φ), a_____
then _____ a. complex number
a. e1 lags e2 by Φ b. real component only
b. e1 leads e2 by Φ c. quadrature component only
c. e2 lags e1 by Φ d. none of above
d. none of the above ans:a
ans:c
149. If two complex numbers are equal,
144.The phase difference between two then_____
waveforms can be compared when they _____ a. only their magnitudes will be equal
a. have the same frequency b. only their angles will be equal
b. have the same peak value c. their in phase and quadrature components
c. have the same effective value will be separately equal
d. are sinusoidal d.none of above
ans:a ans:c
145. If two sinusoids of the same frequency but 150. A phasor 2∟180 can be expressed as____
of different amplitude and phase difference are a.j2
added, the resultant is a ______ b.-j2
a. sinusoid of same frequency c.-2
b. sinusoid of double the original frequency d.2
c. sinusoid of half the original frequency ans:c
d. non-sinusoid
ans:a 151. A current of (3+j4) A is flowing through a
circuit. The magnitude of current is _____
146. If the phasor is multiplied by j, then ____ a. 7 A
a. only its magnitude changes b. 5 A
b. only its direction changes c. 1 A
c. both magnitude and direction change d. 1.33 A
d. none of the above ans:b
ans:b
152. The voltage applied in a circuit is given by
100∟60 volts. It can be written as ____
a. 100∟-60 b.50
b.100∟240 c.60
c. 100∟-300 d.105
d. none of the above ans:d
ans:c
158. A phasor is _____
153. The conjugate of -4+j3 is _____ a. a line which represents the magnitude and
a. 4-j3 phase of an alternating quantity
b. -4-j3 b. a line which represents the magnitude and
c.4+j3 direction of an alternating quantity
d. none of the above c. a colored tag or band for distinction between
ans:b different phases of a 3 phase supply
d. an instrument used for measuring phases of
154. The difference of two conjugate number an unbalanced 3 phase load
results in _____ ans:b
a. a complex number
b. in-phase component only 159. A sinusoidal voltage v1 leads another
c. quadrature component only sinusoidal voltagev2 by 180 degrees. Then ____
d. none of the above a. voltage v2 leads voltage v1 by 180 degrees
ans:c b. both voltage have their zero values at the
same time
155. The reciprocal of j is ____ c. both voltage have their peak values at the
a.j same time
b.-j d. all of above
c.jxj ans:d
d.none of the above
ans:b 160. If A = 10∟45 and B = 5∟15, then the
value of A/B will be___
156. Two waves of same frequency have a.50∟60
opposite phase when the phase angle between b.2∟60
them is ___ degrees c. 2∟-30
a.360 d.2∟30
b.180 ans:d
c.90
d.0 161. The length of a phasor in a phasor diagram
ans: b normally represents the ………… value of the
alternating quantity
157. Two sinusoidal currents are given by i1 = a. rms or effective
100sin (ωt+π/3) and i2 = 150sin(ωt-π/4). The b. average
phase difference between them is _____ c. peak
degrees d. none of these
a.15 ans:a
Unit II
Part (a) ELECTROSTATICS
d. 2.4s ans: a
ans: b
15. The unit of capacitance is
10. Three capacitors of values 3 µF, 6 µF, and 12 a. Volts/Coulomb
µF are connected in parallel across an a.c. b. Coulomb/Volt
source. The maximum current pass through c. Ohms
________________ d. Henry/Wb
a.3 µF ans: b
b.6 µF
c.12 µF 16. There is repulsive force between two
d. all the capacitors charged objects when
ans:c a. Charges of unlike sign
b. they have the same number of protons
11.As per Coulomb’s law___________________ c. charges are of same sign
a. F= Q1Q2 / εoεrd2 d. they have the same number of protons
b. F= Q1Q2 / 4𝜋d2 ans: c
c. F= Q1Q2 / 4𝜋 εoεrd2
d. F= Q1Q2 /4𝜋 εoεrd 17. The capacitance of a capacitor is not
ans: c affected by
a. distance between plates
12. Electric field intensity at any point in an b. area of plates
electric field is equal to_______ c. thickness of plates
a. potential gradient d. all of the above
b. (potential gradient)2 ans: c
c. (potential gradient)1/2
d. (potential gradient)1/3 18. When there is an equal amount of positive
ans: a and negative charges on an object the object is
a. Positively charged
13. The lines of forces due to isolated charged b. negatively charged
particle are___________ c. neutral
a. always straight d. supercharged
b. always curved ans:c
c. sometimes curved
d. none of the above 19. Which of the following statements is
ans: a correct?
a. Air capacitors have a black band to indicate
14. The direction of electric field due to positive the outside foil
charge is___ b. Electrolytic capacitor must be connected in
a. away from the charge the correct polarity
b. towards the charge c. Ceramic capacitors must be connected in the
c. both (a) and (b) correct polarity
d. none of the above
30. The unit of capacitance is 35. The absolute permittivity of free space is
a. Henry given by
b. Ohm a. 8.854 x 10-9 F/m
c. Farad b. 8.854 x 10-10 F/m
d. Farad/m c. 8.854 x 10-11 F/m
ans:c d. 8.854 x 10-12 F/m
ans:d
31. A capacitor charged to 200V has 2000 µC of
charge. The value of capacitance will be 36. The relative permittivity of free space is
a. 10 F given by
b. 10 µF a. 1
c. 100 µF b. 10
d. 1000 µF c. 100
ans:b d. 1000
ans:a
32. Voltage across capacitor at any time‘t’
during charging from a D.C. source of voltage V 37. When 4 Volt e.m.f. is applied across a 1
is given by Farad capacitor, it will store energy of
a. ν = Ve-t/λ a. 2 Joule
b. ν = V(1-e-t/λ) b. 4 Joule
c. ν = V2e-t/λ c. 6 Joule
d. ν = V2(1-e-t/λ) d. 8 Joule
ans:b ans:d
33. The ratio of electric flux density to electric 38. The capacitor preferred for high frequency
field intensity is called ………. of the medium circuits is
a. permeability a. air capacitor
b. permittivity b. mica capacitor
c. reluctance c. electrolytic capacitor
d. capacitance d. paper capacitor
ans:b ans:b
42. The time constant of an R-C circuit is 47. The relative permittivity of air is__________
defined as the time during which capacitor a.0
charging voltage actually rises to ---------------- b.1.0006
percent of its ---------- value c. 8.854 × 10−12
a.37, initial d. none of the above
b.63.2, initial ans:b
c.63.2, final
d.37, final 48. The relative permittivity of a material is 10.
ans: c Its absolute permittivity will be
a. 8.854 × 10−11 𝐹/𝑀
43. The time constant of an R-C circuit is b. 9 × 108 𝐹/𝑀
defined as the time during which capacitor c. 5 × 10−5 𝐹/𝑀
charging current actually falls to ---------------- d. 9 × 105 𝐹/𝑀
percent of its initial maximum value ans: a
a.37
b.63 49. The capacitance of a capacitor is ………
c.42 relative permittivity
d.73
ans:b
63. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
59. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm potential difference of 100V across its
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm
Determine the initial rate of rise of voltage resistor. Find discharging current at 2m Sec.
across the capacitor. a. - 0.0818A
a. 0.1V/s b. - 0.01A
b. 10V/s c. - 0.00818A
c. 0.01V/s d. - 1A
d. 1V/s ans:a
ans:b
64. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
60. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm potential difference of 100V across its
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm
Determine the capacitor voltage after a time resistor. Find initial rate of fall in voltage across
equal to the time constant. capacitor.
a.36V a. 10 4 V/s
b.36.6V b. -10 4 V/s
c.63.2V c. -1 4 V/s
d.63 V d. 10A
ans:c ans:b
61. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm 65. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. potential difference of 100V across its
Determine the voltage across the capacitor terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm
3sec. after switch on. resistor. Find time constant of the circuit.
a.25.92V a. 0.1sec
b.259.2V b. 1sec
c.2.592V c. 0.01sec
d.25V d. 0.001sec
ans:a ans:c
62. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a 66. A capacitor consists of two similar plates
potential difference of 100V across its each 10cm x 10cm mounted parallel and
terminals. It is discharged through 1 KΩ resistor. opposite to each other. What is the value of
Find Initial discharging current. capacitance when distance between them is
a.1A 1cm and dielectric used is air.
b.10A a. 8.854 pF
c.0.01A b. 8.854 µF
d.0.1A c. 8.854 mF
ans:d d. 8.854 F
ans: a
a. magnetic field
67. The capacitance of capacitor formed by two b. electric field
parallel plates each 200 cm2 in area separated c. magnetic field and electric field
by dielectric of 4mm thick is 0.0004µF. If d. neither magnetic field nor electric field
voltage of 20000 V is applied then the total ans: b
charge on the plate is
a. 8µC 72. One Farad is the same as
b. 8mC a. One Coulomb/Volt
c. 8nC b. One Joule/Coulomb
d. 8pC c. One Joule/Volt
ans: a d. One Coulomb /Joule
ans: a
68. A parallel plate capacitor has plate area of
2m2 spaced by three slabs of dielectric 73 . If Q be the charge and C be the capacitance
materials. The relative permittivity’s are 2,3 and then the energy stored in the capacitor is
6 respectively and thickness are 0.4mm, 0.6mm a. 1/2QC
and 0.12 mm respectively. Find the combined b. 1/QC
capacitance. c. Q2/2C
a. 0.000295 x 10-6 F d. Q/2C
b. 0.00295 x 10-6 F ans: c
c. 0.0295 x 10-6 F
d. 0. 295 x 10-6 F 74.What capacitance must be placed in series
ans: b with a 15µF capacitor to give a total capacitance
of 5µF
69. What is the unit of charge? a. 4µF
a. Volt-Amp b. 7.5µF
b. Henery c. 10µF
c. Farad d. 25µF
d. Coulomb ans: b
ans: d 75. One Coulomb charge equals the charge on
a. 6.42 x 10 18 electrons
70. What will be the capacitance of four b. 6.24 x 10 18 atoms
capacitors of equal capacitance ‘C’ when c 6.24 x 10 12electrons
connected in parallel d. none of these
a. 4C ans: a
b. C/4
c. 3C/4 76. The capacitance of parallel plate capacitor is
d. C given as
ans: a a. C = Є0 A / d
b. C = Є0 d / A
71. A region around a stationary electric charge
has
Unit II
Part (b) AC FUNDAMENTALS
b.282.6 V a. 150 V
c.400 V b. 216.5 V
d.565.5 V c. 125 V
ans:a d.108.25 V
ans:b
11. The form factor of a sine wave is_____
a.1.01 16. An alternating current is given by the
𝜋
b.1.11 expression 𝑖 = 200 sin(314𝑡 + ) amperes.
3
c.1.21 The maximum value and frequency of the
d. none of the above current are_________
ans:b a. 200 A, 50 Hz
b. 100√2, 50 Hz
12. A current is said to be alternating when it c. 200 A, 100 Hz
changes in_______ d. 200 A, 25 Hz
a. magnitude only ans:a
b. direction only
c. both magnitude and direction 17.The average value of the current 𝑖 =
d. neither magnitude nor direction 𝜋
200 sin 𝑡 from 𝑡 = 0 to 𝑡 = is ______
2
ans:c
a. 400 π
400
13. An alternating current of 50 Hz frequency b. 𝜋
1
and 100 A maximum value is given by______ c.400
a.𝑖 = 200 𝑠𝑖𝑛628𝑡 𝜋
d.400
b.𝑖 = 100 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
ans:b
c.𝑖 = 100√2 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
d.𝑖 = 100√2 𝑠𝑖𝑛157𝑡 18. When two quantities are in quadrature, the
ans:b phase angles between them will be________
a.45°
14. An alternating current of 50 Hz frequency b.90°
has a maximum value of 100 A. Its value 1/600 c.135°
second after the instant current is zero will d.60°
be________ ans:b
a. 25 A
b. 12.5 A 19.The alternating voltage 𝑒 = 200 sin 314𝑡 is
c. 50 A applied to a device which offers an ohmic
d. 75 A resistance of 20 Ω to the flow of current in one
ans:c direction while entirely preventing the flow in
the opposite direction. The average value of the
15.A sinusoidal voltage varies from zero to a current will be_________
maximum of 250 V. The voltage at the instant of a.5 A
60° of the cycle will be________ b.3.18 A
40.The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 45.The average value of sin2θ over a complete
10 A. Its peak value is_________ cycle is_________
a. 7.07 A a. +1
b. 14.14 A b. -1
1
c. 10 A c. 2
d. 28.28 A d. zero
ans:b ans:c
41. If A=10∠45° and B=5∠15°, then the value of 46.The average value of sinθ over a complete
A/B will be_________ cycle is_________
a. 50∠60° a. zero
b. 2∠60° b. +1
c. 2∠-30° c. -1
d. 2∠30° 1
d.
2
ans:d
ans:a
b. 30 Hz a. mean value
c. 40 Hz b. rms value
d. 50 HZ c. peak value
ans:d d. average value
ans:b
59. An ac current is given by 𝑖 = 200 𝑠𝑖𝑛100𝜋𝑡.
It will achieve a value of 100A 64. The rms value and mean value is the same
after_____second. in the case of_______
1 a. traingular wave
a.900
1 b. sine wave
b.
800 c. square wave
1
c. d. half wave rectified sine wave
700
1 ans:c
d.600
ans:d
65. For the same peak value which of the
following wave will have the highest rms value?
60. A heater is rated as 230V, 10KW, AC. The
a.square wave
value of 230V refers to___________
b.half wave rectified sine wave
a. average voltage
c.triangular wave
b. rms voltage
d.sine wave
c. peak voltage
ans:a
d. none of the above
ans:b
66. For the same peak value which of the
following wave will have the least mean value?
61. The peak value of a sine wave is 200V. Its
a. half wave rectified sine wave
average value is_______
b. triangular wave
a.127.4V
c. sine wave
b.141.4V
d. square wave
c.282.8V
ans:a
d.200V
ans:a
67. For a sine wave with peak value Imax, the rms
value is_______
62. The rms value of a sine wave is 100A. Its
a. 0.5Imax
peak value is _______
b. 0.707Imax
a.70.7A
c. 0.9Imax
b.141.4A
d. 1.414Imax
c.150A
ans:b
d.282.8A
ans:b
68. Form factor is the ratio of_________
a. average value/rms value
63. The voltage of domestic supply is 220V. This
b. average value/peak value
figure represents________
c. rms value/average value
68. For a sine wave with peak value Emax, the 73. A sine wave of voltage varies from zero to
average value is______ maximum of 200V. How much is the voltage at
a. 0.636 Emax the instant of 30° of the cycle?
b. 0.707Emax a.50V
c. 0.434 Emax b.82.8V
d. 1.414Emax c.100V
ans:a d.173.2V
ans:c
69. The current in a circuit is given by: 𝑖 =
100 sin 314𝑡 amperes. The maximum value and 74. How much rms current does a 300W, 200V
frequency of current are_________ bulb take from the 200V, 50 Hz power line?
a.50√2 A, 100 Hz a.0.5 A
b.100√2 A, 100 Hz b.1.5 A
c. 100 A, 50 Hz c.2 A
d. 70.7 A, 50 Hz d. 3 A
ans:c ans:b
70. For a frequency of 200 Hz, the time period 75. The rms value of a half-wave rectified
will be_________ current is 100 A. Its value for full-wave
a. 0.05 S rectification would be_________amperes.
b. 0.005 S a.141.4
c. 0.0005 S b.200
d. 0.5 S c. 200/π
ans:b d. 40/π
ans:a
71. An ac voltage of 50 Hz has a maximum value
of 50 V. Its value after 1/600 second after the 76. The rms value of a sinusoidal ac current is
instant the current is zero will be_________ equal to its value at an angle of ______degrees.
a.5V a.90
b.12.5V b.60
c.25V c.45
d.43.8V d.30
ans:c ans:c
72. For 200V rms value triangular wave, the 77. The rms value of alternating current is given
peak voltage will be______ by steady (dc) current which when flowing
a.200V through a given circuit for a given time
b.222V produces________
c.282V
86. An alternating voltage is given in volts by supplied 500 W output (i.e. no losses) at the
expression 𝑣 = 326 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. Its rms value and new voltage it will supply_________
frequency are____ a. 2500 W
a.230V,50 Hz b. 2000 W
b. 230V,100 Hz c. 500 W
c. 326V,50 Hz d. 250 W
d. 326V,100 Hz ans:b
ans:a
91. The direction of current in an ac
87. According to which of the alternating circuit________
current values in the cross sectional area of a a. is from positive to negative
conductor with regard to the heating effect is b. is always in one direction
selected? c. varies from instant to instant
a. peak value d. can not be determined
b. half peak value ans:c
c. average value
d. rms value 92. The angular frequency of an alternating
ans:d quantity is a mathematical quantity obtained by
multiplying the frequency “f” of the alternating
88. The frequency of an alternating current quantity by a factor_________
𝜋
is________ a.
2
a. the speed with which the alternator runs b.π
b. the number of cycles generated in one c.2π
minute d.4π
c. the number of waves passing through a point ans:c
in one second
d. the number of electrons passing through a 93. The average value of an unsymmetrical
point in one second alternating quantity is calculated over
ans:c the_________
a. whole cycle
89. The equation of 50 Hz current sine wave b. half cycle
having rms value of 60 A is______ c. unsymmetrical part of the waveform
a.60 sin 25𝑡 d. first two cycles
b.60 sin 50𝑡 ans:a
c.84.84 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
d42.42 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. 94. The mean value of the current 𝑖 = 20 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝜃
ans:c 𝜋
from θ=0 to θ=2 is_______
a.40π
90. An electric iron designed for 110 V AC 40
supply was rated at 500 W. It was put across a b. 𝜋
1
220 V supply. Assuming that at 110 V, it c.
40
𝜋
d.40 b. 10 A, 17.07 A
ans:b c. 10 A, 12.25 A
d. 16.36 A, 12.2 A
95. A constant current of 2.8A exists in a ans:c
resistor. The rms value of current is______
a. 2.8 A 100. The size (cross-sectional area) of a
b. about 2 A conductor, with regard to the heating effect, is
c. 1.4 A determined on the basis of ……….. value of
d. undefined current to be carried by it
ans:a a. average value
b. peak value
96. An alternating current is represented as 𝑖 = c. rms value
𝜋 d. peak to peak value
70.7 sin(520𝑡 + 6 ) . The frequency and rms
ans:c
value of the current are_________
a. 82.76 Hz, 50 A
101. The form factor for dc supply voltage is
b. 41.38 Hz, 25 A
always
c. 41.38 Hz, 50 A
a. zero
d. 82.76 Hz, 25 A
b. unity
ans:a
c. infinity
d. any value between 0 and 1
97. The time period or periodic time T of an
ans:b
alternating quantity is the time taken in seconds
to complete_____________
102. The ________ varying alternating quantity
a. one cycle
can be represented as phasor.
b. alternation
a) circular
c. none of the above
b) sinusoidally
d. Half cycle
c) rectangular
ans: a
d) triagular
ans:b
98. The time period of an alternating quantity is
0.02 second. Its frequency will be________
103. The phasors are assumed to be rotated in
a. 25 Hz
_________ direction.
b. 50 Hz
a) clockwise
c. 100 Hz
b) anticlockwise
d. 0.02 Hz
c) circular
ans: b
d) all above
ans:b
99. An ac current is given as i = 10 + 10 sin 314 t,
the average and rms values of the current
104. In practice, alternating quantities are
are____
represented by their _______ values
a. 16.36 A, 17.07 A
a. rms
b. average
c. rectangular
d. polar
ans:a
112. The difference between the phase of two 117. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt-Φ), the
alternating quantities is called the________. ‘v’ is said to _______ ‘i’ by angle Φ
a. phase difference a. in phase
b. sine difference b. lagging
c. length difference c. leading
d. none of the above d. all above
ans:a ans:c
113. When phase difference between the two 118. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ), the
alternating quantities is zero, the two quantities ‘i’ is said to _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ
are said to be in _____ a. in phase
a. tandom b. lagging
b. length c. leading
c. phase d. all above
d. time ans:c
ans:c
119. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ), the
114. When ____________ between the two ‘v’ is said to _______ ‘i’ by angle Φ
alternating quantities is zero, the two quantities a. in phase
are said to be in phase. b. lag
a. time difference c. lead
b. length difference d. all above
c. phase difference ans:b
d. none of the above
ans:c 120. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin ωt, the ‘i’ is
said to _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ
115. When phase difference between the two a. in phase
alternating quantities is _______, the two b. lag
quantities are said to be in phase. c. lead
a. one d. all above
b. unity ans:a
c. zero
d. π/2 121. With respect to reference, plus sign of
ans:c angle indicates _______
a. leading
116. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt-Φ), the ‘i’ b. lagging
is said to be _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ c. in phase
a. in phase d. none of the above
b. lagging ans:a
c. leading
d. all above 122. With respect to reference, minus sign of
ans:b angle indicates _______
126. The diagram in which different sinusoidal 131. Two currents I1 = 1050 and I2 = 5 -100 A
alternating quantities of the same _____, are flow in single phase AC circuit. Then I1+I2 =
represented by individual phasors indicating ________
exact phase relationship is called phasor a. 5.5596+ j4.924 A
diagram. b. 5.55964.924 A
a. time c. 7.296+ j12.58 A
b. frequency d. None of the above
c. sign ans:a
d. shape
ans:b
142.When a phasor is multiplied by j and –j, it is 147. In the complex number 4+j7, 7 is called the
rotated through ______ degrees in the ______ component
anticlockwise direction respectively. a. real
a.90, 270 b. imaginary
b.90, 90 c. in-phase
c.90, 180 d. none of the above`
d.270, 90 ans:d
ans:a
148. The reciprocal of a complex number is
143. If e1 = 100 sin2πf and e2 = 100 sin(2πf-Φ), a_____
then _____ a. complex number
a. e1 lags e2 by Φ b. real component only
b. e1 leads e2 by Φ c. quadrature component only
c. e2 lags e1 by Φ d. none of above
d. none of the above ans:a
ans:c
149. If two complex numbers are equal,
144.The phase difference between two then_____
waveforms can be compared when they _____ a. only their magnitudes will be equal
a. have the same frequency b. only their angles will be equal
b. have the same peak value c. their in phase and quadrature components
c. have the same effective value will be separately equal
d. are sinusoidal d.none of above
ans:a ans:c
145. If two sinusoids of the same frequency but 150. A phasor 2∟180 can be expressed as____
of different amplitude and phase difference are a.j2
added, the resultant is a ______ b.-j2
a. sinusoid of same frequency c.-2
b. sinusoid of double the original frequency d.2
c. sinusoid of half the original frequency ans:c
d. non-sinusoid
ans:a 151. A current of (3+j4) A is flowing through a
circuit. The magnitude of current is _____
146. If the phasor is multiplied by j, then ____ a. 7 A
a. only its magnitude changes b. 5 A
b. only its direction changes c. 1 A
c. both magnitude and direction change d. 1.33 A
d. none of the above ans:b
ans:b
152. The voltage applied in a circuit is given by
100∟60 volts. It can be written as ____
a. 100∟-60 b.50
b.100∟240 c.60
c. 100∟-300 d.105
d. none of the above ans:d
ans:c
158. A phasor is _____
153. The conjugate of -4+j3 is _____ a. a line which represents the magnitude and
a. 4-j3 phase of an alternating quantity
b. -4-j3 b. a line which represents the magnitude and
c.4+j3 direction of an alternating quantity
d. none of the above c. a colored tag or band for distinction between
ans:b different phases of a 3 phase supply
d. an instrument used for measuring phases of
154. The difference of two conjugate number an unbalanced 3 phase load
results in _____ ans:b
a. a complex number
b. in-phase component only 159. A sinusoidal voltage v1 leads another
c. quadrature component only sinusoidal voltagev2 by 180 degrees. Then ____
d. none of the above a. voltage v2 leads voltage v1 by 180 degrees
ans:c b. both voltage have their zero values at the
same time
155. The reciprocal of j is ____ c. both voltage have their peak values at the
a.j same time
b.-j d. all of above
c.jxj ans:d
d.none of the above
ans:b 160. If A = 10∟45 and B = 5∟15, then the
value of A/B will be___
156. Two waves of same frequency have a.50∟60
opposite phase when the phase angle between b.2∟60
them is ___ degrees c. 2∟-30
a.360 d.2∟30
b.180 ans:d
c.90
d.0 161. The length of a phasor in a phasor diagram
ans: b normally represents the ………… value of the
alternating quantity
157. Two sinusoidal currents are given by i1 = a. rms or effective
100sin (ωt+π/3) and i2 = 150sin(ωt-π/4). The b. average
phase difference between them is _____ c. peak
degrees d. none of these
a.15 ans:a
Unit IV
Part (a): POLYPHASE A.C. CIRCUITS
1 Three phase star connected balanced c. Three times the corresponding line
system the magnitude of line current voltage
is equal to d. 1.73 times phase voltage
a. One-third the phase current ans: b
b. Equal to the corresponding phase
current 5 In a balanced three-phase load, each
c. Three times the corresponding phase phase has
current a. An equal amount of power
d. Zero b. One-third of total power
c. Two-thirds of total power
ans: b d. A power consumption equal to
√3VL IL
2 Three phase star connected balanced
system the magnitude of line voltage ans: a
is equal to
a. One-third the line voltage 6 In a three-phase system, the voltages
b. Equal to the corresponding line are separated by
voltage a. 450
c. Three times the corresponding line b. 900
voltage c. 1200
d. 1.73 times phase voltage d. 1800
ans: d ans: c
(4 + j 3) Ohm/phase is connected to a
3 phase 400 V supply. Calculate Line 18 A balanced star-connected load of 5
current 36.860 Ohm per phase is connected
a. 80 Amp to a 3-phase, 400 V supply. Calculate
b. 138.56 Amp power factor
c. 50 Amp a. 0.6 lagging
d. 150 Amp b. 0.6 leading
c. 0.8 lagging
ans: b d. 0.8 leading
11. Electrical power is transformed from one 16. The concentric cylindrical winding is used
coil to other coil in transformer_________ for__________
a. Physically a. Core type transformer
b. Electrically b. Shell type transformer
c. Magnetically c. Berry type transformer
d. Electromagnetically d. None of these
ans:d ans:a
20. The main function of transformer iron core 25. A transformer in which the primary voltage
is to__________ is more than the secondary voltage is called a
a. Provide strength to the winding _____ transformer.
b. To decrease hysteresis loss a. step-down
c. Decrease the reluctance of magnetic path b. step-up
d. Reduce eddy current loss c. Isolation
ans:c d. Auto
ans:a
21. The emf induced in the primary of a
transformer___________ 26. Any transformer flux that does not follow
a. is in phase with the flux the core and escapes into the surrounding air is
b. lags behind the flux by 90 degree called____
c. leads the flux by 90 degree a. magnetizing flux
d. is in phase opposition to that of flux b. coupling flux
ans:b c. leakage flux
d. reactance flux
22.The transformer turns ratio ans:c
determines_____________
a. the ratio of primary and secondary voltages 27. A transformer that does not isolate the
b. the ratio of primary and secondary currents output from the input is called _____
c. The resistance on other side transformer
d. all of the above a. Distribution
ans:a b. step-up
c. Auto
23. Turns ratio of single phase transformer is d. Control
given as__________ ans:c
a. N2/N1
b. N1/N2 28. Ideal transformer assumptions do not
c. (N1xN2)/N1 include____________
d. (N1xN2)/N2 a. Zero reactance of the winding
ans:b b. Zero resistance of the winding
c. No leakage flux
24. A transformer in which the secondary d. No saturation of the core
voltage is more than the primary voltage is ans:a
called a _____ transformer
a. step-down 29.The efficiency of the transformer is normally
b. step-up is normally in the range of____________
c. Isolation a. 50 to 70%
d. Auto b. 60 to 75 %
ans:b c. 80 to 90 %
d. 90 to 98%
ans:d
b.1 c. 9 to 12%
c. Less than 1 d. 12 to 20%
d.0 ans:a
ans:c
46. Transformer oil is used in transformer to
41. The primary and secondary voltages in provide_______
transformer are___________ a. Cooling and insulation
a. Always in Phase b. Cooling and lubrication
b. 1800 out of phase c. Insulation and lubrication
c. 900 out of phase d. Insulation, cooling and lubrication
d. 300 or 600 out of phase ans:a
ans:b
47. What is the typical use of
42. The induced emf in transformer secondary autotransformer____________?
depends on__________ a. Toy transformer
a. Maximum flux in core b. Control transformer
b. Frequency c. Variable transformer
c. No of turns on secondary d. Isolating transformer
d. all of the above ans:c
ans:d
48. In any transformer the voltage per turn in
43. Transformer rating usually expressed primary and secondary remains____________
in____________ a. Always different
a.kW b. Always the same
b.kVA c. Always in ratio of K
c. kV d. Sometimes same
d. kWh ans:b
ans:b
49. Full load copper loss in a transformer is 400
44. In a transformer if secondary turns are Watt. At half load, copper losses will
doubled, at the same time primary voltage is be___________
reduced by half, the secondary voltage a. 400 Watt
will_________ b. 100 Watt
a. Be halved c. 200 Watt
b. Not change d. 50 Watt
c. Be four times ans:b
d. Be reduced to quarter 50. A transformer is working with its maximum
ans:b efficiency. If the iron losses are 500 W, the
45. The no load current in terms of full load copper loss will__________
current is usually________ a. 300 W
a. 1 to 3% b. 350 W
b. 3 to 9 % c. 250 W
d. 500 W
ans:d 𝑉2𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
d. 𝑉 𝐼
1 1 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠
ans:a
51. If we increase the flux density in case
transformer_______________
55. For 100 kVA, 11000V/110V single phase
a. The size of transformer will reduce
transformer, the primary full load current
b. The distortion in transformer will reduce
is____________
c. Hysteresis and eddy current losses will reduce
a. 909.09 Amp
d. None of these will be true
b. 90.90 Amp
ans:a
c. 9.09 Amp
d. 9090.9 Amp
52. The direct loading test is performed on
ans:c
transformer to find its____________
a. Regulation
56. For 100 kVA, 11000V/110V single phase
b. Efficiency
transformer, the secondary full load current
c. Both
is________
d. None of these
a. 90.90 Amp
ans:c
b. 9090.9 Amp
c. 909.0 Amp
53. The regulation of transformer is calculated
d. 9.09 Amp
as_________
ans:c
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
a. 57. The disadvantage of auto transformer
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
is______________
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 a. No separation between primary & secondary
b. 𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
b. Size is more than normal transformer for
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 same rating
c.
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 c. More costlier than normal transformer
d. All
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
d. ans:d
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
ans:a
58. In a transformer the voltage regulation will
54. The efficiency of single phase transformer is be near to zero when it operates
calculated as_____________ at____________
𝑉2𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅ a. unity p.f.
a.
𝑉2𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠 b. leading p.f.
c. lagging p.f.
𝑉1𝐼1 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
b. 𝑉 𝐼 d. full load.
2 2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠
ans:b
𝑉1𝐼1 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
c.
𝑉1𝐼1 𝐶𝑜𝑠 ∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠
59. A transformer steps up voltage by a factor 64. Hysteresis loss in transformer depends
of 100. The ratio of current in the primary to on__________
that in secondary_______________ a. both voltage and frequency
a.1 b. voltage alone
b.100 c. frequency alone
c.0.01 d. none of these
d.0.1 ans:a
ans:b
65. Eddy current loss depends
60. An ideal transformer does not on_____________
change______________ a. both current and frequency
a. Voltage b. current alone
b. Power c. frequency alone
c. current d. none of these
d. None of these ans:a
ans:b
66.The flux involved in EMF equation of a
61. The flux in transformer core____________ transformer has______________
a. increases with load a. RMS Value
b. decreases with load b. Average Value
c. remains constant irrespective of load c. Total Value
d. none of these d. maximum Value
ans:c ans:d
63. If the supply frequency in transformer is 68. If primary of the transformer is connected
doubled, then_________ to dc supply, then______
a. hysteresis loss also doubles a. Primary draws small current
b. eddy current loss also doubles b. primary leakage reactance is increased
c. iron losses doubles c. core losses are increased
d. copper losses doubles d. primary may burn out
ans:a ans:d
106. At relatively light loads, the transformer 110. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase
efficiency is low because__________ transformer has to be worked at a maximum
a. secondary output is low flux density of 1.1 web/m2 in the core. The
b. transformer losses are high effective cross sectional area of the core is 145
c. fixed loss is high in proportion to the output
cm2. The no of secondary turns___
d. copper loss is small.
a.71 turns
ans:c
b.75 turns
c.932 turns
107.A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase
d.923 turns
transformer is built on a core having an
ans:a
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 60
turns on the secondary winding. The value of
111. A 80 kVA, 6000 V/ 400 V, 50 Hz single
maximum flux density___
phase transformer has 80 turns on the
a.1.25 Tesla
secondary winding. The value of maximum flux
b.1.52 Tesla
in the core________
c.1.3 Tesla
a.25.22mwb
d.none of the above
b.22.52mwb
ans:a
c.52.22mwb
d. none of these
108. A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase
ans:b
transformer is built on a core having an
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 60 112. A 6600 V/220 V, 50 Hz, step down single
turns on the secondary winding. The number of phase transformer has 1500 turns on its
turns on the high voltage winding________ primary side. If its maximum flux density is 1.2
a. 600 turns Tesla, then the effective cross sectional area of
b. 900 turns core is _____
c. 300 turns a.16.516 10–3 m2
d. 450 turns b.61.516 10–3 m2
ans:b
c.26.516 10–3 m2
d.62.516 10–3 m2
109. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase
ans:a
transformer has to be worked at a maximum
flux density of 1.1 wb/m2 in the core. The 113. A 10 kVA, 3300/240 V, single phase, 50 Hz
effective cross sectional area of the core is 145 transformer has a core area of 300 sq. cm. The
cm2. The no of primary turns___ flux density is 1.3 tesla. The primary full load
a. 930 turns current is ___________
b. 950 turns a. 3.03 amp
c. 932 turns b. 33.03 amp
d. 923 turns c. 30.3 amp
ans:c d. 0.303 amp
ans:a
Unit IV
Part (a): POLYPHASE A.C. CIRCUITS
1 Three phase star connected balanced c. Three times the corresponding line
system the magnitude of line current voltage
is equal to d. 1.73 times phase voltage
a. One-third the phase current ans: b
b. Equal to the corresponding phase
current 5 In a balanced three-phase load, each
c. Three times the corresponding phase phase has
current a. An equal amount of power
d. Zero b. One-third of total power
c. Two-thirds of total power
ans: b d. A power consumption equal to
√3VL IL
2 Three phase star connected balanced
system the magnitude of line voltage ans: a
is equal to
a. One-third the line voltage 6 In a three-phase system, the voltages
b. Equal to the corresponding line are separated by
voltage a. 450
c. Three times the corresponding line b. 900
voltage c. 1200
d. 1.73 times phase voltage d. 1800
ans: d ans: c
(4 + j 3) Ohm/phase is connected to a
3 phase 400 V supply. Calculate Line 18 A balanced star-connected load of 5
current 36.860 Ohm per phase is connected
a. 80 Amp to a 3-phase, 400 V supply. Calculate
b. 138.56 Amp power factor
c. 50 Amp a. 0.6 lagging
d. 150 Amp b. 0.6 leading
c. 0.8 lagging
ans: b d. 0.8 leading
11. Electrical power is transformed from one 16. The concentric cylindrical winding is used
coil to other coil in transformer_________ for__________
a. Physically a. Core type transformer
b. Electrically b. Shell type transformer
c. Magnetically c. Berry type transformer
d. Electromagnetically d. None of these
ans:d ans:a
20. The main function of transformer iron core 25. A transformer in which the primary voltage
is to__________ is more than the secondary voltage is called a
a. Provide strength to the winding _____ transformer.
b. To decrease hysteresis loss a. step-down
c. Decrease the reluctance of magnetic path b. step-up
d. Reduce eddy current loss c. Isolation
ans:c d. Auto
ans:a
21. The emf induced in the primary of a
transformer___________ 26. Any transformer flux that does not follow
a. is in phase with the flux the core and escapes into the surrounding air is
b. lags behind the flux by 90 degree called____
c. leads the flux by 90 degree a. magnetizing flux
d. is in phase opposition to that of flux b. coupling flux
ans:b c. leakage flux
d. reactance flux
22.The transformer turns ratio ans:c
determines_____________
a. the ratio of primary and secondary voltages 27. A transformer that does not isolate the
b. the ratio of primary and secondary currents output from the input is called _____
c. The resistance on other side transformer
d. all of the above a. Distribution
ans:a b. step-up
c. Auto
23. Turns ratio of single phase transformer is d. Control
given as__________ ans:c
a. N2/N1
b. N1/N2 28. Ideal transformer assumptions do not
c. (N1xN2)/N1 include____________
d. (N1xN2)/N2 a. Zero reactance of the winding
ans:b b. Zero resistance of the winding
c. No leakage flux
24. A transformer in which the secondary d. No saturation of the core
voltage is more than the primary voltage is ans:a
called a _____ transformer
a. step-down 29.The efficiency of the transformer is normally
b. step-up is normally in the range of____________
c. Isolation a. 50 to 70%
d. Auto b. 60 to 75 %
ans:b c. 80 to 90 %
d. 90 to 98%
ans:d
b.1 c. 9 to 12%
c. Less than 1 d. 12 to 20%
d.0 ans:a
ans:c
46. Transformer oil is used in transformer to
41. The primary and secondary voltages in provide_______
transformer are___________ a. Cooling and insulation
a. Always in Phase b. Cooling and lubrication
b. 1800 out of phase c. Insulation and lubrication
c. 900 out of phase d. Insulation, cooling and lubrication
d. 300 or 600 out of phase ans:a
ans:b
47. What is the typical use of
42. The induced emf in transformer secondary autotransformer____________?
depends on__________ a. Toy transformer
a. Maximum flux in core b. Control transformer
b. Frequency c. Variable transformer
c. No of turns on secondary d. Isolating transformer
d. all of the above ans:c
ans:d
48. In any transformer the voltage per turn in
43. Transformer rating usually expressed primary and secondary remains____________
in____________ a. Always different
a.kW b. Always the same
b.kVA c. Always in ratio of K
c. kV d. Sometimes same
d. kWh ans:b
ans:b
49. Full load copper loss in a transformer is 400
44. In a transformer if secondary turns are Watt. At half load, copper losses will
doubled, at the same time primary voltage is be___________
reduced by half, the secondary voltage a. 400 Watt
will_________ b. 100 Watt
a. Be halved c. 200 Watt
b. Not change d. 50 Watt
c. Be four times ans:b
d. Be reduced to quarter 50. A transformer is working with its maximum
ans:b efficiency. If the iron losses are 500 W, the
45. The no load current in terms of full load copper loss will__________
current is usually________ a. 300 W
a. 1 to 3% b. 350 W
b. 3 to 9 % c. 250 W
d. 500 W
ans:d 𝑉2𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
d. 𝑉 𝐼
1 1 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠
ans:a
51. If we increase the flux density in case
transformer_______________
55. For 100 kVA, 11000V/110V single phase
a. The size of transformer will reduce
transformer, the primary full load current
b. The distortion in transformer will reduce
is____________
c. Hysteresis and eddy current losses will reduce
a. 909.09 Amp
d. None of these will be true
b. 90.90 Amp
ans:a
c. 9.09 Amp
d. 9090.9 Amp
52. The direct loading test is performed on
ans:c
transformer to find its____________
a. Regulation
56. For 100 kVA, 11000V/110V single phase
b. Efficiency
transformer, the secondary full load current
c. Both
is________
d. None of these
a. 90.90 Amp
ans:c
b. 9090.9 Amp
c. 909.0 Amp
53. The regulation of transformer is calculated
d. 9.09 Amp
as_________
ans:c
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
a. 57. The disadvantage of auto transformer
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
is______________
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 a. No separation between primary & secondary
b. 𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
b. Size is more than normal transformer for
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 same rating
c.
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 c. More costlier than normal transformer
d. All
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
d. ans:d
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
ans:a
58. In a transformer the voltage regulation will
54. The efficiency of single phase transformer is be near to zero when it operates
calculated as_____________ at____________
𝑉2𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅ a. unity p.f.
a.
𝑉2𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠 b. leading p.f.
c. lagging p.f.
𝑉1𝐼1 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
b. 𝑉 𝐼 d. full load.
2 2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠
ans:b
𝑉1𝐼1 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
c.
𝑉1𝐼1 𝐶𝑜𝑠 ∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠
59. A transformer steps up voltage by a factor 64. Hysteresis loss in transformer depends
of 100. The ratio of current in the primary to on__________
that in secondary_______________ a. both voltage and frequency
a.1 b. voltage alone
b.100 c. frequency alone
c.0.01 d. none of these
d.0.1 ans:a
ans:b
65. Eddy current loss depends
60. An ideal transformer does not on_____________
change______________ a. both current and frequency
a. Voltage b. current alone
b. Power c. frequency alone
c. current d. none of these
d. None of these ans:a
ans:b
66.The flux involved in EMF equation of a
61. The flux in transformer core____________ transformer has______________
a. increases with load a. RMS Value
b. decreases with load b. Average Value
c. remains constant irrespective of load c. Total Value
d. none of these d. maximum Value
ans:c ans:d
63. If the supply frequency in transformer is 68. If primary of the transformer is connected
doubled, then_________ to dc supply, then______
a. hysteresis loss also doubles a. Primary draws small current
b. eddy current loss also doubles b. primary leakage reactance is increased
c. iron losses doubles c. core losses are increased
d. copper losses doubles d. primary may burn out
ans:a ans:d
106. At relatively light loads, the transformer 110. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase
efficiency is low because__________ transformer has to be worked at a maximum
a. secondary output is low flux density of 1.1 web/m2 in the core. The
b. transformer losses are high effective cross sectional area of the core is 145
c. fixed loss is high in proportion to the output
cm2. The no of secondary turns___
d. copper loss is small.
a.71 turns
ans:c
b.75 turns
c.932 turns
107.A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase
d.923 turns
transformer is built on a core having an
ans:a
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 60
turns on the secondary winding. The value of
111. A 80 kVA, 6000 V/ 400 V, 50 Hz single
maximum flux density___
phase transformer has 80 turns on the
a.1.25 Tesla
secondary winding. The value of maximum flux
b.1.52 Tesla
in the core________
c.1.3 Tesla
a.25.22mwb
d.none of the above
b.22.52mwb
ans:a
c.52.22mwb
d. none of these
108. A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase
ans:b
transformer is built on a core having an
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 60 112. A 6600 V/220 V, 50 Hz, step down single
turns on the secondary winding. The number of phase transformer has 1500 turns on its
turns on the high voltage winding________ primary side. If its maximum flux density is 1.2
a. 600 turns Tesla, then the effective cross sectional area of
b. 900 turns core is _____
c. 300 turns a.16.516 10–3 m2
d. 450 turns b.61.516 10–3 m2
ans:b
c.26.516 10–3 m2
d.62.516 10–3 m2
109. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase
ans:a
transformer has to be worked at a maximum
flux density of 1.1 wb/m2 in the core. The 113. A 10 kVA, 3300/240 V, single phase, 50 Hz
effective cross sectional area of the core is 145 transformer has a core area of 300 sq. cm. The
cm2. The no of primary turns___ flux density is 1.3 tesla. The primary full load
a. 930 turns current is ___________
b. 950 turns a. 3.03 amp
c. 932 turns b. 33.03 amp
d. 923 turns c. 30.3 amp
ans:c d. 0.303 amp
ans:a
2. In a R-L-C circuit
a. Power is consumed in resistance and is equal to IR
b. Exchange of power takes place between inductor and supply line
c. Exchange of power takes place between capacitor and supply line
d. All above are correct
Answer: d
Answer: b
Answer: b
Answer: d
6. The product of apparent power and cosine of the phase angle between circuit voltage and current is
a. True power
b. Reactive power
c. Volt-amperes
d. Instantaneous power
Answer: a
Answer: a
Answer: c
Answer: d
10. A sine wave has a frequency of 50 Hz. Its angular frequency is _______ radian/second.
a. 100 π
b. 50 jt
c. 25 JT
d. 5 π
Answer: a
11. The apparent power drawn by an A.C. circuit is 10 kVA and active power is 8 kW. The reactive power in the
circuit is
a. 4 kVAR
b. 6 kVAR
c. 8 kVAR
d. 16 kVAR
Answer: b
Answer: b
Answer: b
Answer: c
Answer: d
16. The impedance of circuit is given by 15.5∠-30 Ω. It means that the circuit is
a. capacitive
b. inductive
c. purely resistive
d. none of the above
Answer: c
17. In RLC series circuit, the inductive reactance is 10 Ω and capacitive reactance is 15 Ω. The total reactance of the
circuit is
a. 25 Ω
b. 18.03 Ω
c. 5 Ω
d. 1.5 Ω
Answer: c
18. In series RL circuit, R = 5 Ω, XL = 10 Ω and XC = 15 Ω. If this circuit is connected to a voltage source v = 100
sin (314t + 30) V, the rms value of the current will be
a. 14.14 A
b. 10 A
c. 5 A
d. 3.33 A
Answer : b
19. An alternating voltage of 80+j60 V is applied to a circuit and the current flowing is 4-j2 A. Find impedance of
circuit.
a. 22.37 Ω
b. 23.27 Ω
c. 21.88 Ω
d. 27.22 Ω
Answer: a
20. An alternating voltage of 80+j60 V is applied to a circuit and the current flowing is 4-j2 A. Find power factor of
circuit.
a. 0.5 lag
b. 0.447 lead
c. 0.447 lag
d. none of the above
Answer: c
21. The voltage applied to a circuit is e =100 sin (ωt+30) and the current flowing in the circuit is i = 15 sin (ωt+60).
Determine impedance of the circuit.
a. 6.67 Ω
b. 5.57 Ω
c. 7.67 Ω
d. 1.67 Ω
Answer: a
22. The voltage applied to a circuit is e =100 sin (ωt+30) and the current flowing in the circuit is i = 15 sin (ωt+60).
Determine resistance of the circuit.
a. 6.67 Ω
b. 5.77 Ω
c. 7.67 Ω
d. 1.67 Ω
Answer: b
23. A resistor of 20 Ω, inductor of 0.005 H and capacitor of 50μF are connected in series. A supply voltage 230 V,
50 Hz is connected across the series combination. Calculate inductive reactance.
a. 16.67 Ω
b. 15.71 Ω
c. 17.67 Ω
d. 14.67 Ω
Answer: b
24. A resistor of 20 Ω, inductor of 0.005 H and capacitor of 50μF are connected in series. A supply voltage 230 V,
50 Hz is connected across the series combination. Calculate capacitive reactance.
a. 53.67 Ω
b. 55.71 Ω
c. 63.67 Ω
d. 57.67 Ω
Answer : c
25. Two impedances Z1 = 40∠30 and Z2 = 30∠60 are connected in series across a single phase 230 V, 50 Hz
supply. Calculate the current drawn
a. 4.3 A
b. 2.3 A
c. 3.4 A
d. 5.0 A
Answer: c
26. A coil having a impedance of 50.39∠7.16 is connected in parallel with capacitor having impedance of
127.32∠-90. If supply voltage is 200 V, single phase, 50 Hz. Calculate current in the coil.
a. 4.47∠7.16 A
b. 5.57∠8.16 A
c. 4.97∠90 A
d. 3.97∠-7.16 A
Answer: d
26. A coil having a impedance of 50.39∠7.16 is connected in parallel with capacitor having impedance of
127.32∠-90. If supply voltage is 200 V, single phase, 50 Hz. Calculate current in the capactor.
a. 4.47∠90 A
b. 5.57∠8.17 A
c. 4.97∠90 A
d. 1.57∠90 A
Answer: d
27. An impedance of (7+j5) Ω is connected in parallel with another impedance of (10-j8) Ω across a 230 V, 50
Hz supply. Calculate admittance of the circuit.
a. 0.16∠-7.04 mho
b. 0.16∠7.04 mho
c. -0.16∠7.04 mho
d. none of the above
Answer: b
Answer: c
Answer: a
30. A series RLC circuit has following parameter values: R = 10 Ω, L = 0.01 H and C = 100 μF. Calculate
resonant frequency.
a. 159.15 Hz
b. 169.15 Hz
a. 179.15 Hz
a. 150.15 Hz
Answer: a
UNIT NO: 5 SINGLE PHASE AC CIRCUIT (PART A)
2. In a R-L-C circuit
a. Power is consumed in resistance and is equal to IR
b. Exchange of power takes place between inductor and supply line
c. Exchange of power takes place between capacitor and supply line
d. All above are correct
Answer: d
Answer: b
Answer: b
Answer: d
6. The product of apparent power and cosine of the phase angle between circuit voltage and current is
a. True power
b. Reactive power
c. Volt-amperes
d. Instantaneous power
Answer: a
Answer: a
Answer: c
Answer: d
10. A sine wave has a frequency of 50 Hz. Its angular frequency is _______ radian/second.
a. 100 π
b. 50 jt
c. 25 JT
d. 5 π
Answer: a
11. The apparent power drawn by an A.C. circuit is 10 kVA and active power is 8 kW. The reactive power in the
circuit is
a. 4 kVAR
b. 6 kVAR
c. 8 kVAR
d. 16 kVAR
Answer: b
Answer: b
Answer: b
Answer: c
Answer: d
16. The impedance of circuit is given by 15.5∠-30 Ω. It means that the circuit is
a. capacitive
b. inductive
c. purely resistive
d. none of the above
Answer: c
17. In RLC series circuit, the inductive reactance is 10 Ω and capacitive reactance is 15 Ω. The total reactance of the
circuit is
a. 25 Ω
b. 18.03 Ω
c. 5 Ω
d. 1.5 Ω
Answer: c
18. In series RL circuit, R = 5 Ω, XL = 10 Ω and XC = 15 Ω. If this circuit is connected to a voltage source v = 100
sin (314t + 30) V, the rms value of the current will be
a. 14.14 A
b. 10 A
c. 5 A
d. 3.33 A
Answer : b
19. An alternating voltage of 80+j60 V is applied to a circuit and the current flowing is 4-j2 A. Find impedance of
circuit.
a. 22.37 Ω
b. 23.27 Ω
c. 21.88 Ω
d. 27.22 Ω
Answer: a
20. An alternating voltage of 80+j60 V is applied to a circuit and the current flowing is 4-j2 A. Find power factor of
circuit.
a. 0.5 lag
b. 0.447 lead
c. 0.447 lag
d. none of the above
Answer: c
21. The voltage applied to a circuit is e =100 sin (ωt+30) and the current flowing in the circuit is i = 15 sin (ωt+60).
Determine impedance of the circuit.
a. 6.67 Ω
b. 5.57 Ω
c. 7.67 Ω
d. 1.67 Ω
Answer: a
22. The voltage applied to a circuit is e =100 sin (ωt+30) and the current flowing in the circuit is i = 15 sin (ωt+60).
Determine resistance of the circuit.
a. 6.67 Ω
b. 5.77 Ω
c. 7.67 Ω
d. 1.67 Ω
Answer: b
23. A resistor of 20 Ω, inductor of 0.005 H and capacitor of 50μF are connected in series. A supply voltage 230 V,
50 Hz is connected across the series combination. Calculate inductive reactance.
a. 16.67 Ω
b. 15.71 Ω
c. 17.67 Ω
d. 14.67 Ω
Answer: b
24. A resistor of 20 Ω, inductor of 0.005 H and capacitor of 50μF are connected in series. A supply voltage 230 V,
50 Hz is connected across the series combination. Calculate capacitive reactance.
a. 53.67 Ω
b. 55.71 Ω
c. 63.67 Ω
d. 57.67 Ω
Answer : c
25. Two impedances Z1 = 40∠30 and Z2 = 30∠60 are connected in series across a single phase 230 V, 50 Hz
supply. Calculate the current drawn
a. 4.3 A
b. 2.3 A
c. 3.4 A
d. 5.0 A
Answer: c
26. A coil having a impedance of 50.39∠7.16 is connected in parallel with capacitor having impedance of
127.32∠-90. If supply voltage is 200 V, single phase, 50 Hz. Calculate current in the coil.
a. 4.47∠7.16 A
b. 5.57∠8.16 A
c. 4.97∠90 A
d. 3.97∠-7.16 A
Answer: d
26. A coil having a impedance of 50.39∠7.16 is connected in parallel with capacitor having impedance of
127.32∠-90. If supply voltage is 200 V, single phase, 50 Hz. Calculate current in the capactor.
a. 4.47∠90 A
b. 5.57∠8.17 A
c. 4.97∠90 A
d. 1.57∠90 A
Answer: d
27. An impedance of (7+j5) Ω is connected in parallel with another impedance of (10-j8) Ω across a 230 V, 50
Hz supply. Calculate admittance of the circuit.
a. 0.16∠-7.04 mho
b. 0.16∠7.04 mho
c. -0.16∠7.04 mho
d. none of the above
Answer: b
Answer: c
Answer: a
30. A series RLC circuit has following parameter values: R = 10 Ω, L = 0.01 H and C = 100 μF. Calculate
resonant frequency.
a. 159.15 Hz
b. 169.15 Hz
a. 179.15 Hz
a. 150.15 Hz
Answer: a
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
UNIT I
ELECTROMAGNETISM
1. The complete path followed by the magnetic 6. Lines of force is also called
flux is called a. flux
a. electric circuit b. current
b. magnetic circuit c. resistance
c. electromagnetism d. flux density
d. electric field ans:a
ans: b
7. Lines of force passing per unit area is called
2. Current carrying conductor is always a. magnetic field
surrounded by b. magnetic flux
a. magnetic field c. magnetic flux density
b. electric field d. magnetic field strength
c. Electricity ans:c
d. current
ans: a 8. unit of flux is
a. weber
3. The direction of magnetic field produced by b. wb/m2
current carrying conductor is given by c. Tesla
a. Lenz’s law d. AT
b. right hand thumb rule ans:a
c. Fleming’s left hand rule
d. Kirchoff’s law 9. Unit of flux density is
ans: b a. wb/m2
b. wb
4. Imaginary lines of force originating from c. AT/wb
magnet is called d. A
a. current ans:a
b. resistance
c. flux 10. Unit of magnetic field
d. magnetic field a. wb/m2
ans: c b. wb
c. AT/wb
5. Region surrounded by magnet is called d. none of above
a. magnetic field strength ans:b
b. magnetic field
c. electric field 11. Unit of reluctance is
d. resistance a. AT/wb
ans: b b. AT
12. Opposition to the magnetic lines of force is 17. An air gap is usually inserted in a magnetic
called circuit
a. Flux a. to prevent saturation
b. resistance b. increase flux
c. susceptance c. decrease flux
d. reluctance d. increase mmf
ans:d ans: a
13. Unit of magnetic field strength is 18. A magnetic circuit requires 800 ampere
a. AT/m turns to produce a certain amount of flux. If
b. AT/wb exciting coil of 100 turns has 5 ohms resistance,
c.Tesla then the voltage to be applied to the exciting
d. ohms coil must be
ans: a a. 40V
b. 20 V
14. The force on two current carrying c.10V
conductors in the same direction d. 5V
a. have force of repulsion between them ans: a
b. have force of attraction between them
c. remains unaffected 19. Permeability of a material is the ratio of
d. none of above a. magnetic field to flux density
ans: b b. flux density to magnetic field strength
c. magnetic field strength to flux density
15. Magneto motive force is directly d. none of above
proportional to ans: b
a. no. of turns of coil
b. current through the coil 20. The term saturation related to magnetic
c. both a and b circuit means
d. none of above a. magnetic field strength increases with
ans: c current
b. flux density increases with current
16. The term permeability for a material means c. flux density remains constant if magnetic
a. the no. of turns on an air core field strength is increased
b. the mmf required to produce one unit of d. magnetic field strength remains constant if
magnetic flux flux density is increased.
c. the ability of a material to conduct electricity ans:c
through it
21. The lines of force produced by coil b. does not vary with increasing the cross
completing their path through air, instead of sectional area
intended path is called c. decreases with increasing cross sectional area
a. useful flux of material
b. saturated flux d. decreases with increasing the length of
c. air flux material
d. leakage flux ans: c
ans: d
27. The correct relation stated as following is
22. The bulging of lines of force in air gap in a 𝑁
a. ф =𝑙/𝑎µ0µ𝑟
magnetic circuit is called
b. NI = B× l/a µ0µr
a. leaking flux
c. N=H×l
b. merging
d. NI = ф × l/µ0µr a
c. fringing
ans: d
d. scattering
ans: c
28. The permeance in a magnetic circuit
corresponds to
23. Relative permeability of vacuum is
a. resistance in an electric circuit
a. 4π × 10-7 H/m
b. emf in an electric circuit
b. 1 H/m
c. conductivity in electric circuit
c.1
d. conductance in an electric circuit
d. ¼ H/m
ans: d
ans: c
33.The force experienced by unit north pole 39. The magnitude of force experienced by
when placed at point in a magnetic field is current carrying conductor placed in magnetic
called field depends on
a. magnetic field strength at that point a. value of flux
b. exerted force at that point b. magnitude of current flowing through
c.flux conductor
d. magnetic field c. direction of current
ans:a d. all of above
ans: d
34. The mechanical force acting on current
carrying on conductor when placed in magnetic 40.Two current carrying conductor lying parallel
field is given by relation and close to each other. They are carrying
a. F= N dф/dt current in the opposite direction. The force
b. F= Blv sinӨ between them is
c. F= BIL sinӨ a. repulsive
d. F=L di/dt b. Attractive
ans: c c. Zero
d. none of these
35. Which of the following has the highest ans: a
magnetic permeability?
a. paramagnetic substances 41. Two current carrying conductor lying
b. diamagnetic substances parallel and close to each other. They are
c. ferromagnetic substances carrying current in the same direction. The
d. vacuum force between them is
ans: c a. repulsive
b. Attractive
36. The perfect insulator for magnetic lines of c. Zero
force is d. none of these
d. Silicon steel
ans: c 76. A strength of an electromagnet is
determined by
71. Which of the following is magnetic material? a. reluctance
a. copper b. permeability of the core
b. silicon steel c.mmf
c. aluminium d. all of above
d. brass ans: d
ans: b
77. The strength of the magnetic field around a
72. Flux in the air gap is called conductor is directly proportional to
a. leakage flux a. voltage across the conductor
b. total flux b. current in the conductor
c. useful flux c. type of material of conductor
d. all of above d. none of above
ans: c ans: b
73. A magnetic circuit has a mmf of 400AT and a 78. Reluctance of magnetic material is
reluctance of 2 × 105 AT/wb. The magnetic flux a. less than non magnetic material
in the magnetic circuit is b. more than non magnetic material
a. 3 × 10-5Wb c. equal to that of non magnetic material
b.2 × 10-3Wb d. none of above
c.1.5 × 10-2Wb ans: a
d. 2.5 × 10-4Wb
ans: b 79. The denser the flux
a. stronger is the magnetic field
74. A 2cm long coil has 10 turns and carries a b. weaker is the magnetic flux
current of 750mA. The magnetizing force of the c. no effect on the strength of field
coil is d. none of above
a. 225 AT/m ans: a
b. 675 AT/m
c.450 AT/m 80. The direction of induced e.m.f. is given by
d. 375 AT/m a. Flemings right hand rule
ans: d b. Flemings left hand rule
c. faradays law of electromagnetic induction
75. The reluctance of a magnetic circuit varies d. crock screw rule.
with ans:a
a. length × area
b. length / area 81. Magnitude of induced e.m.f. in a generator
c. area/length depend on
d. (length)2 + area a. flux density
ans: b b. magnitude of current
82. According to Lenz’s law direction of induced 86. In which of the following situations a
e.m.f. is. voltage is induced in a conductor?
a. Same as cause produced a. The conductor moves through the air.
b. Perpendicular to cause produced b. The conductor is connected to a battery.
c. opposite to cause produced c. The conductor is connected to a motor.
d. Non above d. The conductor is moved in a magnetic field.
ans:c ans:d
d. Induction c. Henry
ans:a d. Linkages
ans:c
93. The property of a coil due to which it
opposes the change of current flowing through 98. Unit of induced emf is_________
itself is called_____ of the coil. a. Volt
a. Static inductance b. Ampere
b. Dynamic inductance c. Henry
c.Self inductance d. Linkages
d. Mutual inductance ans:a
ans:c
99. The property of one coil due to which it
94. ____________is used to sense the flow of opposes the change in the other coil is
current in a electric circuit. called…………. between two coils.
a. Ammeter a. Dynamic inductance
b. Voltmeter b. Static inductance
c. Wattmeter c. Self inductance
d. Galvanometer d. Mutual inductance
ans:a ans:d
95. The phenomenon of the self induction is felt 100. The unit of mutual inductance
only when the current in the coil is is_________
a. Changing a. Volt
b. Increasing b. Ampere/ Volt
c. Decreasing c. Henry
d. All the above d. Linkages
ans:a ans:c
d. 37.5 mA a. MMF
ans:b b. EMF
c. Flux linkage
103. If magnetic flux changes from 0.8 Wb to d. Magnetic intensity
0.3 Wb, then change in flux is______ Wb. ans:a
a. 1.1
b. 0.5 109. Expression NI/L is called
c. -0.5 a. MMF
d. -1.1 b. EMF
ans:c c. Flux linkage
d. Magnetic field strength
104. If Number of turns of coil is 200 and if the ans:d
current is 100mA, then MMF is ________
a. 2000 AT 110. Expression for mutual inductance is
b. 200 AT a. –L dI/dt
c. 20 AT b. MdI / dt
d. 0.5 AT c. N2 Ф2/ I1
ans:c d. NФ/I
ans:c
105. Leakage factor is also called as
a. Fringing 111. Faraday’s law of electromagnetic induction
b. Coefficient of inductance is e=
c. Magnetic coefficient a. –NdФ/dt
d. Hopkinson’s coefficient b. MdI / dt
ans:d c. N2 Ф2 / I1
d. NФ/I
106. Movement of electrons are called as ans:a
a. MMF
b. Current 112. The constant K in case of mutual induction
c. Voltage is equal to
d. Flux a.Ф1/Ф2
ans:b b.Ф2/Ф1
c.Ф1/I1
107. Flux density is equal to ________ of flux d.Ф2/I1
and area of cross – section. ans:d
a. Sum
b. Difference 113. Product of the permeability μoμr is equal to
c. Product a. Magnetic flux
d. Fraction b. Magnetic field
ans:d c. Magnetic intensity
d. Magnetic flux density / magnetic field
108. NI expression is called strength
115. __________is normally termed as flux 120. Two conductors are lying parallel and close
linkages. to each other. They are carrying currents in
a. Ф opposite directions. The force between them is.
b. dФ/dt a. Repulsive
c. NФ b. attractive
d.Ф/I c. zero
ans:c d. none of these
ans:a
116. The term NФ/I is generally called as______
a. Self inductance 121. When a coil consisting of single turn
b. Mutual inductance rotates at uniform speed in magnetic field, the
c. Flux linkage induced emf is____
d. Induced emf a. steady
ans:a b. alternating
c. changing
117. In the expression for reluctance S = l/μA of d. reversing
a conduced, letter A represents_________ of ans:b
the conductor.
a. Total area 122. The emf induced in a conductor of length 1
b. Surface area meter moving at a right angles to a uniform
c. Cross- sectional area magnetic field of flux density 1.5 wb/m2 with
d. None of these. velocity of 50 m/s is.
ans:c a. 0
b.1.5 v
118. When a current carrying conductor is c. 75 v
brought in to magnetic field, the force that d. 100 v
moves the conductor depends on ans:c
a. direction of current.
b. length of conductor 123. Which of following statements is incorrect.
c. value of current a. Whenever flux linking with the coil or circuit
d.all of the above changes, an emf is induced.
ans:d b. The direction of dynamically induced emf can
be determined by Fleming’s right-hand rule.
UNIT I
ELECTROMAGNETISM
1. The complete path followed by the magnetic 6. Lines of force is also called
flux is called a. flux
a. electric circuit b. current
b. magnetic circuit c. resistance
c. electromagnetism d. flux density
d. electric field ans:a
ans: b
7. Lines of force passing per unit area is called
2. Current carrying conductor is always a. magnetic field
surrounded by b. magnetic flux
a. magnetic field c. magnetic flux density
b. electric field d. magnetic field strength
c. Electricity ans:c
d. current
ans: a 8. unit of flux is
a. weber
3. The direction of magnetic field produced by b. wb/m2
current carrying conductor is given by c. Tesla
a. Lenz’s law d. AT
b. right hand thumb rule ans:a
c. Fleming’s left hand rule
d. Kirchoff’s law 9. Unit of flux density is
ans: b a. wb/m2
b. wb
4. Imaginary lines of force originating from c. AT/wb
magnet is called d. A
a. current ans:a
b. resistance
c. flux 10. Unit of magnetic field
d. magnetic field a. wb/m2
ans: c b. wb
c. AT/wb
5. Region surrounded by magnet is called d. none of above
a. magnetic field strength ans:b
b. magnetic field
c. electric field 11. Unit of reluctance is
d. resistance a. AT/wb
ans: b b. AT
12. Opposition to the magnetic lines of force is 17. An air gap is usually inserted in a magnetic
called circuit
a. Flux a. to prevent saturation
b. resistance b. increase flux
c. susceptance c. decrease flux
d. reluctance d. increase mmf
ans:d ans: a
13. Unit of magnetic field strength is 18. A magnetic circuit requires 800 ampere
a. AT/m turns to produce a certain amount of flux. If
b. AT/wb exciting coil of 100 turns has 5 ohms resistance,
c.Tesla then the voltage to be applied to the exciting
d. ohms coil must be
ans: a a. 40V
b. 20 V
14. The force on two current carrying c.10V
conductors in the same direction d. 5V
a. have force of repulsion between them ans: a
b. have force of attraction between them
c. remains unaffected 19. Permeability of a material is the ratio of
d. none of above a. magnetic field to flux density
ans: b b. flux density to magnetic field strength
c. magnetic field strength to flux density
15. Magneto motive force is directly d. none of above
proportional to ans: b
a. no. of turns of coil
b. current through the coil 20. The term saturation related to magnetic
c. both a and b circuit means
d. none of above a. magnetic field strength increases with
ans: c current
b. flux density increases with current
16. The term permeability for a material means c. flux density remains constant if magnetic
a. the no. of turns on an air core field strength is increased
b. the mmf required to produce one unit of d. magnetic field strength remains constant if
magnetic flux flux density is increased.
c. the ability of a material to conduct electricity ans:c
through it
21. The lines of force produced by coil b. does not vary with increasing the cross
completing their path through air, instead of sectional area
intended path is called c. decreases with increasing cross sectional area
a. useful flux of material
b. saturated flux d. decreases with increasing the length of
c. air flux material
d. leakage flux ans: c
ans: d
27. The correct relation stated as following is
22. The bulging of lines of force in air gap in a 𝑁
a. ф =𝑙/𝑎µ0µ𝑟
magnetic circuit is called
b. NI = B× l/a µ0µr
a. leaking flux
c. N=H×l
b. merging
d. NI = ф × l/µ0µr a
c. fringing
ans: d
d. scattering
ans: c
28. The permeance in a magnetic circuit
corresponds to
23. Relative permeability of vacuum is
a. resistance in an electric circuit
a. 4π × 10-7 H/m
b. emf in an electric circuit
b. 1 H/m
c. conductivity in electric circuit
c.1
d. conductance in an electric circuit
d. ¼ H/m
ans: d
ans: c
33.The force experienced by unit north pole 39. The magnitude of force experienced by
when placed at point in a magnetic field is current carrying conductor placed in magnetic
called field depends on
a. magnetic field strength at that point a. value of flux
b. exerted force at that point b. magnitude of current flowing through
c.flux conductor
d. magnetic field c. direction of current
ans:a d. all of above
ans: d
34. The mechanical force acting on current
carrying on conductor when placed in magnetic 40.Two current carrying conductor lying parallel
field is given by relation and close to each other. They are carrying
a. F= N dф/dt current in the opposite direction. The force
b. F= Blv sinӨ between them is
c. F= BIL sinӨ a. repulsive
d. F=L di/dt b. Attractive
ans: c c. Zero
d. none of these
35. Which of the following has the highest ans: a
magnetic permeability?
a. paramagnetic substances 41. Two current carrying conductor lying
b. diamagnetic substances parallel and close to each other. They are
c. ferromagnetic substances carrying current in the same direction. The
d. vacuum force between them is
ans: c a. repulsive
b. Attractive
36. The perfect insulator for magnetic lines of c. Zero
force is d. none of these
d. Silicon steel
ans: c 76. A strength of an electromagnet is
determined by
71. Which of the following is magnetic material? a. reluctance
a. copper b. permeability of the core
b. silicon steel c.mmf
c. aluminium d. all of above
d. brass ans: d
ans: b
77. The strength of the magnetic field around a
72. Flux in the air gap is called conductor is directly proportional to
a. leakage flux a. voltage across the conductor
b. total flux b. current in the conductor
c. useful flux c. type of material of conductor
d. all of above d. none of above
ans: c ans: b
73. A magnetic circuit has a mmf of 400AT and a 78. Reluctance of magnetic material is
reluctance of 2 × 105 AT/wb. The magnetic flux a. less than non magnetic material
in the magnetic circuit is b. more than non magnetic material
a. 3 × 10-5Wb c. equal to that of non magnetic material
b.2 × 10-3Wb d. none of above
c.1.5 × 10-2Wb ans: a
d. 2.5 × 10-4Wb
ans: b 79. The denser the flux
a. stronger is the magnetic field
74. A 2cm long coil has 10 turns and carries a b. weaker is the magnetic flux
current of 750mA. The magnetizing force of the c. no effect on the strength of field
coil is d. none of above
a. 225 AT/m ans: a
b. 675 AT/m
c.450 AT/m 80. The direction of induced e.m.f. is given by
d. 375 AT/m a. Flemings right hand rule
ans: d b. Flemings left hand rule
c. faradays law of electromagnetic induction
75. The reluctance of a magnetic circuit varies d. crock screw rule.
with ans:a
a. length × area
b. length / area 81. Magnitude of induced e.m.f. in a generator
c. area/length depend on
d. (length)2 + area a. flux density
ans: b b. magnitude of current
82. According to Lenz’s law direction of induced 86. In which of the following situations a
e.m.f. is. voltage is induced in a conductor?
a. Same as cause produced a. The conductor moves through the air.
b. Perpendicular to cause produced b. The conductor is connected to a battery.
c. opposite to cause produced c. The conductor is connected to a motor.
d. Non above d. The conductor is moved in a magnetic field.
ans:c ans:d
d. Induction c. Henry
ans:a d. Linkages
ans:c
93. The property of a coil due to which it
opposes the change of current flowing through 98. Unit of induced emf is_________
itself is called_____ of the coil. a. Volt
a. Static inductance b. Ampere
b. Dynamic inductance c. Henry
c.Self inductance d. Linkages
d. Mutual inductance ans:a
ans:c
99. The property of one coil due to which it
94. ____________is used to sense the flow of opposes the change in the other coil is
current in a electric circuit. called…………. between two coils.
a. Ammeter a. Dynamic inductance
b. Voltmeter b. Static inductance
c. Wattmeter c. Self inductance
d. Galvanometer d. Mutual inductance
ans:a ans:d
95. The phenomenon of the self induction is felt 100. The unit of mutual inductance
only when the current in the coil is is_________
a. Changing a. Volt
b. Increasing b. Ampere/ Volt
c. Decreasing c. Henry
d. All the above d. Linkages
ans:a ans:c
d. 37.5 mA a. MMF
ans:b b. EMF
c. Flux linkage
103. If magnetic flux changes from 0.8 Wb to d. Magnetic intensity
0.3 Wb, then change in flux is______ Wb. ans:a
a. 1.1
b. 0.5 109. Expression NI/L is called
c. -0.5 a. MMF
d. -1.1 b. EMF
ans:c c. Flux linkage
d. Magnetic field strength
104. If Number of turns of coil is 200 and if the ans:d
current is 100mA, then MMF is ________
a. 2000 AT 110. Expression for mutual inductance is
b. 200 AT a. –L dI/dt
c. 20 AT b. MdI / dt
d. 0.5 AT c. N2 Ф2/ I1
ans:c d. NФ/I
ans:c
105. Leakage factor is also called as
a. Fringing 111. Faraday’s law of electromagnetic induction
b. Coefficient of inductance is e=
c. Magnetic coefficient a. –NdФ/dt
d. Hopkinson’s coefficient b. MdI / dt
ans:d c. N2 Ф2 / I1
d. NФ/I
106. Movement of electrons are called as ans:a
a. MMF
b. Current 112. The constant K in case of mutual induction
c. Voltage is equal to
d. Flux a.Ф1/Ф2
ans:b b.Ф2/Ф1
c.Ф1/I1
107. Flux density is equal to ________ of flux d.Ф2/I1
and area of cross – section. ans:d
a. Sum
b. Difference 113. Product of the permeability μoμr is equal to
c. Product a. Magnetic flux
d. Fraction b. Magnetic field
ans:d c. Magnetic intensity
d. Magnetic flux density / magnetic field
108. NI expression is called strength
115. __________is normally termed as flux 120. Two conductors are lying parallel and close
linkages. to each other. They are carrying currents in
a. Ф opposite directions. The force between them is.
b. dФ/dt a. Repulsive
c. NФ b. attractive
d.Ф/I c. zero
ans:c d. none of these
ans:a
116. The term NФ/I is generally called as______
a. Self inductance 121. When a coil consisting of single turn
b. Mutual inductance rotates at uniform speed in magnetic field, the
c. Flux linkage induced emf is____
d. Induced emf a. steady
ans:a b. alternating
c. changing
117. In the expression for reluctance S = l/μA of d. reversing
a conduced, letter A represents_________ of ans:b
the conductor.
a. Total area 122. The emf induced in a conductor of length 1
b. Surface area meter moving at a right angles to a uniform
c. Cross- sectional area magnetic field of flux density 1.5 wb/m2 with
d. None of these. velocity of 50 m/s is.
ans:c a. 0
b.1.5 v
118. When a current carrying conductor is c. 75 v
brought in to magnetic field, the force that d. 100 v
moves the conductor depends on ans:c
a. direction of current.
b. length of conductor 123. Which of following statements is incorrect.
c. value of current a. Whenever flux linking with the coil or circuit
d.all of the above changes, an emf is induced.
ans:d b. The direction of dynamically induced emf can
be determined by Fleming’s right-hand rule.
11. Two waves of the same frequency have opposite phase when the phase
angle between them is
(a) 360°
(b) 180°
(c) 90°
(d) 0° Ans: b
UNIT 02
AC Fundamentals
12. The power consumed in a circuit element will be least when the phase
difference between the current and voltage is
(a) 180°
(b) 90°
(c) 60°
(d) 0°
Ans: b
13. The r.m.s. value and mean value is the same in the case of
(a) triangular wave
(6) sine wave
(c) square wave
(d) half wave rectified sine wave
Ans: c
14. For the same peak value which of the following wave will ‘have the
highest r.m.s. value ?
(a) square wave
(b) half wave rectified sine wave
(c) triangular wave
(d) sine wave
Ans: a
15. For the same peak value, which of the following wavehas the least mean
value ?
(a) half wave rectified sine wave
(b) triangular wave
UNIT 02
AC Fundamentals
(c) sine wave
(d) square wave
Ans: a
16. For a sine wave with peak value Imax the r.m.s. value is
(a) 0.5 Imax
(b) 0.707
(c) 0.9
(d) 1.414 Lmax
Ans: b
19. For a sine wave with peak value Emax______,the average value is (a)
0.636 Emax
UNIT 02
AC Fundamentals
(b) 0.707 Emax
(c) 0.434 EWc
(d) lAUEmax
Ans: a
20. For a frequency of 200 Hz, the time period will be
(a) 0.05 s
(b) 0.005 s
(c) 0.0005 s
(d) 0.5 s
Ans: b
21. The phase difference between voltage and current wave through circuit
element is given as 30°. The essential condition is that
(a) both waves must have same frequency
(b) both waves must have identical peak values
(c) both waves must have zero value at the same time
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
22. The r.m.s. value of a sinusoidal A.C. current is equal to its value at an
angle of______degrees.
(a) 90
(b) 60
(c) 45
(d) 30
Ans: c
UNIT 02
AC Fundamentals
23. Capacitive reactance is more when
(a) capacitance is less and frequency of supply is less
(b) capacitance is less and frequency of supply is more
(c) capacitance is more and frequency of supply is less
(d) capacitance is more and frequency of supply is more
Ans: a
29. The time constant of the capacitance circuit is defined as the time
during which voltage
(a) falls to 36.8% of its final steady value
(b) rises to 38.6% of its final steady value
(c) rises to 63.2% of its final steady value
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
UNIT 02
AC Fundamentals
30. The r.m.s. value of alternating current is given by steady (D.C.) current
which when flowing through a given circuit for a given time produces
(a) the more heat than produced by A.C. when flowing through the same
circuit (b) the same heat as produced by A.C. when flowing through the
same circuit
(c) the less heat than produced by A.C. flowing through the same circuit
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
UNIT 02
AC Fundamentals
BEE Unit 1-4 MCQs
UNIT 1 - Electromagnetism
UNIT 2 - Electrostatics and AC Fundamentals
UNIT 3 - Single Phase AC Circuits
UNIT 4 - Polyphase A.C. Circuits and Single
phase Transformers
UNIT I
ELECTROMAGNETISM
1. The complete path followed by the magnetic 6. Lines of force is also called
flux is called a. flux
a. electric circuit b. current
b. magnetic circuit c. resistance
c. electromagnetism d. flux density
d. electric field ans:a
ans: b
7. Lines of force passing per unit area is called
2. Current carrying conductor is always a. magnetic field
surrounded by b. magnetic flux
a. magnetic field c. magnetic flux density
b. electric field d. magnetic field strength
c. Electricity ans:c
d. current
ans: a 8. unit of flux is
a. weber
3. The direction of magnetic field produced by b. wb/m2
current carrying conductor is given by c. Tesla
a. Lenz’s law d. AT
b. right hand thumb rule ans:a
c. Fleming’s left hand rule
d. Kirchoff’s law 9. Unit of flux density is
ans: b a. wb/m2
b. wb
4. Imaginary lines of force originating from c. AT/wb
magnet is called d. A
a. current ans:a
b. resistance
c. flux 10. Unit of magnetic field
d. magnetic field a. wb/m2
ans: c b. wb
c. AT/wb
5. Region surrounded by magnet is called d. none of above
a. magnetic field strength ans:b
b. magnetic field
c. electric field 11. Unit of reluctance is
d. resistance a. AT/wb
ans: b b. AT
12. Opposition to the magnetic lines of force is 17. An air gap is usually inserted in a magnetic
called circuit
a. Flux a. to prevent saturation
b. resistance b. increase flux
c. susceptance c. decrease flux
d. reluctance d. increase mmf
ans:d ans: a
13. Unit of magnetic field strength is 18. A magnetic circuit requires 800 ampere
a. AT/m turns to produce a certain amount of flux. If
b. AT/wb exciting coil of 100 turns has 5 ohms resistance,
c.Tesla then the voltage to be applied to the exciting
d. ohms coil must be
ans: a a. 40V
b. 20 V
14. The force on two current carrying c.10V
conductors in the same direction d. 5V
a. have force of repulsion between them ans: a
b. have force of attraction between them
c. remains unaffected 19. Permeability of a material is the ratio of
d. none of above a. magnetic field to flux density
ans: b b. flux density to magnetic field strength
c. magnetic field strength to flux density
15. Magneto motive force is directly d. none of above
proportional to ans: b
a. no. of turns of coil
b. current through the coil 20. The term saturation related to magnetic
c. both a and b circuit means
d. none of above a. magnetic field strength increases with
ans: c current
b. flux density increases with current
16. The term permeability for a material means c. flux density remains constant if magnetic
a. the no. of turns on an air core field strength is increased
b. the mmf required to produce one unit of d. magnetic field strength remains constant if
magnetic flux flux density is increased.
c. the ability of a material to conduct electricity ans:c
through it
21. The lines of force produced by coil b. does not vary with increasing the cross
completing their path through air, instead of sectional area
intended path is called c. decreases with increasing cross sectional area
a. useful flux of material
b. saturated flux d. decreases with increasing the length of
c. air flux material
d. leakage flux ans: c
ans: d
27. The correct relation stated as following is
22. The bulging of lines of force in air gap in a 𝑁
a. ф =𝑙/𝑎µ0µ𝑟
magnetic circuit is called
b. NI = B× l/a µ0µr
a. leaking flux
c. N=H×l
b. merging
d. NI = ф × l/µ0µr a
c. fringing
ans: d
d. scattering
ans: c
28. The permeance in a magnetic circuit
corresponds to
23. Relative permeability of vacuum is
a. resistance in an electric circuit
a. 4π × 10-7 H/m
b. emf in an electric circuit
b. 1 H/m
c. conductivity in electric circuit
c.1
d. conductance in an electric circuit
d. ¼ H/m
ans: d
ans: c
33.The force experienced by unit north pole 39. The magnitude of force experienced by
when placed at point in a magnetic field is current carrying conductor placed in magnetic
called field depends on
a. magnetic field strength at that point a. value of flux
b. exerted force at that point b. magnitude of current flowing through
c.flux conductor
d. magnetic field c. direction of current
ans:a d. all of above
ans: d
34. The mechanical force acting on current
carrying on conductor when placed in magnetic 40.Two current carrying conductor lying parallel
field is given by relation and close to each other. They are carrying
a. F= N dф/dt current in the opposite direction. The force
b. F= Blv sinӨ between them is
c. F= BIL sinӨ a. repulsive
d. F=L di/dt b. Attractive
ans: c c. Zero
d. none of these
35. Which of the following has the highest ans: a
magnetic permeability?
a. paramagnetic substances 41. Two current carrying conductor lying
b. diamagnetic substances parallel and close to each other. They are
c. ferromagnetic substances carrying current in the same direction. The
d. vacuum force between them is
ans: c a. repulsive
b. Attractive
36. The perfect insulator for magnetic lines of c. Zero
force is d. none of these
d. Silicon steel
ans: c 76. A strength of an electromagnet is
determined by
71. Which of the following is magnetic material? a. reluctance
a. copper b. permeability of the core
b. silicon steel c.mmf
c. aluminium d. all of above
d. brass ans: d
ans: b
77. The strength of the magnetic field around a
72. Flux in the air gap is called conductor is directly proportional to
a. leakage flux a. voltage across the conductor
b. total flux b. current in the conductor
c. useful flux c. type of material of conductor
d. all of above d. none of above
ans: c ans: b
73. A magnetic circuit has a mmf of 400AT and a 78. Reluctance of magnetic material is
reluctance of 2 × 105 AT/wb. The magnetic flux a. less than non magnetic material
in the magnetic circuit is b. more than non magnetic material
a. 3 × 10-5Wb c. equal to that of non magnetic material
b.2 × 10-3Wb d. none of above
c.1.5 × 10-2Wb ans: a
d. 2.5 × 10-4Wb
ans: b 79. The denser the flux
a. stronger is the magnetic field
74. A 2cm long coil has 10 turns and carries a b. weaker is the magnetic flux
current of 750mA. The magnetizing force of the c. no effect on the strength of field
coil is d. none of above
a. 225 AT/m ans: a
b. 675 AT/m
c.450 AT/m 80. The direction of induced e.m.f. is given by
d. 375 AT/m a. Flemings right hand rule
ans: d b. Flemings left hand rule
c. faradays law of electromagnetic induction
75. The reluctance of a magnetic circuit varies d. crock screw rule.
with ans:a
a. length × area
b. length / area 81. Magnitude of induced e.m.f. in a generator
c. area/length depend on
d. (length)2 + area a. flux density
ans: b b. magnitude of current
82. According to Lenz’s law direction of induced 86. In which of the following situations a
e.m.f. is. voltage is induced in a conductor?
a. Same as cause produced a. The conductor moves through the air.
b. Perpendicular to cause produced b. The conductor is connected to a battery.
c. opposite to cause produced c. The conductor is connected to a motor.
d. Non above d. The conductor is moved in a magnetic field.
ans:c ans:d
d. Induction c. Henry
ans:a d. Linkages
ans:c
93. The property of a coil due to which it
opposes the change of current flowing through 98. Unit of induced emf is_________
itself is called_____ of the coil. a. Volt
a. Static inductance b. Ampere
b. Dynamic inductance c. Henry
c.Self inductance d. Linkages
d. Mutual inductance ans:a
ans:c
99. The property of one coil due to which it
94. ____________is used to sense the flow of opposes the change in the other coil is
current in a electric circuit. called…………. between two coils.
a. Ammeter a. Dynamic inductance
b. Voltmeter b. Static inductance
c. Wattmeter c. Self inductance
d. Galvanometer d. Mutual inductance
ans:a ans:d
95. The phenomenon of the self induction is felt 100. The unit of mutual inductance
only when the current in the coil is is_________
a. Changing a. Volt
b. Increasing b. Ampere/ Volt
c. Decreasing c. Henry
d. All the above d. Linkages
ans:a ans:c
d. 37.5 mA a. MMF
ans:b b. EMF
c. Flux linkage
103. If magnetic flux changes from 0.8 Wb to d. Magnetic intensity
0.3 Wb, then change in flux is______ Wb. ans:a
a. 1.1
b. 0.5 109. Expression NI/L is called
c. -0.5 a. MMF
d. -1.1 b. EMF
ans:c c. Flux linkage
d. Magnetic field strength
104. If Number of turns of coil is 200 and if the ans:d
current is 100mA, then MMF is ________
a. 2000 AT 110. Expression for mutual inductance is
b. 200 AT a. –L dI/dt
c. 20 AT b. MdI / dt
d. 0.5 AT c. N2 Ф2/ I1
ans:c d. NФ/I
ans:c
105. Leakage factor is also called as
a. Fringing 111. Faraday’s law of electromagnetic induction
b. Coefficient of inductance is e=
c. Magnetic coefficient a. –NdФ/dt
d. Hopkinson’s coefficient b. MdI / dt
ans:d c. N2 Ф2 / I1
d. NФ/I
106. Movement of electrons are called as ans:a
a. MMF
b. Current 112. The constant K in case of mutual induction
c. Voltage is equal to
d. Flux a.Ф1/Ф2
ans:b b.Ф2/Ф1
c.Ф1/I1
107. Flux density is equal to ________ of flux d.Ф2/I1
and area of cross – section. ans:d
a. Sum
b. Difference 113. Product of the permeability μoμr is equal to
c. Product a. Magnetic flux
d. Fraction b. Magnetic field
ans:d c. Magnetic intensity
d. Magnetic flux density / magnetic field
108. NI expression is called strength
115. __________is normally termed as flux 120. Two conductors are lying parallel and close
linkages. to each other. They are carrying currents in
a. Ф opposite directions. The force between them is.
b. dФ/dt a. Repulsive
c. NФ b. attractive
d.Ф/I c. zero
ans:c d. none of these
ans:a
116. The term NФ/I is generally called as______
a. Self inductance 121. When a coil consisting of single turn
b. Mutual inductance rotates at uniform speed in magnetic field, the
c. Flux linkage induced emf is____
d. Induced emf a. steady
ans:a b. alternating
c. changing
117. In the expression for reluctance S = l/μA of d. reversing
a conduced, letter A represents_________ of ans:b
the conductor.
a. Total area 122. The emf induced in a conductor of length 1
b. Surface area meter moving at a right angles to a uniform
c. Cross- sectional area magnetic field of flux density 1.5 wb/m2 with
d. None of these. velocity of 50 m/s is.
ans:c a. 0
b.1.5 v
118. When a current carrying conductor is c. 75 v
brought in to magnetic field, the force that d. 100 v
moves the conductor depends on ans:c
a. direction of current.
b. length of conductor 123. Which of following statements is incorrect.
c. value of current a. Whenever flux linking with the coil or circuit
d.all of the above changes, an emf is induced.
ans:d b. The direction of dynamically induced emf can
be determined by Fleming’s right-hand rule.
Unit II
Part (a) ELECTROSTATICS
d. 2.4s ans: a
ans: b
15. The unit of capacitance is
10. Three capacitors of values 3 µF, 6 µF, and 12 a. Volts/Coulomb
µF are connected in parallel across an a.c. b. Coulomb/Volt
source. The maximum current pass through c. Ohms
________________ d. Henry/Wb
a.3 µF ans: b
b.6 µF
c.12 µF 16. There is repulsive force between two
d. all the capacitors charged objects when
ans:c a. Charges of unlike sign
b. they have the same number of protons
11.As per Coulomb’s law___________________ c. charges are of same sign
a. F= Q1Q2 / εoεrd2 d. they have the same number of protons
b. F= Q1Q2 / 4𝜋d2 ans: c
c. F= Q1Q2 / 4𝜋 εoεrd2
d. F= Q1Q2 /4𝜋 εoεrd 17. The capacitance of a capacitor is not
ans: c affected by
a. distance between plates
12. Electric field intensity at any point in an b. area of plates
electric field is equal to_______ c. thickness of plates
a. potential gradient d. all of the above
b. (potential gradient)2 ans: c
c. (potential gradient)1/2
d. (potential gradient)1/3 18. When there is an equal amount of positive
ans: a and negative charges on an object the object is
a. Positively charged
13. The lines of forces due to isolated charged b. negatively charged
particle are___________ c. neutral
a. always straight d. supercharged
b. always curved ans:c
c. sometimes curved
d. none of the above 19. Which of the following statements is
ans: a correct?
a. Air capacitors have a black band to indicate
14. The direction of electric field due to positive the outside foil
charge is___ b. Electrolytic capacitor must be connected in
a. away from the charge the correct polarity
b. towards the charge c. Ceramic capacitors must be connected in the
c. both (a) and (b) correct polarity
d. none of the above
30. The unit of capacitance is 35. The absolute permittivity of free space is
a. Henry given by
b. Ohm a. 8.854 x 10-9 F/m
c. Farad b. 8.854 x 10-10 F/m
d. Farad/m c. 8.854 x 10-11 F/m
ans:c d. 8.854 x 10-12 F/m
ans:d
31. A capacitor charged to 200V has 2000 µC of
charge. The value of capacitance will be 36. The relative permittivity of free space is
a. 10 F given by
b. 10 µF a. 1
c. 100 µF b. 10
d. 1000 µF c. 100
ans:b d. 1000
ans:a
32. Voltage across capacitor at any time‘t’
during charging from a D.C. source of voltage V 37. When 4 Volt e.m.f. is applied across a 1
is given by Farad capacitor, it will store energy of
a. ν = Ve-t/λ a. 2 Joule
b. ν = V(1-e-t/λ) b. 4 Joule
c. ν = V2e-t/λ c. 6 Joule
d. ν = V2(1-e-t/λ) d. 8 Joule
ans:b ans:d
33. The ratio of electric flux density to electric 38. The capacitor preferred for high frequency
field intensity is called ………. of the medium circuits is
a. permeability a. air capacitor
b. permittivity b. mica capacitor
c. reluctance c. electrolytic capacitor
d. capacitance d. paper capacitor
ans:b ans:b
42. The time constant of an R-C circuit is 47. The relative permittivity of air is__________
defined as the time during which capacitor a.0
charging voltage actually rises to ---------------- b.1.0006
percent of its ---------- value c. 8.854 × 10−12
a.37, initial d. none of the above
b.63.2, initial ans:b
c.63.2, final
d.37, final 48. The relative permittivity of a material is 10.
ans: c Its absolute permittivity will be
a. 8.854 × 10−11 𝐹/𝑀
43. The time constant of an R-C circuit is b. 9 × 108 𝐹/𝑀
defined as the time during which capacitor c. 5 × 10−5 𝐹/𝑀
charging current actually falls to ---------------- d. 9 × 105 𝐹/𝑀
percent of its initial maximum value ans: a
a.37
b.63 49. The capacitance of a capacitor is ………
c.42 relative permittivity
d.73
ans:b
63. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
59. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm potential difference of 100V across its
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm
Determine the initial rate of rise of voltage resistor. Find discharging current at 2m Sec.
across the capacitor. a. - 0.0818A
a. 0.1V/s b. - 0.01A
b. 10V/s c. - 0.00818A
c. 0.01V/s d. - 1A
d. 1V/s ans:a
ans:b
64. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
60. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm potential difference of 100V across its
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm
Determine the capacitor voltage after a time resistor. Find initial rate of fall in voltage across
equal to the time constant. capacitor.
a.36V a. 10 4 V/s
b.36.6V b. -10 4 V/s
c.63.2V c. -1 4 V/s
d.63 V d. 10A
ans:c ans:b
61. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm 65. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. potential difference of 100V across its
Determine the voltage across the capacitor terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm
3sec. after switch on. resistor. Find time constant of the circuit.
a.25.92V a. 0.1sec
b.259.2V b. 1sec
c.2.592V c. 0.01sec
d.25V d. 0.001sec
ans:a ans:c
62. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a 66. A capacitor consists of two similar plates
potential difference of 100V across its each 10cm x 10cm mounted parallel and
terminals. It is discharged through 1 KΩ resistor. opposite to each other. What is the value of
Find Initial discharging current. capacitance when distance between them is
a.1A 1cm and dielectric used is air.
b.10A a. 8.854 pF
c.0.01A b. 8.854 µF
d.0.1A c. 8.854 mF
ans:d d. 8.854 F
ans: a
a. magnetic field
67. The capacitance of capacitor formed by two b. electric field
parallel plates each 200 cm2 in area separated c. magnetic field and electric field
by dielectric of 4mm thick is 0.0004µF. If d. neither magnetic field nor electric field
voltage of 20000 V is applied then the total ans: b
charge on the plate is
a. 8µC 72. One Farad is the same as
b. 8mC a. One Coulomb/Volt
c. 8nC b. One Joule/Coulomb
d. 8pC c. One Joule/Volt
ans: a d. One Coulomb /Joule
ans: a
68. A parallel plate capacitor has plate area of
2m2 spaced by three slabs of dielectric 73 . If Q be the charge and C be the capacitance
materials. The relative permittivity’s are 2,3 and then the energy stored in the capacitor is
6 respectively and thickness are 0.4mm, 0.6mm a. 1/2QC
and 0.12 mm respectively. Find the combined b. 1/QC
capacitance. c. Q2/2C
a. 0.000295 x 10-6 F d. Q/2C
b. 0.00295 x 10-6 F ans: c
c. 0.0295 x 10-6 F
d. 0. 295 x 10-6 F 74.What capacitance must be placed in series
ans: b with a 15µF capacitor to give a total capacitance
of 5µF
69. What is the unit of charge? a. 4µF
a. Volt-Amp b. 7.5µF
b. Henery c. 10µF
c. Farad d. 25µF
d. Coulomb ans: b
ans: d 75. One Coulomb charge equals the charge on
a. 6.42 x 10 18 electrons
70. What will be the capacitance of four b. 6.24 x 10 18 atoms
capacitors of equal capacitance ‘C’ when c 6.24 x 10 12electrons
connected in parallel d. none of these
a. 4C ans: a
b. C/4
c. 3C/4 76. The capacitance of parallel plate capacitor is
d. C given as
ans: a a. C = Є0 A / d
b. C = Є0 d / A
71. A region around a stationary electric charge
has
Unit II
Part (b) AC FUNDAMENTALS
b.282.6 V a. 150 V
c.400 V b. 216.5 V
d.565.5 V c. 125 V
ans:a d.108.25 V
ans:b
11. The form factor of a sine wave is_____
a.1.01 16. An alternating current is given by the
𝜋
b.1.11 expression 𝑖 = 200 sin(314𝑡 + ) amperes.
3
c.1.21 The maximum value and frequency of the
d. none of the above current are_________
ans:b a. 200 A, 50 Hz
b. 100√2, 50 Hz
12. A current is said to be alternating when it c. 200 A, 100 Hz
changes in_______ d. 200 A, 25 Hz
a. magnitude only ans:a
b. direction only
c. both magnitude and direction 17.The average value of the current 𝑖 =
d. neither magnitude nor direction 𝜋
200 sin 𝑡 from 𝑡 = 0 to 𝑡 = is ______
2
ans:c
a. 400 π
400
13. An alternating current of 50 Hz frequency b. 𝜋
1
and 100 A maximum value is given by______ c.400
a.𝑖 = 200 𝑠𝑖𝑛628𝑡 𝜋
d.400
b.𝑖 = 100 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
ans:b
c.𝑖 = 100√2 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
d.𝑖 = 100√2 𝑠𝑖𝑛157𝑡 18. When two quantities are in quadrature, the
ans:b phase angles between them will be________
a.45°
14. An alternating current of 50 Hz frequency b.90°
has a maximum value of 100 A. Its value 1/600 c.135°
second after the instant current is zero will d.60°
be________ ans:b
a. 25 A
b. 12.5 A 19.The alternating voltage 𝑒 = 200 sin 314𝑡 is
c. 50 A applied to a device which offers an ohmic
d. 75 A resistance of 20 Ω to the flow of current in one
ans:c direction while entirely preventing the flow in
the opposite direction. The average value of the
15.A sinusoidal voltage varies from zero to a current will be_________
maximum of 250 V. The voltage at the instant of a.5 A
60° of the cycle will be________ b.3.18 A
40.The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 45.The average value of sin2θ over a complete
10 A. Its peak value is_________ cycle is_________
a. 7.07 A a. +1
b. 14.14 A b. -1
1
c. 10 A c. 2
d. 28.28 A d. zero
ans:b ans:c
41. If A=10∠45° and B=5∠15°, then the value of 46.The average value of sinθ over a complete
A/B will be_________ cycle is_________
a. 50∠60° a. zero
b. 2∠60° b. +1
c. 2∠-30° c. -1
d. 2∠30° 1
d.
2
ans:d
ans:a
b. 30 Hz a. mean value
c. 40 Hz b. rms value
d. 50 HZ c. peak value
ans:d d. average value
ans:b
59. An ac current is given by 𝑖 = 200 𝑠𝑖𝑛100𝜋𝑡.
It will achieve a value of 100A 64. The rms value and mean value is the same
after_____second. in the case of_______
1 a. traingular wave
a.900
1 b. sine wave
b.
800 c. square wave
1
c. d. half wave rectified sine wave
700
1 ans:c
d.600
ans:d
65. For the same peak value which of the
following wave will have the highest rms value?
60. A heater is rated as 230V, 10KW, AC. The
a.square wave
value of 230V refers to___________
b.half wave rectified sine wave
a. average voltage
c.triangular wave
b. rms voltage
d.sine wave
c. peak voltage
ans:a
d. none of the above
ans:b
66. For the same peak value which of the
following wave will have the least mean value?
61. The peak value of a sine wave is 200V. Its
a. half wave rectified sine wave
average value is_______
b. triangular wave
a.127.4V
c. sine wave
b.141.4V
d. square wave
c.282.8V
ans:a
d.200V
ans:a
67. For a sine wave with peak value Imax, the rms
value is_______
62. The rms value of a sine wave is 100A. Its
a. 0.5Imax
peak value is _______
b. 0.707Imax
a.70.7A
c. 0.9Imax
b.141.4A
d. 1.414Imax
c.150A
ans:b
d.282.8A
ans:b
68. Form factor is the ratio of_________
a. average value/rms value
63. The voltage of domestic supply is 220V. This
b. average value/peak value
figure represents________
c. rms value/average value
68. For a sine wave with peak value Emax, the 73. A sine wave of voltage varies from zero to
average value is______ maximum of 200V. How much is the voltage at
a. 0.636 Emax the instant of 30° of the cycle?
b. 0.707Emax a.50V
c. 0.434 Emax b.82.8V
d. 1.414Emax c.100V
ans:a d.173.2V
ans:c
69. The current in a circuit is given by: 𝑖 =
100 sin 314𝑡 amperes. The maximum value and 74. How much rms current does a 300W, 200V
frequency of current are_________ bulb take from the 200V, 50 Hz power line?
a.50√2 A, 100 Hz a.0.5 A
b.100√2 A, 100 Hz b.1.5 A
c. 100 A, 50 Hz c.2 A
d. 70.7 A, 50 Hz d. 3 A
ans:c ans:b
70. For a frequency of 200 Hz, the time period 75. The rms value of a half-wave rectified
will be_________ current is 100 A. Its value for full-wave
a. 0.05 S rectification would be_________amperes.
b. 0.005 S a.141.4
c. 0.0005 S b.200
d. 0.5 S c. 200/π
ans:b d. 40/π
ans:a
71. An ac voltage of 50 Hz has a maximum value
of 50 V. Its value after 1/600 second after the 76. The rms value of a sinusoidal ac current is
instant the current is zero will be_________ equal to its value at an angle of ______degrees.
a.5V a.90
b.12.5V b.60
c.25V c.45
d.43.8V d.30
ans:c ans:c
72. For 200V rms value triangular wave, the 77. The rms value of alternating current is given
peak voltage will be______ by steady (dc) current which when flowing
a.200V through a given circuit for a given time
b.222V produces________
c.282V
86. An alternating voltage is given in volts by supplied 500 W output (i.e. no losses) at the
expression 𝑣 = 326 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. Its rms value and new voltage it will supply_________
frequency are____ a. 2500 W
a.230V,50 Hz b. 2000 W
b. 230V,100 Hz c. 500 W
c. 326V,50 Hz d. 250 W
d. 326V,100 Hz ans:b
ans:a
91. The direction of current in an ac
87. According to which of the alternating circuit________
current values in the cross sectional area of a a. is from positive to negative
conductor with regard to the heating effect is b. is always in one direction
selected? c. varies from instant to instant
a. peak value d. can not be determined
b. half peak value ans:c
c. average value
d. rms value 92. The angular frequency of an alternating
ans:d quantity is a mathematical quantity obtained by
multiplying the frequency “f” of the alternating
88. The frequency of an alternating current quantity by a factor_________
𝜋
is________ a.
2
a. the speed with which the alternator runs b.π
b. the number of cycles generated in one c.2π
minute d.4π
c. the number of waves passing through a point ans:c
in one second
d. the number of electrons passing through a 93. The average value of an unsymmetrical
point in one second alternating quantity is calculated over
ans:c the_________
a. whole cycle
89. The equation of 50 Hz current sine wave b. half cycle
having rms value of 60 A is______ c. unsymmetrical part of the waveform
a.60 sin 25𝑡 d. first two cycles
b.60 sin 50𝑡 ans:a
c.84.84 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
d42.42 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. 94. The mean value of the current 𝑖 = 20 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝜃
ans:c 𝜋
from θ=0 to θ=2 is_______
a.40π
90. An electric iron designed for 110 V AC 40
supply was rated at 500 W. It was put across a b. 𝜋
1
220 V supply. Assuming that at 110 V, it c.
40
𝜋
d.40 b. 10 A, 17.07 A
ans:b c. 10 A, 12.25 A
d. 16.36 A, 12.2 A
95. A constant current of 2.8A exists in a ans:c
resistor. The rms value of current is______
a. 2.8 A 100. The size (cross-sectional area) of a
b. about 2 A conductor, with regard to the heating effect, is
c. 1.4 A determined on the basis of ……….. value of
d. undefined current to be carried by it
ans:a a. average value
b. peak value
96. An alternating current is represented as 𝑖 = c. rms value
𝜋 d. peak to peak value
70.7 sin(520𝑡 + 6 ) . The frequency and rms
ans:c
value of the current are_________
a. 82.76 Hz, 50 A
101. The form factor for dc supply voltage is
b. 41.38 Hz, 25 A
always
c. 41.38 Hz, 50 A
a. zero
d. 82.76 Hz, 25 A
b. unity
ans:a
c. infinity
d. any value between 0 and 1
97. The time period or periodic time T of an
ans:b
alternating quantity is the time taken in seconds
to complete_____________
102. The ________ varying alternating quantity
a. one cycle
can be represented as phasor.
b. alternation
a) circular
c. none of the above
b) sinusoidally
d. Half cycle
c) rectangular
ans: a
d) triagular
ans:b
98. The time period of an alternating quantity is
0.02 second. Its frequency will be________
103. The phasors are assumed to be rotated in
a. 25 Hz
_________ direction.
b. 50 Hz
a) clockwise
c. 100 Hz
b) anticlockwise
d. 0.02 Hz
c) circular
ans: b
d) all above
ans:b
99. An ac current is given as i = 10 + 10 sin 314 t,
the average and rms values of the current
104. In practice, alternating quantities are
are____
represented by their _______ values
a. 16.36 A, 17.07 A
a. rms
b. average
c. rectangular
d. polar
ans:a
112. The difference between the phase of two 117. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt-Φ), the
alternating quantities is called the________. ‘v’ is said to _______ ‘i’ by angle Φ
a. phase difference a. in phase
b. sine difference b. lagging
c. length difference c. leading
d. none of the above d. all above
ans:a ans:c
113. When phase difference between the two 118. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ), the
alternating quantities is zero, the two quantities ‘i’ is said to _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ
are said to be in _____ a. in phase
a. tandom b. lagging
b. length c. leading
c. phase d. all above
d. time ans:c
ans:c
119. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ), the
114. When ____________ between the two ‘v’ is said to _______ ‘i’ by angle Φ
alternating quantities is zero, the two quantities a. in phase
are said to be in phase. b. lag
a. time difference c. lead
b. length difference d. all above
c. phase difference ans:b
d. none of the above
ans:c 120. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin ωt, the ‘i’ is
said to _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ
115. When phase difference between the two a. in phase
alternating quantities is _______, the two b. lag
quantities are said to be in phase. c. lead
a. one d. all above
b. unity ans:a
c. zero
d. π/2 121. With respect to reference, plus sign of
ans:c angle indicates _______
a. leading
116. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt-Φ), the ‘i’ b. lagging
is said to be _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ c. in phase
a. in phase d. none of the above
b. lagging ans:a
c. leading
d. all above 122. With respect to reference, minus sign of
ans:b angle indicates _______
126. The diagram in which different sinusoidal 131. Two currents I1 = 1050 and I2 = 5 -100 A
alternating quantities of the same _____, are flow in single phase AC circuit. Then I1+I2 =
represented by individual phasors indicating ________
exact phase relationship is called phasor a. 5.5596+ j4.924 A
diagram. b. 5.55964.924 A
a. time c. 7.296+ j12.58 A
b. frequency d. None of the above
c. sign ans:a
d. shape
ans:b
142.When a phasor is multiplied by j and –j, it is 147. In the complex number 4+j7, 7 is called the
rotated through ______ degrees in the ______ component
anticlockwise direction respectively. a. real
a.90, 270 b. imaginary
b.90, 90 c. in-phase
c.90, 180 d. none of the above`
d.270, 90 ans:d
ans:a
148. The reciprocal of a complex number is
143. If e1 = 100 sin2πf and e2 = 100 sin(2πf-Φ), a_____
then _____ a. complex number
a. e1 lags e2 by Φ b. real component only
b. e1 leads e2 by Φ c. quadrature component only
c. e2 lags e1 by Φ d. none of above
d. none of the above ans:a
ans:c
149. If two complex numbers are equal,
144.The phase difference between two then_____
waveforms can be compared when they _____ a. only their magnitudes will be equal
a. have the same frequency b. only their angles will be equal
b. have the same peak value c. their in phase and quadrature components
c. have the same effective value will be separately equal
d. are sinusoidal d.none of above
ans:a ans:c
145. If two sinusoids of the same frequency but 150. A phasor 2∟180 can be expressed as____
of different amplitude and phase difference are a.j2
added, the resultant is a ______ b.-j2
a. sinusoid of same frequency c.-2
b. sinusoid of double the original frequency d.2
c. sinusoid of half the original frequency ans:c
d. non-sinusoid
ans:a 151. A current of (3+j4) A is flowing through a
circuit. The magnitude of current is _____
146. If the phasor is multiplied by j, then ____ a. 7 A
a. only its magnitude changes b. 5 A
b. only its direction changes c. 1 A
c. both magnitude and direction change d. 1.33 A
d. none of the above ans:b
ans:b
152. The voltage applied in a circuit is given by
100∟60 volts. It can be written as ____
a. 100∟-60 b.50
b.100∟240 c.60
c. 100∟-300 d.105
d. none of the above ans:d
ans:c
158. A phasor is _____
153. The conjugate of -4+j3 is _____ a. a line which represents the magnitude and
a. 4-j3 phase of an alternating quantity
b. -4-j3 b. a line which represents the magnitude and
c.4+j3 direction of an alternating quantity
d. none of the above c. a colored tag or band for distinction between
ans:b different phases of a 3 phase supply
d. an instrument used for measuring phases of
154. The difference of two conjugate number an unbalanced 3 phase load
results in _____ ans:b
a. a complex number
b. in-phase component only 159. A sinusoidal voltage v1 leads another
c. quadrature component only sinusoidal voltagev2 by 180 degrees. Then ____
d. none of the above a. voltage v2 leads voltage v1 by 180 degrees
ans:c b. both voltage have their zero values at the
same time
155. The reciprocal of j is ____ c. both voltage have their peak values at the
a.j same time
b.-j d. all of above
c.jxj ans:d
d.none of the above
ans:b 160. If A = 10∟45 and B = 5∟15, then the
value of A/B will be___
156. Two waves of same frequency have a.50∟60
opposite phase when the phase angle between b.2∟60
them is ___ degrees c. 2∟-30
a.360 d.2∟30
b.180 ans:d
c.90
d.0 161. The length of a phasor in a phasor diagram
ans: b normally represents the ………… value of the
alternating quantity
157. Two sinusoidal currents are given by i1 = a. rms or effective
100sin (ωt+π/3) and i2 = 150sin(ωt-π/4). The b. average
phase difference between them is _____ c. peak
degrees d. none of these
a.15 ans:a
2. In a R-L-C circuit
a. Power is consumed in resistance and is equal to IR
b. Exchange of power takes place between inductor and supply line
c. Exchange of power takes place between capacitor and supply line
d. All above are correct
Answer: d
Answer: b
Answer: b
Answer: d
6. The product of apparent power and cosine of the phase angle between circuit voltage and current
is a. True power
b. Reactive power
c. Volt-amperes
d. Instantaneous power
Answer: a
Answer: a
Answer: c
Answer: d
10. A sine wave has a frequency of 50 Hz. Its angular frequency is _______
radian/second. a. 100 π
b. 50 jt
c. 25 JT
d. 5 π
Answer: a
11. The apparent power drawn by an A.C. circuit is 10 kVA and active power is 8 kW. The reactive power in the
circuit is
a. 4 kVAR
b. 6 kVAR
c. 8 kVAR
d. 16 kVAR
Answer: b
Answer: b
Answer: b
Answer: c
Answer: d
16. The impedance of circuit is given by 15.5∠-30 Ω. It means that the circuit is
a. capacitive
b. inductive
c. purely resistive
d. none of the above
Answer: c
17. In RLC series circuit, the inductive reactance is 10 Ω and capacitive reactance is 15 Ω. The total reactance of the
circuit is
a. 25 Ω
b. 18.03 Ω
c. 5 Ω
d. 1.5 Ω
Answer: c
18. In series RL circuit, R = 5 Ω, XL = 10 Ω and XC = 15 Ω. If this circuit is connected to a voltage source v = 100
sin (314t + 30) V, the rms value of the current will be
a. 14.14 A
b. 10 A
c. 5 A
d. 3.33 A
Answer : b
19. An alternating voltage of 80+j60 V is applied to a circuit and the current flowing is 4-j2 A. Find impedance of
circuit.
a. 22.37 Ω
b. 23.27 Ω
c. 21.88 Ω
d. 27.22 Ω
Answer: a
21. The voltage applied to a circuit is e =100 sin (ωt+30) and the current flowing in the circuit is i = 15 sin (ωt+60).
Determine impedance of the circuit.
a. 6.67 Ω
b. 5.57 Ω
c. 7.67 Ω
d. 1.67 Ω
Answer: a
22. The voltage applied to a circuit is e =100 sin (ωt+30) and the current flowing in the circuit is i = 15 sin (ωt+60).
Determine resistance of the circuit.
a. 6.67 Ω
b. 5.77 Ω
c. 7.67 Ω
d. 1.67 Ω
Answer: b
23. A resistor of 20 Ω, inductor of 0.005 H and capacitor of 50μF are connected in series. A supply voltage 230 V,
50 Hz is connected across the series combination. Calculate inductive reactance.
a. 16.67 Ω
b. 15.71 Ω
c. 17.67 Ω
d. 14.67 Ω
Answer: b
24. A resistor of 20 Ω, inductor of 0.005 H and capacitor of 50μF are connected in series. A supply voltage 230 V,
50 Hz is connected across the series combination. Calculate capacitive reactance.
a. 53.67 Ω
b. 55.71 Ω
c. 63.67 Ω
d. 57.67 Ω
Answer : c
25. Two impedances Z1 = 40∠30 and Z2 = 30∠60 are connected in series across a single phase 230 V, 50 Hz
supply. Calculate the current drawn
a. 4.3 A
b. 2.3 A
c. 3.4 A
d. 5.0 A
26. A coil having a impedance of 50.39∠7.16 is connected in parallel with capacitor having impedance of
127.32∠-90. If supply voltage is 200 V, single phase, 50 Hz. Calculate current in the coil. a. 4.47∠7.16 A
b. 5.57∠8.16 A
c. 4.97∠90 A
d. 3.97∠-7.16 A
Answer: d
26. A coil having a impedance of 50.39∠7.16 is connected in parallel with capacitor having impedance of
127.32∠-90. If supply voltage is 200 V, single phase, 50 Hz. Calculate current in the capactor. a. 4.47∠90 A
b. 5.57∠8.17 A
c. 4.97∠90 A
d. 1.57∠90 A
Answer: d
27. An impedance of (7+j5) Ω is connected in parallel with another impedance of (10-j8) Ω across a 230 V, 50
Hz supply. Calculate admittance of the circuit.
a. 0.16∠-7.04 mho
b. 0.16∠7.04 mho
c. -0.16∠7.04 mho
d. none of the above
Answer: b
Answer: c
Answer: a
30. A series RLC circuit has following parameter values: R = 10 Ω, L = 0.01 H and C = 100 μF. Calculate
resonant frequency.
a. 159.15 Hz
b. 169.15 Hz
a. 179.15 Hz
a. 150.15 Hz
Answer: a
Unit IV
Part (a) :SINGLE PHASE TRANSFORMER
1. A transformer is used to___________ d. Tapped
a. change ac voltage to dc voltage ans:b
b. change dc voltage to ac voltage
c. step up or step down dc voltages 6. If supply frequency of a transformer
d. step up or step down ac voltages increases, the secondary output voltage of the
ans: d transformer____
a. Decreases
2. The two windings of a transformer b. increases
are__________ c. remains same
a. conductively linked d. decreases slightly
b. inductively linked ans:b
c. not linked at all
d. electrically linked 7. The horizontal and vertical portions of
ans: b transformer magnetic core are called
as_________
3.The magnetically operated device that can a. Limb, yoke
change values of voltage, current, and b. Yoke, limb
impedance without changing frequency is c. Winding, Yoke
the____________ d. Winding, Limb
a. Motor ans:b
b. Generator
c. Transformer 8. The principle of working of transformer is
d. Transistor based on ________
ans:c a. Static induction
b. Mutual induction
4. The transformer winding across which the c. Dynamic induction
supply voltage applied is called the _____ d. Self induction
winding. ans:b
a. Primary
b. Secondary 9. Transformer is used to change values
c. Tertiary of__________
d. Tapped a. Frequency
ans:a b. Voltage
c. Power
5. The transformer winding which is connected d. Power factor
to the load is called the_______ winding. ans:b
a. Primary
b. Secondary 10. The path of the magnetic flux in transformer
c. Tertiary should have __________
13. The laminations of transformer core are 18. Silicon steel is used for transformer
made up from__________ core__________
a. Low carbon steel a. To reduce hysteresis loss
b. Silicon sheet steel b. To reduce eddy current loss
c. Nickel alloy steel stamping c. To reduce both losses
d. Chrome sheet steel d. None of these
ans:b ans:a
14.The material used for construction of 19. What is common in two windings of
transformer core should have___________ transformer?
a. Low permeability & high hysteresis loss a. Electric current
b. Low permeability & low hysteresis loss b. Magnetic circuit
c. High permeability & high hysteresis loss c. Winding wire guage
d. high permeability & low hysteresis loss d. None of these
ans:d ans:b
15. Most transformer cores are not made from 20. The main function of transformer iron core
a solid piece of metal. Instead, they are is to__________
assembled from many thin sheets of metal. This a. Provide strength to the winding
type of construction is called__________ b. To decrease hysteresis loss
a. Laminated c. Decrease the reluctance of magnetic path
21. The emf induced in the primary of a 26. Any transformer flux that does not follow
transformer___________ the core and escapes into the surrounding air is
a. is in phase with the flux called____
b. lags behind the flux by 90 degree a. magnetizing flux
c. leads the flux by 90 degree b. coupling flux
d. is in phase opposition to that of flux c. leakage flux
ans:b d. reactance flux
ans:c
22.The transformer turns ratio
determines_____________ 27. A transformer that does not isolate the
a. the ratio of primary and secondary voltages output from the input is called _____
b. the ratio of primary and secondary currents transformer
c. The resistance on other side a. Distribution
d. all of the above b. step-up
ans:a c. Auto
d. Control
23. Turns ratio of single phase transformer is ans:c
given as__________
a. N2/N1 28. Ideal transformer assumptions do not
b. N1/N2 include____________
c. (N1xN2)/N1 a. Zero reactance of the winding
d. (N1xN2)/N2 b. Zero resistance of the winding
ans:b c. No leakage flux
d. No saturation of the core
24. A transformer in which the secondary ans:a
voltage is more than the primary voltage is
called a _____ transformer 29.The efficiency of the transformer is normally
a. step-down is normally in the range of____________
b. step-up a. 50 to 70%
c. Isolation b. 60 to 75 %
d. Auto c. 80 to 90 %
ans:b d. 90 to 98%
ans:d
25. A transformer in which the primary voltage
is more than the secondary voltage is called a 30. The resistance of low voltage side of
_____ transformer. transformer________
a. step-down a. Is equal to resistance of its high voltage side
b. step-up b. Is more than its resistance on high voltage
c. Isolation side
41. The primary and secondary voltages in 46. Transformer oil is used in transformer to
transformer are___________ provide_______
a. Always in Phase a. Cooling and insulation
b. 1800 out of phase b. Cooling and lubrication
c. 900 out of phase c. Insulation and lubrication
d. 300 or 600 out of phase d. Insulation, cooling and lubrication
ans:b ans:a
42. The induced emf in transformer secondary 47. What is the typical use of
depends on__________ autotransformer____________?
a. Maximum flux in core a. Toy transformer
b. Frequency b. Control transformer
c. No of turns on secondary c. Variable transformer
d. all of the above d. Isolating transformer
ans:d ans:c
43. Transformer rating usually expressed 48. In any transformer the voltage per turn in
in____________ primary and secondary remains____________
a.kW a. Always different
b.kVA b. Always the same
c. kV c. Always in ratio of K
d. kWh d. Sometimes same
ans:b ans:b
44. In a transformer if secondary turns are 49. Full load copper loss in a transformer is 400
doubled, at the same time primary voltage is Watt. At half load, copper losses will
reduced by half, the secondary voltage be___________
will_________ a. 400 Watt
a. Be halved b. 100 Watt
b. Not change c. 200 Watt
c. Be four times d. 50 Watt
d. Be reduced to quarter ans:b
ans:b 50. A transformer is working with its maximum
45. The no load current in terms of full load efficiency. If the iron losses are 500 W, the
current is usually________ copper loss will__________
a. 1 to 3% a. 300 W
b. 3 to 9 % b. 350 W
c. 9 to 12% c. 250 W
d. 12 to 20% d. 500 W
ans:a ans:d
∅
c. 59. A transformer steps up voltage by a factor
∅
of 100. The ratio of current in the primary to
∅ that in secondary_______________
d.
∅
a.1
ans:a
b.100
c.0.01 ans:a
d.0.1
ans:b 65. Eddy current loss depends
on_____________
60. An ideal transformer does not a. both current and frequency
change______________ b. current alone
a. Voltage c. frequency alone
b. Power d. none of these
c. current ans:a
d. None of these
ans:b 66.The flux involved in EMF equation of a
transformer has______________
61. The flux in transformer core____________ a. RMS Value
a. increases with load b. Average Value
b. decreases with load c. Total Value
c. remains constant irrespective of load d. maximum Value
d. none of these ans:d
ans:c
67. A transformer has maximum efficiency at ¾
62. Efficiency of transformer is maximum of full load. The ratio of its iron loss and full load
when___________ copper loss is_________
a. transformer is unloaded a. 16/9
b. copper losses is equal to iron losses b. 4/3
c. eddy current losses are equal to hysteresis c. 3/4
losses d. 9/16
d. it is maximally loaded ans:d
ans:b
68. If primary of the transformer is connected
63. If the supply frequency in transformer is to dc supply, then______
doubled, then_________ a. Primary draws small current
a. hysteresis loss also doubles b. primary leakage reactance is increased
b. eddy current loss also doubles c. core losses are increased
c. iron losses doubles d. primary may burn out
d. copper losses doubles ans:d
ans:a
69. For an ideal transformer the windings
64. Hysteresis loss in transformer depends should have____________
on__________ a. maximum resistance on primary side and
a. both voltage and frequency least resistance on secondary side
b. voltage alone b. least resistance on primary side ans
c. frequency alone maximum resistance on secondary side
d. none of these
c. equal resistance on primary and secondary 74. In a given transformer for a given applied
side voltage, which losses remain constant
d. no ohmic resistance on either side irrespective of change in load___________
ans:d a. Friction and windage loss
b. copper loss
70. The full load copper and iron loss of a c. hysteresis and eddy current loss
transformer are 6400 W and 5000 W d. none of these
respectively. The copper loss and iron loss at ans:c
half load will be respectively______
a. 3200 W and 2500 W 75. Main advantage to use autotransformer
b. 3200 W and 5200 W over two winding transformer____________
c. 1600 W and 1250 W a. Hysteresis losses are reduced
d. 1600 W and 5000 W b. savings in winding material
ans:d c. copper losses are negligible
d. Eddy current losses are totally eliminated
71. A transformer does not raise or lower the ans:b
voltage of DC supply because________
a. there is no need to change the DC voltage 76. An ideal transformer is one which has
b. DC circuit has more losses _____________
c. Faradays law of Electromagnetic Induction a. no losses and magnetic leakage
are not valid since the rate of change of flux is b. interleaved primary and secondary winding
zero c. a common core for its primary and secondary
d. none of these d. core of stainless steel and winding of pure
ans:c copper material
ans:a
72. Primary winding of a transformer
_____________ 77. In a practical transformer core losses
a. is always low voltage winding remains constant from no load to full load
b. is always high voltage winding because__________
c. could either be a low or high voltage winding a. value of transformation ratio remains
d. none of these constant
ans:c b. permeability of transformer core remains
constant
73. Which winding of a transformer has more c. core flux remains practically constant
number of turns_______________ d. primary and secondary voltage remains
a. Low voltage winding constant
b. High voltage winding ans.c
c. Primary winding
d. secondary winding 78.The transformer laminations are insulated
ans:b from each other by_____________
a. mica strip
b. thin coat of varnish
c. fixed loss is high in proportion to the output effective cross sectional area of the core is 145
d. copper loss is small. cm2. The no of secondary turns___
ans:c a.71 turns
b.75 turns
107.A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase c.932 turns
transformer is built on a core having an d.923 turns
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 60 ans:a
turns on the secondary winding. The value of
maximum flux density___ 111. A 80 kVA, 6000 V/ 400 V, 50 Hz single
a.1.25 Tesla phase transformer has 80 turns on the
b.1.52 Tesla secondary winding. The value of maximum flux
c.1.3 Tesla in the core________
d.none of the above a.25.22mwb
ans:a b.22.52mwb
c.52.22mwb
108. A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase d. none of these
transformer is built on a core having an ans:b
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 60
turns on the secondary winding. The number of 112. A 6600 V/220 V, 50 Hz, step down single
turns on the high voltage winding________ phase transformer has 1500 turns on its
a. 600 turns primary side. If its maximum flux density is 1.2
b. 900 turns Tesla, then the effective cross sectional area of
c. 300 turns core is _____
d. 450 turns a.16.516 10–3 m2
ans:b b.61.516 10–3 m2
c.26.516 10–3 m2
109. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase d.62.516 10–3 m2
transformer has to be worked at a maximum ans:a
flux density of 1.1 wb/m2 in the core. The
effective cross sectional area of the core is 145 113. A 10 kVA, 3300/240 V, single phase, 50 Hz
transformer has a core area of 300 sq. cm. The
cm2. The no of primary turns___
flux density is 1.3 tesla. The primary full load
a. 930 turns
current is ___________
b. 950 turns
a. 3.03 amp
c. 932 turns
b. 33.03 amp
d. 923 turns
c. 30.3 amp
ans:c
d. 0.303 amp
ans:a
110. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase
transformer has to be worked at a maximum
114.A transformer is rated at 90 kVA, at full
flux density of 1.1 web/m2 in the core. The load its copper losses is 1100 W and its iron
losses is 950 W. The efficiency at full load for efficiency at 75% of full load and unity power
unity power factor is___________ factor__________
a. 99% a.98.13%
b.96% b.98.73%
c.97.77% c.99%
d. none of these d. none of these
ans:c ans:b
115. A transformer is rated at 90 kVA, at full 117: The no load voltage at the secondary
load its copper losses is 1100 W and its iron terminals of single phase transformer is
losses is 950 W. The efficiency at 60% of full observed as 230 volt. When the transformer is
load for 0.8 lagging power factor is___________ loaded, the voltage on secondary side has
a.96.97% reduced to 224 volt. Then the % regulation of
b.96% transformer for that loading is_______
c.98% a.2.6%
d. none of these b.2.67%
ans:a c.0%
d. none of these
116. A 500 kVA transformer has iron loss of 2 ans:a
kW and full load copper losses of 5 kW. The
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. If the effective value of the sinusoidal voltage is 111 Volts. Its average value is
A : 100 V
B : 123.21 V
C : 156.51 V
D : 78.48 V
A : increases
in
@
SP
B : decreases
P U
Q.no 3. From the following which is not the property of line of magnetic force ( Flux )
el
eg
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 4. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 150 Hz
A : nodal analysis
B : mesh analysis
A : meter / weber
B : Amp / meter
C : Tesla
D : weber / meter
A : linear curve
-T
el
eg
B : sinusoidal curve
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : exponential curve
D : parabolic curve
Q.no 9. When the supply frequency of transformer is doubled then the eddy current loss
A : remains same
B : is reduced by 50 percent
C : is doubled
Q.no 10. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 10 Amp
C : 5 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
A:1
B : 1.11
C : 1.41
D : 1.21
Q.no 12. In a three phase star connected system the phase difference between phase voltages and
their respetive line voltages is
A : 30 degrees
B : 120 degrees
Jo
in
C : 60 degrees
@
SP
D : 45 degrees
P U
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : Silicon steel
B : Copper
C : Manganin
D : Aluminium
A : increases
B : decreases
C : remaims constant
D : slightly increases
A : The type of material, the area of cross section and the length of the conductor
B : The area of cross section and the length of the conductor only
Q.no 17. Frequency of the primary and secondary parameters of the transformer
Q.no 18. In a transformer, which of the following windings has more number of turns ?
U
B
TE
A : Primary winding
C
H
B : Secondary winding
-T
el
eg
C : High-voltage winding
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 4/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 19. In superposition theorem, when we consider the effect of one current source, all the
other voltage sources are
A : removed
B : shorted
C : open circuited
D : connected
A : infinite
B : zero
C : high
D : low
Q.no 21. During charging or discharging of a capacitor, no current actually passes through the
A : connecting wires
B : battery
C : dielectric
D : circuit switch
A:Y/G
B:B/G
C:G/Y
Jo
in
D:B/Y
@
SP
Q.no 23. Which of the material has negative temperature coefficient of resistance
P U
A : copper
B
TE
C
B : aluminium
H
-T
C : silver
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 5/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : PVC
A : Purely inductive
B : Purely capacitive
C : Purely resistive
Q.no 25. For a fixed supply voltage, the current flowing through a conductor will decrease if
A : Load current
B : Leakage current
C : Leakage flux
D : Conventional current
Q.no 27. Electrical network having only resistances without energy sources is known as
________________
A : Passive network
B : active network
C : lateral network
Jo
in
D : source network
@
SP
A : Amp-turm
B
TE
C
B : Weber/turn
H
-T
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : Tesla
Q.no 30. The direction of induced emf in a rotating conductor in stationary magnetic field is
given by
Q.no 31. For better performance of a transformer , the voltage regulation must be
A : 1 percent
B : as high as possible
C : as low as possible
Q.no 32. EMF induced in a coil because of self / own changing flux cutting is known as
A : 3.6 J
B
TE
C
B : 3.6 kJ
H
-T
C : 3.6 MJ
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 3600 J
Q.no 34. If the frequency of power supply is 60 Hz , the time peroiod of one cycle will be
A : 0.02 sec
B : 20 msec
C : 16.67 msec
D : 0.1667 sec
A : Linear networks
B : Non-Linear networks
Q.no 36. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
C : Flux direction can be reversed but field strength can not be altered
Jo
Q.no 38. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
SP
P
A : Purely capacitive
U
B
TE
B : Inductive
C
H
C : Resistive
-T
el
eg
D : Purely inductive
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
A : store energy
B : dissipate energy
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
Jo
Q.no 43. Certain coil has 100 turns and is carrying 4 ampere current, MMF of the coil is
in
@
A : 100 amp-turn
SP
P
B : 400 amp-turn
U
B
TE
C : 25 amp-turm
C
H
D : 40 amp-turn
-T
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 44. For a three phase delta connected load , the line current is equal to ------------ times that
of its phase current.
A : 1.73
B : 1.42
C:2
D:3
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
Q.no 46. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature coefficient of the filament is
A : negative
B : zero
C : infinite
D : positive
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
Jo
D : 31.4 ohms
in
@
Q.no 48. A balanced star connected load is supplied from three phase 400 V 50 Hz system. Its
SP
phase voltage is
P U
A : 400 V
B
TE
C
B : 230.94 V
H
-T
C : 692.8 V
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 100 V
Q.no 50. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 51. A current of 2A flows through a 100 Ohm resistance for 10 hours. The energy consumed
is
A : 0.5 KWh
B : 4 KWh
C : 2 KWh
D : 0.02 KWh
Q.no 52. Which of the following lamps will have the least resistance at room temperature?
A : 25W, 220V
B : 100W, 220V
C : 200W, 220V
Jo
in
D : 60W, 220V
@
SP
Q.no 53. When Two coils are tightly coupled, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
P U
A : Greater than 1
B
TE
C
B : Less than 1
H
-T
C : Equal to 0.5
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : Equal to 1
Q.no 54. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 100 V
B : 141.4 V
C : 200 V
D : 90.21 V
Q.no 55. In a three phase balanced delta connected system all the phase currents are displaced
from each other by
A : 30 degrees
B : 45 degrees
C : 120 degrees
D : 60 degrees
Q.no 57. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
will be
A : three times
B : one third
Jo
C : two times
in
@
D : two third
SP
P
Q.no 58. When Two coils are magnetically isolated , then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
U
B
TE
A:0
C
H
B:1
-T
el
eg
C : less than 1
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 12/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 1.5
Q.no 59. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 60. If 03 equal resistances are connected in delta, their equivalent each STAR resistance will
be
A : one third
B : three times
C : two times
D : two third
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 13/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half cycle
is
A : r.m.s. value
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
Q.no 2. From the following which is not the property of line of magnetic force ( Flux )
Jo
in
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : infinite
B : zero
C : high
D : low
Q.no 6. If the current in an electric bulb drops by 2 percent, then the power developed reduces by
A : 1 percent
B : 2 percent
C : 4 percent
D : 16 percent
Q.no 7. If the frequency of power supply is 60 Hz , the time peroiod of one cycle will be
Jo
A : 0.02 sec
in
@
B : 20 msec
SP
P
C : 16.67 msec
U
B
TE
D : 0.1667 sec
C
H
A : nodal analysis
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : mesh analysis
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : iron
A : Resistance
B : Inductor
C : Capacitor
D : Diode
Q.no 12. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
Jo
B : Permittivity
in
@
C : Reluctance
SP
P
D : Capacitance
U
B
TE
Q.no 13. In a transformer, which of the following windings has more number of turns ?
C
H
A : Primary winding
-T
el
eg
B : Secondary winding
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 14. Which of the material has positive temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : mica
C : pvc
D : dry paper
Q.no 15. Current variation in the one coil causes voltage induced in the other nearby coil is
known as
Q.no 17. For a fixed supply voltage, the current flowing through a conductor will decrease if
A : Purely inductive
H
-T
B : Purely capacitive
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 4/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : Purely resistive
C : Directly proportional to the product of current in conductor and turns of the coil
D : Directly proportional to the ratio of current in conductor and turns of the coil
B : Hysteresis loss
C : Copper loss
D : Frictional loss
C : power transformers
D : distribution transformers
Q.no 22. If the active and apperent power of an a c circuit are equal in magnetude then its power
factor is
A : 0.5 lag
B : 0.707 lag
Jo
in
C : 0.8 lead
@
SP
D : unity
P U
A : increases
H
-T
B : decreases
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 5/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 24. A circuit content one or more sources of energy, then circuit is known as
A : passive
B : active
C : linear
D : non linear
Q.no 25. The phasor addition of all the phase voltages at any instant in three phase symmetrical
system is always
A:0
B:1
C : 120
D : 90
Q.no 26. For same rating , the size of three phase machine is ---------- to that of single phase
machine.
A : more
B : same
C : less
A : The type of material, the area of cross section and the length of the conductor
Jo
B : The area of cross section and the length of the conductor only
in
@
A : 1.57
-T
el
eg
B : 1.11
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 0.636
D : 1.414
Q.no 30. Every current carrying conductor placed in magnetic field will
A : Load current
B : Leakage current
Jo
C : Leakage flux
in
@
D : Conventional current
SP
P
A : meter / weber
C
H
B : Amp / meter
-T
el
eg
C : Tesla
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : weber / meter
Q.no 34. Which of the material has negative temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : PVC
A : Absolute permittivity
B : Relative permittivity
D : Absolute permeability
C : Flux direction can be reversed but field strength can not be altered
Q.no 37. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
A : 4 ohm
B : 12 ohm
C : 36 ohm
Jo
in
D : 6 ohm
@
SP
Q.no 38. A balanced star connected load is supplied from three phase 400 V 50 Hz system. Its
P
phase voltage is
U
B
TE
A : 400 V
C
H
B : 230.94 V
-T
el
eg
C : 692.8 V
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 100 V
Q.no 39. For a three phase delta connected load , the line current is equal to ------------ times that
of its phase current.
A : 1.73
B : 1.42
C:2
D:3
A : store energy
B : dissipate energy
Q.no 41. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in star, their equivalent each resistance
in delta will be--
A : 6 ohm
B : 36 ohm
C : 12 ohm
D : 2 ohm
Q.no 43. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
U
A : 1A
H
-T
B : 0A
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 0.5A
D : 2A
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
Q.no 46. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
Jo
C : 318.47 ohms
in
@
D : 31.4 ohms
SP
P
A : Current
C
H
B : voltag
-T
el
eg
C : frequency
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : power
Q.no 49. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
Q.no 50. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
C : 20A
D : 0A
Q.no 51. The total capacitance of four capacitors each of 10 mF connected in series is
A : 0.4 mF
B : 2.5 mF
C : 40 mF
D : 10 mF
Q.no 52. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
Jo
in
D : 28.28 Amp
@
SP
Q.no 53. A 10 mF, 20 mF, 25 mF, and 100 mF capacitor are in parallel. The total capacitance is
P U
A : 0.2 mF
B
TE
C
B : 5 mF
H
-T
C : 100 mF
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 155 mF
Q.no 54. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
C : 10
D : 13
Q.no 55. If 03 equal resistances are connected in delta, their equivalent each STAR resistance will
be
A : one third
B : three times
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 56. A current of 2A flows through a 100 Ohm resistance for 10 hours. The energy consumed
is
A : 0.5 KWh
B : 4 KWh
C : 2 KWh
D : 0.02 KWh
Q.no 57. Three 100 ohm resistances are connected in star across 400 V three phase supply. If one
of the resistances is disconnected then the line current is
A : 2 Amp
Jo
B : 4 Amp
in
@
C : 8 Amp
SP
P
D : 6.92 Amp
U
B
TE
Q.no 58. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
C
H
A : 100 V
-T
el
B : 141.4 V
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 12/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 200 V
D : 90.21 V
Q.no 60. A series R-L circuit has resistance of 6 ohms and reactance of 8 ohms. The impedance of
the circuit is
A : 10 ohms
B : 14 ohms
C : 2 ohms
D : 13.43 ohms
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 13/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in series, the equivalent resistance is--ohm
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
A : increases
in
@
SP
B : decreases
P U
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : power transformers
D : distribution transformers
Q.no 5. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in parallel, the equivalent resistance is
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
A : The type of material, the area of cross section and the length of the conductor
B : The area of cross section and the length of the conductor only
Q.no 7. Pure inductor connected to 200V, 50Hz 1 phase AC supply draws a current of 20A. what
will be the power consumed by it
A : 200 Watt
Jo
in
B : 0 Watt
@
SP
C : 4000 Watt
P U
D : 2000 Watt
B
TE
C
A : Irms / Iav
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : Iav / Irms
C : Im/Irms
D : Irms/Im
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : PVC
A : meter / weber
B : Amp / meter
C : Tesla
D : weber / meter
A : Amp-turm
B : Weber/turn
D : Tesla
B : frequency is constant
in
@
Q.no 13. Frequency of the primary and secondary parameters of the transformer
C
H
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A:1
B : 1.11
C : 1.41
D : 1.21
A : ohm
B : siemens
C : ampere
D : micro farad
Q.no 16. When the supply frequency of transformer is doubled then the eddy current loss
A : remains same
B : is reduced by 50 percent
C : is doubled
Q.no 17. EMF induced in a coil because of self / own changing flux cutting is known as
Q.no 18. In a transformer electrical power is transferred from one circuit to other without
U
change in the
B
TE
C
A : Voltage
H
-T
B : Current
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 4/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : Impedance
D : Frequency
Q.no 19. The value of Resistance Temperature Coefficient of material depends upon
Q.no 20. EMF induced in a conductor when magnetic field is stationary and conductor is moving
is known as
Q.no 21. The maximum flux produced in the core of the transformer is
A : infinite
H
-T
B : zero
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 5/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : high
D : low
A : nodal analysis
B : mesh analysis
A : Purely inductive
B : Purely capacitive
C : Purely resistive
Q.no 26. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half
cycle is
A : r.m.s. value
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
Q.no 27. If the frequency of power supply is 60 Hz , the time peroiod of one cycle will be
A : 0.02 sec
B : 20 msec
Jo
in
C : 16.67 msec
@
SP
D : 0.1667 sec
P U
Q.no 28. The direction of induced emf in a rotating conductor in stationary magnetic field is
B
TE
given by
C
H
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : Mesh
B : Branch
C : Path
D : Junction
A : iron loss
B : copper loss
Jo
D : no losses
SP
P
A : increases
C
H
B : decreases
-T
el
eg
C : remaims constant
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : slightly increases
A : 1.57
B : 1.11
C : 0.636
D : 1.414
Q.no 35. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 150 Hz
A : store energy
B : dissipate energy
A : mutual induction
B : self-induction
C : magnetic induction
Jo
D : electrostatic induction
in
@
Q.no 38. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
SP
P
A : Primary winding
U
B
TE
B : Secondary winding
C
H
C : High-voltage winding
-T
el
eg
D : Low-voltage winding
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
Q.no 40. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature coefficient of the filament is
A : negative
B : zero
C : infinite
D : positive
Q.no 41. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
A : 4 ohm
B : 12 ohm
C : 36 ohm
D : 6 ohm
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
Jo
D : 3600 J
in
@
Q.no 43. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
SP
P
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 44. When 40 resistances each of 40 ohms are connected in parallel, their equivalent
resistance will be--
A : 20 ohm
B : 8 ohm
C : 1 ohm
D : 40 ohm
Q.no 46. For a three phase star connected load , the relation between phase voltage and line
voltage is
Q.no 47. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
Jo
D : Purely inductive
in
@
Q.no 48. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in star, their equivalent each resistance
SP
A : 6 ohm
B
TE
C
B : 36 ohm
H
-T
C : 12 ohm
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 2 ohm
Q.no 49. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
C : 20A
D : 0A
Q.no 50. When Two coils are magnetically isolated, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to zero
Q.no 51. When Two coils are magnetically isolated , then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A:0
B:1
C : less than 1
D : 1.5
Q.no 52. A current of 2A flows through a 100 Ohm resistance for 10 hours. The energy consumed
is
A : 0.5 KWh
B : 4 KWh
Jo
C : 2 KWh
in
@
D : 0.02 KWh
SP
P
Q.no 53. The total capacitance of four capacitors each of 10 mF connected in series is
U
B
TE
A : 0.4 mF
C
H
B : 2.5 mF
-T
el
eg
C : 40 mF
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 10 mF
Q.no 54. What will be current drawn by a 1 kW electric heater if its resistance in fully heated
condition is 40 ohm?
A : 5A
B : 2.5 A
C : 10A
D : 1.25A
Q.no 55. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
will be
A : three times
B : one third
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 56. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
C : 10
D : 13
Q.no 57. Which of the following lamps will have the least resistance at room temperature?
A : 25W, 220V
B : 100W, 220V
Jo
in
C : 200W, 220V
@
SP
D : 60W, 220V
P U
Q.no 58. In a three phase balanced delta connected system all the phase currents are displaced
B
TE
A : 30 degrees
-T
el
B : 45 degrees
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 12/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 120 degrees
D : 60 degrees
Q.no 59. When Two coils are tightly coupled, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to 1
Q.no 60. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 13/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. During charging or discharging of a capacitor, no current actually passes through the
A : connecting wires
B : battery
C : dielectric
D : circuit switch
A : linear curve
in
@
SP
B : sinusoidal curve
P U
C : exponential curve
B
TE
D : parabolic curve
C
H
-T
Q.no 3. EMF induced in a conductor when magnetic field is stationary and conductor is moving
el
is known as
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A:Y/G
B:B/G
C:G/Y
D:B/Y
Q.no 5. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(377t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 314 Hz
Q.no 6. In an ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of
1A. Its terminal voltage will be
A : 11 V
B : 12 V
C : 12.5 V
D : 11.5 V
Q.no 7. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in series, the equivalent resistance is--ohm
Jo
in
A : zero
@
SP
B : 15
P U
C : 150
B
TE
C
D : 1.5
H
-T
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : very high
B : very low
C : zero
A : backelite
B : mica
C : cotton
D : copper
Q.no 10. In a transformer electrical power is transferred from one circuit to other without
change in the
A : Voltage
B : Current
C : Impedance
D : Frequency
Q.no 11. For parallel combination of capacitors, which of the following remains constant?
A : Flux
B : Charge
C : Current
D : Voltage
C : Directly proportional to the product of current in conductor and turns of the coil
B
TE
C
D : Directly proportional to the ratio of current in conductor and turns of the coil
H
-T
Q.no 13. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half
el
eg
cycle is
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : r.m.s. value
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
Q.no 14. When the supply frequency of transformer is doubled then the eddy current loss
A : remains same
B : is reduced by 50 percent
C : is doubled
Q.no 16. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
C : Reluctance
D : Capacitance
Q.no 17. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its Average value will be
Jo
A : 14.14 Amp
in
@
B : 10 Amp
SP
P
C : 9 Amp
U
B
TE
D : 7.07 Amp
C
H
A : infinite
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 4/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : zero
C : high
D : low
Q.no 20. For same rating , the size of three phase machine is ---------- to that of single phase
machine.
A : more
B : same
C : less
Q.no 21. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in parallel, the equivalent resistance is
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
A : 1.57
Jo
in
B : 1.11
@
SP
C : 0.636
P U
D : 1.414
B
TE
C
A : Reluctance
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 5/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : Resistance
C : Reactance
D : Impedance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : iron
Q.no 26. The maximum flux produced in the core of the transformer is
A : nodal analysis
Jo
B : mesh analysis
in
@
A : Resistance
-T
el
eg
B : Inductor
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : Capacitor
D : Diode
C : power transformers
D : distribution transformers
A : kilo amper
B : amper
C : milli amper
D : micro amper
A : Load current
B : Leakage current
C : Leakage flux
D : Conventional current
Q.no 32. If the voltage applied to a 250 W,250 V incandescent lamp is 250 V, then the current
flowing at the instant of switching would be
A : 1.25 A
A : infinite
H
-T
B : zero
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : high
D : low
Q.no 34. Pure inductor connected to 200V, 50Hz 1 phase AC supply draws a current of 20A. what
will be the power consumed by it
A : 200 Watt
B : 0 Watt
C : 4000 Watt
D : 2000 Watt
A : increases
B : decreases
C : remaims constant
D : slightly increases
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
D : 31.4 ohms
Q.no 37. When 40 resistances each of 40 ohms are connected in parallel, their equivalent
resistance will be--
A : 20 ohm
Jo
B : 8 ohm
in
@
C : 1 ohm
SP
P
D : 40 ohm
U
B
TE
Q.no 38. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
C
H
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
Q.no 40. A balanced star connected load is supplied from three phase 400 V 50 Hz system. Its
phase voltage is
A : 400 V
B : 230.94 V
C : 692.8 V
D : 100 V
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
C : Flux direction can be reversed but field strength can not be altered
@
SP
Q.no 43. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
B
TE
A : 4 ohm
-T
el
eg
B : 12 ohm
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 36 ohm
D : 6 ohm
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
Q.no 46. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
Q.no 47. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature coefficient of the filament is
A : negative
B : zero
Jo
in
C : infinite
@
SP
D : positive
P U
Q.no 48. When Two coils are magnetically isolated, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
B
TE
C
A : Greater than 1
H
-T
B : Less than 1
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to zero
Q.no 49. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
C : 20A
D : 0A
Q.no 50. The power factor of series R-L-C ac series circuit , at resonance is
A : unity
B : zero
C : 0.5 lagging
D : 0.5 leading
Q.no 51. What will be current drawn by a 1 kW electric heater if its resistance in fully heated
condition is 40 ohm?
A : 5A
B : 2.5 A
C : 10A
D : 1.25A
Q.no 52. Which of the following lamps will have the least resistance at room temperature?
A : 25W, 220V
Jo
B : 100W, 220V
in
@
C : 200W, 220V
SP
P
D : 60W, 220V
U
B
TE
Q.no 53. Three 100 ohm resistances are connected in star across 400 V three phase supply. If one
C
A : 2 Amp
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 4 Amp
C : 8 Amp
D : 6.92 Amp
Q.no 54. Soft iron electro-magnet has cross sectional area 10 square centimeter and has 0.6 mWb
flux, what will be the flux density in the core
A : 0.6 Tesla
B : 6 Tesla
C : 3 Wb/sq. meter
D : 0.06 Tesla
Q.no 55. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
will be
A : three times
B : one third
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 56. A current of 2A flows through a 100 Ohm resistance for 10 hours. The energy consumed
is
A : 0.5 KWh
B : 4 KWh
C : 2 KWh
D : 0.02 KWh
Q.no 57. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
Jo
in
A : 100 V
@
SP
B : 141.4 V
P U
C : 200 V
B
TE
C
D : 90.21 V
H
-T
Q.no 58. If 03 equal resistances are connected in delta, their equivalent each STAR resistance will
el
be
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 12/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : one third
B : three times
C : two times
D : two third
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 13/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. In a three phase star connected system the phase difference between phase voltages and
their respetive line voltages is
A : 30 degrees
B : 120 degrees
C : 60 degrees
D : 45 degrees
Q.no 2. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
Jo
in
A : 14.14 Amp
@
SP
B : 10 Amp
P U
B
C : 5 Amp
TE
C
H
D : 7.07 Amp
-T
el
Q.no 3. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
C : Reluctance
D : Capacitance
Q.no 4. A circuit content one or more sources of energy, then circuit is known as
A : passive
B : active
C : linear
D : non linear
Q.no 5. During charging or discharging of a capacitor, no current actually passes through the
A : connecting wires
B : battery
C : dielectric
D : circuit switch
Q.no 6. If the voltage applied to a 250 W,250 V incandescent lamp is 250 V, then the current
flowing at the instant of switching would be
A : 1.25 A
Q.no 7. In a transformer, which of the following windings has more number of turns ?
Jo
in
A : Primary winding
@
SP
B : Secondary winding
P U
C : High-voltage winding
B
TE
C
D : Low-voltage winding
H
-T
Q.no 8. The insulation resistance of a single core cable is inversely proportional to its
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : width
B : thickness
C : length
D : resistivity
A : increases
B : decreases
B : Hysteresis loss
C : Copper loss
D : Frictional loss
A : infinite
in
@
B : zero
SP
P
C : high
U
B
TE
D : low
C
H
A : linear curve
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : sinusoidal curve
C : exponential curve
D : parabolic curve
Q.no 14. Which of the material has negative temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : PVC
Q.no 15. If the current in an electric bulb drops by 2 percent, then the power developed reduces
by
A : 1 percent
B : 2 percent
C : 4 percent
D : 16 percent
Q.no 16. The phasor addition of all the phase voltages at any instant in three phase symmetrical
system is always
A:0
B:1
C : 120
D : 90
Q.no 17. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its frequency will be
Jo
A : 60 Hz
in
@
B : 50 Hz
SP
P
C : 100 Hz
U
B
TE
D : 150 Hz
C
H
Q.no 18. Electrical network having only resistances without energy sources is known as
-T
________________
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 4/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : Passive network
B : active network
C : lateral network
D : source network
A : increases
B : decreases
C : remaims constant
D : slightly increases
A : Absolute permittivity
B : Relative permittivity
D : Absolute permeability
Q.no 22. In a transformer electrical power is transferred from one circuit to other without
change in the
Jo
in
A : Voltage
@
SP
B : Current
P U
C : Impedance
B
TE
C
D : Frequency
H
-T
Q.no 23. Which of the material has almost zero temperature coefficient of resistance
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 5/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : Nichrome
A : Silicon steel
B : Copper
C : Manganin
D : Aluminium
A : ohm
B : siemens
C : ampere
D : micro farad
A : Load current
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : Leakage current
C : Leakage flux
D : Conventional current
Q.no 29. For a fixed supply voltage, the current flowing through a conductor will decrease if
Q.no 30. For same rating , the size of three phase machine is ---------- to that of single phase
machine.
A : more
B : same
C : less
Q.no 31. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(377t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 314 Hz
Q.no 32. For better performance of a transformer , the voltage regulation must be
A : 1 percent
Jo
in
B : as high as possible
@
SP
C : as low as possible
P U
Q.no 33. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half
H
cycle is
-T
el
eg
A : r.m.s. value
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
A : Resistance
B : Inductor
C : Capacitor
D : Diode
Q.no 35. EMF induced in a coil because of self / own changing flux cutting is known as
Q.no 37. For a three phase star connected load , the relation between phase voltage and line
voltage is
A : store energy
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : dissipate energy
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
Q.no 40. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If value of resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 1A
B : 0A
C : 0.5A
D : 2A
C : Flux direction can be reversed but field strength can not be altered
Q.no 42. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
Jo
A : 4 ohm
in
@
B : 12 ohm
SP
P
C : 36 ohm
U
B
TE
D : 6 ohm
C
H
Q.no 43. The power factor of series R-L-C ac series circuit , at resonance is
-T
el
eg
A : unity
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : zero
C : 0.5 lagging
D : 0.5 leading
Q.no 44. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
C : 20A
D : 0A
A : mutual induction
B : self-induction
C : magnetic induction
D : electrostatic induction
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
Q.no 47. When Two coils are magnetically isolated, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
Jo
in
B : Less than 1
@
SP
C : Equal to 0.5
P U
D : Equal to zero
B
TE
C
Q.no 48. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
H
A : negative
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : zero
C : infinite
D : positive
Q.no 49. When 40 resistances each of 40 ohms are connected in parallel, their equivalent
resistance will be--
A : 20 ohm
B : 8 ohm
C : 1 ohm
D : 40 ohm
Q.no 50. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 52. When Two coils are tightly coupled, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
Jo
in
B : Less than 1
@
SP
C : Equal to 0.5
P U
D : Equal to 1
B
TE
C
Q.no 53. In a three phase balanced delta connected system all the phase currents are displaced
H
A : 30 degrees
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 45 degrees
C : 120 degrees
D : 60 degrees
Q.no 54. Soft iron electro-magnet has cross sectional area 10 square centimeter and has 0.6 mWb
flux, what will be the flux density in the core
A : 0.6 Tesla
B : 6 Tesla
C : 3 Wb/sq. meter
D : 0.06 Tesla
Q.no 55. Three 100 ohm resistances are connected in star across 400 V three phase supply. If one
of the resistances is disconnected then the line current is
A : 2 Amp
B : 4 Amp
C : 8 Amp
D : 6.92 Amp
Q.no 56. A 10 mF, 20 mF, 25 mF, and 100 mF capacitor are in parallel. The total capacitance is
A : 0.2 mF
B : 5 mF
C : 100 mF
D : 155 mF
Q.no 58. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
-T
el
eg
A : 14.14 Amp
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 12/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 59. A current of 2A flows through a 100 Ohm resistance for 10 hours. The energy consumed
is
A : 0.5 KWh
B : 4 KWh
C : 2 KWh
D : 0.02 KWh
Q.no 60. A series R-L circuit has resistance of 6 ohms and reactance of 8 ohms. The impedance of
the circuit is
A : 10 ohms
B : 14 ohms
C : 2 ohms
D : 13.43 ohms
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 13/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
A : 3.6 J
B : 3.6 kJ
C : 3.6 MJ
D : 3600 J
Q.no 2. The insulation resistance of a single core cable is inversely proportional to its
Jo
A : width
in
@
SP
B : thickness
P U
C : length
B
TE
D : resistivity
C
H
-T
A : Load current
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : Leakage current
C : Leakage flux
D : Conventional current
Q.no 4. Current variation in the one coil causes voltage induced in the other nearby coil is known
as
Q.no 5. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in parallel, the equivalent resistance is
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
Q.no 6. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
C : Reluctance
D : Capacitance
Q.no 7. From the following which is not the property of line of magnetic force ( Flux )
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : Silicon steel
B : Copper
C : Manganin
D : Aluminium
Q.no 10. In superposition theorem, when we consider the effect of one current source, all the
other voltage sources are
A : removed
B : shorted
C : open circuited
D : connected
A : ohm
B : siemens
C : ampere
D : micro farad
Q.no 12. Which of the material has positive temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
Jo
in
B : mica
@
SP
C : pvc
P U
D : dry paper
B
TE
C
Q.no 13. If the current in an electric bulb drops by 2 percent, then the power developed reduces
H
by
-T
el
eg
A : 1 percent
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 2 percent
C : 4 percent
D : 16 percent
Q.no 14. The value of Resistance Temperature Coefficient of material depends upon
A : mesh analysis,
B : nodal analysis
Q.no 16. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its average value will be
A : 90.21 V
B : 99.23 V
C : 100 V
D : 141.4 V
Q.no 17. The phasor addition of all the phase voltages at any instant in three phase symmetrical
system is always
A:0
Jo
in
B:1
@
SP
C : 120
P U
D : 90
B
TE
C
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 4/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : kilo amper
B : amper
C : milli amper
D : micro amper
A : meter / weber
B : Amp / meter
C : Tesla
D : weber / meter
Q.no 21. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 10 Amp
C : 5 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
Q.no 22. Electrical network having only resistances without energy sources is known as
________________
A : Passive network
Jo
in
B : active network
@
SP
C : lateral network
P U
D : source network
B
TE
C
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 5/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : frequency is constant
A : increases
B : decreases
C : remaims constant
D : slightly increases
Q.no 25. 100 micro farad capacitor on 50Hz supply offers capacitive reactance
A : 21.33 ohms
B : 3.18 47 ohms
C : 15.92 ohms
D : 31.847 ohms
C : Directly proportional to the product of current in conductor and turns of the coil
D : Directly proportional to the ratio of current in conductor and turns of the coil
A:1
Jo
B : 1.11
in
@
C : 1.41
SP
P
D : 1.21
U
B
TE
Q.no 28. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its Average value will be
C
H
A : 14.14 Amp
-T
el
eg
B : 10 Amp
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 9 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
A : Absolute permittivity
B : Relative permittivity
D : Absolute permeability
A:Y/G
B:B/G
C:G/Y
D:B/Y
Q.no 31. If the frequency of power supply is 60 Hz , the time peroiod of one cycle will be
A : 0.02 sec
B : 20 msec
C : 16.67 msec
D : 0.1667 sec
Q.no 33. In a three phase star connected system the phase difference between phase voltages and
U
A : 30 degrees
H
-T
B : 120 degrees
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 60 degrees
D : 45 degrees
Q.no 34. Every current carrying conductor placed in magnetic field will
A : The type of material, the area of cross section and the length of the conductor
B : The area of cross section and the length of the conductor only
Q.no 37. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If value of resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 1A
B : 0A
Jo
in
C : 0.5A
@
SP
D : 2A
P U
Q.no 38. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
B
TE
C
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 39. When 40 resistances each of 40 ohms are connected in parallel, their equivalent
resistance will be--
A : 20 ohm
B : 8 ohm
C : 1 ohm
D : 40 ohm
Q.no 40. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
A : 4 ohm
B : 12 ohm
C : 36 ohm
D : 6 ohm
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
Q.no 43. When Two coils are magnetically isolated, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
C
H
A : Greater than 1
-T
el
eg
B : Less than 1
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to zero
Q.no 44. The power factor of series R-L-C ac series circuit , at resonance is
A : unity
B : zero
C : 0.5 lagging
D : 0.5 leading
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
Q.no 47. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
Jo
in
C : 20A
@
SP
D : 0A
P U
Q.no 48. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
B
TE
C
A : Purely capacitive
H
-T
B : Inductive
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
Q.no 49. Certain coil has 100 turns and is carrying 4 ampere current, MMF of the coil is
A : 100 amp-turn
B : 400 amp-turn
C : 25 amp-turm
D : 40 amp-turn
Q.no 50. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 51. A series R-L circuit has resistance of 6 ohms and reactance of 8 ohms. The impedance of
the circuit is
A : 10 ohms
B : 14 ohms
C : 2 ohms
D : 13.43 ohms
Q.no 52. When Two coils are tightly coupled, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
Jo
in
C : Equal to 0.5
@
SP
D : Equal to 1
P U
Q.no 53. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
B
TE
A:6
-T
el
eg
B : 12
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 10
D : 13
Q.no 55. If 03 equal resistances are connected in delta, their equivalent each STAR resistance will
be
A : one third
B : three times
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 56. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
will be
A : three times
B : one third
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 57. When Two coils are magnetically isolated , then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A:0
Jo
B:1
in
@
C : less than 1
SP
P
D : 1.5
U
B
TE
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 12/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 59. Which of the following lamps will have the least resistance at room temperature?
A : 25W, 220V
B : 100W, 220V
C : 200W, 220V
D : 60W, 220V
Q.no 60. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 13/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. From the following which is not the property of line of magnetic force ( Flux )
A : 1 percent
in
@
SP
B : as high as possible
P U
C : as low as possible
B
TE
A : ohm
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : siemens
C : ampere
D : micro farad
A : Purely inductive
B : Purely capacitive
C : Purely resistive
B : frequency is constant
Q.no 6. The rms value of sinusoidal alternating current is given by the relation
Q.no 7. The phasor addition of all the phase voltages at any instant in three phase symmetrical
system is always
A:0
Jo
in
B:1
@
SP
C : 120
P U
D : 90
B
TE
C
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 9. Which of the material has almost zero temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : Nichrome
A:1
B : 1.11
C : 1.41
D : 1.21
A : Amp-turm
B : Weber/turn
D : Tesla
Q.no 12. EMF induced in a coil because of self / own changing flux cutting is known as
Q.no 13. During charging or discharging of a capacitor, no current actually passes through the
C
H
A : connecting wires
-T
el
eg
B : battery
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : dielectric
D : circuit switch
Q.no 15. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half
cycle is
A : r.m.s. value
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
C : Directly proportional to the product of current in conductor and turns of the coil
D : Directly proportional to the ratio of current in conductor and turns of the coil
Q.no 17. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
Jo
in
C : Reluctance
@
SP
D : Capacitance
P U
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 4/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 19. Frequency of the primary and secondary parameters of the transformer
A : infinite
B : zero
C : high
D : low
Q.no 21. If the voltage applied to a 250 W,250 V incandescent lamp is 250 V, then the current
flowing at the instant of switching would be
A : 1.25 A
A : mesh analysis,
B : nodal analysis
Jo
in
A : kilo amper
H
-T
B : amper
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 5/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : milli amper
D : micro amper
Q.no 24. In superposition theorem, when we consider the effect of one current source, all the
other voltage sources are
A : removed
B : shorted
C : open circuited
D : connected
Q.no 26. In a transformer electrical power is transferred from one circuit to other without
change in the
A : Voltage
B : Current
C : Impedance
D : Frequency
Q.no 28. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its average value will be
C
H
A : 90.21 V
-T
el
eg
B : 99.23 V
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 100 V
D : 141.4 V
Q.no 29. If the active and apperent power of an a c circuit are equal in magnetude then its power
factor is
A : 0.5 lag
B : 0.707 lag
C : 0.8 lead
D : unity
A : meter / weber
B : Amp / meter
C : Tesla
D : weber / meter
A : Linear networks
B : Non-Linear networks
Jo
in
Q.no 33. Which of the material has negative temperature coefficient of resistance
B
TE
C
A : copper
H
-T
B : aluminium
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : silver
D : PVC
Q.no 34. Electrical network having only resistances without energy sources is known as
________________
A : Passive network
B : active network
C : lateral network
D : source network
A : iron loss
B : copper loss
D : no losses
Q.no 36. A balanced star connected load is supplied from three phase 400 V 50 Hz system. Its
phase voltage is
A : 400 V
B : 230.94 V
C : 692.8 V
D : 100 V
A : 3.6 MJ
Jo
B : 36 kJ
in
@
C : 360 J
SP
P
D : 3600 J
U
B
TE
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 39. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 40. For a three phase star connected load , the relation between phase voltage and line
voltage is
Q.no 41. Certain coil has 100 turns and is carrying 4 ampere current, MMF of the coil is
A : 100 amp-turn
B : 400 amp-turn
C : 25 amp-turm
D : 40 amp-turn
A : Current
B : voltag
Jo
in
C : frequency
@
SP
D : power
P U
Q.no 43. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
B
TE
A : negative
-T
el
eg
B : zero
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : infinite
D : positive
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
D : 31.4 ohms
Q.no 45. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in star, their equivalent each resistance
in delta will be--
A : 6 ohm
B : 36 ohm
C : 12 ohm
D : 2 ohm
A : mutual induction
B : self-induction
Jo
in
C : magnetic induction
@
SP
D : electrostatic induction
P U
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : Flux direction can be reversed but field strength can not be altered
Q.no 49. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
Q.no 50. When Two coils are magnetically isolated, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to zero
Q.no 51. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
C : 10
D : 13
Q.no 53. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
B
TE
will be
C
H
A : three times
-T
el
eg
B : one third
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 54. A series R-L circuit has resistance of 6 ohms and reactance of 8 ohms. The impedance of
the circuit is
A : 10 ohms
B : 14 ohms
C : 2 ohms
D : 13.43 ohms
Q.no 55. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 100 V
B : 141.4 V
C : 200 V
D : 90.21 V
Q.no 56. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 57. A 10 mF, 20 mF, 25 mF, and 100 mF capacitor are in parallel. The total capacitance is
A : 0.2 mF
B : 5 mF
Jo
in
C : 100 mF
@
SP
D : 155 mF
P U
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 12/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 59. Which of the following lamps will have the least resistance at room temperature?
A : 25W, 220V
B : 100W, 220V
C : 200W, 220V
D : 60W, 220V
Q.no 60. If 03 equal resistances are connected in delta, their equivalent each STAR resistance will
be
A : one third
B : three times
C : two times
D : two third
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 13/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its Average value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 10 Amp
C : 9 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
B : Hysteresis loss
P U
C : Copper loss
B
TE
D : Frictional loss
C
H
-T
A : Amp-turm
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : Weber/turn
D : Tesla
Q.no 6. A circuit content one or more sources of energy, then circuit is known as
A : passive
B : active
C : linear
D : non linear
A : nodal analysis
Jo
B : mesh analysis
in
@
Q.no 8. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its frequency will be
C
H
A : 60 Hz
-T
el
eg
B : 50 Hz
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 100 Hz
D : 150 Hz
A : Absolute permittivity
B : Relative permittivity
D : Absolute permeability
A : Silicon steel
B : Copper
C : Manganin
D : Aluminium
A : increases
B : decreases
Q.no 13. Current variation in the one coil causes voltage induced in the other nearby coil is
U
known as
B
TE
C
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 14. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its average value will be
A : 90.21 V
B : 99.23 V
C : 100 V
D : 141.4 V
A:X/R
B:R/X
C:R/Z
D:Z/R
Q.no 16. In a three phase star connected system the phase difference between phase voltages and
their respetive line voltages is
A : 30 degrees
B : 120 degrees
C : 60 degrees
D : 45 degrees
Q.no 17. In superposition theorem, when we consider the effect of one current source, all the
other voltage sources are
A : removed
Jo
B : shorted
in
@
C : open circuited
SP
P
D : connected
U
B
TE
Q.no 18. The phasor addition of all the phase voltages at any instant in three phase symmetrical
C
system is always
H
-T
A:0
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 4/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B:1
C : 120
D : 90
A : increases
B : decreases
C : remaims constant
D : slightly increases
Q.no 20. For parallel combination of capacitors, which of the following remains constant?
A : Flux
B : Charge
C : Current
D : Voltage
Q.no 21. The value of Resistance Temperature Coefficient of material depends upon
A : 1.57
Jo
B : 1.11
in
@
C : 0.636
SP
P
D : 1.414
U
B
TE
A : linear curve
-T
el
eg
B : sinusoidal curve
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 5/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : exponential curve
D : parabolic curve
A : infinite
B : zero
C : high
D : low
Q.no 25. 100 micro farad capacitor on 50Hz supply offers capacitive reactance
A : 21.33 ohms
B : 3.18 47 ohms
C : 15.92 ohms
D : 31.847 ohms
A : iron loss
B : copper loss
Jo
D : no losses
SP
P
A : Linear networks
C
H
B : Non-Linear networks
-T
el
eg
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 29. If the current in an electric bulb drops by 2 percent, then the power developed reduces
by
A : 1 percent
B : 2 percent
C : 4 percent
D : 16 percent
A : Mesh
B : Branch
C : Path
D : Junction
Q.no 31. For a fixed supply voltage, the current flowing through a conductor will decrease if
A : meter / weber
B : Amp / meter
C : Tesla
Jo
in
D : weber / meter
@
SP
Q.no 33. In a transformer electrical power is transferred from one circuit to other without
P
change in the
U
B
TE
A : Voltage
C
H
B : Current
-T
el
eg
C : Impedance
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : Frequency
A : mesh analysis,
B : nodal analysis
Q.no 35. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(377t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 314 Hz
Q.no 36. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
Jo
D : 31.4 ohms
in
@
A : 3.6 MJ
U
B
TE
B : 36 kJ
C
H
C : 360 J
-T
el
eg
D : 3600 J
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 39. For a three phase star connected load , the relation between phase voltage and line
voltage is
Q.no 40. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature coefficient of the filament is
A : negative
B : zero
C : infinite
D : positive
Q.no 41. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in star, their equivalent each resistance
in delta will be--
A : 6 ohm
B : 36 ohm
C : 12 ohm
D : 2 ohm
A : mutual induction
B : self-induction
C : magnetic induction
Jo
in
D : electrostatic induction
@
SP
Q.no 43. Certain coil has 100 turns and is carrying 4 ampere current, MMF of the coil is
P U
A : 100 amp-turn
B
TE
C
B : 400 amp-turn
H
-T
C : 25 amp-turm
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 40 amp-turn
Q.no 44. For a three phase delta connected load , the line current is equal to ------------ times that
of its phase current.
A : 1.73
B : 1.42
C:2
D:3
Q.no 45. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
Q.no 47. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If value of resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 1A
B : 0A
Jo
C : 0.5A
in
@
D : 2A
SP
P
Q.no 48. When Two coils are magnetically isolated, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
U
B
TE
A : Greater than 1
C
H
B : Less than 1
-T
el
eg
C : Equal to 0.5
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : Equal to zero
Q.no 49. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
A : store energy
B : dissipate energy
Q.no 51. A current of 2A flows through a 100 Ohm resistance for 10 hours. The energy consumed
is
A : 0.5 KWh
B : 4 KWh
C : 2 KWh
D : 0.02 KWh
Q.no 52. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
will be
A : three times
B : one third
Jo
C : two times
in
@
D : two third
SP
P
Q.no 53. When Two coils are magnetically isolated , then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
U
B
TE
A:0
C
H
B:1
-T
el
eg
C : less than 1
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 1.5
Q.no 54. Soft iron electro-magnet has cross sectional area 10 square centimeter and has 0.6 mWb
flux, what will be the flux density in the core
A : 0.6 Tesla
B : 6 Tesla
C : 3 Wb/sq. meter
D : 0.06 Tesla
Q.no 55. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
C : 10
D : 13
Q.no 56. A 10 mF, 20 mF, 25 mF, and 100 mF capacitor are in parallel. The total capacitance is
A : 0.2 mF
B : 5 mF
C : 100 mF
D : 155 mF
Q.no 57. Which of the following lamps will have the least resistance at room temperature?
A : 25W, 220V
B : 100W, 220V
Jo
C : 200W, 220V
in
@
D : 60W, 220V
SP
P
Q.no 58. What will be current drawn by a 1 kW electric heater if its resistance in fully heated
U
condition is 40 ohm?
B
TE
C
A : 5A
H
-T
B : 2.5 A
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 12/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 10A
D : 1.25A
Q.no 59. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 60. If 03 equal resistances are connected in delta, their equivalent each STAR resistance will
be
A : one third
B : three times
C : two times
D : two third
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 13/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
C : power transformers
D : distribution transformers
A : Mesh
in
@
SP
B : Branch
P U
C : Path
B
TE
D : Junction
C
H
-T
Q.no 3. From the following which is not the property of line of magnetic force ( Flux )
el
eg
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : copper
B : mica
C : pvc
D : dry paper
Q.no 5. The direction of induced emf in a rotating conductor in stationary magnetic field is given
by
Q.no 6. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 150 Hz
B : Hysteresis loss
@
SP
C : Copper loss
P U
D : Frictional loss
B
TE
C
Q.no 8. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(377t) Volt, its frequency will be
H
-T
A : 60 Hz
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 314 Hz
Q.no 9. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 10 Amp
C : 5 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
A:X/R
B:R/X
C:R/Z
D:Z/R
Q.no 11. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half
cycle is
A : r.m.s. value
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
C : Directly proportional to the product of current in conductor and turns of the coil
P U
D : Directly proportional to the ratio of current in conductor and turns of the coil
B
TE
C
Q.no 13. In a three phase star connected system the phase difference between phase voltages and
H
A : 30 degrees
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 120 degrees
C : 60 degrees
D : 45 degrees
Q.no 14. The rms value of sinusoidal alternating current is given by the relation
A : kilo amper
B : amper
C : milli amper
D : micro amper
Q.no 16. EMF induced in a conductor when magnetic field is stationary and conductor is moving
is known as
Q.no 17. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in series, the equivalent resistance is--
ohm
Jo
A : zero
in
@
B : 15
SP
P
C : 150
U
B
TE
D : 1.5
C
H
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 4/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : nodal analysis
B : mesh analysis
A : Reluctance
B : Resistance
C : Reactance
D : Impedance
Q.no 21. The phasor addition of all the phase voltages at any instant in three phase symmetrical
system is always
A:0
B:1
C : 120
D : 90
Q.no 22. Frequency of the primary and secondary parameters of the transformer
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 5/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : Amp-turm
B : Weber/turn
D : Tesla
Q.no 25. A circuit content one or more sources of energy, then circuit is known as
A : passive
B : active
C : linear
D : non linear
Q.no 26. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its average value will be
A : 90.21 V
B : 99.23 V
C : 100 V
D : 141.4 V
Q.no 27. The insulation resistance of a single core cable is inversely proportional to its
A : width
Jo
B : thickness
in
@
C : length
SP
P
D : resistivity
U
B
TE
Q.no 28. For same rating , the size of three phase machine is ---------- to that of single phase
C
machine.
H
-T
A : more
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : same
C : less
A : backelite
B : mica
C : cotton
D : copper
Q.no 30. During charging or discharging of a capacitor, no current actually passes through the
A : connecting wires
B : battery
C : dielectric
D : circuit switch
Q.no 31. Which of the material has negative temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : PVC
Q.no 32. In an ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of
1A. Its terminal voltage will be
A : 11 V
Jo
in
B : 12 V
@
SP
C : 12.5 V
P U
D : 11.5 V
B
TE
C
A : Irms / Iav
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : Iav / Irms
C : Im/Irms
D : Irms/Im
Q.no 35. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
C : Reluctance
D : Capacitance
Q.no 36. For a three phase delta connected load , the line current is equal to ------------ times that
of its phase current.
A : 1.73
B : 1.42
C:2
D:3
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : Flux direction can be reversed but field strength can not be altered
Q.no 40. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
A : 4 ohm
B : 12 ohm
C : 36 ohm
D : 6 ohm
Q.no 41. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
Q.no 42. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If value of resistance is doubled then current is _____
Jo
A : 1A
in
@
B : 0A
SP
P
C : 0.5A
U
B
TE
D : 2A
C
H
Q.no 43. Certain coil has 100 turns and is carrying 4 ampere current, MMF of the coil is
-T
el
eg
A : 100 amp-turn
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 400 amp-turn
C : 25 amp-turm
D : 40 amp-turn
Q.no 44. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature coefficient of the filament is
A : negative
B : zero
C : infinite
D : positive
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
A : mutual induction
Jo
in
B : self-induction
@
SP
C : magnetic induction
P U
D : electrostatic induction
B
TE
C
A : 37.680 ohms
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
D : 31.4 ohms
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
Q.no 50. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
C : 20A
D : 0A
Q.no 51. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 52. A 10 mF, 20 mF, 25 mF, and 100 mF capacitor are in parallel. The total capacitance is
A : 0.2 mF
Jo
in
B : 5 mF
@
SP
C : 100 mF
P U
D : 155 mF
B
TE
C
Q.no 53. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
H
will be
-T
el
eg
A : three times
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : one third
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 54. When Two coils are tightly coupled, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to 1
Q.no 55. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
C : 10
D : 13
Q.no 56. Capacitive reactance of a capacitor at 50 Hz is 100 ohms. Its capacitive reactance at 100
Hz will be
A : 50 ohms
B : 100 ohms
C : 200 ohms
D : 300 ohms
Q.no 57. Three 100 ohm resistances are connected in star across 400 V three phase supply. If one
of the resistances is disconnected then the line current is
Jo
in
A : 2 Amp
@
SP
B : 4 Amp
P U
C : 8 Amp
B
TE
C
D : 6.92 Amp
H
-T
Q.no 58. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 12/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : 100 V
B : 141.4 V
C : 200 V
D : 90.21 V
Q.no 60. In a three phase balanced delta connected system all the phase currents are displaced
from each other by
A : 30 degrees
B : 45 degrees
C : 120 degrees
D : 60 degrees
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 13/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
A : iron loss
B : copper loss
D : no losses
A : Purely inductive
in
@
SP
B : Purely capacitive
P U
C : Purely resistive
B
TE
A : copper
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : PVC
A : linear curve
B : sinusoidal curve
C : exponential curve
D : parabolic curve
Q.no 5. For a fixed supply voltage, the current flowing through a conductor will decrease if
Q.no 6. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its average value will be
A : 90.21 V
B : 99.23 V
C : 100 V
D : 141.4 V
A : Linear networks
Jo
B : Non-Linear networks
in
@
A : Irms / Iav
-T
el
eg
B : Iav / Irms
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : Im/Irms
D : Irms/Im
Q.no 9. Current variation in the one coil causes voltage induced in the other nearby coil is known
as
Q.no 10. The value of Resistance Temperature Coefficient of material depends upon
Q.no 11. The direction of induced emf in a rotating conductor in stationary magnetic field is
given by
Q.no 12. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in parallel, the equivalent resistance is
A : zero
Jo
B : 15
in
@
C : 150
SP
P
D : 1.5
U
B
TE
Q.no 13. If the active and apperent power of an a c circuit are equal in magnetude then its power
C
factor is
H
-T
A : 0.5 lag
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 0.707 lag
C : 0.8 lead
D : unity
Q.no 14. Frequency of the primary and secondary parameters of the transformer
Q.no 15. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(377t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 314 Hz
A : Resistance
B : Inductor
C : Capacitor
D : Diode
Q.no 17. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
Jo
B : 10 Amp
in
@
C : 5 Amp
SP
P
D : 7.07 Amp
U
B
TE
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 4/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 19. If the voltage applied to a 250 W,250 V incandescent lamp is 250 V, then the current
flowing at the instant of switching would be
A : 1.25 A
Q.no 21. The maximum flux produced in the core of the transformer is
Q.no 22. EMF induced in a conductor when magnetic field is stationary and conductor is moving
is known as
A : infinite
-T
el
eg
B : zero
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 5/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : high
D : low
Q.no 24. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in series, the equivalent resistance is--
ohm
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
Q.no 25. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
C : Reluctance
D : Capacitance
Q.no 26. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half
cycle is
A : r.m.s. value
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
Q.no 27. In a three phase star connected system the phase difference between phase voltages and
their respetive line voltages is
A : 30 degrees
Jo
in
B : 120 degrees
@
SP
C : 60 degrees
P U
D : 45 degrees
B
TE
C
Q.no 28. In an ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of
H
A : 11 V
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 12 V
C : 12.5 V
D : 11.5 V
Q.no 29. When the supply frequency of transformer is doubled then the eddy current loss
A : remains same
B : is reduced by 50 percent
C : is doubled
Q.no 31. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 150 Hz
A : Reluctance
Jo
B : Resistance
in
@
C : Reactance
SP
P
D : Impedance
U
B
TE
Q.no 33. During charging or discharging of a capacitor, no current actually passes through the
C
H
A : connecting wires
-T
el
eg
B : battery
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : dielectric
D : circuit switch
A:1
B : 1.11
C : 1.41
D : 1.21
Q.no 35. In superposition theorem, when we consider the effect of one current source, all the
other voltage sources are
A : removed
B : shorted
C : open circuited
D : connected
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
Jo
in
C : 0 Hz
@
SP
D : 10000 MHz
P U
Q.no 38. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in star, their equivalent each resistance
B
TE
A : 6 ohm
-T
el
eg
B : 36 ohm
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 12 ohm
D : 2 ohm
Q.no 39. A balanced star connected load is supplied from three phase 400 V 50 Hz system. Its
phase voltage is
A : 400 V
B : 230.94 V
C : 692.8 V
D : 100 V
Q.no 40. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
A : mutual induction
B : self-induction
Jo
in
C : magnetic induction
@
SP
D : electrostatic induction
P U
Q.no 43. Certain coil has 100 turns and is carrying 4 ampere current, MMF of the coil is
B
TE
C
A : 100 amp-turn
H
-T
B : 400 amp-turn
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 25 amp-turm
D : 40 amp-turn
Q.no 44. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
Q.no 45. When 40 resistances each of 40 ohms are connected in parallel, their equivalent
resistance will be--
A : 20 ohm
B : 8 ohm
C : 1 ohm
D : 40 ohm
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
Q.no 47. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
Q.no 48. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
B
TE
A : 5A
-T
el
eg
B : 10A
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 20A
D : 0A
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
D : 31.4 ohms
Q.no 50. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
A : 4 ohm
B : 12 ohm
C : 36 ohm
D : 6 ohm
Q.no 51. When Two coils are tightly coupled, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to 1
Q.no 52. In a three phase balanced delta connected system all the phase currents are displaced
from each other by
A : 30 degrees
Jo
B : 45 degrees
in
@
C : 120 degrees
SP
P
D : 60 degrees
U
B
TE
Q.no 53. Soft iron electro-magnet has cross sectional area 10 square centimeter and has 0.6 mWb
C
A : 0.6 Tesla
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 6 Tesla
C : 3 Wb/sq. meter
D : 0.06 Tesla
Q.no 54. Capacitive reactance of a capacitor at 50 Hz is 100 ohms. Its capacitive reactance at 100
Hz will be
A : 50 ohms
B : 100 ohms
C : 200 ohms
D : 300 ohms
Q.no 55. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 56. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 100 V
B : 141.4 V
C : 200 V
D : 90.21 V
Q.no 57. A series R-L circuit has resistance of 6 ohms and reactance of 8 ohms. The impedance of
the circuit is
Jo
A : 10 ohms
in
@
B : 14 ohms
SP
P
C : 2 ohms
U
B
TE
D : 13.43 ohms
C
H
Q.no 58. Three 100 ohm resistances are connected in star across 400 V three phase supply. If one
-T
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 12/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : 2 Amp
B : 4 Amp
C : 8 Amp
D : 6.92 Amp
Q.no 59. A 10 mF, 20 mF, 25 mF, and 100 mF capacitor are in parallel. The total capacitance is
A : 0.2 mF
B : 5 mF
C : 100 mF
D : 155 mF
Q.no 60. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
C : 10
D : 13
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 13/13
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
p
Ap el
eg
ra
m
at C
H
-T
H TE
B
e PU
SP
l @
rp Jo
in
Pu
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
Amrutvahini college of Engineering, Sangamner
Basic Electrical Engineering (103004)
Sample Multi-Choice Questions
UNIT 2 - Electromagnetism
Q.1 The unit of inductance is,
(A) Ohm.
(B) Farad.
(C) Mho.
(D) Henry. Ans: D
Q.2 If a current flowing through a conductor is moving away from the observer and into the plane of the
paper then it is indicated by,
(A) Dot
(B) Cross
(C) Star
(D) Dash Ans: B
Q.3. In case of dynamically induced EMF, direction of induced EMF is given by
(A) Fleming’s rule
(B) Lenz’s law
(C) Faraday’s first law
(D) Faraday’s second law Ans: A
Q.4. EMF induced in a coil due to change in current through it is called ________induction.
(A) Mutual
(B) Self
(C) Dynamic
(D) Static Ans: B
Q.5. EMF induced in a coil due to current change in neighboring coil is called ______ induction.
(A) Mutual
(B) Self
(C) Dynamic
(D) Static Ans: A
Jo
(B) Inductance
P
(B) Ampere
in
(C) Henry
@
SP
Q.13. The property of one coil due to which it opposes the change in the other coil is called………….
U
B
(A) Fringing
@
(A) MMF
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(B) Current
(C) Voltage
(D) Flux Ans : B
Q.21. Flux density is equal to ________ of flux and area of cross – section.
( A) Sum
(B) Difference
(C) Product
(D) Fraction Ans : D
Q.22. NI expression is called
(A) MMF
(B) EMF
(C) Flux linkage
(D) Magnetic intensity Ans : A
Q.23. Expression NI/L is called
(A) MMF
(B) EMF
(C) Flux linkage
(D) Magnetic intensity Ans :D
Q.24. Expression for mutual inductance is
(A) – L dI /dt
(B) M dI / dt
(C) N2 φ2/ I1
(D) N φ /I Ans : B
Q.25. Faraday’s law of electromagnetic induction is e =
(A) –Nd φ /dt
(B) M dI / dt
(C) N2 φ 2/ I1
(D) N φ /I Ans : A
Jo
(A) φ1/ φ2
@
(B) φ2/ φ1
SP
P
(C) φ1/I1
U
B
(A) Faraday
in
(B) Coulomb
@
(C) Orested
SP
(A) Faraday
TE
(B) Coulomb
C
(C) Orested
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(D) Newton Ans:A
(A) 108
(B) 106
(C) 103
(D) 10-8 Ans:A
(A) Tesla
(B) AT/m
(C) Weber
(D) Henry Ans:A
Q37. The capacity of magnetic pole to accept or radiate certain number of magnetic lines is called----------
-----
Q38. The direction of magnetic field due to a straight current carrying conductor is given by --------------
Q39. The direction of flux around a conductor carrying current away from the observer into the plane of
the paper is ----------------
(A) Anticlockwise
(B) Vertical
(C) Clockwise
(D) Horizontal Ans:A
(A) Voltage
(B) Current
(C) Resistance
Jo
(A) H/m
P
(B) Wb/m
U
B
(C) Nm
TE
Q43. A magnetic circuit has a reluctance of 1x105 AT/Wb and m.m.f. is produced by coil having 100
turns, carrying current of 5 A then the flux produced is ----------- Wb.
(A) 5
(B) 0.2x10-3
(C) 5x10-3
(D) 0.2 Ans:B
Q44. A magnetic circuit has relative permeability 1000 and length of 50 cm with cross-sectional area of 4
cm2. The amperes required through a coil of 1000 turns to produce the flux of 2mWb are ----------- A.
(A) 3.98
(B) 5.28
(C) 4.989
(D) 1.989 Ans:D
(A) (mmf)/(reluctance)
(B) (mmf)x(reluctance)
(C) (reluctance)/(mmf)
(D) None of these Ans:A
Q46.In a series magnetic circuit -------- in the circuit is same through all the parts.
(A) Reluctance
(B) Mmf
(C) Flux
(D) None of these Ans:C
Q47. Accordingly to Kirchhoff’s law, the resultant ----------around a closed magnetic circuit is equal to
algebraic sum of the product of the magnetic field strengths of each part of the circuit.
(A) Reluctance
(B) Mmf
(C) Flux
(D) None of these Ans:B
Q48. At a junction point in a magnetic circuit, algebraic sum of all the ------ is zero.
Jo
in
(A) Reluctances
@
(B) Mmf
SP
(C) Flux
(D) Product of flux and reluctances Ans:B
P U
B
(A) Mmf
C
H
(B) Reluctance
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(C) Flux
(D) Perfect magnetic insulator Ans:D
(A) Energy neither required to create the flux nor required to maintain it.
(B) Energy is required to create the flux but not required to maintain it.
(C) Energy is required to create the flux and also to maintain it
(D) None of these Ans:B
Q51. The flux which completes the path through surrounding air instead of the desired path is called ------
--------.
(A) 1
(B) 0
(C) Infinite
(D) 0.5 Ans:B
Q53. . When a current carrying conductor is brought into magnetic field, the force that moves the
conductor, depends on…………
Q54. Two current carrying conductors lying parallel to each other are exerting a force of attraction on
each other. The currents are……….
(A) Resistance
Jo
(B) reluctance
in
(C) conductance
@
Q56. When a coil consisting of single turn rotates at a uniform speed in a magnetic field, the emf
P
induced is…..
U
B
TE
(A) steady
(B) alternating
C
H
(C) changing
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(D) reversing Ans:B
(A) mmf
(B) reluctance
(C) permeability
(D) Magnetic field strength Ans:A
Q58. The emf induced in a conductor of length 1 m moving at right angles to a uniform magnetic field
of flux Density 1.5 Wb/m² with velocity of 50 m/s…
(A) 0
(B) 1.5 V
(C) 75 V
(D) 100 V Ans:C
(A) Ф/NI
(B) NI/Ф
(C) NФ/I
(D) ФI/N Ans:C
(A) 0.8 V
(B) 0.008 V
(C) 0.16 V
(D) 0.064 V Ans:A
Q61. Two coils have self inductances of 0.09 H and 0.01 H and a mutual inductance of 0.015 H. The
coefficient of coupling between the coils is
(A) 0.5
(B) 1.0
(C) 0.05
(D) 0.75 Ans:A
Q62. When current carrying conductor and lines of flux are parallel then the force experienced by
conductor is-------------.
(A) Zero
(B) Maximum
Jo
(C) Small
in
Q63. Direction of force experienced by current carrying conductor in a magnetic field is given by----------
SP
----.
P U
B
(A) Generator
(B) Transformer
(C) Bulb
(D) None of these Ans:A
Q67. A current of 2 A is reversed in 0.1 sec through an inductor of 1H then emf induced is ------ Volt.
(A) 200
(B) -200
(C) -400
(D) 400 Ans:D
Q68. The phenomenon of the self induction is felt only when the current in the coil is-------.
(A) Changing
(B) Increasing
(C) Decreasing
(D) All of above Ans:D
Q69. The property of coil due to which opposes the change in current flowing through itself is called-----
------- of the coil.
Q71. Two coil have self inductances 100μH and 250μH and coefficient of coupling is 0.253 then their
TE
(A) 400μH
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(B) 158.11μH
(C) 40μH
(D) 40mH Ans:C
(A) Amperes
(B) AT/Wb
(C) Unit less
(D) H/m Ans:C
Q73. A current through an inductor of 0.4 H is 5 A then the energy stored in it is ----------J
(A) 5
(B) 2.5
(C) 2
(D) 1 Ans:A
Q74. The energy stored per volume in a magnetic field of flux density 1.373 Wb/m2 is 500 joules then its
relative permeability is ----------------.
(A) 2500
(B) 1500
(C) 1200
(D) 500 Ans:B
Q75. The ease with which magnetic material forces the magnetic flux through a given medium is-----------
---------.
(A) Permeance
(B) Permeability
(C) Reluctance
(D) Permittivity Ans:B
Q77. In the expression for reluctance S=l/μa , letter ‘a’ represent ----------------.
Q78. A 0.1 A of current reverses in 0.2 seconds then the rate of changes of current is -----------A/sec.
P U
B
(A) 1
TE
(B) -1
(C) 2
C
H
(A) 4π x 10-7
(B) 10000
(C) 100
(D) 1000 Ans:D
Q80. The flux density in a magnetic field of cross-sectional area of 0.5 cm2 having a flux of 10μWb is ----
-----T.
(A) 0.2
(B) 5
(C) 50
(D) 1.2 Ans:B
Q81. The maximum working flux density os a lifting electromagnet is 1.9 T and the effective area of a
pole face is circular in cross-section. If the total magnet flux produced is 2444mWb then the radius of
pole face is nearly -------------cm.
(A) 32
(B) 128
(C) 64
(D) 0.64 Ans: C
(A) Permeability
(B) Permeance
(C) Susceptance
(D) Resistance Ans:D
Q84. Which of the following nit the property of the magnetic lines of forces?
Q85. The direction of flux around a conductor carrying current towards the observer out on the plane of
@
(A) Anticlockwise
P
(B) Vertical
U
B
(C) Clockwise
TE
(A) 5
(B) 0.2x10-3
(C) 5x 10-3
(D) 0.2 Ans:C
(A) H/m
(B) Wb/m
(C) Nm
(D) Ni unit Ans:A
Q88. For the series aiding coils, the equivalent inductance is---------------
(A) L1+L2+2M
(B) (L1+L2)/2M
(C) L1+L2-2M
(D) None of above Ans:A
Q90. The energy required to establish the magnetic field is stored into is as ----------energy
(A) kinetic
(B) electrostatic
(C) potential
(D) residual Ans:C
(A) LI2
(B) LI2/2
(C) 2LI2
(D) I2/2L Ans:B
Q92. A current through as inductor of 0.4 H is 5A then the energy stored init is--------J.
Jo
in
(A) 5
(B) 2.5
@
(C) 2
SP
(D) 1 Ans:A
P U
Q93. The energy stored per unit volume in a magnetic field of flux density 1.373 Wb/m2 is 500 J then its
B
TE
permeability is----------------.
C
H
(A) 2500
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(B) 1500
(C) 1200
(D) 500 Ans:B
(A) Volt
(B) Ampere/Volt
(C) Henry
(D) Linkage Ans:C
(A) 100%
(B) More then 100%
(C) 90%
(D) None of above Ans:A
(A) Amperes
(B) AT/m
(C) Unitless
(D) H/m Ans:C
(A) Weber
(B) AT
(C) Tesla
(D) All of above Ans:C
(A) Φxa
(B) φ/a
(C) 1/(φ+a)
(D) Φ+a Ans:B
(A) Faraday
P
(B) Coulomb
U
B
(C) Orested
TE
a) the core encircles the winding b) the winding encircles the core
U
B
34) For leading power factor loads, the regulation of transformer is…………
@
11-d, 12-b, 13-a, 14-a, 15-b, 16-c, 17-a, 18-a, 19-d, 20-a,
in
@
21-a, 22-a, 23-d, 24-c, 25-d, 26-c, 27-b, 28-c, 29-b, 30-c,
SP
P U
31-b, 32-a, 33-b, 34-a, 35-a, 36-b, 37-b, 38-b, 39-b, 40-b,
B
TE
41-a, 42-d, 43-a, 44-a, 45-c, 46-b, 47-c, 48-a, 49-b, 50-d
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Electrostatics
a) Electric field strength, potential difference b)Electric field strength , potential gradient
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
c)Electric field strength , electric flux density d)Electric flux density , potential gradient
18) _________ represent Coulmb’s law of electrostatics
a) F α Q1Q2 d2 b)F α ( Q1Q2 ) /d2 c)F α d2/(Q1 Q2 ) d)F α 1/(Q1Q2 d2)
19) Two conducting surfaces separated by a dielectric medium is called____
a) Capacitor b)Dipole c)Capacitance d)Inductance
20) Capacitance is_________
a) Property of capacitor to repel charges from its plates
b) Property to store electric charges in the form of static charges
c) Property to store magnetic energy d)Property to breakdown the dielectric
21) The unit of capacitance is_________
a) Farad b)Henry c)Hertz d)Farad/m
22) Capacitance of a capacitor is the ratio of ________
a) P.d. between the plates and the charge b)Charge and the p.d. between the plates
c) Charge and spacing between the plates d)P.d. and thickness of dielectric
23) A capacitance of 1 picofarad means _____ farad.
a) 10-6 b)10-9 c)10-12 d)10-15
24) The capacitance of a parallel plate capacitor is_________
a) Єd/A b)Є/dA c)ЄA/d d)A/Єd
25) The capacitance is charged to 10 V and its capacitance μF then charge on it is_________
a) 10μC b)10nC c)10C d)1μC
26) 2
A capacitor uses the plates of area 25 cm and distance between the plates is 5 cm. then its
capacitance with air as a dielectric is_________
a) 04427 μF b)04427 pF c)0.4427nF d)0.4427 F
27) The charge transferred on the plates of a capacitor is 2 nC while the distance between the plates is
1 mm. if area of cross-section is 10 cm2 and air used as a dielectric then the voltage across the
plates is ___ v
a) 22.580 b)2.5588 c)225.88 d)255.88
28) A capacitor of 10 μF has a charge of 1 mC. If distance between the plate is 1 cm then the electric
field intensity between the plates is_________
a) 10 kv/m b)10 v/m c)0.1V/m d) 8.854 kv/m
29) For a 5 μF capacitor, distance between the plates is 0.5 cm and the electric field intensity is 20
KV/m then the charge on the capacitor is_________
a) 5 μC b)0.5 μC c)5 nC d)0.5 mC
30) A capacitor uses a dielectric of Єr =2 it is charged to 500 V and the distance between the plates is
10 cm then electric flux density between the plates is _________ nC/m2
a) 0.8854 b)88.54 c)8.854 d)0.00885
Jo
31) The p.d. between the plates of a 5 μF capacitor with a charge of 2 mC on it is ______V
in
32) A 2 μF capacitor connected in a circuit has one plate at +6 V and the other plate at – 6V. the
SP
a) + 12 μC b)- 12 μC c) 24 μC d)-24 μC
U
B
33) A parallel plate capacitor with air as dielectric remains connected across a battery e.m.f. 6V the
TE
charge on the capacitor in this condition is Q. if the separation between the plates is decreased by
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
10% in this condition and sufficient time is allowed to attain steady state, the charge on the
capacitor will be_________
a) Increased by 11%, approximately b)Increased by 9%, approximately
c)Decreased by 9%, approximately d)Decreased by 11%, approximately
34) The ability of an insulating medium to resist its breakdown s called its_________
a) Dielectric constant b)Dielectric strength
c) Relative permittivity d) Insulation resistance
35) The dielectric strength is measured in ____
a) KV/N b)V/C c)KV/cm d)F/m
36) ________is not the factor affecting dielectric strength.
a) Temperature b)Moisture c)Size and shape of the plates d)Insulation resistance
37) ________ is the factor affecting dielectric strength
a) Presence of air pockets in material b)Molecular arrangement of material
c) Moisture content d)All of these
38) For the capacitor in series, ________ remains same for all of them.
a) Voltage b)Capacitance c)Charge d)One of these
39) The two capacitor 3 μF and 6 μF are in series then the equivalent capacitance is ________
a) 9μF b)4.5μF c)2μF d)1μF
40) Three capacitors each of capacitances C and breakdown voltage V are connected in series then
the capacitances and breakdown voltage of the combination is_______
a) 3C,V/3 b)C/3,3V c)3C,3V d)C./3,V/3
41) The capacitor 15μF, 10μF and 3μF are connected in series and series combination is connected
across 10 V when the capacitors are fully charged then the charge on 3 μF capacitor is_____
a) 10μC b)15μC c)3μC d)20μC
42) Four 2 μF capacitors are connected in series then the equivalent capacitance is _______μF.
a) 0.5 b)8 c)2 d)4
43) The capacitors of capacitance 4μF and 6μF connected in series. A p. d. of 500 volt is applied to
the outer plates of two capacitor system. Then the charge on each plate of each plate of each
capacitor is numerically_________ μC
a) 500 b)5000 c)1200 d)400
44) Two capacitor 3μF and 6μF connected in series across 100 V d.c. supply. Then the voltage across
3μF capacitor will be ________ V
a) 100 b)66.667 c)33.333 d)0
45) Ten capacitor of 3μF each ar connected in series then the equivalent capacitance is ________μF
a) 0.3 b)3 c)30 d)3.333
46) The energy stored in a capacitor is given by___________
Jo
47) if the p.d. between the plates is increased by 10% then energy stored in the capacitor increased by
@
__________%
SP
48) The capacitor of 10 The capacitor of 10 μF is discharged through a resistance of 100 KΩ then the
U
B
Answer:
1 C 11 B 21 A 31 C 41 D
2 A 12 C 22 B 32 D 42 A
3 D 13 C 23 C 33 A 43 C
4 C 14 D 24 C 34 B 44 B
5 B 15 A 25 A 35 C 45 c
6 C 16 B 26 B 36 D 46 B
7 A 17 B 27 C 37 D 47 D
8 C 18 C 28 A 38 C 48 A
9 B 19 A 29 D 39 C 49 B
10 A 20 B 30 B 40 b 50 B
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
UNIT-4
cycle is called
a) maximum b) amplitude c) peak d) all of these
in
a) 5 b) 10 c) 2.5 d) 20
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Q 23. a sinusoidal voltage varies from zero to maximum of 250 V. the voltage at the instant of 60° of
the cycle will be V
a) 150 b) 216.5 c) 125 d) 108.25
Q 24. an ac voltage is given by v=40sin 314t the frequency is Hz
a) 75 b) 50 c) 25 d) 100
Q 25. an ac current is given by i=14.1421 sin100π t then the time taken by it to complete three cycles is
sec
a) 0.02 b) 0.06 c) 0.08 d) 0.01
Q 26. an instantaneous value of an alternating current, having 7.071 A rms value at 120° is
a) 4.33 b) 6.123 c) 8.66 d) 3.061
Q 27. an instantaneous value of an alternating voltage having 50 Hz frequency and maximum
value of 100V at 0.01 sec is
a) 100 b) 100√2 c) 100/√2 d) 0
Q 28. a sinusoidal voltage has a magnitude of 200 V at 150 ° then its maximum value is V
a) 100 b) 400 c) 200 d) 300
Q 29. an AC voltage is given by 100Sin 314t. the frequency is
a) 50 b) 75 c) 25 d) 100
Q 30. the concept of effective value is based on
a) photoelectric effect b) heating effectc) friction d) none of these
Q 31. voltage of domestic ac supply is 230V this represents value
a) peak b) average c) r.m.s d) mean
Q 32. the voltmeter in ac circuit always measure Value
a) average b) maximum c) r.m.s. d) none of these
Q 33. the rms value of an alternating is 10/√2 A then its peak to peak value is
a)10 b) 30 c) 5 d) 20
Q 34. the peak value of an alternating current is Im then its r.m.s. value is
a) Im/√2 b) √2 Im c) Im/2 d) 2Im
Q 35. the peak value of an alternating current is Im then its avg value is
a) 0.5 Im b) 0.637 Im c) Im/√2 d) √2 Im
Q 36. for symmetrical alternating waveform, the average value over a complete cycle is
a) 1 b) √2 c) 0 d) 1/√2
Q 37. the peak value of an alternating wave is 400V, its average value is
a) 254.8 b) 282.6 c) 400 d) 565.5
Q 38. the average value of sinusoidal varying voltage is than its r.m.s. value
a) more b) less c) same as d) none of the above
Q 39. Peak value of sine wave is 200V its average value is
a) 127.4 b) 282.6 c) 400 d) 565
Q 40. The form factor of purely sinusoidal waveform is
a) 1.11 b) 1.21 c) 1.414 d) √2
Q 41. which of the following wave has least value of peak factor?
a) sine b) square c) Triangular d) Full wave rectified sine wave
Jo
a) Ns b) w c) F d) none of these
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Q 47. The phase of an alternating quantity varies from
a) 0-90 b) 0-180 c) 0-360 d) 180-360
48. Alternating quantity having positive phase has value at t=0
a) positive b) negative c) zero d) infinite
49. An alternating quantity having zero phase value at t=0
a) positive b) negative c) zero d) infinite
50. An alternating quantity having negative phase value at t=0
a) positive b) negative c) zero d) infinite
51. An alternating voltage is given by v(t)=150sin(wt+π/3) V then its phase is
a) 30° b) 90° c) 0° d) 60°
52. When two alternating quantities are in phase then their phase difference is
a) 30° b) 90° c) 0° d) 60°
53. The negative maximum of cosine wave occurs at __ °
a) 45 b) 90 c) 180 d) 270
54. representation gives rms value an alternating quantity
a) phasor b) polar c) rectangular d) none of these
55. the phase of v(t)=100cos(314t+π/4) is
a) 45 b) 90 c) 135 d) 0
56. The phase of e(t)= -Em coswt is
a) 90 b) -90 c) -270 d) 0
57. The polar form of -3+j4 is
a) 5<-53.13 b) 5<53.13 c) 5<-126.86 d) 5<126.86
58. The rectangular form of 5<30
a) 4.33+j2.5 b) - 4.33+j2.5 c) -4.33-j2.5 d) 4.33-j2.5
59. for addition and substraction the phasors must be expressed in
a) rectangular b) cylindrical c) polar d) spherical
60. for multiplication and division ac quantity is expressed in
a) cylindrical b) spherical c) rectangular d) polar
61. the power factor of pure resistive circuit is
a) zero b) unity c) lagging d) leading
62. in purely resistive circuit, the average power is the peak power
a) double b) one half of c) one forth of d) equal to
63. the voltage 200< +45 V is applied to R=5Ω then current is
a) 1000<45 b) 40<45 c) 40<0 d) 1000<0
64. the inductive reactance of an inductor L is
a. w/L b. 2πL/f c. wL d. 2fl
65. the inductive reactance of a coil of L=2mH at 100Hz is
a. 0.7957 b. 314.16 c. 1.2566 d. 2
66. inductive reactance of a coil of L =0.5H at 50Hz is
a. 15.7 b. 157 c. 50 d. 25
67. The average power consumption in a pure inductor is
Jo
92. two or more ac quantities are represented on the same phasor diagram if they have same
@
94. an alternating voltage is given by 212.132sin(πt +30) then its rms value and phase are
B
TE
100. Current in rectangular form is 20-j40 A is flowing through a pure capacitor then the phase of the
applied voltage is
a. -153.43° b. 63.43° c. -26.57° d. 26.57
Answer-
01-b 14-a 27-d
Ans: b
Ans: a
Ans: b
Ans: b
Ans: b
6. As compared to constant-current system, the constant-voltage system of charging a lead acid cell
has the advantage of
Jo
Ans: c
U
Ans: d
Ans: d
9. In a lead-acid cell dilute sulphuric acid (electrolyte) approximately comprises the following
(a) one part H2O, three parts H2SO4
(b) two parts H2O, two parts H2SO4
(c) three parts H2O, one part H2SO4
(d) all H2S04
Ans: c
10. When the lead-acid cell is fully charged, the electrolyte assumes _____ appearance
(a) dull
(b) reddish
(c) bright
(d) milky
Ans: d
11. The internal resistance of an alkali cell is nearly _____ times that of the lead-acid cell.
(a) two
(b) three
(c) four
(d) five
Ans: d
Ans: c
Jo
(c) lead
SP
Ans: a
B
TE
(a) 500
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(b) 700
(c) 1000
(d) 1250
Ans: d
Ans: a
Ans: c
17. In ______ system the charging current is intermittently controlled at either a maximum or
minimum value
(a) two rate charge control
(b) trickle charge
(c) floating charge
(d) an equalizing charge
Ans: a
18. Undercharging....
(a) reduces specific gravity of the electrolyte
(b) increases specific gravity of the electrolyte
(c) produces excessive gassing
(d) increases the temperature
Ans: a
9. On overcharging a battery
(a) it will bring about chemical change in active materials
(b) it will increase the capacity of the battery
(c) it will raise the specific gravity of the electrolyte
(d) none of the above will occur
Jo
Ans: d
in
@
20. In a lead-acid cell, if the specific gravity of sulphuric acid is 1.8, it will require following ratio of
SP
Ans: d
Ans: a
Ans: c
24. During discharge, the active material of both the positive and negative plates is changed to
(a) Pb
(b) Pb02
(c) PbO
(d) PbS04
Ans: d
25. _____ of electrolyte indicates the state of charge of the battery
(a) colour
(b) mass
(c) viscosity
(d) specific gravity
Ans: d
Ans: b
PU
(c) NaOH
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(d) KOH
Ans: d
28. All the electrical connections between the battery and vehicle should be by
(a) thin aluminium wires
(b) thin copper wires
(c) rigid cables
(d) flexible cables
Ans: d
Ans: c
30. Which of the following primary cells has the highest voltage ?
(a) Manganese-alkaline
(b) Carbon-zinc
(c) Lithium
(d) Mercury
Ans: c
31. Which of the following primary cells has the lowest voltage ?
(a) Lithium
(b) Zinc-chloride
(c) Mercury
(d) Carbon-zinc
Ans: c
Ans: b
Ans: b
U
B
Ans: a
35. When two batteries are connected in parallel, it should be ensured that
(a) they have same e.m.f.
(b) they have same make
(c) they have same ampere-hour capacity
(d) they have identical internal resistance
Ans: a
Ans: d
13. In order to increase capacity of the battery, number of cells are connected in
(A) series.
(B) parallel.
(C) both above.
(D) none of the above.
Answer ⇓
B
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
A. high A. increases
@
B. low B. decreases
SP
D. remains constant
U
Ans. A Ans. A
B
TE
A. electrons semiconductors
-T
A. increases
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
B. decreases
C. first increases then decreases Que. An effort required to drift the
D. remains constant free electrons in one particular direction, in a
Ans. B conductor is called EMF
A. chemical
Que. Which of the following material has B. mechanical
nearly zero temperature coefficient of C. electrical
resistance D. thermal
A. manganin Ans. C
B. porcelain
C. carbon Que. I = /t amp
D. copper A. R
Ans. A B. L
C. Q
Que. Which of the following material has a D. t
negative temperature coefficient of resistance Ans. C
A. copper
B. aluminium Que. The ability of a charged particle to do
C. carbon work is called
D. brass A. potential difference
Ans. C B. electric potential
C. magnitude
Que. Ohm‟s law is not applicable to D. magnetism
A. vaccume tubes Ans. B
B. carbon resistor
C. high voltage circuits Que. The unit of electric potential is
D. circuits at low current densities A. amp
Ans. A B. coulomb
C. volt
Que. Which one of the following does not D. tesla
have negative temperature coefficient Ans. C
A. aluminium
B. paper Que. 1 calorie =
C. rubber A. 4.186 joules
Jo
D. 4186 KJ
SP
A. MMF A. Ω
TE
B. EMF B. Ω-m
C
C. Ω/m
H
C. current
-T
Ans. B Ans. B
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
D. none of above
Que. Unit of conductance is Ans. C
A. Ohm
B. Siemens Que. Semiconductors have
C. Newton temperature coefficient
D. Henry A. positive
Ans. B B. negative
C. zero
Que. The material having highest value of D. all above
is best conductor Ans. B
A. resistivity
B. conductivity Que. Resistance temperature coefficient is
C. permittivity denoted by
D. all above A. α
Ans. B B. β
C. θ
Que. The material having poorest value of D. Φ
is best insulator. Ans. A
A. resistivity
B. conductivity Que. The RTC at t OC is ratio of
C. permittivity A. change in conductance per degree Celsius
D. all above to the resistance at t 0 C
Ans. B B. change in resistance per degree Celsius to
the resistance at t 0 C
Que. Factors which affect the resistance C. change in initial resistance per degree
Celsius to the resistance at t 0 C
A. length of the material D. all above
B. cross sectional area Ans. B
C. temprature
D. all above Que. Unit of RTC is
Ans. D A. OC
B. /OC
Que. Effect of temperature on resistance C. Ω/OC
depends on of material D. Ω
Jo
A. size Ans. B
in
B. shape
C. nature Que. Insulation resistance is defined as
@
SP
B. voltage
B
A. increases Ans. C
-T
B. remains same
el
C. decreses
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
temperature?
in
C. copper B. 75
D. silver C. 100
P U
Ans. A D. 35
B
Ans. C
TE
C. Joule A. Newton
B. Joule
@
D. all of above
SP
Ans. C C. Newton-metre
D. Joule-Sec.
P U
D. above all
SP
of Ans. C
TE
A. electro-chemical system
C
H
D. all above
cable increases it‟s insulation resistance will Ans. D
@
A. increase
SP
D. None of above.
Que. As the Temprature of surrounding
-T
Ans. A
el
Ans. C Ans. D
P U
Que. What are the factors on which resistance Que. What will be the effect on the resistance
B
material.
-T
Ans. B
Que. Which effect of electrical current is
in
A. Magnetic
SP
D. Change at random.
Que. If the efficiency of a machine is to be
-T
Ans. B
el
because is
A. 1200 MΩ
in
C. 1000 MΩ
SP
supply wires
TE
D. supply wires are made of superior material Que. A 100W electric light bulb is connected
C
H
A. 0.3A
el
B. 0.4A
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
C. 4A A. 1400 ohm
D. 0.6A B. 60 ohm
Ans. B C. 960 ohm
D. 325 ohm
Que. A 100W electric light bulb is connected Ans. C
to a 250V supply. Its hot resistance is
A. 625Ω Que. The energy used by a 1.5kW heater in 5
B. 526Ω minutes is:
C. 62.5Ω A. 5 J
D. 625mΩ B. 450 J
Ans. A C. 7500 J
D. 450000 J
Que. 60 μs is equivalent to: Ans. D
A. 0.06s
B. 0.00006 s Que. If a current of 5A flows for 2 minutes,
C. 1000 minutes the quantity of charge transferred will
D. 0.6 s A. 600C
Ans. B B. 100C
C. 0.6C
Que. The current which flows when 0.1 D. 60C
coulomb is transferred in 10 ms is Ans. A
A. 1A
B. 10A Que. In what time would a current of 1A
C. 10mA transfer a charge of 30 C?
D. 100mA A. 45s
Ans. B B. 30s
C. 65s
Que. The p.d. applied to a 1 kΩ resistance in D. 4s
order that a current of 100 μA may flow is Ans. B
A. 1V
B. 100V Que. How long must a current of 0.1A flow
C. 0.1V so as to transfer a charge of 30 C?
D. 10V A. 5 min
Ans. C B. 5s
Jo
C. 50min
in
A. 6.25W
B. 20W Que. A force of 4N moves an object 200 cm
P U
D. 100W A. 6J
TE
Ans. D B. 8J
C
H
C. 4J
-T
resistance of Ans. B
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Que. 0.32mA= ........... μA Que. Which of the following lamps will have
A. 0.0032 least resistance at room temperature?
B. 0.032 A. 25W, 220V
C. 0.00032 B. 100W, 220V
D. 320 C. 200W, 220V
Ans. D D. 60W, 220V
Ans. C
Que. If two cables with their insulation
resistances Ri1 and Ri2 are joined in Que. If the length of a wire of resistance R
series,then their equivalent resistance will be is uniformly stretched to n times its original
A. Ri1 + Ri2 value, its new resistance is
B. Ri1 - Ri2 A. nr
C. Ri1 / Ri2 B. R/n
D. Ri1 Ri2 / Ri1 + Ri2 C. n2 R
Ans. D D. r/n2
Ans. C
Que. If two cables with their insulation
resistances Ri1 and Ri2 with conductor Que. length of wire having resistance of 1
resistances R 1 and R2 respectively are joined ohm is cut into four equal parts and these four
in parallel ,then their equivalent insulation parts are bundled together side-by-side to
resistance will be form a wire. The new resistance will be
A. Ri1 + Ri2 A. 1/4 ohm
B. Ri1 - Ri2 B. 1/16 ohm
C. Ri1 / Ri2 C. 4 ohm
D. Ri1 Ri2 / Ri1 + Ri2 D. 16 ohm
Ans. A Ans. B
Que. Two bulbs of 500 W and 200W rated at Que. The resistance of copper wire 25 m
250 V will have resistance ratio as long is found to be 50 Ω. If its diameter is
A. 4:25 1mm, then resistivity of copper is
B. 25:4 A. 1.57µΩ-m
C. 2:5 B. 57Ω-m
D. 5:2 C. 15.7Ω-m
Jo
Ans. A
Que. With three resistances connected in
@
SP
parallel, if each dissipates 20 W, the total Que. At 300K the temperature coefficient
power supplied by the voltage source equals of resistance of a wire is 0.00125 /OC and its
P U
B. 20W A. 1154 K
C
C. 40W
H
B. 1100 K
-T
D. 60W C. 1400 K
el
Ans. D D. 1127 K
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
C. 0.00324/0 C
A. reduce by 25% D. 0.0000423/0 C
P
B. reduce by 50%
U
Ans. B
B
C. increase by 50%
TE
Ans. B
H
temperature.
el
A. 990 Ώ.
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
D. electric bulb
A. 1000 C Ans. C
@
SP
B. 1100 C
C. 96.790 C Que. The time required for 1KW electric
P U
C. 42 sec
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Que.
A factory is supplied with power at 210V. Que. The time taken to raise temperature of
The load consists of 250,60W lamp and 4 880gm of water from 160 C to boiling point if
motor each taking 40amp. Find total current heater takes 2A at 220V is ……….
Jo
C. 250A B. 13 hr
D. 231.4A C. 15 min
P U
Ans. D D. 20 min
B
Ans. A
TE
0.125 at 200 C. What will be resistance of Que. A tap supplies water at 220 C. A man
-T
electrode at 850 C. RTC of carbon is - 0.005 at takes 1 lit of water per minute at 370 C from
el
Que. A current of 3A flows for 50 hrs Que. 450 J of energy are converted into
through a 6Ωresistor. The energy consumed heat in 1 minute. The power dissipated is
by the A. 7.5kW
resistor is B. 7.5W
A. 0.9 kWh C. 750W
B. 2.7 kWh D. 600W
C. 9 kWh Ans. B
D. 27 kWh
Ans. B Que. The power rating of a D.C. electric
motor consuming 36 MJ when connected to a
Que. The amount of work done in lifting a 250V supply for 1 hour is
mass of 500 kg to a height of 6m in 30 s, the A. 100W
power developed B. 10W
A. 2943J C. 500W
B. 0.2943J D. 10KW
C. 29.43J Ans. D
Jo
D. 29.43KJ
in
A. 198J B. 4 kWh
B
B. 981W C. 2 kWh
TE
D. 981J Ans. B
-T
Ans. B
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
B. 240 KJ
in
D. 24000 KJ
SP
efficiency of process is ……
H
D. 4500 w
-T
A. 60% Ans. C
el
B. 65%
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Que. A hydro power station has a reservoir hours a day? The effective water head is
capacity of 5x106 m3 .The effective water 220m.The overall efficiency of the power
head is 100m. The penstock, turbine, station is 86.4%.
generator efficiencies are A. 2.316x105 m3
95%,90%,85%respectively. The total energy B. 2.316x106 m3
generated from power station is…. C. 2.316x107 m3
A. 35.61x1015 watt-sec D. 2.316x108 m3
B. 35.61x1010 watt-sec Ans. B
C. 35.61x109 watt-sec
D. 35.61x1011 watt-sec Que. The power required to drive certain
Ans. D machine at 350 rpm is ---- --. The driving
torque produced is 1637 N-m ….
((Q))2_ An electrically driven pump lifts A. 40KW
80m3 of water per min through a height of B. 50 KW
12m.IF overall efficiency of motor-pump set C. 60 KW
is 70%. The input power to motor is …… D. 60 W
A. 224.228Kw Ans. C
B. 156960W
C. 150000W Que. The total power supplied to an engine
D. 200Kw which drives generator is -----. If Generator
Ans. A delivers 15A to a 100Ω load. The efficiency
of process is 55.9%.
Que. A1500V dc motor takes an input of A. 40.25 W
35Kw and drives a load at 1500 rpm. The B. 4025 KW
torque required by the load is 2oo N-m.The C. 402.5KW
efficiency of motor is D. 40.25 KW
A. 85% Ans. D
B. 89.77%
C. 90% Que. The 1234.6 H.P rating engine drives a
D. 70% generator supplying a load of 7000 lamp each
Ans. B taking 0.5A at 250V .efficiency of generator
is
Que. How many joules of energy will be A. 95%
required to melt 50 kg of tin .The m.p of tin is B. 80%
Jo
A. 5500 KJ
B. 5000 KJ
P U
Que. How much volume of water is used by overall efficiency of motor-pump set is
el
B. 75% Ans. B
C. 60%
D. 80% Que. Current carrying conductor is always
Ans. A surrounded by
A. magnetic field
Que. A1500V dc motor takes an input of------ B. electric field
--- and drives a load at 1500 rpm. The torque C. Electricity
required by the load is 2oo N-m.The D. current
efficiency of motor is 89.77% Ans. A
A. 40KW
B. 35Kw Que. The direction of magnetic field
C. 90KW produced by current carrying conductor is
D. 45KW given by
Ans. B A. Lenz‟s law
B. right hand thumb rule
Que. The calorific value of coal used for C. Fleming‟s left hand rule
thermal power generation is D. Kirchoff‟s law
7166.67kcal/kg.The amount of coal burnt per Ans. B
KWh of electrical energy is 0.6 kg. The
steam power station has an overall efficiency Que. Imaginary lines of force originating
of from magnet is called
A. 25% A. current
B. 20%. B. resistance
C. 18% C. flux
D. 22% D. magnetic field
Ans. B Ans. C
Que. when an electric motor having Que. Region surrounded by magnet is called
efficiency of 88.88% is operated for 30 A. magnetic field strength
minute consumes 0.75 KWh. The energy loss B. magnetic field
during the process is ------- C. electric field
A. 200KJ D. resistance
B. 7500J Ans. B
C. 300 KJ
Jo
Ans. C A. flux
B. current
@
SP
Electromagnetism C. resistance
D. flux density
P U
A. electric circuit
H
D. reluctance
B
Que. Unit of magnetic field strength is B. magnetic flux density to magnetic field
-T
A. AT/m strength
el
C. 1
in
D. ¼ H/m
Ans. C Que. The permeance in a magnetic circuit
@
SP
corresponds to
Que. Permeability of vacuum is A. resistance in an electric circuit
P U
Ans. D
H
D. ¼ H/m
-T
Ans. A
el
Que. The mechanical force acting on current Que. Two current carrying conductor lying
carrying on conductor when placed in parallel and close to each other. They are
magnetic field is given by relation carrying current in the opposite direction. The
Jo
B. B. Attractive
@
C.
SP
C. Zero
D. D. none of these
P U
Ans. C Ans. A
B
TE
Que. Which of the following has the highest Que. Two current carrying conductor lying
C
H
Ans. C
Ans. C
in
conductor C. conductivity
C
D. reluctivity
-T
Ans. C Ans. B
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
C. magnetic field is
D. direction of force on conductor
in
A. 1
Ans. D B. less than 1
@
SP
C. greater than 1
Que. Permeance is to reluctance as D. 1000
P U
conductance is to Ans. A
B
A. inductance
TE
C. capacitance
H
magnetic materials is
-T
Ans. B B. 0.7
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Ans. B Ans. A
@
SP
A. reluctance B.
B
Ans. D
el
D. Non above
el
Ans. C
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
called as A. Volt
A. self- induction B. Ampere
@
SP
B. Inductance C. Henry
C. Self- inductance D. Linkages
P U
D. Induction Ans. C
B
Ans. C
TE
D. Linkages B. Difference
Ans. A C. Product
D. ratio
Que. The property of one coil due to which it Ans. D
opposes the change in the other coil is
called…………. between two coils. Que. NI expression is called
A. Dynamic inductance A. MMF
B. Static inductance B. EMF
C. Self inductance C. Flux linkage
D. Mutual inductance D. Magnetic intensity
Ans. D Ans. A
A. Ф1 /Ф2
SP
B. Current B. Ф2 /Ф1
C. Voltage
P
C. Ф1 /I 1
U
D. Flux D. Ф2 /I1
B
Ans. B
TE
Ans. D
C
H
A. Sum
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Que. In the expression for reluctance Que. The unit of energy stored in magnetic
field is
of a conduced, letter „a‟ represents A. Watt
of the core. B. Joule/sec
A. Total area
Jo
C. Joule
B. Surface area D. Joule-sec
in
D. None of these.
SP
A. direction of current. C.
-T
B. length of conductor
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
D. A. in same direction
B. in opposite direction
Ans. B
C. in outward direction
D. in inward direction
Que. The relation between self inductances
Ans. B
L1 and L2 of two side by side placed coils and
the mutual inductance M between them, with
Que. If two coils having self inductances of
coefficient of coupling as K is ….
L1 Henry and L2 Henry are cumulatively
A.
coupled. The mutual inductance between
B.
√ them is M Henry. Then the effective or
C. equivalent inductance is……
√ A. L1 +L2 +2M
D. √ √ B. L1 +L2 -2M
Ans. C C. L1 +L2 +M
D. L1 +L2 -M
Que. If two side by side placed coils are Ans. A
perfectly coupled, then the coefficient of
coupling is…. Que. If two coils having self inductances of
A. less than 1 L1 Henry and L2 Henry are differentially
B. More than 1 coupled. The mutual inductance between
C. equal to 1 them is M Henry. Then the effective or
D. equal to zero equivalent inductance is……
Ans. C A. L1 +L2 +2M
B. L1 +L2 -2M
Que. If two side by side placed coils are C. L1 +L2 +M
loosely coupled, then the coefficient of D. L1 +L2 -M
coupling is…. Ans. B
A. less than 1
B. More than 1 Que. A coil is wound uniformly with 300
C. equal to 1 turns over a steel of relative permeability
D. equal to zero 900. If a current of 5 A is passed through the
Ans. A coil. The MMF is
A. 4500 AT
Que. If two side by side placed coils are B. 270000 AT
Jo
A. in Same direction
SP
B. in Opposite direction
C. in outward direction Que. If magnetic flux changes from 0.8 Wb
P U
A. 1.1
TE
Ans. A
B. 0.5
C
H
B. 3. 75 mA
of 25A is passed through coil. Then the mmf
in
C. 3. 75 micro Ampere
of ring is
@
D. 37.5 mA
A. 5000AT
SP
Ans. B
B. 7200AT
P
C. 750AT
U
B
A. 0V B. 70mWb
B. 1.26V C. 10.6mWb
C. 0.63V D. 106mwb
D. 0.88V Ans. C
Ans. C
Que. A magnetic circuit has a mmf of
Que. A conductor of 10cm length 400AT and a reluctance of 2 × 105 AT/wb.
carrying a current of 5A placed in uniform The magnetic flux in the magnetic circuit is
magnetic field of flux density 1.25T at 30 0 to A. 3 × 10-5 Wb
the lines of flux. Force acting on conductor B. 2 × 10-3 Wb
will be C. 1.5 × 10-2 Wb
A. 0.3125N D. 2.5 × 10-4 Wb
B. 3.125N Ans. B
C. 1.325N
D. 5.321N Que. A 2cm long coil has 10 turns and
Ans. A carries a current of 750mA. The magnetizing
force of the coil is
Que. A solenoid has a flux of 12mwb and a A. 225 AT/m
flux density of 0.9T.The diameter of B. 675 AT/m
solenoid must be C. 450 AT/m
A. 130.3mm D. 375 AT/m
B. 13.33cm Ans. D
C. 10cm
D. 4.12cm Que. A magnetic core having mean length
Ans. A of 20cm, C/S area of 1 cm2 , µr of 2400 . The
reluctance of the magnetic core is
Que. A coil is wound uniformly with 300 A. 663.48 x 104 AT/wb
turns over steel ring of relative permeability B. 663.48 x 103 AT/wb
900, having mean circumference of 40mm C. 66.348 x 102 AT/wb
and cross sectional area of 50mm2 . A current D. 66.348 x105 AT/wb
of 25A is passed through coil. Then the Ans. B
reluctance of ring is
A. 7×107 AT/Wb Que. If the reluctance of magnetic
B. 0.7×106 AT/Wb material is 65x 105 AT/wb. The no. of amp
Jo
Ans. B
SP
B. 13x104 AT
Que. A coil is wound uniformly with 300 C. 13x102 AT
P U
of 25A is passed through coil. The value of Que. An iron ring of 100 cm mean
-T
A. 10.6Wb
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
turns of copper wire on it. The permeability uniform field of 1.5T. Find the mechanical
of the material is 1500. The reluctance of the force on the conductor.
ring is A. 37.5 N
A. 1.67 x 106 AT/Wb B. 0
C. 53N
B. 16.7 x 106 AT/Wb
D. 75N
C. 1.67 x 105 AT/Wb Ans. D
D. 1.67 x 104 AT/Wb
Ans. A Que. A straight wire 0.5 m long carries a
current of 100A & lies at parallel to the
Que. A coil is wound uniformly over a uniform field of 1.5T. Find the mechanical
steel of relative permeability 900, having a force on the conductor.
mean circumference of 40 mm and cross- A. 373N
sectional area of 50 mm2. The reluctance of B. 0
the steel is C. 53N
A. 707.714 x 103 AT/Wb D. 75N
B. 70.77 x 103 AT/Wb Ans. b
C. 707.714 x 104 AT/Wb
D. 7.07 x 104 AT/Wb Que. A coil is wound uniformly with 300
Ans. A turns over a steel ring of relative permeability
900 having mean circumference of 40cm &
Que. A straight conductor having an cross sectional area of 5 cm2. If coil has
active length of 30cm, is kept in a uniform resistance of 100 Ω, & is connected to 250V
magnetic field of 0.6 T. Find the emf DC supply, calculate coil current.
produced in the conductor when it is moved A. 2.5A
parallel to the magnetic field at a rate of 7 B. 3.53 mA
m/s C. 2.8A
A. 0V D. none of these
B. 1.26V Ans. D
C. 0.18V
D. 0.88V Que. A magnetic circuit has a m.m.f. of
Ans. A 400 AT & a reluctance of 2 x 105 AT/wb The
magnetic flux in the magnetic circuit is
Que. In certain electric motor, wire that A. 3 x 10-5wb
Jo
A. 0.04 N Ans. B
P
B. 4 N
U
D. none of these
Ans. A respectively. The amount of energy stored per
C
H
unit volume in it is
-T
C. 15 J B. 0.169H
D. 13.33 J C. 0.011H
Ans. C D. 0.0188H
Ans. C
Que. The magnetic circuit with mean
length of 100 cm and 20cm2 cross sectional Que. A magnetic circuit requires 800
area gives magnetic field strength of 150 A/m ampere turns to produce a certain amount of
along its length, The flux of 6 mWb is flux. If exciting coil of 100 turns has 5 ohms
developed in it. Then the amount of energy resistance, then the voltage to be applied to
stored in it is the exciting coil must be
A. 0.9 J A. 40V
B. 0.45 J B. 20 V
C. 450J C. 10V
D. 18 J D. 5V
Ans. B Ans. A
B. 0.41
in
called
U
B. Generator
respectively. If the coefficient of coupling is
C
C. Transformer
H
Ans. C
el
A. 0.53H
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
B. Mutual induction
TE
D. None of these
SP
transformer A. step-down
TE
Ans. C
Que. Any transformer flux that does not
follow the core and escapes into the Que. Eddy current losses in transformer core
surrounding air is called is reduced by
A. magnetizing flux A. Increasing the thickness of laminations
B. coupling flux B. Decreasing the thickness of laminations
C. leakage flux C. Decreasing the air gap in magnetic circuit
D. reactance flux D. Using wire of higher guage for winding
Ans. C Ans. B
Que. A transformer that does not isolate the Que. A good transformer oil should be
output from the input is called absolutely free from
transformer A. Sulpher
A. Distribution B. Alkalies
B. step-up C. Moisture
C. Auto D. All of the above
D. Control Ans. C
Ans. C
Que. Single phase core type transformer
Que. Ideal transformer assumptions do not has
include A. One magnetic circuit
A. Zero reactance of the winding B. Two magnetic circuits
B. Zero resistance of the winding C. No magnetic circuit
C. No leakage flux D. None of these
D. No saturation of the core Ans. A
Ans. A
Que. Single phase shell type transformer
Que. The efficiency of the transformer is has
normally is normally in the range A. One magnetic circuit
of B. Two magnetic circuits
A. 50 to 70% C. No magnetic circuit
B. 60 to 75 % D. None of these
C. 80 to 90 % Ans. B
D. 90 to 98%
Jo
side Ans. A
B
side
el
D. 0 B. E= 4.44 Bm A N
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
to provide
A. Cooling and insulation
@
autotransformer
el
A. Toy transformer
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
B. Control transformer
C. Variable transformer Que. The efficiency of single phase
D. Isolating transformer transformer is calculated as
Ans. C
A.
Que. In any transformer the voltage per turn B.
in primary and secondary
remains C.
A. Always different
B. Always the same
D.
C. Always in ratio of K
Ans. A
D. Sometimes same
Ans. B
Que. The disadvantage of auto transformer
is
Que. If we increase the flux density in case of
A. No separation between primary &
transformer
A. The size of transformer will reduce secondary
B. The distortion in transformer will reduce B. Size is more than normal transformer for
same rating
C. Hysteresis and eddy current losses will
C. More costlier than normal transformer
reduce
D. All
D. None of these will be true
Ans. D
Ans. A
Que. The direct loading test is performed on Que. In a transformer the voltage regulation
will be near to zero when it operates
transformer to find its
at
A. Regulation
A. unity p.f.
B. Efficiency
B. leading p.f.
C. Both
C. lagging p.f.
D. None of these
D. full loaD.
Ans. C
Ans. B
Que. The regulation of transformer is
Que. A transformer steps up voltage by a
calculated as
factor of 100. The ratio of current in the
primary to that in
Jo
A. secondary
in
A. 1
@
B. 100
SP
B. C. 0.01
P
D. 0.1
U
B
C. Ans. B
TE
C
D. change
-T
Ans. A A. Voltage
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
B. Power
C. current Que. The flux involved in EMF equation of a
D. None of these transformer has
Ans. B A. RMS Value
B. Average Value
Que. The flux in transformer C. Total Value
core D. maximum Value
A. increases with load Ans. D
B. decreases with load
C. remains constant irrespective of load Que. If primary of the transformer is
D. none of these connected to dc supply, then
Ans. C A. Primary draws small current
B. primary leakage reactance is increased
Que. Efficiency of transformer is maximum C. core losses are increased
when D. primary may burn out
A. transformer is unloaded Ans. D
B. copper losses is equal to iron losses
C. eddy current losses are equal to hysteresis Que. For an ideal transformer the windings
losses should have
D. it is maximally loaded A. maximum resistance on primary side and
Ans. B least resistance on secondary side
B. least resistance on primary side and
Que. If the supply frequency in transformer is maximum resistance on secondary side
doubled, then C. equal resistance on primary and secondary
A. hysteresis loss also doubles side
B. eddy current loss also doubles D. no ohmic resistance on either side
C. iron losses doubles Ans. D
D. copper losses doubles
Ans. A Que. A transformer does not raise or lower
the voltage of DC supply because
Que. Hysteresis loss in transformer depends A. there is no need to change the DC voltage
on B. DC circuit has more losses
A. both voltage and frequency C. Faradays laws of electromagnetic
B. voltage alone induction become invalid since the rate of
Jo
on
B
C. frequency alone
winding
-T
D. none of these
el
D. core of stainless steel and winding of pure Que. Negative voltage regulation is indicative
in
B. inductive only
Que. In a practical transformer core losses C. inductive or resistive
P U
because Ans. A
TE
constant A. frequency
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Ans. B
transformer is zero even at full
in
load
@
Ans. B
el
termed as
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Que. Increase in secondary current of D. primary mmf smaller than secondary mmf
transformer brings about increase in primary Ans. A
current . This is possible
because Que. Positive voltage regulation occurs in
A. primary and secondary windings are case of transformer for
capacitively coupleD. A. capacitive load
B. primary and secondary windings are B. resistive load only
inductively coupled C. inductive load only
C. primary and secondary windings are D. either inductive or resistive load
conductively coupled Ans. D
D. none of these
Ans. B Que. Cooling of transformer is required so as
to
Que. Transformer for constant voltage A. increase efficiency
application is considered good if its voltage B. reduce losses
regulation is C. reduce humming
A. low D. dissipate the heat generated in the winding
B. high Ans. D
C. zero
D. none of these Que. The transformer efficiency will be
Ans. C maximum at a power factor of
A. 0.8 pf lead
Que. Transformer action needs that the B. unity
magnetic flux linking with the winding must C. 0.8 lag
be D. 0.5 lag or lead
A. constant Ans. B
B. pulsating
C. alternating Que. The regulations of two transformers are
D. none of these (i) 3% and (ii) 97%. The one with better
Ans. C regulation is
A. second
Que. Low voltage windings are placed next B. first
to the core to reduce C. both are same
A. Hysteresis loss D. depends on loading
Jo
C. insulation requirement
D. copper loss Que. At relatively light loads, the transformer
@
SP
Que. The relation between the primary and B. transformer losses are high
B
transformer output
C
A. exactly equal
H
Que. A dielectric material must be Que. Electric field intensity at any point in an
A. resistor electric field is equal to
B. Insulator A. potential gradient
C. Conductor B. (potential gradient)2
D. Semiconductor C. (potential gradient)1/2
Ans. B D. (potential
gradient)1/3 Ans. A
Que. The energy stored in a capacitor is given
by Que. The lines of forces due to isolated
A. C2 V charged particles are
B. CV 2 /2 A. always straight
C. C2 V/2 B. always curved
D. CV C. sometimes curved
Ans. B D. none of the above
Ans. A
Que. Electrolytic capacitors can be used
for Que. The direction of electric field due to
A. ac only positive charge is
B. dc only A. away from the charge
C. both ac and dc B. towards the charge
D. 50 Hz ac C. both (a) and (b)
Ans. B D. none of the above
Ans. A
law Ans. C
A. F= Q 1 Q 2 / εo εrd 2
P U
C. F= Q1 Q 2 / 4 εo εrd 2 affected by
TE
C. thickness of plates
el
Ans. A
C. E = 𝝅D
@
SP
grows linearly
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
medium D. electrolytic
in
A. permeability Ans. D
B. permittivity
@
SP
Ans. B A. air
B
B. paper
TE
A. ½ CV2
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Ans. C C. Farad
TE
D. Coulomb
C
H
is
el
A. 0
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Que. One Coulomb charge equals the charge phase transformer, the secondary full load
on
@
current is
SP
B. 9090.9 Amp
U
D. none of these
TE
D. 9.09 Amp
Ans. A
C
Ans. C
H
-T
capacitor is given as
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Ans. C
SP
A. 200 W Ans. A
-T
B. 285.71 W
el
C. 408.16W
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Ans. B B. 4 Joule
in
C. 6 Joule
Que. A 20 mF capacitor is in series with a
@
D. 8 Joule
SP
B. 3 S be
C
H
C. 6 S A. 800 µC
-T
D. 2.4 S B. 900 µC
el
Ans. B C. 1200 µC
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
D. 1600 µC A. 5.33
Ans. C B. 2
C. 3
Que. The relative permittivity of a material is D. 0.48
10. Its absolute permittivity will be Ans. D
A.
B. Que. A 10 µF capacitor in series with an 1
C. MΩ resistor is connected across a100 V dc
D. supply. The time constant of the circuit
Ans. A is .
A. 10 sec
Que. An air capacitor has the same B. 0.1 sec
dimensions that of a mica capacitor. If the C. 10mSec
capacitance of mica capacitor is 6 times that D. 100 Sec
of air capacitor, then relative permittivity of Ans. A
mica is
A. 36 Que. A 10 µF capacitor in series with an 1
B. 12 MΩ resistor is connected across a100 V dc
C. 3 supply. The initial value of charging current
D. 6 is .
Ans. D A. 1mA
B. 0.1 mA
Que. Two capacitors of capacitance C 1 and C. 0.01mA
C2 are connected in parallel. A charge Q D. 1.00A
given to them is shared. The ratio of charges Ans. B
Q 1 /Q 2 is .
A. C2 / C1 Que. A 10 µF capacitor in series with an 1
B. C1 / C2 MΩ resistor is connected across a100 V dc
C. C1 C2 supply. The capacitor voltage after a time
D. 1/ C1 C2 equal to the time constant is
Ans. B A. 36V
B. 36.6V
Que. Two capacitors have capacitances 25 µF C. 63.2V
when in parallel and 6 µF when in series. D. 63 V
Jo
A. 12 µF and 13 µF
Que. A fully charged capacitor of 10 µF has
@
B. 15 µF and 10 µF
SP
is .
TE
Ans. A
in
B. 0.00295 x 10-6 F
el
C. 0.0295 x 10-6 F
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
the plates is 2.5 cm. If the insulating medium Que. A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase
P
D. none of these
@
Ans. B
Que. A 10 µF capacitor in series with an 1
SP
single phase transformer has 1500 turns on its supply. The initial rate of rise of voltage
B
B. 10V/s
H
area of core is
-T
C. 0.01V/s
A. 16.516 x 10–3 m2
el
D. 1V/s
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
by Joshi Sir
is second.
@
polarity at B. 0.005
P
D. none of the
-T
above Ans. C
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Que. The form factor of a sine wave is Que. The ac system is preferred to dc system
A. 1.01 because
B. 1.11 A. ac voltages can be easily changed in
C. 1.21 magnitude
D. none of the above B. dc motors do not have fine speed control
Ans. B C. high voltage ac transmission is less
efficient
Que. A current is said to be alternating when D. dc voltage can not be used for domestic
it changes in appliances
A. magnitude only Ans. A
B. direction only
C. both magnitude and direction Que. In ac system, we generate sine
D. neither magnitude nor direction waveform because
Ans. C A. it can be easily drawn
B. it produces least disturbance in electrical
Que. An alternating current of 50 Hz circuits
frequency and 100 A maximum value is C. it is nature‟s standard
given by D. other waves can not be produced easily
A. Ans. B
B.
C. √ Que. will work only on dc
D. √ supply.
Ans. B A. electric lamp
B. refrigerator
Que. An alternating current is given by the C. electroplating
expression D. heater
) amperes. Ans. C
The maximum value and frequency of the
current are _ Que. will produce ac voltage.
A. 200 A, 50 Hz A. friction
B. 100√2, 50 Hz B. photoelectric effect
C. 200 A, 100 Hz C. thermal energy
D. 200 A, 25 Hz D. crystal
Ans. A Ans. D
Jo
be
SP
B. 90°
U
A. one
B
C. 135° B. two
TE
D. 60° C. four
C
Ans. B
H
D. eight
-T
Ans. C
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Que. A sine wave has a maximum value of Que. An alternating current whose average
20 V. Its value at 135° is value is 1 A will produce 1 A dc
A. 10 V under similar conditions.
B. 14.14 V A. less heat than
C. 15 V B. more heat than
D. 5 V C. the same heat as
Ans. B D. none of the above
Ans. B
Que. An alternating voltage is given by
.The time taken by the Que. A sinusoidal alternating current has a
voltage to reach 30 V for the first time maximum value of I m. Its average value will
is be
A. 0.02 second
A.
B. 0.1 second
C. 0.03 second B.
D. 0.005 second C.
Ans. D D. none of the above
Ans. C
Que. A sinusoidal current has a magnitude of
3 A at 120°. Its maximum value will be Que. The area of a sinusoidal wave over a
A. √3 A
half-cycle is
B. √ A A.
C. 2√3 A B.
D. 6 A C.
Ans. C D.
Jo
Ans. B
in
Ans. B Ans. C
-T
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Ans. A C. 270°
D. none of the above
P U
V. Its frequency
Que. The rms value of sinusoidally varying
C
A. more than
el
C. same as Ans. B
D. none of the above
Ans. A Que. The filament of a vacuum tube requires
0.4A dc to heat it. The rms value of ac
Que. Alternating voltages and currents are required is
expressed in rms values because _ A. √ A
A. they can be easily determined B. A
B. calculations become very simple C. √ A
C. they give comparison with dc D. 0.4 A
D. none of the above Ans. D
Ans. C
Que. A100 V peak ac is as effective
Que. The average value of sin2 θ over a as dc
complete cycle is A. 100 V
A. +1 B. 50 V
B. -1 C. 70.7 V
C. D. none of the above
D. zero Ans. C
Ans. C
Que. The form factor of a wave is
Que. The average value of sinθ over a 1.
complete cycle is A. sinusoidal
A. zero B. square
B. +1 C. triangular
C. -1 D. sawtooth
D. Ans. B
Ans. A Que. Out of the following wave is
the peakiest.
Que. An alternating current is given by A. sinusoidal
. The average value of squared B. square
wave of this current over a complete cycle C. rectangualr
is D. triangular
A. I 2 m/2 Ans. D
B. I m/π
Jo
C. 2I m/π
in
is
SP
Ans. A A. 1.11
P
B. 1.414
U
is
TE
D. 1.5
A. 1.414
C
Ans. B
B. 1.11
H
-T
C. 2
el
D. 1.5
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Ans. A
B. rms voltage
in
C. peak voltage
Que. For the same peak value which of the
@
A. 127.4V
H
C. 282.8V Ans. A
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Que. For a sine wave with peak value I max , Que. An ac voltage of 50 Hz has a maximum
the rms value is value of 50 V. Its value after 1/600 second
A. 0.5I max after the instant the current is zero will
B. 0.707I max be
C. 0.9I max A. 5V
D. 1.414I ma B. 12.5V
x Ans. B C. 25V
D. 43.8V
Que. Form factor is the ratio of Ans. C
A. average value/rms value
B. average value/peak value Que. For 200V rms value triangular wave, the
C. rms value/average value peak voltage will be
D. rms value/peak value A. 200V
Ans. C B. 222V
C. 282V
Que. For a sine wave with peak value E max , D. 346V
the average value is Ans. D
A. 0.636Emax
B. 0.707Emax Que. The rms value of a half-wave rectified
C. 0.434Emax current is 100 A. Its value for full-wave
D. 1.414Ema rectification would be amperes.
x Ans. A A. 141.4
B. 200
Que. The current in a circuit is given by: C. 200/π
amperes. The maximum D. 40/π
value and frequency of current are Ans. A
A. 50√2 A, 100 Hz
B. 100√2 A, 100 Hz Que. The rms value of a sinusoidal ac current
C. 100 A, 50 Hz is equal to its value at an angle of
D. 70.7 A, 50 Hz degrees.
Ans. C A. 90
B. 60
Que. For a frequency of 200 Hz, the time C. 45
period will be D. 30
Jo
A. 0.05 S Ans. C
in
B. 0.005 S
C. 0.0005 S Que. The rms value of alternating current is
@
SP
time produces
B
Que. The square waveform of current has Que. The negative maximum of a cosine
following relation between rms value and wave occurs at
average value: A. 30°
A. rms value is equal to average value B. 45°
B. rms value of current is greater than C. 90°
average value D. 180°
C. rms value of current is less than average Ans. D
value
D. none of the above Que. The rms value of pure cosine function
Ans. A is
A. 0.5 of peak value
Que. If a sinusoidal wave has frequency of 50 B. 0.707 of peak value
Hz with 30A rms current, which of the C. same as peak value
following equation represents the wave? D. zero
A. Ans. B
B.
C.
D. Que. An alternating voltage is given in volts
Ans. A by expression . Its rms
value and frequency are
Que. Which of the following waves has the A. 230V,50 Hz
highest value of peak factor? B. 230V,100 Hz
A. square wave C. 326V,50 Hz
B. sine wave D. 326V,100 Hz
C. half wave rectified sine wave Ans. A
D. triangular wave
Ans. C Que. According to which of the alternating
current values in the cross sectional area of a
Que. The frequency of domestic power conductor with regard to the heating effect is
Jo
B. 100 Hz
SP
C. 60 Hz C. average value
D. 50 Hz D. rms value
P U
Ans. D Ans. D
B
TE
Que. The rms value of half wave rectified Que. The frequency of an alternating current
C
H
wave rectified ac will be A. the speed with which the alternator runs
el
A. 282.8V
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
B. the number of cycles generated in one Que. A constant current of 2.8A exists in a
minute resistor. The rms value of current is
C. the number of waves passing through a A. 2.8 A
point in one second B. about 2 A
D. the number of electrons passing through a C. 1.4 A
point in one second D. undefined
Ans. C Ans. A
Que. The average value of an unsymmetrical Que. The size (cross-sectional area) of a
@
alternating quantity is calculated over conductor, with regard to the heating effect,
SP
A. average value
B
B. half cycle
TE
Ans. C
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
B. time
Que. The form factor for dc supply voltage is C. time period
always D. all above
A. zero Ans. C
B. unity
C. infinity
D. any value between 0 and 1
Ans. B
phasor diagram.
C. 3T/4
A. Same
@
D. T/4
SP
B. Different
Ans. C
C. multiple
P U
D. all above
B
A. phase
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Que. The difference between the of Que. If v = Vm Sin ωtand i = Im Sin (ωt-Φ),
two alternating quantities is called the phase the „v‟ is said to „i‟ by angle Φ
difference. A. in phase
A. time B. lagging
B. phase angle C. leading
C. Lengths D. all above
D. both a and b Ans. C
Ans. B
Que. The difference between the phase of Que. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ),
two alternating quantities is called the „i‟ is said to „v‟ by angle Φ
the . A. in phase
A. phase difference B. lagging
B. sinedifference C. leading
C. length difference D. all above
D. none of the above Ans. C
Ans. A
Que. If v = Vm Sin ωtand i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ),
Que. When phase difference between the two the „v‟ is said to „i‟ by angle Φ
alternating quantities is zero, the two A. in phase
Jo
A. tandom C. lead
B. length
@
D. all above
SP
C. phase Ans. B
D. time
P U
phasors indicating exact phase relationship is Que. In purely circuit, current lags
called voltage by 90 degrees.
PU
A. graph A. resistive
B
Ans. C Ans. B
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
A. resistance proportional to .
B. capacitance A. time
@
SP
C. reactance B. phase
D. permeance C. frequency
P U
Ans. C
TE
C. starter A. lags
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
B. leads
C. in phase Que. Pure never consumes power
D. all above A. resistor
Ans. B B. capacitor
C. starter
Que. In purely capacitive circuit, current D. circuit
leads voltageby degrees. Ans. B
A. 30
B. 60 Que. Inductive reactance is given by
C. 90 A. X C=1/ωC
D. 120 B. X C=1/2𝝅C
Ans. C C. XC=1/ΦC
D. XC=2𝝅fL
Que. The capacitor offers reactance to Ans. A
DC.
A. high Que. is given by XC=1/ωL
B. low A. resistance
C. zero B. inductance
D. none of the above C. inductive reactance
Ans. A D. capacitive reactance
Ans. D
Que. The offers infinite reactance
to DC Que. Capacitive reactance is measured in
A. resistance
B. permeance A. farads
C. capacitance B. henrys
D. none of the above C. ohms
Ans. C D. joules
Ans. C
Que. The capacitance offers infinite
to DC Que. Capacitive reactance is to
A. resistance frequency.
B. capacitance A. inversely proportional
C. reactance B. directly proportional
Jo
D. permeance C. both
in
Ans. A
SP
A. sine A. time
TE
B. square B. phase
C
H
C. tringular C. frequency
-T
Ans. A Ans. C
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
D. leads, 45 degrees
B
A. 90,270 Ans. B
B. 90,90
C. 90,180 Que. The phase difference between two
D. 270,90 waveforms can be compared when they
Ans. A
A. have the same frequency
Que. The p. f. of purely resistive circuit is B. have the same peak value
C. have the same effective value
A. zero D. are sinusoidal
B. unity Ans. A
C. lagging
D. leading Que. If two sinusoids of the same frequency
Ans. B but of different amplitude and phase
difference are added, the resultant is a
Que. If e1 = 100 sin(2πf) and e2 = 100
sin(2πf-Φ), then A. sinusoid of same frequency
A. e1 lags e2 by Φ B. sinusoid of double the original frequency
B. e1 leads e2 by Φ C. sinusoid of half the original frequency
C. e2 lags e1 by Φ D. non-sinusoid
D. none of the above Ans. A
Ans. C
Que. A constant current of 2.8 A exists in a
Que. The average power in a purely inductive resistor. The rms value of current is
or capacitive circuit over a cycle A. 2.8 A
A. depends on X Lor X C B. 2 A
B. is negative C. 1.4 A
C. is zero D. undefined
D. is positive Ans. A
Ans. C
Que. The power factor of an ordinary bulb is
Que. Inductive reactance of an AC circuit
increases with A. zero
A. increase in frequency B. unity
B. increase in resistance C. more than unity
C. decrease in resistance
Jo
Ans. A
@
will be degrees. A. 90
TE
A. 45 B. 180
C
B. 90 C. 270
H
D. 60 Ans. C
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
A. 7 A
Que. If the phasor is multiplied by j, then B. 5 A
C. 1 A
A. only its magnitude changes D. 1.33 A
B. only its direction changes Ans. B
C. both magnitude and direction change
D. none of the above Que. The voltage applied in a circuit is given
Ans. B by 100 60 volts. It can be written as
A. 100 -60
Que. In the complex number 4+j7, 7 is called B. 100 240
the component C. 100 -300
A. real D. none of the above
B. imaginary Ans. C
C. in-phase
D. none of the above Que. The conjugate of -4+j3 is
Ans. D A. 4-j3
B. -4-j3
Que. The reciprocal of a complex number is C. 4+j3
a D. none of the above
A. complex number Ans. B
B. real component only
C. quadrature component only Que. The difference of two conjugate number
D. none of above results in
Ans. A A. a complex number
B. in-phase component only
Que. If two complex numbers are equal, C. quadrature component only
then D. none of the above
A. only their magnitudes will be equal Ans. C
B. only their angles will be equal
C. their in phase and quadrature components Que. The reciprocal of j is
will be separately equal A. j
D. none of above B. -j
Ans. C C. jxj
D. none of the above
Jo
B. -j2
SP
D. 2 A. 360
B
Ans. C B. 180
TE
C. 90
C
D. 0
through a circuit. The magnitude of current is
-T
Ans. B
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
C. takes power from the line during some part D. an instrument used for measuring phases
in
of cycle and returns back during other part of of an unbalanced 3 phase load
cycle Ans. B
@
SP
except
B
A. resistive C. resistance
-T
B. pureinductive D. capacitance
el
A. voltageV 2 leads voltageV 1 by 180 degrees Que. The length of a phasor in a phasor
@
Ans. A
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Que. The two quantities are said to be in C. product of peak values of current and
phase with each other when voltage
A. the phase difference between two D. product of rms or effective values of
quantities is zero degree or radian current and voltage
B. each of them pass through zero values at Ans. D
the same instant and rise in the same
direction Que. The power factor of an ac circuit is
C. each of them pass through zero values at equal to
the same instant but rises in the opposite A. tangent of the phase angle
directions B. sine of phase angle
D. either (a) or (b) C. unity for a resistive circuit
Ans. D D. unity for a reactive circuit
Ans. C
Que. The phase difference between the two
waveforms can be compared only when they Que. The phasor diagram of voltage and
A. have the same frequency current considering phasors are rotates
B. have the same peak value anticlockwise direction is of
C. have the same effective value
D. are sinusoidal I
Ans. A
V
Que. The phasor diagram for alternating
quantities can be drawn if they have ………
waves A. pure resistance
A. rectangular B. pure inductance
B. sinusoidal C. pure capacitance
C. triangular D. pure capacitance and pure inductance
D. any of these Ans. C
Ans. B
Que. The phasor diagram of voltage and
Que. Which of the following statements current considering phasors are rotates
associated with purely resistive circuits is clockwise direction is of
correct?
A. PF is unity
I
Jo
D. PF is zero
SP
Ans. A
A. Pure resistance
P U
voltage
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Que. The power factor of an ac circuit lies Que. The average value of the current
between from to is
A. 0 and 1 A. 400 π
B. -1 and 1
C. 0 and -1 B.
D. none of these C.
Ans. A D.
Que. The period of a certain sine wave is 10 Ans. B
milliseconds. Its frequency is
A. 10 MHz Que. An alternating current is given by
B. 10 KHz The time taken to generate
C. 10 Hz two cycles of current is
D. 100 Hz A. 0.02 second
Ans. D B. 0.01 second
C. 0.04 second
Que. The rms value of a sine wave of D. 0.05 second
maximum value 10A equals a dc current of Ans. C
ampere.
A. 7.07 Que. A sine wave has a frequency of 50 Hz.
B. 6.37 Its angular frequency
C. 5 is radian/second
D. 5.77 A. 100π
Ans. A B. 50π
C. 25π
Que. The rms value of a sinusoidal voltage D. 5π
with peak-to-peak value of 240 V Ans. A
is V.
A. 84.84 Que. A sine wave of voltage varies from zero
B. 77.82 to maximum of 200V. How much is the
C. 94.68 voltage at theinstant of 30° of the cycle?
D. 89.15 A. 50V
Ans. A B. 82.8V
C. 100V
D. 173.2V
Jo
Ans. C
in
A. 254.6
B. 282.6 200V bulb take from the 200V, 50Hz power
P
line?
U
C. 400
B
D. 565.5 A. 0.5 A
TE
Ans. A B. 1.5 A
C
C. 2 A
H
D. 3 A
-T
el
Ans. B
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
B. 70.7106 30 v
C. 61.2371 35.3553 i
D. 70.710+ j30 0
=t
Ans. B
Que. RMS value of current I = 25 + j40 Amp Que. The curve for the instantaneous power
is with respect to the waveforms of voltage &
A. 57.99 current is shown in figure is of
B. 47.1699
P P
C. 60 + +
v
D. 30 i
Ans. B 0
2
= t
2
I 1 /I 2 =
A. 5.5596+ j4.924 A A. pure resistance
B. 2150 A B. pure inductance
C. 7.296+ j12.58 A C. pure capacitance
D. None of the above D. purecapaciatance and pure inductance
Ans. B Ans. B
Jo
Que. A 10 mH inductor carries a sinusoidal Que. The curve for the instantaneous power
in
current of 1 A at frequency of 50 Hz. The with respect to the waveforms of voltage &
current is shown in figure is of
@
A. 0
P
P P
U
+ +
B. 3.14 W
B
v
TE
C. 0.5 W 0
i
= t
D. 1 W
C
2 2
H
Ans. A
-T
- -
P P
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
Ans. A
D. 16.36 A, 12.2 A
in
Ans. C
@
I 1 +I 2 = B. 1000 W
TE
B. 5.55964.924 A
H
D. 100 W
C. 7.296+ j12.58 A
-T
Ans. A
el
Que. If a 10 ohm resistance is connected to Que. A sinusoidal voltage varies from zero
an AC supply v = 100 sin (314t+370 ) V, the to a maximum of 250 V. The voltage at the
power dissipated by the resistance is instant of 60° of the cycle will be
A. 10 kW A. 150 V
B. 1 kW B. 216.5 V
C. 500 W C. 125 V
D. 250 W D. 108.25 V
Ans. C Ans. B
Que. A coil has X L = 1000 ohm. If both its Que. The alternating voltage
inductance and frequency are doubled, its is applied to a device which
reactance will become ohm offers an ohmic resistance of 20 Ω to the flow
A. 2000 of current in one direction while entirely
B. 500 preventing the flow in the opposite direction.
C. 250 The average value of the current will
Jo
D. 4000 be
in
Ans. D A. 5 A
@
B. 3.18 A
SP
D. the statement given is false the time taken by the current to reach +10 V
el
condition*
D. Homogeneity, superposition and 7. Which of the following is an active
@
SP
A. Branch
H
-T
B. Loop*
el
C. Circuit
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
A. Unilateral elements
B. Nonlinear elements
C. Passive elements*
D. Active elements
A. Open-circuited
B. Short-circuited*
C. Replaced by some resistance
D. Replaced by inductor
A. Value of resistor
Jo
B. Value of current
in
linear element?
TE
C
H
A. Gas diode
-T
B. Heater coil*
el
C. Tunnel diode
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
be
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
21. In a series parallel circuit, any two 26. Kirchhoff's current law is applicable to
resistance in the same current path must only
be in
A. Junction in a network*
A. Series with each other* B. Closed loops in a network
B. Parallel with each other C. Electric circuits
C. Series with the voltage source
D. Parallel with the voltages source
A. A voltage source*
B. A current source
C. Both of above
D. None of the above
A. Open-circuited*
B. Short-circuited
P U
C. Replaced by a capacitor
B
incorrect?
el
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
D. Electronic circuits
32. The circuit having some properties in
27. Kirchhoff's current law states that either direction is known as circuit
A. Junction cards
B. Battery e.m.fs
C. IR drops
D. Both B and C*
A. Negative
B. Positive
C. Determined by battery e.m.fs.
D. Zero*
circuits with
B
TE
A. Distributed parameters*
C
H
B. Lumped parameters
-T
C. Passive elements
el
D. Non-linear resistances
eg
ra
m
AMRUTVAHINI COLLEGE OF ENGINEERING SANGAMNER
DEPARTMENT OF ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
BEE MCQs
Prepared by Prof. Atul A. Joshi
A. Series
B. Parallel*
C. Both series and parallel
D. None of the above
Eth*
in
@
terminals
el
eg
ra
m
B. Linear,non-linear resistors only
C. Linear responses only* 45. Which law plays a significant role in
D. None of the above the loop analysis of the network?
a. KCL
40. The superposition theorem applicable to b. KVL*
c. Law of Superposition Theorem
A. Voltage only d. None of the above
B. Current only 46. How is the loop analysis different in
C. Both current and voltage* application/functioning level as
D. Current, voltage and power compared to Kirchoff’s law?
a. Utilization of loop currents instead of
41. The superposition theorem requires as branch currents for writing equations
many circuits to be solved as there are b. Capability of branch current to carry
multiple networks
A. Sources, nodes and meshes c. Reduction in the number of unknowns for
B. Sources and nodes complex networks
C. Sources* d. All of the above*
D. Nodes
47. Which is the correct sequential order of
42. Superposition theorem is not applicable steps to be undertaken while applying
for Thevenin’s theorem?
A. Calculation of Thevenin‟s equivalent
A. Voltage calculations voltage
B. Bilateral elements B. Removal of branch resistance through
C. Power calculations* which required current is to be estimated
D. Passive elements C. Estimation of equivalent resistance
between two terminals of the branch
43. In any linear network, the elements like D. Estimation of branch current by schematic
inductor, resistor and capacitor always representation of Thevenin‟s equivalent
circuit
a. Exhibit changes due to change in a. A, C, B, D
temperature b. B, A, C, D*
b. Exhibit changes due to change in voltage c. D, A, C, B
c. Exhibit changes due to change in time d. B, C, D, A
d. Remains constant irrespective of change in
temperature, voltage and time * 48. If a resistor R x is connected between
nodes X and Y, R y between X and Y, R z
44. Which type of networks allow the between Y and Z to form a delta
Jo
d. Bilateral Networks
C
H
85
-T
el
eg
ra
m
49. If the resistors of star connected system
are R1 , R2 , R3 then the resistance between
1 and 2 in delta connected system will be?
a) (R1 R2 + R2 R3 + R3 R1 )/R3 *
b) (R1 R2 + R2 R3 + R3 R1)/R1
c) (R1 R2 + R2 R3 + R3 R1 )/R2
d) (R1 R2 + R2 R3 + R3 R1 )/(R1 +R2)
a) 30
b) 31
c) 32*
d) 33
shown below d) 7
@
SP
86
-T
el
eg
ra
m
c) 9
d) 9.5
a) 0.5
b) 0
c) 1 a) 0.333
d) 1.5* b) 3.33
c) 33.3*
59. Consider the circuit shown below. Find the d) 333
equivalent Thevenin‟s voltage between nodes 63. Find the equivalent thevenin‟s resistance
A and B. between terminals A and B in the circuit
shown.
a) 333
b) 33.3
c) 3.33*
d) 0.333
Jo
a) 8
@
a) 5
B
b) 15
TE
C
H
87
-T
el
eg
ra
m
c) 25*
d) 35
A) 0.1
b) 0.2
c) 0.3
d) 0.4
a) 6
b) 6.25 Polyphase AC Circuits
c) 6.5
1. Power in a Three Phase Circuit = .
d) 6.75*
a) P = 3 V Ph IPh CosФ
b) P = √3 V L IL CosФ
66. Determine the equivalent thevenin‟s voltage
c) Both 1 & 2.
between terminals „a‟ and „b‟ in the circuit
shown below. d) None of The Above
ans: c
2. A polyphase system is generated by ?
a) Having two or more generator windings
separated by equal electrical angle.
b) Having generator windings at equal distances
c) None of the above
a) 0.7
d) A and C
b) 1.7
c) 2.7* ans: a
d) 3.7 3. In a three phase AC circuit, the sum of all three
ans: b
TE
C
H
88
-T
el
eg
ra
m
5. For a star connection network, consuming
9. In the ABOVE question, determine the phase
power of a)8kW and power factor 0.5, the current IY.
inductance and resistance of each coil at a supply a)44.74 183.4⁰A
voltage of 230 Volts, 60 Hz is ? b)45.74 183.4⁰A
a) 0.1H, 8 Ohms c)44.74 183.4⁰A
b) 0.5H, 10 Ohms d) 45.74 -183.4⁰A
c) 0.3H, 7.4 Ohms ans: C
d) 1H, 7 Ohms
10. Determine the power (kW) drawn by the load)
a)21
ans: c
b)22
6. For a star connected three phase AC circuit —— c)23
a) Phase voltage is equal to line voltage and d)24
phase current is three times the line current
ans: d
b) Line voltage is square root three times phase 11. In a balanced three-phase system-delta load, if
voltage and phase current is equal to line
we assume the line voltage is V RY = V 0⁰ as a
current
reference phasor. Then the source voltage V YB is?
c) Phase voltage is equal to line voltage and line
a) V 0⁰
current is equal to phase current
b) V -120⁰
d) None of the above
c) V 120⁰
ans: b d) V 240⁰
ans: c
U
ans: a
B
TE
C
H
89
-T
el
eg
ra
m
14. For delta-connected circuit the correct
relationship is……….. 19. A 3 – φ delta connected symmetrical load
a) VL = Vph consumes P Watts of power from a balanced
b) Iph x √ 3 = IL supply. If the same load is connected in star to the
c) VL = IL x √ 3 same supply then what is the power
d) Both A and B consumption?
ans: d a)P/3
b)3P
15. Three unequal impedances are connected in c)2P
delta to a three phase, three wire system
d) 0.5P
a) The voltage across the three phases will be
different ans: a
b) Both of the phase current and line currents
will be unbalanced 20. In a balanced star connected system the line
c) Phase current will be unbalanced but line voltages are ahead of their respective phase
currents will be balanced voltages by .
d) None of the above a)30o
ans: b b)60o
c)120o
16. To rated voltage of a three phase power d) None of these
system is given as……….
ans: a
a) RMS phase voltage
b) Peak phase voltage
c) RMS line to line voltage
d) Peak line to line voltage
ans: c Batteries
1. The capacity of a battery is expressed in terms
of
17. Condition for a balanced 3 - phase load is that, A. Current rating
each phase has the same value of . B. Voltage rating
a)Impedance C. Ampere hour rating
b)Resistance D. None of the above
2. To prevent local action in battery, only
c)Power-factor
............is used in electrolytes
d) All of these A. Pump water
ans: d B. Distilled water
C. Tap water
D. Both A and C
18. Phase voltages of a star connected alternator 3. When two batteries are connected in parallel,
are ER = 240 0o V, EY = 240 -- 120o V and EB = it should be ensured that
240 + 120o V. What is the phase sequence of the A. They have same emf
Jo
electrolytic cells.
d) YBR
U
A. True
B
ans: a B. False
TE
C
H
90
-T
el
eg
ra
m
5. Number of cells connected in series provide a D. Pbo2
—– 14. Which of the following battery will burst if
A. High current carrying capacity separator get damaged
B. Higher Voltage A. dry cell
C. Higher power B. zinc chloride cell
D. None of the above C. lithium ion battery
6. Number of cells connected in parallel provide D. lead acid battery
a——- 15. Amp-hr capacity of battery during discharge is
A. High current carrying capacity 30 amp-hr and during charging its 10 amp-hr
B. Higher Voltage then efficiency of battery is
C. Higher power A. 0.3
D. None of the above B. 3
7. The electrode for a battery must be C. 300
A. A semi conductor D. None of the above
B. An insulator 16. If 200 amp-hr battery is discharged at 90 amp
C. A good conductor of electricity for 30 minutes then depth of discharge is
D. A bad conductor of electricity A. 23.5%
8. Each cell has a vent plug B. 22.5%
A. To allow gases out when the cell is on C. 20%
charge D. 60%
B. To add water to the cell if needed 17. Parallel grouping of battery is used for to
C. To check the level of electrolyte increase… .... capacity
D. To do all above functions A. Current
9. Which of the following cell is rechargeable B. Voltage
A. dry cell C. Both current and voltage
B. zinc chloride cell D. None of the above
C. primary cell 18. Series grouping of battery is used for to
D. lead acid battery increase… .... capacity
A. Current
10. Colour of Positive plate in lead acid battery is B. Voltage
A. Dark chocolate brown C. Both current and voltage
B. Grey colour D. None of the above
C. Pink colour 19. Series and Parallel grouping of battery is used
D. Black colour for to increase… .... capacity
11. In lithium ion battery seprator is made up A. Current
from B. Voltage
A. H2so4 C. Both current and voltage
B. Lead D. None of the above
C. Polymer film 20. Positive plate of lead acid battery is made up
D. Pbo2 from
12. In lithium ion battery electron flow during A. Lead peroxide
charging is B. Pure lead
A. Anode to cathode C. Copper
Jo
C. None of the above 21. Positive plate of Lithium ion battery is made
@
C. Polymer film
TE
C
H
91
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
UNIT-I
FUNDAMENTALS OF ELECTRICITY
change the temp. of a given substance without 10. Which effect of electric current is utilized in
in
14. MOTOR-PUMP SET is the example of which 20. Effective water head of a Hydro-electric
system power plant means it’s
a. Electro-mechanical system a. loss
b. Electro-chemical system b. height
c. Only electrical system c. friction
d. All above d. none of above
ans: a ans:b
ans: a ans:b
SP
P
U
16. One metre cube holds a water of 22. Wind-mill-Generator set is the example of
B
b.526Ω ans:d
SP
c. 62.5Ω
PU
resistor is:
C
H
a.198J
@
a. 600C ans: b
B
b. 100C
TE
d. 60C a.0.0032
-T
el
d. 10KW ans:b
SP
ans: d
P U
resistor is
-T
el
ρ
b. Ri=2πl 𝑙𝑛(R2/R1) d. all of above
c. Ri=
ρ
(R2/R1) ans: b
2πl
d. none of above
60. Factors affecting the insulation resistance of
ans:b
a cable are
a. length
55. As the thickness of insulation layer of a
b. thickness
cable increases, it’s insulation resistance will
c. resistivity of insulating material
a. increase
d. all above
b. decrease
ans:d
c. remain same
d. none of above
61. If length of cable is doubled, then its
ans: a
insulation resistance will
a. reduce by 25%
56. As the Temperature of surrounding
b. reduce by 50%
increases the insulation resistance will
c. increase by 50%
a. increase
d. reduce by 55%
b. remain same
ans:b
c. decrease
d. none of above
62 .If two cables with their insulation
ans: c
resistances Ri1 and Ri2 are joined in series, then
their equivalent resistance will be
57. Which is a good conductor of electricity?
a. Ri1 + Ri2
a. normal tap water
b. Ri1 - Ri2
b. pure water
c. Ri1 / Ri2
c. glass
d. (Ri1.Ri2) / (Ri1 + Ri2)
d. plastic
ans:d
ans: b
ans:c
ans: a
in
@
b. increase
resistance will be
C
c. decrease
H
a. R1 + R2
-T
el
69. Resistance of material will decrease with 74. What will be the effect on the resistance of
increase of….. conducting material if the temperature
a. Length of material. increases?
b. Both Length and Cross-section area of a. No effect on resistance.
material. b. Resistance will increase.
c. Cross-section area of material. c. Resistance will decrease.
d. None of above. d. Resistance will remain same.
ans:c ans:b
Jo
in
70. According to Ohm’s law current in the 75. What will be the effect on the resistance of
@
a. Insulator. c. 0C.
P
d. Ώ/0C.
U
b. Conductor.
B
c. Semi-conductor. ans:b
TE
d. None of above.
C
H
ans:a
-T
el
b. 0.00423/0C. a. 1000C.
@
c.0.00324/0C. b. 1100C.
SP
d. 0.0000423/0C. c. 96.790C.
P
ans:b d. 98.790C.
U
B
ans:c
TE
b.1/16 ohm
in
c. 6.24x1016 electrons
U
B
a. manganin b. mechanical
in
b. porcelain c. electrical
@
c. carbon d. thermal
SP
d. copper ans:c
P U
ans:a
B
c. Q a. resistivity
d. t b. conductivity
ans:c c. permittivity
d. all above
117. The ability of a charged particle to do work ans:b
is called
a. potential difference 123. The material having poorest value of ____
b. electric potential is best insulator.
c. magnitude a. resistivity
d. magnetism b. conductivity
ans:b c. permittivity
d. all above
118. The unit of electric potential is ___ ans:b
a.amp
b. coulomb 124. The resistance of copper wire 25 m long is
c. volt found to be 50 Ω. If its diameter is 1mm, then
d. tesla resistivity of copper is ___
ans:c a.1.57 µΩ-m
b.1.57 Ω-m
119. 1 calorie = ___ c.15.7 Ω-m
a.4.186 joules d. none of the above
b.0.24 joules ans:a
c.41.86 joules
d. none of the above 125. Factors which affect the resistance _____
ans:a a. length of the material
b. cross sectional area
120. Unit of resistivity is ____ c. temperature
a. Ω d. all above
b. Ω-m ans:d
c. Ω/m
d. all above 126. Effect of temperature on resistance
ans:b depends on ____ of material
a. size
121. Unit of conductance is ___ b. shape
Jo
a. ohms c. nature
in
b. siemens d. length
@
c. newtons ans:c
SP
d. none of above
PU
temperature increases
TE
d. all above
in
a. current b. constantan
TE
b. voltage c. copper
C
H
140. Insulators have _______ temperature 144. Two underground cables A and B, each has
coefficient of resistance a conductor resistance of 0.6 Ω and 0.8 Ω resp.
a. positive each has insulation resistance of 600 MΩ and
b. negative 400 MΩ resp. if cables are connected in parallel,
c. zero its conductor resistance is ___
d. none of the above a.0.3428Ω
ans:b b.0.240 Ω
c.0.240 MΩ
141. Two underground cables A and B, each has d. 0.160 Ω
a conductor resistance of 0.6 Ω and 0.8 Ω resp. ans:a
each has insulation resistance of 600 MΩ and
400 MΩ resp. if cables are connected in series, 145. Match the pair
its conductor resistance is ___ 1. Resistance a. / 0C
a.1.2 MΩ 2. Insulation resistance b.siemens
b.1.2 Ω 3. RTC c.ohm
Jo
d. 1.6 Ω a. 1a,2-b,3-c,4-d
@
ans:c b.1-c,2-d,3-a,4-b
SP
c.1-d,2-c,3-b,4-a
P U
UNIT II
MAGNETIC CIRCUIT & ELECTROMAGNETIC INDUCTION
1. The complete path followed by the magnetic 6. Lines of force is also called
flux is called a. flux
a. electric circuit b. current
b. magnetic circuit c. resistance
c. electromagnetism d. flux density
d. electric field ans:a
ans: b
7. Lines of force passing per unit area is called
2. Current carrying conductor is always a. magnetic field
surrounded by b. magnetic flux
a. magnetic field c. magnetic flux density
b. electric field d. magnetic field strength
c. Electricity ans:c
d. current
ans: a 8. unit of flux is
a. weber
3. The direction of magnetic field produced by b. wb/m2
current carrying conductor is given by c. Tesla
a. Lenz’s law d. AT
b. right hand thumb rule ans:a
c. Fleming’s left hand rule
d. Kirchoff’s law 9. Unit of flux density is
ans: b a. wb/m2
b. wb
4. Imaginary lines of force originating from c. AT/wb
magnet is called d. A
a. current ans:a
b. resistance
c. flux 10. Unit of magnetic field
d. magnetic field a. wb/m2
ans: c b. wb
Jo
c. AT/wb
in
b. magnetic field
P U
d. resistance a. AT/wb
ans: b b. AT
C
H
-T
el
12. Opposition to the magnetic lines of force is 17. An air gap is usually inserted in a magnetic
called circuit
a. Flux a. to prevent saturation
b. resistance b. increase flux
c. susceptance c. decrease flux
d. reluctance d. increase mmf
ans:d ans: a
13. Unit of magnetic field strength is 18. A magnetic circuit requires 800 ampere
a. AT/m turns to produce a certain amount of flux. If
b. AT/wb exciting coil of 100 turns has 5 ohms resistance,
c.Tesla then the voltage to be applied to the exciting
d. ohms coil must be
ans: a a. 40V
b. 20 V
14. The force on two current carrying c.10V
conductors in the same direction d. 5V
a. have force of repulsion between them ans: a
b. have force of attraction between them
c. remains unaffected 19. Permeability of a material is the ratio of
d. none of above a. magnetic field to flux density
ans: b b. flux density to magnetic field strength
c. magnetic field strength to flux density
15. Magneto motive force is directly d. none of above
proportional to ans: b
a. no. of turns of coil
b. current through the coil 20. The term saturation related to magnetic
c. both a and b circuit means
d. none of above a. magnetic field strength increases with
ans: c current
Jo
16. The term permeability for a material means c. flux density remains constant if magnetic
@
b. the mmf required to produce one unit of d. magnetic field strength remains constant if
P U
through it
C
H
-T
el
21. The lines of force produced by coil b. does not vary with increasing the cross
completing their path through air, instead of sectional area
intended path is called c. decreases with increasing cross sectional area
a. useful flux of material
b. saturated flux d. decreases with increasing the length of
c. air flux material
d. leakage flux ans: c
ans: d
27. The correct relation stated as following is
𝑁
22. The bulging of lines of force in air gap in a a. ф =𝑙/𝑎µ0µ𝑟
magnetic circuit is called
b. NI = B× l/a µ0µr
a. leaking flux
c. N=H×l
b. merging
d. NI = ф × l/µ0µr a
c. fringing
ans: d
d. scattering
ans: c
28. The permeance in a magnetic circuit
corresponds to
23. Relative permeability of vacuum is
a. resistance in an electric circuit
a. 4π × 10-7 H/m
b. emf in an electric circuit
b. 1 H/m
c. conductivity in electric circuit
c.1
d. conductance in an electric circuit
d. ¼ H/m
ans: d
ans: c
c. conductivity
is 800 and ampere turns are 3200
in
ans: d
SP
b.2.5
P
c.4.0
U
ans:c
of material
C
H
-T
el
33.The force experienced by unit north pole 39. The magnitude of force experienced by
when placed at point in a magnetic field is current carrying conductor placed in magnetic
called field depends on
a. magnetic field strength at that point a. value of flux
b. exerted force at that point b. magnitude of current flowing through
c.flux conductor
d. magnetic field c. direction of current
ans:a d. all of above
ans: d
34. The mechanical force acting on current
carrying on conductor when placed in magnetic 40.Two current carrying conductor lying parallel
field is given by relation and close to each other. They are carrying
a. F= N dф/dt current in the opposite direction. The force
b. F= Blv sinӨ between them is
c. F= BIL sinӨ a. repulsive
d. F=L di/dt b. Attractive
ans: c c. Zero
d. none of these
35. Which of the following has the highest ans: a
magnetic permeability?
Jo
ans: c a. repulsive
B
b. Attractive
TE
d. H=NI/l ans: b
P U
ans: c
B
54. Right hand thumb rule is used to find out of solenoid must be
B
d. 0
in
67
SP
A coil is wound uniformly with 300 turns over 70. Which of the following is non magnetic
P U
d. Silicon steel
ans: c 76. A strength of an electromagnet is
determined by
71. Which of the following is magnetic material? a. reluctance
a. copper b. permeability of the core
b. silicon steel c.mmf
c. aluminium d. all of above
d. brass ans: d
ans: b
77. The strength of the magnetic field around a
72. Flux in the air gap is called conductor is directly proportional to
a. leakage flux a. voltage across the conductor
b. total flux b. current in the conductor
c. useful flux c. type of material of conductor
d. all of above d. none of above
ans: c ans: b
73. A magnetic circuit has a mmf of 400AT and a 78. Reluctance of magnetic material is
reluctance of 2 × 105 AT/wb. The magnetic flux a. less than non magnetic material
in the magnetic circuit is b. more than non magnetic material
a. 3 × 10-5Wb c. equal to that of non magnetic material
b.2 × 10-3Wb d. none of above
c.1.5 × 10-2Wb ans: a
d. 2.5 × 10-4Wb
ans: b 79. The denser the flux
a. stronger is the magnetic field
74. A 2cm long coil has 10 turns and carries a b. weaker is the magnetic flux
current of 750mA. The magnetizing force of the c. no effect on the strength of field
coil is d. none of above
a. 225 AT/m ans: a
b. 675 AT/m
c.450 AT/m 80. The direction of induced e.m.f. is given by
d. 375 AT/m a. Flemings right hand rule
ans: d b. Flemings left hand rule
Jo
with ans:a
SP
a. length × area
P
U
c. area/length depend on
TE
82. According to Lenz’s law direction of induced 86. In which of the following situations a
e.m.f. is. voltage is induced in a conductor?
a. Same as cause produced a. The conductor moves through the air.
b. Perpendicular to cause produced b. The conductor is connected to a battery.
c. opposite to cause produced c. The conductor is connected to a motor.
d. Non above d. The conductor is moved in a magnetic field.
ans:c ans:d
magnetic field.
SP
b. The plane of the loop is perpendicular to the 92. Co-efficient of self induction is also called
P U
c. Self- inductance
-T
el
d. Induction c. Henry
ans:a d. Linkages
ans:c
93. The property of a coil due to which it
opposes the change of current flowing through 98. Unit of induced emf is_________
itself is called_____ of the coil. a. Volt
a. Static inductance b. Ampere
b. Dynamic inductance c. Henry
c.Self inductance d. Linkages
d. Mutual inductance ans:a
ans:c
99. The property of one coil due to which it
94. ____________is used to sense the flow of opposes the change in the other coil is
current in a electric circuit. called…………. between two coils.
a. Ammeter a. Dynamic inductance
b. Voltmeter b. Static inductance
c. Wattmeter c. Self inductance
d. Galvanometer d. Mutual inductance
ans:a ans:d
95. The phenomenon of the self induction is felt 100. The unit of mutual inductance
only when the current in the coil is is_________
a. Changing a. Volt
b. Increasing b. Ampere/ Volt
c. Decreasing c. Henry
d. All the above d. Linkages
ans:a ans:c
c. electric
in
d. Magnetic
102. If 0.75 V is induced emf and resistance
@
ans:d
SP
circuit is______
TE
b. 3. 75 mA
a. Volt
C
c. 3.75μA
H
b. Ampere
-T
el
d. 37.5 mA a. MMF
ans:b b. EMF
c. Flux linkage
103. If magnetic flux changes from 0.8 Wb to d. Magnetic intensity
0.3 Wb, then change in flux is______ Wb. ans:a
a. 1.1
b. 0.5 109. Expression NI/L is called
c. -0.5 a. MMF
d. -1.1 b. EMF
ans:c c. Flux linkage
d. Magnetic field strength
104. If Number of turns of coil is 200 and if the ans:d
current is 100mA, then MMF is ________
a. 2000 AT 110. Expression for mutual inductance is
b. 200 AT a. –L dI/dt
c. 20 AT b. MdI / dt
d. 0.5 AT c. N2 Ф2/ I1
ans:c d. NФ/I
ans:c
105. Leakage factor is also called as
a. Fringing 111. Faraday’s law of electromagnetic induction
b. Coefficient of inductance is e=
c. Magnetic coefficient a. –NdФ/dt
d. Hopkinson’s coefficient b. MdI / dt
ans:d c. N2 Ф2 / I1
d. NФ/I
106. Movement of electrons are called as ans:a
a. MMF
b. Current 112. The constant K in case of mutual induction
c. Voltage is equal to
d. Flux a.Ф1/Ф2
ans:b b.Ф2/Ф1
c.Ф1/I1
107. Flux density is equal to ________ of flux d.Ф2/I1
Jo
a. Sum
@
115. __________is normally termed as flux 120. Two conductors are lying parallel and close
linkages. to each other. They are carrying currents in
a. Ф opposite directions. The force between them is.
b. dФ/dt a. Repulsive
c. NФ b. attractive
d.Ф/I c. zero
ans:c d. none of these
ans:a
116. The term NФ/I is generally called as______
a. Self inductance 121. When a coil consisting of single turn
b. Mutual inductance rotates at uniform speed in magnetic field, the
c. Flux linkage induced emf is____
d. Induced emf a. steady
ans:a b. alternating
c. changing
117. In the expression for reluctance S = l/μA of d. reversing
a conduced, letter A represents_________ of ans:b
the conductor.
a. Total area 122. The emf induced in a conductor of length 1
b. Surface area meter moving at a right angles to a uniform
c. Cross- sectional area magnetic field of flux density 1.5 wb/m2 with
d. None of these. velocity of 50 m/s is.
ans:c a. 0
b.1.5 v
118. When a current carrying conductor is c. 75 v
Jo
a. direction of current.
SP
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
(B) Inductance
SP
(B) Ampere
in
(C) Henry
@
SP
Q.13. The property of one coil due to which it opposes the change in the other coil is called………….
U
B
(A) Fringing
@
Ans : D
TE
(A) MMF
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(B) Current
(C) Voltage
(D) Flux Ans : B
Q.21. Flux density is equal to ________ of flux and area of cross – section.
( A) Sum
(B) Difference
(C) Product
(D) Fraction Ans : D
Q.22. NI expression is called
(A) MMF
(B) EMF
(C) Flux linkage
(D) Magnetic intensity Ans : A
Q.23. Expression NI/L is called
(A) MMF
(B) EMF
(C) Flux linkage
(D) Magnetic intensity Ans :D
Q.24. Expression for mutual inductance is
(A) – L dI /dt
(B) M dI / dt
(C) N2 φ2/ I1
(D) N φ /I Ans : B
Q.25. Faraday’s law of electromagnetic induction is e =
(A) –Nd φ /dt
(B) M dI / dt
(C) N2 φ 2/ I1
(D) N φ /I Ans : A
Jo
(A) φ1/ φ2
@
(B) φ2/ φ1
SP
(C) φ1/I1
P U
(D) φ2/I2
B
Ans : B
TE
(A) Faraday
in
(B) Coulomb
@
(C) Orested
SP
(A) Faraday
TE
(B) Coulomb
C
(C) Orested
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(D) Newton Ans:A
(A) 108
(B) 106
(C) 103
(D) 10-8 Ans:A
(A) Tesla
(B) AT/m
(C) Weber
(D) Henry Ans:A
Q37. The capacity of magnetic pole to accept or radiate certain number of magnetic lines is called----------
-----
Q38. The direction of magnetic field due to a straight current carrying conductor is given by --------------
Q39. The direction of flux around a conductor carrying current away from the observer into the plane of
the paper is ----------------
(A) Anticlockwise
(B) Vertical
(C) Clockwise
(D) Horizontal Ans:A
(A) Voltage
(B) Current
(C) Resistance
Jo
(A) H/m
P
(B) Wb/m
U
B
(C) Nm
TE
Q43. A magnetic circuit has a reluctance of 1x105 AT/Wb and m.m.f. is produced by coil having 100
turns, carrying current of 5 A then the flux produced is ----------- Wb.
(A) 5
(B) 0.2x10-3
(C) 5x10-3
(D) 0.2 Ans:B
Q44. A magnetic circuit has relative permeability 1000 and length of 50 cm with cross-sectional area of 4
cm2. The amperes required through a coil of 1000 turns to produce the flux of 2mWb are ----------- A.
(A) 3.98
(B) 5.28
(C) 4.989
(D) 1.989 Ans:D
(A) (mmf)/(reluctance)
(B) (mmf)x(reluctance)
(C) (reluctance)/(mmf)
(D) None of these Ans:A
Q46.In a series magnetic circuit -------- in the circuit is same through all the parts.
(A) Reluctance
(B) Mmf
(C) Flux
(D) None of these Ans:C
Q47. Accordingly to Kirchhoff’s law, the resultant ----------around a closed magnetic circuit is equal to
algebraic sum of the product of the magnetic field strengths of each part of the circuit.
(A) Reluctance
(B) Mmf
(C) Flux
(D) None of these Ans:B
Q48. At a junction point in a magnetic circuit, algebraic sum of all the ------ is zero.
Jo
in
(A) Reluctances
@
(B) Mmf
SP
(C) Flux
(D) Product of flux and reluctances Ans:B
P U
B
(A) Mmf
H
(B) Reluctance
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(C) Flux
(D) Perfect magnetic insulator Ans:D
(A) Energy neither required to create the flux nor required to maintain it.
(B) Energy is required to create the flux but not required to maintain it.
(C) Energy is required to create the flux and also to maintain it
(D) None of these Ans:B
Q51. The flux which completes the path through surrounding air instead of the desired path is called ------
--------.
(A) 1
(B) 0
(C) Infinite
(D) 0.5 Ans:B
Q53. . When a current carrying conductor is brought into magnetic field, the force that moves the
conductor, depends on…………
Q54. Two current carrying conductors lying parallel to each other are exerting a force of attraction on
each other. The currents are……….
(A) Resistance
Jo
(B) reluctance
in
(C) conductance
@
Q56. When a coil consisting of single turn rotates at a uniform speed in a magnetic field, the emf
P
induced is…..
U
B
TE
(A) steady
C
(B) alternating
H
(C) changing
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(D) reversing Ans:B
(A) mmf
(B) reluctance
(C) permeability
(D) Magnetic field strength Ans:A
Q58. The emf induced in a conductor of length 1 m moving at right angles to a uniform magnetic field
of flux Density 1.5 Wb/m² with velocity of 50 m/s…
(A) 0
(B) 1.5 V
(C) 75 V
(D) 100 V Ans:C
(A) Ф/NI
(B) NI/Ф
(C) NФ/I
(D) ФI/N Ans:C
(A) 0.8 V
(B) 0.008 V
(C) 0.16 V
(D) 0.064 V Ans:A
Q61. Two coils have self inductances of 0.09 H and 0.01 H and a mutual inductance of 0.015 H. The
coefficient of coupling between the coils is
(A) 0.5
(B) 1.0
(C) 0.05
(D) 0.75 Ans:A
Q62. When current carrying conductor and lines of flux are parallel then the force experienced by
conductor is-------------.
(A) Zero
(B) Maximum
Jo
(C) Small
in
Q63. Direction of force experienced by current carrying conductor in a magnetic field is given by----------
SP
----.
P U
(A) Generator
(B) Transformer
(C) Bulb
(D) None of these Ans:A
Q67. A current of 2 A is reversed in 0.1 sec through an inductor of 1H then emf induced is ------ Volt.
(A) 200
(B) -200
(C) -400
(D) 400 Ans:D
Q68. The phenomenon of the self induction is felt only when the current in the coil is-------.
(A) Changing
(B) Increasing
(C) Decreasing
(D) All of above Ans:D
Q69. The property of coil due to which opposes the change in current flowing through itself is called-----
------- of the coil.
Q71. Two coil have self inductances 100μH and 250μH and coefficient of coupling is 0.253 then their
B
TE
(A) 400μH
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(B) 158.11μH
(C) 40μH
(D) 40mH Ans:C
(A) Amperes
(B) AT/Wb
(C) Unit less
(D) H/m Ans:C
Q73. A current through an inductor of 0.4 H is 5 A then the energy stored in it is ----------J
(A) 5
(B) 2.5
(C) 2
(D) 1 Ans:A
Q74. The energy stored per volume in a magnetic field of flux density 1.373 Wb/m2 is 500 joules then its
relative permeability is ----------------.
(A) 2500
(B) 1500
(C) 1200
(D) 500 Ans:B
Q75. The ease with which magnetic material forces the magnetic flux through a given medium is-----------
---------.
(A) Permeance
(B) Permeability
(C) Reluctance
(D) Permittivity Ans:B
Q77. In the expression for reluctance S=l/μa , letter ‘a’ represent ----------------.
Q78. A 0.1 A of current reverses in 0.2 seconds then the rate of changes of current is -----------A/sec.
P U
B
(A) 1
TE
(B) -1
C
(C) 2
H
(A) 4π x 10-7
(B) 10000
(C) 100
(D) 1000 Ans:D
Q80. The flux density in a magnetic field of cross-sectional area of 0.5 cm2 having a flux of 10μWb is ----
-----T.
(A) 0.2
(B) 5
(C) 50
(D) 1.2 Ans:B
Q81. The maximum working flux density os a lifting electromagnet is 1.9 T and the effective area of a
pole face is circular in cross-section. If the total magnet flux produced is 2444mWb then the radius of
pole face is nearly -------------cm.
(A) 32
(B) 128
(C) 64
(D) 0.64 Ans: C
(A) Permeability
(B) Permeance
(C) Susceptance
(D) Resistance Ans:D
Q84. Which of the following nit the property of the magnetic lines of forces?
Q85. The direction of flux around a conductor carrying current towards the observer out on the plane of
@
(A) Anticlockwise
P
(B) Vertical
U
B
(C) Clockwise
TE
(A) 5
(B) 0.2x10-3
(C) 5x 10-3
(D) 0.2 Ans:C
(A) H/m
(B) Wb/m
(C) Nm
(D) Ni unit Ans:A
Q88. For the series aiding coils, the equivalent inductance is---------------
(A) L1+L2+2M
(B) (L1+L2)/2M
(C) L1+L2-2M
(D) None of above Ans:A
Q90. The energy required to establish the magnetic field is stored into is as ----------energy
(A) kinetic
(B) electrostatic
(C) potential
(D) residual Ans:C
(A) LI2
(B) LI2/2
(C) 2LI2
(D) I2/2L Ans:B
Q92. A current through as inductor of 0.4 H is 5A then the energy stored init is--------J.
Jo
in
(A) 5
(B) 2.5
@
(C) 2
SP
(D) 1 Ans:A
P U
Q93. The energy stored per unit volume in a magnetic field of flux density 1.373 Wb/m2 is 500 J then its
B
TE
permeability is----------------.
C
H
(A) 2500
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(B) 1500
(C) 1200
(D) 500 Ans:B
(A) Volt
(B) Ampere/Volt
(C) Henry
(D) Linkage Ans:C
(A) 100%
(B) More then 100%
(C) 90%
(D) None of above Ans:A
(A) Amperes
(B) AT/m
(C) Unitless
(D) H/m Ans:C
(A) Weber
(B) AT
(C) Tesla
(D) All of above Ans:C
(A) Φxa
(B) φ/a
(C) 1/(φ+a)
(D) Φ+a Ans:B
(A) Faraday
P
(B) Coulomb
U
B
(C) Orested
TE
Unit III
Part (a) :SINGLE PHASE TRANSFORMER
1. A transformer is used to___________ d. Tapped
a. change ac voltage to dc voltage ans:b
b. change dc voltage to ac voltage
c. step up or step down dc voltages 6. If supply frequency of a transformer
d. step up or step down ac voltages increases, the secondary output voltage of the
ans: d transformer____
a. Decreases
2. The two windings of a transformer b. increases
are__________ c. remains same
a. conductively linked d. decreases slightly
b. inductively linked ans:b
c. not linked at all
d. electrically linked 7. The horizontal and vertical portions of
ans: b transformer magnetic core are called
as_________
3.The magnetically operated device that can a. Limb, yoke
change values of voltage, current, and b. Yoke, limb
impedance without changing frequency is c. Winding, Yoke
the____________ d. Winding, Limb
a. Motor ans:b
b. Generator
c. Transformer 8. The principle of working of transformer is
d. Transistor based on ________
ans:c a. Static induction
b. Mutual induction
4. The transformer winding across which the c. Dynamic induction
supply voltage applied is called the _____ d. Self induction
winding. ans:b
a. Primary
b. Secondary 9. Transformer is used to change values
c. Tertiary of__________
Jo
d. Tapped a. Frequency
in
ans:a b. Voltage
@
c. Power
SP
a. Primary
TE
13. The laminations of transformer core are 18. Silicon steel is used for transformer
made up from__________ core__________
a. Low carbon steel a. To reduce hysteresis loss
b. Silicon sheet steel b. To reduce eddy current loss
c. Nickel alloy steel stamping c. To reduce both losses
d. Chrome sheet steel d. None of these
ans:b ans:a
14.The material used for construction of 19. What is common in two windings of
transformer core should have___________ transformer?
a. Low permeability & high hysteresis loss a. Electric current
b. Low permeability & low hysteresis loss b. Magnetic circuit
c. High permeability & high hysteresis loss c. Winding wire guage
Jo
ans:d ans:b
@
SP
15. Most transformer cores are not made from 20. The main function of transformer iron core
P U
assembled from many thin sheets of metal. This a. Provide strength to the winding
TE
21. The emf induced in the primary of a 26. Any transformer flux that does not follow
transformer___________ the core and escapes into the surrounding air is
a. is in phase with the flux called____
b. lags behind the flux by 90 degree a. magnetizing flux
c. leads the flux by 90 degree b. coupling flux
d. is in phase opposition to that of flux c. leakage flux
ans:b d. reactance flux
ans:c
22.The transformer turns ratio
determines_____________ 27. A transformer that does not isolate the
a. the ratio of primary and secondary voltages output from the input is called _____
b. the ratio of primary and secondary currents transformer
c. The resistance on other side a. Distribution
d. all of the above b. step-up
ans:a c. Auto
d. Control
23. Turns ratio of single phase transformer is ans:c
given as__________
a. N2/N1 28. Ideal transformer assumptions do not
b. N1/N2 include____________
c. (N1xN2)/N1 a. Zero reactance of the winding
d. (N1xN2)/N2 b. Zero resistance of the winding
ans:b c. No leakage flux
d. No saturation of the core
24. A transformer in which the secondary ans:a
voltage is more than the primary voltage is
called a _____ transformer 29.The efficiency of the transformer is normally
a. step-down is normally in the range of____________
b. step-up a. 50 to 70%
c. Isolation b. 60 to 75 %
d. Auto c. 80 to 90 %
Jo
ans:b d. 90 to 98%
in
ans:d
@
is more than the secondary voltage is called a 30. The resistance of low voltage side of
P U
c. Isolation side
-T
el
a. Greater than 1
@
ans:a
-T
el
41. The primary and secondary voltages in 46. Transformer oil is used in transformer to
transformer are___________ provide_______
a. Always in Phase a. Cooling and insulation
b. 1800 out of phase b. Cooling and lubrication
c. 900 out of phase c. Insulation and lubrication
d. 300 or 600 out of phase d. Insulation, cooling and lubrication
ans:b ans:a
42. The induced emf in transformer secondary 47. What is the typical use of
depends on__________ autotransformer____________?
a. Maximum flux in core a. Toy transformer
b. Frequency b. Control transformer
c. No of turns on secondary c. Variable transformer
d. all of the above d. Isolating transformer
ans:d ans:c
43. Transformer rating usually expressed 48. In any transformer the voltage per turn in
in____________ primary and secondary remains____________
a.kW a. Always different
b.kVA b. Always the same
c. kV c. Always in ratio of K
d. kWh d. Sometimes same
ans:b ans:b
44. In a transformer if secondary turns are 49. Full load copper loss in a transformer is 400
doubled, at the same time primary voltage is Watt. At half load, copper losses will
reduced by half, the secondary voltage be___________
will_________ a. 400 Watt
a. Be halved b. 100 Watt
b. Not change c. 200 Watt
c. Be four times d. 50 Watt
d. Be reduced to quarter ans:b
ans:b 50. A transformer is working with its maximum
45. The no load current in terms of full load efficiency. If the iron losses are 500 W, the
Jo
a. 1 to 3% a. 300 W
@
b. 3 to 9 % b. 350 W
SP
c. 9 to 12% c. 250 W
P U
d. 12 to 20% d. 500 W
B
ans:a ans:d
TE
C
H
-T
el
𝑉1 𝐼1 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
c. 𝑉 𝐼 59. A transformer steps up voltage by a factor
1 1 𝐶𝑜𝑠 ∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠
P
U
ans:a
H
b.100
-T
el
c.0.01 ans:a
d.0.1
ans:b 65. Eddy current loss depends
on_____________
60. An ideal transformer does not a. both current and frequency
change______________ b. current alone
a. Voltage c. frequency alone
b. Power d. none of these
c. current ans:a
d. None of these
ans:b 66.The flux involved in EMF equation of a
transformer has______________
61. The flux in transformer core____________ a. RMS Value
a. increases with load b. Average Value
b. decreases with load c. Total Value
c. remains constant irrespective of load d. maximum Value
d. none of these ans:d
ans:c
67. A transformer has maximum efficiency at ¾
62. Efficiency of transformer is maximum of full load. The ratio of its iron loss and full load
when___________ copper loss is_________
a. transformer is unloaded a. 16/9
b. copper losses is equal to iron losses b. 4/3
c. eddy current losses are equal to hysteresis c. 3/4
losses d. 9/16
d. it is maximally loaded ans:d
ans:b
68. If primary of the transformer is connected
63. If the supply frequency in transformer is to dc supply, then______
doubled, then_________ a. Primary draws small current
a. hysteresis loss also doubles b. primary leakage reactance is increased
b. eddy current loss also doubles c. core losses are increased
c. iron losses doubles d. primary may burn out
d. copper losses doubles ans:d
Jo
ans:a
in
d. none of these
-T
el
c. equal resistance on primary and secondary 74. In a given transformer for a given applied
side voltage, which losses remain constant
d. no ohmic resistance on either side irrespective of change in load___________
ans:d a. Friction and windage loss
b. copper loss
70. The full load copper and iron loss of a c. hysteresis and eddy current loss
transformer are 6400 W and 5000 W d. none of these
respectively. The copper loss and iron loss at ans:c
half load will be respectively______
a. 3200 W and 2500 W 75. Main advantage to use autotransformer
b. 3200 W and 5200 W over two winding transformer____________
c. 1600 W and 1250 W a. Hysteresis losses are reduced
d. 1600 W and 5000 W b. savings in winding material
ans:d c. copper losses are negligible
d. Eddy current losses are totally eliminated
71. A transformer does not raise or lower the ans:b
voltage of DC supply because________
a. there is no need to change the DC voltage 76. An ideal transformer is one which has
b. DC circuit has more losses _____________
c. Faradays law of Electromagnetic Induction a. no losses and magnetic leakage
are not valid since the rate of change of flux is b. interleaved primary and secondary winding
zero c. a common core for its primary and secondary
d. none of these d. core of stainless steel and winding of pure
ans:c copper material
ans:a
72. Primary winding of a transformer
_____________ 77. In a practical transformer core losses
a. is always low voltage winding remains constant from no load to full load
b. is always high voltage winding because__________
c. could either be a low or high voltage winding a. value of transformation ratio remains
d. none of these constant
ans:c b. permeability of transformer core remains
constant
73. Which winding of a transformer has more c. core flux remains practically constant
Jo
c. Primary winding
P U
a. mica strip
C
H
ans:d d. buzz
B
ans:b
TE
_______________
-T
el
c. Step up transformer 96. Low voltage windings are placed next to the
in
is______ ans:b
SP
a. second
P U
c. fixed loss is high in proportion to the output effective cross sectional area of the core is 145
d. copper loss is small. cm2. The no of secondary turns___
ans:c a.71 turns
b.75 turns
107.A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase c.932 turns
transformer is built on a core having an d.923 turns
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 60 ans:a
turns on the secondary winding. The value of
maximum flux density___ 111. A 80 kVA, 6000 V/ 400 V, 50 Hz single
a.1.25 Tesla phase transformer has 80 turns on the
b.1.52 Tesla secondary winding. The value of maximum flux
c.1.3 Tesla in the core________
d.none of the above a.25.22mwb
ans:a b.22.52mwb
c.52.22mwb
108. A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase d. none of these
transformer is built on a core having an ans:b
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 60
turns on the secondary winding. The number of 112. A 6600 V/220 V, 50 Hz, step down single
turns on the high voltage winding________ phase transformer has 1500 turns on its
a. 600 turns primary side. If its maximum flux density is 1.2
b. 900 turns Tesla, then the effective cross sectional area of
c. 300 turns core is _____
d. 450 turns a.16.516 10–3 m2
ans:b b.61.516 10–3 m2
c.26.516 10–3 m2
109. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase d.62.516 10–3 m2
transformer has to be worked at a maximum ans:a
flux density of 1.1 wb/m2 in the core. The
effective cross sectional area of the core is 145 113. A 10 kVA, 3300/240 V, single phase, 50 Hz
transformer has a core area of 300 sq. cm. The
cm2. The no of primary turns___
flux density is 1.3 tesla. The primary full load
a. 930 turns
current is ___________
b. 950 turns
a. 3.03 amp
Jo
c. 932 turns
b. 33.03 amp
in
d. 923 turns
c. 30.3 amp
@
ans:c
SP
d. 0.303 amp
P
ans:a
110. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase
U
B
losses is 950 W. The efficiency at full load for efficiency at 75% of full load and unity power
unity power factor is___________ factor__________
a. 99% a.98.13%
b.96% b.98.73%
c.97.77% c.99%
d. none of these d. none of these
ans:c ans:b
115. A transformer is rated at 90 kVA, at full 117: The no load voltage at the secondary
load its copper losses is 1100 W and its iron terminals of single phase transformer is
losses is 950 W. The efficiency at 60% of full observed as 230 volt. When the transformer is
load for 0.8 lagging power factor is___________ loaded, the voltage on secondary side has
a.96.97% reduced to 224 volt. Then the % regulation of
b.96% transformer for that loading is_______
c.98% a.2.6%
d. none of these b.2.67%
ans:a c.0%
d. none of these
116. A 500 kVA transformer has iron loss of 2 ans:a
kW and full load copper losses of 5 kW. The
Unit III
Part (b) ELECTROSTATICS
b. CV2/2 be_________
SP
c. C2V/2 a.2.5 µF
P
d. CV b.40 µF
U
B
ans:b c.0.4 µF
TE
d.20 µF
C
ans:d
H
-T
el
ans: a
@
resistor. The combination is placed across a 40V 14. The direction of electric field due to positive
P U
24. In a capacitor the electric charge is 29. Air capacitors are generally available in the
deposited on range
a. metal plates a. 10 to 400 pF
b. dielectric b. 1 to 20 pF
c. both (a) and (b) c. 100 to 900 pF
d. none of the above d. 20 to 100 pF
ans:a ans:a
25. Which of the following materials has the 30. The unit of capacitance is
highest value of dielectric constant? a. Henry
a. Glass b. Ohm
b. Vaccum c. Farad
c. Ceramics d. Farad/m
d. Oil ans:c
ans: c
31. A capacitor charged to 200V has 2000 µC of
26. Capacitance of air capacitor increases with charge. The value of capacitance will be
a. increase in plate area and decrease in a. 10 F
distance between the plates b. 10 µF
b. increase in plate area and distance between c. 100 µF
the plates d. 1000 µF
c. decrease in plate area and value of applied ans:b
voltage
d. reduction in plate area and distance between 32. Voltage across capacitor at any time‘t’
the plates during charging from a D.C. source of voltage V
ans: a is given by
a. ν = Ve-t/λ
27. A capacitor consists of b. ν = V(1-e-t/λ)
a. two insulators separated by a conductor c. ν = V2e-t/λ
b. two conductor separated by a dielectric d. ν = V2(1-e-t/λ)
c. two insulators only ans:b
d. two conductors only
ans:b 33. The ratio of electric flux density to electric
Jo
form of b. permittivity
SP
a. tubes c. reluctance
P U
c. disc ans:b
TE
d. meshed plates
C
H
ans:b
-T
el
34. Energy stored in the electrical field of a 39. If a 6µF capacitor is charged to 200 V the
capacitor C when charged from a D.C, source of charge in Coulomb will be_______________
voltage V is equal to …….. Joule a. 800 µC
a. ½ CV2 b. 900 µC
b. ½ C2V c. 1200 µC
c. CV2 d. 1600 µC
d. C2V ans:c
ans:a
40. Which of the following capacitors is marked
35. The absolute permittivity of free space is for polarity____________________?
given by a. air
a. 8.854 x 10-9 F/m b. paper
b. 8.854 x 10-10 F/m c. mica
c. 8.854 x 10-11 F/m d. electrolyte
d. 8.854 x 10-12 F/m ans: d
ans:d
41. Which of the following capacitor are usually
36. The relative permittivity of free space is used for radio frequency tuning__________
given by a. air
a. 1 b. paper
b. 10 c. mica
c. 100 d. electrolyte
d. 1000 ans: b
ans:a
42. The time constant of an R-C circuit is
37. When 4 Volt e.m.f. is applied across a 1 defined as the time during which capacitor
Farad capacitor, it will store energy of charging voltage actually rises to ----------------
a. 2 Joule percent of its ---------- value
b. 4 Joule a.37, initial
c. 6 Joule b.63.2, initial
d. 8 Joule c.63.2, final
ans:d d.37, final
ans: c
38. The capacitor preferred for high frequency
Jo
ans:b b.63
TE
c.42
C
H
d.73
-T
el
47. The relative permittivity of air is__________ 52. Two capacitors of capacitance C1 and C2 are
a.0 connected in parallel. A charge Q given to them
b.1.0006 is shared. The ratio of charges Q1/Q2 is
c. 8.854 × 10−12 a. C2/ C1
d. none of the above b. C1/ C2
ans:b c. C1 C2
d. 1/ C1 C2
48. The relative permittivity of a material is 10. ans: b
Its absolute permittivity will be
a. 8.854 × 10−11 𝐹/𝑀 53. Two capacitors have capacitance 25 µF
Jo
ans: a b. 15 µF and 10 µF
PU
c. 10 µF and 8 µF
B
58. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm Find Initial discharging current.
@
a. 1mA c.0.01A
B
b. 0.1 mA d.0.1A
TE
c. 0.01mA ans:d
C
H
d. 1.00A
-T
el
63. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a 67. The capacitance of capacitor formed by two
potential difference of 100V across its parallel plates each 200 cm2 in area separated
terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm by dielectric of 4mm thick is 0.0004µF. If
resistor. Find discharging current at 2m Sec. voltage of 20000 V is applied then the total
a. - 0.0818A charge on the plate is
b. - 0.01A a. 8µC
c. - 0.00818A b. 8mC
d. - 1A c. 8nC
ans:a d. 8pC
ans: a
64. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
potential difference of 100V across its 68. A parallel plate capacitor has plate area of
terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm 2m2 spaced by three slabs of dielectric
resistor. Find initial rate of fall in voltage across materials. The relative permittivity’s are 2,3 and
capacitor. 6 respectively and thickness are 0.4mm, 0.6mm
a. 10 4 V/s and 0.12 mm respectively. Find the combined
b. -10 4 V/s capacitance.
c. -1 4 V/s a. 0.000295 x 10-6 F
d. 10A b. 0.00295 x 10-6 F
ans:b c. 0.0295 x 10-6 F
d. 0. 295 x 10-6 F
65. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a ans: b
potential difference of 100V across its
terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm 69. What is the unit of charge?
resistor. Find time constant of the circuit. a. Volt-Amp
a. 0.1sec b. Henery
b. 1sec c. Farad
c. 0.01sec d. Coulomb
d. 0.001sec ans: d
ans:c
70. What will be the capacitance of four
66. A capacitor consists of two similar plates capacitors of equal capacitance ‘C’ when
each 10cm x 10cm mounted parallel and connected in parallel
Jo
a. 8.854 pF d. C
P U
b. 8.854 µF ans: a
B
c. 8.854 mF
TE
ans: a has
-T
el
ans: a ans: a
in
@
76. The capacitance of parallel plate capacitor is 80. The plate area of a parallel-plate capacitor is
SP
a. C = Є0 A / d
B
b. C = Є0 d / A
insulating material of relative permittivity 5?
C
a 177.1 x 10-12 F
H
-T
el
1. A standard sinusoidal voltage wave changes 4. The distance occupied by one complete cycle
its polarity at________ of the wave is called its________
a. maximum value a. time period
b. minimum value b. wavelength
c. zero value c. velocity
d. none of the above d. frequency
ans:c ans:a
2. The period of a certain sine wave is 10 5. The rms value of a sine wave of peak value Im
milliseconds. Its frequency is________ is given by_______
a.10 MHz a. Im/√2
b.10 KHz b. Im
c.10 Hz c. Im/2
d.100 Hz d. Im/π
ans:d
ans:a
Jo
each other if they achieve their______ 6.The average value of a sine wave of maximum
SP
a. zero value at the same time value Im over one cycle is_______
P
ans:d d. Im/2
H
-T
el
11. The form factor of a sine wave is_____ 16. An alternating current is given by the
@
a.1.01 𝜋
expression 𝑖 = 200 sin(314𝑡 + 3 ) amperes.
SP
b.1.11
P
c.1.21
current are_________
B
a. 200 A, 50 Hz
ans:b
C
b. 100√2, 50 Hz
H
-T
el
because_______ ans:c
in
b. dc motors do not have fine speed control Its value at 135° is______
P U
b. 14.14 V
TE
appliances
H
d. 5 V
-T
el
d. 100 V respectively_______
@
ans:c
b. 100 V, 100 Hz, -90°
P U
ans:c c. same as
SP
a. they can be easily determined 50. The filament of a vacuum tube requires 0.4A
b. calculations become very simple dc to heat it. The rms value of ac required
c. they give comparison with dc is______
d. none of the above a.0.4 × √2 A
ans:c b.0.4 ÷ 2 A
c.0.8 ÷ √2 A
46.The average value of sin2θ over a complete d. 0.4 A
cycle is_________ ans:d
a. +1
b. -1 51. A100 V peak ac is as effective as_____dc.
1
c. a. 100 V
2
d. zero b. 50 V
ans:c c. 70.7 V
d. none of the above
47.The average value of sinθ over a complete ans:c
cycle is_________
a. zero 52. The form factor of a ________wave is 1.
b. +1 a. sinusoidal
c. -1 b. square
d.
1 c. triangular
2
d. sawtooth
ans:a
ans:b
a.1.414
b.1.414
in
b.1.11
c.2
@
c.2
d.1.5
SP
d.1.5
ans:b
P
ans:b
U
B
TE
a.15V 1
c.700
b.15 × √2 V 1
d.600
c.15/√2 V
ans:d
d.none of the above
ans:a
61. A heater is rated as 230V, 10KW, AC. The
value of 230V refers to___________
56.A sine wave has a frequency of 50 Hz. Its
a. average voltage
angular frequency is_______radian/second.
b. rms voltage
a.100π
c. peak voltage
b.50π
d. none of the above
c.25π
ans:b
d.5π
ans:a
62. The peak value of a sine wave is 200V. Its
average value is_______
57. The period of a wave is____________
a.127.4V
a. the same as frequency
b.141.4V
b. time required to complete one cycle
c.282.8V
c. expressed in amperes
d.200V
d. none of the above
ans:a
ans:b
d. average value
ans:d
in
ans:b
@
after_____second.
B
1
a. traingular wave
TE
1
b.800 c. square wave
H
-T
el
d. half wave rectified sine wave 70. The current in a circuit is given by: 𝑖 =
ans:c 100 sin 314𝑡 amperes. The maximum value and
frequency of current are_________
66. For the same peak value which of the a.50√2 A, 100 Hz
following wave will have the highest rms value? b.100√2 A, 100 Hz
a.square wave c. 100 A, 50 Hz
b.half wave rectified sine wave d. 70.7 A, 50 Hz
c.triangular wave ans:c
d.sine wave
ans:a 71. For a frequency of 200 Hz, the time period
will be_________
67. For the same peak value which of the a. 0.05 S
following wave will have the least mean value? b. 0.005 S
a. half wave rectified sine wave c. 0.0005 S
b. triangular wave d. 0.5 S
c. sine wave ans:b
d. square wave
ans:a 72. An ac voltage of 50 Hz has a maximum value
of 50 V. Its value after 1/600 second after the
68. For a sine wave with peak value Imax, the rms instant the current is zero will be_________
value is_______ a.5V
a. 0.5Imax b.12.5V
b. 0.707Imax c.25V
c. 0.9Imax d.43.8V
d. 1.414Imax ans:c
ans:b
73. For 200V rms value triangular wave, the
69. Form factor is the ratio of_________ peak voltage will be______
a. average value/rms value a.200V
b. average value/peak value b.222V
c. rms value/average value c.282V
d. rms value/peak value d.346V
ans:c ans:d
Jo
69. For a sine wave with peak value Emax, the 74. A sine wave of voltage varies from zero to
in
b. 0.707Emax a.50V
P U
d. 1.414Emax c.100V
TE
ans:a d.173.2V
C
H
ans:c
-T
el
c. the less heat than produced by ac flowing wave is 200V. The rms value of full wave
in
ans:b b.141.4V
P U
c.111V
B
average value:
-T
el
84. The voltage in a circuit follows the law: 𝑣 = b. half peak value
100 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝜔𝑡. If the frequency is 25 Hz, how long c. average value
will d. rms value
it take for the voltage to rise to 50V? ans:d
1
a.50 S
1 89. The frequency of an alternating current
b.100S
is________
1
c.300S a. the speed with which the alternator runs
1 b. the number of cycles generated in one
d. 600S
minute
ans:c
c. the number of waves passing through a point
in one second
85. The negative maximum of a cosine wave
d. the number of electrons passing through a
occurs at________
point in one second
a.30°
ans:c
b.45°
c.90°
90. The equation of 50 Hz current sine wave
d.180°
having rms value of 60 A is______
ans:d
a.60 sin 25𝑡
b.60 sin 50𝑡
86. The rms value of pure cosine function
c.84.84 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
is_________
d42.42 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡.
a. 0.5 of peak value
ans:c
b. 0.707 of peak value
c. same as peak value
91. An electric iron designed for 110 V AC
d. zero
supply was rated at 500 W. It was put across a
ans:b
220 V supply. Assuming that at 110 V, it
supplied 500 W output (i.e. no losses) at the
87. An alternating voltage is given in volts by
new voltage it will supply_________
expression 𝑣 = 326 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. Its rms value and
a. 2500 W
frequency are____
b. 2000 W
a.230V,50 Hz
c. 500 W
b. 230V,100 Hz
d. 250 W
c. 326V,50 Hz
ans:b
d. 326V,100 Hz
Jo
ans:a
in
circuit________
SP
selected?
d. can not be determined
C
a. peak value
H
ans:c
-T
el
b. 41.38 Hz, 25 A
93. The angular frequency of an alternating c. 41.38 Hz, 50 A
quantity is a mathematical quantity obtained by d. 82.76 Hz, 25 A
multiplying the frequency “f” of the alternating ans:a
quantity by a factor_________
𝜋
a. 2 98. The time period or periodic time T of an
b.π alternating quantity is the time taken in seconds
c.2π to complete_____________
d.4π a. one cycle
ans:c b. alternation
c. none of the above
94. The average value of an unsymmetrical d. Half cycle
alternating quantity is calculated over ans: a
the_________
a. whole cycle 99. The time period of an alternating quantity is
b. half cycle 0.02 second. Its frequency will be________
c. unsymmetrical part of the waveform a. 25 Hz
d. first two cycles b. 50 Hz
ans:a c. 100 Hz
d. 0.02 Hz
95. The mean value of the current 𝑖 = 20 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝜃 ans: b
𝜋
from θ=0 to θ= is_______
2
100. An ac current is given as i = 10 + 10 sin 314
a.40π
40
t, the average and rms values of the current
b. are____
𝜋
1
c. a. 16.36 A, 17.07 A
40
𝜋
d.40 b. 10 A, 17.07 A
c. 10 A, 12.25 A
ans:b
d. 16.36 A, 12.2 A
ans:c
96. A constant current of 2.8A exists in a
resistor. The rms value of current is______
101. The size (cross-sectional area) of a
a. 2.8 A
conductor, with regard to the heating effect, is
b. about 2 A
determined on the basis of ……….. value of
c. 1.4 A
Jo
current to be carried by it
d. undefined
in
a. average value
ans:a
@
b. peak value
SP
c. rms value
P
ans:c
TE
a. 82.76 Hz, 50 A
H
-T
el
a. Same
in
b. Different
110. When phase of an alternating quantity is
@
c. multiple
SP
ans: a
a. zero
B
TE
b. positive
107. The phase of alternating quantity at any
C
c. negative
H
c. phase c. leading
in
ans:c ans:c
SP
P U
115. When ____________ between the two 120. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ), the
B
alternating quantities is zero, the two quantities ‘v’ is said to _______ ‘i’ by angle Φ
TE
c. lead ans:c
d. all above
ans:b 126. The diagram in which different sinusoidal
alternating quantities of the same frequency,
121. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin ωt, the ‘i’ is are represented by individual phasors indicating
said to _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ exact phase relationship is called ________
a. in phase a. graph
b. lag b. still diagram
c. lead c. phasor diagram
d. all above d. picture
ans:a ans:c
122. With respect to reference, plus sign of 127. The diagram in which different sinusoidal
angle indicates _______ alternating quantities of the same _____, are
a. leading represented by individual phasors indicating
b. lagging exact phase relationship is called phasor
c. in phase diagram.
d. none of the above a. time
ans:a b. frequency
c. sign
123. With respect to reference, minus sign of d. shape
angle indicates _______ ans:b
a. leading
b. lagging 128. The lagging and leading word is relative to
c. in phase the ______
d. none of the above a. base
ans:b b. range
c. reference
124. With respect to reference, _____ sign of d. angle
angle indicates lead. ans:c
a. division
b. plus 129. Polar form of v = 100 sin(100πt+π/6) Volt is
c. minus ________
d.dot a.61.2371+j35.3553
Jo
ans:b b.70.7106∟30
in
c. 61.2371∟35.3553
@
a. division
B
d.dot a.61.2371+j35.3553
-T
el
b. 2150 A a. 30
@
ans:b d.120
B
ans:c
TE
C
H
-T
el
ans:a a. lags
SP
b. leads
P U
b. inductance ans:b
C
H
c. inductive reactance
-T
el
b. capacitor
in
ans:b a.8
P U
b.10
B
a. XC=1/ωC d.20
C
H
b. XC=1/2𝝅C ans:c
-T
el
166. The product of (-4-j7) and (6-j2) is______ 171. Inductive reactance of a coil of inductance
a. -24+j14 0.2 H at 50 Hz is ____ ohms.
b. 24-j14 a.62.8
Jo
c. -38-j34 b.628
in
d. -24-j14 c.0.2
@
ans:c d.10
SP
ans:a
PU
141.4 sin(314.18t-π/2). Its rms value of voltage, 172. The reactance of L Henry inductance
TE
ans:b ans:a
B
TE
182. If two sinusoids of the same frequency but 187. In the complex number 4+j7, 7 is called the
of different amplitude and phase difference are ______ component
added, the resultant is a ______ a. real
a. sinusoid of same frequency b. imaginary
b. sinusoid of double the original frequency c. in-phase
c. sinusoid of half the original frequency d. none of the above`
d. non-sinusoid ans:d
ans:a
188. The reciprocal of a complex number is
183. A constant current of 2.8 A exists in a a_____
resistor. The rms value of current is ____ a. complex number
a. 2.8 A b. real component only
b. 2 A c. quadrature component only
c. 1.4 A d. none of above
d. undefined ans:a
ans:a
189. If two complex numbers are equal,
184. A 10 mH inductor carries a sinusoidal then_____
current of 1 A at frequency of 50 Hz. The a. only their magnitudes will be equal
average power dissipated by the inductor is b. only their angles will be equal
____ c. their in phase and quadrature components
a.0 will be separately equal
b. 3.14 W d.none of above
c. 0.5 W ans:c
d. 1 W
ans:a 190. A phasor 2∟180 can be expressed as____
a.j2
185. The power factor of an ordinary bulb is b.-j2
_____ c.-2
a. zero d.2
b. unity ans:c
c. more than unity
d. less than unity 191. A current of (3+j4) A is flowing through a
ans:b circuit. The magnitude of current is _____
Jo
a. 7 A
in
a. 100∟-60 b. approx. 90
b.100∟240 c. approx. 60
c. 100∟-300 d. approx. 0
d. none of the above ans:b
ans:c
198. Two sinusoidal currents are given by i1 =
193. The conjugate of -4+j3 is _____ 100sin (ωt+π/3) and i2 = 150sin(ωt-π/4). The
a. 4-j3 phase difference between them is _____
b. -4-j3 degrees
c.4+j3 a.15
d. none of the above b.50
ans:b c.60
d.105
194. The difference of two conjugate number ans:d
results in _____
a. a complex number 199. Capacitive reactance is more when____
b. in-phase component only a. capacitance is less and frequency of supply is
c. quadrature component only less
d. none of the above b. capacitance is less and frequency of supply is
ans:c more
c. capacitance is more and frequency of supply
195. The reciprocal of j is ____ is less
a.j d.capacitance is more and frequency of supply
b.-j is more
c.jxj ans:a
d.none of the above
ans:b 200. Pure inductive circuit ______
a. consumes some power on average
196. Two waves of same frequency have b. does not take power at all from lines
opposite phase when the phase angle between c. takes power from the line during some part
them is ___ degrees of cycle and returns back during other part of
a.360 cycle
b.180 d. none of the above
c.90 ans: c
Jo
d.0
in
zero
SP
a. approx.180 ans:d
-T
el
212. Power factor of the following circuit will be 217. For a purely resistive circuit the following
unity statement is correct
a. resistive a. work done is zero
b. pure inductive b. power consumed is zero
c. pure capacitive c. heat produced is zero
d. both (b) and (c) d. power factor is unity
ans:a ans:d
213. In pure resistive circuit _____ 218. Which value of inductance will give the
a. current lags the voltage by 90 degrees same reactance as a capacitor of 2 µF when
b. current leads the voltage by 90 degrees both are at 50 Hz?
c. current can lead or lag the voltage by 90 a. 5 H
degrees b. 10 H
d. current is in phase with the voltage c. 15 H
ans:d d. 20 H
and:a
214. In pure inductive circuit _____
a. current lags the voltage by 90 degrees 219. For purely inductive circuit if v = Vm sin
b. current leads the voltage by 90 degrees (ωt) then equation of current is _____
c. current can lead or lag the voltage by 90 a. i = Im sin (ωt-π/2)
degrees b. i = Im sin (ωt+π/2)
d. current is in phase with the voltage c. i = Im sin (ωt-π)
ans:a d. i = Im sin (ωt+π)
ans:a
215. A phasor is _____
a. a line which represents the magnitude and 220. For purely capacitive circuit if v = Vm sin
phase of an alternating quantity (ωt) then equation of current is _____
b. a line which represents the magnitude and a. i = Im sin (ωt-π/2)
direction of an alternating quantity b. i = Im sin (ωt+π/2)
c. a colored tag or band for distinction between c. i = Im sin (ωt-π)
different phases of a 3 phase supply d. i = Im sin (ωt+π)
d. an instrument used for measuring phases of ans:b
an unbalanced 3 phase load
Jo
216. Ohm is the unit of all the following except a.i = Im sin (ωt-π/2)
SP
d. capacitance ans:c
C
H
ans:d
-T
el
222. A sinusoidal voltage v1 leads another d. becomes zero with the increase in supply
sinusoidal voltagev2 by 180 degrees. Then ____ frequency
a. voltage v2 leads voltage v1 by 180 degrees ans:a
b. both voltage have their zero values at the
same time 227. A pure inductance connected across 250 V,
c. both voltage have their peak values at the 50 Hz supply consumes 100 W. This
same time consumption is due to_____
d. all of above a. the big size of the inductor
ans:d b. the reactance of the inductor
c. the current flowing in the inductor
223. If A = 10∟45 and B = 5∟15, then the d. the statement given is false
value of A/B will be___ ans:d
a.50∟60
b.2∟60 228. Which of the following statements pertains
c. 2∟-30 to resistor only
d.2∟30 a.can dissipate considerable amount of power
ans:d b.can act as energy storage device
c. connecting them in parallel increases the
224. A coil has XL = 1000 ohm. If both its total value
inductance and frequency are doubled, its d. opposes sudden change in voltage
reactance will become ___ ohm ans:a
a.2000
b.500 229. A pure capacitor connected across an AC
c.250 voltage consumed 50 W. This
d.4000 a. is due to the capacitive reactance in ohms
ans:d b. is due to the current flowing in capacitor
c. is due to the size of capacitor
225. The active power of AC circuit is given by d. statement is incorrect
___ ans:d
a. VI sin Φ
b. I2XL 230. The length of a phasor in a phasor diagram
c.I2R normally represents the ………… value of the
d.I2Z alternating quantity
ans:c a. rms or effective
Jo
b. average
in
frequency
B
c. increases with the increase in supply 231. The two quantities are said to be in phase
TE
a. the phase difference between two quantities d. product of rms or effective values of current
is zero degree or radian and voltage
b. each of them pass through zero values at the ans:d
same instant and rise in the same direction
c. each of them pass through zero values at the 236. The power factor of an ac circuit is equal to
same instant but rises in the opposite directions a. tangent of the phase angle
d. either (a) or (b) b. sine of phase angle
ans:d c. unity for a resistive circuit
d. unity for a reactive circuit
232. The phase difference between the two ans:c
waveforms can be compared only when they
a. have the same frequency 237. The curve for the instantaneous power
b. have the same peak value with respect to the waveforms of voltage &
c. have the same effective value current is shown in figure is of
d. are sinusoidal
ans:a p p
v
2
0
t
in
2
235. Average power in a pure resistive circuit is
@
equal to - -
SP
P P
T
a. zero
P U
V
a. pure resistance
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
a) c/m
U
B
b) c/m2
TE
c) N/C
C
d) N/m2C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
9) The electric field intensity is also measure in _______
a) V/m2
b) V/m
c) C/m
d) Wb/V
10) The electric field intensity at a point _______
a) F/Q
b) Q/F
c) B/Q
d) 1/(2VQ)
11) _________ represents electric field intensity.
a) V/Q
b) V/d
c) 1/(2V2)
d) VQ
12) The permittivity is __________
a) The ease with which magnetic flux passes through dielectric medium.
b) The ease with which current passes through given material.
c) The ease with which a dielectric medium permits an electric flux to establish in it.
d) None of above
13) The absolute permittivity is measured in__________.
a) H/m
b) A/m
c) F/m
d) N/m
14) The value of Є0 is ________F/m
a) 8.854x10-10
b) 8.854x1012
c) 6.657x10-12
d) 8.854xz10-12
15) The relative permittivity is also called as _______ of the material.
a) Dielectric constant
b) Di electric strength
Jo
c) Breakdown voltage
in
d) Coulmb’s constant
@
a) D=Є/E
P
b) D=ЄE
U
B
c) E=Є/D
TE
d) E=ЄD
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
17) The unit of ____________ are same.
a) Electric field strength, potential difference
b) Electric field strength , potential gradient
c) Electric field strength , electric flux density
d) Electric flux density , potential gradient
18) _________ represent Coulmb’s law of electrostatics
a) F α Q1Q2 d2
b) F α ( Q1Q2 ) /d2
c) F α d2/(Q1 Q2 )
d) F α 1/(Q1Q2 d2)
19) Two conducting surfaces separated by a dielectric medium is called____
a) Capacitor
b) Dipole
c) Capacitance
d) Inductance
20) Capacitance is_________
a) Property of capacitor to repel charges from its plates
b) Property to store electric charges in the form of static charges
c) Property to store magnetic energy
d) Property to breakdown the dielectric
21) The unit of capacitance is_________
a) Farad
b) Henry
c) Hertz
d) Farad/m
22) Capacitance of a capacitor is the ratio of ________
a) P.d. between the plates and the charge
b) Charge and the p.d. between the plates
c) Charge and spacing between the plates
d) P.d. and thickness of dielectric
23) A capacitance of 1 picofarad means _____ farad.
a) 10-6
b) 10-9
Jo
c) 10-12
in
d) 10-15
@
a) Єd/A
P
b) Є/dA
U
B
c) ЄA/d
TE
d) A/Єd
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
25) The capacitance is charged to 10 V and its capacitance μF then charge on it is_________
a) 10μC
b) 10nC
c) 10C
d) 1μC
26) A capacitor uses the plates of area 25 cm2 and distance between the plates is 5 cm. then
its capacitance with air as a dielectric is_________
a) 04427 μF
b) 04427 pF
c) 0.4427nF
d) 0.4427 F
27) The charge transferred on the plates of a capacitor is 2 nC while the distance between the
plates is 1 mm. if area of cross-section is 10 cm2 and air used as a dielectric then the
voltage across the plates is ___ v
a) 22.580
b) 2.5588
c) 225.88
d) 255.88
28) A capacitor of 10 μF has a charge of 1 mC. If distance between the plate is 1 cm then the
electric field intensity between the plates is_________
a) 10 kv/m
b) 10 v/m
c) 0.1V/m
d) 8.854 kv/m
29) For a 5 μF capacitor, distance between the plates is 0.5 cm and the electric field intensity
is 20 KV/m then the charge on the capacitor is_________
a) 5 μC
b) 0.5 μC
c) 5 nC
d) 0.5 mC
30) A capacitor uses a dielectric of Єr =2 it is charged to 500 V and the distance between the
plates is 10 cm then electric flux density between the plates is _________ nC/m2
a) 0.8854
Jo
b) 88.54
in
c) 8.854
@
d) 0.00885
SP
31) The p.d. between the plates of a 5 μF capacitor with a charge of 2 mC on it is ______V
P U
a) 200
B
b) 100
TE
c) 400
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
d) 4000
32) A 2 μF capacitor connected in a circuit has one plate at +6 V and the other plate at – 6V.
the charge on the negative plate of the capacitor is___________
a) + 12 μC
b) - 12 μC
c) - 24 μC
d) -24 μC
33) A parallel plate capacitor with air as dielectric remains connected across a battery e.m.f.
6V the charge on the capacitor in this condition is Q. if the separation between the plates
is decreased by 10% in this condition and sufficient time is allowed to attain steady state,
the charge on the capacitor will be_________
a) Increased by 11%, approximately
b) Increased by 9%, approximately
c) Decreased by 9%, approximately
d) Decreased by 11%, approximately
34) The ability of an insulating medium to resist its breakdown s called its_________
a) Dielectric constant
b) Dielectric strength
c) Relative permittivity
d) Insulation resistance
35) The dielectric strength is measured in ____
a) KV/N
b) V/C
c) KV/cm
d) F/m
36) _ ________is not the factor affecting dielectric strength.
a) Temperature
b) Moisture
c) Size and shape of the plates
d) Insulation resistance
37) ________ is the factor affecting dielectric strength
a) Presence of air pockets in material
b) Molecular arrangement of material
Jo
c) Moisture content
in
d) All of these
@
38) For the capacitor in series, ________ remains same for all of them.
SP
a) Voltage
P U
b) Capacitance
B
c) Charge
TE
d) One of these
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
39) The two capacitor 3 μF and 6 μF are in series then the equivalent capacitance is
________
a) 9μF
b) 4.5μF
c) 2μF
d) 1μF
40) Three capacitors each of capacitances C and breakdown voltage V are connected in series
then the capacitances and breakdown voltage of the combination is_______
a) 3C,V/3
b) C/3,3V
c) 3C,3V
d) C./3,V/3
41) The capacitor 15μF, 10μF and 3μF are connected in series and series combination is
connected across 10 V when the capacitors are fully charged then the charge on 3 μF
capacitor is_____
a) 10μC
b) 15μC
c) 3μC
d) 20μC
42) Four 2 μF capacitors are connected in series then the equivalent capacitance is
_______μF.
a) 0.5
b) 8
c) 2
d) 4
43) The capacitors of capacitance 4μF and 6μF connected in series. A p. d. of 500 volt is
applied to the outer plates of two capacitor system. Then the charge on each plate of each
plate of each capacitor is numerically_________ μC
a) 500
b) 5000
c) 1200
d) 400
44) Two capacitor 3μF and 6μF connected in series across 100 V d.c. supply. Then the
Jo
a) 100
@
b) 66.667
SP
c) 33.333
P U
d) 0
B
45) Ten capacitor of 3μF each ar connected in series then the equivalent capacitance is
TE
________μF
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
a) 0.3
b) 3
c) 30
d) 3.333
46) The energy stored in a capacitor is given by___________
a) 1/(2CV)
b) 1/(2CV2)
c) v/(2C)
d) c2/2v
47) if the p.d. between the plates is increased by 10% then energy stored in the capacitor
increased by __________%
a) 11
b) 10
c) 2.1
d) 21
48) The capacitor of 10 The capacitor of 10 μF is discharged through a resistance of 100 KΩ
then the time constant is __________
a) 1 s b) 1 μs
b) 1ms c) 0.1 sec
49) Initially the capacitor act as _________
a) Open circuit
b) Short circuit
c) Breakdown
d) None of above
50) Four, 2 μF capacitor are conneted in parallel the effective capacitance is _________μF
a) 0.5 b) 8 c) 2 d) 4
Answer:
1 C 11 B 21 A 31 C 41 D
2 A 12 C 22 B 32 D 42 A
3 D 13 C 23 C 33 A 43 C
4 C 14 D 24 C 34 B 44 B
5 B 15 A 25 A 35 C 45 c
Jo
6 C 16 B 26 B 36 D 46 B
in
7 A 17 B 27 C 37 D 47 D
@
8 C 18 C 28 A 38 C 48 A
SP
9 B 19 A 29 D 39 C 49 B
P
10 A 20 B 30 B 40 b 50 B
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
MULTIPLE CHOICE QUESTIONS
ELECTROSTATICS
1. The force between two charges is 120 N. If the distance between the charges is doubled,
the force will be
(a) 60 N
(b) 30 N
(c) 40 N
(d) 15
Ans: b
2. The electric field intensity at a point situated 4 metres from a point charge is 200 N/C. If
the distance is reduced to 2 metres, the field intensity will be
(a) 400 N/C
(b) 600 N/C
(c) 800 N/C
(d) 1200 N/C
Ans: c
above Ans: b
4. The electric field at a point situated at a distance d from straight charged conductor is
Jo
(a) proportional to d
in
above Ans: b
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
5. The direction of electric field due +0 positive charge is .
(a) away from the charge
(b) towards the charge
(c) both (a) and (6)
(d) none of the
above Ans: a
7. The ability of charged bodies to exert force on 6ne another is attributed to the existence of
(a) electrons
(b) protons
(c) neutrons
(d) electric
field Ans: d
8. If the sheet of a bakelite is inserted between the plates of an air capacitor, the
capacitance will
(a) decrease
(b) increase
(c) remains unchanged
(d) become
zero Ans: b
8F
in
Ans: a
@
SP
Ans: b
-T
el
eg
above Ans: c
TE
C
(d) Electric
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
potential Ans: b
18. Two plates of a parallel plate capacitor after being charged from a constant voltage
source are separated apart by means of insulated handles, then the
(a) Voltage across the plates increases
(b) voltage across the plates decreases
(c) charge on the capacitor decreases
(d) charge on the capacitor increases
Ans: b
19. If A.C. voltage is applied to capacitive circuit, the alternating current can flow in the
circuit because
(a) varying voltage produces the charg¬ing and dicharging currents
(b) of high peak value
(c) charging current can flow
(d) discharge current can
flow Ans: a
20. Voltage applied across a ceramic dielectric produces an electrolytic field 100 times
greater than air. What will be the value of dielectric constant ?
(a) 50
(6)
100
(c) 150
(d) 200
Ans:
b
(b) 0.002
in
(c) 0.02
@
(d)
SP
0.2
P
Ans:
U
B
a
TE
C
23. "The total electric flux through any closed surface surrounding charges is equal to the
H
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Ans: b
24. Three capacitors each of the capacity C are given. The resultant capacity 2/3 C
can be obtained by using them
(a) all in series
(b) all in parallel
(c) two in parallel and third in series with this combination
(d) two in series and third in parallel across this combination
Ans: c
25. For which of the following parameter variation, the capacitance of the capacitor
remains unaffected ?
(a) Distance between plates
(b) Area of the plates
(c) Nature of dielectric
(d) Thickness of the
plates Ans: d
27. Which of the following expression is correct for electric field strength ?
(a) E = D/E
(b) E = D2/t
(c) E = jtD
(d) E=
nD2
Ans: a
(b) dielectric
in
above Ans: b
P U
29. Which of the following materials has the highest value of dielectric constant?
B
TE
(a) Glass
C
(b) Vacuum
H
-T
(c) Ceramics
el
(d) O
eg
il
ra
Ans:
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
c
30. Which of the following capacitors will have the least variation ?
(a) Paper capacitor
(b) Ceramic capacitor
(c) Silver plated mica capacitor
(d) None of the
above Ans: c
32. Which of the following capacitors has relatively shorter shelf life ?
(a) Mica capacitor
(b) Electrolytic capacitor
(c) Ceramic capacitor
(d) Paper
capacitor Ans: b
33. The sparking between two electrical contacts can be reduced by inserting a
(a) capacitor in parallel with contacts
(6) capacitor in series with each contact
(c) resistance in line
(d) none of the
above Ans: a
34. In the case of a lossy capacitor, its series equivalent resistance value will be
(a) small
(b) very small
(c) large
(d) ze
ro
Ans: c
Jo
in
(a) zero
SP
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(d) none of the
above Ans: b
37. When a dielectric slab is introduced in a parallel plate capacitor, the potential difference
between plates will
(a) remain uncharged
(b) decrease
(c) increase
(d) become
zero Ans: b
(c) disc
in
(d) meshed
@
plates Ans: b
SP
P
(a) 10 to 400 pF
TE
(b) 1 to 20 pF
C
H
(d) 20 to 100
el
pF Ans: a
eg
ra
m
43. The unit of capacitance is
(a) henry
(b) ohm
(c) farad
(d) farad/
m Ans: c
44. A capacitor charged to 200 V has 2000 (iC of charge. The value of capacitance will be
(a) 10 F
(6) 10 uF
(c) 100 nF
(d) 1000
uF Ans: b
45. A capacitor in a circuit became hot and ultimately exploded due to wrong con¬nections,
which type of capacitor it could be ?
(a) Paper capacitor
(b) Ceramic capacitor
(c) Electrolytic capacitor
(d) Any-of the
above Ans: c
46. Energy stored in the electric field of a capacitor C when charged from a D.C source of
voltage V is equal to joules
(a) CV2
(b) C2V
(c) CV2
(d) C
V
Ans
:a
Ans: b
@
SP
(a) 1
B
TE
(b) 10
C
(c) 100
H
(d) 1000
-T
Ans: a
el
eg
(a) scalar
m
(b) vector
(c) both (a) and (6)
(d) none of the
above Ans: b
50. When 4 volts e.m.f. is applied across a 1 farad capacitor, it will store energy of
(a) 2 joules
(b) 4 joules
(c) 6 joules
(d) 8
joules
Ans: d
52. The capacity of capacitor bank used in power factor correction is expressed in terms of
(a) kW
(b) kVA
(c) kVAR
(d) vo
lts
Ans: c
53. While testing a capacitor with ohm-metre, if the capacitor shows charging, but the final
resistance reading is appreciably less than normal, it can be concluded that the capacitor is
(a) short-circuited
(b) open circuited
(c) alright
(d) lea
ky
Jo
Ans: d
in
@
(a) 800 uC
P
(b) 900 uC
U
B
(c) 1200 uC
TE
(d) 1600
C
uC Ans: c
H
-T
el
55. Which capacitor will be physically smaller for the same ratings ?
eg
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Ans: a
56. What is the value of capacitance that must be connected in parallel with 50 pF
condenser to make an equivalent capacitance of 150 pF ?
(a) 50 pF
(b) 100 pF
(c) 150 pF
(d) 200
pF Ans:
b
57. A mica capacitor and a ceramic capacitor both have the same physical dimensions.
Which will have more value of capacitance ?
(a) Ceramic capacitor
(b) Mica capacitor
(c) Both will have identical value of capacitance
(d) It depends on applied
voltage Ans: a
58. Which of the following material has least value of dielectric constant ?
(a) Ceramics
(b) Oil
(c) Glass
(d) Pap
er Ans:
b
59. Which of the following capacitors will have the least value of breakdown voltage ?
(a) Mica
(b) Paper
(c) Ceramic
(d) Electrolyt
ic Ans: d
(a) 20 to 60 volts
in
volts Ans:
U
B
TE
(a) 200
H
(b) 100
-T
el
(c) 3 to 8
eg
(d) 1 to
ra
2 Ans:
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
c
61. The value of dielectric constant for vacuum is taken as
(a) zero
(b) 1
(c) 4
(d) 1
0
Ans
:b
63. Which of the following capacitors can be used for temperature compensation ?
(a) Air capacitor
(b) Ceramic capacitor
(c) Paper capacitor
(d) None of the
above Ans: b
(c) ± 15%
in
(d) ± 20%
@
Ans: b
SP
P
66. For closer tolerances which of the following capacitors is usually preferred ?
U
B
above Ans: b
eg
ra
67. The electrostatic force between two charges of one coulomb each and placed at a
m
distance of 0.5 m will be
(a) 36 x 10fa
(b) 36 x 107 N
(c) 36 x 108 N
(d) 36 x 109 N
Ans: d
69. "The surface integral of the normal component of the electric displacement D over any
closed surface equals the charge enclosed by the surface".
The above statement is associated with
(a) Gauss's law
(b) Kirchhoff s law
(c) Faraday's law
(d) Lenz's
law Ans: a
Ans: d
in
@
(a) Paper
P
(b) Air
U
B
(c) Mica
TE
(d) Electrolyt
C
H
ic Ans: b
-T
el
(a) Air
ra
m
(b) Paper
(e) Mica
(d) Electrolytic
Ans: d
75. capacitors are used for audio frequency and radio frequency coupling and tuning.
(a) Air
(b) Mica
(c) Plastic film
(d) Ceram
ic Ans: b
78. The potential gradient across the material of low permittivity is than across the
material of high permittivity.
Jo
(a) smaller
in
(b) greater
@
above Ans: b
B
TE
(a) Electric
-T
(b) Magnetic
el
81. A single core cable used on 33000 V has conductor diameter 10 mm and the in¬ternal
diameter of sheath 25 mm. The maximum electrostatic stress in the cable is
(a) 62 x 105 V/m
(b) 72 x 105 V/m
(c) 82 x 105 V/m
(d) 92 x 105 V/m
Ans: b
82. Two infinite parallel plates 10 mm apart have maintained between them a potential
difference of 100 V. The acceleration of an electron placed between them is
(a) 0.56 x 1015 m/s2
(b) 1.5 x 1015 m/s2
(c) 1.6 x 1015 m/s2
(d) 1.76 x 1015 m/s2
Ans: d
(a) F/m
in
@
(b) m/F
SP
(c) Wb/m
P
(d) no
U
B
units Ans:
TE
c
C
H
85. The phenomenon of an uncharged body getting charged merely by the nearness of a
-T
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Ans: d
87. The number of Faraday tubes of flux passing through a surface in an electric field is
called
(a) electric flux
(6) electric flux density
(c) magnetic flux density
(d) electric charge
density Ans: a
89. The value of E within the field due to a point charge can be found with the help of
(a) Faraday's laws
(b) Kirchhoff s laws
(c) Coulomb's laws
(d) none of the
above Ans: c
90. at a point may be defined as equal to the lines of force passing normally through a unit
cross section at that point.
(a) Electric intensity
Jo
above Ans: a
PU
91. Electric intensity at any point in an electric field is equal to the at that point.
B
TE
above Ans: c
ra
m
92. Electric displacement is a quantity.
(a) scalar
(b) vector
(c) both of the above
(d) none of the
above Ans: b
97. is that property of a capacitor which delays any change of voltage across it.
@
(a) Inductance
SP
(b) Capacitance
P U
98. A capacitance of 100 fiF is connected in series with a resistance of 8000 £2. The time
el
(a) 0.2 s
ra
(b) 0.4 s
m
(c) 0.6 s
(d) 0.
8s
Ans:
d
100. The time constant of an R-C circuit is defined as the time during which capacitor
charging voltage actually rises to percent of its value.
(a) 37, initial
(b) 63.2, initial
(c) 63.2, final
(d) 37,
final Ans:
c
101. The time constant and R-C circuit may also be defined as the time during which the
charging current falls to percent of its initial maximum value,
(a) 37
(b) 42
(c) 63
(d) 7
3
Ans
:a
above Ans:
SP
P U
Ans: d
eg
ra
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(d) Weber/sq-
m Ans: b
106. What will happen to an insulating medium if voltage more than the breakdown
voltage is applied on it ?
(a) It will become magnetic
(b) It will melt
(c) It will get punctured or cracked
(d) Its molecular structure will get changed
Ans: c
(d) one
TE
joule Ans:
C
a
H
-T
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
111. The capacitance C is charged through a resistance R. The time constant of the charging
circuit is given by
(a) CIR
(b) 1/RC
(c) RC
(d) R
IC
Ans:
c
112. The bridge used for the measurement of the value of the capacitance is
(a) Wien's bridge
(b) Wheatstone bridge
(c) Schering bridge
(d) Hay's
bridge Ans: c
113. If an ohmmeter reading immediately goes practically to zero and stays there, capacitor is
(a) charged
(b) short-circuited
(c) lossy
(d) satisfactor
y Ans: b
114. Out of the following capacitors of identical rating which one will have the smallest
dimensions ?
(a) Aluminium foil capacitor
(b) Mica capacitor
(c) Ceramic capacitor
(d) Paper
capacitor Ans: c
(6) the uncharged conductor gets charged by induction and then attracted towards the
charging body
in
(c) the uncharged conductor is attracted first and then charged by induction
@
SP
(d) it remains as
such Ans: b
P U
B
TE
116. The presence of an uncharged conductor near a charged one increases the
(a) charge of the charged conductor
C
H
above Ans: b
m
117. Paper condenser is
(a) always polarised
(6) usually of fixed value
(c) electrolytic condenser
(d) a variable
condenser Ans: b
119. A potential of 400 V is applied to a capacitor, the plates of which are 4 mm apart. The
strength of electric field is
(a) 100 kV/m
(b) 10 kV/m
(c) 5 kV/m
(d) 2
kV/m
Ans: a
(d) ze
@
ro
SP
Ans:
P
d
U
B
TE
(b) Air capapitors have a black band to indicate the outside foil
-T
el
Ans: c
m
123. Which of the following capacitors preferred for high frequency circuits ?
(a) Air capacitor
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(b) Electrolytic capacitor
(c) Mica capacitor
(d) none of the
above Ans: c
126. If a third equal and similar charge is placed between two equal and similar charges,
then this third charge will
(a) move out of the field of influence of the two charges
(b) remain in stable equilibrium
(c) not be in equilibrium
(d) be in unstable
equilibrium Ans: b
(a) insulation
in
(b) conductor
@
over Ans: a
B
TE
130. Acharge which when placed in vacuum from an equal and similar charge repels with a
force of 9 x 10 N, is known as
(a) milli-coulomb
(b) micro-coulomb
(c) pico-coulomb
(d) coulo
mb Ans: b
132. A positive and a negative charge are initially 50 mm apart. When they are moved close
together so that they are now only 10 mm apart, the force between them will be
(a) 5 times smaller than before
(b) 5 times greater than before
(c) 10 times greater than before
(d) 25 times larger than before
Ans: d
(b) increases
in
@
(d) remain
P
unchanged Ans: a
U
B
TE
Ans: b
m
136. Which of the following capacitor is preferred in case of single phase motor ?
(a) Mica capacitor
(b) Paper capacitor
(c) Electrolytic capacitor
(d) Ceramic
capacitor Ans: c
1. Tesla is a unit of
(a) field strength
(b) inductance
Jo
(d) fl
@
SP
ux
P U
B
Ans:
TE
C
c
H
-T
el
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Ans: d
above Ans: b
above Ans: b
TE
C
(d) Magnetic
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
potential Ans: b
11. The two conductors of a transmission line carry equal current I in opposite directions.
The force on each conductor is
(a) proportional to 7
(b) proportional to X
(c) proportional to distance between the conductors
(d) inversely proportional to
I Ans: b
above Ans: b
SP
P
permeability Ans: d
eg
ra
m
17. The left hand rule correlates to
(a) current, induced e.m.f. and direc¬tion of force on a conductor
(b) magnetic field, electric field and direction of force on a conductor
(c) self induction, mutual induction and direction of force on a conductor
(d) current, magnetic field and direc¬tion of force on a conductor
Ans: d
19. A conductor of length L has current I passing through it, when it is placed parallel to a
magnetic field. The force experienced by the conductor will be
(a) zero
(b) BLI
(c) B2LI
(d) B
LI2
Ans: a
20. The force between two long parallel conductors is inversely proportional to
(a) radius of conductors
(b) current in one conductor
(c) product of current in two conduc¬tors
(d) distance between the conductors
Ans: d
density Ans: b
in
@
22. Indicate which of the following material does not retain magnetism permanently.
SP
Ans: a
-T
el
(a) cobalt
ra
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
(b) chromium
(c) nickel
(d) tungste
n Ans: c
27. Substances which have permeability less than the permeability of free space are known as
(a) ferromagnetic
(b) paramagnetic
(c) diamagnetic
(d) bipol
ar Ans: c
28. Two infinitely long parallel conductors in vacuum anf' separated 1 metre between centres
>rhen a current of 1 ampere flows thn. ugh each conductor, produce on each otLer a force of
(a) 2 x 1(T2 N/m)
Jo
Ans: d
P U
B
(a) voltage
C
H
(b) current
-T
33. The working of a meter is based on the use of a permanent magnet. In order to protect the
meter functioning from stray magnetic fields
(a) meter is surrounded by strong magnetic fields
(b) a soft iron shielding is used
(c) a plastic shielding is provided
(d) a shielding of anon-magnetic material is used
Ans: b
(b) susceptibility
in
(c) permittivity
@
(d) conductanc
SP
e Ans: a
PU
(b) ferrites
H
-T
(d) diamagnetic
eg
materials Ans: d
ra
m
36. Which of the following is the unit of magnetic flux density ?
(a) weber
(b) lumens
(c) tesla
(d) none of the
above Ans: c
37. The magnetism left in the iron after exciting field has been removed is known as
(a) permeance
(b) residual magnetism
(c) susceptance
(d) reluctan
ce Ans: b
42. Out of the following statements, concerning an electric field, which statement is not true
@
?
SP
(b) The electric field intensity at a point is numerically equal to the force exerted upon a
B
(c) An electric field is defined as a point in space at which an electric charge would
C
H
experienc* a force
-T
(d) Unit field intensity in the exertion of a force of one newton on a charge of one
el
coulomb
eg
Ans: b
ra
m
43. When a magnet is in motion relative to a coil the induced e.m.f. does not depend upon
(a) resistance of the coil
(b) motion of the magnet
(c) number of turns of the coil
(d) pole strength of the
magnet Ans: a
46. When two ends of a circular uniform wire are joined to the terminals of a battery, the
field at the centre of the circle
(a) will be zero
(b) will be infinite
(c) will depend on the amount of e.m.f. applied
(d) will depend on the radius of the circle
Ans: d
48. Two long parallel conductors carry 100 A. If the conductors are separated by 20 mm,
the force per metre of length of each conductor will be
(a) 100 N
(b) 10 N
(c) 1 N
Jo
(d) 0.1
in
N Ans:
@
d
SP
P
49. A 300 mm long conductor is carrying a current of 10 A and is situated at right angles to a
U
B
magnetic field having a flux density of 0.8 T ; the force on the conductor will be
TE
(a) 240 N
C
(6) 24 N
H
(c) 2.4 N
-T
el
(d) 0.24
eg
N Ans: c
ra
m
50. A 200 turn coil having an axial length of 30 mm and a radius of 10 mm is pivoted in a
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
magnetic field having a flux density of 0.8 T. If the coil carries a current of 0.5 A, the torque
acting on the coil will be
(a) 4.8 N-m
(b) 0.48 N-m
(e) 0.048 N-m
(d) 0.0048 N-
m
[Hint. Torque = 2BIlNr N-
m] Ans: c
51. The electromagnet has 50 turns and a current of 1A flows through the coil. If the length of
the magnet circuit is 200 mm, what is the magnetic field strength ?
(a) 2500 AT/m
(b) 250 AT/m
(c) 25 AT/m
(d) 2.5
AT/m Ans:
b
52. What is the magnitude and the direction of force per 1.1m length of a pair of conductors of
a direct current linecarrying 10 amperes and spaced 100 mm apart ?
(a) 22 x 10"8 N
(b) 22 x 10"7 N
(c) 22 x 10-6 N
(d) 22 x 10"5 N
Ans: d
53. A square cross-sectional magnet has a pole strength of 1 x 10 Wb and cross sectional area
of 20 mm x 20 mm. What is the strength at a distance of 100 mm from the unit pole in air ?
(a) 63.38 N/Wb
(b) 633.8 N/Wb
(c) 6338 N/Wb
(d) 63380 N/Wb
Ans: c
(a) reluctance
in
(b) resistance
@
(c) permeance
SP
(d) pole
P
U
strength Ans: d
B
TE
(a) ampere-hour
-T
(b) watt
el
eg
(c) joule
ra
(d) coulomb
m
Ans: d
61. The most effective and quickest may of making a magnet from soft iron is by
(a) placing it inside a coil carrying current
(b) induction
(c) the use of permanent magnet
(d) rubbing with another magnet
Ans: a
63. If a copper disc is rotated rapidly below a freely suspended magnetic needle, the
magnetic needle shall start rotating with a velocity
(a) less than that of disc but in opposite direction
(b) equal to that of disc and in the same direction
(c) equal to that of disc and in the opposite direction
(d) less than that of disc and in the same direction
Ans: d
Ans: a
SP
P
(b) transformers
C
(d) electromagnet
el
s Ans: a
eg
ra
67. The materials are a bit inferior conductors of magnetic flux than air.
(a) ferromagnetic
(b) paramagnetic
(c) diamagnetic
(d) dielectr
ic Ans: c
68. Hysteresis loop in case of magnetically hard materials is more in shape as compared to
magnetically soft materials.
(a) circular
(b) triangular
(c) rectangular
(d) none of the
above Ans: c
69. A rectangular magnet of magnetic moment M is cut into two piece of same length, the
magnetic moment of each piece will be
(a) M
(6) M/2
(c) 2 M
(d) M
/4
Ans:
b
flux Ans: d
@
SP
(d) vector
H
quantity Ans: d
-T
el
eg
72. The change of cross-sectional area of conductor in magnetic field will affect
ra
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(c) (a) and (b) b >th in the same way
(d) none of the
above Ans: c
75. What will be the current passing through the ring shaped air cored coil when number of
turns is 800 and ampere turns are 3200 ?
(a) 2
(b) 4
(c) 6
(d) 8
Ans
:b
76. What will be the magnetic potential difference across the air gap of 2 cm length in
magnetic field of 200 AT/m ?
(a) 2 AT
(b) 4 AT
(c) 6 AT
(d) 10
AT
Ans: b
Jo
(a) The magnetic flux inside an exciting coil is lower than its outside surface
SP
(e) The magnetic flux inside the exciting coil is greater than its outside surface
U
B
(d) The magnetic flux inside the exciting coil is same as on its outside surface Ans: d
TE
C
78. A certain amount of current flows through a ring-shaped coil with fixed number of
H
netic induction B varies inside the coil if an iron core is threaded into coil without
el
eg
(a) Decreases
m
(b) Increases
(c) Remains same
(d) First increases and then decreases depending on the depth of iron in¬sertion
Ans: b
82. How does the magnetic compass needle behave in a magnetic field ?
(a) It assures a position right angle to magnetic field
(b) It starts rotating
(c) It assures a position which follows a line of magnetic flux
(d) None of the
above Ans: c
(d) a line of magnetic flux which does not follow the designed path
Ans: d
P U
B
above Ans: a
ra
m
86. Which of the following materials are dia-magnetic ?
(a) Silver
(b) Copper
(c) Silver and copper
(d) Ir
on
Ans:
c
87. Which of the following type of materials are not very important for engineering
applications ?
(a) Ferromagnetic
(b) Paramagnetic
(c) Diamagnetic
(d) None of the
above Ans: c
89. For which of the following materials the saturation value is the highest ?
(a) Ferromagnetic materials
(6) Paramagnetic materials
(c) Diamagnetic materials
(d) Ferrit
es Ans: d
above Ans: c
P U
B
91. For which of the following materials the net magnetic moment should be zero ?
TE
(d) Antiferrimagnetic
eg
materials Ans: c
ra
m
92. The attraction capacity of electromagnet will increase if the
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(a) core length increases i
(b) core area increases
(c) flux density decreases
(d) flux density
increases Ans: d
above Ans: c
C
H
(a) heating
eg
(b) hammering
ra
m
(c) by inductive action of another magnet
(d) by all above
methods Ans: d
MAGNETIC CIRCUIT
above Ans: c
1000 Ans: d
(c) conductivity
in
@
(d) conductanc
SP
e Ans: c
P U
9. Those magnetic materials are best suited for making armature and transformer cores
which have permeability and hystersis loss.
(a) high, high
(b) low, high
(c) high, low
(d) low,
low Ans:
c
Ans: b
P U
B
11. When both the inductance and resistance of a coil are doubled the value of
TE
halved Ans: a
m
12. The initial rate of rise of current through a coil of inductance 10 H when suddenly
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
connected to a D.C. supply of 200 V is Vs
(a) 50
(b) 2
0 (c)
0.05
(d) 500
Ans:
b
16. Those materials are well suited for making permanent magnets which
have retentivity and coercivity.
(a) low, high
(b) high, high
(c) high, low
Jo
(d) low,
in
low Ans:
@
b
SP
17. If the area of hysteresis loop of a material is large, the hysteresis loss in this material
P U
will be
B
(a) zero
TE
(b) small
C
H
(c) large
-T
above Ans: c
ra
m
18. Hard steel is suitable for making permanent magnets because
(a) it has good residual magnetism
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(b) its hysteresis loop has large area
(c) its mechanical strength is high
(d) its mechanical strength is
low Ans: a
21. The property of a material which opposes the creation of magnetic flux in it is known as
(a) reluctivity
(b) magnetomotive force
(c) permeance
(d) reluctan
ce Ans: d
(b) permeance
in
(c) permeability
@
SP
(d) susceptibilit
y Ans: b
P
U
B
24. While comparing magnetic and electric circuits, the flux of magnetic circuit is compared
TE
(a) E.m.f.
-T
(b) Current
el
(d) Conductivity
ra
m
Ans: b
26. A ferrite core has less eddy current loss than an iron core because
(a) ferrites have high resistance
(b) ferrites are magnetic
(c) ferrites have low permeability
(d) ferrites have high hysteresis
Ans: d
ELECTROMAGNETIC INDUCTION
1. The property of coil by which a counter e.m.f. is induced in it when the current through
the coil changes is known as
Jo
(a) self-inductance
in
(d) capacitan
U
B
TE
ce Ans: a
C
H
-T
whenever it
eg
ra
m
(a) lies perpendicular to the magnetic flux
(b) lies in a magnetic field
(e) cuts magnetic flux
(d) moves parallel to the direction of the magnetic field Ans:
3. Which of the following circuit element stores energy in the electromagnetic field ?
(a) Inductance
(b) Condenser
(c) Variable resistor
(d) Resistan
ce Ans: a
4. The inductance of a coil will increase under all the following conditions except
(a) when more length for the same number of turns is provided
(6) when the number of turns of the coil increase
(c) when more area for each turn is provided
(d) when permeability of the core increases
Ans: a
6. In an iron cored coil the iron core is removed so that the coil becomes an air cored coil.
The inductance of the coil will
Jo
(a) increase
in
(b) decrease
@
Ans: b
U
B
TE
8. Both the number of turns and the core length of an inductive coil are doubled.
Its self-inductance will be
(a) unaffected
(b) doubled
(c) halved
(d) quadruple
d Ans: b
9. If current in a conductor increases then according to Lenz's law self-induced voltage will
(a) aid the increasing current
(b) tend to decrease the amount of cur-rent
(c) produce current opposite to the in-creasing current
(d) aid the applied
voltage Ans: c
linkages Ans: d
@
SP
above Ans: d
el
eg
15. The law that the induced e.m.f. and current always oppose the cause producing them is
due to
(a) Faraday
(b) Lenz
(c) Newton
(d) Coulo
mb Ans: b
18. Which of the following circuit elements will oppose the change in circuit current ?
(a) Capacitance
(b) Inductance
(c) Resistance
(d) All of the
above Ans: b
Jo
(d) Any capacitance even if present in the circuit will not be charged
B
Ans: c
TE
C
(a) Ohm
el
(b) Henry
eg
21. An e.m.f. of 16 volts is induced in a coil of inductance 4H. The rate of change of current
must be
(a) 64 A/s
(b) 32 A/s
(c) 16 A/s
(d) 4
A/s
Ans: d
22. The core of a coil has a length of 200 mm. The inductance of coil is 6 mH. If the core
length is doubled, all other quantities, remaining the same, the in ductance will be
(a) 3 mH
(b) 12 mH
(c) 24m
H
(d)48m
H Ans:
a
23. The self inductances of two coils are 8 mH and 18 mH. If the co-efficients of coupling is
0.5, the mutual inductance of the coils is
(a) 4 mH
(b) 5 mH
(c) 6 mH
(d) 12
mH
Ans: c
24. Two coils have inductances of 8 mH and 18 mH and a co-efficient of coupling of 0.5. If
the two coils are connected in series aiding, the total inductance will be
(a) 32 mH
(b) 38 mH
(c) 40 mH
Jo
(d) 48
in
mH
@
Ans: b
SP
P
25. A 200 turn coil has an inductance of 12 mH. If the number of turns is increased to 400
U
turns, all other quantities (area, length etc.) remaining the same, the inductance will be
B
TE
(a) 6 mH
C
(b) 14 mH
H
(c) 24 mH
-T
el
(d) 48
eg
mH
ra
Ans: d
m
26. Two coils have self-inductances of 10 H and 2 H, the mutual inductance being zero. If
the two coils are connected in series, the total inductance will be
(a) 6 H
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(b) 8 H
(c) 12 H
(d) 24
H
Ans: c
27. In case all the flux from the current in coil 1 links with coil 2, the co-efficient of coupling
will be
(a) 2.0
(b) 1.0
(c) 0.5
(d)
zero
Ans:
b
28. A coil with negligible resistance has 50V across it with 10 mA. The inductive reactance
is
(a) 50 ohms
(b) 500 ohms
(c) 1000 ohms
(d) 5000
ohms Ans: d
29. A conductor 2 metres long moves at right angles to a magnetic field of flux density 1
tesla with a velocity of 12.5 m/s. The induced e.m.f. in the conductor will be
(a) 10 V
(6) 15 V
(c) 25V
(d) 5
0V
Ans:
c
(b) charge
in
(c) energy
@
(d) induced
SP
e.m.f. Ans: c
P U
B
31. A conductor carries 125 amperes of current under 60° to a magnetic field of 1.1 tesla.
TE
(a) 50 N
-T
(b) 120 N
el
(c) 240 N
eg
ra
(d) 480
m
N Ans:
b
32. Find the force acting on a conductor 3m long carrying a current of 50 amperes at right
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
angles to a magnetic field having a flux density of 0.67 tesla.
(a) 100 N
(b) 400 N
(c) 600 N
(d) 1000 N
Ans: a
33. The co-efficient of coupling between two air core coils depends on
(a) self-inductance of two coils only
(b) mutual inductance between two coils only
(c) mutual inductance and self inductance of two coils
(d) none of the
above Ans: c
35. A 500 turns solenoid develops an average induced voltage of 60 V. Over what time
interval must a flux change of 0.06 Wb occur to produce such a voltage ?
(a) 0.01 s
(b) 0.1 s
(c) 0.5 s
(d) 5
s
Ans:
c
36. Which of the fpllowing inductor will have the least eddy current losses ?
(a) Air core
Jo
core Ans: a
P U
B
37. A coil induces 350 mV when the current changes at the rate of 1 A/s. The value of
TE
inductance is
C
(a) 3500 mH
H
(b) 350 mH
-T
el
(c) 250 mH
eg
(d) 150
ra
mH Ans:
m
b
38. Two 300 uH coils in series without mutual coupling have a total inductance of
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
(a) 300 uH
(b) 600 uH
(c) 150 uH
(d) 75
uH
Ans: b
40. Which circuit element(s) will oppose the change in circuit current ?
(a) Resistance only
(b) Inductance only
(c) Capacitance only
(d) Inductance and
capacitance Ans: b
42. A coil is wound on iron core which carries current I. The self-induced voltage in the coil
is not affected by
(a) variation in coil current
(b) variation in voltage to the coil
(c) change of number of turns of coil
Jo
Ans: b
@
SP
43. A moving magnetic field will produce the same effect as a conductor that is moving.
P
(a) Yes
U
B
(b) N
TE
o
C
Ans:
H
-T
44. The polarity of the induced voltage can be determined by using the left-hand generator
el
eg
rule.
ra
(a) Yes
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
(b) N
Ans:
o
a
45. Increasing the field or increasing the current will decrease the force on the conductor.
(a) Yes
(b) N
o
Ans:
b
46. Reversing the field or the current will reverse the force on the conductor.
(a) Yes
(b) N
o
Ans:
a
47. When a conductor moves in the field, so that it makes an angle 8 with the lines of flux,
the force F is given as : F = Bl sin2 0.
(a) Yes
(b) N
o
Ans:
b
48. The self-inductance of the coil may be defined as equal to the e.m.f. induced in volts
when the current in the circuit changes at the rate of unit weber turns.
(a) Yes
(b) N
o
Ans:
b
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit I: Elementary Concepts
SESSION I MCQ
1 Materials with lots of free electrons are called…..
A. Conductors B. insulators
C. Semiconductors D. Filters
A. Coulomb B. joule
C. Volt D. watt
A. a switch is opened
B. a switch is closed
A. voltage
B. current
Jo
C. capacitance
in
@
D. inductance
SP
7. A material that does not allow current under normal conditions is a(n)…..
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
A. Insulator B. conductor
C. Semiconductor D. valence
8. A multimeter measures….
A. Current
B. Voltage
C. Resistance
D. current, voltage, and resistance
A. Current
B. Voltage
C. Resistance
D. none of the above
SESSION 2 MCQ
1. Copper
2. Platinum
3. Mercury
4. Carbon
Answer: 4
2. Determine the length of a copper wire that has resistance of 0.172 and a cross-sectional area
of 1 x 10-4 m2. The resistivity of copper is 1.72 x 10-8 m.
(a) 0.1 m
(b) 10 m
Jo
(c) 100 m
in
(d) 1000 m
@
Ans-D
SP
P U
B
TE
SESSION 3 MCQ
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
1. Unit of RTC ……
a. Ampere
b. /˚c
c. ohm
d. ˚c
Ans: b
SESSION 4 MCQ
R
b. Ri = ln 2
2 l R1
c. Ri = ρ/ 2пl * R1 *R2
d. Ri = ρ/ 2пl * R1 /R2
Ans: b
SESSION 5 MCQ
C. Kilojoules
in
Answer: D
P
U
B
TE
A. 5
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
B. 2
C. 746
D. 6
Answer: A
Answer: D
A. 1500
B. 150
C. 15000
D. 15
Answer: A
5. Name the physical quantity which is equal to the product of force and velocity.
A. Work
B. Energy
C. Power
D. acceleration
Answer: C
Jo
in
SESSION 6 MCQ
@
SP
A. Distance
U
B. Acceleration
B
TE
C. Velocity
C
D. Speed
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Answer: A
2. The work done in moving a unit positive charge across two points in an electric circuit is a
measure of ___________.
A. Current
B. Potential difference
C. Resistance
D. Power
Answer: B
1. What are the effects of moving a closed wire loop through a magnetic field?
a. A voltage is induced in the wire.
b. A current is induced in the wire.
c. The polarity across the wire depends on the direction of motion.
d. All of the above
2. The current going away from the observer is represented by a
a) Dot
b) Cross
c) Line
d) Circle
a) Dot
b) Cross
c) Line
d) Circle
4. A solenoid of 100cm is wound on a brass tube. If the current through the coil is 0.5A, the
number of turns necessary over the solenoid to produce a field strength of 500AT/m at the centre
of coil are
a) 500
b) 1700
c) 100
Jo
in
d) 1000
@
SP
c) Magnetic dipoles
TE
d) Magnetic domains
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
SESSION : 08 MCQ
1. Permeability is the inverse equivalent of which electrical term?
a. Voltage
b. Current
c. Resistance
d. Conductance
2.What is the flux density of a magnetic field whose flux is 3000 microWb and cross-sectional
area is 0.25 m2 ?
a. 12,000 microT
b. 83,330 T
c. 0 T
d More information is needed in order to find flux density.
3.How much flux is there in a magnetic field when its flux density is 5000 T and its cross-
sectional area is 300 mm2 ?
a. 16.67 mWb
b 5.0 microWb
c. 3.0 mWb
d. 1.5 microWb
SESSION : 09 MCQ
1. Permeability in a magnetic circuit corresponds to__________in an electric circuit
a) reluctivity
b) resistivity
c) conductivity
d)conductance
Jo
in
a)resistance
SP
P
b)charge
U
B
TE
c)emf
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
d)reactance
a)resistance
b)charge
c)emf
d)reactance
a)charge density
b)charge
c)current density
d)electron density
a)permittivity
b)conductance
c)resistance
d)reactance
SESSION : 10 MCQ
Jo
in
1. There will be force of attraction between two current-carrying conductors if the currents are
@
SP
in __________ direction.
P U
a. Same
B
b. Opposite
TE
c. None of these
C
H
d. Cannot say
-T
el
eg
ra
m
2. The direction of induced current is obtained by
SESSION : 11 MCQ
1) The force experienced by a current carrying conductor lying parallel to magnetic field is
a) BIl
b) BIlsinθ
c) HiL
d)zero
2) Fleming's right hand rule shows the direction of induced current when a conductor moves in a
magnetic field. The First finger represents the
d)none of these
SESSION : 12 MCQ
1. In the phenomenon of mutual induction
a) Magnetic coupling takes place between two coils carrying a current.
b) The unit of the coefficient of coupling k is Henry.
c) The coefficient of coupling k can have any value from 0 to ∞.
d) Mutual inductance M is proportional to the sum of self-inductances of coils
Jo
in
2) If the current in an inductor doubles, the energy stored in the inductor will
@
(b) Double,
P
(c) Quadruple,
U
(d) Halve.
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
Unit III: Single Phase Transformers and
Electrostatics
SESSION 13 MCQ
3 When the turns ratio of transformer is 20 and primary ac voltage is 12V, the secondary
voltage is ---------------
a) 12 V
b) 120 V
c) 240 V
d) 2400 V
4 For a transformer the turns ratio is 10 : 1 then its primary resistance of 10 Ω will be ----------
When referred to secondary.
a) 1 Ω
b) 0.1 Ω
c) 0.01 Ω
d) 10 Ω
5 The Emf Equation of transformer in secondary side is ----------
a) 4.44fϕmN1
b) 4.44fϕmN2
Jo
c) 4.44fϕmN1N2
in
d) 4.44fϕmN2
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
SESSION 14 MCQ
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
1A transformer has 200 W iron losses at full load. The iron loss at half full load is --------
a) 100 W
b) 200 W
c) 300 W
d) 400 W
2Full load copper loss in transformer is 1600 W. At half load the loss will be --------------
a) 400
b) 1600
c) 3200
d) 6400
SESSION 15 MCQ
a) Low, high
@
b) High, low
SP
P
c) Both high
U
B
d) Both low
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
SESSION 16 MCQ
2) An advantage of autotransformer is
a) Copper saving
b) Efficiency is 100%
c) Highly stable voltage
d) None of these
3) An autotransformer-----------------
a) Increases the iron loss
b) Converts single phase to three Phase.
c) Uses common winding between single phase and three phase
d) None
SESSION 17MCQ
U
B
TE
1).A capacitor is charged to 100mC and the energy stored is 10J then the capacitor value is-
C
-------------
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
a) 50µF
b) 5µF
c) 0.5µF
d) 500µF
2) Two capacitor 3µF and 6µF are in parallel and combination is connected across 100V
supply then the charge on 6µF is -----------------µC
a) 300
b) 600
c) 1200
d) 100
3) A capacitor is charged to 100mC and the energy stored is 10J then the capacitor value is--
e) 50µF
f) 5µF
g) 0.5µF
h) 500µF
4) A capacitor is made up of two dielectric having constant 2 and 5 with thickness 1mm and
2 mm respectively. If area of cross section is 50 cm2then capacitance is -------------------
a) 110.075pF
b) 49.188pF
c) 8.854µF
d) 2.03nF
SESSION 18 MCQ
Jo
in
1 When fully charged capacitor to V is discharged through R, the expression for the capacitor
@
voltage is -----------
SP
P U
a)
B
TE
b)
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
c)
d)
2 When a capacitor ‘C’ is charge through resistance R then the initial rate of rise of
capacitor voltage is ------------
a) VRC
b) V/RC
c) VR/C
d) VC/R
3 Two capacitor 2 µF and 8 µF are in series and the combination is connected across 50V ,
then the energy stored in 8 µF capacitor is ----------µJ
a) 200
b) 100
c) 400
d) 2000
4.A capacitor of 1µF, is charged to 100 V. It is disconnected and then connected across another
1µF capacitor. Then the new voltage across them is --------------------
a) 100V
b) 50V
c) 150V
d) 0V
5.A capacitor of 1µF is charged through resistor of 1MΩ from a 100 V source then voltage
across capacitor after 2 sec is--------------------
a) 36.8 V
b) 63.212V
c) 86.466V
d) 100V
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit IV: AC Fundamentals
SESSION 19 MCQ
a. Crest value
b. Effective value ,virtual value
c. Peak value
d. None
a. Waveform
b. Cycle
c. Time period
d. Frequency
a. Waveform
Jo
b. Cycle
in
c. Time period
@
d. Frequency
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
SESSION 20 MCQ
Q 1) The RMS value of current or voltage is __________ times the maximum value of voltage or
current
a. 0.637
b. 0.707
c. 1.414
d. 1.11
e. Crest value
f. Effective value ,virtual value
g. Peak value
h. None
a. 0.637
b. 0.642
c. 0.14
d. 1.11
Q4) A Resultant current is made up of two components, a 10A DC component and a sinusoidal
component of max value 14.14A.the average value of resultant current is ----A.
a. 0
b. 24.14
c. 10
d. 4.14
Q5) The RMS Value of sinusoidal AC Current is equal to its value at an angle of ----- degree.
Jo
a. 60
in
b. 45
@
c. 30
SP
d. 90
P U
B
TE
C
SESSION 21 MCQ
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Q1) From the voltage equation, eA=Em sin100πt & eB=Em sin (100 πt+ π/6), it is obvious that-
a. A leads B by 30 degree
b. B achieves its maximum value 1/600 second before A
c. B lags behind A
d. A achieves its zero value 1/600 second before B
Q 2) The relation between Phasor diagram of voltage and current in pure inductive circuit is
Q 3) The relation between Phasor diagram of voltage and current in pure capacitive circuit is
SESSION 22 MCQ
a. 6.196<26.2
b. 14.546<60
c. 2<150
d. 25<24
Q2) A complex current wave is given by-i=5+5sin 100 πt. Its average value is-
a. 10
Jo
b. 0
in
@
c. Root50
SP
d. 5
P U
e3=40cos(wt+π/6)
TE
C
H
a. 25.10<32.33
-T
el
eg
ra
m
b. 20.18<31.32
c. 32.68<68.32
d. 32.32<25.10
Q 4) The voltage of 200 < + 450 V is applied to R = 5 Ω then the current is ___________A
a) 1000<450
b) 40 < + 450
c) 40<00
d) 1000<00
a) 2< -173.130
b) 2<6.870
c) 50<113.13010
d) 2<113.130
SESSION 23 MCQ
a) 4.33 A
b) 6.123 A
c) 8.66 A
d) 3.061 A
Q2) An alternating voltage is given by –v=30sin314t,the time taken by the voltage to reach 30v
for first time is-
a. 0.02sec
Jo
b. 0.1sec
in
@
c. 0.03sec
SP
d. 0.005sec
P U
a. 50Hz
C
H
b. 25Hz
-T
el
eg
ra
m
c. 100Hz
d. 75Hz
a. 60.60 Ω
b. 60.99 Ω
c. 63.66 Ω
d. 59.22 Ω
a. 2.5 ms
b. 2.083 ms
c. 3 ms
d. 2.11 ms
SESSION 24 MCQ
a) Purely resistive
b) Purely inductive
c) Purely capacitive
d) None of these
a) Zero
b) Infinite
c) One
Jo
d) Negative
in
@
a) Zero
P U
b) Infinite
B
TE
c) One
C
d) Negative
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Q 4) The voltage of 200 < + 450 V is applied to R = 5 Ω then the current is ___________A
e) 1000<450
f) 40 < + 450
g) 40<00
h) 1000<00
Q 5) If pure R and Pure L are connected in series, the current will ___________ the applied
voltage
a) Lead
b) In phase with
c) A lag
d) None of these
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING D. nucleus
Ans. A
UNIT IA Que. The resistance of human body is around
THEORY QUESTIONS (1 MARK EACH) A. 5 ohms
B. 25 ohms
Que. Two wires A and B of same material and C. 250 ohms
length L and 2L have radius r and 2r D. 1000 ohms
respectively. The ratio of their specific Ans. D
resistance will be
A. 1:1 Que. One commercial unit of energy equals
B. 1:2 A. 500 watt seconds
C. 1:4 B. one watt hour
D. 1:8 C. one Kilowatt hour
Ans. A D. ten kilowatt hour
Ans. C
Que. Two wires A and B of same material and
length L and 2L have radius r and 2r Que. One coulomb charge equals the charge
respectively. The ratio of their resistances will on
be A. 6.24x1012 electrons
A. 1:1 B. 6.24x1014 electrons
B. 2:1 C. 6.24x1016 electrons
C. 4: 1 D. 6.24x1018 electrons
D. 1:8 Ans. D
Ans. B
Que. Electric pressure is also called
Que. The hot resistance of filament of a bulb is A. resistance
higher than the cold resistance because the B. power
temperature coefficient of filament is C. voltage
A. negative D. energy
B. infite Ans. C
C. zero
D. positive Que. With rise in temperature resistance of
Ans. D pure metals
A. increases
Que. Insulation resistance of the insulating B. decreases
material should be C. first increases then decreases
A. high D. remains constant
Jo
B. low Ans. A
in
C. zero
D. none of these
@
Ans. A semiconductors
P
A. increases
U
A. electrons
TE
D. remains constant
H
C. atoms
-T
el
1
eg
ra
m
Ans. B A. chemical
B. mechanical
Que. Which of the following material has C. electrical
nearly zero temperature coefficient of D. thermal
resistance Ans. C
A. manganin
B. porcelain Que. I = ___/t amp
C. carbon A. R
D. copper B. L
Ans. A C. Q
D. t
Que. Which of the following material has a Ans. C
negative temperature coefficient of resistance
A. copper Que. The ability of a charged particle to do
B. aluminium work is called
C. carbon A. potential difference
D. brass B. electric potential
Ans. C C. magnitude
D. magnetism
Que. Ohm‟s law is not applicable to Ans. B
A. vaccume tubes
B. carbon resistor Que. The unit of electric potential is ___
C. high voltage circuits A. amp
D. circuits at low current densities B. coulomb
Ans. A C. volt
D. tesla
Que. Which one of the following does not Ans. C
have negative temperature coefficient
A. aluminium Que. 1 calorie = ___
B. paper A. 4.186 joules
C. rubber B. 0.24 joules
D. mica C. 4186 joules
Ans. A D. 4186 KJ
Ans. A
Que. An electrical effort required to drift the
free electrons in one particular direction, in a Que. Unit of resistivity is ____
conductor is called __ A. Ω
A. MMF B. Ω-m
Jo
B. EMF C. Ω/m
in
Ans. B
P
2
eg
ra
m
D. Henry C. zero
Ans. B D. all above
Ans. B
Que. The material having highest value of
____ is best conductor Que. Resistance temperature coefficient is
A. resistivity denoted by ____
B. conductivity A. α
C. permittivity B. β
D. all above C. θ
Ans. B D. Φ
Ans. A
Que. The material having poorest value of
____ is best insulator. Que. The RTC at tOC is ratio of _____
A. resistivity A. change in conductance per degree Celsius
B. conductivity to the resistance at t 0C
C. permittivity B. change in resistance per degree Celsius to
D. all above the resistance at t0C
Ans. B C. change in initial resistance per degree
Celsius to the resistance at t0C
Que. Factors which affect the resistance _____ D. all above
A. length of the material Ans. B
B. cross sectional area
C. temprature Que. Unit of RTC is ____
D. all above A. OC
Ans. D B. /OC
C. Ω/OC
Que. Effect of temperature on resistance D. Ω
depends on ____ of material Ans. B
A. size
B. shape Que. Insulation resistance is defined as
C. nature opposition to the flow of ____
D. length A. current
Ans. C B. voltage
C. leakage current
Que. Resistance of carbon _____ as the D. all above
temperature increases Ans. C
A. increases
B. remains same Que. Insulation resistance Ri = V/Il, in this V
Jo
C. decreses is ____
in
coefficient Ans. A
B
TE
A. positive
C
B. negative
H
-T
el
3
eg
ra
m
Que. Insulation resistance Ri = V/Il, in this Il is D. none of the above
____ Ans. B
A. current
B. voltage Que. Which effect of electrical current is
C. leakage current utilised in thermal systems
D. line current A. Magnetic
Ans. C B. chemical
C. heating
Que. Insulation resistance is ______ D. all above
proportional to its length Ans. C
A. directly
B. inversely Que. As per the Joule,s law the amount of heat
C. never produced is proportional to
D. none of above A. I.R
Ans. B B. V.I
C. V.I.t
Que. Insulation resistance is inversely D. I2R
proportional to its ______ Ans. C
A. length
B. area Que. Geyser is a example of which system
C. diameter A. Mechanical
D. cross sectional area B. Electrical
Ans. A C. Thermal
D. None of above
Que. which of the following substance, the Ans. B
resistance decreases with the increase of
temperature? Que. Boiling temp. of water is
A. carbon A. 50
B. constantan B. 75
C. copper C. 100
D. silver D. 35
Ans. A Ans. C
Que. The conventional electric current is due Que. The amount of heat energy required to
to the flow of change the temp. of a given substance without
A. positive charges only change in the form of the substance is called as
B. negative charges only A. Sensible heat energy
C. neutral particles only B. Latent heat energy
Jo
Ans. A
SP
A. positive A. 1cal=4.12 J
B
TE
B. negative B. 1cal=4.186 J
C
C. zero C. 1cal=4.44 J
H
-T
el
4
eg
ra
m
D. 1cal=3.986 J B. Latent heat of vapourisation
Ans. B C. both of above
D. None of above
Que. The amount of heat energy required to Ans. B
change the form of the substance with change
in the temp. is called as Que. The unit of specific heat capacity is
A. Kinetic energy A. J/Kg
B. Potential energy B. J/KgK
C. Latent heat of energy C. Joule
D. All of above D. J-Kg
Ans. C Ans. B
Que. The amount of heat energy obtained by Que. WATER-PUMP SET is the example of
burning the unit mass of the fuel is called as which system
A. Molecular value A. Electro-mechanical system
B. Calorific value B. Electro-chemical system
C. Atomic value C. Only electrical system
D. None of above D. All above
Ans. B Ans. A
Que. which effect of electric current is utilized Que. One metre cube holds a water of
in electric lamps? A. 1000Kg
A. Magnetic effect B. 1000gm
B. Chemical effect C. 1000miligram
C. Heating effect D. none of above
D. All of above Ans. A
Ans. C
Que. Which relationship is correct
Que. The heat energy required to convert a A. P=T.ω
body from solid state to liquid state is called as B. P=T/ ω
A. Latent heat of fusion C. P=T.v
Jo
D. All of above
SP
5
eg
ra
m
Ans. B Que. Kinetic energy is given by
A. E=1/2 mV2
Que. Energy is defined as B. E=1/2 mV
A. workdone/time C. E=1/2m.t
B. capacity to do the work D. none of above
C. energy=power.resistance Ans. A
D. all above
Ans. B Que. Which of the following statements is
true?
Que. Effective water head of a Hydro-electric A. Electric current is measured in volts
power plant means it‟s B. 200 kΩresistance is equivalent to 2MΩ
A. loss C. An ammeter has a low resistance and must
B. height be connected in parallel with a circuit
C. friction D. An electrical insulator has a high resistance
D. none of above Ans. D
Ans. B
Que. What must be known in order to
Que. Efficiency is the ratio of calculate the energy used by an electrical
A. power and time appliance?
B. output and input A. voltage and current
C. input and output B. current and time of operation
D. above all C. power and time of operation
Ans. B D. current and resistance
Ans. C
Que. Wind-mill-Generator set is the example
of Que. Voltage drop is the
A. electro-chemical system A. maximum potential
B. electro-thermal system B. difference in potential between two points
C. mechanical-electrical system C. voltage produced by a source
D. all above D. voltage at the end of a circuit
Ans. C Ans. B
Que. Which relationship is correct? Que. The opposition to the flow of leakage
A. volume=mass. Density current is called as
B. volume=mass/density A. resistance
C. volume=mass +density B. leakage coefficient
D. none of above C. insulation resistance
Ans. B D. all above
Jo
Ans. C
in
B. E=m.g A. Ohms
P
Ans. B
H
-T
el
6
eg
ra
m
Que. The insulation resistance of a cable is Que. When the Humidity in the surrounding
A. directly proportional to length of cable increases, the leakage current in the cable will
B. inversly proportional to length of cable A. remain same
C. remains same with change in length B. increase
D. none of above C. decrease
Ans. B D. all of above
Ans. B
Que. Which is the expression for insulation
resistance of a single core cable Que. Factors affecting the insulation resistance
A. R =ρ l/a of a cable are
ρ
B. Ri =2πl 𝑙𝑛(R2/R1) A. length
ρ B. thickness
C. Ri=2πl (R2/R1)
C. resistivity of insulating material
D. R= V/I D. all above
Ans. B Ans. D
increase of?
@
increases,then the insulation resistance will B. Both Length and Cross-section area of
A. decrease
P
material.
U
Ans. C
H
Ans. A
-T
el
7
eg
ra
m
A. Resistance will remain same.
Que. According to Ohm‟s law current is B. No effect on resistance.
directly proportional to? C. Resistance will increase.
A. Resistance of material. D. Resistance will decrease.
B. Voltage across it. Ans. D
C. Both Voltage and Resistance.
D. Temp. Que. What will be the effect on the resistance
Ans. B of insulating material if the temperature
increases?
Que. According to Ohm‟s law current is A. No effect on resistance.
inversely proportional to? B. Resistance will increase.
A. Voltage across it. C. Resistance will remain same.
B. Both Voltage and Resistance. D. Resistance will decrease.
C. Resistance of material. Ans. D
D. Temp.
Ans. C Que. What will be the effect on the resistance
of insulating material if the temperature
Que. What are the factors on which resistance decreases?
of material depends?
A. Length and Cross-section area of material. A. Resistance will remain same.
B. Temperature of material. B. No effect on resistance.
C. Specific resistivity of material. C. Resistance will increase.
D. All of above. D. Resistance will decrease.
Ans. D Ans. C
Que. Resistance of material will increase with Que. What will be the resistance of semi-
increase of? conductor at low temperature?
A. Cross-section area of material. A. Resistance will be high.
B. Length of material. B. Resistance will be low.
C. Both Length and Cross-section area of C. No effect on resistance.
material. D. None of above.
D. None of above. Ans. A
Ans. B
Que. What will be the resistance of semi-
Que. What will be the effect on the resistance conductor at high temperature?
of conducting material if the temperature A. Resistance will be high
increases? B. No effect on resistance..
A. No effect on resistance. C. Resistance will be low.
Jo
behave as?
U
decreases? C. Semi-conductor.
H
-T
el
8
eg
ra
m
D. None of above. Que. Temperature co-efficient of resistance α0
Ans. B is given by.
𝑅𝑡 −𝑅0
A. α0= 𝑅𝑜 .𝑡
Que. At high temperature semi-conductor will 𝑅𝑜 −𝑅𝑡
behave as? B. α0= 𝑅𝑡 .𝑡
𝑅1−𝑅2
A. Insulator. C. α0= 𝑅1 𝑡
B. Conductor. 𝑅2
C. Semi-conductor. D. α0= 𝑅𝑜 .𝑡
D. None of above. Ans. A
Ans. B
Que. Which effect of electrical current is
Que. The length of a conductor or a wire is utilised in thermal systems?
doubled and its cross section is also doubled A. Magnetic
then the resistance will. B. chemical
A. Increases four times. C. heating
B. Remains unchange D. all above
C. Decreases four times. Ans. C
D. Change at random.
Ans. B Que. If the efficiency of a machine is to be
high, what should be low?
Que. The variation of resistance with A. input power
temperature is governed by a property called B. losses
A. Resistance access coefficient (RAC). C. KWh consumed
B. Resistance nature coefficient (RNC). D. ratio of output to input
C. Resistance temperature coefficient (RTC). Ans. B
D. None of above.
Ans. C Que. One Nnewton meter is same as
_________
A. one watt
Que. Temperature co-efficient of resistance at B. one Joule
00C is defined as the change in resistance per C. five Joules
ohm original resistance per 0C change in D. one Joule second
temperature. Ans. B
A. True.
B. Fasle. Que. f I, R, t are the current, resistance and
Ans. A time respectively, then according to Joule‟s
Law; heat produced will be proportional
Que. Unit of Temperature co-efficient of to________
Jo
A. /Ώ/0C B. I2Rt2
C. I2R2t
@
B. /0C
SP
C. 0C D. I2R2t2
D. Ώ/0C
P
Ans. A
U
Ans. B
B
TE
A. 100Ω, 10W
-T
el
9
eg
ra
m
B. 10Ω, 50W Ans. C
C. 1MΩ, 0.5W
D. 1KΩ, 1W Que. Two underground cables A and B, each
Ans. B has a conductor resistance of 0.6 Ω and 0.8 Ω
resp. each has insulation resistance of 600 MΩ
Que. When current flows through heater coil, and 400 MΩ resp. if cables are connected in
it glows but supply wiring does not glow parallel, its insulation resistance is ___
because_______ A. 1200 MΩ
A. current through supply line flows at slower B. 2400 Ω
speed C. 1000 MΩ
B. supply wiring is covered with insulation D. 1600 Ω
layer Ans. C
C. resistance of heater coil is more than supply
wires Que. A 100W electric light bulb is connected
D. supply wires are made of superior material to a 250V supply.The current in the circuit is
Ans. C A. 0.3A
B. 0.4A
Que. Which of the following relation is C. 4A
incorrect? D. 0.6A
A. 𝑃 = 𝑉𝐼 Ans. B
B. 𝑃 = 𝐼 2 R
C. P=V2/R Que. A 100W electric light bulb is connected
D. P=V2R to a 250V supply. Its hot resistance is
Ans. D A. 625Ω
B. 526Ω
C. 62.5Ω
UNIT IB D. 625mΩ
Ans. A
Que. The resistance of copper wire 200 m long
is 21 ohms. If its thickness is 0.44 mm, its Que. 60 μs is equivalent to:
specific resistance is around A. 0.06s
A. 2x10-8Ω-m B. 0.00006 s
B. 4x10-8Ω-m C. 1000 minutes
C. 6x10-8Ω-m D. 0.6 s
D. 8x10-8Ω-m Ans. B
Ans. C
Que. The current which flows when 0.1
Que. Two underground cables A and B, each coulomb is transferred in 10 ms is
Jo
A. 1.2 MΩ Ans. B
U
B
B. 0.2 Ω
TE
D. 1.4 M Ω
H
-T
el
10
eg
ra
m
A. 1V Que. How long must a current of 0.1A flow so
B. 100V as to transfer a charge of 30 C?
C. 0.1V A. 5 min
D. 10V B. 5s
Ans. C C. 50min
D. 50s
Que. The power dissipated by a resistor of Ans. A
4Ωwhen a current of 5A passes through it is
A. 6.25W Que. A force of 4N moves an object 200 cm in
B. 20W the direction of the force. Work done is
C. 80W A. 6J
D. 100W B. 8J
Ans. D C. 4J
D. 10J
Que. A 240V, 60W lamp has a working Ans. B
resistance of
A. 1400 ohm Que. 0.32mA=. . . . . . μA
B. 60 ohm A. 0.0032
C. 960 ohm B. 0.032
D. 325 ohm C. 0.00032
Ans. C D. 320
Ans. D
Que. The energy used by a 1.5kW heater in 5
minutes is: Que. If two cables with their insulation
A. 5 J resistances Ri1 and Ri2 are joined in
B. 450 J series,then their equivalent resistance will be
C. 7500 J A. Ri1 + Ri2
D. 450000 J B. Ri1 - Ri2
Ans. D C. Ri1 / Ri2
D. Ri1 Ri2 / Ri1 + Ri2
Que. If a current of 5A flows for 2 minutes, Ans. D
the quantity of charge transferred will
A. 600C Que. If two cables with their insulation
B. 100C resistances Ri1 and Ri2 with conductor
C. 0.6C resistances R1and R2respectively are joined in
D. 60C parallel ,then their equivalent insulation
Ans. A resistance will be
A. Ri1 + Ri2
Jo
B. 30s Ans. A
P
C. 65s
U
A. 4:25
H
-T
el
11
eg
ra
m
B. 25:4 Que. The resistance of copper wire 25 m
C. 2:5 long is found to be 50 Ω. If its diameter is
D. 5:2 1mm, then resistivity of copper is ___
Ans. C A. 1.57µΩ-m
B. 57Ω-m
Que. With three resistances connected in C. 15.7Ω-m
parallel, if each dissipates 20 W, the total D. 157 Ω-m
power supplied by the voltage source equals Ans. A
_______
A. 10W Que. At 300K the temperature coefficient of
B. 20W resistance of a wire is 0.00125 /OC and its
C. 40W resistance is 1 ohm. The resistance of wire will
D. 60W be 2 ohm at
Ans. D A. 1154 K
B. 1100 K
Que. Which of the following lamps will have C. 1400 K
least resistance at room temperature? D. 1127 K
A. 25W, 220V Ans. B
B. 100W, 220V
C. 200W, 220V Que. Two underground cables A and B,
D. 60W, 220V each has a conductor resistance of 0.6 Ω and
Ans. C 0.8 Ω resp. each has insulation resistance of
600 MΩ and 400 MΩ resp. if cables are
connected in series, its insulation resistance is
UNIT IC ___
A. 120 MΩ
Que. If the length of a wire of resistance R B. 240 Ω
is uniformly stretched to n times its original C. 240 MΩ
value, its new resistance is D. 160 Ω
A. nr Ans. C
B. R/n
C. n2R Que. Two underground cables A and B,
D. r/n2 each has a conductor resistance of 0.6 Ω and
Ans. C 0.8 Ω resp. each has insulation resistance of
600 MΩ and 400 MΩ resp. if cables are
Que. length of wire having resistance of 1 ohm connected in parallel, its conductor resistance
is cut into four equal parts and these four parts is ___
are bundled together side-by-side to form a A. 0.3428Ω
Jo
C. 4 ohm Ans. A
P
D. 16 ohm
U
Ans. B
TE
Resistance a- /0C
C
12
eg
ra
m
RTC c-ohm
Conductance d-MΩ Que. An aluminum conductor has resistance
A. 1a,2-b,3-c,4-d of 10Ώ AT 200C and the RTC of 0.0039 per 0C
B. 1-c,2-d,3-a,4-b at 200C. Find the RTC at 00C
C. 1-d,2-c,3-a,4-b A. 0.000124/0C
D. all above B. 0.00423/0C
Ans. C C. 0.00324/0C
Que. If length of cable is doubled, then its D. 0.0000423/0C
insulation resistance will Ans. B
A. reduce by 25%
B. reduce by 50% Que. Find the resistance of filament of 60
C. increase by 50% watt in a 230 V supply lamp at its working
D. reduce by 55% temperature.
Ans. B A. 990 Ώ.
B. 881.667 Ώ.
Que. At 00C a specimen of copper have a C. 981.667 Ώ.
resistance of 4mΏ and its temperature co- D. 1000 Ώ.
efficient of resistance equal to 1/234.5 per 00C Ans. B
Find the value of its temperature co-efficient at
700C
A. 0.003248/0C Que. A single core cable has 1.5cm
B. 0.003428/0C diameter conductor and thickness of insulation
C. 0.003284/0C is 2.2 cm. The resistivity of insulating material
D. 0.003434/0C is 9.2×1012 Ώ-m. Determine the insulation
Ans. C resistance per km length of cable.
A. 2×1012 Ώ.
Que. At 00C a specimen of copper have a B. 2.9×1013 Ώ.
resistance of 4mΏ and its temperature co- C. 2×109 Ώ.
efficient of resistance equal to 1/234.5 per 00C D. 9.2×1012 Ώ.
Find the value of resistance at 700C Ans. C
A. 4.5mΏ.
B. 3.5mΏ. Que. A single core cable has a 5cm diameter
C. 5.19mΏ. conductor and thickness of insulation is 2.2
D. 5.5mΏ. cm. The resistivity of insulating material is
Ans. C 9.2×1012 Ώ-m. Determine the insulation
resistance per km length of cable.
Que. A certain copper winding has a A. 0.55×10-6
resistance of 100Ώ at room temperature. RTC B. 55×10-6
Jo
A. 111 Ώ.
B. 115 Ώ.
P
13
eg
ra
m
winding if α of its material at 250C is Ans. C
0.0039/0C
A. 1000C Que. The time required for 1KW electric
B. 1100C kettle to raise the temperature of 10 liters of
C. 96.790C water through 10°C is__________(Specific
D. 98.790C heat of water is 4200 J/KgK)
Ans. C A. 210 sec
B. 420 sec
Que. A 25W, 220V bulb and a 100W, 220V C. 42 sec
bulb are joined in parallel and connected to D. 840 sec
220V supply. Which bulb will glow more Ans. B
brightly?
A. 25W bulb Que. A 3 Ω resistor having 2 A current will
B. 100W bulb dissipate the power of _________
C. both will glow with same brightness A. 2W
D. neither bulb will glow B. 6W
Ans. B C. 4W
D. 12 W
Que. A 25W, 220V bulb and a 100W, 220V Ans. D
are joined in series and connected to 220V
supply. Which bulb will glow brighter? Que. A nichrome wire used as a heater coil
A. 25W bulb has the resistance of 2Ω per meter. For a
B. 100W bulb heater of 1KW at 200V, the length of wire
C. both will glow with same brightness required will be________
D. neither bulb will glow A. 80m
Ans. A B. 60m
C. 40m
Que. You are given three bulbs of 25W, D. 20m
40W and 60W. Which of them has the lowest Ans. D
resistance?
A. 25W bulb Que. How many KW will be required to light
B. 40W bulb a factory which has 250 lamps each taking
C. 60W bulb 1.3A at 230V?.
D. incomplete information A. 74750W
Ans. C B. 7.47KW
C. 325W
Que. You have the following electric D. 299W
appliances: Ans. A
Jo
iii.1KW, 250V electric bulb A factory is supplied with power at 210V. The
SP
Which of these has the highest resistance? load consists of 250,60W lamp and 4 motor
P
B. kettle by factory.
B
TE
14
eg
ra
m
C. 250A C. 15 min
D. 231.4A D. 20 min
Ans. D Ans. A
Que. A carbon electrode has resistance of Que. A tap supplies water at 220C. A man
0.125 at 200C. What will be resistance of takes 1 lit of water per minute at 370C from
electrode at 850C. RTC of carbon is - 0.005 at geyser. The power rating of geyser is ……
200C. A. 1000 W
A. 0.126Ω B. 500 W
B. 0.121Ω C. 1050 W
C. 0.125Ω D. 1500 W
D. 0.127Ω Ans. C
Ans. B
Que. Amount of energy expended in raising
temperature of 45 liter of water by 750C is
Que. The coil has resistance of 4Ω at ……..
220C.RTC of coil at 220C is 0.0039 /0C. After A. 3.937KWh
operating the coil at 210V for 2days, current B. 4.36 KW
through coil is 42A. The temperature of coil at C. 43.6 KWh
this time is……… D. 436 KW
A. 960C Ans. A
B. 86.10C
C. 500C
D. 600C UNIT ID
Ans. B
power developed
in
4200j/Kg.k,)
B
Ans. D
TE
A. 13.08 min
C
B. 13 hr
H
-T
el
15
eg
ra
m
Que. The power required in lifting a mass of B. 4 kWh
500 kg to a height of 6m in 30 s. C. 2 kWh
A. 198J D. 0.02 kWh
B. 981W Ans. B
C. 198W
D. 981J Que. Amount of heart energy required to
Ans. B raise the temperture of 10kg of water through
100oC is
Que. A portable machine requires a force of (Swof water as 4200J/kgK)
200N to move it. If the machine is moved A. 4.2kJ
through 20m in 25s, power required is B. 4.2MJ
A. 160kW C. 42kJ
B. 1600W D. 420J
C. 16kW Ans. B
D. 160W
Ans. D Que. The power required to drive certain
machine at 350 rpm is 60 KW. The driving
Que. Energy provided by a source e.m.f. of torque produced is ……….
5V supplying a current of 3A for 10 minutes is A. 1600 N-m
A. 9kJ B. 1637 N-m
B. 65J C. 163 N-m
C. 25kJ D. 16370 N-m
D. 90kJ Ans. B
Ans. A
Que. An electric motor when operated for 30
Que. 450 J of energy are converted into heat minute consumes 0.75 KWh. The energy loss
in 1 minute. The power dissipated is during the process is 300 KJ. The efficiency of
A. 7.5kW motor is ……..
B. 7.5W A. 88.08 %
C. 750W B. 88 %
D. 600W C. 88.88%
Ans. B D. 78 %
Ans. C
Que. The power rating of a D.C. electric
motor consuming 36 MJ when connected to a Que. An electric motor when operated for 30
250V supply for 1 hour is minute consumes 0.75 KWh. The energy loss
A. 100W during the process is 300 KJ. The useful work
B. 10W done by motor is ………
Jo
C. 500W A. 2400 KJ
in
D. 10KW B. 240 KJ
@
Ans. D C. 24 J
SP
D. 24000 KJ
P
16
eg
ra
m
Generator delivers 15A to a 100Ω load. The Ans. C
efficiency of process is ……
A. 60% Que. A hydro power station has a reservoir
B. 65% capacity of 5x106 m3 .The effective water head
C. 40% is 100m. The penstock, turbine, generator
D. 55.9% efficiencies are 95%,90%,85%respectively.
Ans. D The total energy generated from power station
is….
Que. A hydro- electric generating plant is A. 35.61x1015 watt-sec
supplied from reservoir of capacity 2 X107 m3 B. 35.61x1010 watt-sec
with water head of 200m. Efficiency of system C. 35.61x109 watt-sec
is 0.72. The amount of useful energy is ……. D. 35.61x1011 watt-sec
A. 8.8 X 109 Wh Ans. D
B. 7.99 X 109 Wh
C. 8.855 X 109 Wh ((Q))2_ An electrically driven pump lifts 80m3
D. 7.85 X 109 Wh of water per min through a height of 12m.IF
Ans. D overall efficiency of motor-pump set is 70%.
The input power to motor is ……
Que. The H.P rating of an engine which drives A. 224.228Kw
a generator supplying a load of 7000 lamp B. 156960W
each taking 0.5A at 250V is ……..(efficiency C. 150000W
of generator is 95%) D. 200Kw
A. 1234.6H.P Ans. A
B. 1172.9H.P
C. 2000H.P Que. A1500V dc motor takes an input of
D. 500H.P 35Kw and drives a load at 1500 rpm. The
Ans. A torque required by the load is 2oo N-m.The
efficiency of motor is
Que. A steam power station has an overall A. 85%
efficiency of 20%.The calorific value of coal B. 89.77%
used is 7166.67 kcal/kg. The amount of coal C. 90%
burnt per KWh of electrical energy is …… D. 70%
A. 2 Kg Ans. B
B. 0.6 kg
C. 6 Kg Que. How many joules of energy will be
D. 1 Kg required to melt 50 kg of tin .The m.p of tin is
Ans. B 2350C and room temperature is 150C. Latent
heat of fusion for tin is 55.902 KJ/Kg and
Jo
is…… C. 5336.1 KJ
P
A. 41.87 Wh D. 6000 KJ
U
B. 4.187W Ans. C
B
TE
C. 4.187 Wh
C
D. 4500 w
H
-T
el
17
eg
ra
m
Que. How much volume of water is used by B. 75%
100MW power station suppling load for 12 C. 60%
hours a day? The effective water head is D. 80%
220m.The overall efficiency of the power Ans. A
station is 86.4%.
A. 2.316x105 m3 Que. A1500V dc motor takes an input of-------
B. 2.316x106 m3 -- and drives a load at 1500 rpm. The torque
C. 2.316x107m3 required by the load is 2oo N-m.The efficiency
D. 2.316x108m3 of motor is 89.77%
Ans. B A. 40KW
B. 35Kw
Que. The power required to drive certain C. 90KW
machine at 350 rpm is------. The driving torque D. 45KW
produced is 1637 N-m …. Ans. B
A. 40KW
B. 50 KW Que. The calorific value of coal used for
C. 60 KW thermal power generation is
D. 60 W 7166.67kcal/kg.The amount of coal burnt per
Ans. C KWh of electrical energy is 0.6 kg. The steam
power station has an overall efficiency of
Que. The total power supplied to an engine A. 25%
which drives generator is-----. If Generator B. 20%.
delivers 15A to a 100Ω load. The efficiency of C. 18%
process is 55.9%. D. 22%
A. 40.25 W Ans. B
B. 4025 KW
C. 402.5KW Que. when an electric motor having efficiency
D. 40.25 KW of 88.88% is operated for 30 minute consumes
Ans. D 0.75 KWh. The energy loss during the process
is -------
Que. The 1234.6 H.P rating engine drives a A. 200KJ
generator supplying a load of 7000 lamp each B. 7500J
taking 0.5A at 250V .efficiency of generator is C. 300 KJ
A. 95% D. 75KW
B. 80% Ans. C
C. 30%
D. 50%
Ans. A UNIT IIA
Jo
in
@
Que. An electrically driven pump lifts 80m3 of Que. The complete path followed by the
SP
B. magnetic circuit
TE
18
eg
ra
m
Ans. B Ans. C
Que. Imaginary lines of force originating from Que. Unit of magnetic field
magnet is called A. wb/m2
A. current B. wb
B. resistance C. AT/wb
C. flux D. none of above
D. magnetic field Ans. D
Ans. C
Que. Unit of reluctance is
Que. Region surrounded by magnet is called A. AT/wb
A. magnetic field strength B. AT
B. magnetic field C. Tesla
C. electric field D. Wb/A
D. resistance Ans. A
Ans. B
Que. Opposition to the magnetic lines of force
Que. lines of force is also called is called
A. flux A. Flux
B. current B. resistance
C. resistance C. susceptance
D. flux density D. reluctance
Jo
Ans. A Ans. D
in
@
Que. Lines of force passing per unit area is Que. Unit of magnetic field strength is
SP
called A. AT/m
P
19
eg
ra
m
Que. The term saturation related to magnetic
Que. The force experienced between two circuit means
current carrying conductors in the same A. magnetic field strength increases with
direction current
A. have force of repulsion between them B. flux density increases with current
B. have force of attraction between them C. flux density remains constant if magnetic
C. remains unaffected field strength is increased
D. none of above D. magnetic field strength remains constant if
Ans. B flux density is increased
Ans. C
Que. Magneto motive force is directly
proportional to Que. The lines of force produced by coil
A. no. of turns of coil completing their path through air, instead of
B. current through the coil intended path is called
C. both a and b A. useful flux
D. none of above B. saturated flux
Ans. C C. air flux
D. leakage flux
Que. The term permeability for a material Ans. D
means
A. the no. of turns on an air core Que. The bulging of lines of force in air gap in
B. the mmf required to produce one unit of a magnetic circuit is called
magnetic flux A. leaking flux
C. the ability of a material to carry electricity B. merging
through it C. fringing
D. the ability of material to carry magnetic D. scattering
lines of force Ans. C
Ans. D
Que. Relative permeability of vacuum is
Que. An air gap is usually inserted in a A. 4π × 10-7 H/m
magnetic circuit B. 1 H/m
A. to prevent saturation C. 1
B. increase flux D. ¼ H/m
C. decrease flux Ans. C
D. increase mmf
Ans. A Que. Permeability of vacuum is
A. 4π × 10-7 H/m
Que. Permeability of a material is the ratio of B. 1 H/m
Jo
strength Ans. A
SP
20
eg
ra
m
D. resistance in electric circuit Que. Leakage factor is defined as the ratio of
Ans. C A. flux in air gap by total flux
B. Total flux by useful flux
Que. Reluctance is analogous to C. air gap flux by useful flux
A. emf in electric circuit D. total flux by flux produced by solenoid
B. resistivity in electric circuit Ans. B
C. conductivity in electric circuit
D. resistance in electric circuit Que. Effect of fringing in magnetic circuit is
Ans. D A. it increases flux density
B. its effective area of air gap decreases
Que. The magnetic reluctance of a material C. it decreases flux density
A. increases with increasing cross sectional D. none of above
area of material Ans. C
B. does not vary with increasing the cross
sectional area Que. The force experienced by unit north pole
C. decreases with increasing cross sectional when placed at point in a magnetic field is
area of material called
D. decreases with increasing the length of A. magnetic field strength at that point
material B. exerted force at that point
Ans. C C. flux
D. magnetic field
Que. The correct relation in the following is Ans. A
𝑁𝑥𝑎
A. ф = 𝑙µ0µ𝑟
𝑙
Que. The mechanical force acting on current
B. 𝑁𝐼 = 𝐵 × 𝜇 carrying on conductor when placed in
0𝜇 𝑟 𝑎
C. 𝑁 = 𝐻𝑥𝑙 magnetic field is given by relation
∅𝑥 𝑙 𝑑∅
D. 𝑁𝐼 = 𝜇 𝜇 𝑎 A. 𝐹 = 𝑁 𝑑𝑡
0 𝑟
Ans. D B. 𝐹 = 𝐵𝑙𝑉𝑠𝑖𝑛𝜃
C. 𝐹 = 𝐵𝐼𝑙𝑠𝑖𝑛𝜃
𝑑𝑖
Que. The permeance in a magnetic circuit D. 𝐹 = 𝐿 𝑑𝑡
corresponds to Ans. C
A. resistance in an electric circuit
B. emf in an electric circuit Que. Which of the following has the highest
C. conductivity in electric circuit magnetic permeability
D. conductance in an electric circuit A. paramagnetic substances
Ans. D B. diamagnetic substances
C. ferromagnetic substances
Jo
B. the number of turns of a coil through which Que. The perfect insulator for magnetic lines
P
C. glass
H
-T
el
21
eg
ra
m
D. none of these A. very high
Ans. D B. in opposite direction
C. low
Que. When current carrying conductor is D. in the same direction
brought into magnetic field, the force that Ans. D
moves the conductor depends upon
A. direction of current Que. Two current carrying conductor lying
B. length of conductor parallel and close to each other are exerting
C. value of current force of repulsion on each other. The currents
D. both b and c are
Ans. D A. very high
B. in opposite direction
Que. The magnitude of force experienced by C. low
current carrying conductor placed in magnetic D. in the same direction
field depends on Ans. B
A. value of flux
B. magnitude of current flowing through Que. Magnetic field strength due to N long
conductor straight conductors carrying current in the
C. direction of current same direction is given by
𝑁𝐼
D. all of above A. 𝐻 = 4𝜋𝑑
Ans. D 𝐼
B. 𝐻 = 2𝜋𝑑
𝑁𝐼
Que. Two current carrying conductor lying C. 𝐻 = 2𝜋𝑑
parallel and close to each other. They are 𝑁𝐼
carrying current in the opposite direction. The D. 𝐻 = 𝑙
force between them is Ans. C
A. repulsive
B. Attractive Que. Fleming‟s left hand rule is used to find
C. Zero A. Magnitude of induced emf in conductor
D. none of these B. Direction of magnetic field in conductor
Ans. A C. Direction of force on current carrying
conductor
Que. Two current carrying conductor lying D. Magnitude of flux density
parallel and close to each other. They are Ans. C
carrying current in the same direction. The
force between them is Que. Which statement is correct related to
A. repulsive magnetic field produced due to current
B. Attractive carrying conductor
Jo
Que. Two current carrying conductors lying direction of current, thumb gives the direction
U
force of attraction on each other. The currents C. if direction of rotation of screw shows
current ,tip gives the direction of magnetic
C
are
H
field
-T
el
22
eg
ra
m
D. all of these B. magnetic flux density in other medium to
Ans. A magnetic field strength
C. magnetic field strength to magnetic flux
Que. Force experienced by current carrying density in vacuum
conductors when placed in magnetic field will D. magnetic field strength in medium to flux
be zero when density in other medium
A. current in the conductor is maximum Ans. A
B. Angle between conductor and field is zero
C. Both a &b Que. Right hand thumb rule is used to find out
D. None of these A. direction of induced emf
Ans. B B. direction of magnetic field due to current
carrying conductor
Que. Relative permeability is defined as the C. magnitude of force experienced
ratio of D. direction of force
A. magnetic field strength in a medium to flux Ans. B
density in the same medium
B. Magnetic flux density in vacuum to Que. In Flemings left hand rule, thumb always
magnetic field strength in vacuum represents
C. Magnetic flux density in other medium to A. current
flux density in vacuum B. voltage
D. Magnetic flux density in vacuum to flux C. magnetic field
density in other medium D. direction of force on conductor
Ans. C Ans. D
Que. The ability with which the magnetic Que. Permeance is to reluctance as
material allows the flux to pass through a conductance is to
given medium is called A. inductance
A. susceptibility B. resistance
B. permeability C. capacitance
C. conductivity D. ampere turns
D. reluctivity Ans. B
Ans. B
Que. 1 Tesla is given as
Que. Unit of permeability is A. 1wb/m2
𝐴 B. 1wb/cm2
A. 𝑚
𝐻 C. 1mwb/cm2
B. D. 1wb/mm2
𝑚
𝑙
C. 𝑚 Ans. A
Jo
𝐻
in
A. coil
P
Ans. C
H
-T
el
23
eg
ra
m
B. silicon steel
Que. Soft steel and iron alloy allows easy flow C. aluminum
of a magnetic flux because D. brass
A. of its high elasticity Ans. B
B. of its high permeability
C. of its high conductivity Que. Flux in the air gap which passes through
D. of its high reluctance the desired path is______
Ans. B A. leakage flux
B. total flux
Que. Magnitude of the magnetic field strength C. useful flux
produced by a coil depends on D. all of above
A. Permeability of the core material Ans. C
B. the no. of turns of coil
C. the magnitude of current flow through the Que. The reluctance of a magnetic circuit
coil varies with
D. all of the above A. length × area
Ans. D B. length / area
C. area/length
Que. The relative permeability of air D. (length)2 + area
is__________ Ans. B
A. 1
B. less than 1 Que. A strength of an electromagnet is
C. greater than 1 determined by
D. 1000 A. reluctance
Ans. A B. permeability of the core
C. mmf
Que. Relative permeability of all non D. all of above
magnetic materials is_____ Ans. D
A. 300
B. 0.7 Que. The strength of the magnetic field
C. 1 around a conductor is directly proportional to
D. 0 A. voltage across the conductor
Ans. C B. current in the conductor
C. type of material of conductor
D. none of above
Que. Which of the following is non magnetic Ans. B
material?
A. iron Que. Reluctance of magnetic material is
Jo
Ans. A
U
24
eg
ra
m
B. weaker is the magnetic flux C. fore fingure
C. no effect on the strength of field D. middle fingure
D. none of above Ans. B
Ans. A
Que. The direction of induced e.m.f. is given
Que. The direction of induced e.m.f. is given by
by A. Flemings right hand rule
A. Flemings right hand rule B. Flemings left hand rule
B. Flemings left hand rule C. faradays law of electromagnetic induction
C. faradays law of electromagnetic induction D. crock screw rule.
D. crock screw rule. Ans. A
Ans. A
Que. Magnitude of induced e.m.f. will be
Que. One weber is dependent on
A. 108 lines of force A. flux density
B. 106 lines of force B. rate of change of current
C. 109 lines of force C. rate of cutting flux
D. none of these D. bothb and c
Ans. A Ans. D
object is
SP
by____ C. a conductor
B
TE
B. thumb Ans. D
H
-T
el
25
eg
ra
m
Ans. B
Que. Electricity can be generated by rotating a
wire loop between the poles of a magnet. In Que. Emf induced in a coil due to current
which of the following positions would induce change in neighboring coil is called_________
the greatest current in the loop? induction.
A. The plane of the loop is parallel to the A. Mutual
magnetic field B. Self
B. The plane of the loop is perpendicular to the C. Dynamic
magnetic field D. Static
C. The plane of the loop makes an angle of 45° Ans. A
with the magnetic field
D. The induced current is the same in all Que. Co-efficient of self induction is also
positions called as__________
Ans. B A. self- induction
B. Inductance
Que. In which of the following situations a C. Self- inductance
voltage is induced in a conductor? D. Induction
A. The conductor moves through the air. Ans. C
B. The conductor is connected to a battery.
C. The conductor is connected to a motor. Que. The property of a coil due to which it
D. The conductor is moved in a magnetic field opposes the change of current flowing through
Ans. D itself is called_____ of the coil.
A. Static inductance
Que. Faraday‟s law of electromagnetic B. Dynamic inductance
induction describes how an electric field can C. Self inductance
be reduced at a point in space by D. Mutual inductance
A. an electric charge Ans. C
B. a constant magnetic field
C. a changing magnetic field Que. ____________is used to sense the flow
D. a steady current. of current in a electric circuit.
Ans. C A. Ammeter
B. Voltmeter
Que. In case of dynamically induced emf, C. Wattmeter
direction of induced emf is given by D. Galvanometer
A. Fleming‟s right hand rule Ans. A
B. Lenz‟s law
C. Faraday‟s first law Que. The phenomenon of the self induction is
D. Faraday‟s second law felt only when the current in the coil is
Jo
Ans. A A. Changing
in
B. Increasing
@
A. Mutual Ans. D
U
B. Self
B
TE
C. Dynamic
C
D. Static
H
-T
el
26
eg
ra
m
Que. The negative sign in the induced emf of C. Number of lines of force
self induction indicates that energy is being D. None of these
absorbed from the electric circuit and stored Ans. B
as _______ energy in the coil.
A. mechanical Que. Leakage factor can be called as
B. Electronic A. Fringing
C. electric B. Coefficient of inductance
D. Magnetic C. Magnetic coefficient
Ans. D D. Hopkinson‟s coefficient
Ans. D
Que. Unit of co-efficient of self induction of
the circuit is______ Que. Movement of electrons are called as
A. Volt A. MMF
B. Ampere B. Current
C. Henry C. Voltage
D. Linkages D. Flux
Ans. C Ans. B
Que. Unit of induced emf is_________ Que. Flux density is equal to ________ of
A. Volt flux and area of cross – section.
B. Ampere A. Sum
C. Henry B. Difference
D. Linkages C. Product
Ans. A D. ratio
Ans. D
Que. The property of one coil due to which it
opposes the change in the other coil is Que. NI expression is called
called…………. between two coils. A. MMF
A. Dynamic inductance B. EMF
B. Static inductance C. Flux linkage
C. Self inductance D. Magnetic intensity
D. Mutual inductance Ans. A
Ans. D
𝑁𝐼
Que. Expression is called
𝑙
Que. The unit of mutual inductance
A. MMF
is_________
B. EMF
A. Volt
C. Flux linkage
B. Ampere/ Volt
D. Magnetic field strength
Jo
C. Henry
Ans. D
in
D. Linkages
@
Ans. C
Que. Expression for mutual inductance is
SP
A. –L dI/dt
P
B. MdI / dt
represents
B
C. N2 Ф2/ I1
TE
A. Mutual induction
D. NФ/I
C
B. Mutual inductance
Ans. C
H
-T
el
27
eg
ra
m
D. Induced emf
Que. As per Faraday‟s law of electromagnetic Ans. A
induction, e=
A. –NdФ/dt 𝑙
Que. In the expression for reluctance𝑆 = 𝜇𝑎
B. MdI / dt
C. N2 Ф2 / I1 of a conduced, letter „a‟ represents_________
D. NФ/I of the core.
Ans. A A. Total area
B. Surface area
Que. The constant K in case of mutual C. Cross- sectional area
induction is equal to D. None of these.
A. Ф1/Ф2 Ans. C
B. Ф2/Ф1
C. Ф1/I1 Que. When a current carrying conductor is
D. Ф2/I1 brought in to magnetic field, the force that
Ans. D moves the conductor depends on
A. direction of current.
Que. Product of the permeability μ0μr is equal B. length of conductor
to C. value of current
A. Magnetic flux D. all of the above
B. Magnetic field Ans. D
C. Magnetic intensity
D. Magnetic flux density / magnetic field Que. When a coil consisting of single turn
strength rotates at uniform speed in magnetic field, the
Ans. D induced emf is____
A. steady
Que. Expression for self induced emf is B. alternating
A. –L dI/dt C. changing
B. MdI1 / dt D. reversing
C. N2 Ф2/ I1 Ans. B
D. NФ/I Que. If l is the length of magnetic path, then
Ans. A magnetizing force is
A. N l
Que. __________is normally termed as flux B. NI x ℓ
linkages. C. ℓ / NI
A. Ф D. NI / ℓ
B. dФ/dt Ans. D
C. NФ
Jo
Ans. C 1
A. 𝐸 = 2 𝐶𝐼 2
@
SP
as______ 1
U
A. Self inductance C. 𝐸 = 2 𝐿𝑉 2
B
1
TE
B. Mutual inductance D. 𝐸 = 2 𝐶𝑉 2
C
C. Flux linkage
Ans. B
H
-T
el
28
eg
ra
m
Ans. A
Que. The unit of energy stored in magnetic
field is____ Que. If two side by side placed coils are
A. Watt cumulatively coupled, then the fluxes in that
B. Joule/sec two coils are always ….
C. Joule A. in Same direction
D. Joule-sec B. in Opposite direction
Ans. C C. in outward direction
D. in inward direction
Que. The amount of energy stored per unit Ans. A
volume in magnetic field is____
1
A. 𝐸 = 2 𝐵𝐿 Que. If two side by side placed coils are
1 differentially coupled, then the fluxes in that
B. 𝐸 = 2 𝐵𝐻 two coils are always ….
1
C. 𝐸 = µ𝐻 A. in same direction
2
1 B. in opposite direction
D. 𝐸 = 2 𝜇𝐵 C. in outward direction
Ans. B D. in inward direction
Ans. B
Que. The relation between self inductances L1
and L2 of two side by side placed coils and the Que. If two coils having self inductances of L1
mutual inductance M between them, with Henry and L2 Henry are cumulatively coupled.
coefficient of coupling as K is …. The mutual inductance between them is M
A. 𝑀 = 𝐾𝑥𝐿1 𝐿2 Henry. Then the effective or equivalent
𝐾
B. 𝑀 = 𝐿 𝐿 inductance is……
1 2
𝑀 A. L1+L2+2M
C. 𝐾 = B. L1+L2-2M
𝐿1 𝐿2
D. 𝐾 = 𝑀𝑥 𝐿1 𝐿2 C. L1+L2+M
D. L1+L2-M
Ans. C
Ans. A
Que. If two side by side placed coils are
Que. If two coils having self inductances of L1
perfectly coupled, then the coefficient of
Henry and L2 Henry are differentially coupled.
coupling is….
The mutual inductance between them is M
A. less than 1
Henry. Then the effective or equivalent
B. More than 1
inductance is……
C. equal to 1
A. L1+L2+2M
D. equal to zero
B. L1+L2-2M
Ans. C
Jo
C. L1+L2+M
in
D. L1+L2-M
Que. If two side by side placed coils are
@
Ans. B
loosely coupled, then the coefficient of
SP
coupling is….
P U
A. less than 1
UNIT IIB
B
B. More than 1
TE
C. equal to 1
C
D. equal to zero
H
-T
el
29
eg
ra
m
Que. A coil is wound uniformly with 300 Que. A coil is wound uniformly with 300 turns
turns over a steel of relative permeability 900. over steel ring of relative permeability 900,
If a current of 5 A is passed through the coil. having mean circumference of 40mm and
The MMF is________ cross sectional area of 50mm2. A current of
A. 4500 AT 25A is passed through coil. Then the mmf of
B. 270000 AT ring is_____
C. 1500 AT A. 5000AT
D. 7500 AT B. 7200AT
Ans. C C. 750AT
D. 7500 AT
Que. If magnetic flux changes from 0.8 Wb to Ans. D
0.3 Wb, then change in flux is______ Wb
A. 1.1 Que. If two coils having self inductances of
B. 0.5 10mH and 20mH are cumulatively coupled.
C. -0.5 The mutual inductance between them is 5mH
D. -1.1 Henry. Then the effective or equivalent
Ans. C inductance is……
A. 40 mH
Que. If Number of turns of coil is 200 and if B. 20 mH
the current is 100 mA, then MMF is ________ C. 35 mH
A. 2000 AT D. 25 mH
B. 200 AT Ans. A
C. 20 AT
D. 0.5 AT Que. If two coils having self inductances of
Ans. C 10mH and 20mH are differentially coupled.
The mutual inductance between them is 5
Que. A straight conductor having an active Henry. Then the effective or equivalent
length of 30cm, is kept in a uniform magnetic inductance is……
field of 0.6 T. Find the emf produced in the A. 40 mH
conductor when it is moved perpendicular to B. 20 mH
the magnetic field at a rate of 7 m/s C. 35 mH
A. 0V D. 25 mH
B. 1.26V Ans. B
C. 0.18V
D. 0.88V Que. What will be the current flowing through
Ans. B the ring shaped air core when number of turns
is 800 and ampere turns are 3200
Que. The coil with self inductance 35mH A. 0.25A
Jo
A. 1.12 J D. 0.4A
SP
B. 0.14 J Ans. C
P
C. 0.56 J
U
current is
H
-T
el
30
eg
ra
m
A. 3.75 A B. 0.7×106 AT/Wb
B. 3. 75 mA C. 6×107 AT/Wb
C. 3. 75 micro Ampere D. 6×105 AT/Wb
D. 37.5 mA Ans. B
Ans. B
Que. A coil is wound uniformly with 300
turns over steel ring of relative permeability
UNIT IIC 900, having mean circumference of 40mm and
cross sectional area of 50mm2. A current of
Que. A straight conductor having an 25A is passed through coil. The value of flux
active length of 30cm, is kept in a uniform is _________
magnetic field of 0.6 T. Find the emf produced A. 10.6Wb
in the conductor when it is moved at 300 to the B. 70mWb
magnetic field at a rate of 7 m/s C. 10.6mWb
A. 0V D. 106mwb
B. 1.26V Ans. C
C. 0.63V
D. 0.88V Que. A magnetic circuit has a mmf of
Ans. C 400AT and a reluctance of 2 × 105 AT/wb.
The magnetic flux in the magnetic circuit is
Que. A conductor of 10cm length carrying A. 3 × 10-5Wb
a current of 5A placed in uniform magnetic B. 2 × 10-3Wb
field of flux density 1.25T at 300 to the lines of C. 1.5 × 10-2Wb
flux. Force acting on conductor will be D. 2.5 × 10-4Wb
A. 0.3125N Ans. B
B. 3.125N
C. 1.325N Que. A 2cm long coil has 10 turns and
D. 5.321N carries a current of 750mA. The magnetizing
Ans. A force of the coil is
A. 225 AT/m
Que. A solenoid has a flux of 12mwb and a B. 675 AT/m
flux density of 0.9T.The diameter of solenoid C. 450 AT/m
must be D. 375 AT/m
A. 130.3mm Ans. D
B. 13.33cm
C. 10cm Que. A magnetic core having mean length
D. 4.12cm of 20cm, C/S area of 1 cm2, µr of 2400 . The
Ans. A reluctance of the magnetic core is
Jo
A. 7×107 AT/Wb
H
-T
el
31
eg
ra
m
required to produce a flux of 20 A. 0.04 N
mwb__________ B. 4 N
A. 13x103 AT C. 0.4 N
B. 13x104AT D. none of these
C. 13x102AT Ans. A
D. none of these
Ans. B Que. A straight wire 0.5 m long carries a
current of 100A & lies at right angle to a
Que. An iron ring of 100 cm mean diameter uniform field of 1.5T. Find the mechanical
and 10 cm2 cross section has 1000 turns of force on the conductor.
copper wire on it. The permeability of the A. 37.5 N
material is 1500. The reluctance of the ring B. 0
is___________ C. 53N
D. 75N
A. 1.67 x 106 AT/Wb Ans. D
B. 16.7 x 106 AT/Wb
C. 1.67 x 105 AT/Wb Que. A straight wire 0.5 m long carries a
current of 100A & lies at parallel to the
D. 1.67 x 104 AT/Wb
uniform field of 1.5T. Find the mechanical
Ans. A
force on the conductor.
A. 373N
Que. A coil is wound uniformly over a steel
B. 0
of relative permeability 900, having a mean
C. 53N
circumference of 40 mm and cross-sectional
D. 75N
area of 50 mm2. The reluctance of the steel is
Ans. b
___
A. 707.714 x 103 AT/Wb
Que. A coil is wound uniformly with 300
B. 70.77 x 103 AT/Wb
turns over a steel ring of relative permeability
C. 707.714 x 104 AT/Wb
900 having mean circumference of 40cm &
D. 7.07 x 104 AT/Wb
cross sectional area of 5 cm2. If coil has
Ans. A
resistance of 100 Ω, & is connected to 250V
DC supply, calculate coil current.
Que. A straight conductor having an
A. 2.5A
active length of 30cm, is kept in a uniform
B. 3.53 mA
magnetic field of 0.6 T. Find the emf produced
C. 2.8A
in the conductor when it is moved parallel to
D. none of these
the magnetic field at a rate of 7 m/s
Ans. D
A. 0V
B. 1.26V
Jo
A. 3 x 10-5wb
P
B. 2 x 10-3wb
U
D. 2.5 x 10-4wb
magnetic field of 0.8 T. What is the force on
C
Ans. B
each cm of these wires
H
-T
el
32
eg
ra
m
Que. The self inductances of two side by
Que. In a magnetic circuit the value of B side placed coils are 18 mH and 12 mH
and H are 1.5Tesla and 20 AT/m respectively. respectively. If the coefficient of coupling is
The amount of energy stored per unit volume 0.78, then the mutual inductance between them
in it is ____ is ….
A. 60 J A. 0.53H
B. 30 J B. 0.169H
C. 15 J C. 0.011H
D. 13.33 J D. 0.0188H
Ans. C Ans. C
Que. The magnetic circuit with mean length Que. A magnetic circuit requires 800
of 100 cm and 20cm2 cross sectional area ampere turns to produce a certain amount of
gives magnetic field strength of 150 A/m flux. If exciting coil of 100 turns has 5 ohms
along its length, The flux of 6 mWb is resistance, then the voltage to be applied to the
developed in it. Then the amount of energy exciting coil must be
stored in it is ____ A. 40V
A. 0.9 J B. 20 V
B. 0.45 J C. 10V
C. 450J D. 5V
D. 18 J Ans. A
Ans. B
is…. Ans. B
@
A. 0.245
SP
D. 0.4
B
Ans. D called____________
C
A. Motor
H
-T
el
33
eg
ra
m
B. Generator D. Self induction
C. Transformer Ans. B
D. Transistor
Ans. C Que. Transformer is used to change values
of__________
Que. The transformer winding across which A. Frequency
the supply voltage applied is called the _____ B. Voltage
winding. C. Power
A. Primary D. Power factor
B. Secondary Ans. B
C. Tertiary
D. Tapped Que. The path of the magnetic flux in
Ans. A transformer should have __________
A. Low resistance
Que. The transformer winding which is B. Low reluctance
connected to the load is called the_______ C. High reluctance
winding. D. High conductivity
A. Primary Ans. B
B. Secondary
C. Tertiary
D. Tapped Que. Electrical power is transformed from one
Ans. B coil to other coil in transformer_________
A. Physically
Que. If supply frequency of a transformer B. Electrically
increases, the secondary output voltage of the C. Magnetically
transformer____. D. Electromagnetically
A. Decreases Ans. D
B. increases
C. remains same Que. A transformer operates___________
D. decreases slightly A. Always at unity power factor
Ans. B B. At power factor depending on load
C. Has its own power factor
Que. The horizontal and vertical portions of D. At power factor below particular value
transformer magnetic core are called Ans. B
as_________
A. Limb, yoke Que. The laminations of transformer core are
B. Yoke, limb made up from__________
C. Yoke A. Low carbon steel
Jo
is based on ________
U
34
eg
ra
m
B. Low permeability & low hysteresis loss
C. High permeability & high hysteresis loss Que. The main function of transformer iron
D. high permeability & low hysteresis loss core is to__________
Ans. D A. Provide strength to the winding
B. To decrease hysteresis loss
Que. Most transformer cores are not made C. Decrease the reluctance of magnetic path
from a solid piece of metal. Instead, they are D. Reduce eddy current loss
assembled from many thin sheets of metal. Ans. C
This type of construction is called__________
A. Laminated Que. The transformer turns ratio
B. Toroid determines_____________
C. H core A. the ratio of primary and secondary voltages
D. tape wound B. the ratio of primary and secondary currents
Ans. A C. The resistance on other side
D. all of the above
Que. The concentric cylindrical winding is Ans. A
used for__________
A. Core type transformer Que. Turns ratio of single phase transformer is
B. Shell type transformer given as__________
C. Berry type transformer A. N2/N1
D. None of these B. N1/N2
Ans. A C. (N1xN2)/N1
D. (N1xN2)/N2
Que. The sandwich type winding is used Ans. B
for___________
A. Core type transformer Que. A transformer in which the secondary
B. Berry type transformer voltage is more than the primary voltage is
C. Shell type transformer called a _____ transformer
D. None of these A. step-down
Ans. C B. step-up
C. Isolation
Que. Silicon steel is used for transformer D. Auto
core__________ Ans. B
A. To reduce hysteresis loss
B. To reduce eddy current loss Que. A transformer in which the primary
C. To reduce both losses voltage is more than the secondary voltage is
D. None of these called a _____ transformer
Ans. A A. step-down
Jo
B. step-up
in
transformer_________ D. Auto
SP
B. Magnetic circuit
U
C. Winding wire guage Que. Any transformer flux that does not follow
B
TE
D. None of these the core and escapes into the surrounding air is
C
Ans. B called____
H
-T
el
35
eg
ra
m
A. magnetizing flux B. Decreasing the thickness of laminations
B. coupling flux C. Decreasing the air gap in magnetic circuit
C. leakage flux D. Using wire of higher guage for winding
D. reactance flux Ans. B
Ans. C
Que. A good transformer oil should be
Que. A transformer that does not isolate the absolutely free from__________
output from the input is called _____ A. Sulpher
transformer B. Alkalies
A. Distribution C. Moisture
B. step-up D. All of the above
C. Auto Ans. C
D. Control
Ans. C Que. Single phase core type transformer
has__________
Que. Ideal transformer assumptions do not A. One magnetic circuit
include____________ B. Two magnetic circuits
A. Zero reactance of the winding C. No magnetic circuit
B. Zero resistance of the winding D. None of these
C. No leakage flux Ans. A
D. No saturation of the core
Ans. A Que. Single phase shell type transformer
has__________
Que. The efficiency of the transformer is A. One magnetic circuit
normally is normally in the range B. Two magnetic circuits
of____________ C. No magnetic circuit
A. 50 to 70% D. None of these
B. 60 to 75 % Ans. B
C. 80 to 90 %
D. 90 to 98% Que. Natural cooling is better in_________
Ans. D A. Core type transformer
B. Shell Type transformer
Que. The resistance of low voltage side of C. Both A & B
transformer________ D. Berry type transformer
A. Is equal to resistance of its high voltage Ans. A
side
B. Is more than its resistance on high voltage Que. EMF equation for single phase
side transformer is________
Jo
side B. E= 4.44 Bm A N
@
D. 0 C. E= 4.44 Bm f N
SP
Ans. C D. E= 4.44 Φm f N
P
Ans. D
U
36
eg
ra
m
A. N2/N1 Que. Transformer power rating is usually
B. E1/E2 expressed in____________
C. I2/I1 A. kW
D. V1/V2 B. kVA
Ans. A C. kV
D. kWh
Que. For Isolation transformer the Ans. B
transformation ratio(K) is_________
A. 0 Que. In a transformer if secondary turns are
B. Greater than 1 doubled, at the same time primary voltage is
C. Less than 1 reduced by half, the secondary voltage
D. 1 will_________
Ans. D A. Be halved
B. Not change
Que. In step up transformer the transformation C. Be four times
ratio (K) is_____________ D. Be reduced to quarter
A. Greater than 1 Ans. C
B. 1
C. Less than 1 Que. The no load current in terms of full load
D. 0 current in a transformer is usually________
Ans. A A. 1 to 3%
B. 3 to 9 %
Que. In step down transformer the C. 9 to 12%
transformation ratio (K) is__________ D. 12 to 20%
A. Greater than 1 Ans. A
B. 1
C. Less than 1 Que. Transformer oil is used in transformer to
D. 0 provide_______
Ans. C A. Cooling and insulation
B. Cooling and lubrication
Que. The primary and secondary voltages in C. Insulation and lubrication
transformer are___________ D. Insulation, cooling and lubrication
A. Always in Phase Ans. A
B. 1800 out of phase
C. 900 out of phase Que. What is the typical use of
D. 300 or 600 out of phase autotransformer____________
Ans. B A. Toy transformer
B. Control transformer
Jo
B. Frequency
P
37
eg
ra
m
C. Always in ratio of K
D. Sometimes same Que. The disadvantage of auto transformer
Ans. B is______________
A. No separation between primary &
Que. If we increase the flux density in case of secondary
transformer_______________ B. Size is more than normal transformer for
A. The size of transformer will reduce same rating
B. The distortion in transformer will reduce C. More costlier than normal transformer
C. Hysteresis and eddy current losses will D. All
reduce Ans. D
D. None of these will be true
Ans. A Que. In a transformer the voltage regulation
will be near to zero when it operates
Que. The direct loading test is performed on at____________
transformer to find its____________ A. unity p.f.
A. Regulation B. leading p.f.
B. Efficiency C. lagging p.f.
C. Both D. full loaD.
D. None of these Ans. B
Ans. C
Que. A transformer steps up voltage by a
Que. The regulation of transformer is factor of 100. The ratio of current in the
calculated as_________ primary to that in secondary_______________
A. 1
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 −𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 B. 100
A. 𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
C. 0.01
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 −𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
D. 0.1
B. Ans. B
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 −𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 Que. An ideal transformer does not
C. 𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 change______________
A. Voltage
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 −𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
D. B. Power
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
C. current
Ans. A
D. None of these
Ans. B
Que. The efficiency of single phase
transformer is calculated as_____________
𝑉2 𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅ Que. The flux in transformer
Jo
A. 𝑉 𝐼 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 core____________
2 2 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠 +𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠 𝑠
in
D. none of these
U
Ans. C
B
𝑉2 𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
D. 𝑉 𝐼
TE
Ans. A
H
-T
el
38
eg
ra
m
Que. Efficiency of transformer is maximum D. primary may burn out
when___________ Ans. D
A. transformer is unloaded
B. copper losses is equal to iron losses Que. For an ideal transformer the windings
C. eddy current losses are equal to hysteresis should have____________
losses A. maximum resistance on primary side and
D. it is maximally loaded least resistance on secondary side
Ans. B B. least resistance on primary side and
maximum resistance on secondary side
Que. If the supply frequency in transformer is C. equal resistance on primary and secondary
doubled, then_________ side
A. hysteresis loss also doubles D. no ohmic resistance on either side
B. eddy current loss also doubles Ans. D
C. iron losses doubles
D. copper losses doubles Que. A transformer does not raise or lower the
Ans. A voltage of DC supply because________
A. there is no need to change the DC voltage
Que. Hysteresis loss in transformer depends B. DC circuit has more losses
on__________ C. Faradays laws of electromagnetic induction
A. both voltage and frequency become invalid since the rate of change of flux
B. voltage alone is zero
C. frequency alone D. none of these
D. none of these Ans. C
Ans. A
Que. Primary winding of a transformer
Que. Eddy current loss depends _____________
on_____________ A. is always low voltage winding
A. both current and frequency B. is always high voltage winding
B. current alone C. could either be a low or high voltage
C. frequency alone winding
D. none of these D. none of these
Ans. A Ans. C
Que. The flux involved in EMF equation of a Que. Which winding of a transformer has
transformer has______________ more number of turns_______________
A. RMS Value A. Low voltage winding
B. Average Value B. High voltage winding
C. Total Value C. Primary winding
Jo
Ans. D Ans. B
@
SP
Que. If primary of the transformer is Que. In a given transformer for a given applied
P
39
eg
ra
m
C. hysteresis and eddy current loss B. 10 ohm
D. none of these C. 1000 ohm
Ans. C D. infinity
Ans. D
Que. Main advantage to use autotransformer
over two winding transformer____________ Que. A good voltage regulation of transformer
A. Hysteresis losses are reduced means___________
B. savings in winding material A. output voltage fluctuations from no load to
C. copper losses are negligible full load is least
D. Eddy current losses are totally eliminated B. output voltage fluctuations with power
Ans. B factor is least
C. difference between primary and secondary
Que. An ideal transformer is one which has voltage is least
_____________ D. difference between primary and secondary
A. no losses and magnetic leakage voltage is maximum
B. interleaved primary and secondary winding Ans. A
C. a common core for its primary and
secondary Que. Negative voltage regulation is indicative
D. core of stainless steel and winding of pure that the load is_____________
copper material A. Capacitive only
Ans. A B. inductive only
C. inductive or resistive
Que. In a practical transformer core losses D. none of these
remains constant from no load to full load Ans. A
because__________
A. value of transformation ratio remains Que. The size of the transformer core depend
constant on___________
B. permeability of transformer core remains A. frequency
constant B. area of the core
C. core flux remains practically constant C. flux density of the core material
D. primary and secondary voltage remains D. (a) and (b) both
constant Ans. D
Ans. C
Que. A shell type transformer has
Que. The transformer laminations are insulated _______________
from each other by_____________ A. high eddy current losses
A. mica strip B. reduced magnetic leakage
B. thin coat of varnish C. negligible hysteresis loss
Jo
Ans. B
SP
40
eg
ra
m
B. core built up of laminations of hot rolled A. 220V is no load voltage
steel B. The no load voltage is more than 220V
C. either a or b C. The secondary voltage increases with
D. none of these increase in load
Ans. C D. At a load which draws the rated current &
the voltage becomes less than 220V.
Ans. A
Que. Losses which occur in rotating electric
machine and do not occur in transformers Que. In which of the following transformer,
are____________ part of the primary winding serves as the
A. friction and windage losses secondary winding__
B. magnetic losses A. Potential transformer
C. hysteresis and eddy current losses B. Auto transformer
D. copper losses C. Step up transformer
Ans. A D. None of these
Ans. B
Que. Which of the following loss in a
transformer is zero even at full Que. The rating of the transformer is given in
load__________ kVA instead of kW because__________
A. core loss A. kVA is fixed whereas kW depends on load
B. friction loss pf
C. eddy current loss B. load power factor is often not known
D. Hysteresis loss C. it has become customary
Ans. B D. total transformer loss depends on VA
Ans. B
Que. The noise produced by transformer is
termed as _______________ Que. Increase in secondary current of
A. zoom transformer brings about increase in primary
B. hum current . This is possible because___________
C. ringing A. primary and secondary windings are
D. buzz capacitively coupleD.
Ans. B B. primary and secondary windings are
inductively coupled
Que. Part of the transformer which is most C. primary and secondary windings are
subject to damage from overheating conductively coupled
is______________ D. none of these
A. iron core Ans. B
B. copper winding
Jo
A. low
P
correct?_______ Ans. C
H
-T
el
41
eg
ra
m
B. unity
Que. Transformer action needs that the C. 0.8 lag
magnetic flux linking with the winding must D. 0.5 lag or lead
be_____________ Ans. B
A. constant
B. pulsating Que. The regulations of two transformers are
C. alternating (i) 3% and (ii) 97%. The one with better
D. none of these regulation is______
Ans. C A. second
B. first
Que. Low voltage windings are placed next to C. both are same
the core to reduce_____________ D. depends on loading
A. Hysteresis loss Ans. B
B. eddy current loss
C. insulation requirement Que. At relatively light loads, the transformer
D. copper loss efficiency is low because__________
Ans. C A. secondary output is low
B. transformer losses are high
Que. The relation between the primary and C. fixed loss is high in proportion to the output
secondary ampere turns of a D. copper loss is small.
transformer___________ Ans. C
A. exactly equal
B. approximately equal Que. A dielectric material must be________
C. primary mmf larger than secondary mmf A. resistor
D. primary mmf smaller than secondary mmf B. Insulator
Ans. A C. Conductor
D. Semiconductor
Que. Positive voltage regulation occurs in case Ans. B
of transformer for______________
A. capacitive load Que. The energy stored in a capacitor is given
B. resistive load only by__________________________
C. inductive load only A. C2V
D. either inductive or resistive load B. CV2/2
Ans. D C. C2V/2
D. CV
Que. Cooling of transformer is required so as Ans. B
to_____________
A. increase efficiency Que. Electrolytic capacitors can be used
Jo
D. 50 Hz ac
U
A. 0.8 pf lead
H
-T
el
42
eg
ra
m
Que. If a number of capacitors are connected B. Coulomb/Volt
in series then the total capacitance of C. Ohms
combination is_____ D. Henry/Wb
A. greater than the capacitance of largest Ans. B
capacitor
B. greater than the capacitance of any Que. There is repulsive force between two
capacitor charged objects when
C. smaller than the capacitance of smallest A. Charges of unlike sign
capacitor B. they have the same number of protons
D. average of capacitances of all capacitors C. charges are of same sign
Ans. C D. they have the same number of protons
Ans. C
Que. As per Coulomb‟s
law___________________ Que. The capacitance of a capacitor is not
A. F= Q1Q2 / εoεrd2 affected by
B. F= Q1Q2 / 4𝜋d2 A. distance between plates
C. F= Q1Q2 / 4𝜋 εoεrd2 B. area of plates
D. F= Q1Q2 /4𝜋 εoεrd C. thickness of plates
Ans. C D. all of the above
Ans. C
Que. Electric field intensity at any point in an
electric field is equal to_______ Que. When there is an equal amount of
A. potential gradient positive and negative charges on an object the
B. (potential gradient)2 object is
C. (potential gradient)1/2 A. Positively charged
D. (potential gradient)1/3 B. negatively charged
Ans. A C. neutral
D. supercharged
Que. The lines of forces due to isolated Ans. C
charged particles are___________
A. always straight Que. Which of the following statements is
B. always curved correct?
C. sometimes curved A. Air capacitors have a black band to indicate
D. none of the above the outside foil
Ans. A B. Electrolytic capacitor must be connected in
the correct polarity
Que. The direction of electric field due to C. Ceramic capacitors must be connected in
positive charge is___ the correct polarity
Jo
43
eg
ra
m
B. Area of the plates B. increase in plate area and distance between
C. Nature of dielectric the plates
D. Thickness of the plates C. decrease in plate area and value of applied
Ans. D voltage
D. reduction in plate area and distance
Que. Which of the following expressions is between the plates
correct for electric field strength? Ans. A
A. E = D/𝝐
B. E = D2/𝝐 Que. A capacitor consists of
C. E = 𝝅D A. two insulators separated by a conductor
D. E = 𝝅D2 B. two conductors separated by a dielectric
Ans. A C. two insulators only
D. two conductors only
Que. Which of the following statements is Ans. B
true?
A. The current in the discharging capacitor Que. A paper capacitor is usually available in
grows linearly the form of
B. The current in the discharging capacitor A. tubes
grows exponentially B. rolled foil
C. The current in the discharging capacitor C. disc
decays exponentially D. meshed plates
D. The current in the discharging capacitor Ans. B
decreases constantly
Ans. C Que. Air capacitors are generally available in
the range
Que. In a capacitor the electric charge is A. 10 to 400 pF
deposited on B. 1 to 20 pF
A. metal plates C. 100 to 900 pF
B. dielectric D. 20 to 100 pF
C. both (a) and (b) Ans. A
D. none of the above
Ans. A Que. The unit of capacitance is
A. Henry
B. Ohm
Que. Which of the following materials has the C. Farad
highest value of dielectric constant D. Farad/m
A. Glass Ans. C
B. Vaccum
Jo
Ans. C is given by
SP
A. ν = Ve-t/λ
B. ν = V(1-e-t/λ)
P
with C. ν = V2e-t/λ
B
TE
44
eg
ra
m
B. paper
Que. The ratio of electric flux density to C. mica
electric field intensity is called ………. of the D. electrolytic
medium Ans. D
A. permeability
B. permittivity Que. Which of the following capacitors are
C. reluctance usually used for radio frequency tuining?
D. capacitance A. air
Ans. B B. paper
C. mica
Que. Energy stored in the electric field of a D. electrolyte
capacitor C when charged from a dc source of Ans. B
voltage V is equal to …….. Joule
A. ½ CV2 Que. The time constant of an R-C circuit is
B. ½ C2V defined as the time during which capacitor
C. CV2 charging voltage actually rises to ----------------
D. C2V percent of its ---------- value
Ans. A A. 37, initial
B. 63.2, initial
Que. The absolute permittivity of free space is C. 63.2, final
given by D. 37, final
A. 8.854 x 10-9 F/m Ans. C
B. 8.854 x 10-10 F/m
C. 8.854 x 10-11 F/m Que. The time constant of an R-C circuit is
D. 8.854 x 10-12 F/m defined as the time during which capacitor
Ans. D charging current actually falls to ----------------
percent of its initial maximum value
Que. The relative permittivity of free space is A. 37
given by „ B. 63
A. 1 C. 42
B. 10 D. 73
C. 100 Ans. A
D. 1000
Ans. A Que. Permitivity is expressed in_______
A. Farad/sq-m
Que. The capacitor preferred for high B. weber/metre
frequency circuits is C. Farad/meter
A. air capacitor D. Weber/ sq- m
Jo
C. electrolytic capacitor
@
Ans. B on_________________
P
A. moisture content
U
45
eg
ra
m
Ans. D D. none of the above.
Ans. B
Que. 1 Volt /metre is same as
A. 1 metre/coulomb Que. What is the unit of charge?
B. 1 Newton metre A. Volt-Amp
C. 1 Newton /Coulomb B. Henery
D. 1 Joule /Coulomb C. Farad
Ans. C D. Coulomb
Ans. D
Que. The relative permittivity of air
is__________ Que. What will be the capacitance of four
A. 0 capacitors of equal capacitance „C‟ when
B. 1.0006 connected in parallel?
C. 8.854 × 10−12 A. 4C
D. none of the above B. C/4
Ans. B C. 3C/4
D. C
Que. The capacitance of a capacitor is ……… Ans. A
relative permittivity.
A. directly proportional to Que. A region around a stationary electric
B. inversely proportional to charge has______
C. independent of A. magnetic field
D. directly proportional to square of B. electric field
Ans. A C. magnetic field and electric field
D. neither magnetic field nor electric field
Que. The most convenient way of achieving Ans. B
large capacitance is by using
A. multiplate construction
B. decreased distance between plates
C. air as dielectric Que. One Farad is the same as
D. dielectric of low permittivity A. One Coulomb/Volt
Ans. A B. One Joule/ Coulomb
C. One Joule/ Volt
Que. If the dielectric of a capacitor is replaced D. One Coulomb / Joule
by a conducting material the Ans. A
A. capacitor will get heated up owing to eddy
currents Que. If Q be the charge and C be the
B. plates will get short-circuited capacitance then the energy stored in the
Jo
Ans. B B. 1/QC
SP
C. Q2/2C
P
B. potential
C
C. charge
H
-T
el
46
eg
ra
m
Que. One Coulomb charge equals the charge
on Que. For 100 kVA, 11000V/110V single
A. 6.42 x 10 18 electrons phase transformer, the secondary full load
B. 6.24 x 10 18 atoms current is________
C. 6.24 x 10 12 electrons A. 90.90 Amp
D. none of these B. 9090.9 Amp
Ans. A C. 909.0 Amp
D. 9.09 Amp
Que. The capacitance of parallel plate Ans. C
capacitor is given as
A. C = Є0 A / d Que. A transformer has maximum efficiency
B. C = Є0 d / A at ¾ of full load. The ratio of its iron loss and
C. C = Є0 Єr A / d full load copper loss is_________
D. C= Єr A / d A. 16/9
Ans. C B. 4/3
C. 3/4
D. 9/16
Ans. D
UNIT IIIB
Que. The full load copper and iron loss of a
Que. Full load copper loss in a transformer is transformer are 6400 W and 5000 W
400 Watt. At half load, copper losses will respectively. The copper loss and iron loss at
be___________ half load will be respectively______
A. 400 Watt A. 3200 W and 2500 W
B. 100 Watt B. 3200 W and 5200 W
C. 200 Watt C. 1600 W and 1250 W
D. 50 Watt D. 1600 W and 5000 W
Ans. B Ans. D
Que. A transformer is working with its Que. In a step down transformer, there is a
maximum efficiency. If the iron losses are 500 change of 15A in the load current. This results
W, the copper loss will__________ in change of supply current of_____________
A. 300 W A. less than 15 A
B. 350 W B. more than 15 A
C. 250 W C. 15A
D. 500 W D. none of these
Ans. D Ans. A
Jo
A. 10
A. 909.09 Amp
P
B. 5
U
C. 9.09 Amp
TE
D. 9
D. 9090.9 Amp
C
Ans. C
Ans. C
H
-T
el
47
eg
ra
m
A. 2.6%
B. 2.67%
Que. If the copper loss of a transformer at 70% C. 0%
of full load is 200 W. The full load copper loss D. none of these
is ________ Ans. A
A. 200 W
B. 285.71 W Que. If two 10 µF capacitors are connected in
C. 408.16W parallel, then the effective capacitance will
D. none of these be_________
Ans. C A. 2.5 µF
B. 40 µF
Que. A transformer having 1000 primary turns C. 0.4 µF
is connected 250 V ac supply. For a secondary D. 20 µF
voltage of 400 volt, the no of secondary turns Ans. D
should be________
A. 1600 Que. The total capacitance of five capacitor
B. 250 each of 10 µF in series is________________
C. 400 A. 10 µF
D. 1250 B. 2 µF
Ans. A C. 25 µF
D. none of these
Que. If Copper loss of a transformer at 7/8th of Ans. B
the full load is 4900W. Then its full load
copper loss is____ Que. Two capacitors of capacitances C1=0.1
A. 5600 µF and C2=0.2 µF are connected in series
B. 6400 across 300V source. The voltage across C1
C. 375 will be________________
D. 429 A. 100 V
Ans. B B. 200 V
C. 150 V
Que. A 10 kVA, 3300/240 V, single phase, 50 D. 300 V
Hz transformer has a core area of 300 sq. cm. Ans. B
The flux density is 1.3 T. The primary full
load current is ___________ Que. A capacitor stores 0.4C charge at 2 V. Its
A. 3.03 amp capacitance
B. 33.03 amp is___________________________
C. 30.3 amp A. 0.4 F
D. 0.303 amp B. 0.2 F
Jo
Ans. A C. 3.2 F
in
D. 0.8 F
@
observed as 230 volt. When the transformer is Que. A 20 mF capacitor is in series with a 150
U
loaded, the voltage on secondary side has Ohm resistor. The combination is placed
B
TE
reduced to 224 volt. Then the % regulation of across a 40 V dc source. Time constant of the
C
48
eg
ra
m
A. 8 S B. 900 µC
B. 3 S C. 1200 µC
C. 6 S D. 1600 µC
D. 2.4 S Ans. C
Ans. B
Que. The relative permittivity of a material is
Que. Three capacitors of values 3 µF, 6 µF and 10. Its absolute permittivity will be
12 µF are connected in parallel across an ac A. 8.854 × 10−11 𝐹/𝑀
source. The maximum current pass through B. 9 × 108 𝐹/𝑀
________________ C. 5 × 10−5 𝐹/𝑀
A. 3 µF D. 9 × 105 𝐹/𝑀
B. 6 µF Ans. A
C. 12 µF
D. all the capacitors Que. An air capacitor has the same dimensions
Ans. C that of a mica capacitor. If the capacitance of
mica capacitor is 6 times that of air capacitor,
Que. Three capacitors each of the capacity C then relative permittivity of mica is
are given. The resultant capacity 2/3 C can be A. 36
obtained by using them B. 12
A. all in series C. 3
B. all in parallel D. 6
C. two in parallel and third in series with this Ans. D
combination
D. two in series and third in parallel across this Que. Two capacitors of capacitance C1 and C2
combination. are connected in parallel. A charge Q given to
Ans. C them is shared. The ratio of charges Q1/Q2
is________.
Que. A capacitor charged to 200V has 2000 A. C2/ C1
µC of charge. The value of capacitance will be B. C1/ C2
A. 10 F C. C1 C2
B. 10 µF D. 1/ C1 C2
C. 100 µF Ans. B
D. 1000 µF
Ans. B Que. Two capacitors have capacitances 25 µF
when in parallel and 6 µF when in series.
Que. When 4 Volt e.m.f. is applied across a 1 Their individual capacitances are
Farad capacitor, it will store energy of A. 12 µF and 13 µF
A. 2 Joule B. 15 µF and 10 µF
Jo
B. 4 Joule C. 14 µF and 11 µF
in
D. 8 Joule Ans. B
SP
Ans. D
P
49
eg
ra
m
A. 5.33 Que. A fully charged capacitor of 10 µF has a
B. 2 potential difference of 100V across its
C. 3 terminals. It is discharged through 1 KΩ
D. 0.48 resistor. The time constant of the circuit
Ans. D is______.
A. 0.1sec
Que. A 10 µF capacitor in series with an 1 MΩ B. 1sec
resistor is connected across a100 V dc supply. C. 0.01sec
The time constant of the circuit is__________. D. 0.001sec
A. 10 sec Ans. C
B. 0.1 sec
C. 10mSec Que. A capacitor consists of two similar plates
D. 100 Sec each 10cm x 10cm mounted parallel and
Ans. A opposite to each other. The value of
capacitance when distance between them is
Que. A 10 µF capacitor in series with an 1 MΩ 1cm and dielectric used is air is______.
resistor is connected across a100 V dc supply. A. 8.854 pF
The initial value of charging current B. 8.854 µF
is____________. C. 8.854 mF
A. 1mA D. 8.854 F
B. 0.1 mA Ans. A
C. 0.01mA
D. 1.00A
Ans. B Que. The capacitance of capacitor formed by
two parallel plates each 200 cm2 in area
Que. A 10 µF capacitor in series with an 1 MΩ separated by dielectric of 4mm thick is 0.0004
resistor is connected across a100 V dc supply. µF. If voltage of 20000 V is applied then the
The capacitor voltage after a time equal to the total charge on the plate is________
time constant is________ A. 8 µC
A. 36V B. 8 mC
B. 36.6V C. 8 nC
C. 63.2V D. 8 pC
D. 63 V Ans. A
Ans. C
Que. A parallel plate capacitor has plate area
Que. A fully charged capacitor of 10 µF has a of 2m2 spaced by three slabs of dielectric
potential difference of 100V across its materials. The relative permitivities are 2, 3
terminals. It is discharged through 1 KΩ and 6 respectively and thicknesses are 0.4mm,
Jo
resistor. The initial discharging current 0.6mm and 0.12 mm respectively. The
in
A. 1A A. 0.000295 x 10-6 F
SP
Ans. D Ans. B
C
H
-T
el
50
eg
ra
m
Que. What is the unit of charge? C. 10 µF
A. Volt-Amp D. 25 µF
B. Henery Ans. B
C. Farad
D. Coulomb Que. One Coulomb charge equals the charge
Ans. D on
A. 6.42 x 10 18 electrons
Que. What will be the capacitance of four B. 6.24 x 10 18 atoms
capacitors of equal capacitance „C‟ when C. 6.24 x 10 12 electrons
connected in parallel? D. none of these
A. 4C Ans. A
B. C/4
C. 3C/4 Que. The capacitance of parallel plate
D. C capacitor is given as
Ans. A A. C = Є0 A / d
B. C = Є0 d / A
Que. A region around a stationary electric C. C = Є0 Єr A / d
charge has______ D. C= Єr A / d
A. magnetic field Ans. C
B. electric field
C. magnetic field and electric field Que. Two capacitors of 2 µF and 4 µF are
D. neither magnetic field nor electric field connected in parallel across 100 V dc supply.
Ans. B Energy stored in each capacitor will
be_________.
Que. One Farad is the same as A. 0. 1 J and 0. 2 J
A. One Coulomb/Volt B. 0.01 J and 0.02 J
B. One Joule/ Coulomb C. 1J and 2 J
C. One Joule/ Volt D. 0.001 J and 0.002 J
D. One Coulomb / Joule Ans. B
Ans. A
Que. The plate area of a parallel-plate
capacitor is 0.01 sq. m. The distance between
Que. If Q be the charge and C be the the plates is 2.5 cm. If the insulating medium
capacitance then the energy stored in the is air, its capacitance is________
capacitor is ___________ A. 3.54 x 10-12 F
A. 1/2QC B. 35.4 x 10-12 F
B. 1/QC C. 3.54 x 10-10 F
C. Q2/2C D. 3.54 x 10-11 F
Jo
D. Q/2C Ans. A
in
Ans. C
@
Que. What capacitance must be placed in capacitor is 0.01 sq. m. The distance between
P
series with a 15 µF capacitor to give a total the plates is 2.5 cm. If the space between the
U
capacitance of 5 µF?
B
B. 7.5 µF is___________
H
-T
el
51
eg
ra
m
A. 177.1 x 10-12 F Que. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase
B. 1.771 x 10-12 F transformer has to be worked at a maximum
C. 17.71 x 10-10 F flux density of 1.1 Web/m2 in the core. The
D. 17.71 x 10-12 F effective cross sectional area of the core is 145
Ans. D
cm2. The no of primary turns___
Que. A parallel-plate capacitor has two plates A. 930 turns
each of area 2.5 m2 separated by three B. 950 turns
dielectric materials of thickness 1, 2 and 3 mm C. 932 turns
and relative permitivities of 2, 4 and 8 D. 923 turns
respectively. The effective capacitance value Ans. C
is__________
A. 1.60 x 10-8 F Que. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase
B. 1.60 x 10-10 F transformer has to be worked at a maximum
C. 1.60 x 10-12 F flux density of 1.1 web/m2 in the core. The
D. 1.60 x 10-9 F effective cross sectional area of the core is 145
Ans. A cm2. The no of secondary turns___
A. 71 turns
B. 75 turns
UNIT IIIC C. 932 turns
D. 923 turns
Ans. A
Que. A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase
transformer is built on a core having an Que. A 80 kVA, 6000 V/ 400 V, 50 Hz single
phase transformer has 80 turns on the
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and
secondary winding. The value of maximum
60 turns on the secondary winding. The value
flux in the core________
of maximum flux density___
A. 25.22 mwb
A. 1.25 Tesla
B. 22.52 mwb
B. 1.52 Tesla
C. 52.22 mwb
C. 1.3 Tesla
D. none of these
D. none of the above
Ans. B
Ans. A
Que. A 6600 V/220 V, 50 Hz, step down
Que. A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase
single phase transformer has 1500 turns on its
transformer is built on a core having an
primary side. If its maximum flux density is
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 1.2 Tesla, then the effective cross sectional
60 turns on the secondary winding. The area of core is _____
Jo
winding________
B. 61.516 x 10–3 m2
@
A. 600 turns
C. 26.516 x 10–3 m2
SP
B. 900 turns
P
D. 450 turns
B
Ans. A
TE
Ans. B
C
H
-T
el
52
eg
ra
m
Que. A transformer is rated at 90 kVA, at B. 259.2V
full load its copper loss is 1100 W and its iron C. 2.592V
loss is 950 W. The efficiency at full load for D. 25V
unity power factor is___________ Ans. A
A. 99%
B. 96% Que. A fully charged capacitor of 10 µF
C. 97.77% has a potential difference of 100V across its
D. none of these terminals. It is discharged through 1 KΩ
Ans. C resistor. The discharging current at 2 msec
is_____
Que. A transformer is rated at 90 kVA, at A. -0.0818A
full load its copper losses is 1100 W and its B. -0.01A
iron losses is 950 W. The efficiency at 60% of C. -0.00818A
full load for 0.8 lagging power factor D. -1A
is___________ Ans. A
A. 96.97%
B. 96% Que. A fully charged capacitor of 10 µF has
C. 98% a potential difference of 100V across its
D. none of these terminals. It is discharged through 1 KΩ
Ans. A resistor. The initial rate of fall in voltage
across capacitor is____________
Que. A 500 kVA transformer has iron loss A. 10 4 V/s
of 2 kW and full load copper losses of 5 kW. B. -10 4 V/s
The efficiency at 75% of full load and unity C. -1 4 V/s
power factor__________ D. 10A
A. 98.13% Ans. B
B. 98.73%
C. 99%
D. none of these
Ans. B
Ans. B Ans. C
@
SP
Que. A 10 µF capacitor in series with an 1 Que. Two sine waves are said to be in phase
MΩ resistor is connected across a100 V dc
P
53
eg
ra
m
D. all of the above B. direction only
Ans. D C. both magnitude and direction
D. neither magnitude nor direction
Que. The distance occupied by one complete Ans. C
cycle of the wave is called its________
A. time period Que. An alternating current of 50 Hz
B. wavelength frequency and 100 A maximum value is given
C. velocity by______
D. frequency A. 𝑖 = 200 𝑠𝑖𝑛628𝑡
Ans. A B. 𝑖 = 100 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
C. 𝑖 = 100 2 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
Que. The rms value of a sine wave of peak D. 𝑖 = 100 2𝑠𝑖𝑛157𝑡
value Imis given by_______ Ans. B
A. Im/√2
B. Im Que. An alternating current is given by the
C. Im/2 𝜋
expression 𝑖 = 200 sin
(314𝑡 + 3 ) amperes.
D. Im/π
Ans. A The maximum value and frequency of the
current are_________
Que. The average value of a sine wave of A. 200 A, 50 Hz
maximum value I m over one cycle is_______ B. 100√2, 50 Hz
A. Im/π C. 200 A, 100 Hz
B. 2Im/π D. 200 A, 25 Hz
C. zero Ans. A
D. Im/2
Ans. C Que. When two quantities are in quadrature,
the phase angle between them will
Que. The time period of a sinusoidal be________
waveform with 200 Hz frequency A. 45°
is________second. B. 90°
A. 0.05 C. 135°
B. 0.005 D. 60°
C. 0.0005 Ans. B
D. 0.5
Ans. B Que. The ac system is preferred to dc system
because_______
Que. The form factor of a sine wave is_____ A. ac voltages can be easily changed in
A. 1.01 magnitude
Jo
Ans. B appliances
Ans. A
P U
changes in_______
because_______
C
A. magnitude only
H
54
eg
ra
m
B. it produces least disturbance in electrical
circuits Que. An alternating voltage is given by
C. it is nature‟s standard 𝑣 = 30 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡 .The time taken by the
D. other waves can not be produced easily voltage to reach 30 V for the first time is_____
Ans. B A. 0.02 second
B. 0.1 second
Que. __________will work only on dc supply. C. 0.03 second
A. electric lamp D. 0.005 second
B. refrigerator Ans. D
C. electroplating
D. heater Que. A sinusoidal current has a magnitude of 3
Ans. C A at 120°. Its maximum value will be_____
A. √3 A
Que. _________will produce ac voltage. 3
B. 2 A
A. friction
B. photoelectric effect C. 2√3 A
C. thermal energy D. 6 A
D. crystal Ans. C
Ans. D
Que. We have assigned a frequency of 50Hz to
Que. A coil is rotating in the uniform field of power system because it_______
an 8-pole generator. In one revolution of the A. can be easily obtained
coil, the number of cycles generated by the B. gives best result when used for operating
voltage is________ both lights and machinery
A. one C. leads to easy calculations
B. two D. none of the above
C. four Ans. B
D. eight
Ans. C Que. An alternating voltage is given by
𝑣 = 100 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡 volts. Its average value will
Que. An alternating voltage is given by be________
𝑣 = 20 sin 157𝑡. The frequency of the A. 70.7 V
alternating voltage is_____ B. 50 V
A. 50 Hz C. 63.7 V
B. 25 Hz D. 100 V
C. 100 Hz Ans. C
D. 75 Hz
Ans. B Que. An alternating current whose average
Jo
B. 14.14 V
U
Ans. B
TE
D. 5 V
C
Ans. B
H
-T
el
55
eg
ra
m
Que. A sinusoidal alternating current has a
maximum value of I m. Its average value will Que. The direction of current in an ac circuit
be_______ is___________
𝐼𝑚 A. always in one direction
A. 𝜋
𝐼𝑚 B. varying from time to time
B. 2𝜋 C. unpredictable
𝐼𝑚
C. 2 𝜋 D. from positive to negative
D. none of the above Ans. B
Ans. C
Que. Consider the sinusoidal waves:
Que. The area of a sinusoidal wave over a 𝐴sin(𝜔𝑡 + 30°) and 𝐵sin (𝜔𝑡 − 60°). The
half-cycle is________ phase angle relationship between the two
A. 𝑚𝑎𝑥. 𝑣𝑎𝑙𝑢𝑒 ÷ 2 waves________
B. 2 × 𝑚𝑎𝑥. 𝑣𝑎𝑙𝑢𝑒 A. B-wave lags A-wave by 90°
B. B-wave lags A-wave by 60°
C. 𝑚𝑎𝑥. 𝑣𝑎𝑙𝑢𝑒 ÷ 𝜋
C. B-wave lags A-wave by 30°
D. 𝑚𝑎𝑥. 𝑣𝑎𝑙𝑢𝑒 ÷ 2𝜋
D. B-wave and A-wave are in phase
Ans. B
Ans. A
Que. An alternating voltage is given by
Que. A sinusoidal voltage is expressed as
𝑣 = 200 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. Its rms value will be_____ 𝜋
A. 100 V 𝑣 = 20 sin(314.16𝑡 + 3 ) V. Its frequency
B. 282.8 V and phase angle respectively
C. 141.4 V are____________
D. 121.4 V A. 314.16 Hz, 60°
Ans. C B. 60Hz, 60°
C. 50 Hz, 60°
Que. A sinusoidal voltage is represented as D. 50 Hz, -60°
𝜋 Ans. C
𝑣 = 141.4 sin(314.18𝑡 − 2 ). Its rms value of
voltage, frequency and phase angle are
Que. A sinusoidal voltageV1 leads another
respectively_______
sinusoidal voltage V2 by 180°.
A. 141.42 V, 314.16 Hz, 90°
Then__________
B. 100 V, 100 Hz, -90°
A. voltageV2 leads voltage V1by 180°
C. 87.92 V, 56 Hz, 90°
B. both voltage have their zero values at the
D. 100 V,50 Hz, -90°
same time
Ans. D
C. both voltages have their peak values at the
same time
Que. When two sinusoidal waves are 90° out
D. all of the above
Jo
of phase, then__________
Ans. D
in
instant
Que. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current
SP
instant
A. 7.07 A
U
B. 14.14 A
TE
zero value
C. 10 A
D. none of these
C
D. 28.28 A
H
Ans. C
-T
el
56
eg
ra
m
Ans. B B. +1
C. -1
Que. If A=10∠45° and B=5∠15°, then the 1
D. 2
value of A/B will be_________
Ans. A
A. 50∠60°
B. 2∠60° Que. An alternating current is given by
C. 2∠-30° 𝑖 = 𝐼𝑚 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝜃. The average value of squared
D. 2∠30° wave of this current over a complete cycle
Ans. D is________
A. I2m/2
Que. When a phasor is multiplied by –j, it gets B. Im/π
rotated through_______in the C. 2Im/π
counterclockwise direction. D. 2Im
A. 90° Ans. A
B. 180°
C. 270° Que. The form factor of a sinusoidal wave
D. none of the above is______
Ans. C A. 1.414
B. 1.11
Que. The rms value of sinusoidally varying C. 2
current is_________that of its average value. D. 1.5
A. more than Ans. B
B. less than
C. same as Que. The filament of a vacuum tube requires
D. none of the above 0.4A dc to heat it. The rms value of ac
Ans. A required is______
A. 0.4 × 2 A
Que. Alternating voltages and currents are
B. 0.4 ÷ 2 A
expressed in rms values because______
A. they can be easily determined C. 0.8 ÷ 2 A
B. calculations become very simple D. 0.4 A
C. they give comparison with dc Ans. D
D. none of the above
Ans. C Que. A100 V peak ac is as effective
as_____dc
Que. The average value of sin2θ over a A. 100 V
complete cycle is_________ B. 50 V
A. +1 C. 70.7 V
Jo
1 Ans. C
C.
@
2
D. zero
SP
B. square
B
C. triangular
complete cycle is_________ D. sawtooth
C
A. zero
H
Ans. B
-T
el
57
eg
ra
m
Que. Out of the following _________wave is Que. A heater is rated as 230V, 10KW, AC.
the peakiest. The value of 230V refers to___________
A. sinusoidal A. average voltage
B. square B. rms voltage
C. rectangualr C. peak voltage
D. triangular D. none of the above
Ans. D Ans. B
Que. The peak factor of a sine waveform Que. The peak value of a sine wave is 200V.
is_______ Its average value is_______
A. 1.11 A. 127.4V
B. 1.414 B. 141.4V
C. 2 C. 282.8V
D. 1.5 D. 200V
Ans. B Ans. A
Que. When a 15V square wave is connected Que. The rms value of a sine wave is 100A.
across a 50V ac voltmeter, it will read______ Its peak value is _______
A. 15V A. 70.7A
B. 15 × 2 V B. 141.4A
C. 15/ 2 V C. 150A
D. none of the above D. 282.8A
Ans. A Ans. B
Que. The period of a wave is____________ Que. The voltage of domestic supply is 220V.
A. the same as frequency This figure represents________
B. time required to complete one cycle A. mean value
C. expressed in amperes B. rms value
D. none of the above C. peak value
Ans. B D. average value
Ans. B
Que. The form factor is the ratio of _________
A. peak value to rms value Que. The rms value and mean value is the
B. rms value to average value same in the case of_______
C. average value to rms value A. traingular wave
D. none of the above B. sine wave
Ans. B C. square wave
Jo
value?
B
C. 40 Hz
TE
D. 50 HZ A. square wave
C
58
eg
ra
m
C. triangular wave Que. For a frequency of 200 Hz, the time
D. sine wave period will be_________
Ans. A A. 0.05 S
B. 0.005 S
Que. For the same peak value which of the C. 0.0005 S
following wave will have the least mean D. 0.5 S
value? Ans. B
A. half wave rectified sine wave
B. triangular wave
C. sine wave
D. square wave
Ans. A
Que. For a sine wave with peak value Imax, the Que. An ac voltage of 50 Hz has a maximum
rms value is_______ value of 50 V. Its value after 1/600 second
A. 0.5Imax after the instant the current is zero will
B. 0.707Imax be_________
C. 0.9Imax A. 5V
D. 1.414Imax B. 12.5V
Ans. B C. 25V
D. 43.8V
Que. Form factor is the ratio of_________ Ans. C
A. average value/rms value
B. average value/peak value Que. For 200V rms value triangular wave, the
C. rms value/average value peak voltage will be______
D. rms value/peak value A. 200V
Ans. C B. 222V
C. 282V
Que. For a sine wave with peak value E max, the D. 346V
average value is______ Ans. D
A. 0.636Emax
B. 0.707Emax Que. The rms value of a half-wave rectified
C. 0.434Emax current is 100 A. Its value for full-wave
D. 1.414Emax rectification would be_________amperes.
Ans. A A. 141.4
B. 200
Que. The current in a circuit is given by: C. 200/π
𝑖 = 100 sin 314𝑡 amperes. The maximum D. 40/π
Jo
A. 50√2 A, 100 Hz
@
D. 70.7 A, 50 Hz ______degrees.
U
Ans. C A. 90
B
TE
B. 60
C
C. 45
H
-T
el
59
eg
ra
m
D. 30 A. 200 Hz
Ans. C B. 100 Hz
C. 60 Hz
Que. The rms value of alternating current is D. 50 Hz
given by steady dc current which when Ans. D
flowing through a given circuit for a given
time produces________ Que. The rms value of half wave rectified sine
A. the more heat than produced by ac when wave is 200V. The rms value of full wave
flowing through the same circuit rectified ac will be__________
B. the same heat as produced by ac when A. 282.8V
flowing through the same circuit B. 141.4V
C. the less heat than produced by ac flowing C. 111V
through the same circuit D. 100V
D. none of the above Ans. A
Ans. B
Que. The negative maximum of a cosine wave
Que. The square waveform of current has occurs at________
following relation between rms value and A. 30°
average value: B. 45°
A. rms value is equal to average value C. 90°
B. rms value of current is greater than average D. 180°
value Ans. D
C. rms value of current is less than average
value Que. The rms value of pure cosine function
D. none of the above is_________
Ans. A A. 0.5 of peak value
B. 0.707 of peak value
Que. If a sinusoidal wave has frequency of 50 C. same as peak value
Hz with 30A rms current, which of the D. zero
following equation represents the wave? Ans. B
A. 42.42 sin 314𝑡
B. 60 𝑠𝑖𝑛25𝑡
C. 30 sin 50𝑡 Que. An alternating voltage is given in volts
D. 84.84 𝑠𝑖𝑛25𝑡 by expression 𝑣 = 326 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. Its rms value
Ans. A and frequency are____
A. 230V,50 Hz
Que. Which of the following waves has the B. 230V,100 Hz
highest value of peak factor? C. 326V,50 Hz
Jo
60
eg
ra
m
B. half peak value A. whole cycle
C. average value B. half cycle
D. rms value C. unsymmetrical part of the waveform
Ans. D D. first two cycles
Ans. A
Que. The frequency of an alternating current
is________ Que. A constant current of 2.8A exists in a
A. the speed with which the alternator runs resistor. The rms value of current is______
B. the number of cycles generated in one A. 2.8 A
minute B. about 2 A
C. the number of waves passing through a C. 1.4 A
point in one second D. undefined
D. the number of electrons passing through a Ans. A
point in one second
Ans. C Que. An alternating current is represented as
𝜋
𝑖 = 70.7 sin(520𝑡 + ). The frequency and
6
Que. The equation of 50 Hz current sine wave rms value of the current are_________
having rms value of 60 A is______ A. 82.76 Hz, 50 A
A. 60 sin 25𝑡 B. 41.38 Hz, 25 A
B. 60 sin 50𝑡 C. 41.38 Hz, 50 A
C. 84.84 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡 D. 82.76 Hz, 25 A
D. 42.42 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. Ans. A
Ans. C
Que. The time period or periodic time T of an
Que. The direction of current in an ac alternating quantity is the time taken in
circuit________ seconds to complete_____________
A. is from positive to negative A. one cycle
B. is always in one direction B. alternation
C. varies from instant to instant C. none of the above
D. can not be determined D. Half cycle
Ans. C Ans. A
Que. The angular frequency of an alternating Que. The time period of an alternating quantity
quantity is a mathematical quantity obtained is 0.02 second.Its frequency will be________
by multiplying the frequency “f” of the A. 25 Hz
alternating quantity by a factor_________ B. 50 Hz
𝜋
A. 2 C. 100 Hz
B. π D. 0.02 Hz
Jo
C. 2π Ans. B
in
D. 4π
@
61
eg
ra
m
C. rms value Que. The phase of alternating quantity at any
D. peak to peak value particular instant is the fraction of ______
Ans. C A. phase
B. time
Que. The form factor for dc supply voltage is C. time period
always D. all above
A. zero Ans. C
B. unity
C. infinity
D. any value between 0 and 1
Ans. B
diagram.
C. 3T/4
in
A. Same
D. T/4
@
B. Different
Ans. C
SP
C. multiple
P
D. all above
U
A. zero
H
-T
el
62
eg
ra
m
B. positive C. phase difference
C. negative D. none of the above
D. none of the above Ans. C
Ans. B
Que. When phase difference between the two
Que. When phase of an alternating quantity is alternating quantities is _______, the two
negative it means that quantity has some quantities are said to be in phase.
_______ instantaneous value at t=0 A. one
A. zero B. unity
B. positive C. zero
C. negative D. π/2
D. none of the above Ans. C
Ans. C
Que. If v = Vm Sin ωtand i = Im Sin (ωt-Φ),
the „v‟ is said to _______ „i‟ by angle Φ
Que. The difference between the _____ of two A. in phase
alternating quantities is called the phase B. lagging
difference. C. leading
A. time D. all above
B. phase angle Ans. C
C. Lengths
D. both a and b
Ans. B Que. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ),
the „i‟ is said to _______ „v‟ by angle Φ
Que. The difference between the phase of two A. in phase
alternating quantities is called the________. B. lagging
A. phase difference C. leading
B. sinedifference D. all above
C. length difference Ans. C
D. none of the above
Ans. A Que. If v = Vm Sin ωtand i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ),
the „v‟ is said to _______ „i‟ by angle Φ
Que. When phase difference between the two A. in phase
alternating quantities is zero, the two B. lag
quantities are said to be in _____ C. lead
A. tandom D. all above
B. length Ans. B
C. phase
Jo
A. in phase
SP
B. length difference
H
-T
el
63
eg
ra
m
Que. With respect to reference, plus sign of indicating exact phase relationship is called
angle indicates _______ phasor diagram.
A. leading A. time
B. lagging B. frequency
C. inphase C. sign
D. none of the above D. shape
Ans. A Ans. B
Que. With respect to reference, minus sign of Que. The lagging and leading word is relative
angle indicates _______ to the ______
A. leading A. base
B. lagging B. range
C. inphase C. reference
D. none of the above D. angle
Ans. B Ans. C
Que. With respect to reference, _____ sign of Que. In purely _____ circuit, the current
angle indicates lead flowing and voltage applied are in phase with
A. division each other.
B. plus A. resistive
C. minus B. inductive
D. dot C. capacitive
Ans. B D. none of the above
Ans. A
Que. With respect to reference, _____ sign of
angle indicates lag. Que. In purely resistive circuit, the current and
A. division voltage applied are in ______ with each other.
B. plus A. opposition
C. minus B. phase
D. dot C. direction
Ans. C D. line
Ans. B
Que. The diagram in which different
sinusoidal alternating quantities of the same Que. In purely _______ circuit, current lags
frequency, are represented by individual voltage by 90 degrees.
phasors indicating exact phase relationship is A. resistive
called ________ B. inductive
A. graph C. capacitive
Jo
D. picture
SP
voltage by 90 degrees.
U
64
eg
ra
m
D. all above C. XL=ΦL
Ans. B D. XL=ωC
Ans. A
Que. In purely Inductive circuit, current lags Que. Inductive reactance is measured in
voltage by _______ degrees. ______
A. 30 A. Farad
B. 60 B. Henry
C. 90 C. Ohm
D. 120 D. Joule
Ans. C Ans. C
Que. The inductance offers _____ reactance to Que. Inductive reactance depends on ______
DC of applied voltage
A. high A. phase
B. low B. sign
C. zero C. frequency
D. none of the above D. speed
Ans. C Ans. C
Que. The _________ offers zero reactance to Que. Inductive reactance is _________
DC frequency.
A. resistance A. inversely proportional to
B. inductance B. directly proportional to
C. permeance C. indepedent of
D. none of the above C. none of above
Ans. B Ans. B
Que. The inductance offers zero _________ to Que. Inductive reactance is directly
DC proportional to ________.
A. resistance A. time
B. capacitance B. phase
C. reactance C. frequency
D. permeance D. phase difference
Ans. C Ans. C
Que. Pure ______ never consumes power Que. In purely capacitive circuit, current
A. resistor ______ voltage by 90 degrees.
Jo
B. inductor A. lags
in
C. starter B. leads
@
D. circuit C. in phase
SP
Ans. B
U
65
eg
ra
m
A. 30 Que. Inductive reactance is given by_____
B. 60 A. XC=1/ωC
C. 90 B. XC=1/2𝝅C
D. 120 C. XC=1/ΦC
Ans. C D. XC=2𝝅fL
Ans. A
Que. The capacitor offers _____ reactance to
DC. Que. ______is given by XC=1/ωL
A. high A. resistance
B. low B. inductance
C. zero C. inductive reactance
D. none of the above D. capacitive reactance
Ans. A Ans. D
Que. The _________ offers infinite reactance Que. Capacitive reactance is measured in
to DC ______
A. resistance A. farads
B. permeance B. henrys
C. capacitance C. ohms
D. none of the above D. joules
Ans. C Ans. C
Que. The power curve of pure capacitor is Que. Capacitive reactance is inversly
________ curve of frequency double than that proportional to ________.
of applied voltage A. time
A. sine B. phase
B. square C. frequency
C. tringular D. phase difference
D. sawtooth Ans. C
Ans. A
Jo
Que. Pure ______ never consumes power at 5kHz. Its reactance at 15 kHz is _____ kΩ.
@
A. resistor A. 8
SP
B. capacitor B. 10
P
C. starter C. 12
U
D. circuit D. 20
B
TE
Ans. B Ans. C
C
H
-T
el
66
eg
ra
m
Que. The square of aj operator _____ D. from positive to negative
A. can never be negative Ans. B
B. can never be positive
C. could be either positive or negative Que. Consider the sinusoidal waves: A sin
D. is equal to j (ωt+30) and B cos(ωt-60). The phase angle
Ans. B relationship between two waves is:
A. B wave lags A wave by 90 degrees
Que. A complex number_____ B. B wave lags A wave by 60 degrees
A. is the same as imaginary number C. B wave lags A wave by 30 degrees
B. has real and imaginary part D. B wave and A wave are in phase
C. is negative number Ans. D
D. is merely a technical term
Ans. B Que. Thereactance of L Henryinductance
connected to an AC source of frequency f is
Que. The sum of (3+j6) and (-3-j6) is ____ ______ ohm.
A. 0+j0 A. fL
B. 6+j12 B. πfL
C. -6-j12 C. 2 πfL
D. 0-j12 D. all above
Ans. A Ans. C
Que. A sinusoidal voltageis represented as: v = Que. When pure inductance is connected to an
141.4 sin(314.18t-π/2). Its rms value of AC sources, the voltage____ to the current by
voltage, frequency and phase angle are ____
respectively____ A. lags, 90 degrees
A. 141.42V, 314.16 Hz, 90 degrees B. leads, 90 degrees
B. 100V, 50 Hz, -90 degrees C. lags, 45 degrees
C. 87.92V, 56 Hz, 90 degrees D. leads, 45 degrees
D. 200V, 50 Hz, -90 degrees Ans. B
Ans. B
Que. When a phasor is multiplied by j and –j,
Que. When two sinusoidal waves are 90 it is rotated through ______ degrees in the
degrees out of phase, then ____ anticlockwise direction respectively.
A. both have their peak values at the same A. 90,270
time B. 90,90
B. both have their minimum values at the same C. 90,180
time D. 270,90
C. one has its peak value, other has zero value Ans. A
Jo
D. none of these
in
____
SP
is _____ B. unity
U
C. unpredictable Ans. B
H
-T
el
67
eg
ra
m
B. sinusoid of double the original frequency
Que. If e1 = 100 sin(2πf) and e2 = 100 sin(2πf- C. sinusoid of half the original frequency
Φ), then _____ D. non-sinusoid
A. e1 lags e2 by Φ Ans. A
B. e1 leads e2 by Φ
C. e2 lags e1 by Φ Que. A constant current of 2.8 A exists in a
D. none of the above resistor. The rms value of current is ____
Ans. C A. 2.8 A
B. 2 A
Que. The average power in a purely inductive C. 1.4 A
or capacitive circuit over a cycle____ D. undefined
A. depends on XLor XC Ans. A
B. is negative
C. is zero Que. The power factor of an ordinary bulb is
D. is positive _____
Ans. C A. zero
B. unity
Que. Inductive reactance of an AC circuit C. more than unity
increases with ____ D. less than unity
A. increase in frequency Ans. B
B. increase in resistance
C. decrease in resistance Que. When aphasor is multiplied by –j, it is
D. decrease in frequency rotated through ____ in counter-clockwise
Ans. A direction
A. 90
Que. When the two quantities are in B. 180
quadrature, the phase angle between them will C. 270
be ____ degrees. D. none of the above
A. 45 Ans. C
B. 90
C. 135 Que. If the phasor is multiplied by j, then ____
D. 60 A. only its magnitude changes
Ans. B B. only its direction changes
C. both magnitude and direction change
Que. The phase difference between two D. none of the above
waveforms can be compared when they _____ Ans. B
A. have the same frequency
B. have the same peak value Que. In the complex number 4+j7, 7 is called
Jo
Ans. A B. imaginary
SP
C. in-phase
P
68
eg
ra
m
Que. The reciprocal of a complex number is Ans. B
a_____
A. complex number Que. The difference of two conjugate number
B. real component only results in _____
C. quadrature component only A. a complex number
D. none of above B. in-phase component only
Ans. A C. quadrature component only
D. none of the above
Que. If two complex numbers are equal, Ans. C
then_____
A. only their magnitudes will be equal Que. The reciprocal of j is ____
B. only their angles will be equal A. j
C. their in phase and quadrature components B. -j
will be separately equal C. jxj
D. none of above D. none of the above
Ans. C Ans. B
Que. A phasor 2 180 can be expressed Que. Two waves of same frequency have
as____ opposite phase when the phase angle between
A. j2 them is ___ degrees
B. -j2 A. 360
C. -2 B. 180
D. 2 C. 90
Ans. C D. 0
Ans. B
Que. A current of (3+j4) A is flowing through
a circuit. The magnitude of current is _____ Que. The power consumed in a circuit element
A. 7 A will be least when the phase difference
B. 5 A between the current and voltageis ____
C. 1 A degrees.
D. 1.33 A A. approx.180
Ans. B B. approx. 90
C. approx. 60
Que. The voltage applied in a circuit is given D. approx. 0
by 100 60 volts. It can be written as ____ Ans. B
A. 100 -60
B. 100 240 Que. Two sinusoidal currents are given by i1 =
C. 100 -300 100sin(ωt+π/3) and i2 = 150sin(ωt-π/4). The
Jo
Ans. C degrees
@
A. 15
SP
A. 4-j3 C. 60
U
B. -4-j3 D. 105
B
TE
C. 4+j3 Ans. D
C
69
eg
ra
m
Que. Capacitive reactance is more when____ B. current leads the voltageby 90 degrees
A. capacitance is less and frequency of supply C. current can lead or lagthe voltageby 90
is less degrees
B. capacitance is less and frequency of supply D. current is in phase with the voltage
is more Ans. B
C. capacitance is more and frequency of
supply is less Que. A phasor is _____
D. capacitance is more and frequency of A. a line which represents the magnitude and
supply is more phase of an alternatingquantity
Ans. A B. a line which represents the magnitude and
direction of an alternatingquantity
Que. Pure inductive circuit ______ C. acoloured tag or band for distinction
A. consumes some power on average between different phases of a 3 phase supply
B. does not take power at all from lines D. an instrument used for measuring phases of
C. takes power from the line during some part an unbalanced 3 phase load
of cycle and returns back during other part of Ans. B
cycle
D. none of the above Que. Ohm is the unit of all the following
Ans. C except
A. inductive reactance
Que. Power factor of the following circuit will B. capacitive reactance
be zero C. resistance
A. resistive D. capacitance
B. pureinductive Ans. D
C. pure capacitive
D. both (B) and (C) Que. For a purely resistive circuit the
Ans. D following statement is correct
A. work done is zero
Que. Power factor of the following circuit will B. power consumed is zero
be unity C. heat produced is zero
A. resistive D. power factor is unity
B. pureinductive Ans. D
C. pure capacitive
D. both (B) and (C) Que. For purely inductive circuit if v = Vm sin
Ans. A (ωt) then equation of current is _____
A. i = Im sin (ωt-π/2)
Que. In pure resistive circuit _____ B. i = Im sin (ωt+π/2)
A. current lags the voltageby 90 degrees C. i = Im sin (ωt-π)
Jo
degrees
SP
D. current is in phase with the voltage Que. For purely capacitive circuit if v = Vm
sin (ωt) then equation of current is _____
P
Ans. D
U
A. i = Im sin (ωt-π/2)
B
TE
70
eg
ra
m
D. i = Im sin (ωt+π) Ans. A
Ans. B
Que. Which of the following statements
Que. For purely resistive circuit if v = Vm sin pertains to resistor only
(ωt) then equation of current is _____ A. can dissipate considerable amount of power
A. i = Im sin (ωt-π/2) B. can act as energy storage device
B. i = Im sin (ωt+π/2) C. connecting them in parallel increases the
C. i = Im sin (ωt) total value
D. i = Im sin (ωt+π) D. opposes sudden change in voltage
Ans. C Ans. A
Que. A sinusoidal voltageV1 leads another Que. The length of a phasor in a phasor
sinusoidal voltage V2 by 180 degrees. Then diagram normally represents the …………
____ value of the alternating quantity
A. voltageV2 leads voltageV1 by 180 degrees A. rms or effective
B. both voltagehave their zero values at the B. average
same time C. peak
C. both voltagehave their peak values at the D. none of these
same time Ans. A
D. all of above
Ans. D Que. The two quantities are said to be in phase
with each other when
Que. If A = 10 45 and B = 5 15, then the A. the phase difference between two quantities
value of A/B will be___ is zero degree or radian
A. 50 60 B. each of them pass through zero values at the
B. 2 60 same instant and rise in the same direction
C. 2 -30 C. each of them pass through zero values at the
D. 2 30 same instant but rises in the opposite
Ans. D directions
D. either (a) or (b)
Que. The active power of AC circuit is given Ans. D
by ___
A. VI sin Φ Que. The phase difference between the two
B. I2XL waveforms can be compared only when they
C. I2R A. have the same frequency
D. I2Z B. have the same peak value
Ans. C C. have the same effective value
D. are sinusoidal
Jo
B. decreses with the increase in supply Que. The phasor diagram for alternating
SP
frequency A. rectangular
B
TE
frequency C. triangular
H
-T
el
71
eg
ra
m
D. any of these Que. The phasor diagram of voltage and
Ans. B current considering phasors are rotates
clockwise direction is of
Que. Which of the following statements
associated with purely resistive circuits is
I
correct?
A. PF is unity
V
B. Power consumed is zero
C. Heat produced is zero
D. PF is zero A. Pure resistance
Ans. A B. pure inductance
C. pure capacitance
Que. Average power in a pure resistive circuit D. pure capacitance and pure inductance
is equal to Ans. B
A. zero
B. product of average values of current and Que. The power factor of an ac circuit lies
voltage between
C. product of peak values of current and A. 0 and 1
voltage B. -1 and 1
D. product of rms or effective values of C. 0 and -1
current and voltage D. none of these
Ans. D Ans. A
V
B. 6.37
in
C. 5
@
C. pure capacitance
U
is________V.
H
-T
el
72
eg
ra
m
A. 84.84 C. 100V
B. 77.82 D. 173.2V
C. 94.68 Ans. C
D. 89.15
Ans. A Que. How much rms current does a 300W,
200V bulb take from the 200V, 50Hz power
line?
Que. The peak value of a sine wave is 400 V. A. 0.5 A
Its average value is_________V. B. 1.5 A
A. 254.6 C. 2 A
B. 282.6 D. 3 A
C. 400 Ans. B
D. 565.5
Ans. A Que. Polar form of v = 100 sin(100πt+π/6)
Volt is ________
Que. The average value of the current 𝑖 = A. 61.2371+j35.3553
𝜋
200 sin 𝑡 from 𝑡 = 0 to 𝑡 = 2 is ______ B. 70.7106 30
A. 400 π C. 61.2371 35.3553
400 D. 70.710+ j30
B. 𝜋 Ans. B
1
C. 400
𝜋 Que. Rectangular form of V= 100
D. 400
sin(100πt+π/6) Volt is ________
Ans. B A. 61.2371+j35.3553
B. 70.7106 30
Que. An alternating current is given by C. 61.2371 35.3553
𝑖 = 10 sin 314𝑡. The time taken to generate D. 70.710+ j30
two cycles of current is____ Ans. A
A. 0.02 second
B. 0.01 second Que. RMS value of current I = 25 + j40 Amp
C. 0.04 second is _______
D. 0.05 second A. 57.99
Ans. C B. 47.1699
C. 60
Que. A sine wave has a frequency of 50 Hz. Its D. 30
angular frequency is_______radian/second Ans. B
A. 100π
B. 50π Que. Two currents I1 = 1050 and I2 = 5 -
C. 25π
Jo
I1/I2 =________
@
B. 2150 A
Que. A sine wave of voltage varies from zero
P
C. 7.296+ j12.58 A
U
Ans. B
A. 50V
C
H
B. 82.8V
-T
el
73
eg
ra
m
Que. A 10 mH inductor carries a sinusoidal Que. The curve for the instantaneous power
current of 1 A at frequency of 50 Hz. The with respect to the waveforms of voltage &
average power dissipated by the inductor is current is shown in figure is of
____
A. 0 P P
+
+
B. 3.14 W v
C. 0.5 W 0
i
D. 1 W t
2 2
Ans. A
- -
P P
UNIT IVC
Que. An electric iron designed for 110 V
A. pure resistance AC supply was rated at 500 W. It was put
B. pure inductance across a 220 V
C. resistance and capacitance supply. Assuming that at 110 V, it supplied
D. pure capacitance 500 W output (i.e. no losses) at the new
Ans. A voltage it will
supply_________
Que. The curve for the instantaneous power A. 2500 W
with respect to the waveforms of voltage & B. 2000 W
current is shown in figure is of C. 500 W
P P
D. 250 W
+ +
Ans. B
v
i
0
2
t
Que. The mean value of the current
𝜋
2
𝑖 = 20 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝜃 from θ=0 to θ=2 is_______
-
P
-
P A. 40π
T
40
B. 𝜋
Jo
A. pure resistance 1
C. 40
in
B. pure inductance 𝜋
@
C. pure capacitance D. 40
SP
Ans. B
U
current are____
H
-T
el
74
eg
ra
m
A. 16.36 A, 17.07 A D. 10
B. 10 A, 17.07 A Ans. A
C. 10 A, 12.25 A
D. 16.36 A, 12.2 A Que. If 10 ohm resistor is connected across
Ans. C an AC voltagev = 100 sin(314t+300), the
power dissipated through resistor is _____
Que. Two currents I1 = 1050 and I2 = 5 A. 500 W
-100 A flow in single phase AC circuit. Then B. 1000 W
I1+I2 =________ C. 250 W
A. 5.5596+ j4.924 A D. 100 W
B. 5.55964.924 A Ans. A
C. 7.296+ j12.58 A
D. None of the above Que. For a frequency of 50 Hz, the
Ans. A reactance offered by capacitor is 10 ohms, If
the frequency is increased to 100 Hz, the
Que. Two currents I1 = 1050 and I2 = 5 reactance becomes____
-100 A flow in single phase AC circuit. Then A. 40 ohms
I1-I2 =________ B. 20 ohms
A. 5.5596+ j4.924 A C. 5 ohms
B. 5.5596 4.924 A D. 2.5 ohms
C. 7.296+ j12.58 A Ans. C
D. None of the above
Ans. C Que. Which value of inductance will give
the same reactance as a capacitor of 2 µF when
Que. In purely inductive circuit, if the both are at 50 Hz?
frequency is doubled and applied voltage is A. 5 H
halved, the resulting current becomes____ B. 10 H
A. one-fourth C. 15 H
B. one-fifth D. 20 H
C. one-half Ans. A
D. one-third
Ans. A Que. If a 10 ohm resistance is connected to
an AC supply v = 100 sin (314t+370) V, the
Que. The product of (-4-j7) and (6-j2) power dissipated by the resistance is
is______ A. 10 kW
A. -24+j14 B. 1 kW
B. 24-j14 C. 500 W
C. -38-j34 D. 250 W
Jo
D. -24-j14 Ans. C
in
Ans. C
@
Que. Inductive reactance of a coil of inductance and frequency are doubled, its
P
A. 2000
B
A. 62.8
TE
B. 628 B. 500
C
C. 0.2 C. 250
H
-T
el
75
eg
ra
m
D. 4000 A. 5 A
Ans. D B. 3.18 A
C. 1.57 A
Que. A pure inductance connected across D. 1.10 A
250 V, 50 Hz supply consumes 100 W. This Ans. B
consumption is due to_____
A. the big size of the inductor Que. An alternating current is given by
B. the reactance of the inductor 𝑖 = 10 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. Measuring time from 𝑡 = 0,
C. the current flowing in the inductor the time taken by the current to reach +10 V
D. the statement given is false for the second time is_________
Ans. D A. 0.05 second
B. 0.1 second
Que. A pure capacitor connected across an C. 0.025 second
AC voltage consumed 50 W. This D. 0.02 second
A. is due to the capacitive reactance in ohms Ans. C
B. is due to the current flowing in capacitor
C. is due to the size of capacitor Que. An ac current is given by 𝑖 =
D. statement is incorrect 200 𝑠𝑖𝑛100𝜋𝑡. It will achieve a value of 100A
Ans. D after_____second.
1
A. 900
Que. An alternating current of 50 Hz 1
frequency has a maximum value of 100 A. Its B. 800
value 1/600 second after the instant current is 1
C. 700
zero will be________ 1
A. 25 A D. 600
B. 12.5 A Ans. D
C. 50 A
D. 75 A Que. The voltage in a circuit follows the
Ans. C law: 𝑣 = 100 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝜔𝑡. If the frequency is 25
Hz, how long willit take for the voltage to rise
Que. A sinusoidal voltage varies from zero to 50V?
1
to a maximum of 250 V. The voltage at the A. 50 S
instant of 60° of the cycle will be________ 1
A. 150 V B. 100 S
1
B. 216.5 V C. 300 S
C. 125 V 1
D. 108.25 V D. 600 S
Ans. B Ans. C
Jo
in
be_________
H
-T
el
76
eg
ra
m
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple Choice Questions
Unit II
Part (a) ELECTROSTATICS
5. If a number of capacitors are connected in resistor. The combination is placed across a 40V
SP
series then the total capacitance of combination dc source. Time constant of the circuit
P
is_____ is_____________________
U
capacitor b. 3 s
C
d. 2.4s ans: a
ans: b
15. The unit of capacitance is
10. Three capacitors of values 3 µF, 6 µF, and 12 a. Volts/Coulomb
µF are connected in parallel across an a.c. b. Coulomb/Volt
source. The maximum current pass through c. Ohms
________________ d. Henry/Wb
a.3 µF ans: b
b.6 µF
c.12 µF 16. There is repulsive force between two
d. all the capacitors charged objects when
ans:c a. Charges of unlike sign
b. they have the same number of protons
11.As per Coulomb’s law___________________ c. charges are of same sign
a. F= Q1Q2 / εoεrd2 d. they have the same number of protons
b. F= Q1Q2 / 4𝜋d2 ans: c
c. F= Q1Q2 / 4𝜋 εoεrd2
d. F= Q1Q2 /4𝜋 εoεrd 17. The capacitance of a capacitor is not
ans: c affected by
a. distance between plates
12. Electric field intensity at any point in an b. area of plates
electric field is equal to_______ c. thickness of plates
a. potential gradient d. all of the above
b. (potential gradient)2 ans: c
c. (potential gradient)1/2
d. (potential gradient)1/3 18. When there is an equal amount of positive
ans: a and negative charges on an object the object is
a. Positively charged
13. The lines of forces due to isolated charged b. negatively charged
particle are___________ c. neutral
a. always straight d. supercharged
b. always curved ans:c
c. sometimes curved
d. none of the above 19. Which of the following statements is
Jo
ans: a correct?
in
14. The direction of electric field due to positive the outside foil
SP
grows linearly
in
b. The current in the discharging capacitor 28. A paper capacitor is usually available in the
@
ans:c ans:b
-T
el
30. The unit of capacitance is 35. The absolute permittivity of free space is
a. Henry given by
b. Ohm a. 8.854 x 10-9 F/m
c. Farad b. 8.854 x 10-10 F/m
d. Farad/m c. 8.854 x 10-11 F/m
ans:c d. 8.854 x 10-12 F/m
ans:d
31. A capacitor charged to 200V has 2000 µC of
charge. The value of capacitance will be 36. The relative permittivity of free space is
a. 10 F given by
b. 10 µF a. 1
c. 100 µF b. 10
d. 1000 µF c. 100
ans:b d. 1000
ans:a
32. Voltage across capacitor at any time‘t’
during charging from a D.C. source of voltage V 37. When 4 Volt e.m.f. is applied across a 1
is given by Farad capacitor, it will store energy of
a. ν = Ve-t/λ a. 2 Joule
b. ν = V(1-e-t/λ) b. 4 Joule
c. ν = V2e-t/λ c. 6 Joule
d. ν = V2(1-e-t/λ) d. 8 Joule
ans:b ans:d
33. The ratio of electric flux density to electric 38. The capacitor preferred for high frequency
Jo
ans:b ans:b
TE
C
H
-T
el
42. The time constant of an R-C circuit is 47. The relative permittivity of air is__________
defined as the time during which capacitor a.0
charging voltage actually rises to ---------------- b.1.0006
percent of its ---------- value c. 8.854 × 10−12
a.37, initial d. none of the above
b.63.2, initial ans:b
c.63.2, final
d.37, final 48. The relative permittivity of a material is 10.
ans: c Its absolute permittivity will be
a. 8.854 × 10−11 𝐹/𝑀
Jo
a.37
B
d.73
-T
el
c. 10 µF and 8 µF a. 1mA
B
ans:b c. 0.01mA
C
H
d. 1.00A
-T
el
ans:b
63. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
59. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm potential difference of 100V across its
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm
Determine the initial rate of rise of voltage resistor. Find discharging current at 2m Sec.
across the capacitor. a. - 0.0818A
a. 0.1V/s b. - 0.01A
b. 10V/s c. - 0.00818A
c. 0.01V/s d. - 1A
d. 1V/s ans:a
ans:b
64. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
60. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm potential difference of 100V across its
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm
Determine the capacitor voltage after a time resistor. Find initial rate of fall in voltage across
equal to the time constant. capacitor.
a.36V a. 10 4 V/s
b.36.6V b. -10 4 V/s
c.63.2V c. -1 4 V/s
d.63 V d. 10A
ans:c ans:b
61. A 10µF capacitor in series with an 1 M Ohm 65. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. potential difference of 100V across its
Determine the voltage across the capacitor terminals. It is discharged through 1 K Ohm
3sec. after switch on. resistor. Find time constant of the circuit.
a.25.92V a. 0.1sec
b.259.2V b. 1sec
c.2.592V c. 0.01sec
d.25V d. 0.001sec
ans:a ans:c
62. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a 66. A capacitor consists of two similar plates
potential difference of 100V across its each 10cm x 10cm mounted parallel and
Jo
terminals. It is discharged through 1 KΩ resistor. opposite to each other. What is the value of
in
b.10A a. 8.854 pF
P U
c.0.01A b. 8.854 µF
B
d.0.1A c. 8.854 mF
TE
ans:d d. 8.854 F
C
H
ans: a
-T
el
a. magnetic field
67. The capacitance of capacitor formed by two b. electric field
parallel plates each 200 cm2 in area separated c. magnetic field and electric field
by dielectric of 4mm thick is 0.0004µF. If d. neither magnetic field nor electric field
voltage of 20000 V is applied then the total ans: b
charge on the plate is
a. 8µC 72. One Farad is the same as
b. 8mC a. One Coulomb/Volt
c. 8nC b. One Joule/Coulomb
d. 8pC c. One Joule/Volt
ans: a d. One Coulomb /Joule
ans: a
68. A parallel plate capacitor has plate area of
2m2 spaced by three slabs of dielectric 73 . If Q be the charge and C be the capacitance
materials. The relative permittivity’s are 2,3 and then the energy stored in the capacitor is
6 respectively and thickness are 0.4mm, 0.6mm a. 1/2QC
and 0.12 mm respectively. Find the combined b. 1/QC
capacitance. c. Q2/2C
a. 0.000295 x 10-6 F d. Q/2C
b. 0.00295 x 10-6 F ans: c
c. 0.0295 x 10-6 F
d. 0. 295 x 10-6 F 74.What capacitance must be placed in series
ans: b with a 15µF capacitor to give a total capacitance
of 5µF
69. What is the unit of charge? a. 4µF
a. Volt-Amp b. 7.5µF
b. Henery c. 10µF
c. Farad d. 25µF
d. Coulomb ans: b
ans: d 75. One Coulomb charge equals the charge on
a. 6.42 x 10 18 electrons
70. What will be the capacitance of four b. 6.24 x 10 18 atoms
capacitors of equal capacitance ‘C’ when c 6.24 x 10 12electrons
connected in parallel d. none of these
Jo
a. 4C ans: a
in
b. C/4
@
d. C given as
P U
ans: a a. C = Є0 A / d
B
TE
b. C = Є0 d / A
71. A region around a stationary electric charge
C
H
has
-T
el
ans: a
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
Unit II
Part (b) AC FUNDAMENTALS
c.0.0005
in
@
a. Im/√2
U
d. Im/π a.254.6 V
H
-T
el
b.282.6 V a. 150 V
c.400 V b. 216.5 V
d.565.5 V c. 125 V
ans:a d.108.25 V
ans:b
11. The form factor of a sine wave is_____
a.1.01 16. An alternating current is given by the
𝜋
b.1.11 expression 𝑖 = 200 sin(314𝑡 + ) amperes.
3
c.1.21 The maximum value and frequency of the
d. none of the above current are_________
ans:b a. 200 A, 50 Hz
b. 100√2, 50 Hz
12. A current is said to be alternating when it c. 200 A, 100 Hz
changes in_______ d. 200 A, 25 Hz
a. magnitude only ans:a
b. direction only
c. both magnitude and direction 17.The average value of the current 𝑖 =
d. neither magnitude nor direction 𝜋
200 sin 𝑡 from 𝑡 = 0 to 𝑡 = is ______
2
ans:c
a. 400 π
400
13. An alternating current of 50 Hz frequency b. 𝜋
1
and 100 A maximum value is given by______ c.400
a.𝑖 = 200 𝑠𝑖𝑛628𝑡 𝜋
d.400
b.𝑖 = 100 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
ans:b
c.𝑖 = 100√2 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
d.𝑖 = 100√2 𝑠𝑖𝑛157𝑡 18. When two quantities are in quadrature, the
ans:b phase angles between them will be________
a.45°
14. An alternating current of 50 Hz frequency b.90°
has a maximum value of 100 A. Its value 1/600 c.135°
second after the instant current is zero will d.60°
be________ ans:b
a. 25 A
b. 12.5 A 19.The alternating voltage 𝑒 = 200 sin 314𝑡 is
Jo
ans:c
SP
b.3.18 A
H
-T
el
b.25 Hz
second time is_________
in
c.100 Hz
a. 0.05 second
@
d.75 Hz
SP
b. 0.1 second
ans:b
P
c. 0.025 second
U
d. 0.02 second
B
ans:c
10 sin 314𝑡. The time taken to generate two
C
H
200 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. Its rms value will be_____ d. B-wave and A-wave are in phase
P U
a. 100 V ans:a
B
b. 282.8 V
TE
c. 141.4 V
C
H
d. 121.4 V
-T
el
40.The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 45.The average value of sin2θ over a complete
10 A. Its peak value is_________ cycle is_________
a. 7.07 A a. +1
b. 14.14 A b. -1
1
c. 10 A c. 2
d. 28.28 A d. zero
ans:b ans:c
41. If A=10∠45° and B=5∠15°, then the value of 46.The average value of sinθ over a complete
A/B will be_________ cycle is_________
a. 50∠60° a. zero
b. 2∠60° b. +1
c. 2∠-30° c. -1
d. 2∠30° 1
d.
2
ans:d
Jo
ans:a
in
a.90°
B
a. I2m/2
TE
b.180°
b. Im/π
C
c.270°
c. 2Im/π
H
-T
el
52. Out of the following _________wave is the c. average value to rms value
in
a. sinusoidal ans:b
SP
b. square
P U
b. 30 Hz a. mean value
c. 40 Hz b. rms value
d. 50 HZ c. peak value
ans:d d. average value
ans:b
59. An ac current is given by 𝑖 = 200 𝑠𝑖𝑛100𝜋𝑡.
It will achieve a value of 100A 64. The rms value and mean value is the same
after_____second. in the case of_______
1 a. traingular wave
a.900
1 b. sine wave
b.
800 c. square wave
1
c. d. half wave rectified sine wave
700
1 ans:c
d.600
ans:d
65. For the same peak value which of the
following wave will have the highest rms value?
60. A heater is rated as 230V, 10KW, AC. The
a.square wave
value of 230V refers to___________
b.half wave rectified sine wave
a. average voltage
c.triangular wave
b. rms voltage
d.sine wave
c. peak voltage
ans:a
d. none of the above
ans:b
66. For the same peak value which of the
following wave will have the least mean value?
61. The peak value of a sine wave is 200V. Its
a. half wave rectified sine wave
average value is_______
b. triangular wave
a.127.4V
c. sine wave
b.141.4V
d. square wave
c.282.8V
ans:a
d.200V
ans:a
67. For a sine wave with peak value Imax, the rms
value is_______
62. The rms value of a sine wave is 100A. Its
a. 0.5Imax
peak value is _______
b. 0.707Imax
a.70.7A
Jo
c. 0.9Imax
b.141.4A
in
d. 1.414Imax
c.150A
@
ans:b
SP
d.282.8A
ans:b
P U
figure represents________
H
68. For a sine wave with peak value Emax, the 73. A sine wave of voltage varies from zero to
average value is______ maximum of 200V. How much is the voltage at
a. 0.636 Emax the instant of 30° of the cycle?
b. 0.707Emax a.50V
c. 0.434 Emax b.82.8V
d. 1.414Emax c.100V
ans:a d.173.2V
ans:c
69. The current in a circuit is given by: 𝑖 =
100 sin 314𝑡 amperes. The maximum value and 74. How much rms current does a 300W, 200V
frequency of current are_________ bulb take from the 200V, 50 Hz power line?
a.50√2 A, 100 Hz a.0.5 A
b.100√2 A, 100 Hz b.1.5 A
c. 100 A, 50 Hz c.2 A
d. 70.7 A, 50 Hz d. 3 A
ans:c ans:b
70. For a frequency of 200 Hz, the time period 75. The rms value of a half-wave rectified
will be_________ current is 100 A. Its value for full-wave
a. 0.05 S rectification would be_________amperes.
b. 0.005 S a.141.4
c. 0.0005 S b.200
d. 0.5 S c. 200/π
ans:b d. 40/π
ans:a
71. An ac voltage of 50 Hz has a maximum value
of 50 V. Its value after 1/600 second after the 76. The rms value of a sinusoidal ac current is
instant the current is zero will be_________ equal to its value at an angle of ______degrees.
a.5V a.90
b.12.5V b.60
c.25V c.45
Jo
d.43.8V d.30
in
ans:c ans:c
@
SP
72. For 200V rms value triangular wave, the 77. The rms value of alternating current is given
P U
peak voltage will be______ by steady (dc) current which when flowing
B
b.222V produces________
C
H
c.282V
-T
el
d. triangular wave
b. 0.707 of peak value
in
ans:c
c. same as peak value
@
SP
d. zero
81.The frequency of domestic power supply in
ans:b
P U
India is_____
B
a. 200 Hz
TE
b. 100 Hz
C
H
c. 60 Hz
-T
el
86. An alternating voltage is given in volts by supplied 500 W output (i.e. no losses) at the
expression 𝑣 = 326 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. Its rms value and new voltage it will supply_________
frequency are____ a. 2500 W
a.230V,50 Hz b. 2000 W
b. 230V,100 Hz c. 500 W
c. 326V,50 Hz d. 250 W
d. 326V,100 Hz ans:b
ans:a
91. The direction of current in an ac
87. According to which of the alternating circuit________
current values in the cross sectional area of a a. is from positive to negative
conductor with regard to the heating effect is b. is always in one direction
selected? c. varies from instant to instant
a. peak value d. can not be determined
b. half peak value ans:c
c. average value
d. rms value 92. The angular frequency of an alternating
ans:d quantity is a mathematical quantity obtained by
multiplying the frequency “f” of the alternating
88. The frequency of an alternating current quantity by a factor_________
𝜋
is________ a.
2
a. the speed with which the alternator runs b.π
b. the number of cycles generated in one c.2π
minute d.4π
c. the number of waves passing through a point ans:c
in one second
d. the number of electrons passing through a 93. The average value of an unsymmetrical
point in one second alternating quantity is calculated over
ans:c the_________
a. whole cycle
89. The equation of 50 Hz current sine wave b. half cycle
having rms value of 60 A is______ c. unsymmetrical part of the waveform
a.60 sin 25𝑡 d. first two cycles
b.60 sin 50𝑡 ans:a
Jo
c.84.84 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
in
ans:c 𝜋
from θ=0 to θ=2 is_______
SP
P
a.40π
U
1
220 V supply. Assuming that at 110 V, it c.
C
40
H
-T
el
𝜋
d.40 b. 10 A, 17.07 A
ans:b c. 10 A, 12.25 A
d. 16.36 A, 12.2 A
95. A constant current of 2.8A exists in a ans:c
resistor. The rms value of current is______
a. 2.8 A 100. The size (cross-sectional area) of a
b. about 2 A conductor, with regard to the heating effect, is
c. 1.4 A determined on the basis of ……….. value of
d. undefined current to be carried by it
ans:a a. average value
b. peak value
96. An alternating current is represented as 𝑖 = c. rms value
𝜋 d. peak to peak value
70.7 sin(520𝑡 + 6 ) . The frequency and rms
ans:c
value of the current are_________
a. 82.76 Hz, 50 A
101. The form factor for dc supply voltage is
b. 41.38 Hz, 25 A
always
c. 41.38 Hz, 50 A
a. zero
d. 82.76 Hz, 25 A
b. unity
ans:a
c. infinity
d. any value between 0 and 1
97. The time period or periodic time T of an
ans:b
alternating quantity is the time taken in seconds
to complete_____________
102. The ________ varying alternating quantity
a. one cycle
can be represented as phasor.
b. alternation
a) circular
c. none of the above
b) sinusoidally
d. Half cycle
c) rectangular
ans: a
d) triagular
ans:b
98. The time period of an alternating quantity is
0.02 second. Its frequency will be________
103. The phasors are assumed to be rotated in
a. 25 Hz
_________ direction.
b. 50 Hz
a) clockwise
c. 100 Hz
Jo
b) anticlockwise
d. 0.02 Hz
in
c) circular
@
ans: b
d) all above
SP
ans:b
P
are____
represented by their _______ values
C
a. 16.36 A, 17.07 A
H
a. rms
-T
el
b. average
c. rectangular
d. polar
ans:a
ans:d difference.
in
a. time
@
c. Lengths
P
d. both a and b
U
B
ans:b
TE
C
H
-T
el
112. The difference between the phase of two 117. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt-Φ), the
alternating quantities is called the________. ‘v’ is said to _______ ‘i’ by angle Φ
a. phase difference a. in phase
b. sine difference b. lagging
c. length difference c. leading
d. none of the above d. all above
ans:a ans:c
113. When phase difference between the two 118. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ), the
alternating quantities is zero, the two quantities ‘i’ is said to _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ
are said to be in _____ a. in phase
a. tandom b. lagging
b. length c. leading
c. phase d. all above
d. time ans:c
ans:c
119. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ), the
114. When ____________ between the two ‘v’ is said to _______ ‘i’ by angle Φ
alternating quantities is zero, the two quantities a. in phase
are said to be in phase. b. lag
a. time difference c. lead
b. length difference d. all above
c. phase difference ans:b
d. none of the above
ans:c 120. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin ωt, the ‘i’ is
said to _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ
115. When phase difference between the two a. in phase
alternating quantities is _______, the two b. lag
quantities are said to be in phase. c. lead
a. one d. all above
b. unity ans:a
c. zero
d. π/2 121. With respect to reference, plus sign of
ans:c angle indicates _______
Jo
a. leading
in
b. lagging ans:a
B
c. leading
TE
126. The diagram in which different sinusoidal 131. Two currents I1 = 1050 and I2 = 5 -100 A
alternating quantities of the same _____, are flow in single phase AC circuit. Then I1+I2 =
Jo
diagram. b. 5.55964.924 A
SP
c. sign ans:a
TE
d. shape
C
H
ans:b
-T
el
ans:d
B
a. -24+j14
C
H
-T
el
142.When a phasor is multiplied by j and –j, it is 147. In the complex number 4+j7, 7 is called the
rotated through ______ degrees in the ______ component
anticlockwise direction respectively. a. real
a.90, 270 b. imaginary
b.90, 90 c. in-phase
c.90, 180 d. none of the above`
d.270, 90 ans:d
ans:a
148. The reciprocal of a complex number is
143. If e1 = 100 sin2πf and e2 = 100 sin(2πf-Φ), a_____
then _____ a. complex number
a. e1 lags e2 by Φ b. real component only
b. e1 leads e2 by Φ c. quadrature component only
c. e2 lags e1 by Φ d. none of above
d. none of the above ans:a
ans:c
149. If two complex numbers are equal,
144.The phase difference between two then_____
waveforms can be compared when they _____ a. only their magnitudes will be equal
a. have the same frequency b. only their angles will be equal
b. have the same peak value c. their in phase and quadrature components
c. have the same effective value will be separately equal
d. are sinusoidal d.none of above
ans:a ans:c
145. If two sinusoids of the same frequency but 150. A phasor 2∟180 can be expressed as____
of different amplitude and phase difference are a.j2
added, the resultant is a ______ b.-j2
a. sinusoid of same frequency c.-2
b. sinusoid of double the original frequency d.2
c. sinusoid of half the original frequency ans:c
d. non-sinusoid
ans:a 151. A current of (3+j4) A is flowing through a
circuit. The magnitude of current is _____
Jo
ans:b
TE
a. 100∟-60 b.50
b.100∟240 c.60
c. 100∟-300 d.105
d. none of the above ans:d
ans:c
158. A phasor is _____
153. The conjugate of -4+j3 is _____ a. a line which represents the magnitude and
a. 4-j3 phase of an alternating quantity
b. -4-j3 b. a line which represents the magnitude and
c.4+j3 direction of an alternating quantity
d. none of the above c. a colored tag or band for distinction between
ans:b different phases of a 3 phase supply
d. an instrument used for measuring phases of
154. The difference of two conjugate number an unbalanced 3 phase load
results in _____ ans:b
a. a complex number
b. in-phase component only 159. A sinusoidal voltage v1 leads another
c. quadrature component only sinusoidal voltagev2 by 180 degrees. Then ____
d. none of the above a. voltage v2 leads voltage v1 by 180 degrees
ans:c b. both voltage have their zero values at the
same time
155. The reciprocal of j is ____ c. both voltage have their peak values at the
a.j same time
b.-j d. all of above
c.jxj ans:d
d.none of the above
ans:b 160. If A = 10∟45 and B = 5∟15, then the
value of A/B will be___
156. Two waves of same frequency have a.50∟60
opposite phase when the phase angle between b.2∟60
them is ___ degrees c. 2∟-30
a.360 d.2∟30
b.180 ans:d
c.90
Jo
alternating quantity
SP
a.15 ans:a
-T
el
Unit IV
Part (a): POLYPHASE A.C. CIRCUITS
1 Three phase star connected balanced c. Three times the corresponding line
system the magnitude of line current voltage
is equal to d. 1.73 times phase voltage
a. One-third the phase current ans: b
b. Equal to the corresponding phase
current 5 In a balanced three-phase load, each
c. Three times the corresponding phase phase has
current a. An equal amount of power
d. Zero b. One-third of total power
c. Two-thirds of total power
ans: b d. A power consumption equal to
√3VL IL
2 Three phase star connected balanced
system the magnitude of line voltage ans: a
is equal to
a. One-third the line voltage 6 In a three-phase system, the voltages
b. Equal to the corresponding line are separated by
voltage a. 450
c. Three times the corresponding line b. 900
voltage c. 1200
d. 1.73 times phase voltage d. 1800
ans: d ans: c
frame size.
@
is equal to
U
ans: d
B
voltage
H
b. 138.56 Amp
in
ans: d c.
@
50 Amp
SP
d. 150 Amp
P
Ans: a
TE
the circuit is
C
(4 + j 3) Ohm/phase is connected to a
3 phase 400 V supply. Calculate Line 18 A balanced star-connected load of 5
current 36.860 Ohm per phase is connected
a. 80 Amp to a 3-phase, 400 V supply. Calculate
b. 138.56 Amp power factor
c. 50 Amp a. 0.6 lagging
d. 150 Amp b. 0.6 leading
c. 0.8 lagging
ans: b d. 0.8 leading
c. 7.698 600
to a 3-phase, 400 V supply. Calculate
in
Line current
d. 7.698 300
@
a. ans: d
SP
46.182 Amp
b.
P
9.98 Amp
U
c.
B
30 Amp
TE
d. 100 Amp
C
ans: a
H
-T
el
c. Tertiary
in
ans:a of__________
SP
a. Frequency
P U
11. Electrical power is transformed from one 16. The concentric cylindrical winding is used
coil to other coil in transformer_________ for__________
a. Physically a. Core type transformer
b. Electrically b. Shell type transformer
c. Magnetically c. Berry type transformer
d. Electromagnetically d. None of these
ans:d ans:a
ans:b
C
H
-T
el
20. The main function of transformer iron core 25. A transformer in which the primary voltage
is to__________ is more than the secondary voltage is called a
a. Provide strength to the winding _____ transformer.
b. To decrease hysteresis loss a. step-down
c. Decrease the reluctance of magnetic path b. step-up
d. Reduce eddy current loss c. Isolation
ans:c d. Auto
ans:a
21. The emf induced in the primary of a
transformer___________ 26. Any transformer flux that does not follow
a. is in phase with the flux the core and escapes into the surrounding air is
b. lags behind the flux by 90 degree called____
c. leads the flux by 90 degree a. magnetizing flux
d. is in phase opposition to that of flux b. coupling flux
ans:b c. leakage flux
d. reactance flux
22.The transformer turns ratio ans:c
determines_____________
a. the ratio of primary and secondary voltages 27. A transformer that does not isolate the
b. the ratio of primary and secondary currents output from the input is called _____
c. The resistance on other side transformer
d. all of the above a. Distribution
ans:a b. step-up
c. Auto
23. Turns ratio of single phase transformer is d. Control
given as__________ ans:c
a. N2/N1
b. N1/N2 28. Ideal transformer assumptions do not
c. (N1xN2)/N1 include____________
d. (N1xN2)/N2 a. Zero reactance of the winding
ans:b b. Zero resistance of the winding
c. No leakage flux
24. A transformer in which the secondary d. No saturation of the core
voltage is more than the primary voltage is ans:a
Jo
c. Isolation a. 50 to 70%
P U
d. Auto b. 60 to 75 %
B
ans:b c. 80 to 90 %
TE
d. 90 to 98%
C
H
ans:d
-T
el
c. No magnetic path
B
a. Greater than 1
-T
el
b.1 c. 9 to 12%
c. Less than 1 d. 12 to 20%
d.0 ans:a
ans:c
46. Transformer oil is used in transformer to
41. The primary and secondary voltages in provide_______
transformer are___________ a. Cooling and insulation
a. Always in Phase b. Cooling and lubrication
b. 1800 out of phase c. Insulation and lubrication
c. 900 out of phase d. Insulation, cooling and lubrication
d. 300 or 600 out of phase ans:a
ans:b
47. What is the typical use of
42. The induced emf in transformer secondary autotransformer____________?
depends on__________ a. Toy transformer
a. Maximum flux in core b. Control transformer
b. Frequency c. Variable transformer
c. No of turns on secondary d. Isolating transformer
d. all of the above ans:c
ans:d
48. In any transformer the voltage per turn in
43. Transformer rating usually expressed primary and secondary remains____________
in____________ a. Always different
a.kW b. Always the same
b.kVA c. Always in ratio of K
c. kV d. Sometimes same
d. kWh ans:b
ans:b
49. Full load copper loss in a transformer is 400
44. In a transformer if secondary turns are Watt. At half load, copper losses will
doubled, at the same time primary voltage is be___________
reduced by half, the secondary voltage a. 400 Watt
will_________ b. 100 Watt
a. Be halved c. 200 Watt
Jo
45. The no load current in terms of full load copper loss will__________
B
a. 1 to 3% b. 350 W
C
H
b. 3 to 9 % c. 250 W
-T
el
d. 500 W
ans:d 𝑉2𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
d. 𝑉 𝐼
1 1 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅+𝑖𝑟𝑜𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠+𝑐𝑜𝑝𝑝𝑒𝑟 𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑠
ans:a
51. If we increase the flux density in case
transformer_______________
55. For 100 kVA, 11000V/110V single phase
a. The size of transformer will reduce
transformer, the primary full load current
b. The distortion in transformer will reduce
is____________
c. Hysteresis and eddy current losses will reduce
a. 909.09 Amp
d. None of these will be true
b. 90.90 Amp
ans:a
c. 9.09 Amp
d. 9090.9 Amp
52. The direct loading test is performed on
ans:c
transformer to find its____________
a. Regulation
56. For 100 kVA, 11000V/110V single phase
b. Efficiency
transformer, the secondary full load current
c. Both
is________
d. None of these
a. 90.90 Amp
ans:c
b. 9090.9 Amp
c. 909.0 Amp
53. The regulation of transformer is calculated
d. 9.09 Amp
as_________
ans:c
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
a. 57. The disadvantage of auto transformer
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
is______________
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 a. No separation between primary & secondary
b. 𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
b. Size is more than normal transformer for
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 same rating
c.
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 c. More costlier than normal transformer
d. All
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
d. ans:d
𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
ans:a
58. In a transformer the voltage regulation will
54. The efficiency of single phase transformer is be near to zero when it operates
at____________
Jo
calculated as_____________
a. unity p.f.
in
𝑉2𝐼2 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
a.
b. leading p.f.
@
c. lagging p.f.
𝑉1𝐼1 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
P
b. 𝑉 𝐼 d. full load.
U
𝑉1𝐼1 𝐶𝑜𝑠∅
c.
C
59. A transformer steps up voltage by a factor 64. Hysteresis loss in transformer depends
of 100. The ratio of current in the primary to on__________
that in secondary_______________ a. both voltage and frequency
a.1 b. voltage alone
b.100 c. frequency alone
c.0.01 d. none of these
d.0.1 ans:a
ans:b
65. Eddy current loss depends
60. An ideal transformer does not on_____________
change______________ a. both current and frequency
a. Voltage b. current alone
b. Power c. frequency alone
c. current d. none of these
d. None of these ans:a
ans:b
66.The flux involved in EMF equation of a
61. The flux in transformer core____________ transformer has______________
a. increases with load a. RMS Value
b. decreases with load b. Average Value
c. remains constant irrespective of load c. Total Value
d. none of these d. maximum Value
ans:c ans:d
63. If the supply frequency in transformer is 68. If primary of the transformer is connected
Jo
ans:a ans:d
TE
C
H
-T
el
ans:c constant
P U
73. Which winding of a transformer has more d. primary and secondary voltage remains
TE
ans:b
SP
b. Auto transformer
P U
c. Step up transformer 96. Low voltage windings are placed next to the
B
c. 0.8 lag the full load is 4900W. Then its full load copper
in
ans:b a.5600
SP
b.6400
P U
is______ ans:b
C
H
a. second
-T
el
106. At relatively light loads, the transformer 110. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase
efficiency is low because__________ transformer has to be worked at a maximum
a. secondary output is low flux density of 1.1 web/m2 in the core. The
b. transformer losses are high effective cross sectional area of the core is 145
c. fixed loss is high in proportion to the output
cm2. The no of secondary turns___
d. copper loss is small.
a.71 turns
ans:c
b.75 turns
c.932 turns
107.A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase
d.923 turns
transformer is built on a core having an
ans:a
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 60
turns on the secondary winding. The value of
111. A 80 kVA, 6000 V/ 400 V, 50 Hz single
maximum flux density___
phase transformer has 80 turns on the
a.1.25 Tesla
secondary winding. The value of maximum flux
b.1.52 Tesla
in the core________
c.1.3 Tesla
a.25.22mwb
d.none of the above
b.22.52mwb
ans:a
c.52.22mwb
d. none of these
108. A 3000 V/200 V, 50 Hz, single phase
ans:b
transformer is built on a core having an
effective cross sectional area of 120 cm2 and 60 112. A 6600 V/220 V, 50 Hz, step down single
turns on the secondary winding. The number of phase transformer has 1500 turns on its
turns on the high voltage winding________ primary side. If its maximum flux density is 1.2
a. 600 turns Tesla, then the effective cross sectional area of
b. 900 turns core is _____
c. 300 turns a.16.516 10–3 m2
d. 450 turns b.61.516 10–3 m2
ans:b
c.26.516 10–3 m2
d.62.516 10–3 m2
109. A 3300 V/250 V, 50 Hz, single phase
ans:a
transformer has to be worked at a maximum
flux density of 1.1 wb/m2 in the core. The 113. A 10 kVA, 3300/240 V, single phase, 50 Hz
effective cross sectional area of the core is 145
Jo
cm2. The no of primary turns___ flux density is 1.3 tesla. The primary full load
@
ans:a
H
-T
el
UNIT I
ELECTROMAGNETISM
1. The complete path followed by the magnetic 6. Lines of force is also called
flux is called a. flux
a. electric circuit b. current
b. magnetic circuit c. resistance
c. electromagnetism d. flux density
d. electric field ans:a
ans: b
7. Lines of force passing per unit area is called
2. Current carrying conductor is always a. magnetic field
surrounded by b. magnetic flux
a. magnetic field c. magnetic flux density
b. electric field d. magnetic field strength
c. Electricity ans:c
d. current
ans: a 8. unit of flux is
a. weber
3. The direction of magnetic field produced by b. wb/m2
current carrying conductor is given by c. Tesla
a. Lenz’s law d. AT
b. right hand thumb rule ans:a
c. Fleming’s left hand rule
d. Kirchoff’s law 9. Unit of flux density is
ans: b a. wb/m2
b. wb
4. Imaginary lines of force originating from c. AT/wb
magnet is called d. A
a. current ans:a
b. resistance
c. flux 10. Unit of magnetic field
d. magnetic field a. wb/m2
ans: c b. wb
Jo
c. AT/wb
in
b. magnetic field
P U
d. resistance a. AT/wb
ans: b b. AT
C
H
-T
el
12. Opposition to the magnetic lines of force is 17. An air gap is usually inserted in a magnetic
called circuit
a. Flux a. to prevent saturation
b. resistance b. increase flux
c. susceptance c. decrease flux
d. reluctance d. increase mmf
ans:d ans: a
13. Unit of magnetic field strength is 18. A magnetic circuit requires 800 ampere
a. AT/m turns to produce a certain amount of flux. If
b. AT/wb exciting coil of 100 turns has 5 ohms resistance,
c.Tesla then the voltage to be applied to the exciting
d. ohms coil must be
ans: a a. 40V
b. 20 V
14. The force on two current carrying c.10V
conductors in the same direction d. 5V
a. have force of repulsion between them ans: a
b. have force of attraction between them
c. remains unaffected 19. Permeability of a material is the ratio of
d. none of above a. magnetic field to flux density
ans: b b. flux density to magnetic field strength
c. magnetic field strength to flux density
15. Magneto motive force is directly d. none of above
proportional to ans: b
a. no. of turns of coil
b. current through the coil 20. The term saturation related to magnetic
c. both a and b circuit means
d. none of above a. magnetic field strength increases with
ans: c current
Jo
16. The term permeability for a material means c. flux density remains constant if magnetic
@
b. the mmf required to produce one unit of d. magnetic field strength remains constant if
P U
through it
C
H
-T
el
21. The lines of force produced by coil b. does not vary with increasing the cross
completing their path through air, instead of sectional area
intended path is called c. decreases with increasing cross sectional area
a. useful flux of material
b. saturated flux d. decreases with increasing the length of
c. air flux material
d. leakage flux ans: c
ans: d
27. The correct relation stated as following is
22. The bulging of lines of force in air gap in a 𝑁
a. ф =𝑙/𝑎µ0µ𝑟
magnetic circuit is called
b. NI = B× l/a µ0µr
a. leaking flux
c. N=H×l
b. merging
d. NI = ф × l/µ0µr a
c. fringing
ans: d
d. scattering
ans: c
28. The permeance in a magnetic circuit
corresponds to
23. Relative permeability of vacuum is
a. resistance in an electric circuit
a. 4π × 10-7 H/m
b. emf in an electric circuit
b. 1 H/m
c. conductivity in electric circuit
c.1
d. conductance in an electric circuit
d. ¼ H/m
ans: d
ans: c
c. conductivity
is 800 and ampere turns are 3200
in
ans: d
SP
b.2.5
P
c.4.0
U
ans:c
of material
C
H
-T
el
33.The force experienced by unit north pole 39. The magnitude of force experienced by
when placed at point in a magnetic field is current carrying conductor placed in magnetic
called field depends on
a. magnetic field strength at that point a. value of flux
b. exerted force at that point b. magnitude of current flowing through
c.flux conductor
d. magnetic field c. direction of current
ans:a d. all of above
ans: d
34. The mechanical force acting on current
carrying on conductor when placed in magnetic 40.Two current carrying conductor lying parallel
field is given by relation and close to each other. They are carrying
a. F= N dф/dt current in the opposite direction. The force
b. F= Blv sinӨ between them is
c. F= BIL sinӨ a. repulsive
d. F=L di/dt b. Attractive
ans: c c. Zero
d. none of these
35. Which of the following has the highest ans: a
magnetic permeability?
Jo
ans: c a. repulsive
B
b. Attractive
TE
d. H=NI/l ans: b
P U
ans: c
B
54. Right hand thumb rule is used to find out of solenoid must be
B
d. 0
in
67
SP
A coil is wound uniformly with 300 turns over 70. Which of the following is non magnetic
P U
d. Silicon steel
ans: c 76. A strength of an electromagnet is
determined by
71. Which of the following is magnetic material? a. reluctance
a. copper b. permeability of the core
b. silicon steel c.mmf
c. aluminium d. all of above
d. brass ans: d
ans: b
77. The strength of the magnetic field around a
72. Flux in the air gap is called conductor is directly proportional to
a. leakage flux a. voltage across the conductor
b. total flux b. current in the conductor
c. useful flux c. type of material of conductor
d. all of above d. none of above
ans: c ans: b
73. A magnetic circuit has a mmf of 400AT and a 78. Reluctance of magnetic material is
reluctance of 2 × 105 AT/wb. The magnetic flux a. less than non magnetic material
in the magnetic circuit is b. more than non magnetic material
a. 3 × 10-5Wb c. equal to that of non magnetic material
b.2 × 10-3Wb d. none of above
c.1.5 × 10-2Wb ans: a
d. 2.5 × 10-4Wb
ans: b 79. The denser the flux
a. stronger is the magnetic field
74. A 2cm long coil has 10 turns and carries a b. weaker is the magnetic flux
current of 750mA. The magnetizing force of the c. no effect on the strength of field
coil is d. none of above
a. 225 AT/m ans: a
b. 675 AT/m
c.450 AT/m 80. The direction of induced e.m.f. is given by
d. 375 AT/m a. Flemings right hand rule
ans: d b. Flemings left hand rule
Jo
with ans:a
SP
a. length × area
P
U
c. area/length depend on
TE
82. According to Lenz’s law direction of induced 86. In which of the following situations a
e.m.f. is. voltage is induced in a conductor?
a. Same as cause produced a. The conductor moves through the air.
b. Perpendicular to cause produced b. The conductor is connected to a battery.
c. opposite to cause produced c. The conductor is connected to a motor.
d. Non above d. The conductor is moved in a magnetic field.
ans:c ans:d
magnetic field.
SP
b. The plane of the loop is perpendicular to the 92. Co-efficient of self induction is also called
P U
c. Self- inductance
-T
el
d. Induction c. Henry
ans:a d. Linkages
ans:c
93. The property of a coil due to which it
opposes the change of current flowing through 98. Unit of induced emf is_________
itself is called_____ of the coil. a. Volt
a. Static inductance b. Ampere
b. Dynamic inductance c. Henry
c.Self inductance d. Linkages
d. Mutual inductance ans:a
ans:c
99. The property of one coil due to which it
94. ____________is used to sense the flow of opposes the change in the other coil is
current in a electric circuit. called…………. between two coils.
a. Ammeter a. Dynamic inductance
b. Voltmeter b. Static inductance
c. Wattmeter c. Self inductance
d. Galvanometer d. Mutual inductance
ans:a ans:d
95. The phenomenon of the self induction is felt 100. The unit of mutual inductance
only when the current in the coil is is_________
a. Changing a. Volt
b. Increasing b. Ampere/ Volt
c. Decreasing c. Henry
d. All the above d. Linkages
ans:a ans:c
c. electric
in
d. Magnetic
102. If 0.75 V is induced emf and resistance
@
ans:d
SP
circuit is______
TE
b. 3. 75 mA
a. Volt
C
c. 3.75μA
H
b. Ampere
-T
el
d. 37.5 mA a. MMF
ans:b b. EMF
c. Flux linkage
103. If magnetic flux changes from 0.8 Wb to d. Magnetic intensity
0.3 Wb, then change in flux is______ Wb. ans:a
a. 1.1
b. 0.5 109. Expression NI/L is called
c. -0.5 a. MMF
d. -1.1 b. EMF
ans:c c. Flux linkage
d. Magnetic field strength
104. If Number of turns of coil is 200 and if the ans:d
current is 100mA, then MMF is ________
a. 2000 AT 110. Expression for mutual inductance is
b. 200 AT a. –L dI/dt
c. 20 AT b. MdI / dt
d. 0.5 AT c. N2 Ф2/ I1
ans:c d. NФ/I
ans:c
105. Leakage factor is also called as
a. Fringing 111. Faraday’s law of electromagnetic induction
b. Coefficient of inductance is e=
c. Magnetic coefficient a. –NdФ/dt
d. Hopkinson’s coefficient b. MdI / dt
ans:d c. N2 Ф2 / I1
d. NФ/I
106. Movement of electrons are called as ans:a
a. MMF
b. Current 112. The constant K in case of mutual induction
c. Voltage is equal to
d. Flux a.Ф1/Ф2
ans:b b.Ф2/Ф1
c.Ф1/I1
107. Flux density is equal to ________ of flux d.Ф2/I1
Jo
a. Sum
@
115. __________is normally termed as flux 120. Two conductors are lying parallel and close
linkages. to each other. They are carrying currents in
a. Ф opposite directions. The force between them is.
b. dФ/dt a. Repulsive
c. NФ b. attractive
d.Ф/I c. zero
ans:c d. none of these
ans:a
116. The term NФ/I is generally called as______
a. Self inductance 121. When a coil consisting of single turn
b. Mutual inductance rotates at uniform speed in magnetic field, the
c. Flux linkage induced emf is____
d. Induced emf a. steady
ans:a b. alternating
c. changing
117. In the expression for reluctance S = l/μA of d. reversing
a conduced, letter A represents_________ of ans:b
the conductor.
a. Total area 122. The emf induced in a conductor of length 1
b. Surface area meter moving at a right angles to a uniform
c. Cross- sectional area magnetic field of flux density 1.5 wb/m2 with
d. None of these. velocity of 50 m/s is.
ans:c a. 0
b.1.5 v
118. When a current carrying conductor is c. 75 v
Jo
a. direction of current.
SP
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
Unit III
Part (a) :SINGLE PHASE TRANSFORMER
ans:b
14.The material used for construction of
9.Transformer is used to change values transformer core should have___________
of__________ a. Low permeability & high hysteresis loss
a.Frequency b. Low permeability & low hysteresis loss
b.Voltage c. High permeability & high hysteresis loss
c.Power d. high permeability & low hysteresis loss
d.Power factor ans:d
ans:b
15. Most transformer cores are not made from a
10.The path of the magnetic flux in transformer solid piece of metal. Instead, they are assembled
should have __________ from many thin sheets of metal. This type of
a.Low resistance construction is called__________
b.Low reluctance a. Laminated
c.High reluctance b. Toroid
d.High conductivity c. H core
ans:b d. tape wound
ans:a
11. Electrical power is transformed from one coil
to other coil in transformer_________ 16. The concentric cylindrical winding is used
a. Physically for__________
b. Electrically a. Core type transformer
c. Magnetically b.Shell type transformer
d. Electromagnetically c.Berry type transformer
ans:d d.None of these
ans:a
12. A transformer operates___________
a. Always at unity power factor 17.The sandwich type winding is used
b. At power factor depending on load for___________
c. Has its own power factor a.Core type transformer
d. At power factor below particular value b.Berry type transformer
ans: b c.Shell type transformer
d.None of these
Jo
in
made up from__________
SP
19.What is common in two windings of 24. A transformer in which the secondary voltage
transformer? is more than the primary voltage is called a
a.Electric current _____ transformer
b.Magnetic circuit a. step-down
c.Winding wire guage b. step-up
d.None of these c.Isolation
ans:b d. Auto
ans:b
20.The main function of transformer iron core is
to__________ 25. A transformer in which the primary voltage is
a.Provide strength to the winding more than the secondary voltage is called a
b.To decrease hysteresis loss _____ transformer.
c.Decrease the reluctance of magnetic path a. step-down
d.Reduce eddy current loss b. step-up
ans:c c.Isolation
d.Auto
21.The emf induced in the primary of a ans:a
transformer___________
a.is in phase with the flux 26.Any transformer flux that does not follow the
b.lags behind the flux by 90 degree core and escapes into the surrounding air is
c.leads the flux by 90 degree called____
d.is in phase opposition to that of flux a.magnetizing flux
ans:b b.coupling flux
c.leakage flux
22.The transformer turns ratio d.reactance flux
determines_____________ ans:c
a. the ratio of primary and secondary voltages
b. the ratio of primary and secondary currents 27.A transformer that does not isolate the
c. The resistance on other side output from the input is called _____
d. all of the above transformer
Jo
in
ans:a a.Distribution
@
b.step-up
SP
a. N2/N1 ans:c
B
TE
b. N1/N2
C
c. (N1xN2)/N1
H
-T
el
29.The efficiency of the transformer is normally 34.Single phase shell type transformer
is normally in the range of____________ has__________
a.50 to 70% a.One magnetic path
b.60 to 75 % b.Two magnetic paths
c.80 to 90 % c.No magnetic path
d.90 to 98% d.None of these
ans:d ans:b
a.Sulpher b.E1/E2
SP
b.Alkalies c.I2/I1
P
c.Moisture d.V1/V2
U
ans:c
C
H
-T
el
39.In step up transformer the transformation 44.In a transformer if secondary turns are
ratio (K) is_____________ doubled, at the same time primary voltage is
a.Greater than 1 reduced by half, the secondary voltage
b.1 will_________
c.Less than 1 a.Be halved
d.0 b.Not change
ans:a c.Be four times
d.Be reduced to quarter
40.In step down transformer the transformation ans:b
ratio (K) is__________ 45.The no load current in terms of full load
a.Greater than 1 current is usually________
b.1 a.1 to 3%
c.Less than 1 b.3 to 9 %
d.0 c.9 to 12%
ans:c d.12 to 20%
ans:a
41.The primary and secondary voltages in
transformer are___________ 46.Transformer oil is used in transformer to
a.Always in Phase provide_______
b.1800 out of phase a.Cooling and insulation
c.900 out of phase b.Cooling and lubrication
d.300 or 600 out of phase c.Insulation and lubrication
ans:b d.Insulation, cooling and lubrication
ans:a
42.The induced emf in transformer secondary
Jo
in
ans:c
H
-T
el
ans:c
48.In any transformer the voltage per turn in
primary and secondary remains____________ 53.The regulation of transformer is calculated
a.Always different as_________
b.Always the same
c.Always in ratio of K 𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
a. 𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
d.Sometimes same
ans:b 𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
b.
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
49.Full load copper loss in a transformer is 400
𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
Watt. At half load, copper losses will c. 𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
be___________
a.400 Watt 𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒−𝑁𝑜 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
d.
b.100 Watt 𝐹𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒
c.9.09 Amp
in
d.9090.9 Amp
@
a.Regulation
U
60.An ideal transformer does not 65.Eddy current loss depends on_____________
Jo
in
ans:b
C
H
-T
el
b.copper loss
P
70.The full load copper and iron loss of a c.hysteresis and eddy current loss
U
a.zero ans:b
C
b.10 ohm
H
-T
el
88. Part of the transformer which is most subject b.load power factor is often not known
P
93.Increase in secondary current of transformer 97.The relation between the primary and
brings about increase in primary current . This is secondary ampere turns of transformer ----------
possible because___________
a.primary and secondary windings are a.exactly equal
capacitively coupled. b.approximately equal
b.primary and secondary windings are c.primarymmf larger than secondary mmf
inductively coupled d. primary mmf smaller than secondary mmf
c.primary and secondary windings are ans:a
conductively coupled
d.none of these 98.Positive voltage regulation occurs in case of
ans:b transformer for______________
a.capacitive load
94.Transformer for constant voltage application b.resistive load only
is considered good if its voltage regulation c.inductive load only
is_________ d.either inductive or resistive load
a.low ans:d
b.high
c.zero 99.Cooling of the transformer is required so as
d.none of these to_____________
ans:c a.increase the efficiency
b.to reduce the losses
95.Transformer action needs that the magnetic c.to reduce humming
flux linking with the winding must d. to dissipate the heat generated in the winding
be_____________ ans:d
a.constant
b.pulsating 100.The transformer efficiency will be maximum
c.alternating at a power factor of ____________
d.none of these a.0.8pf lead
ans:c b.unity
c.0.8 lag
96. Low voltage windings are placed next to the d.0.5 lag or lead
core to reduce_____________ ans:b
a.Hysteresis loss
Jo
in
b.eddy current loss 101. The regulations of two transformers are (i)
@
c.insulation requirement 3% and (ii) 97%. The one with better regulation
SP
ans:c a.second
U
b.first
B
TE
d.depends on loading
H
-T
el
2
in
b.6400
2
cross sectional area of the core is 145 cm . The
SP
c.375
P
b.950 turns
C
c.932 turns
H
-T
el
111.A 80 kVA, 6000 V/ 400 V, 50 Hz single phase 115.A transformer is rated at 90 kVA, at full load
transformer has 80 turns on the secondary its copper losses is 1100 W and its iron losses is
winding. The value of maximum flux in the 950 W. The efficiency at 60% of full load for 0.8
core________ lagging power factor is___________
a.25.22mwb a.96.97%
b.22.52mwb b.96%
c.52.22mwb c.98%
d.none of these d.none of these
ans:b ans:a
112.A 6600 V/220 V, 50 Hz, step down single 116.A 500 kVA transformer has iron loss of 2 kW
phase transformer has 1500 turns on its primary and full load copper losses of 5 kW. The
side. If its maximum flux density is 1.2 Tesla, then efficiency at 75% of full load and unity power
the effective cross sectional areaof core is _____ factor__________
a.16.516 × 10–3 m2 a.98.13%
b.61.516 × 10–3 m2 b.98.73%
c.99%
c.26.516 × 10–3 m2
d.none of these
Jo
d.62.516 × 10–3 m2
in
ans:b
ans:a
@
SP
a.3.03 amp
-T
el
Unit III
Part (b) ELECTROSTATICS
be_________ c.150 V
SP
a.2.5 µF d.300 V
P U
b.40 µF ans:b
B
TE
c.0.4 µF
C
d.20 µF
H
-T
el
ans: c
@
ans: c
22. Which of the following expression is correct
18. When there is an equal amount of positive for electric field strength?
and negative charges on an object the object is a. E = D/𝝐
a. Positively charged b. E = D2/𝝐
b. negatively charged c. E = 𝝅D
c. neutral d. E = 𝝅D2
d. supercharged ans: a
ans:c
23. Which of the following statement is true?
19. Which of the following statements is correct? a. The current in the discharging capacitor grows
a. Air capacitors have a black band to indicate linearly
the outside foil b. The current in the discharging capacitor grows
b. Electrolytic capacitor must be connected in exponentially
the correct polarity c. The current in the discharging capacitor
c. Ceramic capacitors must be connected in the decays exponentially
correct polarity d. The current in the discharging capacitor
d. Mica capacitors are available in capacitance decreases constantly
value of 1 to 10 µF ans:c
ans: b
24. In a capacitor the electric charge is deposited
20. Three capacitors each of the capacity C are on
given. The resultant capacity 2/3 C can be a. metal plates
obtained by using them b. dielectric
a. all in series c. both (a) and (b)
b. all in parallel d. none of the above
c. two in parallel and third in series with this ans:a
combination
d. two in series and third in parallel across this 25. Which of the following materials has the
combination. highest value of dielectric constant?
ans:c a. Glass
b. Vaccum
21. For which of the following parameter c. Ceramics
Jo
in
ans: d
H
-T
el
28.A paper capacitor is usually available in the 33. The ratio of electric flux density to electric
form of field intensity is called ………. of the medium
a. tubes a. permeability
b. rolled foil b. permittivity
c. disc c. reluctance
d. meshed plates d. capacitance
ans:b ans:b
29. Air capacitors are generally available in the 34. Energy stored in the electrical field of a
range capacitor C when charged from a D.C, source of
a. 10 to 400 pF voltage V is equal to …….. Joule
b. 1 to 20 pF a. ½ CV2
c. 100 to 900 pF b. ½ C2V
d. 20 to 100 pF c. CV2
ans:a d. C2V
ans:a
30. The unit of capacitance is
a. Henry 35. The absolute permittivity of free space is
Jo
in
b. Ohm given by
a. 8.854 x 10-9 F/m
@
c. Farad
SP
36. The relative permittivity of free space is given 41. Which of the following capacitor are usually
by used for radio frequency tuning__________
a. 1 a. air
b. 10 b.paper
c. 100 c.mica
d. 1000 d.electrolyte
ans:a ans: b
37. When 4 Volt e.m.f. is applied across a 1 Farad 42. The time constant of an R-C circuit is defined
capacitor, it will store energy of as the time during which capacitor charging
a. 2 Joule voltage actually rises to ----------------percent of
b. 4 Joule its ---------- value
c. 6 Joule a.37, initial
d. 8 Joule b.63.2, initial
ans:d c.63.2, final
d.37, final
38. The capacitor preferred for high frequency ans: c
circuits is
a. air capacitor 43. The time constant of an R-C circuit is defined
b. mica capacitor as the time during which capacitor charging
c. electrolytic capacitor current actually falls to ----------------percent of its
d. paper capacitor initial maximum value
ans:b a.37
b.63
39.If a 6µF capacitor is charged to 200 V the c.42
charge in Coulomb will be_______________ d.73
a. 800 µC ans: a
b.900 µC
c.1200 µC 44. Permittivity is expressed in_______
d.1600 µC a.Farad/sq-m
ans:c b.weber/metre
c. Farad/meter
40. Which of the following capacitors is marked d. weber/ square metre
Jo
in
a. air
SP
c.mica on_________________
U
ans: d b.temperature
C
c.thickness
H
-T
el
46.1Volt /metre is same as 51. The most convenient way of achieving large
a. 1 metre/coulomb capacitance is by using
b. 1 Newton metre a. multiplate construction
c. 1 Newton /Coulomb b. decreased distance between plates
d. 1 Joule /Coulomb c. air as dielectric
ans: c d. dielectric of low permittivity
ans: a
47. The relative permittivity of air is__________
a.0 52. Two capacitors of capacitance C1 and C2 are
b.1.0006 connected in parallel. A charge Q given to them
c. 8.854 × 10−12 is shared. The ratio of charges Q1/Q2 is
d.none of the above a. C2/ C1
ans:b b. C1/ C2
c. C1 C2
48. The relative permittivity of a material is 10.Its d. 1/ C1 C2
absolute permittivity will be ans: b
a. 8.854 × 10−11 𝐹/𝑀
b. 9 × 108 𝐹/𝑀 53. Two capacitors have capacitance 25 µF when
c. 5 × 10−5 𝐹/𝑀 in parallel and 6 µF when in series. Their
d. 9 × 105 𝐹/𝑀 individual capacitances are
ans: a a. 12 µF and 13 µF
b. 15 µF and 10 µF
49. The capacitance of a capacitor is ……… c. 10 µF and 8 µF
relative permittivity d. none of the above
a. directly proportional to ans:b
b. inversely proportional to
c. independent of 54. If the dielectric of a capacitor is replaced by a
d. directly proportional to square of conducting material the
ans: a a. capacitor will get heated up owing to eddy
currents
Jo
in
50. An air capacitor has the same dimensions b. plates will get short-circuited
@
that of a mica capacitor. If the capacitance of c. capacitor can store infinite charge
SP
mica capacitor is 6 times that of air capacitor, d. capacitance will become very high
P
a. 36
TE
resistor is connected across a100 V d. c. supply. 63. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a
SP
Determine the initial rate of rise of voltage potential difference of 100V across its terminals.
P
c. - 0.00818A a. 8µC
d.- 1A b. 8mC
ans:a c. 8nC
d. 8pC
64. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a ans: a
potential difference of 100V across its terminals.
It is discharged through 1 K Ohm resistor. Find 68.A parallel plate capacitor has plate area of
initial rate of fall in voltage across capacitor. 2m2 spaced by three slabs of dielectric materials.
a. 10 4 V/s The relative permittivity’s are 2,3 and 6
b. -10 4 V/s respectively and thickness are 0.4mm, 0.6mm
c. -1 4 V/s and 0.12 mm respectively. Find the combined
d. 10A capacitance.
ans:b a. 0.000295 x 10-6 F
b. 0.00295 x 10-6 F
65. A fully charged capacitor of 10µF has a c. 0.0295 x 10-6 F
potential difference of 100V across its terminals. d. 0. 295 x 10-6 F
It is discharged through 1 K Ohm resistor. Find ans: b
time constant of the circuit.
a. 0.1sec 69. What is the unit of charge?
b. 1sec a. Volt-Amp
c. 0.01sec b.Henery
d. 0.001sec c. Farad
ans:c d. Coulomb
ans: d
66. A capacitor consists of two similar plates
each 10cm x 10cm mounted parallel and 70.What will be the capacitance of four
opposite to each other.What is the value of capacitors of equal capacitance ‘C’ when
capacitance when distance between them is 1cm connected in parallel
and dielectric used is air. a. 4C
a. 8.854 pF b. C/4
b. 8.854 µF c. 3C/4
c. 8.854 mF d. C
d. 8.854 F ans: a
Jo
in
ans: a
@
20000 V is applied then the total charge on the c. magnetic field andelectric field
C
ans: b
77.Two capacitors of 2 µF and 4 µF are
72. One Farad is the same as connected in parallel across 100 V D.C. supply.
a. One Coulomb/Volt Determine (i) Energy stored on each capacitor
b. One Joule/Coulomb a. 0. 1 J and 0. 2 J
c. One Joule/Volt b. 0.01 J and 0.02 J
d. One Coulomb /Joule c 1 J and 2 J
ans: a d. 0.001 J and 0.002 J
ans: b
73 . If Q be the charge and C be the capacitance
then the energy stored in the capacitor is 78.The capacitance composit capacitor is given
a. 1/2QC as
b. 1/QC a.C =
c. Q2/2C b.C = Є0 d / A
d. Q/2C c. C =
ans: c d.C = Єr A / d
ans: a
74.What capacitance must be placed in series
with a 15µF capacitor to give a total capacitance 79. The plate area of a parallel-plate capacitor is
of 5µF 0.01 sq. m. The distance between the plates is
a. 4µF 2.5 cm. The insulating medium is air. Find its
b. 7.5µF capacitance.
c. 10µF a 3.54 x 10-12 F
d. 25µF b. 35.4 x 10-12 F
ans: b c 3.54 x 10-10 F
75. One Coulomb charge equals the charge on d. 3.54 x 10-11 F
a. 6.42 x 10 18 electrons ans: a
b. 6.24 x 10 18 atoms
c 6.24 x 10 12electrons 80.The plate area of a parallel-plate capacitor is
d. none of these 0.01 sq. m. The distance between the plates is
ans: a 2.5 cm. What would be its capacitance, if the
space between the plates is filled with an
76. The capacitance of parallel plate capacitor is insulating material of relative permittivity 5?
Jo
a 177.1 x 10-12 F
in
given as
b. 1.771 x 10-12 F
@
a.C = Є0 A / d
SP
c . 17.71 x 10-10 F
b.C = Є0 d / A
P
d. 17.71 x 10-12 F
U
c. C = ans: d
B
TE
d.C = Єr A / d
ans: c
C
H
-T
el
Unit IV
Part (a) : AC Fundamentals
4.The distance occupied by one complete cycle
1.A standard sinusoidal voltage wave changes its of the wave is called its________
polarity at________ a.time period
a.maximum value b.wavelength
b.minimum value c.velocity
c.zero value d.frequency
d.none of the above ans:a
ans:c
5.The rms value of a sine wave of peak value Imis
2.The period of a certain sine wave is 10 given by_______
milliseconds. Its frequency is________ a.Im/√2
a.10 MHz b.Im
b.10 KHz c.Im/2
c.10 Hz d.Im/π
d.100 Hz
ans:d ans:a
3.Two sine waves are said to be in phase with 6.The average value of a sine wave of maximum
Jo
each other if they achieve their______ value Im over one cycle is_______
in
ans:d ans:c
TE
C
H
-T
el
7.The rms value of a sine wave of maximum 12.A current is said to be alternating when it
value 10A equals a dc current of ______ampere. changes in_______
a.7.07 a.magnitude only
b.6.37 b.direction only
c.5 c.both magnitude and direction
d.5.77 d.neither magnitude nor direction
ans:a ans:c
8.The rms value of a sinusoidal voltage with 13.An alternating current of 50 Hz frequency and
peak-to-peak value of 240 V is________V. 100 A maximum value is given by______
a.84.84 a.𝑖 = 200 𝑠𝑖𝑛628𝑡
b.77.82 b.𝑖 = 100 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
c.94.68 c.𝑖 = 100√2 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
d.89.15 d.𝑖 = 100√2𝑠𝑖𝑛157𝑡
ans:a ans:b
9.The time period of a sinusoidal waveform with 14.An alternating current of 50 Hz frequency has
200 Hz frequency is________second. a maximum value of 100 A. Its value 1/600
a.0.05 second after the instant current is zero will
b.0.005 be________
c.0.0005 a.25 A
d.0.5 b.12.5 A
ans:b c.50 A
d.75 A
10.The peak value of a sine wave is 400 V. Its ans:c
average value is_________
a.254.6 V 15.A sinusoidal voltage varies from zero to a
b.282.6 V maximum of 250 V. The voltage at the instant of
c.400 V 60° of the cycle will be________
d.565.5 V a.150 V
ans:a b.216.5 V
c.125 V
11.The form factor of a sine wave is_____
Jo
d.108.25 V
in
a.1.01 ans:b
@
b.1.11
SP
3
ans:b
B
current are_________
C
H
a.200 A, 50 Hz
-T
el
d.1.10 A
in
c.0.04 second
SP
because_______ ans:c
U
B
b.dc motors do not have fine speed control 25.A sine wave has a maximum value of 20 V. Its
C
a.10 V ans:c
b.14.14 V
c.15 V 31.An alternating current whose average value is
d.5 V 1 A will produce_________1 A dc under similar
ans:b conditions.
a.less heat than
26.An alternating voltage is given by 𝑣 = b.more heat than
30 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡 .The time taken by the voltage to c.the same heat as
reach 30 V for the first time is_____ d.none of the above
a.0.02 second ans:b
b.0.1 second
c.0.03 second 32.A sinusoidal alternating current has a
d.0.005 second maximum value of Im. Its average value will
ans:d be_______
𝐼𝑚
a. 𝜋
27.A sinusoidal current has a magnitude of 3 A at 𝐼𝑚
b.
120°. Its maximum value will be_____ 2𝜋
𝐼𝑚
a.√3 A c. 2 𝜋
√3
b. A d.none of the above
2
ans:c
c.2√3 A
d.6 A
33.The area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle
ans:c
is________
a.𝑚𝑎𝑥. 𝑣𝑎𝑙𝑢𝑒 ÷ 2
29.An alternating current is given by 𝑖 =
b.2 × 𝑚𝑎𝑥. 𝑣𝑎𝑙𝑢𝑒
10 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. Measuring time from 𝑡 = 0, the
c.𝑚𝑎𝑥. 𝑣𝑎𝑙𝑢𝑒 ÷ 𝜋
time taken by the current to reach +10 V for the
d. .𝑚𝑎𝑥. 𝑣𝑎𝑙𝑢𝑒 ÷ 2𝜋
second time is_________
ans:b
a.0.05 second
b.0.1 second
34.An alternating voltage is given by 𝑣 =
c.0.025 second
200 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡. Its rms value will be_____
d.0.02 second
a.100 V
ans:c
b.282.8 V
Jo
in
c.141.4 V
30.An alternating voltage is given by 𝑣 =
@
d.121.4 V
100 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡 volts. Its average value will
SP
ans:c
be________
P U
a.70.7 V
35.A sinusoidal voltage is represented as 𝑣 =
B
b.50 V
TE
𝜋
141.4 𝑠𝑖𝑛(314.18𝑡 − ). Its rms value of
c.63.7 V 2
C
H
d.100 V
-T
el
ans:a a.90°
@
b.180°
SP
ans:c
B
b.60Hz, 60°
-T
el
peakiest.
𝐼𝑚 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝜃. The average value of squared wave of
@
a.sinusoidal
this current over a complete cycle is________
SP
b.square
a. I2m/2
P
c.rectangualr
U
b.Im/π
B
d.triangular
TE
c.2Im/π
ans:d
C
d.2Im
H
-T
el
58.The form factor is the ratio of _________ 63.The rms value of a sine wave is 100A. Its peak
a.peak value to rms value value is _______
Jo
ans:b d.282.8A
P
ans:b
U
B
a.20 Hz
H
figure represents________
-T
el
67. For the same peak value which of the 71.For a frequency of 200 Hz, the time period will
following wave will have the least mean value? be_________
a.half wave rectified sine wave a.0.05 S
b.triangular wave b.0.005 S
c.sine wave c.0.0005 S
d.square wave d.0.5 S
ans:a ans:b
68.For a sine wave with peak value Imax, the rms 72.An ac voltage of 50 Hz has a maximum value
value is_______ of 50 V. Its value after 1/600 second after the
a. 0.5Imax instant the current is zero will be_________
Jo
in
b. 0.707Imax a.5V
@
c. 0.9Imax b.12.5V
SP
d. 1.414Imax c.25V
P
ans:b d.43.8V
U
ans:c
B
TE
76.The rms value of a half-wave rectified current 80.If a sinusoidal wave has frequency of 50 Hz
is 100 A. Its value for full-wave rectification with 30A rms current, which of the following
would be_________amperes. equation represents the wave?
a.141.4 a.42.42 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑠𝑖𝑛 314𝑡
b.200 b.60 𝑠𝑖𝑛25𝑡
c.200/π c.30 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑠𝑖𝑛 50𝑡
d.40/π d.84.84 𝑠𝑖𝑛25𝑡
ans:a ans:a
Jo
in
@
77.The rms value of a sinusoidal ac current is 81.Which of the following waves has the highest
SP
a.30°
in
b.45°
@
c.84.84 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡
86.The rms value of pure cosine function
C
d42.42 𝑠𝑖𝑛314𝑡.
H
is_________
-T
el
the_________ ans: a
@
a.whole cycle
SP
ans:a b. 50 Hz
C
H
c. 100 Hz
-T
el
d. 0.02 Hz a) clockwise
ans: b b) anticlockwise
c) circular
100. An ac current is given as i = 10 + 10 sin 314 d) all above
t, the average and rms values of the current ans:b
are____
a. 16.36 A, 17.07 A 105. In practice, alternating quantities are
b. 10 A, 17.07 A represented by their _______ values
c. 10 A, 12.25 A a. rms
d. 16.36 A, 12.2 A b. average
ans:c c. rectangular
d. polar
101.The size (cross-sectional area) of a ans:a
conductor, with regard to the heating effect, is
determined on the basis of ……….. value of 106. Alternating quantities of ____ frequencies
current to be carried by it can be represented on same phasor diagram.
a. average value a. Same
b. peak value b. Different
c. rms value c. multiple
d. peak to peak value d. all above
ans:c ans: a
102. The form factor for dc supply voltage is 107.The phase of alternating quantity at any
always particular instant is the fraction of ______
a. zero a. phase
b. unity b. time
c. infinity c. time period
d. any value between 0 and 1 d. all above
ans:b ans:c
b) sinusoidally
@
c) rectangular
SP
d) triagular
P
ans:b
U
_________ direction. a. T
H
-T
el
b.positive
in
ans:c
c.negative
@
a.one
C
b.unity
H
-T
el
c.zero c. lead
d.π/2 d. all above
ans:c ans:a
117. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt-Φ), the ‘i’ 122. With respect to reference, plus sign of angle
is said to be _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ indicates _______
a. in phase a. leading
b. lagging b.lagging
c. leading c.inphase
d. all above d.none of the above
ans:b ans:a
118. If v = Vm Sin ωtand i = Im Sin (ωt-Φ), the ‘v’ 123. With respect to reference, minus sign of
is said to _______ ‘i’ by angle Φ angle indicates _______
a. in phase a. leading
b. lagging b.lagging
c. leading c.inphase
d. all above d.none of the above
ans:c ans:b
119. If v = Vm Sin ωt and i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ), the ‘i’ 124. With respect to reference, _____ sign of
is said to _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ angle indicates lead.
a. in phase a. division
b. lagging b.plus
c. leading c.minus
d. all above d.dot
ans:c ans:b
120. If v = Vm Sin ωtand i = Im Sin (ωt+Φ), the ‘v’ 125. With respect to reference, _____ sign of
is said to _______ ‘i’ by angle Φ angle indicates lag.
a. in phase a. division
b. lag b.plus
c. lead c.minus
Jo
in
ans:b ans:c
SP
P
121. If v = Vm Sin ωtand i = Im Sin ωt, the ‘i’ is 126. The diagram in which different sinusoidal
U
said to _______ ‘v’ by angle Φ alternating quantities of the same frequency, are
B
TE
a.graph
b.still diagram 131. RMS value of current I = 25 + j40 Amp is
c.phasor diagram _______
d.picture a.57.99
ans:c b.47.1699
c.60
127.The diagram in which different sinusoidal d.30
alternating quantities of the same _____, are ans:b
represented by individual phasors indicating
exact phase relationship is called phasor 132. Two currents I1 = 1050 and I2 = 5 -100 A
diagram. flow in single phase AC circuit. Then I 1+I2
a.time =________
b.frequency a. 5.5596+ j4.924 A
c.sign b. 5.55964.924 A
d.shape c. 7.296+ j12.58 A
ans:b d. None of the above
ans:a
128.The lagging and leading word is relative to
the ______ 133. Two currents I1 = 1050 and I2 = 5 -100 A
a.base flow in single phase AC circuit. Then I 1-I2
b.range =________
c.reference a. 5.5596+ j4.924 A
d.angle b. 5.5596∟4.924 A
ans:c c. 7.296+ j12.58 A
d. None of the above
129. Polar form of v = 100 sin(100πt+π/6) Volt is ans:c
________
a.61.2371+j35.3553 134. Two currents I1 = 1050 and I2 = 5 -100 A
b.70.7106∟30 flow in single phase AC circuit. Then I 1/I2
c. 61.2371∟35.3553 =________
d. 70.710+ j30 a. 5.5596+ j4.924 A
ans:b b. 2150 A
Jo
c. 7.296+ j12.58 A
in
a.61.2371+j35.3553
P
c. 61.2371∟35.3553
B
ans:a b.inductive
H
-T
el
c.capacitive c.zero
d.none of the above d.none of the above
ans:a ans:c
136.In purely resistive circuit, the current and 141.The _________ offers zero reactance to DC.
voltage applied are in ______ with each other. a.resistance
a.opposition b.inductance
b.phase c.permeance
c.direction d.none of the above
d.line ans:b
ans:b
142. The inductance offers zero _________ to DC
137.In purely _______ circuit, current lags a.resistance
voltage by 90 degrees. b. capacitance
a.resistive c.reactance
b.inductive d.permeance
c.capacitive ans:c
d.none of the above
ans:b 143.Pure ______ never consumes power
a.resistor
138.In purely Inductive circuit, current _____ b.inductor
voltage by 90 degrees. c.starter
a.leads d.circuit
b.lags ans:b
c.in phase
d.all above 144.Inductive reactance is given by_____
ans:b a.XL=ωL
b.XL=2𝜋L
139.In purely Inductive circuit, current lags c.XL=ΦL
voltage by _______ degrees. d.XL=ωC
a. 30 ans:a
b.60
c.90 145.______is given by XL=ωL
Jo
in
d.120 a.resistance
@
ans:c b.inductance
SP
c.inductive reactance
P
DC. ans:c
B
TE
a. high
C
a.Farad a. 30
b.Henry b.60
c.Ohm c.90
d.Joule d.120
ans:c ans:c
147.Inductive reactance depends on ______ of 152.The capacitor offers _____ reactance to DC.
applied voltage a. high
a.phase b.low
b.sign c.zero
c.frequency d.none of the above
d.speed ans:a
ans:c
153.The _________ offers infinite reactance to
148. Inductive reactance is _________ DC.
frequency. a.resistance
a. inversely proportional to b.permeance
b.directly proportional to c.capacitance
c.indepedent of d.none of the above
c.none of above ans:c
ans:b
154. The capacitance offers infinite _________
149. Inductive reactance is directly proportional to DC
to ________. a.resistance
a.time b. capacitance
b.phase c.reactance
c.frequency d.permeance
d.phase difference ans:c
ans:c
155.Pure ______ never consumes power
150.In purely capacitive circuit, current ______ a.resistor
voltage by 90 degrees. b.capacitor
a.lags c.starter
Jo
in
b.leads d.circuit
@
d.all above
P
a.XC=1/ωC
B
TE
d.XC=2𝝅fL
ans:a 162.In purely inductive circuit, if the frequency is
doubled and applied voltage is halved, the
157.______is given by XC=1/ωL resulting current becomes____
a.Inductive resistance a.one-fourth
b.inductive capacitance b.one-fifth
c.inductive reactance c.one-half
d.capacitive reactance d.one-third
ans:d ans:a
a.8 d.-24-j14
P
b.10 ans:c
U
c.12
B
TE
d.20
C
ans:c
H
-T
el
ans:d a.90,270
@
b.90,90
SP
a.62.8 ans:a
B
TE
b.628
C
ans:b
191.A current of (3+j4) A is flowing through a
186.If the phasor is multiplied by j, then ____ circuit. The magnitude of current is _____
a.only its magnitude changes a.7 A
b.only its direction changes b.5 A
c.both magnitude and direction change c.1 A
d.none of the above d.1.33 A
ans:b ans:b
187.In the complex number 4+j7, 7 is called the 192.The voltage applied in a circuit is given by
______ component 100∟60 volts. It can be written as ____
a.real a.100∟-60
b.imaginary b.100∟240
c.in-phase c.100∟-300
d.none of the above` d.none of the above
ans:d ans:c
a.j
@
a.j2 c.jxj
P
c.-2 ans:b
B
TE
d.2
C
ans:c
H
-T
el
c.capacitance is more and frequency of supply is b.current leads the voltageby 90 degrees
@
ans:a ans:a
B
TE
C
216.Ohm is the unit of all the following except 221.For purely resistive circuit if v = Vm sin (ωt)
a.inductive reactance then equation of current is _____
b.capacitive reactance a.i = Im sin (ωt-π/2)
c.resistance b. i = Im sin (ωt+π/2)
d.capacitance c. i = Im sin (ωt)
ans:d d. i = Im sin (ωt+π)
ans:c
217.For a purely resistive circuit the following 222.A sinusoidal voltagev1 leads another
statement is correct sinusoidal voltagev2 by 180 degrees. Then ____
a.work done is zero a.voltagev2 leads voltagev1 by 180 degrees
b.power consumed is zero b.both voltagehave their zero values at the same
c.heat produced is zero time
d.power factor is unity c. both voltagehave their peak values at the
ans:d same time
d.all of above
218.Which value of inductance will give the same ans:d
reactance as a capacitor of 2 µF when both are
at 50 Hz? 223.If A = 10∟45 and B = 5∟15, then the value
a.5 H of A/B will be___
b.10 H a.50∟60
c.15 H b.2∟60
d.20 H c.2∟-30
and:a d.2∟30
Jo
in
ans:d
@
then equation of current is _____ 224.A coil has XL = 1000 ohm. If both its
P
d.opposes sudden change in voltage quantities can be drawn if they have ……… waves
SP
ans:a a. rectangular
P
b. sinusoidal
U
shown in figure is of
d. unity for a reactive circuit
P U
ans:c
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
240. The phasor diagram of voltage and current 242. The power factor of an ac circuit lies
considering phasors are rotates anticlockwise between
direction is of a. 0 and 1
b. -1 and 1
I c. 0 and -1
d. none of these
V ans:a
a. pure resistance
b. pure inductance
c. pure capacitance
d.pure capacitance and pure inductance
Answer: c
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
770 MCQs
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING MOST IMPORTANT 770 MCQ
Ans-c
Ans-b
3. The resistance of a conductor having length l area of cross section a and resistivity ρ is given
as:
Ans-b
Ans-a
5. Which of the following quantities are same in all parts of a series circuit?
Ans-c
c. applied voltage is equal to the sum of voltage drops across individual resistors are additive
@
SP
d.none
P U
Ans-b
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
7. A resistance of 30 ohm is connected across 240v supply. If a resistance R ohm is connected in
parallel with 30ohm resistor across the same supply, the current drawn becomes triple of original
one The unknown resistor R is
Ans-a
8. Three resistors, each of R ohms, are connected to form a triangle. The resistance between any
two terminals will be:
a. 2/3 R b. 3/2R c. R d. 3R
Ans-a
Ans-
10. A 100W bulb is connected in series with a room heater. If now 100W bulb is replaced by a
40w bulb, the heater output will :
Ans-b
11. The voltage applied across an electric iron is halved. The power consumption of the iron will
be:
Ans-b
Ans-c
@
SP
13. Two heaters rated at 1000w, 250v each are connected in series across a 250v, 50Hz ac
P
supply. The total power drawn from the supply will be:
U
B
TE
2| www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans-b
14. A 200w, 100v lamp is to be operated on 250v supply. The additional resistance required to be
connected in series will be:
Ans-c
Ans-d
Ans-c
Ans-c
18. A wye arrangement of resistances has each resistance of 3ohm, the equivalent delta
arrangement will have each resistance of values.
Ans-a
Jo
19. A battery is connected to a resistance causing a current of 0.5A in the circuit. The current
in
drops to 0.4 when an additional resistance of 5? is connected in series . The current will drop to
@
Ans-c
C
H
-T
el
3| www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
20. Cells are connected in series in order to increase the
Ans-c
Ans-c
22. When two cells are connected in parallel , it should ensure that have
Ans-b
Ans-b
Ans-c
Ans-b
Ans-b
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
Page
eg
ra
m
4| www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
27. Voltmeter should be of very high resistance so that
Ans-c
a. the measurement reading will be too high b. Almost no current will flow in the circuit
c. the meter will burn out d. an inadmissably high current will flow
Ans-b
a. Multiple shunt or series resistances inside the meter b. variable coil turns
Ans-a
Ans-c
31. Electric pressure is also called
a. resistance b. power c. voltage d. energy
Ans-c
32 The substances whfch have a large number of free electrons and offer a low resistance are
called
a. insulators b. inductors c. semi-conductors d. conductors
Ans-d
33. Out of the following which is not a poor conductor ?
Jo
Ans-b
SP
Ans-d
C
H
-T
el
Page
eg
ra
m
5| www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
35. The property of a conductor due to which it passes current is called
a. resistance b. reluctance c. conductance d. inductance
Ans-cc
36 . Conductance is reciprocal of
(a) resistance (b) inductance (c) reluctance (d) capacitance
Ans-a
37. The resistance of a conductor varies inversely as
(a) length (b) area of cross-section (c) temperature (d) resistivity
Ans-b
38. With rise in temperature the resistance of pure metals
(a) Increases (b) decreases
(c) first increases and then decreases (d) remains constant
Ans-a
39. With rise in temperature the resistance of semi-conductors
(a) decreases (b) increases
(c) first increases and then decreases (d) remains constant
Ans-a
40. The resistance of a copper wire 200 m long is 21 Q. If its thickness (diameter) is 0.44 mm, its
specific resistance is around
(a) 1.2 x 10~8 Q-m (b) 1.4 x 10~8 Q-m
(c) 1.6 x 10""8 Q-m (d) 1.8 x 10"8 Q-m
Ans-c
41. Three resistances of 10 ohms, 15 ohms and 30 ohms are connected in parallel.
The total resistance of the combination is
(a) 5 ohms (b) 10 ohms (c) 15 ohms (d) 55 ohms
Ans-a
42. An instrument which detects electric current is known as
(a) voltmeter (b) rheostat (c) wattmeter (d) galvanometer
Ans-d
Jo
43. In a circuit a 33 Q resistor carries a current of 2 A. The voltage across the resistor is
in
Ans-b
P
44. A light bulb draws 300 mA when the voltage across it is 240 V. The resistance of the light
U
bulb is (a) 400 ohm (b) 600 ohm (c) 800 ohm (d) 1000 ohm
B
TE
Ans-c
C
H
-T
el
6| www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
45. The resistance of a parallel circuit consisting of two branches is 12 ohms. If the resistance of
one branch is 18 ohms, what is the resistance of the other ?
(a) 18 ohm (b) 36 ohm (c) 48 ohm (d) 64 ohm
Ans-b
46. Four wires of same material, the same cross-sectional area and the same length when
connected in parallel give a resistance of 0.25 ohm. If the same four wires are connected is series
the effective resistance will be
(a) 1 ohm (b) 2 ohm (c) 3 ohm (d) 4 ohm
Ans-d
47. A current of 16 amperes divides between two branches in parallel of resistances 8 ohms and
12 ohms respectively. The current in each branch is
(a) 6.4 A, 6.9 A (b) 6.4 A, 9.6 A (c) 4.6 A, 6.9 A (d) 4.6 A, 9.6 A
Ans-b
48. Current velocity through a copper conductor is
(a) the same as propagation velocity of electric energy (b) independent of current strength
(c) of the order of a few micro second (d) nearly 3 x 108 m/s
Ans-c
49. Which of the following material has nearly zero temperature co-efficient of resistance?
(a) Manganin (b) Porcelain (c) Carbon (d) Copper
Ans-a
50. You have to replace 1500 ohm resistor in radio. You have no 1500 ohm resistor but have
several 1000 ohm ones which you would connect
(a) two in parallel (b) two in parallel and one in series (c) three in parallel (d) three in series
Ans-b
51. Two resistors are said to be connected in series when
(a) same current passes in turn through both (b) both carry the same value of current
(c) total current equals the sum of branch currents (d) sum of IR drops equals the applied e.m.f.
Ans-a
52. Which of the following statement is true both for a series and a parallel D.C. circuit?
(a) Elements have individual currents (b) Currents are additive
(c) Voltages are additive (d) Power are additive
Jo
in
Ans-d
@
53. Which of the following materials has a negative temperature co-efficient of resistance?
SP
Ans-c
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
54. Ohm's law is not applicable to
(a) vacuum tubes (b) carbon resistors
(c) high voltage circuits (d) circuits with low current densities
Ans-a
55. Which is the best conductor of electricity ?
(a) Iron (b) Silver (c) Copper (d) Carbon
Ans-b
56. For which of the following 'ampere second' could be the unit ?
(a) Reluctance (b) Charge (c) Power (d) Energy
Ans-b
57. All of the following are equivalent to watt except
(a) amperes square ohm (b) joules/sec. (c) amperes x volts (d) amperes/volt
Ans-d
58. A resistance having rating 10 ohms, 10W is likely to be a
(a) metallic resistor
(b) carbon resistor
(c) wire wound resistor
(d) variable resistor
Ans-c
59. Which one of the following does not have negative temperature co-efficient ?
(a) Aluminium
(b) Paper
(c) Rubber
(d) Mica
Ans-a
60. Varistors are
(a) insulators
(b) non-linear resistors
(c) carbon resistors
(d) resistors with zero temperature coefficient
Ans-b
Jo
(b) preventing an open circuit between the voltage source and the load
SP
Ans-a
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
62. The rating of a fuse wire is always expressed in
(a) ampere-hours
(b) ampere-volts
(c) kWh
(d) amperes
Ans-d
63. The minimum charge on an ion is
(a) equal to the atomic number of the atom
(b) equal to the charge of an electron
(c) equal to the charge of the number of electrons in an atom zero
Ans-b
64. In a series circuit with unequal resistances
(a) the highest resistance has the most of the current through it
(b) the lowest resistance has the highest voltage drop
(c) the lowest resistance has the highest current
(d) the highest resistance has the highest voltage drop
Ans-c
65. The filament of an electric bulb is made of
(a) carbon
(b) aluminium
(c) tungsten
(d) nickel
Ans-c
66. A 3 ohm resistor having 2 A current will dissipate the power of
(a) 2 watts
(b) 4 watts
(c) 6 watts
(d) 12 watts
Ans-d
67. Which of the following statement is true?
(a) A galvanometer with low resistance in parallel is a voltmeter
(b) A galvanometer with high resistance in parallel is a voltmeter
(c) A galvanometer with low resistance in series is an ammeter
Jo
Ans-
SP
68. The resistance of a few metres of wire conductor in closed electrical circuit is
P
Ans-a
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
69. If a parallel circuit is opened in the main line, the current
(a) increases in the branch of the lowest resistance (b) increases in each branch
(c) is zero in all branches (d) is zero in the highest resistive branch
Ans-c
70. If a wire conductor of 0.2 ohm resistance is doubled in length, its resistance becomes
(a) 0.4 ohm
(b) 0.6 ohm
(c) 0.8 ohm
(d) 1.0 ohm
Ans-a
71. Three 60 W bulbs are in parallel across the 60 V power line. If one bulb burns open
(a) there will be heavy current in the main line
(b) rest of the two bulbs will not light
(c) all three bulbs will light
(d) the other two bulbs will light
Ans-b
72. The four bulbs of 40 W each are connected in series with a battery across them, which of the
following statement is true ?
(a) The current through each bulb in same
(b) The voltage across each bulb is not same
(c) The power dissipation in each bulb is not same
(d) None of the above
Ans-a
73. Two resistances Rl and R2 are connected in series across the voltage source where R2>R1.
The largest drop will be across
(a) R2
(b) R1
(c) either Rl or R2
(d) none of them
Ans-a
74. What will be energy used by the battery if the battery has to drive 6.28 x 1018 electrons with
potential difference of 20 V across the terminal ?
Jo
(a) 5 joules
in
(b) 10 joules
@
(c) 15 joules
SP
(d) 20 joules
P U
Ans-d
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
10 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
75. A closed switch has a resistance of
(a) zero
(b) about 50 ohms
(c) about 500 ohms
(d) infinity
Ans-a
76. The hot resistance of the bulb's filament is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature co-efficient of the filament is
(a) zero
(b) negative
(c) positive
(d) about 2 ohms per degree
Ans-c
77. Heat in a conductor is produced on the passage of electric current due to
(a) reactance
(b) capacitance
(c) impedance
(d) resistance
Ans-d
78. The insulation on a current carrying conductor is provided
(a) to prevent leakage of current (b) to prevent shock
(c) both of above factor (d) none of above factors
Ans-c
79. The thickness of insulation provided on the conductor depends on
(a) the magnitude of voltage on the conductor
(b) the magnitude of current flowing through it
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans-a
80. Which of the following quantities remain the same in all parts of a series circuit ?
(a) Voltage
(b) Current
(c) Power
Jo
(d) Resistance
in
@
Ans-b
SP
81. A 40 W bulb is connected in series with a room heater. If now 40 W bulb is replaced by 100
P
(a) decrease
B
TE
(b) increase
(c) remain same
C
H
-T
el
11 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(d) heater will burn out
Ans-b
82. In an electric kettle water boils in 10 minutes. It is required to boil the boiler in 15 minutes,
using same supply mains
(a) length of heating element should be decreased
(b) length of heating element should be increased
(c) length of heating element has no effect on heating if water
(d) none of the above
Ans-a
83. An electric filament bulb can be worked from
(a) D.C. supply only
(b) A.C. supply only
(c) Battery supply only
(d) All above
Ans-d
84. Resistance of a tungsten as applied voltage increases
(a) decreases
(b) increases
(c) remains same
(d) none of the above
Ans-b
85. Electric current passing through the circuit produces
(a) magnetic effect
(b) luminous effect
(c) thermal effect
(d) chemical effect
(e) all above effects
Ans-c
86. Resistance of a material always decreases if
(a) temperature of material is decreased
(6) temperature of material is increased
(c) number of free electrons available become more
(d) none of the above is correct
Jo
in
Ans: c
@
Ans: b
C
H
-T
el
12 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
88. When electric current passes through a metallic conductor, its temperature rises. This is due
to
(a) collisions between conduction electrons and atoms
(b) the release of conduction electrons from parent atoms
(c) mutual collisions between metal atoms
(d) mutual collisions between conducting electrons
Ans: a
89. Two bulbs of 500 W and 200 W rated at 250 V will have resistance ratio as
(a) 4 : 25
(b) 25 : 4
(c) 2 : 5
(d) 5 : 2
Ans: c
90. A glass rod when rubbed with silk cloth is charged because
(a) it takes in proton
(b) its atoms are removed
(c) it gives away electrons
(d) it gives away positive charge
Ans: c
91. Whether circuit may be AC. or D.C. one, following is most effective in reducing the
magnitude of the current.
(a) Reactor
(b) Capacitor
(c) Inductor
(d) Resistor
Ans: d
92. It becomes more difficult to remove
(a) any electron from the
(6) first electron from the orbit
(c) second electron from the orbit
(d) third electron from the orbit
Ans: d
Jo
93. When one leg of parallel circuit is opened out the total current will
in
(a) reduce
@
(b) increase
SP
(c) decrease
P
Ans: c
C
H
-T
el
13 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
94. In a lamp load when more than one lamp are switched on the total resistance of the load
(a) increases
(b) decreases
(c) remains same
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
95. Two lamps 100 W and 40 W are connected in series across 230 V (alternating). Which of the
following statement is correct ?
(a) 100 W lamp will brighter (b) 40 W lamp will glow brighter
(c) Both lamps will glow equally bright (d) 40 W lamp will fuse
Ans: b
96. Resistance of 220 V, 100 W lamp will be
(a) 4.84 Q
(b) 48.4 Q
(c) 484 ft
(d) 4840 Q
Ans: c
97. In the case of direct current
(a) magnitude and direction of current remains constant
(b) magnitude and direction of current changes with time
(c) magnitude of current changes with time
(d) magnitude of current remains constant
Ans: a
98. When electric current passes through a bucket full of water, lot of bubbling is observed. This
suggests that the type of supply is
(a) A.C.
(b) D.C.
(c) any of above two
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
99. Resistance of carbon filament lamp as the applied voltage increases.
(a) increases
(b) decreases
Jo
Ans: b
P
(a) parallel
B
TE
(b) series
C
H
-T
el
14 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) series-parallel
(d) end-to-end
Ans: a
101. For testing appliances, the wattage of test lamp should be
(a) very low
(b) low
(c) high
(d) any value
Ans: c
102. Switching of a lamp in house produces noise in the radio. This is because switching
operation produces
(a) arcs across separating contacts
(b) mechanical noise of high intensity
(c) both mechanical noise and arc between contacts
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
103. Sparking occurs when a load is switched off because the circuit has high
(a) resistance (b) inductance (c) capacitance (d) impedance
Ans: b
104. Copper wire of certain length and resistance is drawn out to three times its length without
change in volume, the new resistance of wire becomes
(a) 1/9 times (b) 3 times (c) 9 times (d) unchanged
Ans: c
105. When resistance element of a heater fuses and then we reconnect it after removing a portion
of it, the power of the heater will
(a) decrease
(b) increase
(c) remain constant
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
106. A field of force can exist only between
(a) two molecules
Jo
Ans: b
U
(a) semi-conductor
(b) super-conducto
C
H
-T
el
15 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) compound
(d) insulator
Ans: c
108. International ohm is defined in terms of the resistance of
(a) a column of mercury
(b) a cube of carbon
(c) a cube of copper
(d) the unit length of wire
Ans: a
109. Three identical resistors are first connected in parallel and then in series.
The resultant resistance of the first combination to the second will be
(a) 9 times
(b) 1/9 times
(c) 1/3 times
(d) 3 times
Ans: b
110. Which method can be used for absolute measurement of resistances ?
(a) Lorentz method
(b) Releigh method
(c) Ohm's law method
(d) Wheatstone bridge method
Ans: d
111. 3 6 ohm resistors are connected to form a triangle. What is the resistance between any two
corners
?
(a) 3/2 Q (b 6 Q (c) 4 Q (d) 8/3 Q
Ans: c
112. Ohm's law is not applicable to
(a) semi-conductors (b) D.C. circuits
(c) small resistors (d) high currents
Ans: a
113. Two copper conductors have equal length. The cross-sectional area of one conductor is four
times that of the other. If the conductor having smaller cross-sectional area has a resistance of 40
Jo
(b) 80 ohms
SP
(c) 20 ohms
P
(d) 10 ohms
U
B
TE
Ans: d
C
H
-T
el
16 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
114. A nichrome wire used as a heater coil has the resistance of 2 £2/m. For a heater of 1 kW at
200 V, the length of wire required will be
(a) 80 m
(b) 60 m
(c) 40 m
(d) 20 m
Ans: a
115. Temperature co-efficient of resistance is expressed in terms of
(a) ohms/°C
(b) mhos/ohm°C
(e) ohms/ohm°C
(d) mhos/°C
Ans: c
116. Which of the following materials has the least resistivity ?
(a) Zinc
(b) Lead
(c) Mercury
(d) Copper
Ans: d
117. When current flows through heater coil it glows but supply wiring does not glow because
(a) current through supply line flows at slower speed
(b) supply wiring is covered with insulation layer
(c) resistance of heater coil is more than the supply wires
(d) supply wires are made of superior material
Ans: c
118. The condition for the validity under Ohm's law is that
(a) resistance must be uniform
(b) current should be proportional to the size of the resistance
(c) resistance must be wire wound type
(d) temperature at positive end should be more than the temperature at negative end
Ans: a
119. Which of the following statement is correct ?
(a) A semi-conductor is a material whose conductivity is same as between that of a conductor
Jo
and an insulator
in
(b) A semi-conductor is a material which has conductivity having average value of conductivity
@
(c) A semi-conductor is one which conducts only half of the applied voltage
P
(d) A semi-conductor is a material made of alternate layers of conducting material and insulator
U
Ans: a
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
17 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
120. A rheostat differs from potentiometer in the respect that it
(a) has lower wantage rating
(b) has higher wattage rating
(c) has large number of turns
(d) offers large number of tappings
Ans: b
121. The weight of an aluminium conductor as compared to a copper conductor of identical
cross-section, for the same electrical resistance, is
(a) 50%
(b) 60% (c) 100% (d) 150%
Ans: a
122. An open resistor, when checked with an ohm-meter reads
(a) zero
(b) infinite
(c) high but within tolerance
(d) low but not zero
Ans: b
123. are the materials having electrical conductivity much less than most of the metals but much
greater than that of typical insulators.
(a) Varistors
(b) Thermistor
(c) Semi-conductors
(d) Variable resistors
Ans: c
124. All good conductors have high
(a) conductance
(b) resistance
(c) reluctance
(d) thermal conductivity
Ans: a
125. Voltage dependent resistors are usually made from
(a) charcoal (b) copper
(c) nichrome
Jo
(d) graphite
in
@
Ans: c
SP
18 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: b
127. The ratio of mass of proton to that of electron is nearly
Ans: a
128. The number of electrons in the outer most orbit of carbon atom is
(a) 3
(b) 4
(c) 6
(d) 7
Ans: b
129. With three resistances connected in parallel, if each dissipates 20 W the total power
supplied by the voltage source equals
(a) 10 W
(b) 20 W
(c) 40 W
(d) 60 W
Ans: d
130. A thermistor has
(a) positive temperature coefficient
(b) negative temperature coefficient
(c) zero temperature coefficient
(d) variable temperature coefficient
Ans: c
131. If, R and t are the current, resistance and time respectively, then according to Joule's law
heat produced will be proportional to
(a) I2Rt
(b) I2Rf
(c) I2R2t
(d) I2R2t*
Ans: a
132. Nichrome wire is an alloy of
(a) lead and zinc
Jo
Ans: c
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
19 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
133. When a voltage of one volt is applied, a circuit allows one microampere current to flow
through it.The conductance of the circuit is
(a) 1 n-mho
(b) 106 mho
(c) 1 milli-mho
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
Ans: d
135. Conductance : mho ::
(a) resistance : ohm
(b) capacitance : henry
(c) inductance : farad
(d) lumen : steradian
Ans: a
136. 1 angstrom is equal to
(a) 10-8 mm (6) 10"6 cm (c) 10"10 m (d) 10~14 m
Ans: c
137. One newton metre is same as
(a) one watt
(b) one joule
(c) five joules
(d) one joule second
Ans: b
138. The force between two charges is 120 N. If the distance between the charges is doubled, the
force will be
(a) 60 N
Jo
(b) 30 N
in
(c) 40 N
@
(d) 15 N
SP
Ans: b
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
20 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
139. The electric field intensity at a point situated 4 metres from a point charge is 200 N/C. If the
distance is reduced to 2 metres, the field intensity will be
(a) 400 N/C
(b) 600 N/C
(c) 800 N/C
(d) 1200 N/C
Ans: c
140. The lines of force due to charged particles are
(a) always straight(b) always curved
(c) sometimes curved(d) none of the above
Ans: b
141. The electric field at a point situated at a distance d from straight charged conductor is
(a) proportional to d
(b) inversely proportional to d
(c) inversely proportional to d
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
142. The direction of electric field due +0 positive charge is .
(a) away from the charge (b) towards the charge
(c) both (a) and (b) (d) none of the above
Ans: a
143. A field line and an equipotential surface are
(a) always parallel(b) always at 90°
(c) inclined at any angle 0(d) none of the above
Ans: b
144. The ability of charged bodies to exert force on 6ne another is attributed to the existence of
(a) electrons
(b) protons
(c) neutrons
(d) electric field
Ans: d
145. If the sheet of a bakelite is inserted between the of an , the capacitance will
Jo
(a) decrease
in
(b) increase
@
Ans: b
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
21 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
146. A capacitor stores 0.24 coulombs at 10 volts. Its capacitance is
(a) 0.024 F
(b) 0.12 F
(c) 0.6 F
(d) 0.8 F
Ans: a
147. For making a capacitor, it is better to select a dielectric having
(a) low permittivity
(b) high permittivity
(c) permittivity same as that of air
(d) permittivity slightly more than that of air
Ans: b
148. The units of capacitance are
(a) volts/coulomb
(b) coulombs/volt
(c) ohms
(d) henry/Wb
Ans: b
149. If three 15 uF capacitors are connected in series, the net capacitance is
(a) 5 uF
(6) 30 uF
(c) 45 uF
(d) 50 uF
Ans: a
150. If three 10 uF capacitors are connected in parallel, the net cararitance is
(a) 20 uF
(b) 30 uE
(c) 40 uF
(d) 50 uF
Ans: b
151. A dielectric material must be
(a) resistor
Jo
(b) insulator
in
Ans: b
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
22 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
152. An electrolytic capacitor can be used for
Ans: a
153. The capacitance of a capacitor is not affected by
(a) distance between plates
(6) area of plates
(c) thickness of plates
(d) all of the above
Ans: c
154. Which of the following is not a vector ?
(a) Linear momentum
(b) Angular momentum
(c) Electric field
(d) Electric potential
Ans: b
155. Two plates of a parallel capacitor after being charged from a constant voltage source are
separated apart by means of insulated handles, then the
(a) Voltage across the plates
(b) voltage across the plates decreases
(c) charge on the capacitor decreases
(d) charge on the capacitor increases
Ans: b
156. If A.C. voltage is applied to capacitive circuit, the alternating current can flow in the circuit
because
(a) varying voltage produces the charging and dicharging currents
(b) of high peak value
(c) charging current can flow
(d) discharge current can flow
Ans: a
157. Voltage applied across a ceramic dielectric produces an electrolytic field 100 times greater
Jo
Ans: b
U
23 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) Ceramic capacitors must be connected in the correct polarity
(d) Mica capacitors are available in capacitance value of 1 to 10 pF
Ans: b
159. The dissipation factor of a good dielectric is of the order of
(a) 0.0002
(b) 0.002
(c) 0.02
(d) 0.2
Ans: a
160. "The total electric flux through any closed surface surrounding charges is equal to the
amount oflcharge enclosed".The above statement is associated with
(a) Coulomb's square law
(b) Gauss's law
(c) Maxwell's first law
(d) Maxwell's second law
Ans: b
161. Three capacitors each of the capacity C are given. The resultant capacity 2/3 C can be
obtained by using them
(a) all in series
(b) all in parallel
(c) two in parallel and third in series with this combination
(d) two in series and third in parallel across this combination
Ans: c
162. For which of the following parameter variation, the capacitance of the capacitor remains
unaffected ?
(a) Distance between plates
(b) Area of the plates
(c) Nature of dielectric
(d) Thickness of the plates
Ans: d
163. Which of the following statement is true ?
(a) The current in the discharging capacitor grows linearly
Jo
Ans: b
U
164. Which of the following expression is correct for electric field strength ?
B
TE
(a) E = D/E
(b) E = D2/t
C
H
-T
el
24 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) E = jtD
(d) E= nD2
Ans: a
165. In a capacitor the electric charge is stored in
(a) metal plates
(b) dielectric
(c) both (a) and (6)
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
166. Which of the following materials has the highest value of dielectric constant?
(a) Glass
(b) Vacuum
(c) Ceramics
(d) Oil
Ans: c
167. Which of the following capacitors will have the least variation ?
(a) Paper capacitor
(b) Ceramic capacitor
(c) Silver plated mica capacitor
(d) None of the above
Ans: c
168. Which of the following statements is incorrect ?
(a) The leakage resistance of ceramic capacitors is generally high
(b) The stored energy in a capacitor decreases with reduction in value of capacitance
(c) The stored energy in a capacitor increases with applied voltage
(d) A wire cable has distributed capacitance between the conductors
Ans: b
169. Which of the following capacitors has relatively shorter shelf life ?
(a) Mica capacitor
(b) Electrolytic capacitor
(c) Ceramic capacitor
(d) Paper capacitor
Jo
Ans: b
in
170. The sparking between two electrical contacts can be reduced by inserting a
@
25 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: a
171. In the case of a lossy capacitor, its series equivalent resistance value will be
(a) small
(b) very small
(c) large
(d) zero
Ans: c
172. The power dissipated in a pure capacitor is
(a) zero
(6) proportional to applied voltage
(c) proportional to value of capacitance
(d) both (b) and (c) above
Ans: a
173. In a capacitive circuit
(a) a steady value of applied voltage causes discharge
(b) an increase in applied voltage makes a capacitor charge
(c) decrease in applied voltage makes a capacitor charge
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
174. When a dielectric slab is introduced in a parallel plate capacitor, the potential difference
between plates will
(a) remain uncharged
(b) decrease
(c) increase
(d) become zero
Ans: b
175. Capacitance increases with
(a) increase in plate area and decrease in distance between the plates
(b) increase in plate area and distance between the plates
(c) decrease in plate area and value of applied voltage
(d) reduction in plate area and distance between the plates
Ans: a
176. A capacitor consists of
Jo
Ans: b
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
26 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
177. A paper capacitor is usually available in the form of
(a) tubes
(b) rolled foil
(c) disc
(d) meshed plates
Ans: b
178. Air capacitors are generally available in the range
(a) 10 to 400 pF
(b) 1 to 20 pF
(c) 100 to 900 pF
(d) 20 to 100 pF
Ans: a
Ans: c
180. A capacitor charged to 200 V has 2000 (iC of charge. The value of capacitance will be
(a) 10 F
(6) 10 uF
(c) 100 nF
(d) 1000 uF
Ans: b
181. A capacitor in a circuit became hot and ultimately exploded due to wrong connections,
which type of capacitor it could be ?
(a) Paper capacitor
(b) Ceramic capacitor
(c) Electrolytic capacitor
(d) Any-of the above
Ans: c
182. Energy stored in the electric field of a capacitor C when charged from a D.C source of
Jo
(a) CV2
@
(b) C2V
SP
(c) CV2
P
(d) CV
U
B
TE
Ans: a
C
H
-T
el
27 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
183. The absolute permittivity of free space is given by (a) 8.854 x 1(T9 F/m)
(6) 8.854 x 1(T10 F/m)
(c) 8.854 x KT11 F/m (d) 8.854 x 10"12 F/m
Ans: b
184. The relative permittivity of free space is given by
(a) 1
(b) 10
(c) 100 (d) 1000
Ans: a
185. Electric field intensity is a quantity
(a) scalar
(b) vector
(c) both (a) and (6)
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
186. When 4 volts e.m.f. is applied across a 1 farad capacitor, it will store energy of
(a) 2 joules
(b) 4 joules
(c) 6 joules
(d) 8 joules
Ans: d
187. The capacitor preferred for high circuits is
(a) air capacitor
(b) mica capacitor
(c) electrolytic capacitor
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
188. The capacity of capacitor bank used in power factor correction is expressed in terms of
(a) kW
(b) kVA
(c) kVAR
(d) volts
Jo
Ans: c
in
189. While testing a capacitor with ohm-metre, if the capacitor shows charging, but the final
@
resistance reading is appreciably less than normal, it can be concluded that the capacitor is
SP
(a) short-circuited
P
(c) alright
B
TE
(d) leaky
C
H
-T
el
28 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
190. If a 6 mF capacitor is charged to 200 V, the charge in coulombs will be
(a) 800 uC
(b) 900 uC
(c) 1200 uC
(d) 1600 uC
Ans: c
191. Which capacitor will be physically smaller for the same ratings ?
(a) Ceramic capacitor
(b) Paper capacitor
(c) Both will be of equal size
(d) None of the above
Ans: a
192. What is the value of capacitance that must be connected in parallel with 50 pF condenser to
make an equivalent capacitance of 150 pF ?
(a) 50 pF
(b) 100 pF
(c) 150 pF
(d) 200 pF
Ans: b
193. A mica capacitor and a ceramic capacitor both have the same physical dimensions. Which
will have more value of capacitance ?
(a) Ceramic capacitor
(b) Mica capacitor
(c) Both will have identical value of capacitance
(d) It depends on applied voltage
Ans: a
194. Which of the following material has least value of dielectric constant ?
(a) Ceramics
(b) Oil
(c) Glass
(d) Paper
Ans: b
Jo
195. Which of the following capacitors will have the least value of breakdown voltage ?
in
(a) Mica
@
(b) Paper
SP
(c) Ceramic
P
(d) Electrolytic
U
B
TE
Ans: d
C
H
-T
el
29 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
196. The breakdown voltage for paper capacitors is usually
(a) 20 to 60 volts
(b) 200 to 1600 volts
(c) 2000 to 3000 volts
(d) more than 10000 volts
Ans:b
197. Dielectric constant for mica is nearly
(a) 200
(b) 100
(c) 3 to 8
(d) 1 to 2
Ans: c
198. The value of dielectric constant for vacuum is taken as
(a) zero
(b) 1
(c) 4
(d) 10
Ans: b
Ans: d
200. Which of the following capacitors can be used for temperature compensation ?
(a) Air capacitor
(b) Ceramic capacitor
(c) Paper capacitor
(d) None of the above
Ans: b
201. Which of the following statements is incorrect ?
(a) The thinner the dielectric, the more the capacitance and the lower the voltage breakdown
Jo
(b) A six dot mica capacitor colour coded white, green, black, red and yellow has the capacitance
@
value of 500 pF
SP
(c) Capacitors in series provide less capacitance but a higher voltage breakdown rating for the
P
combination
U
(d) A capacitor can store charge because it has a dielectric between two conductors
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
30 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: b
202. Paper capacitors usually have a tolerance of
(a) ± 5% (b) ± 10% (c) ± 15% (d) ± 20%
Ans: b
203. For closer tolerances which of the following capacitors is usually preferred ?
(a) Paper capacitor
(b) Mica capacitor
(c) Ceramic disc capacitor
(d) None of the above
Ans: b
204. The electrostatic force between two charges of one coulomb each and placed at a distance
of
0.5 m will be
(a) 36 x 10fa
(b) 36 x 107 N
(c) 36 x 108 N
(d) 36 x 109 N
Ans: d
205. The units of volume charge density are
(a) Coulomb/metre
(b) Coulomb/metre
(c) Coulomb/metre
(d) Coulomb/metre
Ans: c
206. "The surface integral of the normal component of the electric displacement D over any
closed surface equals the charge enclosed by the surface".
The above statement is associated with
(a) Gauss's law
(b) Kirchhoff s law
(c) 's law
(d) Lenz's law
Ans: a
Jo
(a) 10 to 20 kV/mm
@
(6) 30 to 50 kV/mm
SP
Ans: c
C
H
-T
el
31 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
208. The dielectric constant (relative permittivity) of glass is given by (a) 0.1 to 0.4
(b) 0.5 to 1.0(c) 2.0 to 4.0 (d) 5 to 100
Ans: d
209 capacitors are mainly used for radio frequency tuning.
(a) Paper
(b) Air
(c) Mica
(d) Electrolytic
Ans: b
210. capacitors can be used only for D.C.
(a) Air
(b) Paper
(c) Mica
(d) Electrolytic
Ans: d
211. capacitors are used in transistor circuits.
(a) Ceramic
(b) Paper
(c) Air
(d) Electrolytic
Ans: a
212. capacitors are used for audio frequency and radio frequency coupling and tuning.
(a) Air
(b) Mica
(c) Plastic film
(d) Ceramic
Ans: b
213. The inverse of capacitance is called
(a) reluctance
(b) conductance
(c) susceptance
(d) elastance
Ans: d
Jo
(a) uniform
@
(b) non-uniform
SP
(c) zero
P
Ans: a
C
H
-T
el
32 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
215. The potential gradient across the material of low permittivity is than across the material of
high permittivity.
(a) smaller
(b) greater
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
216. field is associated with the capacitor.
(a) Electric
(b) Magnetic
(c) Both (a) and (b)
(d) None of the above
Ans: a
217. A capacitor having capacitance of 5 uF is charged to a potential difference of 10,000 V. The
energy stored in the capacitor is
(a) 50 joules
(b) 150 joules
(c) 200 joules
(d) 250 joules
Ans: d
218. A single core cable used on 33000 V has conductor diameter 10 mm and the internal
diameter of sheath 25 mm. The maximum electrostatic stress in the cable is
(a) 62 x 105 V/m
(b) 72 x 105 V/m
(c) 82 x 105 V/m
(d) 92 x 105 V/m
Ans: b
219. Two infinite parallel plates 10 mm apart have maintained between them a potential
difference of 100 V. The acceleration of an electron placed between them is
(a) 0.56 x 1015 m/s2
(b) 1.5 x 1015 m/s2
(c) 1.6 x 1015 m/s2
(d) 1.76 x 1015 m/s2
Jo
in
Ans: d
@
(a) current
P
(b) voltage
U
(d) charge
C
H
-T
el
33 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
221. The relative permittivity has the following units
(a) F/m
(b) m/F
(c) Wb/m
(d) no units
Ans: c
222. The phenomenon of an uncharged body getting charged merely by the nearness of a charged
body is known as
(a) pholoelectric effect
(b) chemical effect
(c) magnetic effect
(d) induction
Ans: d
223. A unit tube of flux is known as tube
(a) Newton
(b) Faraday
(c) Michale
(d) None of the above
Ans: b
224. The number of Faraday tubes of flux passing through a surface in an electric field is called
(a) electric flux
(6) electric flux density
(c) magnetic flux density
(d) electric charge density
Ans: a
225. The unit of electric intensity is
(a) N/C2
(b) Wb/m2
(c) N/C
(d) N2/C
Ans:c
226. The value of E within the field due to a point charge can be found with the help of
Jo
Ans: c
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
34 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
227. at a point may be defined as equal to the lines of force passing normally through a unit cross
section at that point.
(a) Electric intensity
(6) Magnetic flux density
(c) Electric flux
(d) None of the above
Ans: a
228. Electric intensity at any point in an electric field is equal to the at that point.
(a) electric flux
(b) magnetic flux density
(c) potential gradient
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
229. Electric displacement is a quantity.
(a) scalar
(b) vector
(c) both of the above
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
230. at a point is equal to the negative potential gradient at that point.
(a) Electric intensity
(6) Electric flux
(c) Magnetic flux
(d) Magnetic flux density
Ans: a
231. The unit of dielectric strength is given by
(a) V/m
(b) V2/m
(c) m/V
(d) m/V2
Ans: a
232. Dielectric strength with increasing thickness
(a) increases
Jo
(b) decreases
in
Ans: b
U
(a) capacitance
(b) charge
C
H
-T
el
35 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) energy
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
234. is that property of a capacitor which delays any change of voltage across it.
(a) Inductance
(b) Capacitance
(c) Potential gradient
(d) None of the above
Ans: b
235. A capacitance of 100 pF is connected in series with a resistance of 8000 ohm. The time
constant of the circuit is
(a) 0.2 s
(b) 0.4 s
(c) 0.6 s
(d) 0.8 s
Ans: d
236. In a cable capacitor, voltage gradient is maximum at the surface of the
(a) earth
(b) conduction
(c) sheath
(d) insulator
Ans: b
237. The time constant of an R-C circuit is defined as the time during which capacitor charging
voltage actually rises to _ percent of its value.
(a) 37, initial
(b) 63.2, initial
(c) 63.2, final
(d) 37, final
Ans: c
238. The time constant and R-C circuit may also be defined as the time during which the
charging current falls to percent of its initial maximum value,
(a) 37
(b) 42
Jo
(c) 63
in
(d) 73
@
SP
Ans: a
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
36 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
239. The capacitance of a capacitor is influenced by
(a) plate area
(b) plate separation
(c) nature of dielectric
(d) none of the above
(e) all of the above
Ans:e
240. A capacitor consists of two
(a) ceramic plates and one mica disc
(b) insulators separated by a dielectric
(c) silver-coated insulators
(d) conductors separated by an insulator
Ans: d
241. Permittivity is expressed in
(a) Farad/sq-m
(b) Farad/metre
(c) Weber/metre
(d) Weber/sq-m
Ans: b
242. Dielectric strength of a material depends on
(a) moisture content
(b) temperature
(c) thickness
(d) all of the above
(e) none of the above
Ans: d
243. What will happen to an insulating medium if voltage more than the breakdown voltage is
applied on it ?
(a) It will become magnetic
(b) It will melt
(c) It will get punctured or cracked
(d) Its molecular structure will get changed
Jo
Ans: c
in
(b) Quartz
P
(c) Glass
U
(d) Air
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
37 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
245. 1 volt/metre is same as
(a) 1 metre/coulomb(6) 1 newton metre(c) 1 newton/metre(d) 1 joule/coulomb
Ans: c
246. One volt is the same as
(a) one joule/coulomb
(b) one coulomb/joule
(c) one coulomb
(d) one joule
Ans: a
247. The capacitance between two plates increases with
(a) shorter plate area and higher applied voltage
(6) shorter plate area and shorter distance between them
(c) larger plate area, longer distance between plates and higher,applied voltage
(d) larger plate area and shorter distance between plates
Ans: d
248. The capacitance C is charged through a resistance R. The time constant of the charging
circuit is given by
(a) CIR
(b) 1/RC
(c) RC
(d) RIC
Ans: c
249. The bridge used for the measurement of the value of the capacitance is
(a) Wien's bridge
(b) Wheatstone bridge
(c) Schering bridge
(d) Hay's bridge
Ans: c
250. If an ohmmeter reading immediately goes practically to zero and stays there, capacitor is
(a) charged
(b) short-circuited
(c) lossy
Jo
(d) satisfactory
in
@
Ans: b
SP
251. Out of the following capacitors of identical rating which one will have the smallest
P
dimensions ?
U
38 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) Ceramic capacitor
(d) Paper capacitor
Ans: c
252. An uncharged conductor is placed near a charged conductor, then
(a) the uncharged conductor gets charged by conduction
(6) the uncharged conductor gets charged by induction and then attracted towards the charging
body
(c) the uncharged conductor is attracted first and then charged by induction
(d) it remains as such
Ans: b
253. The presence of an uncharged conductor near a charged one increases the
(a) charge of the charged conductor
(6) capacity of the charged conductor
(c) potential of the charged conductor
(d) all of the above
Ans: b
254. Paper condenser is
(a) always polarised
(6) usually of fixed value
(c) electrolytic condenser
(d) a variable condenser
Ans: b
255. Mica capacitors are characterised by all of thte following except
(a) stable operation
(b) accurate value
(c) low leakage reactance
(d) low losses
Ans: c
256. A potential of 400 V is applied to a capacitor, the plates of which are 4 mm apart. The
strength of electric field is
(a) 100 kV/m
(b) 10 kV/m
(c) 5 kV/m
Jo
(d) 2 kV/m
in
@
Ans: a
SP
(a) show low resistance momentarily and back off to a very high resistance
U
(6) show high resistance momentarily and then a very low resistance
B
TE
39 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: a
258. The ohmmeter reading for a short circuited capacitor is
(a) infinity
(b) few kilo ohms
(c) few megaahms
(d) zero
Ans: d
259. Which of the following statements is correct ?
(a) Mica capacitors are available in capacitance values of 5 to 20 \iF
(b) Air capapitors have a black band to indicate the outside foil
(c) Electrolytic capacitors must be connected in correct polarity
(d) Ceramic capacitors must be connected in correct polarity
Ans: c
260. Which of the following capacitors preferred for high frequency circuits ?
(a) Air capacitor (b) Electrolytic capacitor (c) Mica capacitor (d) none of the above
Ans: c
261. An electrolytic capacitor is generally made to provide
(a) low capacitance
(b) fixed capacitance
(c) variable capacitance
(d) large value of capacitance
Ans: d
262. In order to remove static electricity from machinery
(a) construct insulated cabins
(b) insulate the machinery
(c) ground the framework
(d) humidify the surroundings
Ans: c
263. If a third equal and similar charge is placed between two equal and similar charges, then
this third charge will
(a) move out of the field of influence of the two charges
(b) remain in stable equilibrium
(c) not be in equilibrium
Jo
Ans: b
SP
40 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: a
265. The minimum value of potential gradient in a cable occurs in
(a) insulation
(b) conductor
(c) outer sheath
(d) uniformly all over
Ans: a
266. Dielectric strength of medium
(a) increases with rise in temperature
(b) increases with moisture content
(c) is same for all insulating materials
(d) none of the above
Ans: d
267. Acharge which when placed in vacuum from an equal and similar charge repels with a force
of 9 x 10 N, is known as
(a) milli-coulomb
(b) micro-coulomb
(c) pico-coulomb
(d) coulomb
Ans: b
268. Dielectric strength of a medium is usually expressed in
(a) J/mm (b) C/m2 (c) kV/mm (d) N/mm
Ans: c
269. A positive and a negative charge are initially 50 mm apart. When they are moved close
together so that they are now only 10 mm apart, the force between them will be
(a) 5 times smaller than before
(b) 5 times greater than before
(c) 10 times greater than before
(d) 25 times larger than before
Ans: d
(b) Glass
in
(c) Bakelite
@
(d) Paper
SP
P
Ans: c
U
(a) decreases
(b) increases
C
H
-T
el
41 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) reduces to zero
(d) remain unchanged
Ans: a
272. To prevent the generation of static charges on rubber or flat leather
(a) surface is moistened
(b) conductive dressing is done
(c) oil compound dressing is done
(d) talcum powder is sprayed on the surface
Ans: b
273. Which of the following capacitor is preferred in case of single phase motor ?
(a) Mica capacitor
(b) Paper capacitor
(c) Electrolytic capacitor
(d) Ceramic capacitor
Ans: c
274. A capacitance is a circuit component that opposes the change in circuit
(a) current
(b) voltage
(c) impedance
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
275. A condenser suitable for D.C. only is
(a) metallic plate variable gang condenser
(b) metallic paper capacitor
(c) oil impregrated paper condenser
(d) poled aluminium electrolytic condenser
Ans: d
276. In a capacitor, the electric charge is stored in
(a) metal plates (b) dielectric
(c) dielectric as well as metal plates (d) none of the above
Ans: b
277. An air gap is usually inserted in magnetic circuits to
Jo
Ans: c
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
42 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
278. The relative permeability of a ferromagnetic material is
(a) less than one
(b) more than one
(c) more than 10
(d) more than 100 or 1000
Ans: d
279. The unit of magnetic flux is
(a) henry
(b) weber
(c) ampereturn/weber
(d) ampere/metre
Ans: b
280. Permeability in a magnetic circuit corresponds to in an electric circuit.
(a) resistance
(b) resistivity
(c) conductivity
(d) conductance
Ans: c
281. Point out the wrong statement.
Magnetic leakage is undesirable in electric machines because it
(a) lowers their power efficiency
(b) increases their cost of
(c) leads to their increased weight
(d) produces fringing
Ans: a
282. Relative permeability of vacuum is
(a) 1
(b) 1 H/m
(c) 1/4JI
(d) 4n x 10-' H/m
Ans: a
283. Permanent magnets are normally made of
(a) alnico alloys
Jo
(b) aluminium
in
Ans: a
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
43 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
284. Energy stored by a coil is doubled when its current is increased by percent.
(a) 25(b) 50 (c)41.4 (d) 100
Ans: c
285. Those magnetic materials are best suited for making armature and transformer cores which
have permeability and hystersis loss.
(a) high, high
(b) low, high
(c) high, low
(d) low, low
Ans: c
286. The rate of rise of current through an inductive coil is maximum
(a) at 63.2% of its maximum steady value
(b) at the start of the current flow
(c) after one time constant
(d) near the final maximum value of current
Ans: b
287. When both the inductance and resistance of a coil are doubled the value of
(a) time constant remains unchanged
(b) initial rate of rise of current is doubled
(c) final steady current is doubled
(d) time constant is halved
Ans: a
288. The initial rate of rise of current through a coil of inductance 10 H when suddenly
connected to a D.C. supply of 200 V is Vs
(a) 50 (b) 20 (c) 0.05 (d) 500
Ans: b
289. A material for good magnetic memory
(a) low hysteresis loss
(b) high permeability
(c) low retentivity
(d) high retentivity
Ans: d
Jo
(a) retentivity
@
(b) resistivity
SP
(c) permeability
P
(d) inductance
U
B
TE
Ans: c
C
H
-T
el
44 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
291. In a magnetic material hysteresis loss takes place primarily due to
(a) rapid reversals of its magnetization (b) flux density lagging behind magnetising force
(c) molecular friction (d) it high retentivity
Ans: d
292. Those materials are well suited for making permanent magnets which have retentivity and
coercivity.
(a) low, high
(b) high, high
(c) high, low
(d) low, low
Ans: b
293. If the area of hysteresis loop of a material is , the hysteresis loss in this material will be
(a) zero
(b) small
(c) large
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
294. Hard steel is suitable for making permanent magnets because
(a) it has good residual magnetism
(b) its hysteresis loop has large area
(c) its mechanical strength is high
(d) its mechanical strength is low
Ans: a
295. Silicon steel is used in electrical machines because it has
(a) low co-ercivity
(b) low retentivity
(c) low hysteresis loss
(d) high co-ercivity
Ans: c
296. Conductance is analogous to
(a) permeance
(b) reluctance
(c) flux
Jo
(d) inductance
in
@
Ans: a
SP
297. The property of a material which opposes the creation of magnetic flux in it is known as
P
(a) reluctivity
U
(c) permeance
(d) reluctance
C
H
-T
el
45 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
298. The unit of retentivity is
(a) weber
(b) weber/sq. m
(c) ampere turn/metre
(d) ampere turn
Ans: b
299. Reciprocal of reluctance is
(a) reluctivity
(b) permeance
(c) permeability
(d) susceptibility
Ans: b
300. While comparing magnetic and electric circuits, the flux of magnetic circuit is compared
with which parameter of electrical circuit ?
(a) E.m.f.
(b) Current
(c) Current density
(d) Conductivity
Ans: b
301. The unit of reluctance is
(a) metre/henry
(b) henry/metre
(c) henry
(d) 1/henry
Ans: d
302. A ferrite core has less eddy current loss than an iron core because
(a) ferrites have high resistance
(b) ferrites are magnetic
(c) ferrites have low permeability
(d) ferrites have high hysteresis
Ans: d
303. Hysteresis loss least depends on
(a) volume of material (b) frequency
Jo
Ans: d
SP
46 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: b
305. "The mass of an ion liberated at an electrode is directly proportional to the quantity of
electricity".The above statement is associated with
(a) Newton's law
(b) Faraday's law of electromagnetic
(c) Faraday's law of electrolysis
(d) Gauss's law
Ans: c
306. The charge required to liberate one gram equivalent of any substance is known as
constant
(a) time (b) Faraday's (c) Boltzman
Ans: b
307. During the charging of a lead-acid cell
(a) its voltage
(b) it gives out energy
(c) its cathode becomes dark chocolate brown in colour
(d) specific gravity of H2SO4 decreases
Ans: a
308. The capacity of a lead-acid cell does not depend on its
(a) temperature
(b) rate of charge
(c) rate of discharge
(d) quantity of active material
Ans: b
309. During charging the specific gravity of the electrolyte of a lead-acid battery
(a) increases
(b) decreases
(c) remains the same
(d) becomes zero
Ans: a
310. The active materials on the positive and negative plates of a fully charged lead-acid battery
are
(a) lead and lead peroxide
(b) lead sulphate and lead
Jo
Ans: c
P
310. When a lead-acid battery is in fully charged condition, the colour of its positive plate is
U
(b) brown
C
H
-T
el
47 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) dark brown
(d) none of above
Ans: c
311. The active materials of a nickel-iron battery are
(a) nickel hydroxide
(6) powdered iron and its oxide
(c) 21% solution of KOH (d) all of the above
Ans: d
312. The ratio of ampere-hour efficiency to watt-hour efficiency of a lead-acid cell is
(a) just one
(b) always greater than one
(c) always less than one
(d) none of the above.
Ans: b
313. The best indication about the state of charge on a lead-acid battery is given by
(a) output voltage
(b) temperature of electrolyte
(c) specific gravity of electrolyte
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
314. The storage battery generally used in electric power station is
(a) nickel-cadmium battery
(b) zinc-carbon battery
(c) lead-acid battery
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
315. The output voltage of a charger is
(a) less than the battery voltage
(b) higher than the battery voltage
(c) the same as the battery voltage
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
Jo
Ans: a
C
H
-T
el
48 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
317. Five 2 V cells are connected in parallel.The output voltage is
(a) 1 V (6) 1.5 V
(c) 1.75 V
(d) 2 V
Ans: d
318. The capacity of a battery is expressed in terms of
(a) current rating
(b) voltage rating
(e) ampere-hour rating
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
319. Duringthe charging and discharging of a nickel-iron cell
(a) corrosive fumes are produced
(b) water is neither formed nor absorbed
(c) nickel hydroxide remains unsplit
(d) its e.m.f. remains constant
Ans: b
320. As compared to constant-current system, the constant-voltage system of charging a lead
acid cell has the advantage of
(a) reducing time of charging
(b) increasing cell capacity
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) avoiding excessive gassing Ans: c
321. A dead storage battery can be revived by
(a) adding
(6) adding so-called battery restorer
(c) a dose of H2SO4
(d) none of the above
Ans: d
322. As compared to a lead-acid cell, the efficiency of a nickel-iron cell is less due to its
(a) compactness
(b) lower e.m.f.
(c) small quantity of electrolyte used
(d) higher internal resistance
Jo
in
Ans: d
@
49 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
324. Those substances of the cell which take active part in chemical combination and hence
produce electricity during
charging or discharging are known as materials.
(a) passive (b) active (c) redundant (d) inert
Ans: b
325. In a lead-acid cell dilute sulphuric acid (electrolyte) approximately comprises the following
(a) one part H2O, three parts H2SO4
(b) two parts H2O, two parts H2SO4
(c) three parts H2O, one part H2SO4
(d) all H2S04
Ans: c
326. It is noticed that durmg charging
(a) there is a rise in voltage
(6) energy is absorbed by the cell
(c) specific gravity of H2SO4 is increased
(d) the anode becomes chocolate brown in colour (PbCfe) and cathode becomes grey metallic
lead (Pb)
(e) all of the above
Ans: e
327. It is noticed that during discharging the following does not happen
(a) both anode and cathode become PbS04
(b) specific gravity of H2SO4 decreases
(c) voltage of the cell decreases
(d) the cell absorbs energy
Ans: d
328. The ampere-hour efficiency of a leadacid cell is normally between
(a) 20 to 30%
(b) 40 to 50%
(c) 60 to 70%
(d) 90 to 95%
Ans: d
Jo
(a) 25 to 35%
@
(b) 40 to 60%
SP
(c) 70 to 80%
P
(d) 90 to 95%
U
B
TE
Ans: c
330. The capacity of a lead-acid cell is measured in
C
H
-T
el
50 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(a) amperes
(b) ampere-hours
(c) watts
(d) watt-hours
Ans: b
331. The capacity of a lead-acid cell depends on
(a) rate of discharge
(b) temperature
(c) density of electrolyte
(d) quantity of active materials
(e) all above
Ans: e
332. When the lead-acid cell is fully charged, the electrolyte assumes _ appearance
(a) dull
(b) reddish
(c) bright
(d) milky
Ans: d
333. The e.m.f. of an Edison cell, when fully charged, is nearly
(a) 1.4 V
(b) 1 V
(c) 0.9 V
(d) 0.8 V
Ans: a
334. The internal resistance of an alkali cell is nearly times that of the lead- acid cell.
(a) two
(b) three
(c) four
(d) five
Ans: d
335. The average charging voltage for alkali cell is about
(a) 1 V
(b) 1.2 V
Jo
(c) 1.7 V
in
(d) 2.1 V
@
SP
Ans: c
P
(a) 40%
B
TE
(b) 60%
C
H
-T
el
51 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) 70%
(d) 80%
Ans: d
337. The active material of the positive plates of silver-zinc batteries is
(a) silver oxide
(b) lead oxide (c) lead (d) zinc powder
Ans: a
338. Lead-acid cell has a life of nearly charges and discharges
(a) 500 (b) 700 (c) 1000 (d) 1250
Ans: d
339. Life of the Edison cell is at least
(a) five years
(b) seven years
(c) eight years
(d) ten years
Ans: a
340. The internal resistance of a lead-acid cell is that of Edison cell
(a) less than
(b) more than
(c) equal to
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
341. Electrolyte used in an Edison cell is
(a) NaOH
(b) KOH
(c) HC1
(d) HN03
Ans: b
342. Electrolyte used in a lead-acid cell is
(a) NaOH
(b) onlyH2S04
(c) only water
Jo
Ans: d
SP
(a) copper
U
(b) lead
B
TE
(c) iron
(d) silver oxide
C
H
-T
el
52 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: c
344. The open circuit voltage of any storage cell depends wholly upon
(a) its chemical constituents
(b) on the strength of its electrolyte
(c) its temperature (d) all above
Ans: d
345. The specific gravity of electrolyte is measured by
(a) manometer
(6) a mechanical gauge
(c) hydrometer
(d) psychrometer
Ans: c
346. When the specific gravity of the electrolyte of a lead-acid cell is reduced to
1.1 to 1.15 the cell is in
(a) charged state
(b) discharged state
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) active state
Ans: b
347. In system the charging current is intermittently controlled at either a maximum or
minimum value
(a) two rate charge control
(b) trickle charge
(c) floating charge
(d) an equalizing charge
Ans: a
348. Over charging
(a) produces excessive gassing
(b) loosens the active material
(e) increases the temperature resulting in buckling of plates
(d) all above
Ans: d
349. Undercharging
Jo
Ans: a
B
TE
53 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(b) excess accumulation of sediment at the bottom of the cell
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
351. The effect of sulphation is that the internal resistance
(a) increases (b) decreases(c) remains same (d) none of the above
Ans: a
352. Excessive formation of lead sulphate on the surface of the plates happens
because of
(a) allowing a battery to stand in discharged condition for a long time
(b) topping up with electrolyte
(c) persistent undercharging
(d) low level of electrolyte
(e) all above
Ans: e
353. The substances which combine together to store electrical energy during the charge are
called materials
(a) active
(b) passive
(c) inert
(d) dielectric
Ans: a
354. In a lead-acid cell, lead is called as
(a) positive active material
(b) negative active material
(c) passive material
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
355. The lead-acid cell should never be discharged beyond
(a) 1.8 V
(b) 1.9 V
(c) 2 V
(d) 2.1 V
Jo
in
Ans: a
@
54 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
357. Each cell has a vent cap
(a) to allow gases out when the cell is on charge
(b) to add water to the cell if needed
(c) to check the level of electrolyte
(d) to do all above functions
Ans: d
358. Following will occur if level of electrolyte falls below plates
(a) capacity of the cell is reduced
(b) life of the cell is reduced
(c) open plates are converted to lead sulphate
(d) all above
Ans: d
359. In constant voltage charging method, the charging current from discharged to fully charged
condition
(a) decreases
(b) increases
(c) remains constant
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
360. 48 ampere-hour capacity would deliver a current of
(a) 48 amperes for 1 hour
(b) 24 amperes for 2 hours
(c) 8 amperes for 6 hours
(d) 6 amperes for 8 hours
Ans: d
361. In constant-current charging method, the supply voltage from discharged to fully charged
condition
(a) decreases
(b) increases
(c) remains constant
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
Jo
Ans: d
C
H
-T
el
55 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
363. Following will happen if the specific gravity of electrolyte becomes more than 1.23.
(a) Loss of capacity
(b) Loss of life
(c) Corrosion of the grids of the plate
(d) All above
Ans: d
364. Batteries are charged by
(a) rectifiers
(b) engine generator sets
(c) motor generator sets
(d) any one of the above methods
Ans: d
Ans: d
366. Internal resistance of a cell is reduced by
(a) using vent plug to permit gas formed during discharge
(b) increasing the plate area
(c) putting plates very close together
(d) all above methods
Ans: d
367. Capacity of dry cells is
(a) more when it is supplying current for intermittent periods
(b) more when it is supplying current for continuous periods
(c) unaffected by the type of discharge
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
368. Battery container should be acid resistance, therefore it is made up of
(a) glass
Jo
(b) plastic
in
(c) wood
@
Ans: d
U
56 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) the low voltage of the cell on discharge
(d) all above conditions
Ans: d
370. In a lead-acid cell, if the specific gravity of sulphuric acid is 1.8, it will require following
ratio of acid towater to get mixture of specific gravity of 1.3
(a) 6 parts of acid to 4 parts of water
(b) 4 parts of acid to 4 parts of water
(c) 4 parts of acid to 6 parts of water
(d) 4 parts of acid to 8 parts of water
Ans: c
371. Local action in a battery is indicated by
(a) excessive gassing under load conditions
(b) excessive drop in the specific gravity of electrolyte even when the cell is on open circuit
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: d
372. Following will happen if battery charging rate is too high
(a) excessive gassing will occur
(b) temperature rise will occur
(c) bulging and buckling of plates will occur
(d) all above will occur
Ans: d
373. Internal resistance of a cell is due to
(a) resistance of electrolyte
(b) electrode resistance
(c) surface contact resistance between electrode and electrolyte
(d) all above
Ans: d
Ans: d
SP
375. In order that a hydrometer may float vertically in electrolyte its C.G. should be
P
(a) lowered
U
(b) raised
B
TE
(c) undisturbed
(d) displaced sideways
C
H
-T
el
57 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: a
376. If a lead-acid cell is discharged below 1.8 V the following will happen.
(a) Capacity of cell will reduce
(b) Sulphation of plates will occur
(c) Internal resistance will increase
(d) All above will occur
Ans: d
377. Life of the batteries is in the following ascending order.
(a) Lead-acid cell, Edison cell, Nickel cadmium cell
(b) Lead-acid cell, Nickel-cadmium cell, Edison cell
(c) Edison cell, Nickel-cadmium cell, lead-acid cell
(d) Nickel-cadmium cell, Edison cell, lead-acid cell
Ans: a
378. Persons preparing electrolyte should wear
(a) goggles or other face shield
(b) rubber
(c) rubber boots and gloves
(d) all above safety devices
Ans: d
379. Excessive charging a battery tends to
(a) produce gassing
(b) increase the internal resistance of the battery
(c) to corrode the positive plates into lead peroxide thereby weakening them physically
(d) bring about all above changes
Ans: d
380. Shelf life of a small dry cell is
(a) equal to that of large dry cell
(6) less than that of large dry cell
(c) more than that of large dry cell
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
381. The current flow through electrolyte is due to the movement of
(a) ions
Jo
(b) holes
in
(c) electrons
@
Ans: a
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
58 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
382. Level of electrolyte in a cell should be the level of plates
(a) below
(b) equal to
(c) above
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
383. During discharge, the active material of both the positive and negative plates is changed to
(a) Pb
(b) Pb02
(c) PbO
(d) PbS04
Ans: d
384. of electrolytelndicates the state of charge of the battery
(a) colour
(b) mass
(c) viscosity
(d) specific gravity
Ans: d
385. The following indicate that battery on charge has attained full charge
(a) colour of electrode
(b) gassing
(c) specific gravity
(d) all above
Ans: d
386. Dry cell is modification of
(a) Deniell cell
(b) Leclanche cell
(e) Lead-acid cell
(d) Edison cell
Ans: b
387. Capacity of a battery.is expressed in
(a) Ah
(b) Vh
Jo
(c) Wh
in
(d) kWh
@
SP
Ans: a
P
59 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) NaOH
(d) KOH
Ans: d
389. Self charge of a Ni-Fe cell is Edison cell.
(a) equal to
(b) less than
(c) more than
(d) much more than
Ans: b
390. Ampere hour capacity of an industrial battery is based on hours discharge rate.
(a) 8
(b) 12
(c) 16
(d) 24
Ans: a
391. The body of Edison cell is made of
(a) bakelite
(b) rubber
(c) nickel plated steel
(d) aluminium
Ans: c
392. Specific gravity of electrolyte in Edison cell is
(a) 0.8 (b) 0.95
(c) 1.1 (d) 1.21
Ans: d
393. All the electrical connections between the battery and vehicle should be by
(a) thin aluminium wires
(b) thin copper wires
(c) rigid cables
(d) flexible cables
Ans: d
394. A battery of 6 cells will show a drop of volts from fully charged state to fully discharged
Jo
state.
in
(a) 1.0
@
(b) 1.5
SP
(c) 2.4
P
(d) 2.9
U
B
TE
Ans: c
C
H
-T
el
60 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
395. During the idle period of the battery, strong electrolyte tends to change the active material
of the cell into
(a) Pb02
(6) PbSC-4
(c) PbO
(d) Pb
Ans: b
396. Chargmg of sulphated battery produces heat.
(a) no
(b) very little
(c) less
(d) more
Ans: d
397. Hydrogen evolved during charging produces explosive mixture when it is more than
(a) 2%
(b) 4%
(c) 6%
(d) 8%
Ans: d
398. Weston standard cell at 20°C has voltage of volts.
(a) 0.8
(b) 0.9
(c) 1.0187
(d) 1.5
Ans: c
399. Extent of corrosion in the underground metal work depends upon
(a) amount of moisture
(b) type of metals
(c) type of soil chemicals
(d) all above factors
Ans: d
400. Mercury cell has which of the following characteristics ?
(a) Flat discharge current-voltage curve
Jo
(c) Comparatively longer shelf life under adverse conditions of high temperature and humidity
@
Ans: d
U
61 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) damage to separators, cell caps covers and battery case due to excessive temperature
(d) all above
Ans: d
402. Short circuiting of a cell may be caused
(a) buckling of plates
(b) faulty separators
(c) lead particles forming circuit between positive and negative plates
(d) excessive accumulation of sediment
(e) any one of above
Ans: e
403. In a battery cover is placed over the element and sealed to the top of the battery container.
This is done
(a) to reduce evaporation of water from electrolyte
(b) to exclude dirt and foreign matter from the electrolyte
(c) to discharge both of the above functions
(d) to discharge none of the above functions
Ans: c
404. For a cell to work, which of the following condition(s) become necessary ?
(a) Two electrodes of different meta's should be inserted in the electrolyte, not touching each
other
(b) Electrolyte must chemically react with one of the electrodes
(c) Electrolyte liquid or paste should be conducting
(d) All above three conditions are necessary
Ans: d
405. Which of the following primary cells has the lowest voltage ?
(a) Lithium
(b) Zinc-chloride
(c) Mercury
(d) Carbon-zinc
Ans: c
406. Which of the following primary cells has the highest voltage ?
(a) Manganese-alkaline
(6) Carbon-zinc
Jo
(c) Lithium
in
(d) Mercury
@
SP
Ans: c
P
62 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: b
408. Which of the following battery is used for air-craft ?
(a) Lead-acid battery
(b) Nickel-iron battery
(c) Dry cell battery
(d) Silver oxide battery
Ans: b
409. Which of the following cell has a. reversible chemical reaction ?
(a) Lead-acid
(b) Mercury oxide
(c) Carbon-zinc
(d) Silver-oxide
Ans: a
410. Which of the following is incorrect ?
(a) A storage cell has a reversible chemical reaction
(b) A lead-acid cell can be recharged
(c) A carbon-zinc cell has unlimited shelf life
(d) A primary cell has an irreversible chemical reaction
Ans: c
411. Which of the following has lower sp. gravity V
(a) Dilute H2S04
(6) Concentrated H2SO4
(c) Water
(d) Any of the above
Ans: c
412. Under normal charging rate, the charging current should be
(a) 10% of capacity
(b) 20% of capacity
(c) 30% of capacity
(d) 40% of capacity
Ans: a
413. When two batteries are connected in parallel, it should be ensured that
(a) they have same e.m.f.
Jo
Ans: a
U
(a) 0.1V
(b) 0.26 V
C
H
-T
el
63 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) 1.1 V
(d) 2 V
Ans: b
415. Petroleum jelly is applied to the electrical connections to the lead-acid battery
(a) prevent local heating
(b) prevent short-circuiting
(c) reduce path resistance
(d) prevent corrosion
Ans: d
416. When the load resistance equals the generator resistance which of the following will be
maximum ?
(a) Current
(b) Efficiency of the circuit
(c) Power in the load resistance
(d) Voltage across the load resistance
Ans: c
417. The common impurity in the electrolyte of lead-acid battery is
(a) chlorine
(b) dust particles
(c) lead crystals
(d) iron
Ans: d
418. In a lead-acid battery the energy is stored in the form of
(a) charged ions
(b) chemical energy
(c) electrostatic energy
(d) electromagnetic energy
Ans: b
419. Which among the following constitutes the major load for an ? (a)
(b) Self starter
(c) Parking lights
(d) Spark plugs
Jo
Ans: b
in
420. Which of the following factors adversely affects the capacity of the leadacid battery ?
@
Ans: d
C
H
-T
el
64 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
421. Cells are connected in parallel to
(a) increase the efficiency
(b) increase the current capacity
(c) increase the voltage output
(d) increase the internal resistance
Ans: b
422. A constant-voltage generator has
(a) minimum efficiency
(b) minimum current capacity
(c) low internal resistance
(d) high internal resistance
Ans: c
423. The property of coil by which a counter e.m.f. is induced in it when the current through the
coil changes is known as
(a) self-inductance
(b) mutual inductance
(c) series aiding inductance
(d) capacitance
Ans: a
424. As per Farada y's laws of electromagnetic induction, an e.m.f. is induced in a conductor
whenever it
(a) lies perpendicular to the magnetic flux
(b) lies in a magnetic field
(e) cuts magnetic flux
(d) moves parallel to the direction of the magnetic field
Ans: c
425. Which of the following circuit element stores energy in the electromagnetic field ?
(a) Inductance
(b) Condenser
(c) Variable resistor
(d) Resistance
Ans: a
426. The inductance of a coil will increase under all the following conditions except
(a) when more length for the same number of turns is provided
Jo
Ans: a
U
65 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) greater the flux produced by it
(d) longer the delay in establishing steady current through it
Ans: d
428. In an iron cored coil the iron core is removed so that the coil becomes an air cored coil. The
inductance of the coil will
(a) increase
(b) decrease
(c) remain the same
(d) initially increase and then decrease
Ans: b
429. An open coil has
(a) zero resistance and inductance
(b) infinite resistance and zero inductance
(c) infinite resistance and normal inductance
(d) zero resistance and high inductance
Ans: b
430. Both the number of turns and the core length of an inductive coil are doubled.
Its self-inductance will be
(a) unaffected
(b) doubled
(c) halved
(d) quadrupled
Ans: b
431. If current in a conductor increases then according to Lenz's law self-induced voltage will
(a) aid the increasing current
(b) tend to decrease the amount of cur-rent
(c) produce current opposite to the in-creasing current
(d) aid the applied voltage
Ans: c
432. The direction of incViced e.m.f. can be found by
(a) Laplace's law
(b) Lenz's law
(c) Fleming's right hand rule
Jo
Ans: b
SP
66 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: c
434. The magnitude of the induced e.m.f. in a conductor depends on the
(a) flux density of the magnetic field
(b) amount of flux cut
(c) amount of flux linkages
(d) rate of change of flux-linkages
Ans: d
Ans: d
436. A laminated iron core has reduced eddy-current losses because
(a) more wire can be used with less D.C. resistance in coil
(b) the laminations are insulated from each other
(c) the magnetic flux is concentrated in the air gap of the core
(d) the laminations are stacked vertf-cally
Ans: b
437. The law that the induced e.m.f. and current always oppose the cause producing them is due
to
(a) Faraday
(b) Lenz
(c) Newton
(d) Coulomb
Ans: b
438. Which of the following is not a unit of inductance ?
(a) Henry
(b) Coulomb/volt ampere
(c) Volt second per ampere
(d) All of the above
Ans: b
Jo
Ans: b
C
H
-T
el
67 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
440. Which of the following circuit elements will oppose the change in circuit current ?
(a) Capacitance
(b) Inductance
(c) Resistance
(d) All of the above
Ans: b
441. For a purely inductive circuit which of the following is true ?
(a) Apparent power is zero
(b) Relative power is.zero
(c) Actual power of the circuit is zero
(d) Any capacitance even if present in the circuit will not be charged
Ans: c
Ans: b
443. An e.m.f. of 16 volts is induced in a coil of inductance 4H. The rate of change of current
must be
(a) 64 A/s
(b) 32 A/s
(c) 16 A/s
(d) 4 A/s
Ans: d
444. The core of a coil has a length of 200 mm. The inductance of coil is 6 mH. If the core length
is doubled, all other quantities, remaining the same, the in ductance will be
(a) 3 mH
(b) 12 mH
(c) 24mH (d)48mH
Ans: a
445. The self inductances of two coils are 8 mH and 18 mH. If the co-efficients of coupling is
Jo
(a) 4 mH
@
(b) 5 mH
SP
(c) 6 mH
P
(d) 12 mH
U
B
TE
Ans: c
C
H
-T
el
68 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
446. Two coils have inductances of 8 mH and 18 mH and a co-efficient of coupling of 0.5. If the
two coils are connected in series aiding, the total inductance will be
(a) 32 mH
(b) 38 mH
(c) 40 mH
(d) 48 mH
Ans: b
447. A 200 turn coil has an inductance of 12 mH. If the number of turns is increased to 400
turns, all other quantities (area, length etc.) remaining the same, the inductance will be
(a) 6 mH
(b) 14 mH
(c) 24 mH
(d) 48 mH
Ans: d
448. Two coils have self-inductances of 10 H and 2 H, the mutual inductance being zero. If the
two coils are connected in series, the total inductance will be
(a) 6 H
(b) 8 H
(c) 12 H
(d) 24 H
Ans: c
449. In case all the flux from the current in coil 1 links with coil 2, the co-efficient of coupling
will be
(a) 2.0
(b) 1.0
(c) 0.5
(d) zero
Ans: b
450. A coil with negligible resistance has 50V across it with 10 mA. The inductive reactance is
(a) 50 ohms
(b) 500 ohms
(c) 1000 ohms
(d) 5000 ohms
Jo
Ans: d
in
451. A conductor 2 metres long moves at right angles to a magnetic field of flux density 1 tesla
@
with a velocity of 12.5 m/s. The induced e.m.f. in the conductor will be
SP
(a) 10 V
P
(6) 15 V
U
(c) 25V
B
TE
(d) 50V
C
H
-T
el
69 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: c
452. Lenz's law is a consequence of the law of conservation of
(a) induced current
(b) charge
(c) energy
(d) induced e.m.f.
Ans: c
453. A conductor carries 125 amperes of current under 60° to a magnetic field of 1.1 tesla. The
force on the conductor will be
nearly
(a) 50 N
(b) 120 N
(c) 240 N
(d) 480 N
Ans: b
454. Find the force acting on a conductor 3m long carrying a current of 50 amperes at right
angles to a magnetic field having a flux density of 0.67 tesla.
(a) 100 N
(b) 400 N
(c) 600 N
(d) 1000 N
Ans: a
455. The co-efficient of coupling between two air core coils depends on
(a) self-inductance of two coils only
(b) mutual inductance between two coils only
(c) mutual inductance and self inductance of two coils
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
456. An average voltage of 10 V is induced in a 250 turns solenoid as a result of a change in flux
which occurs in 0.5 second. The total flux change is
(a) 20 Wb
(b) 2 Wb
(c) 0.2 Wb
Jo
(d) 0.02 Wb
in
@
Ans: d
SP
457. A 500 turns solenoid develops an average induced voltage of 60 V. Over what time interval
P
(a) 0.01 s
B
TE
(b) 0.1 s
C
H
-T
el
70 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) 0.5 s
(d) 5 s
Ans: c
458. Which of the fpllowing inductor will have the least eddy current losses ?
(a) Air core
(b) Laminated iron core
(c) Iron core
(d) Powdered iron core
Ans: a
459. A coil induces 350 mV when the current changes at the rate of 1 A/s. The value of
inductance is
(a) 3500 mH
(b) 350 mH
(c) 250 mH
(d) 150 mH
Ans: b
460. Two 300 uH coils in series without mutual coupling have a total inductance of
(a) 300 uH
(b) 600 uH
(c) 150 uH
(d) 75 uH
Ans: b
Ans: c
462. Which circuit element(s) will oppose the change in circuit current ?
(a) Resistance only
(b) Inductance only
Jo
Ans: b
P
71 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) zero inductance
(d) reduced inductance
Ans: d
464. A coil is wound on iron core which carries current I. The self-induced voltage in the coil is
not affected by
(a) variation in coil current
(b) variation in voltage to the coil
(c) change of number of turns of coil
(d) the resistance of magnetic path
Ans: b
465. A moving magnetic field will produce the same effect as a conductor that is moving.
(a) Yes
(b) No
Ans:a
466. The polarity of the induced voltage can be determined by using the left-hand generator rule.
(a) Yes
(b) No
Ans: a
467. Increasing the field or increasing the current will decrease the force on the conductor.
(a) Yes
(b) No
Ans: b
468. Reversing the field or the current will reverse the force on the conductor.
(a) Yes
(b) No
Ans: a
469 When a conductor moves in the field, so that it makes an angle 8 with the lines of flux, the
force F is given as : F = Bl sin2 0.
(a) Yes
(b) No
Jo
Ans: b
in
470. The self-inductance of the coil may be defined as equal to the e.m.f. induced in volts when
@
the current in the circuit changes at the rate of unit weber turns.
SP
(a) Yes
P
(b) No
U
B
TE
Ans: b
C
H
-T
el
72 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
471. Laminations of core are generally made of
(a) case iron
(b) carbon
(c) silicon steel
(d) stainless steel
Ans: c
472. Which of the following could be lamina-proximately the thickness of lamina-tions of a D.C.
machine?
(a) 0.005 mm
(b) 0.05 mm
(c) 0.5 m
(d) 5 m
Ans: c
473. The armature of D.C. generator is laminated to
(a) reduce the bulk
(b) provide the bulk
(c) insulate the core
(d) reduce eddy current loss
Ans: d
474. The resistance of armature winding depends on
(a) length of conductor
(b) cross-sectional area of the conductor
(c) number of conductors
(d) all of the above
Ans: d
475. The field coils of D.C. generator are usually made of
(a) mica
(b) copper
(c) cast iron
(d) carbon
Ans: b
476. The commutator segments are connected to the armature conductors by means of
Jo
Ans: a
U
477. In a commutator
B
TE
73 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) mica is harder than copper
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
478. In D.C. generators the pole shoes are fastened to the pole core by
(a) rivets
(b) counter sunk screws
(c) brazing
(d) welding
Ans: b
479. According to Fleming's right-hand rule for finding the direction of induced e.m.f., when
middle finger points in the direction of induced e.m.f., forefinger will point in the direction of
(a) motion of conductor
(b) lines of force
(c) either of the above
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
480. Fleming's right-hand rule regarding direction of induced e.m.f., correlates
(a) magnetic flux, direction of current flow and resultant force
(b) magnetic flux, direction of motion and the direction of e.m.f. induced
(c) magnetic field strength, induced voltage and current
(d) magnetic flux, direction of force and direction of motion of conductor
Ans: b
481. While applying Fleming's right-hand rule to And the direction of induced e.m.f., the thumb
points towards
(a) direction of induced e.m.f.
(b) direction of flux
(c) direction of motion of the conductor if forefinger points in the direction of generated e.m.f.
(d) direction of motion of conductor, if forefinger points along the lines of flux
Ans: d
482. The bearings used to support the rotor shafts are generally
(a) ball bearings
(b) bush bearings
(c) magnetic bearmgs
Jo
Ans: a
SP
74 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
484. In lap winding, the number of brushes is always
(a) double the number of poles
(b) same as the number of poles
(c) half the number of poles
(d) two
Ans: b
485. For a D.C. generator when the number of poles and the number of armature conductors is
fixed, then which winding will give the higher e.m.f. ?
(a) Lap winding
(b) Wave winding
(c) Either of (a) and (b) above
(d) Depends on other features of design
Ans: b
486. In a four-pole D.C. machine
(a) all the four poles are north poles
(b) alternate poles are north and south
(c) all the four poles are south poles
(d) two north poles follow two south poles
Ans: b
487. Copper brushes in D.C. machine are used
(a) where low voltage and high currents are involved
(b) where high voltage and small cur-rents are involved
(c) in both of the above cases
(d) in none of the above cases
Ans: a
488. A separately excited generator as compared to a self-excited generator
(a) is amenable to better voltage con-trol
(b) is more stable
(c) has exciting current independent of load current
(d) has all above features
Ans: d
489. In case of D.C. machines, mechanical losses are primary function of
(a) current
(b) voltage
Jo
(c) speed
in
Ans: c
SP
(a) speed
U
(b) load
B
TE
(c) voltage
(d) speed and voltage
C
H
-T
el
75 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: b
491. In D.C. generators, current to the external circuit from armature is given through
(a) commutator
(b) solid connection
(c) slip rings
(d) none of above
Ans: a
492. Brushes of D.C. machines are made of
(a) carbon
(b) soft copper
(c) hard copper
(d) all of above
Ans: a
493. If B is the flux density, I the length of conductor and v the velocity of conductor, then
induced e.m.f. is given by
(a)Blv (b)Blv2 (c)Bl2v (d)Bl2v2
Ans: a
494. In case of a 4-pole D.C. generator provided with a two layer lap winding with sixteen coils,
the pole pitch will be
(a) 4
(b) 8
(c) 16
(d) 32
Ans: b
495. The material for commutator brushes is generally
(a) mica
(b) copper
(c) cast iron
(d) carbon
Ans: d
496. The insulating material used between the commutator segments is normally
(a) graphite
(b) paper
Jo
(c) mica
in
Ans: c
P
497. In D.C. generators, the brushes on commutator remain in contact with conductors which
U
76 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) lie under interpolar region
(d) are farthest from the poles
Ans: c
498. If brushes of a D.C. generator are moved in order to bring these brushes in magnetic neutral
axis, there will be
(a) demagnetisation only
(b) cross magnetisation as well as magnetisation
(c) crossmagnetisation as well as demagnetising
(d) cross magnetisation only
Ans: c
499. Armature reaction of an unsaturated D.C. machine is
(a) crossmagnetising
(b) demagnetising
(c) magnetising
(d) none of above
Ans: a
500. D.C. generators are connected to the busbars or disconnected from them only under the
floating condition
(a) to avoid sudden loading of the primemover
(b) to avoid mechanicaljerk to the shaft
(c) to avoid burning of switch contacts
(d) all above
Ans: d
501. Eddy currents are induced in the pole shoes of a D.C. machine due to
(a) oscillating magnetic field
(b) pulsating magnetic flux
(c) relative rotation between field and armature
(d) all above
Ans: c
502. In a D.C. machine, short-circuited field coil will result in
(a) odour of barning insulation
(b) unbalanced magnetic pull producing vibrations
(c) reduction of generated voltage for which excitation has to be increased to maintain the
Jo
voltage
in
Ans: d
P
77 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) delta wound
(d) duplex wound
Ans: b
504. Welding generator will have
(a) lap winding
(b) wave winding
(c) delta winding
(d) duplex wave winding
Ans: a
505. In case of D.C. machine winding, number of commutator segments is equal to
(a) number of armature coils
(b) number of armature coil sides
(c) number of armature conductors
(d) number of armature turns
Ans: a
506. For a D.C. machines laboratory following type of D.C. supply will be suitable
(a) rotary converter
(b) mercury are rectifier
(c) induction motor D.C. generator set
(d) synchronous motor D.C. generator set
Ans: c
507. The function of pole shoes in the case of D.C. machine is
(a) to reduce the reluctance of the magnetic path
(b) to spread out the flux to achieve uniform flux density
(c) to support the field coil
(d) to discharge all the above functions
Ans: d
508. In the case of lap winding resultant pitch is
(a) multiplication of front and back pitches
(b) division of front pitch by back pitch
(c) sum of front and back pitches
(d) difference of front and back pitches
Jo
Ans: d
in
Ans: a
C
H
-T
el
78 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
510. Which of the following statement about D.C. generators is false ?
(a) Compensating winding in a D.C. machine helps in commutation
(b) In a D. C. generator interpoles winding is connected in series with the armature winding
(c) Back pitch and front pitch are both odd and approximately equal to the pole pitch
(d) Equilizing bus bars are used with parallel running of D.C. shunt generators
Ans: d
511. The demagnetising component of armature reaction in a D.C. generator
(a) reduces generator e.m.f.
(b) increases armature speed
(c) reduces interpoles flux density
(d) results in sparking trouble
Ans: a
512. Magnetic field in a D.C. generator is produced by
(a) electromagnets
(b) permanent magnets
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
513. The number of brushes in a commutator depends on
(a) speed of armature
(b) type of winding
(c) voltage
(d) amount of current to be collected
Ans: d
514. Compensating windings are used in D.C. generators
(a) mainly to reduce the eddy currents by providing local short-circuits
(b) to provide path for the circulation of cooling air
(c) to neutralise the cross-magnetising effect of the armature reaction
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
515. Which of the following components of a D.C, generator plays vital role for providing direct
current of a D.C. generator ?
(a) Dummy coils
Jo
(b) Commutator
in
Ans: b
U
516. In a D.C. generator the ripples in the direct e.m.f. generated are reduced by
B
TE
79 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) using carbon brushes of superior quality
(d) using equiliser rings
Ans: c
517. In D.C. generators, lap winding is used for
(a) high voltage, high current
(b) low voltage, high current
(c) high voltage, low current
(d) low voltage, low current
Ans: b
518. Two generators A and B have 6-poles each. Generator A has wave wound armature while
generator B has lap wound armature. The ratio of the induced e.m.f. is generator A and B will be
(a) 2 : 3
(b) 3 : 1
(c) 3 : 2
(d) 1 : 3
Ans: b
519. The voltage drop for which of the following types of brush can be expected to be least ?
(a) Graphite brushes
(b) Carbon brushes
(c) Metal graphite brushes
(d) None of the above
Ans: c
520. The e.m.f. generated by a shunt wound D.C. generator isE. Now while pole flux remains , if
the speed of the generator is doubled, the e.m.f. generated will be
(a) E/2
(b) 2E
(c) slightly less than E
(d) E
Ans: b
521. In a D.C. generator the actual flux distribution depends upon
(a) size of air gap
(b) shape of the pole shoe
(c) clearance between tips of the adjacent pole shoes
Jo
Ans:d
SP
(b) copper
B
TE
80 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: a
523. Satisfactory commutation of D.C. machines requires
(a) brushes should be of proper grade and size
(b) brushes should smoothly run in the holders
(c) smooth, concentric commutator properly undercut
(d) all of the above
Ans: d
524. Open circuited armature coil of a D.C. machine is
(a) identified by the scarring of the commutator segment to which open circuited coil is
connected
(b) indicated by a spark completely around the commutator
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
525. In a D.C. machine, fractional pitch winding is used
(a) to increasethe generated voltage
(b) to reduce sparking
(c) to save the copper because of shorter end connections
(d) due to (b) and (c) above
Ans:
526. For the parallel operation of two or more D.C. compound generators, we should ensure that
(a) voltage of the incoming generator should be same as that of bus bar
(b) polarity of incoming generator should be same as that of bus bar
(c) all the series fields should be run in parallel by means of equilizer connection
(d) series fields of all generators should be either on positive side or negative side of the
armature
(e) all conditions mentioned above should be satisfied
Ans: d
527. D.C. series generator is used
(a) to supply traction load
(b) to supply industrial load at constant voltage
(c) voltage at the toad end of the feeder
(d) for none of the above purpose
Jo
Ans: c
in
528. Following D.C. generator will be in a position to build up without any magnetism in the
@
poles
SP
81 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
529. Interpole flux should be sufficient to
(a) neutralise the commutating self induced e.m.f.
(b) neutralise the armature reaction flux
(c) neutralise both the armature reaction flux as well as commutating e.m.f. induced in the coil
(d) perform none of the above functions
Ans: c
Ans: c
531. In a D.C. generator the number of mechanical degrees and electrical degrees will be the
same when
(a) r.p.m. is more than 300
(b) r.p.m. is less than 300
(c) number of poles is 4
(d) number of poles is 2
Ans: d
532. Permeance is the reciprocal of
(a) flux density
(b) reluctance
(c) ampere-turns
(d) resistance
Ans: b
533. In D.C. generators the polarity of the interpoles
(a) is the same as that of the main pole ahead
(b) is the same as that of the immediately preceding pole
(c) is opposite to that of the main pole ahead
(d) is neutral as these poles do not play part in generating e.m.f.
Ans: a
Jo
(a) flux/pole
@
Ans: b
C
H
-T
el
82 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
535. In a D.C. generator the magnetic neutral axis coincides with the geometrical neutral axis,
when
(a) there is no load on|he generator
(b) the generator runs on full load
(c) the generator runs on overload
(d) the generator runs on designed speed
Ans: a
536. In a D.C. generator in order to reduce sparking at brushes, the self-induced e.m.f. in the coil
is neutralised by all of the following except
(a) interpoles
(b) dummy coils
(c) compensating winding
(d) shifting of axis of brushes
Ans: b
537. In D.C. generators on no-load, the air gap flux distribution in space is
(a) sinusoidal
(b) triangular
(c) pulsating
(d) flat topped
Ans: d
538. A shunt generator running at 1000 r.p.m. has generated e.m.f. as 200 V. If the speed
increases to 1200 r.p.m., the generated e.m.f. will be nearly
(a) 150 V
(b) 175 V
(c) 240 V
(d) 290 V
Ans: c
539. The purpose of providing dummy coils in a generator is
(a) to reduce eddy current losses
(b) to enhance flux density
(c) to amplify voltage
(d) to provide mechanical balance for the rotor
Ans: d
Jo
Ans:
C
H
-T
el
83 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
541. If a D.C. generator fails to build up the probable cause could not be
(a) imperfect brush contact
(b) field resistance less than the critical resistance
(c) no residual magnetism in the generator
(d) faulty shunt connections tending to reduce the residual magnetism
Ans: b
542. Flashing the field of D.C. generator means
(a) neutralising residual magnetism
(b) creating residual magnetism by a D.C. source
(c) making the magnetic losses of forces parallel
(d) increasing flux density by adding extra turns of windings on poles
Ans: b
543. The e.m.f. induced in the armature of a shunt generator is 600 V. The armature resistance is
0.1 ohm. If the armature current is 200 A, the terminal voltage will be
(a) 640 V
(b) 620 V
(c) 600 V
(d) 580 V
Ans: d
544. In a D.C. generator the critical resistance refers to the resistance of
(a) brushes
(b) field
(c) armature
(d) load
Ans: b
545. To achieve sparkless commutation brushes of a D.C. generator are rockedm ahead so as to
bring them
(a) just ahead of magnetic neutral axis
(b) in magnetic neutral axis
(c) just behind the magnetic neutral axis
Ans: a
546. Armature coil is short circuited by brushes when it lies
(a) along neutral axis
Jo
Ans: a
U
547. A cumulatively compounded long shunt generator when operating as a motor would be
B
TE
84 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) cumulatively compounded short shunt
(d) differentially compounded short shunt
Ans: b
548. To avoid formation of grooves in the commutator of a D.C. machine
(a) the brushes of opposite polarity should track each other
(b) the brushes of same polarity should track each other
(c) brush position has no effect on the commutator grooving
Ans: a
549. The following constitute short-circuit in the armature winding.
(a) Insulation failure between two com-mutator bars
(6) Insulation failure between two turns of a coil
(c) Two of more turns of the same coil getting grounded
(d) All of the above
Ans: d
550. The rapid wear of brushes takes place due to
(a) abrasion from dust
(b) excessive spring pressure
(c) rough commutator bars
(d) high mica insulation between com-mutation bars
(e) all of the above factors
Ans: e
551. Number of tappings for each equilizer ring is equal to
(a) number of pole pairs
(b) number of poles
(c) number of parallel paths
(d) number of commutator segments
Ans: a
552. A D.C. generator can be considered as
(a) rectifier
(b) primemover
(c) rotating amplifier
(d) power pump
Jo
Ans: c
in
553. In any rotating machine that part which houses the conductors and in which e.m.f. induced
@
is to be utilised is called
SP
(a) rotor
P
(b) stator
U
(c) field
B
TE
(d) armature
C
H
-T
el
85 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
554. In a D.C. machine stray loss is the sum of
(a) total copper loss and mechanical loss
(b) armature copper loss and iron loss
(c) shunt field copper loss and mechanical loss
(d) iron loss and mechanical loss
Ans: d
555. Lap winding is composed of
(a) any even number of conductors
(b) any odd number of conductors
(c) that even number which is exact multiple of poles + 2
(d) that even number which is exact multiple of poles
Ans: a
556. In a D.C. generator in case the resistance of the field winding is increased, then output
voltage will
(a) increase
(b) decrease
(c) remain unaffected
(d) fluctuate heavily
Ans: b
557. An exciter for a turbo generator is a
(a) separately excited generator
(b) shunt generator
(c) series generator
(d) compound generator
Ans: b
558. In case of a flat compounded generator
(a) voltage generated is less than the rated voltage
(b) generated voltage is proportional to the load on the generator
(c) voltage remains constant irrespective of the load
(d) speed varies in proportion to the load on the generator
Ans: c
559. Which of the following generator will have negligible terminal voltage while running on
Jo
no-load ?
in
Ans: a
C
H
-T
el
86 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
560. Which of the following D.C. generators will be in a position to build up without any
residual magnetism in the poles ?
(a) Series generator
(b) Shunt generator
(c) Compound generator
(d) None of the above
Ans: d
561. In over compounded generator, full load terminal voltage is
(a) almost zero
(b) less than noload terminal voltage
(c) more than noload terminal voltage
(d) equal to no-load terminal voltage
Ans: c
562. In a level compounded D.C. generator, full load terminal voltage is
(a) negligibly low
(b) equal to no-load terminal voltage
(c) more than no-load terminal voltage
(d) less than no-load terminal voltage
Ans: b
563. The terminal voltage of a D.C. shunt generator drops on load because of all of the following
reasons except
(a) armature reaction
(b) armature resistance drop
(c) field weakening due to armature reaction and armature
(d) commutation
Ans: d
Ans: c
Jo
565. A sinusoidal voltage of 5 Hz is applied to the field of a shunt generator. The armature
in
voltage wave
@
(b) will be of 5 Hz
P
(c) willbeof5xiVHz
U
(d) will be of v Hz 5
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
87 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: b
566. A 220 V D.C. generator is run at full speed without any excitation. The open circuit voltage
will be
(a) zero
(b) about 2 V
(c) about 50 V
(d) 220 V
Ans: b
567. In a separately excited generator supplying rated load the armature reaction ,
(a) is always present
(b) is always absent
(c) may be sometimes present
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
568. If residual magnetism is present in a D.C. generator, the induced e.m.f. at zero speed will be
(a) zero
(b) small
(c) the same as rated voltage
(d) high
Ans: a
569. Armature reaction in a generator results in
(a) demagnetisation of leading pole tip and magnetisation of trailing pole tip
(b) demagnetisation of trailing pole tip and magnetisation of leading pole tip
(c) damagnetising the centre of all poles
(d) magnetising the centre of all poles
Ans: a
570. Following energized winding of a D.C. machine should not be opened as it would produce
high inductive voltage which may be dangerous to personnel and may cause its own insulation
failure.
(a) Series field
(b) Compensating field
(c) Inter pole field
(d) Shunt field
Ans: d
Jo
Ans: c
C
H
-T
el
88 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
572. The critical resistance of the D.C. generator is the resistance of
(a) field
(b) brushes
(c) armature
(d) load
Ans: a
573. When two D.C. series generators are running in parallel, an equilizer bar is used
(a) to increase the speed and hence generated e.m.f.
(b) to increase the series flux
(c) so that two similar machines will pass approximately equal currents to the load
(d) to reduce the combined effect of ar-mature reaction of both machines
Ans: c
574. Which of the following generating machine will offer constant voltage on all loads ?
(a) Self-excited generator
(b) Separately excited generator
(c) Level compounded generator .
(d) All of the above
Ans: c
575. Which of the following generators will be preferred if they are required to be run in parallel
(a) Shunt generators
(b) Series generators
(c) Compound generators
(d) None of the above
Ans: a
576. Two generators are running in parallel. One of the generators may run as motor for which of
the following reasons ?
(a) The direction of that generator is reversed
(b) The speed of that generator is increased
(c) The field of that generator is weakened
(d) That generator takes large share of loads Ans: d
577. A D.C. generator works on the principle of
(a) Lenz's law
(b) Ohm's law
(c) Faraday's law of electromagnetic induction
Jo
Ans: c
SP
89 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: b
579. A shunt generator can self-excite
(a) only if the resistance of the field circuit is less than critical value
(b) only if the resistance of the field circuit is critical value
(c) irrespective of the value of the resis-tance in the field circuit
Ans: a
580. The terminal voltage of a series generator is 150 V when the load current is 5 A. If the load
current is increased to 10 A, the terminal voltage will be
(a) 150 V
(b) less than 150 V
(c) greater than 150 V
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
581. The open circuit voltage of a compound generator is 250 V. At full load the terminal
voltage
(a) will be less than 250 V
(b) will always be 250 V
(c) may be greater or less than 250 V
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
582. Two D.C. shunt generators, each with armature resistance of 0.02 ohm and field resistance
of 50 ohm run in parallel and supply a total current of 1000 amperes to the load circuit. If their
e.m.fs. are 270 V and 265 V, their bus bar voltage will be
(a) 270 V (b) 267.5 V
(c) 265 V (d) 257.4 V
Ans: b
583. The essential condition for parallel operation of two D.C. generators is that they have '
(a) same kW rating
(b) the same operation r.p.m.
(c) the same drooping voltage charac-teristics
(d) same percentage regulation
Ans: c
584. When two D.C. generators are running in parallel an equilizer bar is used
Jo
(c) to reduce the combined effect of ar-mature reaction of both the machines
SP
(d) so that the two identical machines will pass approximately equal currents to the load
P U
Ans: d
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
90 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
585. With a D.C. generator which of the following regulation is preferred ?
(a) 100% regulation
(b) infinite regulation
(c) 50% regulation
(d) 1% regulation
Ans: d
586. Which generator would you prefer for feeding long D.C. transmission lines ?
(a) Series generator
(b) Shunt generator
(c) Over compound generator
(d) Flat compound generator
Ans: c
587. In a D.C. generator the critical resistance can be increased by
(a) increasing its field resistance
(b) decreasing its field resistance
(c) increasing its speed
(d) decreasing its speed
Ans: c
588. The number of armature parallel paths in a two-pole D.C. generator having duplex lap
winding is
(a) 2
(b) 4
(c) 6
(d) 8
Ans: b
589. For both lap and wave windings, there are as many commutator bars as the number of
(a) slots
(b) armature conductors
(c) winding elements
(d) poles
Ans: c
590. The series field of a short-shunt D.C. generator is excited by
(a) external current
Jo
Ans: d
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
91 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
591. As a result of armature reaction, the reduction in the total mutual air gap flux in a D.C.
generator is approximately
(a) 40 percent
(b) 25 percent
(c) 10 percent
(d) 5 percent
Ans: d
592. Shunt generators are most suited for stable parallel operation because of their
(a) rising voltage characteristics
(b) identical voltage characteristics
(c) drooping voltage characteristics
(d) linear voltage characteristics
Ans: c
593. The main factor which leads to unstable parallel operation of flat and over compounded
generators is
(a) their rising voltage characteristics
(b) unequal number of turns in their series field windings
(c) unequal speed regulation of their primemovers
(d) unequal series field resistances
Ans: a
594. If a self excited D.C. generator after being installed, fails to build up on its first trial run, the
first is to
(a) reverse the field connections
(b) increase the field resistance
(c) increase the speed of primemover
(d) check armature insulation resistance
Ans: a
Ans: b
Jo
Ans: b
C
H
-T
el
92 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
597. Which of the following application requires high starting torque ?
(a) Lathe machine
(b) Centrifugal pump
(c) Locomotive
(d) blower
Ans: c
598. If a D.C. motor is to be selected for conveyors, which rriotor would be preferred ?
(a) Series motor
(b) Shunt motor
(c) Differentially compound motor
(d) Cumulative compound motor
Ans: a
599. Which D.C. motor will be preferred for machine tools ?
(a) Series motor
(b) Shunt motor
(c) Cumulative compound motor
(d) Differential compound motor
Ans: b
600. Differentially compound D.C. motors can find applications requiring
(a) high starting torque
(b) low starting torque
(c) variable speed
(d) frequent on-off cycles
Ans: b
601. Which D.C. motor is preferred for elevators ?
(a) Shunt motor
(b) Series motor
(c) Differential compound motor
(d) Cumulative compound motor
Ans: d
602. According to Fleming's left-hand rule, when the forefinger points in the direction of the
field or flux, the middle finger will point in the direction of
Jo
Ans: a
U
603. If the field of a D.C. shunt motor gets opened while motor is running
B
TE
93 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) the motor will attain dangerously high speed 1
(d) the motor will continue to nuvat constant speed
Ans: c
604. Starters are used with D.C. motors because
(a) these motors have high starting torque
(b) these motors are not self-starting
(c) back e.m.f. of these motors is initially
(d) to restrict armature current as there is no back e.m.f. while starting
Ans: d
605. In D.C. shunt motors as load is reduced
(a) the speed will increase abruptly
(b) the speed will increase in proportion to reduction in load
(c) the speed will remain almost/constant
(d) the speed will reduce
Ans: c
606. A D.C. series motor is that which
(a) has its field winding consisting of thick wire and less turns
(b) has a poor torque
(c) can be started easily without load
(d) has almost constant speed
Ans: a
607. For starting a D.C. motor a starter is required because
(a) it the speed of the motor
(b) it limits the starting current to a safe value
(c) it starts the motor
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
608. The type of D.C. motor used for shears and punches is
(a) shunt motor
(b) series motor
(c) differential compoutid D.C. motor
(d) cumulative compound D.C. motor
Jo
Ans: d
in
(d) burn due to heat produced in the field winding by eddy currents
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
94 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
610. To get the speed of D.C, motor below the normal without wastage of electrical energy is
used.
(a) Ward Leonard control
(b) rheostatic control
(c) any of the above method
(d) none of the above method
Ans: a
611. When two D.C. series motors are connected in parallel, the resultant speed is
(a) more than the normal speed
(b) loss than the normal speed
(c) normal speed
(d) zero
Ans: c
612. The speed of a D.C. shunt motor more than its full-load speed can be obtained by
(a) decreasing the field current
(b) increasing the field current
(c) decreasing the armature current
(d) increasing the armature current
Ans: a
613. In a D.C. shunt motor, speed is
(a) independent of armature current
(b) directly proportional to the armature current
(c) proportional to the square of the current
(d) inversely proportional to the armature current
Ans: a
614. A direct on line starter is used: for starting motors
(a) iip to 5 H.P.
(b) up to 10 H.P.
(c) up to 15 H.P.
(d) up to 20 H.P.
Ans: a
Jo
615. What will happen if the back e.m.f. of a D.C. motor vanishes suddenly?
in
Ans: c
C
H
-T
el
95 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
616. In case of D.C. shunt motors the speed is dependent on back e.m.f. only because
(a) back e.m.f. is equal to armature drop
(b) armature drop is negligible
(c) flux is proportional to armature current
(d) flux is practically constant in D:C. shunt motors
Ans: d
617. In a D.C. shunt motor, under the conditions of maximum power, the current in the armature
will be
(a) almost negligible
(b) rated full-load current
(c) less than full-load current
(d) more than full-load current
Ans: d
618. These days D.C. motors are widely used in
(a) pumping sets
(b) air compressors
(c) electric traction
(d) machine shops
Ans: c
619. By looking at which part of the motor, it can be easily confirmed that a particular motor is
D.C. motor?
(a) Frame
(b) Shaft
(c) Commutator
(d) Stator Ans: c
620. In which of the following applications D.C. series motor is invariably tried?
(a) Starter for a car
(b) Drive for a water pump
(c) Fan motor
(d) Motor in A.C. or D.C.
Ans: a
621. In D.C. machines fractional pitch winding is used
(a) to improve cooling
(b) to reduce copper losses
Jo
Ans: d
P
96 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) shunt, compound and series motors
(d) all D.C. motors
Ans: b
623. In case-the conditions for maximum power for a D.C. motor are established, the efficiency
of the motor will be
(a) 100%
(b) around 90%
(c) anywhere between 75% and 90%
(d) less than 50%
Ans: d
624. The ratio of starting torque to full-load torque is least in case of
(a) series motors
(b) shunt motors
(c) compound motors
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
625. In D.C. motor which of the following can sustain the maximum temperature rise?
(a) Slip rings
(b) Commutator
(c) Field winding
(d) Armature winding
Ans: c
626. Which of the following /rule can he used to determine the direction of rotation of D.C.
motor
(a) Lenz's law
(b) Faraday's law
(c) Coloumb's law
(d) Fleming's left-hand rule
Ans: d
627. Which of the following load normally needs starting torque more than the rated torque?
(a) Blowers
(b) Conveyors
(c) Air compressors
Jo
Ans: b
SP
(a) low
U
(c) 1000 Q
(d) infinitely large
C
H
-T
el
97 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: a
629. The speed of a D.C. series motor is
(a) proportional to the armature current
(b) proportional to the square of the armature current
(c) proportional to field current
(d) inversely proportional to the armature current
Ans: d
630. In a D.C. series motor, if the armature current is reduced by 50%, the torque of the motor
will be equal to
(a) 100% of the previous value
(b) 50% of the previous value
(c) 25% of the previous value
(d) 10% of the previous value
(e) none of the above
Ans: c
631. The current drawn by the armature of D.C. motor is directly proportional to
(a) the torque required
(b) the speed of the motor
(c) the voltage across the terminals
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
632. The power mentioned on the name plate of an electric motor indicates
(a) the power drawn in kW
(b) the power drawn in kVA
(c) the gross power
(d) the output power available at the shaft
Ans: d
633. Which D.C. motor has got maximum self loading property?
(a) Series motor
(b) Shunt motor
(c) Cumulatively compounded 'motor
(d) Differentially compounded motor
Ans: d
Jo
634. Which D.C. motor will be suitable alongwith flywheel for intermittent light and heavy
in
loads?
@
98 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: c
635. If a D.C. shunt motor is working at no load and if shunt field circuit suddenly opens
(a) nothing will happen to th£ motor
(b) this will make armature to take heavy current, possibly burning it
(c) this will result in excessive speed, possibly destroying armature due to excessive centrifugal
stresses
(d) motor will run at very slow speed
Ans: c
636. D.C. series motors are used
(a) where load is constant
(b) where load changes frequently
(c) where constant operating speed is needed
(d) in none of the above situations.
Ans: d
637. For the same H.P. rating and full load speed, following motor has poor starting torque
(a) shunt
(b) series
(c) differentially compounded
(d) cumulativelyc'ompounded
Ans: c
638. In case of conductively compensated D.C. series motors, the compensating winding is
provided
(a) as separately wound unit
(6) in parallel with armature winding
(c) in series with armature winding
(d) in parallel with field winding
Ans: c
639. Sparking at the commutator of a D.C. motor may result in
(a) damage to commutator segments
(b) damage to commutator insulation
(c) increased power consumption
(d) all of the above
Ans: d
Jo
640. Which of the following motor is preferred for operation in highly explosive atmosphere ?
in
Ans: c
C
H
-T
el
99 | P a g e NANDINI EDUCATION
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
641. If the supply voltage for a D.C. motor is increased, which of the following will decrease ?
(a) Starting torque
(b) Operating speed
(c) Full-load current
(d) All of the above
Ans: c
642. Which one of the following is not the function of pole shoes in a D.C. machine ?
(a) To reduce eddy current loss
(b) To support the field coils
(c) To spread out flux for better unifor-mity
(d) To reduce the reluctance of the mag-netic path
Ans: a
643. The mechanical power developed by a shunt motor will be maximum when the ratio of back
e.m.f. to applied voltage is
(a) 4.0
(b) 2.0
(c) 1.0
(d) 0.5
Ans: d
644. The condition for maximum power in case of D.C. motor is
(a) back e.m.f. = 2 x supply voltage
(b) back e.m.f. =1 /2x supply voltage
(c) supply voltage = 1/2 x back e.m.f.
(d) supply voltage = back e.m.f.
Ans: b
645. For which of the following applications a D.C. motor is preferred over an A.C. motor ?
(a) Low speed operation
(b) High speed operation
(c) Variable speed operation
(d) Fixed speed operation
Ans: c
646. In D.C. machines the residual magnetism is of the order of
(a) 2 to 3 per cent
Jo
Ans: a
U
647. Which D.C. motor is generally preferred for cranes and hoists ?
B
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) Cumulatively compounded motor
(d) Differentially compounded motor
Ans: a
648. Three point starter can be used for
(a) series motor only
(b) shunt motor only
(c) compound motor only
(d) both shunt and compound motor
Ans: d
649. Sparking, is discouraged in a D.C. motor because
(a) it increases the input power con-sumption
(b) commutator gets damaged
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
650. Speed control by Ward Leonard method gives uniform speed variation
(a) in one direction
(b) in both directions
(c) below normal speed only
(d) above normal speed only.
Ans: b
651. Flywheel is used with D.C. compound motor to reduce the peak demand by the motor,
compound motor will have to be
(a) level compounded
(b) under compounded
(c) cumulatively compounded
(d) differentially compounded
Ans: c
652. Following motor is used where high starting torque and wide speed range control is
required.
(a) Single phase capacitor start
(b) Induction motor
(c) Synchronous motor
Jo
Ans: d
P
(a) the motor will first stop and then run in opposite direction as series motor
B
TE
(b) the motor will work as series motor and run at slow speed in the same direction
(c) the motor will work as series motor and run at high speed in the same direction
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(d) the motor will not work and come to stop Ans: a
654. Which of the following motor has the poorest speed regulation ?
(a) Shunt motor
(b) Series motor
(c) Differential compound motor
(d) Cumulative compound motor
Ans: b
655. Buses, trains, trolleys, hoists, cranes require high starting torque and therefore make use of
(a) D.C. series motor
(b) D.C. shunt motor
(c) induction motor
(d) all of above motors
Ans: a
656. As -the load is increased the speed of D.C. shunt motor will
(a) reduce slightly
(b) increase slightly
(c) increase proportionately
(d) remains unchanged
Ans: a
657. The armature torque of the D.C. shunt motor is proportional to
(a) field flux only
(b) armature current only
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
658. Which of the following method of speed control of D.C. machine will offer minimum
efficiency ?
(a) Voltage control method
(b) Field control method
(c) Armature control method
(d) All above methods
Ans: c
659. Usually wide and sensitive speed control is desired in case of
Jo
(b) elevators
@
Ans: d
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
660. The speed of a motor falls from 1100 r.p.m. at no-load to 1050 r.p.m. at rated load. The
speed regulation of the motor is
(a) 2.36%
(6) 4.76%
(c) 6.77%
(d) 8.84%
Ans: b
661. The armature voltage control of D.C. motor provides
(a) constant torque drive
(b) constant voltage drive
(c) constant current drive
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
662. As there is no back e.m.f. at the instant of starting a D.C. motor, in order to prevent a heavy
current from flowing though the armature circuit
(a) a resistance is connected in series with armature
(b) a resistance is connected parallel to the armature
(c) armature is temporarily open circuited
(d) a high value resistor is connected across the field winding
Ans: a
663. The speed of a D.C. shunt motor can be increased by
(a) increasing the resistance in armature circuit
(b) increasing the resistance in field circuit
(c) reducing the resistance in the field circuit
(d) reducing the resistance in the armature circuit
Ans: b
664. If I2 be the armature current, then speed of a D.C. shunt motor is
(a) independent of Ia
(b) proportional to la
(c) varies as (Ia)
(d) varies as la
Ans: a
665. In case the back e.m.f. and the speed of a D.C. motor are doubled, the torque developed by
the motor will
Jo
(d) be doubled
P U
Ans: a
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
666. At the instant of starting when a D.C. motor is put on supply, it behaves like
(a) a highly resistive circuit
(6) a low resistance circuit
(c) a capacitive circuit
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
667. The speed of a D.C. motor can be varied by varying
(a) field current
(b) applied voltage
(c) resistance in series with armature
(d) any of the above
Ans: d
668. Which one of the following is not necessarily the advantage of D.C. motors over A.C.
motors ?
(a) Low cost
(b) Wide speed range
(c) Stability
(d) High starting torque.
Ans: a
669. For a D.C. shunt motor if the excitation is changed
(a) torque will remain constant
(b) torque will change but power will remain constant
(c) torque and power both will change
(d) torque, power and speed, all will change
Ans: b
670. Which motor has the poorest speed control?
(a) Differentially compounded motor
(b) Cumulatively compounded motor
(c) Shunt motor
(d) Series motor
Ans: d
671. The plugging gives the
(a) zero torque braking
Jo
Ans: c
U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) constant torque drive
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
673. If a D.C. motor designed for 40°C ambient temperature is to be used for 50°C ambient
temperature, then the motor
(a) of lower H.P. should be selected
(6) of higher H.P. should be selected
(c) can be used for 50°C ambient temperature also
(d) is to be derated by a factor recom-mended by manufacturer and select the next higher H.P.
motor
Ans: d
674. If the terminals of armature of D.C. motor are interchanged, this action will offer following
kind of braking
(o) regenerative
(b) plugging
(c) dynamic braking
(d) none of the above
(e) any of the above
Ans: b
675. Which of the following motors one will choose to drive the rotary compressor ?
(a) D.C. shunt motor
(b) D.C. series motor
(c) Universal motor
(d) Synchronous motor
Ans: d
676. If the speed of a D.C. shunt motor is increased, the back e.m.f. of the motor will
(a) increase
(b) decrease
(c) remain same
(d) become zero
Ans: a
677. Why are the D.C. motors preferred for traction applications ?
Jo
(d) The speed is inversely proportional to the torque and the torque is proportional to square of
P
armature current
U
Ans: d
B
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(b) D.C. series motor
(c) Single phase induction motor (split phase start or induction run motor)
(d) Reluctance motor
(e) Synchronous motor
Ans: c
679. Which of the following motors is most suitable for signalling and many kinds of timers ?
(a) D.C. shunt motor
(b) D.C. series motor
(c) Induction motor
(d) Reluctance motor
Ans: d
680. Which motor should not be started on no-load ?
(a) Series motor
(b) Shunt motor
(c) Cumulatively compounded motor
(d) Differentially compounded motor.
Ans: a
681. Ward-Leonard control is basically a
(a) voltage control method
(b) field divertor method
(c) field control method
(d) armature resistance control method
Ans: a
682. For constant torque drive which speed control method is preferred ?
(a) Field control
(b) Armature voltage control
(c) Shunt armature control
(d) Mechanical loading system
Ans: b
683. In Ward-Leonard control the lower limit of speed is imposed by
(a) residual magnetism of the generator
(b) core losses of motor
(c) mechanical losses of motor and generator together
Jo
Ans: a
SP
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
685. Regenerative method of braking is based on that
(a) back e.m.f. is less than the applied voltage
(b) back e.m.f. is equal to the applied voltage
(c) back e.m.f. of rotor is more than the applied voltage
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
686. The hysteresis loss in a D.C. machine least depends on
(a) Frequency of magnetic reversals
(b) Maximum value of flux density
(c) Volume and grade of iron
(d) Rate of flow of ventilating air
Ans: d
687. In a D.C. generator all of the following could be the effects of iron losses except
(a) Loss of efficiency
(b) Excessive heating of core
(c) Increase in terminal voltage
(d) Rise in temperature of ventilating air
Ans: c
688. The losses occurring in a D.C. generator are given below. Which loss is likely to have
highest proportion at rated load of the generator ?
(a) hysteresis loss
(b) field copper loss
(c) armature copper loss
(d) eddy current loss
Ans: c
689. Which of the following loss in a D.C. generator varies significantly with the load current ?
(a) Field copper loss
(b) Windage loss
(c) Armature copper loss
(d) None of the above
Ans: c
690. Torque developed by a D.C. motor depends upon
Jo
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: f
691. D.C. shunt motors are used for driving
(a) trains
(b) cranes
(c) hoists
(d) machine tools
Ans: d
692. In a manual shunt motor starter
(a) over load is connected in series and no volt relay in parallel with the load
(6) over load relay is connected in parallel and no volt relay in series with the load
(c) over load relay and no volt relay are both connected in series with the load
(d) over load relay and no volt relay are both connected in parallel with the load
Ans: a
693. Which of the following steps is likely to result in reduction of hysteresis loss in a D.C.
generator ?
(a) Providing laminations in armature core
(b) Providing laminations in stator
(c) Using non-magnetic material for frame
(d) Using material of low hysteresis co-efficient for armature core material
Ans: d
694. Which of the following loss in a D.C. generator is dissipated in the form of heat?
(a) Mechanical loss
(b) Core loss
(c) Copper loss
(d) All of the above
Ans: d
695. Which of the following losses are significantly reduced by laminating the core of a D.C.
generator ?
(a) Hysteresis losses
(b) Eddy current losses
(c) Copper losses
(d) Windage losses
Ans: b
Jo
696. The total losses in a well designed D.C. generator of 10 kW will be nearly
in
(a) 100 W
@
(b) 500 W
SP
(c) 1000 W
P
(d) 1500 W
U
B
TE
Ans: b
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
697. The condition for maximum efficiency for a D.C. generator is
(a) eddy current losses = stray losses
(b) hysteresis losses = eddy current losses
(c) copper losses = 0
(d) variable losses = constant losses
Ans: d
698. D.C. generators are normally designed for maximum efficiency around
(a) full-load
(b) rated r.p.m.
(c) rated voltage
(d) all of the above
Ans: a
699. In a D.C. generator, the iron losses mainly take place in
(a) yoke
(b) commutator
(c) armature conductors
(d) armature rotor
Ans: d
700. D.C. generators are installed near the load centres to reduce
(a) iron losses
(b) line losses
(c) sparking
(d) corona losses
Ans: b
701. The purpose of retardation test on D.C. shunt machines is to find out
(a) stray losses
(b) eddy current losses
(c) field copper losses
(d) windage losses
Ans: a
702. Which of the following tests will be suitable for testing two similar D.C. series motors of
large capacity ?
(a) Swinburne's test
Jo
Ans: c
U
(a) no-load
(b) part load
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) full-load
(d) overload
Ans: c
704. During rheostat braking of D.C. series motors
(a) motor is run as a generator
(b) motor is reversed in direction
(c) motor is run at reduced speed
Ans: a
705. For which types of D.C. motor, dynamic braking is generally used ?
(a) Shunt motors
(b) Series motors
(c) Compound motors
(d) All of the above
Ans: d
706. Which method of braking is generally used in elevators ?
(a) Plugging
(b) Regenerative braking
(c) Rheostatic braking
(d) None of the above
Ans: a
707. In variable speed motor
(a) a stronger commutating field is needed at low speed than at high speed
(b) a weaker commutating field is needed at low speed than at high speed
(c) same commutating field is needed at low speed than at high speed
(d) none of the above is correct
Ans: b
708. When the armature of a D.C. motor rotates, e.m.f. induced is
(a) self-induced e.m.f.
(b) mutually induced e.m.f.
(c) back e.m.f.
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
Jo
709. Where D.C. motor of H.P. 12 or more requires frequent starting, stopping, reversing and
in
speed control
@
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: a
710. If a D.C. shunt motor is working at full load and if shunt field circuit suddenly opens
(a) this will make armature to take heavy current, possibly burning it
(6) this will result in excessive speed, possibly destroying armature due to excessive centrifugal
stresses
(c) nothing will happen to motor
(d) motor will come to stop
Ans: a
711. D.C. motor is to drive a load which has certain minimum value for most of the time and
some peak value for short
duration. We will select the
(a) series motor
(b) shunt motor
(c) compound motor
(d) any of the above
Ans: a
712. D.C. motor is to a drive a load which is almost nil for certain part of the load cycle and peak
value for short duration. We will select this
(a) series motor
(b) shunt motor
(c) compound motor
(d) any of the above
Ans: c
713. Which D.C. motor has got maximum self relieving property ?
(a) Series motor
(6) Shunt motor
(c) Cumulatively compounded motor
(d) Differentially compounded motor
Ans: a
714. In the D.C. motor the iron losses occur in
(a) the field
(b) the armature
(c) the brushes
(d) the commutator
Jo
in
Ans: b
@
715. The speed of a D.C. shunt motor is required to be more than full load speed. This is possible
SP
by
P
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(d) increasing the excitation current
(e) none of the above methods
Ans: a
716. One D.C. motor another D.C. motor. The second D.C. motor when excited and driven
(a) runs as a generator
(b) does not run as a generator
(c) also runs as a motor comes to stop after sometime
Ans: a
717. The insulating material for a
(a) low cost (b) high dielectric strength
(c) high mechanical strength (d) all of the above
Ans: d
718. Which of the following protects a cable against mechanical injury ?
(a) Bedding
(b) Sheath
(c) Armouring
(d) None of the above
Ans: c
719. Which of the following insulation is used in cables ?
(a) Varnished cambric
(b) Rubber
(c) Paper
(d) Any of the above
Ans: d
720. Empire tape is
(a) varnished cambric
(b) vulcanised rubber
(c) impregnated paper
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
721. The thickness of the layer of insulation on the conductor, in cables, depends upon
(a) reactive power
(b) power factor
(c) voltage
(d) current carrying capacity
Ans: c
Jo
Ans: c
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
723. The insulating material for cables should
(a) be acid proof (b) be non-inflammable
(c) be non-hygroscopic (d) have all above properties
Ans: d
724. In a cable immediately above metallic sheath is provided.
(a) earthing connection (b) bedding
(c) armouring (d) none of the above
Ans: b
725. The current carrying capacity of cables in D.C. is more thanthat in A.C. mainly due to
(a) absence of harmonics
(b) non-existence of any stability limit
(c) smaller dielectric loss
(d) absence of ripples
(e) none of the above
Ans: c
726. In case of three core flexible cable the colour of the neutral is
(a) blue
(b) black
(c) brown
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
Ans: d
728. Conduit pipes are normally used to protect cables.
(a) unsheathed cables
(b) armoured
(c) PVC sheathed cables
(d) all of the above
Jo
in
Ans: a
@
(a) armour
P
(b) bedding
U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
730. In single core cables armouring is not done to
(a) avoid excessive sheath losses (b) make it flexible
(c) either of the above (d) none of the above
Ans: a
731. Dielectric strength of rubber is around
(a) 5 kV/mm
(b) 15 kV/mm
(c) 30 kV/mm
(d) 200 kV/mm
Ans: c
732. Low tension cables are generally used upto
(a) 200 V
(b) 500 V
(c) 700 V
(d) 1000 V
Ans: d
733. In a cable, the maximum stress under operating conditions is at
(a) insulation layer
(b) sheath
(c) armour
(d) conductor surface
Ans: d
734. High tension cables are generally used upto
(a) 11kV
(b) 33kV
(c) 66 kV
(d) 132 kV
Ans: a
735. The surge resistance of cable is
(a) 5 ohms
(b) 20 ohms
(c) 50 ohms
Jo
Ans: c
SP
(a) polyvinyl chloride (b) post varnish conductor (c) pressed and varnished cloth
U
Ans: a
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
737. In the cables, the location of fault is usually found out by comparing
(a) the resistance of the conductor
(b) the inductance of conductors
(c) the capacitances of insulated conductors
(d) all above parameters
Ans: c
738. In capacitance grading of cables we use a dielectric.
(a) composite
(b) porous
(c) homogeneous
(d) hygroscopic
Ans: a
739. Pressure cables are generally not used beyond
(a) 11 kV
(b) 33 kV
(c) 66 kV
(d) 132 kV
Ans: c
740. The material for armouring on cable is usually
(a) steel tape
(b) galvanised steel wire
(c) any of the above
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
741. Cables, generally used beyond 66 kV are
(a) oil
(b) S.L. type
(c) belted
(d) armoured
Ans: a
742. The relative permittivity of rubber is
(a) between 2 and 3 (b) between 5 and 6
(c) between 8 and 10 (d) between 12 and 14
Jo
Ans: a
in
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
744. If the length of a cable is doubled, its capacitance
(a) becomes one-fourth
(b) becomes one-half
(c) becomes double
(d) remains unchanged
Ans: c
745. In cables the charging current
(a) lags the voltage by 90°
(b) leads the voltage by 90°
(c) lags the voltage by 180°
(d) leads the voltage by 180°
Ans: b
746. A certain cable has an insulation of relative permittivity 4. If the insulation is replaced by
one of relative permittivity 2, the capacitance of the cable will become
(a) one half
(6) double
(c) four times
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
747. If a cable of homogeneous insulation has a maximum stress of 10 kV/mm, then the
dielectric strength of insulation should be
(a) 5 kV/mm
(b) 10 kV/mm
(a) 15 kV/mm
(d) 30 kV/mm
Ans: b
748. In the cables, sheaths are used to
(a) prevent th from entering the cable `(b) provide enough strength
(e) provide proper insulation (d) none of the above
Ans: a
749. The intersheaths in the cables are used to
(a) minimize the stress
Jo
Ans: c
U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
(c) maximum at the conductor and minimum at the sheath
(d) zero at the conductor as well as on the sheath
(e) none of the above
Ans: c
751. The breakdown of insulation of the cable can be avoided economically by the use of
(a) inter-sheaths
(b) insulating materials with different dielectric constants
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
752. The insulation of the cable decreases with
(a) the increase in length of the insulation
(b) the decrease in the length of the insulation
(c) either (a) or (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
753. A cable carrying alternating current has
(a) hysteresis losses only
(b) hysteresis and leakage losses only
(c) hysteresis, leakage and copper losses only
(d) hysteresis, leakage, copper and friction losses
Ans: b
754. In a cable the voltage stress is maximum at
(a) sheath
(6) insulator
(e) surface of the conductor
(d) core of the conductor
Ans: d
755. Capacitance grading of cable implies
(a) use of dielectrics of different permeabilities
(b) grading according to capacitance of cables per km length
(c) cables using single dielectric in different concentrations
(d) capacitance required to be introduced at different lengths to counter the effect of inductance
Jo
Ans: a
SP
(c) to minimise the effect of shocks and vibrations due to gassing vehicles, etc.
(d) for all of the above reasons
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: c
757. The advantage of cables over overhead transmission lines is
(a) easy maintenance
(b) low cost
(c) can be used in congested areas
(d) can be used in high voltage circuits
Ans: c
758. The thickness of metallic shielding on cables is usually
(a) 0.04 mm
(b) 0.2 to 0.4 mm
(e) 3 to 5 mm
(d) 40 to 60 mm
Ans: a
759. Cables for 220 kV lines are invariably
(a) mica insulated
(b) paper insulated
(c) compressed oil or compressed gas insulated
(d) rubber insulated
(e) none of the above
Ans: c
760. Is a cable is to be designed for use on 1000 kV, which insulation would you prefer ?
(a) Polyvinyle chloride (b) Vulcanised rubber (c) Impregnated paper
(d) Compressed SFe gas(e) none of the above Ans: d
761. If a power cable and a communication cable are to run parallel the minimum distance
between the two, to avoid interference, should be
(a) 2 cm
(b) 10 cm
(c) 50 cm
(d) 400 cm
Ans: c
762. Copper as conductor for cables is used as
(a) annealed
(b) hardened and tempered
(c) hard drawn
Jo
Ans: a
@
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Ans: d
764. The advantage of oil filled cables is
(a) more perfect impregnation
(b) smaller overall size
(c) no ionisation, oxidation and formation of voids
(d) all of the above
Ans: d
765. The disadvantage with paper as insulating material is
(a) it is hygroscopic
(6) it has high capacitance
(c) it is an organic material
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
766. The breakdown voltage of a cable depends on
(a) presence of moisture (b) working temperature
(c) time of application of the voltage (d) all of the above
Ans: d
767. It is difficult to maintain oil filled cables.
(a) Yes
(b) No
Ans: a
768. In capacitance grading a homogeneous dielectric is used.
(a) Yes
(b) No
Ans: b
769. In congested areas where excavation is expensive and inconvenient 'draw in system' of
laying of underground cables
is often adopted.
(a) Yes
(b) No
Ans: a
770. Natural rubber is obtained from milky sap of tropical trees.
Jo
(a) Yes
in
(b) No
@
SP
Ans: a
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL
ENGINEERING
OBJECTIVE
TYPE QUESTIONS
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
NO OF
UNIT NAME QNS
1A DC GENERATORS 124
1B DC MOTORS 123
2 TRANSFORMERS 135
THREE PHASE INDUCTION
3A MOTORS 101
SINGLE PHASE INDUCTION
3B MOTORS 110
4 SYNCHRONOUS MOTORS 124
TRANSMISSION AND
5A DISTRIBUTION 102
5B CABLES 56
TOTAL 875
1. A. DC GENERATORS
Ans: c
Ans: c
@
SP
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: d
Ans: d
Ans: b
Ans: a
7. In a commutator
(a) copper is harder than mica
(b) mica and copper are equally hard
(c) mica is harder than copper
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
8. In D.C. generators the pole shoes are fastened to the pole core by
Jo
(a) rivets
(b) counter sunk screws
in
(c) brazing
@
SP
(d) welding
P U
Ans: b
B
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
9. According to Fleming's right-hand rule for finding the direction of induced e.m.f., when
middle finger points in the direction of induced e.m.f., forefinger will point in the direction
of
(a) motion of conductor
(b) lines of force
(c) either of the above
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
Ans: b
11. While applying Fleming's right-hand rule to And the direction of induced e.m.f., the
thumb points towards
(a) direction of induced e.m.f.
(b) direction of flux
(c) direction of motion of the conductor if forefinger points in the direction of generated
e.m.f.
(d) direction of motion of conductor, if forefinger points along the lines of flux
Ans: d
12. The bearings used to support the rotor shafts are generally
(a) ball bearings
(b) bush bearings
(c) magnetic bearmgs
(d) needle bearings
Ans: a
Jo
in
Ans: d
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
14. In lap winding, the number of brushes is always
(a) double the number of poles
(b) same as the number of poles
(c) half the number of poles
(d) two
Ans: b
15. For a D.C. generator when the number of poles and the number of armature conductors
is fixed, then which winding will give the higher e.m.f. ?
(a) Lap winding
(b) Wave winding
(c) Either of (a) and (b) above
(d) Depends on other features of design
Ans: b
Ans: b
Ans: a
Ans: d
P U
B
(a) current
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) voltage
(c) speed
(d) none of above
Ans: c
Ans: b
21. In D.C. generators, current to the external circuit from armature is given through
(a) commutator
(b) solid connection
(c) slip rings
(d) none of above
Ans: a
24. If B is the flux density, I the length of conductor and v the velocity of conductor, then
induced e.m.f. is given by
(a)Blv
(b)Blv2
(c)Bl2v
(d)Bl2v2
Ans: a
Jo
in
25. In case of a 4-pole D.C. generator provided with a two layer lap winding with sixteen
coils, the pole pitch will be
@
SP
(a) 4
(b) 8
P U
(c) 16
B
(d) 32
TE
Ans: b
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
27. The insulating material used between the commutator segments is normally
(a) graphite
(b) paper
(c) mica
(d) insulating varnish
Ans: c
28. In D.C. generators, the brushes on commutator remain in contact with conductors
which
(a) lie under south pole
(b) lie under north pole
(c) lie under interpolar region
(d) are farthest from the poles
Ans: c
29. If brushes of a D.C. generator are moved in order to bring these brushes in magnetic
neutral axis, there will be
(a) demagnetisation only
(b) cross magnetisation as well as magnetisation
(c) crossmagnetisation as well as demagnetising
(d) cross magnetisation only
Ans: c
Ans: a
@
SP
31. D.C. generators are connected to the busbars or disconnected from them only under the
floating condition
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) all above
Ans: d
32. Eddy currents are induced in the pole shoes of a D.C. machine due to
(a) oscillating magnetic field
(b) pulsating magnetic flux
(c) relative rotation between field and armature
(d) all above
Ans: c
37. For a D.C. machines laboratory following type of D.C. supply will be suitable
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) synchronous motor D.C. generator set
Ans: c
(a) electromagnets
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
46. Which of the following components of a D.C, generator plays vital role for providing
direct current of a D.C. generator ?
(a) Dummy coils
(b) Commutator
(c) Eye bolt
(d) Equilizer rings
Ans: b
47. In a D.C. generator the ripples in the direct e.m.f. generated are reduced by
(a) using conductor of annealed copper
(b) using commutator with large number of segments
(c) using carbon brushes of superior quality
(d) using equiliser rings
Ans: c
49. Two generators A and B have 6-poles each. Generator A has wave wound armature
P U
while generator B has lap wound armature. The ratio of the induced e.m.f. is generator A
B
and B will be
TE
(a) 2 : 3
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) 3 : 1
(c) 3 : 2
(d) 1 : 3
Ans: b
50. The voltage drop for which of the following types of brush can be expected to be least ?
(a) Graphite brushes
(b) Carbon brushes
(c) Metal graphite brushes
(d) None of the above
Ans: c
51. The e.m.f. generated by a shunt wound D.C. generator isE. Now while pole flux remains
constant, if the speed of the generator is doubled, the e.m.f. generated will be
(a) E/2
(b) 2E
(c) slightly less than E
(d) E
Ans: b
(a) identified by the scarring of the commutator segment to which open circuited coil is
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
connected
(b) indicated by a spark completely around the commutator
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
56. For the parallel operation of two or more D.C. compound generators, we should ensure
that
(a) voltage of the incoming generator should be same as that of bus bar
(b) polarity of incoming generator should be same as that of bus bar
(c) all the series fields should be run in parallel by means of equilizer connection
(d) series fields of all generators should be either on positive side or negative side of the
armature
(e) all conditions mentioned above should be satisfied
Ans: d
58. Following D.C. generator will be in a position to build up without any residual
magnetism in the poles
(a) series generator
(b) shunt generator
(c) compound generator
Jo
Ans: d
@
SP
(c) neutralise both the armature reaction flux as well as commutating e.m.f. induced in the
TE
coil
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) perform none of the above functions
Ans: c
61. In a D.C. generator the number of mechanical degrees and electrical degrees will be the
same when
(a) r.p.m. is more than 300
(b) r.p.m. is less than 300
(c) number of poles is 4
(d) number of poles is 2
Ans: d
65. In a D.C. generator the magnetic neutral axis coincides with the geometrical neutral
PU
axis, when
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) the generator runs on overload
(d) the generator runs on designed speed
Ans: a
66. In a D.C. generator in order to reduce sparking at brushes, the self-induced e.m.f. in the
coil is neutralised by all of the following except
(a) interpoles
(b) dummy coils
(c) compensating winding
(d) shifting of axis of brushes
Ans: b
67. In D.C. generators on no-load, the air gap flux distribution in space is
(a) sinusoidal
(b) triangular
(c) pulsating
(d) flat topped
Ans: d
68. A shunt generator running at 1000 r.p.m. has generated e.m.f. as 200 V. If the speed
increases to 1200 r.p.m., the generated e.m.f. will be nearly
(a) 150 V
(b) 175 V
(c) 240 V
(d) 290 V
Ans: c
71. If a D.C. generator fails to build up the probable cause could not be
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) field resistance less than the critical resistance
(c) no residual magnetism in the generator
(d) faulty shunt connections tending to reduce the residual magnetism
Ans: b
73. The e.m.f. induced in the armature of a shunt generator is 600 V. The armature
resistance is 0.1 ohm. If the armature current is 200 A, the terminal voltage will be
(a) 640 V
(b) 620 V
(c) 600 V
(d) 580 V
Ans: d
75. To achieve sparkless commutation brushes of a D.C. generator are rockedm ahead so as
to bring them
(a) just ahead of magnetic neutral axis
(b) in magnetic neutral axis
(c) just behind the magnetic neutral axis
Ans: a
77. A cumulatively compounded long shunt generator when operating as a motor would be
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) differentially compounded long shunt
(c) cumulatively compounded short shunt
(d) differentially compounded short shunt
Ans: b
(b) primemover
in
Ans: c
P U
83. In any rotating machine that part which houses the conductors and in which e.m.f.
B
(a) rotor
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) stator
(c) field
(d) armature
Ans: d
86. In a D.C. generator in case the resistance of the field winding is increased, then output
voltage will
(a) increase
(b) decrease
(c) remain unaffected
(d) fluctuate heavily
Ans: b
89. Which of the following generator will have negligible terminal voltage while running on
TE
no-load ?
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) Series generator
(b) Shunt generator
(c) Compound generator
(d) Separately excited generator
Ans: a
90. Which of the following D.C. generators will be in a position to build up without any
residual magnetism in the poles ?
(a) Series generator
(b) Shunt generator
(c) Compound generator
(d) None of the above
Ans: d
93. The terminal voltage of a D.C. shunt generator drops on load because of all of the
following reasons except
(a) armature reaction
(b) armature resistance drop
(c) field weakening due to armature reaction and armature
(d) commutation
Ans: d
Jo
in
Ans: c
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
95. A sinusoidal voltage of 5 Hz is applied to the field of a shunt generator. The armature
voltage wave
(a) will be zero
(b) will be of 5 Hz
(c) willbeof5xiVHz
(d) will be of v Hz 5
Ans: b
96. A 220 V D.C. generator is run at full speed without any excitation. The open circuit
voltage will be
(a) zero
(b) about 2 V
(c) about 50 V
(d) 220 V
Ans: b
97. In a separately excited generator supplying rated load the armature reaction ,
(a) is always present
(b) is always absent
(c) may be sometimes present
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
98. If residual magnetism is present in a D.C. generator, the induced e.m.f. at zero speed will
be
(a) zero
(b) small
(c) the same as rated voltage
(d) high
Ans: a
Ans: a
@
SP
100. Following energized winding of a D.C. machine should not be opened as it would
produce high inductive voltage which may be dangerous to personnel and may cause its
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) Inter pole field
(d) Shunt field
Ans: d
103. When two D.C. series generators are running in parallel, an equilizer bar is used
(a) to increase the speed and hence generated e.m.f.
(b) to increase the series flux
(c) so that two similar machines will pass approximately equal currents to the load
(d) to reduce the combined effect of ar-mature reaction of both machines
Ans: c
104. Which of the following generating machine will offer constant voltage on all loads ?
(a) Self-excited generator
(b) Separately excited generator
(c) Level compounded generator .
(d) All of the above
Ans: c
105. Which of the following generators will be preferred if they are required to be run in
parallel ?
(a) Shunt generators
Jo
Ans: a
P U
106. Two generators are running in parallel. One of the generators may run as motor for
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) The speed of that generator is increased
(c) The field of that generator is weakened
(d) That generator takes large share of loads
Ans: d
110. The terminal voltage of a series generator is 150 V when the load current is 5 A. If the
load current is increased to 10 A, the terminal voltage will be
(a) 150 V
(b) less than 150 V
(c) greater than 150 V
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
111. The open circuit voltage of a compound generator is 250 V. At full load the terminal
voltage
Jo
112. Two D.C. shunt generators, each with armature resistance of 0.02 ohm and field
TE
resistance of 50 ohm run in parallel and supply a total current of 1000 amperes to the load
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
circuit. If their e.m.fs. are 270 V and 265 V, their bus bar voltage will be
(a) 270 V
(b) 267.5 V
(c) 265 V
(d) 257.4 V
Ans: b
113. The essential condition for parallel operation of two D.C. generators is that they have
'
(a) same kW rating
(b) the same operation r.p.m.
(c) the same drooping voltage charac-teristics
(d) same percentage regulation
Ans: c
114. When two D.C. generators are running in parallel an equilizer bar is used
(a) to increase the series flux
(b) to increase the generated e.m.f.
(c) to reduce the combined effect of ar-mature reaction of both the machines
(d) so that the two identical machines will pass approximately equal currents to the load
Ans: d
116. Which generator would you prefer for feeding long D.C. transmission lines ?
(a) Series generator
(b) Shunt generator
(c) Over compound generator
(d) Flat compound generator
Ans: c
Jo
in
Ans: c
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
118. The number of armature parallel paths in a two-pole D.C. generator having duplex lap
winding is
(a) 2
(b) 4
(c) 6
(d) 8
Ans: b
119. For both lap and wave windings, there are as many commutator bars as the number of
(a) slots
(b) armature conductors
(c) winding elements
(d) poles
Ans: c
121. As a result of armature reaction, the reduction in the total mutual air gap flux in a D.C.
generator is approximately
(a) 40 percent
(b) 25 percent
(c) 10 percent
(d) 5 percent
Ans: d
122. Shunt generators are most suited for stable parallel operation because of their
(a) rising voltage characteristics
(b) identical voltage characteristics
(c) drooping voltage characteristics
(d) linear voltage characteristics
Jo
Ans: c
in
123. The main factor which leads to unstable parallel operation of flat and over
@
SP
compounded generators is
(a) their rising voltage characteristics
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: a
124. If a self excited D.C. generator after being installed, fails to build up on its first trial run,
the first thing to do is to
(a) reverse the field connections
(b) increase the field resistance
(c) increase the speed of primemover
(d) check armature insulation resis¬tance
Ans: a
1. B. DC MOTOR
Ans: a
P U
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) Cumulative compound motor
(d) Differential compound motor
Ans: b
8. According to Fleming's left-hand rule, when the forefinger points in the direction of the
field or flux, the middle finger will point in the direction of
(a) current in the conductor aovtaat of conductor
(c) resultant force on conductor
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
9. If the field of a D.C. shunt motor gets opened while motor is running
(a) the speed of motor will be reduced %
(b) the armature current will reduce
(c) the motor will attain dangerously high speed 1
(d) the motor will continue to nuvat constant speed
Ans: c
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) the speed will reduce
Ans: c
14. The type of D.C. motor used for shears and punches is
(a) shunt motor
(b) series motor
(c) differential compoutid D.C. motor
(d) cumulative compound D.C. motor
Ans: d
16. To get the speed of D.C, motor below the normal without wastage of electrical energy
is used.
(a) Ward Leonard control
(b) rheostatic control
Jo
17. When two D.C. series motors are connected in parallel, the resultant speed is
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) zero
Ans: c
18. The speed of a D.C. shunt motor more than its full-load speed can be obtained by
(a) decreasing the field current
(b) increasing the field current
(c) decreasing the armature current
(d) increasing the armature current
Ans: a
21. What will happen if the back e.m.f. of a D.C. motor vanishes suddenly?
(a) The motor will stop
(b) The motor will continue to run
(c) The armature may burn
(d) The motor will run noisy
Ans: c
22. In case of D.C. shunt motors the speed is dependent on back e.m.f. only because
(a) back e.m.f. is equal to armature drop
(b) armature drop is negligible
(c) flux is proportional to armature current
Jo
Ans: d
@
SP
23. In a D.C. shunt motor, under the conditions of maximum power, the current in the
armature will be
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) more than full-load current
Ans: d
25. By looking at which part of the motor, it can be easily confirmed that a particular
motor is D.C. motor?
(a) Frame
(b) Shaft
(c) Commutator
(d) Stator
Ans: c
26. In which of the following applications D.C. series motor is invariably tried?
(a) Starter for a car
(b) Drive for a water pump
(c) Fan motor
(d) Motor operation in A.C. or D.C.
Ans: a
29. In case-the conditions for maximum power for a D.C. motor are established, the
P U
(a) 100%
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) anywhere between 75% and 90%
(d) less than 50%
Ans: d
32. In D.C. motor which of the following can sustain the maximum temperature rise?
(a) Slip rings
(b) Commutator
(c) Field winding
(d) Armature winding
Ans: c
33. Which of the following law/rule can he used to determine the direction of rotation of
D.C. motor ?
(a) Lenz's law
(b) Faraday's law
(c) Coloumb's law
(d) Fleming's left-hand rule
Ans: d
34. Which of the following load normally needs starting torque more than the rated
torque?
(a) Blowers
(b) Conveyors
(c) Air compressors
(d) Centrifugal pumps
Ans: b
(a) low
in
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) proportional to the square of the armature current
(c) proportional to field current
(d) inversely proportional to the armature current
Ans: d
37. In a D.C. series motor, if the armature current is reduced by 50%, the torque of the
motor will be equal
to
(a) 100% of the previous value
(b) 50% of the previous value
(c) 25% of the previous value
(d) 10% of the previous value
(e) none of the above
Ans: c
38. The current drawn by the armature of D.C. motor is directly proportional to
(a) the torque required
(b) the speed of the motor
(c) the voltage across the terminals
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
39. The power mentioned on the name plate of an electric motor indicates
(a) the power drawn in kW
(b) the power drawn in kVA
(c) the gross power
(d) the output power available at the shaft
Ans: d
40. Which D.C. motor has got maximum self loading property?
(a) Series motor
(b) Shunt motor
(c) Cumulatively compounded 'motor
(d) Differentially compounded motor
Ans: d
Jo
in
41. Which D.C. motor will be suitable alongwith flywheel for intermittent light and heavy
loads?
@
SP
Ans: c
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
42. If a D.C. shunt motor is working at no load and if shunt field circuit suddenly opens
(a) nothing will happen to th£ motor
(b) this will make armature to take heavy current, possibly burning it
(c) this will result in excessive speed, possibly destroying armature due to excessive
centrifugal stresses (d) motor will run at very slow speed
Ans: c
44. For the same H.P. rating and full load speed, following motor has poor starting torque
(a) shunt
(b) series
(c) differentially compounded
(d) cumulativelyc'ompounded
Ans: c
45. In case of conductively compensated D.C. series motors, the compensating winding is
provided
(a) as separately wound unit
(6) in parallel with armature winding
(c) in series with armature winding
(d) in parallel with field winding
Ans: c
Ans: d
in
47. Which of the following motor is preferred for operation in highly explosive
@
SP
atmosphere ?
(a) Series motor
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: c
48. If the supply voltage for a D.C. motor is increased, which of the following will decrease
?
(a) Starting torque
(b) Operating speed
(c) Full-load current
(d) All of the above
Ans: c
49. Which one of the following is not the function of pole shoes in a D.C. machine ?
(a) To reduce eddy current loss
(b) To support the field coils
(c) To spread out flux for better unifor-mity
(d) To reduce the reluctance of the mag-netic path
Ans: a
50. The mechanical power developed by a shunt motor will be maximum when the ratio
of back e.m.f. to applied voltage is
(a) 4.0
(b) 2.0
(c) 1.0
(d) 0.5
Ans: d
52. For which of the following applications a D.C. motor is preferred over an A.C. motor ?
(a) Low speed operation
(b) High speed operation
Jo
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) 50 to 75 per cent
Ans: a
54. Which D.C. motor is generally preferred for cranes and hoists ?
(a) Series motor
(b) Shunt motor
(c) Cumulatively compounded motor
(d) Differentially compounded motor
Ans: a
57. Speed control by Ward Leonard method gives uniform speed variation
(a) in one direction
(b) in both directions
(c) below normal speed only
(d) above normal speed only.
Ans: b
58. Flywheel is used with D.C. compound motor to reduce the peak demand by the motor,
compound motor will have
to be
(a) level compounded
Jo
Ans: c
59. Following motor is used where high starting torque and wide speed range control is
P U
required.
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) Synchronous motor
(d) D.C. motor
(e) None of the above
Ans: d
61. Which of the following motor has the poorest speed regulation ?
(a) Shunt motor
(b) Series motor
(c) Differential compound motor
(d) Cumulative compound motor
Ans: b
62. Buses, trains, trolleys, hoists, cranes require high starting torque and therefore make
use of
(a) D.C. series motor
(b) D.C. shunt motor
(c) induction motor
(d) all of above motors
Ans: a
63. As -the load is increased the speed of D.C. shunt motor will
(a) reduce slightly
(b) increase slightly
(c) increase proportionately
(d) remains unchanged
Ans: a
65. Which of the following method of speed control of D.C. machine will offer minimum
TE
efficiency ?
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) Voltage control method
(b) Field control method
(c) Armature control method
(d) All above methods
Ans: c
67. The speed of a motor falls from 1100 r.p.m. at no-load to 1050 r.p.m. at rated load. The
speed regulation of the motor is
(a) 2.36%
(6) 4.76%
(c) 6.77%
(d) 8.84%
Ans: b
69. As there is no back e.m.f. at the instant of starting a D.C. motor, in order to prevent a
heavy current from flowing though the armature circuit
(a) a resistance is connected in series with armature
(b) a resistance is connected parallel to the armature
(c) armature is temporarily open circuited
(d) a high value resistor is connected across the field winding
Ans: a
Jo
in
Ans: b
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
71. If I2 be the armature current, then speed of a D.C. shunt motor is
(a) independent of Ia
(b) proportional to la
(c) varies as (Ia)
(d) varies as la
Ans: a
72. In case the back e.m.f. and the speed of a D.C. motor are doubled, the torque developed
by the motor will
(a) remain unchanged
(6) reduce to one-fourth value
(c) increase four folds
(d) be doubled
Ans: a
73. At the instant of starting when a D.C. motor is put on supply, it behaves like
(a) a highly resistive circuit
(6) a low resistance circuit
(c) a capacitive circuit
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
75. Which one of the following is not necessarily the advantage of D.C. motors over A.C.
motors ?
(a) Low cost
(b) Wide speed range
(c) Stability
(d) High starting torque.
Jo
Ans: a
in
Ans: b
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
80. If a D.C. motor designed for 40°C ambient temperature is to be used for 50°C ambient
temperature, then the motor
(a) of lower H.P. should be selected
(6) of higher H.P. should be selected
(c) can be used for 50°C ambient temperature also
(d) is to be derated by a factor recom-mended by manufacturer and select the next higher
H.P. motor
Ans: d
81. If the terminals of armature of D.C. motor are interchanged, this action will offer
following kind of braking
(o) regenerative
(b) plugging
Jo
Ans: b
P U
82. Which of the following motors one will choose to drive the rotary compressor ?
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) Universal motor
(d) Synchronous motor
Ans: d
83. If the speed of a D.C. shunt motor is increased, the back e.m.f. of the motor will
(a) increase
(b) decrease
(c) remain same
(d) become zero
Ans: a
84. Why are the D.C. motors preferred for traction applications ?
(a) Torque and speed are inversely proportional to armature current
(b) Torque is proportional to armature current
(c) Torque is proportional to square root of armature current
(d) The speed is inversely proportional to the torque and the torque is proportional to
square of armature current
Ans: d
86. Which of the following motors is most suitable for signalling devices and many kinds
of timers ?
(a) D.C. shunt motor
(b) D.C. series motor
(c) Induction motor
(d) Reluctance motor
Ans: d
Jo
Ans: a
B
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) voltage control method
(b) field divertor method
(c) field control method
(d) armature resistance control method
Ans: a
89. For constant torque drive which speed control method is preferred ?
(a) Field control
(b) Armature voltage control
(c) Shunt armature control
(d) Mechanical loading system
Ans: b
94. In a D.C. generator all of the following could be the effects of iron losses except
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) Excessive heating of core
(c) Increase in terminal voltage
(d) Rise in temperature of ventilating air
Ans: c
95. The losses occurring in a D.C. generator are given below. Which loss is likely to have
highest proportion at rated load of the generator ?
(a) hysteresis loss
(b) field copper loss
(c) armature copper loss
(d) eddy current loss
Ans: c
96. Which of the following loss in a D.C. generator varies significantly with the load
current ?
(a) Field copper loss
(b) Windage loss
(c) Armature copper loss
(d) None of the above
Ans: c
Ans: d
in
(a) over load relay is connected in series and no volt relay in parallel with the load
(6) over load relay is connected in paral¬lel and no volt relay in series with the load
P U
(c) over load relay and no volt relay are both connected in series with the load
B
(d) over load relay and no volt relay are both connected in parallel with the load
TE
Ans: a
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
100. Which of the following steps is likely to result in reduction of hysteresis loss in a D.C.
generator ?
(a) Providing laminations in armature core
(b) Providing laminations in stator
(c) Using non-magnetic material for frame
(d) Using material of low hysteresis co-efficient for armature core material
Ans: d
101. Which of the following loss in a D.C. generator is dissipated in the form of heat?
(a) Mechanical loss
(b) Core loss
(c) Copper loss
(d) All of the above
Ans: d
102. Which of the following losses are significantly reduced by laminating the core of a
D.C. generator ?
(a) Hysteresis losses
(b) Eddy current losses
(c) Copper losses
(d) Windage losses
Ans: b
103. The total losses in a well designed D.C. generator of 10 kW will be nearly
(a) 100 W
(b) 500 W
(c) 1000 W
(d) 1500 W
Ans: b
Ans: d
@
SP
105. D.C. generators are normally designed for maximum efficiency around
(a) full-load
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: a
107. D.C. generators are installed near the load centres to reduce
(a) iron losses
(b) line losses
(c) sparking
(d) corona losses
Ans: b
108. The purpose of retardation test on D.C. shunt machines is to find out
(a) stray losses
(b) eddy current losses
(c) field copper losses
(d) windage losses
Ans: a
109. Which of the following tests will be suitable for testing two similar D.C. series motors
of large capacity ?
(a) Swinburne's test
(b) Hopkinson's test
(c) Field test
(d) Brake test
Ans: c
(d) overload
in
Ans: c
@
SP
Ans: a
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
112. For which types of D.C. motor, dynamic braking is generally used ?
(a) Shunt motors
(b) Series motors
(c) Compound motors
(d) All of the above
Ans: d
116. Where D.C. motor of H.P. 12 or more requires frequent starting, stopping, reversing
and speed control
(a) drum type controller is used
(b) three point starter is used
(c) four point starter is used
(d) all above can be used
Jo
Ans: a
in
117. If a D.C. shunt motor is working at full load and if shunt field circuit suddenly opens
@
SP
(a) this will make armature to take heavy current, possibly burning it
(6) this will result in excessive speed, possibly destroying armature due to excessive
P U
centrifugal stresses
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: a
118. D.C. motor is to drive a load which has certain minimum value for most of the time
and some peak value for short
duration. We will select the
(a) series motor
(b) shunt motor
(c) compound motor
(d) any of the above
Ans: a
119. D.C. motor is to a drive a load which is almost nil for certain part of the load cycle
and peak value for short duration. We will select this
(a) series motor
(b) shunt motor
(c) compound motor
(d) any of the above
Ans: c
120. Which D.C. motor has got maximum self relieving property ?
(a) Series motor
(6) Shunt motor
(c) Cumulatively compounded motor
(d) Differentially compounded motor
Ans: a
122. The speed of a D.C. shunt motor is required to be more than full load speed. This is
possible by
Jo
Ans: a
B
TE
123. One D.C. motor drives another D.C. motor. The second D.C. motor when excited and
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
driven
(a) runs as a generator
(b) does not run as a generator
(c) also runs as a motor comes to stop after sometime
Ans: a
2. TRANSFORMERS
depends on
@
Ans: d
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
5. The no-load current drawn by transformer is usually what per cent of the full-load
current ?
(a) 0.2 to 0.5 per cent
(b) 2 to 5 per cent
(c) 12 to 15 per cent
(d) 20 to 30 per cent
Ans: b
(a) temperature
in
Ans: a
B
TE
C
10. The permissible flux density in case of cold rolled grain oriented steel is around
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) 1.7 Wb/m2
(b) 2.7 Wb/m2
(c) 3.7 Wb/m2
(d) 4.7 Wb/m2
Ans: a
(d) Exciter
in
Ans: d
@
SP
15. While conducting short-circuit test on a transformer the following side is short
P U
circuited
B
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) Primary side
(d) Secondary side
Ans: b
16. In the transformer following winding has got more cross-sectional area
(a) Low voltage winding
(b) High voltage winding
(c) Primary winding
(d) Secondary winding
Ans: a
18. A transformer cannot raise or lower the voltage of a D.C. supply because
(a) there is no need to change the D.C. voltage
(b) a D.C. circuit has more losses
(c) Faraday's laws of electromagnetic induction are not valid since the rate of change of flux
is zero
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
Ans: c
in
@
SP
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: b
22. In a given transformer for given applied voltage, losses which remain constant
irrespective of load changes are
(a) friction and windage losses
(b) copper losses
(c) hysteresis and eddy current losses
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
24. The no load current in a transformer lags behind the applied voltage by an angle of
about
(a) 180°
(b) 120"
(c) 90°
(d) 75°
Ans: d
Jo
in
Ans: d
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) has high magnitude and high power factor
(c) has small magnitude and high power factor
(d) has small magnitude and low power factor
Ans: d
Ans: d
in
@
SP
36. Two transformers operating in parallel will share the load depending upon their
(a) leakage reactance
P U
(c) efficiencies
C
(d) ratings
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: b
38. What will happen if the transformers working in parallel are not connected with
regard to polarity ?
(a) The power factor of the two trans-formers will be different from the power factor of
common load
(b) Incorrect polarity will result in dead short circuit
(c) The transformers will not share load in proportion to their kVA ratings
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
39. Ifthe percentage impedances of the two transformers working in parallel are different,
then
(a) transformers will be overheated
(b) power factors of both the trans-formers will be same
(c) parallel operation will be not possible
(d) parallel operation will still be possible, but the power factors at which the two
transformers operate will be different from the power factor of the common load
Ans: d
Ans: c
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) reduces copper losses
(d) increases part load efficiency
Ans: a
42. The chemical used in breather for transformer should have the quality of
(a) ionizing air
(b) absorbing moisture
(c) cleansing the transformer oil
(d) cooling the transformer oil.
Ans: b
44. An ideal transformer has infinite values of primary and secondary inductances. The
statement is
(a) true
(b) false
Ans: b
46. The noise resulting from vibrations of laminations set by magnetic forces, is termed as
in
(a) magnetostrication
@
SP
(b) boo
(c) hum
P
U
(d) zoom
B
TE
Ans: c
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
47. Hysteresis loss in a transformer varies as CBmax = maximum flux density)
(a) Bmax
(b) Bmax1-6
(C) Bmax1-83
(d) B max
Ans: b
(6) 66 kV
in
(c) 132 kV
@
SP
(d) 400 kV
Ans: d
P U
B
TE
(a) zero
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) 1 ohm
(c) 1000 ohms
(d) infinite
Ans: d
55. Gas is usually not liberated due to dissociation of transformer oil unless the oil
temperature exceeds
(a) 50°C
(b) 80°C
(c) 100°C
(d) 150°C
Ans: d
Ans: d
@
SP
57. Distribution transformers are generally designed for maximum efficiency around
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) 50% load
Ans: d
58. Which of the following property is not necessarily desirable in the material for
transformer core ?
(a) Mechanical strength
(6) Low hysteresis loss
(c) High thermal conductivity
(d) High permeability
Ans: c
Ans: a
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
64. Which of the following properties is not necessarily desirable for the material for
transformer core ?
(a) Low hysteresis loss
(b) High permeability
(c) High thermal conductivity
(d) Adequate mechanical strength
Ans: c
Ans: c
B
TE
C
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) Core insulation voltage test
(b) Impedance test
(c) Radio interference test
(d) Polarity test
Ans: c
Ans: c
@
SP
73. The full-load copper loss of a trans¬former is 1600 W. At half-load, the copper loss will
P U
be
B
TE
(a) 6400 W
C
(b) 1600 W
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) 800 W
(d) 400 W
Ans: d
77. Power transformers are generally designed to have maximum efficiency around
(a) no-load
(b) half-load
(c) near full-load
(d) 10% overload
Ans: c
Jo
in
.78. Which of the following is the main advantage of an auto-transformer over a two
@
SP
winding transformer ?
(a) Hysteresis losses are reduced
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: b
79. During short circuit test iron losses are negligible because
(a) the current on secondary side is negligible
(b) the voltage on secondary side does not vary
(c) the voltage applied on primary side is low
(d) full-load current is not supplied to the transformer
Ans: c
80. Two transformers are connected in parallel. These transformers do not have equal
percentage impedance. This is likely to result in
(a) short-circuiting of the secondaries
(b) power factor of one of the trans¬formers is leading while that of the other lagging
(c) transformers having higher copper losses will have negligible core losses
(d) loading of the transformers not in proportion to their kVA ratings
Ans: d
81. The changes in volume of transformer cooling oil due to variation of atmospheric
temperature during day and
night is taken care of by which part of transformer
(a) Conservator
(b) Breather
(c) Bushings
(d) Buchholz relay
Ans: a
Ans: a
@
SP
83. When a given transformer is run at its rated voltage but reduced frequency, its
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) core flux density is increased
Ans: d
84. In an actual transformer the iron loss remains practically constant from noload to
fullload because
(a) value of transformation ratio remains constant
(b) permeability of transformer core remains constant
(c) core flux remains practically constant
(d) primary voltage remains constant
(c) secondary voltage remains constant
Ans: c
85. An ideal transformer will have maximum efficiency at a load such that
(a) copper loss = iron loss
(b) copper loss < iron loss
(c) copper loss > iron loss
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
86. If the supply frequency to the transformer is increased,"the iron loss will
(a) not change
(b) decrease
(c) increase
(d) any of the above
Ans: c
Ans: a
in
@
SP
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: a
89. When secondary of a current transformer is open-circuited its iron core will be
(a) hot because of heavy iron losses taking place in it due to high flux density
(b) hot because primary will carry heavy current
(c) cool as there is no secondary current
(d) none of above will happen
Ans: a
Ans: c
B
TE
C
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) hysteresis losses
(b) copper losses
(c) core losses
(d) eddy current losses
Ans: b
95. For the parallel operation of single phase transformers it is necessary that they should
have
(a) same efficiency
(b) same polarity
(c) same kVA rating
(d) same number of turns on the secondary side.
Ans: b
96. The transformer oil should have _____ volatility and _____ viscosity.
(a) low,low
(b) high,high
(c) low,high
(d) high,low
Ans: a
98. The secondary winding of which of the following transformers is always kept closed ?
(a) Step-up transformer
(b) Step-down transformer
Jo
Ans: d
P U
(a) frequency
C
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) flux density of the core material
(d) (a) and (b) both
Ans: d
104. Which of the following is not the standard voltage for power supply in India ?
@
SP
(a) llkV
(b) 33kV
P U
(c) 66 kV
B
TE
(d) 122 kV
C
Ans: d
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
105. Reduction in core losses and increase in permeability are obtained with transformer
employing
(a) core built-up of laminations of cold rolled grain oriented steel
(b) core built-up of laminations of hot rolled sheet
(c) either of the above
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
106. In a power or distribution transformer about 10 per cent end turns are heavily
insulated
(a) to withstand the high voltage drop due to line surge produced by the shunting
capacitance of the end turns
(b) to absorb the line surge voltage and save the winding of transformer from damage
(c) to reflect the line surge and save the winding of a transformer from damage
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
107. For given applied voltage, with the increase in frequency of the applied voltage
(a) eddy current loss will decrease
(b) eddy current loss will increase
(c) eddy current loss will remain unchanged
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
108. Losses which occur in rotating electric machines and do not occur in trans formers
are
(a) friction and windage losses
(b) magnetic losses
(c) hysteresis and eddy current losses
(d) copper losses
Jo
Ans: a
in
@
SP
109. In a given transformer for a given applied voltage, losses which remain constant
irrespective of load changes are
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
110. Which of the following statements regarding an idel single-phase transformer having
a turn ratio of 1 : 2 and
drawing a current of 10 A from 200 V A.C. supply is incorrect ?
(a) Its secondary current is 5 A
(b) Its secondary voltage is 400 V
(c) Its rating is 2 kVA
(d) Its secondary current is 20 A
(e) It is a step-up transformer
Ans: d
112. In a transformer the resistance between its primary and secondary should be
(a) zero
(b) 10 Q
(c) 1000 Q
(d) infinity
Ans: d
Ans: a
P U
114. For a transformer, operating at constant load current, maximum efficiency will occur
B
TE
at
C
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) 0.8 lagging power factor
(c) zero power factor
(d) unity power factor
Ans: d
115. Which of the following protection is normally not provided on small distribution
transformers ?
(a) Overfluxing protection
(b) Buchholz relay
(c) Overcurrent protection
(d) All of the above
Ans: b
116. Which of the following acts as a protection against high voltage surges due to
lightning and switching ?
(a) Horn gaps
(b) Thermal overload relays
(c) Breather
(d) Conservator
Ans: a
117. The efficiency of two identical transformers under load conditions can be
determined by
(a) short-circuit test
(b) back-to-back test
(c) open circuit test
(d) any of the above
Ans: b
118. Which of the following insulating materials can withstand the highest temperature
safely ?
Jo
(a) Cellulose
in
(b) Asbestos
@
SP
(c) Mica
(d) Glass fibre
P
U
Ans: c
B
TE
C
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) Bushings
(b) Core
(c) Primary winding
(d) Secondary winding
Ans: a
121. Which of the following loss in a transformer is zero even at full load ?
(a) Core loss
(b) Friction loss
(c) Eddy current loss
(d) Hysteresis loss
Ans: b
122. Which of the following is the most likely source of harmonics in a transformer ?
(a) poor insulation
(b) Overload
(c) loose connections
(d) Core saturation
Ans: d
123. If a transformer is continuously operated the maximum temperature rise will occur
in
(a) core
(b) windings
Jo
(c) tank
in
Ans: b
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) magnetostriction
(d) mechanical vibrations
Ans: c
125. The maximum load that a power transformer can carry is limited by its
(a) temperature rise
(b) dielectric strength of oil
(c) voltage ratio
(d) copper loss
Ans: c
126. The efficiency of a transformer, under heavy loads, is comparatively low because
(a) copper loss becomes high in proportion to the output
(b) iron loss is increased considerably
(c) voltage drop both in primary and secondary becomes large
(d) secondary output is much less as compared to primary input
Ans: a
Ans: e
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) secondary induced e.m.f. to primary induced e.m.f.
(d) secondary terminal voltage to primary applied voltage
Ans: c
130. Part of the transformer which is most subject to damage from overheating is
(a) iron core
(b) copper winding
(c) winding insulation
(d) frame or case
(e) transformer tank
Ans: c
132. Auto-transformer makes effective saving on copper and copper losses, when its
transformation ratio is
(a) approximately equal to one
(b) less than one
(c) great than one
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
133. Minimum voltage regulation occurs when the power factor of the load is
(a) unity
(b) lagging
(c) leading
Jo
(d) zero
in
Ans: c
@
SP
134. In a step-down transformer, there is a change of 15 A in the load current. This results
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) 15 A
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
135. The efficiencies of transformers compared with that of electric motors of the same
power are
(a) about the same
(6) much smaller
(c) much higher
(d) somewhat smaller
(e) none of the above
Ans: c
Ans: a
@
SP
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: c
7. In squirrel cage induction motors, the rotor slots are usually given slight skew in order
to
(a) reduce windage losses
(b) reduce eddy currents
(c) reduce accumulation of dirt and dust
(d) reduce magnetic hum
Ans: d
(d) aluminium
in
Ans: c
@
SP
10. A 3-phase 440 V, 50 Hz induction motor has 4% slip. The frequency of rotor e.m.f. will
be
PU
(a) 200 Hz
B
(b) 50 Hz
TE
(c) 2 Hz
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) 0.2 Hz
Ans: c
11. In Ns is the synchronous speed and s the slip, then actual running speed of an
induction motor will be
(a) Ns
(b) s.N,
(c) (l-s)Ns
(d) (Ns-l)s
Ans: c
13. The number of slip rings on a squirrel cage induction motor is usually
(a) two
(b) three
(c) four
(d) none
Ans: d
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) high speed motors
Ans: a
20. The good power factor of an induction motor can be achieved if the average flux
density in the air gap is
(a) absent
(b) small
(c) large
(d) infinity
Ans: b
22. The injected e.m.f. in the rotor of induction motor must have
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) the same phase as the rotor e.m.f.
(d) high value for the satisfactory speed control
Ans: b
23. Which of the following methods is easily applicable to control the speed of the
squirrel-cage induction motor ?
(a) By changing the number of stator poles
(b) Rotor rheostat control
(c) By operating two motors in cascade
(d) By injecting e.m.f. in the rotor circuit
Ans: a
25. The auto-starters (using three auto transformers) can be used to start cage induction
motor of the following type
(a) star connected only
(b) delta connected only
(c) (a) and (b) both
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
26. The torque developed in the cage induction motor with autostarter is
(a) k/torque with direct switching
(6) K x torque with direct switching
(c) K2 x torque with direct switching
(d) k2/torque with direct switching
Ans: c
Jo
27. When the equivalent circuit diagram of doouble squirrel-cage induction motor is
in
(a) in series
(b) in parallel
P U
(c) in series-parallel
B
Ans: b
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
28. It is advisable to avoid line-starting of induction motor and use starter because
(a) motor takes five to seven times its full load current
(b) it will pick-up very high speed and may go out of step
(c) it will run in reverse direction
(d) starting torque is very high
Ans: a
29. Stepless speed control of induction motor is possible by which of the following
methods ?
(a) e.m.f. injection in rotor eueuit
(b) Changing the number of poles
(c) Cascade operation
(d) None of the above
Ans: b
31. In the circle diagram for induction motor, the diameter of the circle represents
(a) slip
(b) rotor current
(c) running torque
(d) line voltage
Ans: b
32. For which motor the speed can be controlled from rotor side ?
(a) Squirrel-cage induction motor
(b) Slip-ring induction motor
(c) Both (a) and (b)
(d) None of the above
Jo
Ans: b
in
Ans: a
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
37. In a three-phase induction motor, the number of poles in the rotor winding is always
(a) zero
(b) more than the number of poles in stator
(c) less than number of poles in stator
(d) equal to number of poles in stator
Ans: d
39. The speed of a squirrel-cage induction motor can be controlled by all of the following
except
@
SP
Ans: c
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
41. The power factor of an induction motor under no-load conditions will be closer to
(a) 0.2 lagging
(b) 0.2 leading
(c) 0.5 leading
(d) unity
Ans: a
43. If an induction motor with certain ratio of rotor to stator slots, runs at 1/7 of the
normal speed, the phenomenon will be termed as
(a) humming
(b) hunting
(c) crawling
(d) cogging
Ans: c
direction
in
45. Size of a high speed motor as compared to low speed motorfor the same H.P. will be
P U
(a) bigger
B
(b) smaller
TE
(c) same
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) any of the above
Ans: b
46. A 3-phase induction motor stator delta connected, is carrying full load and one of its
fuses blows out. Then the motor
(a) will continue running burning its one phase
(b) will continue running burning its two phases
(c) will stop and carry heavy current causing permanent damage to its winding
(d) will continue running without any harm to the winding
Ans: a
47. A 3-phase induction motor delta connected is carrying too heavy load and one of its
fuses blows out. Then the
motor
(a) will continue running burning its one phase
(b) will continue running burning its two phase
(c) will stop and carry heavy current causing permanent damage to its winding
(d) will continue running without any harm to the winding
Ans: c
49. In an induction motor the relationship between stator slots and rotor slots is that
(a) stator slots are equal to rotor slots
(b) stator slots are exact multiple of rotor slots
(c) stator slots are not exact multiple of rotor slots
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) its power factor remains constant
(c) its power factor goes on increasing even after full load
(d) its power factor goes on increasing upto full load and then it falls again
Ans: d
52. If a 3-phase supply is given to the stator and rotor is short circuited rotor will move
(a) in the opposite direction as the direction of the rotating field
(b) in the same direction as the direction of the field
(c) in any direction depending upon phase squence of supply
Ans: b
53. It is advisable to avoid line starting of induction motor and use starter because
(a) it will run in reverse direction
(b) it will pick up very high speed and may go out of step
(c) motor takes five to seven times its fullload current
(d) starting torque is very high
Ans: c
54. The speed characteristics of an induction motor closely resemble the speedload
characteristics of which of the
following machines
(a) D.C. series motor
(b) D.C. shunt motor
(c) universal motor
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
55. Which type of bearing is provided in small induction motors to support the rotor shaft
?
(a) Ball bearings
(b) Cast iron bearings
(c) Bush bearings
(d) None of the above
Ans: a
Jo
56. A pump induction motor is switched on to a supply 30% lower than its rated voltage.
in
Ans: d
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
57. 5 H.P., 50-Hz, 3-phase, 440 V, induction motors are available for the following r.p.m.
Which motor will be the
costliest ?
(a) 730 r.p.m.
(b) 960 r.p.m.
(c) 1440 r.p.m.
(d) 2880 r.p.m.
Ans: a
Ans: d
@
SP
(c) starting the motor on load which is more than the rated load
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: d
63. Which is of the following data is required to draw the circle diagram for an induction
motor ?
(a) Block rotor test only
(b) No load test only
(c) Block rotor test and no-load test
(d) Block rotor test, no-load test and stator resistance test
Ans: d
64. In three-phase induction motors sometimes copper bars are placed deep in the rotor
to
(a) improve starting torque
(b) reduce copper losses
(c) improve efficiency
(d) improve power factor
Ans: a
67. The power scale of circle diagram of an induction motor can be found from
(a) stator resistance test
(6) no-load test only
(c) short-circuit test only
Jo
Ans: c
@
SP
(b) hyperbola
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: c
70. The stating torque of the slip ring induction motor can be increased by adding
(a) external inductance to the rotor
(b) external resistance to the rotor
(c) external capacitance to the rotor
(d) both resistance and inductance to rotor
Ans: b
71. A 500 kW, 3-phase, 440 volts, 50 Hz, A.C. induction motor has a speed of 960 r.p.m. on
full load. The machine has 6 poles. The slip of the machine will be
(a) 0.01
(b) 0.02
(c) 0.03
(d) 0.04
Ans: d
72. The complete circle diagram of induetion motor can be drawn with the help of data
found from
(a) noload test
(6) blocked rotor test
(c) stator resistance test
(d) all of the above
Ans: d
73. In the squirrel-cage induction motor the rotor slots are usually given slight skew
(a) to reduce the magnetic hum and locking tendency of the rotor
Jo
Ans: a
P U
74. The torque of a rotor in an induction motor under running condition is maximum
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) at the value of the slip which makes rotor reactance per phase equal to the resistance
per phase
(d) at the value of the slip which makes the rotor reactance half of the rotor
Ans: c
75. What will happen if the relative speed between the rotating flux of stator and rotor of
the induction motor is zero ?
(a) The slip of the motor will be 5%
(b) The rotor will not run
(c) The rotor will run at very high speed
(d) The torque produced will be very large
Ans: b
76. The circle diagram for an induction motor cannot be used to determine
(a) efficiency
(b) power factor
(c) frequency
(d) output
Ans: a
80. Which motor is preferred for use in mines where explosive gases exist ?
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) Induction motor
(c) D.C. shunt motor
(d) Synchronous motor
Ans: a
85. In case of a double cage induction motor, the inner cage has
Jo
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) stator reactance
(c) the reactive lagging magnetizing current necessary to generate the magnetic flux
(d) all of the above
Ans: d
88. Insertion of resistance in the rotcir of an induction motor to develop a given torque
(a) decreases the rotor current
(b) increases the rotor current
(c) rotor current becomes zero
(d) rotor current rernains same
Ans: d
89. For driving high inertia loods best type of induction motor suggested is
(a) slip ring type
(b) squirrel cage type
(c) any of the above
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
90. Temperature of the stator winding of a three phase induction motor is obtained by
(a) resistance rise method
(b) thermometer method
(c) embedded temperature method
(d) all above methods
Ans: d
Ans: a
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) slip times the stand still e.m.f. induced in the rotor
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
96. Slip ring motor is preferred over squirrel cage induction motor where
(a) high starting torque is required
(b) load torque is heavy
(c) heavy pull out torque is required
(d) all of the above
Ans: a
(d) applied voltage per1 stator phase is 57.7% of the line voltage
Ans: d
@
SP
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
100. The starting torque of a three phase induction motor can be increased by
(a) increasing slip
(b) increasing current
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
(d) the motor will run in the same direction at reduced r.p.m.
P U
Ans: a
B
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) current in the starting winding lags the voltage
(c) current in the starting winding is in phase with voltage in running winding
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
4. In a capacitor start and run motors the function of the running capacitor in series with
the auxiliary winding is to
(a) improve power factor
(b) increase overload capacity
(c) reduce fluctuations in torque
(d) to improve torque
Ans: a
5. In a capacitor start motor, the phase displacement between starting and running
winding can be nearly
(a) 10°
(b) 30°
(c) 60°
(d) 90°
Ans: d
8. Which of the following motor will give relatively high starting torque ?
in
Ans: a
B
TE
9. Which of the following motor will have relatively higher power factor ?
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) Capacitor run motor
(b) Shaded pole motor
(c) Capacitor start motor
(d) Split phase motor
Ans: a
11. In a shaded pole single-phase motor, the revolving field is produced by the use of
(a) inductor
(b) capacitor
(c) resistor
(d) shading coils
Ans: d
12. A centrifugal switch is used to dis- connect 'starting winding when motor has
(a) run for about 1 minute
(b) run for about 5 minutes
(c) picked up about 50 to 70 per cent of rated speed
(d) picked up about 10 to 25 per cent of rated speed
Ans: c
13. If a particular application needs high speed and high starting torque, then which of the
following motor will be
preferred ?
(a) Universal motor
(b) Shaded pole type motor
(c) Capacitor start motor
(d) Capacitor start and run motor
Jo
Ans: a
in
14. The value of starting capacitor of a fractional horse power motor will be
@
SP
(a) 100 uF
(6) 200 uF
P U
(c) 300 uF
B
(d) 400 uF
TE
Ans: c
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
17. The running winding of a single phase motor on testing with meggar is found to be
ground. Most probable location of the ground will be
(a) at the end connections
(b) at the end terminals
(c) anywhere on the winding inside a slot
(d) at the slot edge where coil enters or comes out of the slot
Ans: d
18. A capacitor-start single phase induction motor is switched on to supply with its
capacitor replaced by an inductor of equivalent reactance value. It will
(a) start and then stop
(b) start and run slowly
(c) start and run at rated speed
(d) not start at all
Ans: d
Ans: d
in
Ans: b
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
23. Direction of rotation of a split phase motor can be reversed by reversing the
connection of
(a) running winding only
(b) starting winding only
(c) either (a) or (b)
(d) both (a) and (b)
Ans: c
Ans: d
in
Ans: d
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
30. Which of the following motor will give the highest starting torque ?
(a) D.C. shunt motor
(b) Schrage motor
(c) Repulsion start and induction run motor
(d) Universal motor
Ans: b
Ans: c
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
33. Which of the following motors is preferred for tape-recorders ?
(a) Shaded pole motor
(b) Hysteresis motor
(c) Two value capacitor motor
(d) Universal motor
Ans: b
37. Which of the following single-phase motors is suitable for timing and control
purposes ?
(a) Reluctance motor
(b) Series motor
(c) Repulsion motor
(d) Universal motor
Ans: a
Jo
in
Ans: a
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
39. In split-phase motor iauxiliary winding is of
(a) thick wire placed at the bottom of the slots
(b) thick wire placed at the top of the slots
(c) thin wire placed at the top of the slots
(d) thin wire placed at the bottom of the slots
Ans: c
40. Which of the following motors will operate at high power factor ?
(a) Shaped pole motor
(b) Split phase motor
(c) Capacitor start motor
(d) Capacitor run motor
Ans: d
41. In a two value capacitor motor, the capacitor used for running purposes is
(a) air capacitor
(b) paper spaced oilfilled type
(c) ceramic type
(d) a.c. electrolytic type
Ans: b
42. Which of the following motors can be run on AC. as well as D.C. supply ?
(a) Universal motor
(b) Repulsion motor
(c) Synchronous motor
(d) Reluctance motor
Ans: a
44. Which of the following single-phase induction motors is generally used in time
in
phonographs ?
(a) Resistance start
@
SP
(d) Universal
B
Ans: c
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
45. Which of the following motors has highest starting torque ?
(a) Repulsion motor
(b) Shaped pole motor
(c) Capacitor-start motor
(d) Split-phase motor
Ans: c
47. In case of a shaded pole motor the direction of rotation of the motor is
(a) from main pole to shaded pole
(b) from shaded pole to main pole
(c) either of the above depending on voltage
(d) either of the above depending on power factor
Ans: a
48. In case of high speed universal motor which of the following needs more attention ?
(a) End play
(b) Air gap
(c) Insulation in rotor
(d) Balancing of rotor
Ans: d
49. The wattage rating for a ceiling fan motor will be in the range
(a) 200 to 250 W
(b) 250 to 500 W
(c) 50 to 150 W
(d) 10 to 20 W
Ans: c
Jo
50. The wattage of motor for driving domestic sewing machine will be around
in
(c) 10 to 30 W
(d) 5 to 10 W
P U
Ans: a
B
TE
51. Which of the following single-phase motors has relatively poor starting torque ?
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) Universal motor
(b) Repulsion motor
(c) Capacitor motor
(d) All single phase motors have zero starting torque
Ans: c
54. Which of the following motors can be used for unity power factor ?
(a) Capacitor run motor
(b) Shaded pole motor
(c) Hysteresis motor
(d) Schrage motor
Ans: d
55. When a D.C. series motor is connected to A.C. supply, the power factor will be low
because of
(a) high inductance of field and armature circuits
(b) induced current in rotor due to variations of flux
(c) fine copper wire winding
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
Jo
56. The direction of rotation of universal motor can be reversed the by reversing the flow
in
of current through
(a) armature winding
@
SP
Ans: c
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
57. In which single-phase motor, the rotor has no teeth or winding ?
(a) Split phase motor
(b) Reluctance motor
(c) Hysteresis motor
(d) Universal motor
Ans: c
58. Which motor is normally free from mechanical and magnetic vibrations ?
(a) Split phase motor
(b) Universal motor
(c) Hysteresis motor
(d) Shaded pole motor
Ans: c
59. As hysteresis motors are free from mechanical and magnetic vibrations therefore
these are considered as suitable for
(a) fans
(b) blowers
(c) sound equipment
(d) mixer grinders
Ans: c
(d) copper
B
Ans: c
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
63. The electric motor used in portable drills is
(a) capacitor run motor
(b) hysteresis motor
(c) universal motor
(d) repulsion motor
Ans: c
64. Which of the following applications always have some load whenever switched on ?
(a) Vacuum cleaners
(b) Fan motors
(c) Pistol drills
(d) All of the above
Ans: c
65. The speed control of universal motor used for sewing machines is by
(a) friction
(b) varying the resistance
(c) tapping the field
(d) centrifugal mechanism
Ans: b
Ans: a
B
TE
69. If the centrifugal switch does not open at 70 to 80 percent of synchronous speed of
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
motor, it would result in
(a) damage to the starting winding
(b) damage to the centrifugal switch
(c) overloading of running winding
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
70. Speed torque characteristic of a repulsion induction motor is similar to that of a D.C.
(a) shunt motor
(b) series motor
(c) compound motor
(d) separately excited motor
Ans: c
73. The rotor slots, in an induction motor, are usually not quite parallel to the shaft
because it
(a) improves the efficiency
(b) helps the rotor teeth to remain under the stator teeth
(c) helps in reducing the tendency of the rotor teeth to remain under the stator teeth
(d) improves the power factor
Ans: c
Jo
in
Ans: c
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
75. The purpose of stator winding in the compensated repulsion motor is to
(a) provide mechanical balance
(b) improve power factor and provide better speed regulation
(c) prevent hunting in the motor
(d) eliminate armature reaction
Ans: b
76. Which of the following motors is used for unity power factor ?
(a) Hysteresis motor
(b) Schrage motor
(c) Universal motor
(d) Reluctance motor
Ans: b
78. Which of the following motors is used in a situation where load increases with speed ?
(a) Induction motor
(b) Three-phase series motor
(c) Schrage motor
(d) Hysteresis motor
Ans: b
80. Centrifugal switch disconnects the auxiliary winding of the motor at about ____
in
(b) 70 to 80
(c) 80 to 90
P U
(d) 100
B
Ans: b
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
81. Starting winding of a single phase motor of a refrigerator is disconnected from the
circuit by means of a
(a) magnetic relay
(b) thermal relay
(c) centrifugal switch
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
82. If a single phase induction motor runs slower than normal, the most likely defect is
(a) worn bearings
(b) short-circuit in the winding
(c) open-circuit in the winding
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
84. Which of the following statements regarding two value capacitor motor is incorrect ?
(a) It is a reversing motor
(b) It is preferred to permanent-split single-value capacitor motor where frequent
reversals are required
(c) It has low starting as well as rush¬ing currents
(d) It has high starting torque
Ans: b
85. Two-value capacitor motor finds increased application as compressor motor in small
home air-conditioners
because
(a) it is comparatively cheaper
(b) it has almost non-destructible capacitor
Jo
(c) it has low starting as well as running currents at relatively high power factor
in
86. If the centrifugal switch of a two-value capacitor motor using two capacitors fails to
P U
open then
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) current drawn by the motor will be excessively high
(d) electrolytic capacitor will, in all probability, suffer break down
Ans: d
88. If starting winding of a single-phase induction motor is left in the circuit, it will
(a) run faster
(b) spark at light loads
(c) draw excessive current and overheat
(d) run slower
Ans: c
91. To reverse the direction of rotation of acapacitor start motor while it is running we
should
Jo
(a) disconnect motor from the supply till it stops then reconnect it to supply with
in
(d) reverse the direction of connections of the auxiliary winding and im-mediately
TE
connect it to supply
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: a
92. In case of a reluctance motor, when the load is increased so that it cannot maintain
synchronous speed the motor will
(a) become unstable
(b) draw excessive armature current and may burn out
(c) fall out of synchronism and come to stand still
(d) run as induction motor
Ans: d
93. Which of the following motors has two separate windings on the motor ?
(a) Repulsion motor
(b) Repulsion induction motor
(c) Repulsion start induction run motor
(d) None of the above
Ans: b
95. In a A.C. series motor armature coils are usually connected to commutator
(a) through resistance
(b) through reactances
(c) through capacitors
(d) solidly
Ans: a
(a) can be operated either on D.C. or A.C. supply at approximately the same speed and
B
output
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) runs at dangerously high speed on no-load
Ans: a
101. After the starting winding of a single phase induction motor is disconnected from
supply, it continues to run only on
(a) running winding
(b) rotor winding
(c) field winding
(d) compensating winding
Ans: a
(c) In fractional horse power motors, it has replaced the capacitor motors
(d) It is not easily reversed
@
SP
Ans: c
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) more number of armature turns
(d) less air gap
(e) all of the above
Ans: e
106. Hysteresis motor is particularly useful for high-quality record players and tape-
recorders because
(a) it revolves synchronously
(b) it is not subject to any magnetic or mechanical vibrations
(c) it can be easily manufactured in extremely small sizes of upto 1 W output
(d) it develops hysteresis torque which is extremely steady both in amplitude and phase
Ans: d
108. Which of the following statements regarding single-phase induction motoris correct
in
?
(a) It requires only one winding
@
SP
Ans: d
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
109. The starting winding of a single-phase motor is placed in
(a) armature
(b) field
(c) rotor
(d) stator
Ans: d
4. SYNCHRONOUS MOTORS
2. In case one phase of a three-phase synchronous motor is short-circuited the motor will
(a) not start
(b) run at 2/3 of synchronous speed
(c) run with excessive vibrations
(d) take less than the rated load
Ans: a
Ans: a
SP
P
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) below or above synchronous speed
Ans: c
7. Under which of the following conditions hunting of synchronous motor is likely to occur
?
(a) Periodic variation of load
(b) Over-excitation
(c) Over-loading for long periods
(d) Small and constant load
Ans: a
8. When the excitation of an unloaded salient pole synchronous motor suddenly gets
disconnected
(a) the motor stops
(b) it runs as a reluctance motor at the same speed
(c) it runs as a reluctance motor at a lower speed
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
9. When V is the applied voltage, then the breakdown torque of a synchronous motor
varies as
(a) V
Jo
(b) V312
in
(c) V2
(d) 1/V
@
SP
Ans: a
P U
10. The power developed by a synchronous motor will be maximum when the load angle
B
is
TE
(a) zero
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) 45°
(c) 90°
(d) 120°
Ans: c
12. A synchronous motor is running on a load with normal excitation. Now if the load on
the motor is increased
(a) power factor as well as armature current will decrease
(b) power factor as well as armature current will increase
(c) power factor will increase but armature current will decrease
(d) power factor will decrease and armature current will increase
Ans: d
15. As the load is applied to a synchronous motor, the motor takes more armature current
in
because
(a) the increased load has to take more current
@
SP
(b) the rotor by shifting its phase backward causes motor to take more current
(c) the back e.m.f. decreases causing an increase in motor current
P U
(d) the rotor strengthens the rotating field casuing more motor current
B
Ans: b
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
16. Synchronous motor always runs at
(a) the synchronous speed
(b) less than synchronous speed
(c) more than synchronous speed
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
19. The minimum armature current of the synchronous motor corresponds to operation at
(a) zero power factor leading
(b) unity power factor
(c) 0.707 power factor lagging
(d) 0.707 power factor leading
Ans: b
20. In a synchronous motor, the magnitude of stator back e.m.f. £& depends on
(a) d.c. excitation only
(b) speed of the motor
(c) load on the motor
(d) both the speed and rotor flux
Ans: a
Jo
in
21. If load (or torque) angle of a 4-pole synchronous motor is 6° electrical, its value in
mechanical degrees is
@
SP
(a) 2
(b) 3
P U
(c) 4
B
(d) 6
TE
Ans: b
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
22. For V-curves for a synchronous motor the graph is drawn between
(a) field current and armature current
(b) terminal voltage and load factor
(c) power factor and field current
(d) armature current and power factor
Ans: a
Ans: c
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
28. The shaft of synchronous motor is made of
(a) mild steel
(b) chrome steel
(c) alnico
(d) stainless steel
Ans: a
29. When the field of a synchronous motor is under-excited, the power factor will be
(a) leading
(b) lagging
(c) unity
(d) zero
Ans: b
32. The operating speed of a synchronous motor can be changed to new fixed value by
(a) changing the load
(b) changing the supply voltage
(c) changing frequency
(d) using brakes
Ans: c
Jo
Ans: c
B
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) when supply voltage fluctuates
(b) when load varies
(c) when power factor is unity
(d) motor is under loaded
Ans: b
37. The maximum power developed in a synchronous motor occurs at a coupling angle of
(a) 30°
(b) 60°
(c) 90°
(d) 180°
Ans: c
38. When the stator windings are connected in such a fashion that the number of poles
are made half, the speed of
the rotor of a synchronous motor
(a) remains same as the original value
(b) decreases to half the original value
(c) tends to becomes zero
(d) increases to two times the original value
Jo
Ans: d
in
39. In which of the following motors the stator and rotor magnetic field rotate at the same
@
SP
speed ?
(a) Universal motor
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: b
42. The standard full-load power factor ratings for synchronous motors are
(a) zero or 0.8 leading
(b) unity or 0.8 lagging
(c) unity or 0.8 leading
(d) unity or zero
Ans: c
43. A synchronous motor running with normal excitation adjusts to load increases
essentially by increase in
(a) back e.m.f.
(b) armature current
(c) power factor
(d) torque angle
Ans: b
44. A synchronous motor has better power factor as compared to that of an equivalent
induction motor. This is mainly
because
(a) synchronous motor has no slip
Jo
Ans: b
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) noise generator
(d) mechanical synchronizer
Ans: b
48. When the voltage applied to a synchronous motor is increased, which of the following
will reduce ?
(a) Stator flux
(b) Pull in torque
(c) Both (a) and (b)
(d) None of the above
Ans: d
51. The efficiency of a properly designed synchronous motor will usually fall in range
(a) 60 to 70%
(6) 75 to 80%
(c) 85 to 95%
(d) 99 to 99.5%
Ans: c
52. To limit the operating temperature an electrical machine should have proper
(a) voltage rating
Jo
Ans: b
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) no current
(d) all of the above
Ans: a
55. The armature current of the synchronous motor has higher values for
(a) high excitation only
(b) low excitation only
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
56. In a synchronous motor running with fixed excitation, when the load is increased
three times, its torque angle
becomes approximately
(a) one-third
(b) twice
(c) thrice
(d) six times
(e) nine times
Ans: c
57. The angle between the rotating stator flux and rotor poles is called _____ angle.
(a) torque
(b) obtuse
(c) synchronizing
(d) power factor
Ans: a
Jo
in
Ans: c
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
59. When the rotor speed, in a synchronous machine, becomes more than the
synchronous speed during hunting, the
damper bars develop
(a) inductor motor torque
(b) induction generator torque
(c) synchronous motor torque
(d) d.c. motor toque
(e) none of the above
Ans: b
60. An important advantage of a synchronous motor over wound round induction motor
is that
(a) its power factor may be varied at will
(b) its speed is independent of supply frequency
(c) its speed may be controlled more easily
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
61. The mechanical displacement of the rotor with respect to the stator, in polyphase
multipolar synchronous motors
running at full load, is of the order of
(a) zero degree
(b) two degrees
(c) five degrees
(d) ten degrees
Ans: c
Ans: c
B
TE
64. While starting a synchronous motor by induction motor action, field winding is
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
usually
(a) connected to D.C. supply
(b) short-circuited by low resistance
(c) kept open-circuited
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
66. If in a synchronous motor, driving mechanical load and drawing current at lagging
power factor from constant
voltage supply, its field excitation is increased, then its power factor
(a) become more
(b) become less
(c) remain constant
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
67. A synchronous motor installed at the receiving end substation operates with such an
excitation that it takes power
at lagging power factor. Now if the applied voltage of the synchronous motor goes down,
the power factor of the
synchronous motor will
(a) remain same
(b) go down
(c) improve
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
68. While starting a salient pole synchronous motor by induction motor action and
Jo
connecting field discharge resistance across field, starting and accelerting torque is
in
produced by
(a) induction motor torque in field winding
@
SP
Ans: e
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
70. If excitation of a synchronous motor running with a constant load is decreased from
its normal value, ignoring effects of armature reaction, it leads to
(a) increase in both armature current and power factor angle
(b) increase in back e.m.f. but decrease in armature current
(c) increase in both armature current and power factor which is lagging
(d) increase in torque angle but decrease in back e.m.f.
Ans: a
71. When a 3-phase synchronous generator is supplying a zero power factor lagging load,
the armature field affects
the main field in the following way
(a) augments it directly
(b) directly opposes it
(c) cross-magnetises it
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
73. The power factor of a synchronous motor is better than that of induction motor
because
(a) stator supply is relieved of responsibility of producing magnetic field
Jo
Ans: a
P U
74. If in a synchronous motor, driving a given mechanical load and drawing current at a
B
constant voltage supply its field excitation is increased, its power factor
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) will become more
(b) will become less
(c) will remain unchanged
(d) none of the above.
Ans: b
75. A synchronous motor is running with normal excitation. When the load is increased,
the armature current drawn
by it increases because
(a) speed of the motor is reduced
(b) power factor is decreased
(c) Eb (back e.m.f.) becomes less than V (applied voltage)
(d) Er (net resultant voltage) in armature is increased
(e) none of the above
Ans: d
77. If the field circuit of an unloaded salientpole synchronous motor gets suddenly open-
circuited, then
(a) it runs at a slower speed
(b) the motor stops
(c) it continues to run at the same speed
(d) it runs at a very high speed
Ans: b
78. In which of the following motors the stator and rotor fields rotate simultaneously ?
(a) D.C. motor
(b) Reluctance motor
(c) Universal motor
Jo
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
83. Due to which of the following reasons a synchronous motor fails to pull into
synchronism after applying D.C. field
current ?
(a) High field current
(b) Low short circuit ratio
(c) High core losses
(d) Low field current
Ans: d
Jo
in
84. In a synchronous motor, the maximum power developed depends on all of the
following except
@
SP
Ans: c
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
85. In a 3-phase synchronous motor, the negative phase sequence exists when the motor
is
(a) supplied with unbalanced voltage
(b) under-loaded
(c) over-loaded
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
87. The induced e.m.f. in a synchronous motor working on leading power factor will be
(a) more than the supply voltage
(b) less than the supply voltage
(c) equal to the supply voltage
Ans: a
88. The effect of increasing the load on a synchronous motor running with normal
excitation is to
(a) decrease both armature current and power factor
(6) decrease armature current but increase power factor
(c) increase armature current but decrease power factor
(d) increase both its armature current and power factor
Ans: c
Ans: d
in
(a) zero
(b) one
P U
(c) two
B
(d) infinity
TE
Ans: a
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
92. A 3-phase synchronous motor is running clockwise. If the direction of its field current
is reversed
(a) the motor will stop
(b) the motor continue to run in the same direction
(c) the winding of the motor will burn
(d) the motor will run in the reverse direction
(e) none of the above
Ans: b
Ans: a
@
SP
96. By which of the following methods the constant speed of a synchronous motor can be
changed to new fixed value ?
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) By changing the load.
Ans: a
98. In a 3-phase, 4-pole, 50 Hz synchronous motor, the frequency, pole number and load
torque all are halved. The motor speed will be
(a) 3000 r.p.m.
(b) 1500 r.p.m.
(c) 750 r.p.m.
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
99. A synchronous motor connected to infinite bus-bars has at constant full load, 100%
excitation and unity power fac
tor. On changing the excitation only, the armature current will have
(a) no change of power factor
(b) lagging power factor with over-excitation
(c) leading power factor with under-excitation
(d) leading power factor with over-excitation
Ans: d
101. In a synchronous motor it the back e.m.f. generated in the armature at noload is
Jo
Ans: d
B
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) prevent hunting and provide the starting torque
(b) reduce the eddy currents
(c) provide starting torque only
(d) reduce noise level
(e) none of the above
Ans: a
103. If the field of a synchronous motor is underexcited, the power factor will be
(a) zero
(b) unity
(c) lagging
(d) leading
Ans: c
105. The maximum value of torque that a synchronous motor can develop without losing
its synchronism, is known as
(a) slip torque
(b) pull-out torque
(c) breaking torque
(d) synchronising torque
Ans: d
106. In a synchronous motor, the armature current has large values for
(a) high excitation only
(b) low excitation only
(c) both high and low excitation
(d) none of the above
Jo
Ans: c
in
107. Which of the following losses, in a synchronous motor, does not vary with load?
@
SP
Ans: a
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
109. Which of the following losses is not dissipated by the stator core surface in a
synchronous motor ?
(a) Eddy current losses in the conductors
(b) Iron losses in the stator
(c) Copper losses in the slot portion of the conductors
(d) Windage losses
(e) None of the above
Ans: d
110. The duration of sudden snort-circuit test on a synchronous motor is usually about
(a) one hour
(b) one minute
(c) one second
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
111. The maximum constant load torque under which a synchronous motor will pull into
synchronism at rated rotor
supply voltage and frequency is known as
(a) pull-up torque
(b) pull-in torque
(c) pull-out torque
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) an induction motor
(c) an alternator
(d) a rotary converter
Ans: c
114. If the field winding of an unloaded salient pole synchronous motor is open circuited,
the motor will
(a) stop
(b) run as induction motor
(c) function as static condenser
(d) burn with dense smoke
Ans: a
116. The maximum torque which a synchronous motor will develop at rest for any
angular position of the rotor, at rated
stator supply voltage and frequency, is known as
(a) locked-rotor torque
(b) synchronous torque
(c) pull up torque
(d) reluctance torque
Ans: a
118. The coupling angle or load angle of synchronous motor is defined as the angle
between the
@
SP
Ans: b
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
119. If the synchronous motor, properly synchronised to the supply is running on no load
and is having negligible loss
then
(a) the stator current will be zero
(b) the stator current will be very small
(c) the stator current will be very high
(d) the back e.m.f. will be more than the supply voltage
(e) none of the above
Ans: a
122. A synchronous motor which works on a leading power factor and does not drive a
mechanical load is called as
(a) static condenser
(b) condenser
(c) synchronous condenser
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
(a) 45°
in
(b) 60°
(c) 90°
@
SP
(d) 120°
Ans: c
P U
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) directly proportional to the square of the applied voltage
(c) inversely proportional to applied voltage
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
2 are the conductors, which connect the consumer's terminals to the distribution
(a) Distributors
(b) Service mains
(c) Feeders
(d) None of the above
Ans: b
5. If variable part of annual cost on account of interest and depreciation on the capital
@
annual cost of electrical energy wasted in the conductors, the total annual cost will be
P
minimum and the corresponding size of conductor will be most economical. This statement
U
B
is known as
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) Kirchhoffs law
(d) Faraday's law
(e) none of the above
Ans: a
6. The wooden poles well impregnated with creosite oil or any preservative compound
have life
(a) from 2 to 5 years
(b) 10 to 15 years
(c) 25 to 30 years
(d) 60 to 70 years
Ans: c
7. Which of the following materials is not used for transmission and distribution of
electrical power ?
(a) Copper
(b) Aluminium
(c) Steel
(d) Tungsten
Ans: d
Ans: d
B
TE
11. Which of the following are the constants of the transmission lines ?
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) Resistance
(b) Inductance
(c) Capacitance
(d) All of the above
Ans: d
13. The phenomenon qf rise in voltage at the receiving end of the open-circuited or lightly
loaded line is called the
(a) Seeback effect
(b) Ferranti effect
(c) Raman effect
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
14. The square root of the ratio of line impedance and shunt admittance is called the
(a) surge impedance of the line
(b) conductance of the line
(c) regulation of the line
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
15. Which of the following is the demerit of a 'constant voltage transmission system' ?
(a) Increase of short-circuit current of the system
(b) Availability of steady voltage at all loads at the line terminals
(c) Possibility of better protection for the line due to possible use of higher terminal
reactances
(d) Improvement of power factor at times of moderate and heavy loads
(e) Possibility of carrying increased power for a given conductor size in case of long-
Jo
transmission
@
SP
Ans: a
PU
(a)l.lkV
TE
(b)3.3kV
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c)6.6kV
(d)llkV
Ans: e
20. Which of the following methods is used for laying of underground cables ?
(a) Direct laying
(b) Draw-in-system
(c) Solid system
(d) All of the above
Ans: d
21. Which of the following is the source of heat generation in the cables ?
(a) Dielectric losses in cable insulation
Jo
Ans:
P U
22. Due to which of the following reasons the cables should not be operated too hot ?
B
(a) The oil may loose its viscosity and it may start drawing off from higher levels
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) Unequal expansion may create voids in the insulation which will lead to ionization
(d) The thermal instability may rise due to the rapid increase of dielectric losses with
temperature
(e) All of the above
Ans: e
23. Which of the following D.C. distribution system is the simplest and lowest in first cost
?
(a) Radial system
(b) Ring system
(c) Inter-connected system
(d) None of the above
Ans: a
24. A booster is a
(a) series wound generator
(b) shunt wound generator
(c) synchronous generator
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
25. Besides a method of trial and error, which of the following methods is employed for
solution of network problems
in interconnected system ?
(a) Circulating current method
(b) Thevenin's theorem
(c) Superposition of currents
(d) Direct application of Kirehhoffs laws
(e) All of the above
Ans: e
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) all of the above
Ans: d
Ans: a
@
SP
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(e) none of the above
Ans: d
35. The material commonly used for insulation in high voltage cables is
(a) lead
(b) paper
(c) rubber
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
Ans: c
@
SP
(b) wood
B
(c) R.C.C.
TE
(d) steel
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
Ans: d
40. The material generally used for armour of high voltage cables is
(a) aluminium
(b) steel
(c) brass
(d) copper
Ans: b
43. The minimum clearance between the ground and a 220 kV line is about
(a) 4.3 m
(b) 5.5 m
(c) 7.0 m
(d) 10.5 m
Ans: c
44. The spacing between phase conductors of a 220 kV line is approximately equal to
(a) 2 m
(b) 3.5 m
(c) 6 m
(d) 8.5 m
Jo
Ans: c
in
(a) 400 V
(b) 11 kV
P U
(c) 66 kV
B
(d) 400 kV
TE
Ans: c
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
46. In a D.C. 3-wire distribution system, balancer fields are cross-connected in order to
(a) boost the generated voltage
(b) balance loads on both sides of the neutral
(c) make both machine^ run as unloaded motors
(d) equalize voltages on the positive and negative outers
Ans: d
47. In a D.C. 3-wire distributor using balancers and having unequal loads on the two sides
(a) both balancers run as generators
(b) both balancers run as motors
(c) balancer connected to lightly- loaded side runs as a motor
(d) balancer connected to heavily- loaded side runs as a motor
Ans: c
48. Transmitted power remaining the same, if supply voltage of a D.C. 2-wire feeder is
increased 100 percent, saving in copper is
(a) 25 percent
(b) 50 percent
(c) 75 percent
(d) 100 percent
Ans: b
49. A uniformly-loaded D.C. distributor is fed at both ends with equal voltages. As
compared to a similar distributor fed at one end only, the drop at the middle point is
(a) one-fourth
(b) one-third
(c) one-half
(d) twice
(e) none of the above
Ans: a
50. As compared to a 2-wire D.C. distributor, a 3-wire distributor with same maximum
voltage to earth uses only
(a) 31.25 percent of copper
Jo
Ans: a
P U
(a) 6.6 kV
TE
(b) 8.8 kV
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) 11 kV
(d) 13.2 kV
Ans: b
57. Which of the following materials is used for overhead transmission lines ?
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) Galvanised steel
(c) Cadmium copper
(d) Any of the above
Ans: d
58. Which of the following is not a constituent for making porcelain insulators ?
(a) Quartz
(b) Kaolin
(c) Felspar
(d) Silica
Ans: d
Ans: c
B
TE
63. Which of the following characteristics should the line supports for transmission lines
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
possess ?
(a) Low cost
(b) High mechanical strength
(c) Longer life
(d) All of the above
Ans: d
67. A conductor, due to sag between two supports, takes the form of
(a) semi-circle
(b) triangle
(c) ellipse
(d) catenary
Ans: d
Jo
in
68. In AC.S.R. conductors, the insulation between aluminium and steel conductors is
(a) insulin
@
SP
(b) bitumen
(c) varnish
P
U
Ans: d
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
69. Which of the followingbus-bar schemes has the lowest cost ?
(a) Ring bus-bar scheme
(b) Single bus-bar scheme
(c) Breaker and a half scheme
(d) Main and transfer scheme
Ans: b
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) circuit breaker is not open
Ans: b
75. For which of the following equipment current rating is not necessary ?
(a) Circuit breakers
(b) Isolators
(c) Load break switch
(d) Circuit breakers and load break switches
Ans: b
77. jCorona usually occurs when the electrostatic stress in air around the conductor
exceeds
(a) 6.6 kV (r.m.s. value)/cm
(b) 11 kV (r.m.s. value)/cm
(c) 22 kV (maximum value)/cm
(d) 30 kV (maximum v^lue)/cm
Ans: d
78. The voltage drop, for constant voltage transmission is compensated by installing
(a) inductors
(b) capacitors
(c) synchronous motors
(d) all of above
(e) none of the above
Ans: c
79. The use of strain type insulators is made where the conductors are
(a) dead ended
Jo
Ans: c
P U
(a) non-sinusoidal
TE
(b) sinusoidal
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) triangular
(d) square
Ans: a
81. Pin type insulators are generally not used for voltages beyond
(a) 1 kV
(b) 11 kV
(c) 22 kV
(d) 33 kV
Ans: d
83. For transmission of power over a distance of 200 km, the transmission voltage should
be
(a) 132 kV
(b) 66 kV
(c) 33 kV
(d) 11 kV
Ans: a
84. For aluminium, as compared to copper, all the following factors have higher values
except
(a) specific volume
(6) electrical conductivity
(c) co-efficient of linear expansion
(d) resistance per unit length for same cross-section
Ans: b
85. Which of the following equipment, for regulating the voltage in distribution feeder,
Jo
Ans: d
B
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) primary winding
(b) secondary winding
(c) high voltage winding
(d) any of the above
Ans: b
90. For transmission of power over a distance of 500 km, the transmission voltage should
be in the range
(a) 150 to 220 kV
(b) 100 to 120 kV
(c) 60 to 100 kV
(d) 20 to 50 kV
Ans: a
Jo
91. In the analysis of which of the following lines shunt capacitance is neglected ?
in
Ans: a
B
TE
92. When the interconnector between two stations has large reactance
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) the transfer of power will take place with voltage fluctuation and noise
(b) the transfer of power will take place with least loss
(c) the stations will fall out of step because of large angular displacement between the
stations
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
94. When an alternator connected to the bus-bar is shut down the bus-bar voltage will
(a) fall
(b) rise
(c) remain unchanged
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
95. The angular displacement between two interconnected stations is mainly due to
(a) armature reactance of both alternators
(b) reactance of the interconnector
(c) synchronous reactance of both the alternators
(d) all of the above
Ans: a
97. Series capacitors on transmission lines are of little use when the load VAR
requirement is
@
SP
(a) large
(b) small
P U
(b) fluctuating
B
Ans: b
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
98. The voltage regulation in magnetic amplifier type voltage regulator is effected by
(a) electromagnetic induction
(b) varying the resistance
(c) varying the reactance
(d) variable transformer
Ans: c
99. When a conductor carries more current on the surface as compared to core, it is due
to
(a) permeability variation
(b) corona
(c) skin effect
(d) unsymmetrical fault
(e) none of the above
Ans: c
102. When a live conductor of public electric supply breaks down and touches the earth
which of the following will happen ?
(a) Current will flow to earth
(b) Supply voltage will drop
Jo
Ans: a
P U
5. B. DC GENERATORS
B
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) high dielectric strength
(c) high mechanical strength
(d) all of the above
Ans: d
4. Empire tape is
(a) varnished cambric
(b) vulcanised rubber
(c) impregnated paper
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
5. The thickness of the layer of insulation on the conductor, in cables, depends upon
(a) reactive power
(b) power factor
(c) voltage
(d) current carrying capacity
Ans: c
(b) jute
in
Ans: c
P U
(b) be non-inflammable
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) be non-hygroscopic
(d) have all above properties
Ans: d
9. The current carrying capacity of cables in D.C. is more thanthat in A.C. mainly due to
(a) absence of harmonics
(b) non-existence of any stability limit
(c) smaller dielectric loss
(d) absence of ripples
(e) none of the above
Ans: c
10. In case of three core flexible cable the colour of the neutral is
(a) blue
(b) black
(c) brown
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
(b) armoured
in
Ans: a
P U
(a) armour
TE
(b) bedding
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) conductor surface
(d) lead sheath
Ans: d
(c) 66 kV
in
(d) 132 kV
Ans: a
@
SP
(a) 5 ohms
B
(b) 20 ohms
TE
(c) 50 ohms
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) 100 ohms
Ans: c
(c) belted
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(d) armoured
Ans: a
30. A certain cable has an insulation of relative permittivity 4. If the insulation is replaced
by one of relative permittivity 2, the capacitance of the cable will become
(a) one half
(6) double
Jo
31. If a cable of homogeneous insulation has a maximum stress of 10 kV/mm, then the
P U
(a) 5 kV/mm
TE
(b) 10 kV/mm
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(a) 15 kV/mm
(d) 30 kV/mm
Ans: b
35. The breakdown of insulation of the cable can be avoided economically by the use of
(a) inter-sheaths
(b) insulating materials with different dielectric constants
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
Ans: a
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(c) hysteresis, leakage and copper losses only
(d) hysteresis, leakage, copper and friction losses
Ans: b
(a) 0.04 mm
in
(d) 40 to 60 mm
Ans: a
P U
B
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) paper insulated
(c) compressed oil or compressed gas insulated
(d) rubber insulated
(e) none of the above
Ans: c
44. Is a cable is to be designed for use on 1000 kV, which insulation would you prefer ?
(a) Polyvinyle chloride
(b) Vulcanised rubber
(c) Impregnated paper
(d) Compressed SFe gas
(e) none of the above
Ans: d
45. If a power cable and a communication cable are to run parallel the minimum distance
between the two, to avoid interference, should be
(a) 2 cm
(b) 10 cm
(c) 50 cm
(d) 400 cm
Ans: c
Ans: d
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
49. The disadvantage with paper as insulating material is
(a) it is hygroscopic
(6) it has high capacitance
(c) it is an organic material
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
52. In congested areas where excavation is expensive and inconvenient 'draw in system'
of laying of underground cables
is often adopted.
(a) Yes
(b) No
Ans: a
(b) No
Ans: a
P U
B
(a) Yes
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING OBJECTIVE TYPE QUESTIONS
(b) No
Ans: b
56. The metallic sheath may be made of lead or lead alloy or of aluminium.
(a) Yes
(b) No
Ans: b
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Electrical
Engineering
Questions
with
Answers
Jo
2017
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
TSPSC-AEE- 2017 Questions with Answers
(ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING)
01. A generating station has a maximum 04. The inductance of single phase two wire
demand of 30 MW, a load factor of 60% and power transmission line per km gets doubled
a plant capacity factor of 50%. The reserve when the
capacity of the plant is (a) Distance between wires is doubled
(a) 5 MW (b) 4 MW (b) Distance between the wires is increased
(c) 6 MW (d) 10 MW four fold
01. Ans: (c) (c) Distance between the wires is increased
as square of the original distance
02. A 100 km long transmission line is loaded at (d) Radius of the wire is doubled
110 kV. If the loss of the line is 15 MW and 04. Ans: (c)
the load is 150 MVA, the resistance of the
line is 05. The dielectric strength of impregnated
(a) 8.06 ohms per phase papers is about
(b) 0.806 ohms per phase (a) 20 kV/mm (b) 30 kV/mm
(c) 0.0806 ohms per phase (c) 15 kV/mm (d) 5 kV/mm
(d) 80.6 ohms per phase 05. Ans: (b)
02. Ans: (a)
06. HVDC transmission is preferred to EHV AC
03. When the load on a transmission line is because
equal to the surge impedance loading (a) HVDC terminal equipments are
(a) The receiving end voltage is less than inexpective
the sending end voltage (b) VAR compensation is not required in
(b) The sending end voltage is less than the HVDC systems
Jo
(c) The receiving end voltage is more than (d) Harmonic problem is avoided
SP
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
:2: TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
07. Zero-sequence current is used for relaying required inductive reactance for neutral
purpose only in the case of grounding is
(a) Phase over current relay (a) 0.05 p.u. (b) 0.0166 p.u.
(b) Phase impedance relay (c) 0.1 p.u. (d) 0.15 p.u.
(c) Ground over current relay 10. Ans: (b)
(d) Ground impedance relay
07. Ans: (d) 11. The critical clearing time of a fault in power
system is related to
08. A 10 kVA, 400 V/200 V single phase (a) Reactive power limit
transformer with 10% impedance draws a (b) Steady state stability limit
steady short-circuit line current of (c) Short-circuit current limit
(a) 250A (b) 50 A (d) Transient stability limit
(c) 150 A (d) 350 A 11. Ans: (d)
08. Ans: (a)
12. If the inertia constant H of a machine of 200
09. In a 3-phase extra-high voltage cable, a MVA is 2 p.u., its value corresponding to
metallaic screen around each core insulation 400 MVA will be
is provided to (a) 4 p.u. (b) 2 p.u.
(a) Facilitate heat dissipation (c) 1.0 p.u. (d) 0.5 p.u.
(b) Give mechanical strength 12. Ans: (c)
(c) Obtain longitudinal electric stress
(d) Obtain radial electric stress 13. In case of a 3-phase short-circuit fault in a
09. Ans: (b) system, the power fed into the system is
(a) Mostly reactive
Jo
10. The severity of line to ground and three (b) Reactive only
in
@
synchronous generator is to be same. If the (d) Active and Reactive both equal
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
:3: TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
14. The maximum demand of a consumer is 2 18. The X/R ratio for 220 kV line as compared
kW and his daily energy consumption is 20 to 400 kV line is
units. His load factor is (a) Equal (b) Greater
(a) 10% (b) 42% (c) Smaller (d) Not equal
(c) 60% (d) 41.6% 18. Ans: (b)
14. Ans: (d)
19. Large size steam plants and nuclear plants
15. In order to quench the are quickly and also are suitable for
optimize the dimensions generally (a) Intermediate loads
(a) Air blast C.B. is preferred (b) Base loads
(b) Oil C.B. is preferred (c) Both base and peak loads
(c) SF6 C.B. is preferred (d) Peak loads
(d) Minimum oil C.B. is preferred 19. Ans: (b)
15. Ans: (c)
20. Transmission of power by a.c. cables is
16. If a voltage-controlled bus is treated as load impossible beyond
bus, then which one of the following limits (a) 500 km (b) 300 km
would be violated? (c) 250 km (d) 45 km
(a) Active power (b) Reactive power 20. Ans: (d)
(c) Voltage (d) Phase angle
16. Ans: (b) 21. The corona loss in a 50 Hz system is 0.25
kW/ph/km. At a frequency of 60 Hz, the
17. A suspension type insulator has three units corona loss would be
with self-capacitance C and ground (a) 0.30 kW/ph/km (b) 0.36 kW/ph/km
Jo
capacitance of 0.2 C having a string (c) 028 kW/ph/km (d) 0.21 kW/ph/km
in
@
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
:4: TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
R = 2 L=2 Henry
@
Vs C =2 Farads
B
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
:5: TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
(b) S = 0.9 and S = –1.8 36. Find out maximum frequency of the transfer
in
@
(S 2)
(d) S = –6.8 and S = –1.8
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
:6: TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
37. In lag compensator the damping ratio, gain 41. Standardization of potentiometers is done in
and steady state error (ess) are order that, they become
(a) Decreases, Decreases and Increases (a) Accurate
(b) Decreases, Increases and Increases (b) Precise
(c) Increases, Increases and Decreases (c) Accurate and direct reading
(d) Increases, Decreases and Decreases (d) Accurate and precise
37. Ans: (d) 41. Ans: (c)
38. Find the K value for unity feedback transfer 42. Maxwell's Inductance-Capacitance bridge is
k used for measurement of inductance of
function G (s) when ess= 80%
S(S 1) (a) Low Q coils
(a) 1 (b) 5 (b) Medium Q coils
(c) 8 (d) 2 (c) High Q coils
38. Ans: (a) (d) Low and medium Q coils
42. Ans: (b)
39. Horizontally mounted moving iron
instruments use 43. If the distance of screen from a CRT to
(a) Eddy current damping center of deflection plates is 15 cm, the
(b) Electromagnetic damping length of deflection plates is 2 cm, the
(c) Fluid friction damping distance between the plates is 1 cm and
(d) Air friction damping accelerating voltage is 500 V, deflection
39. Ans: (d) sensitivity is
(a) 33.2 V/cm (b) 0.03 cm/V
40. Light load adjustments for induction type (c) 66.4 V/cm (d) 0.015 cm/V
Jo
(b) 5% of full load current 44. Gearing, blacklash, friction between moving
P U
(c) 50% of full load current parts and scale accuracies are generally
B
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
:7: TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
given below:
SP
48. Wagner's earth devices are used in AC (c) Only 2 and 3 (d) Only 1 and 4
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
:8: TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
:9: TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
52. Which one of the following frequency meter 56. The 8086 fetches instruction one after
53. Integrating principle in the digital (b) Signed numbers go out of their range
(a) Voltage to time (c) Carry and sign flags are set
______ mode.
@
(d) Medium
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 10 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
59. Which microprocessor accepts the program 63. Which of the following notations have two
written for 8086 without any changes? repetitions of zero ?
(a) 8085 (b) 8088 (P) 1’s complement with radix of number
(c) 80186 (d) 80188 being 2
59. Ans: (b) (Q) 7’s complement with radix of number
being 8.
60. In an R-C phase shift oscillator, the (R) 9’s complement with radix of number
minimum number of R-C networks to be being 10.
connected in cascade will be (S) 10’s complement with radix of number
(a) One (b) Two being 10
(c) Three (d) Four Select the correct answer using the codes
60. Ans: (c) given below:
(a) P,Q and S (b) P and R
61. The multivibrator circuit which processes (c) Q, R and S (d) P,Q and R
one stable state and one quasi stable is 63. Ans: (d)
(a) Astabel
(b) Monostable 64. Which of the following circuits come under
(c) Bistable the class of sequential logic circuits ?
(d) Schmitt trigger circuit P. Full adder
61. Ans: (b) Q. Full subtractor
R. Half adder
62. Introducing a resistor in the emitter of a S. JK flip
common amplifier stabilizes the DC T. Counter
operating point against variations in Select the correct answer from the codes
Jo
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 11 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
65. Which signal of 8085 microprocessor is across the load. For conduction angle , the
used to insert wait states ? main diode and freewheeling diode would
(a) Ready (b) ALE respectively, conduct for
(c) HOLD (d) INTR (a) , (b) ,
65. Ans: (a) (c) , (d) –,
69. Ans: (b)
66. In an 8085 microprocessor, the contents of
accumulator, after the following instructions
70. A single-phase full-bridge diode rectifier
are executed will become
delivers a load current of 10A, which is
XRA A
ripple free. Average and rms values of diode
MVI B F0H
currents are respectively
SUB B
(a) 10A, 7.07A (b) 5A, 10A
(a) 01 H (b) 0F H (c) F0 H (d) 10 H
(c) 5A, 7.07A (d) 7.07A, 5A
66. Ans: (d)
70. Ans: (c)
68. In an npn transistor, _____ are the minority 72. Turn-on time of an SCR in series with RL
carriers. circuit can be reduced by
Jo
in
(a) Free electrons (b) Acceptor ions (a) Increasing circuit resistance R
@
(d) Decreasing L
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 12 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
73. For an UJT employed for the triggering of (b) Two full converters connected back to
an SCR, stand-off ratio = 0.64 and dc back
source voltage VBB is 20V. The UJT would (c) Two full converters connected in
trigger when the emitter voltage is parallel.
(a) 12.8V (b) 13.1V (d) Two semiconverters connected back to
(c) 10V (d) 5V back.
73. Ans: (b) 77 Ans: (b)
74. In a single-phase full converter, for 78. In dc choppers per unit ripple is maximum
continuous conduction, each pair of SCRs when duty cycle is
conduct for (a) 0.2 (b) 0.5
(a) – (b) (c) 0.7 (d) 0.9
75. In a 3-phase half-wave rectifier, if per phase voltage consists of rectangular pulse of
input is 200 V, then the average output duration 1 msec in an overall cycle time of 3
(a) 233.91 V (b) 116.95V factor for this chopper are respectively.
(b) 60
P
(a) 30
U
B
77. The four-quadrant dual operation requires (c) 120 (d) 150
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 13 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 14 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
81. In a single phase voltage controller with RL 84. As compared to power MOSFET, a BJT has
load, ac output power can be controlled if (a) Lower switching losses but higher
(a) Firing angle > (load phase angle) and conduction losses
conduction angle = (b) Higher switching losses and higher
(b) Increase
dt 86. Ans: (b)
in
@
dv
SP
(c) Decrease
dt 87. An unsaturated dc shunt motor runs at its
P U
(d) Keep transient overvoltage at a constant rated speed when rated voltage is applied to
B
TE
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 15 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
(a) Increases by 25% 91. A three phase slip ring induction motor with
(b) Remains the same chopper controlled resistance has its torque
(c) Decreases by 25% proportional to
(d) Decrease only slightly by an amount less (a) Rotor current
than 25% (b) Stator resistance
87. Ans: (b) (c) Square of rotor current
(d) Square root of rotor current
88. In v/f control method,
91. Ans: (c)
(a) The maximum torque decreases
(b) The motor speed increases
92. In static Kramer drive, motor turns ratio is
(c) The maximum torque is constant
0.6, the firing angle is 120. The motor slip
(d) The maximum torque increases
is
88. Ans: (c)
(a) 0.633 (b) 0.533
(a) R2 (1 –) b)
in
(c) 38 kW (d) 48 kW
(c) R (1–) (d) R (1 – )2
@
of
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 16 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
(a) Electric are heating 98. The average speed of a train is independent
(b) Resistance heating of
(c) Induction heating (a) Duration of steps
(d) Dielectric heating (b) Acceleration and braking retardation
94. Ans: (b) (c) Distance between stops
(d) Running time
95. In which of the following welding methods, 98. Ans: (a)
the molten metal is poured for joining the
metals ? 99. Nichrome wires can be safely used for
(a) Gas welding heating upto
(b) Thermit welding (a) 1200 C (b) 1400 C
(c) TIG welding (c) 1500 C (d) 2000 C
(d) Arc welding 99. Ans: (a)
95. Ans: (b)
100. V being the voltage impressed on a
96. Which of the following vapour/gas will give dielectric, dielectric loss is proportional to
yellow colour in a filament lamp? (a) V (b) V2
(a) Helium (b) Mercury (c) 1/V (d) V–2
(c) Magnesium (d) Sodium 100. Ans: (b)
96. Ans: (d)
101. The coefficient of adhesion is
97. For continuously running rolling mills with (a) Zero in traction systems
intermittent loading, the most suitable DC (b) Low in case of AC traction high in DC
drive is traction
Jo
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 17 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
102. In HPSV lamps, traces of neon gas 106. The flicker effect of fluorescent lamps is
(a) Helps in stabilizing the arc more pronounced at
(b) Changes the colour of light (a) Lower frequencies
(c) Prevents the vaporization of filament (b) Higher frequencies
(d) Assists during starting to develop enough (c) Lower voltage
heat to vaporize sodium (d) Higher voltages
102. Ans: (d) 106. Ans: (a)
103. Which of the following lamp light output is 107. In an electric press, mica is used
comparable with that of day light? (a) As an insulator
(a) Fluorescent lamp (b) As a device for power factor
(b) Sodium vapour lamp improvement
(c) Mercury vapour lamp (c) For dielectric heating
(d) Halogen lamp (d) For induction heating
103. Ans: ( ) 107. Ans: (a)
104. Bearings used to support axles of traction 108. Gray iron is usually welded by
coaches are (a) Gas welding
(a) Ball bearings (b) Bush bearings (b) TIG welding
(c) Roller bearings (d) Journal bearings (c) MIG welding
104. Ans: (c) (d) Arc welding
108. Ans: (a)
105. Change in the frequency of supply does not
affect the 109. Three resistances each of R ohms are
Jo
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 18 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
110. If the number of branches in a network is 114. In a pure inductive circuit, if the supply
'B', the number of nodes is 'N' and the frequency is reduced to half, the current will
number of dependent loops is 'L', then the be
number of independent node equations will (a) Reduced to one fourth
be (b) Reduced to half
(a) N+L–1 (b) B–1 (c) Doubled
(c) B–N (d) N–1 (d) Four times at high
110. Ans: (d) 114. Ans: (c)
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 19 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
(c) three phase load is connected to the 120. A 200 V, 50 Hz inductive circuit takes
source through three wires current of 10 amp, lagging 30o. The
(d) three phase load is connected to the inductive reactance of the circuit is
source through four wires (a) 20 (b) 16
117. Ans: (c) (c) 17.32 (d) 10
120. Ans: (d)
118. Measurement of power and power factor of
a 3-phase system by two wattmeter method 121. The surface integral of the electrical field
can be obtained in case of intensity is the
1. Balanced load and balanced source (a) net flux eliminating from the surfaces
2. Balanced source with 3-phase 3-wire (b) Electrical charge
unbalanced load (c) Charge density
3. Unbalanced source with 3-phase 3-wire (d) Flux density
balanced load 121. Ans: (a)
4. Balanced source with 3-phase 4-wire
unbalanced load 122. Which of the following is a vector quantity?
5. unbalanced and unbalanced source (a) Magnetic potential
(a) 1 only (b) 2, 3 and 5 (b) Susceptibility
(c) 1, 2, 3, 4 and 5 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 5 (c) Magnetic flux intensity
118. Ans: (d) (d) Magnetic flux density
122. Ans: (d)
119. The time constant of an RC circuit is defined
as the time taken by the voltage across the 123. Which law is synonymous to the occurrence
capacitor to become_____ of its final value of diamagnetism?
Jo
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 20 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
List-I
SP
B. Hopkinson’s test
TE
C. Swinburne’s test
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 21 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 22 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
128. What are the slot wedges in a DC machine 3. Reduce the risk of voltage shock in case
made of? of insulation breakdown
(a) Mild steel (b) Silicon steel 4. Reduce the core loss
(c) Fibre (d) Cast iron From these, the correct answer is
128. Ans: (c) (a) 1, 2, 3 (b) 2, 3, 4
(c) 1, 2, 3, 4 (d) 2, 3
129. A transformer has a percentage resistance of 131. Ans: (d)
2% and percentage reactance of 4%. What
are its regulations at power factor 0.8 132. For a constant load current, transformer
lagging and 0.8 leading respectively? maximum efficiency occurs at
(a) 4% and 0.8% (a) any power factor
(b) 3.2% and 1.6% (b) zero power factor leading
130. In a transformer, zero voltage regulation at 133. The hysteresis and eddy current losses of a
(b) Possible at unity power factor load The percentage decrease in these when
(c) Possible at leading power factor load operated on a 160 V, 40 Hz supply are
(d) Possible at lagging power factor laod (a) 32, 36 (b) 20, 36
placed near the core in case of concentric 134. Potier reactance of an alternator is almost
SP
the same as
P
windings so as to
U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 23 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
(c) Leakage reactance of field winding 137. Skew of rotor bar eliminates
(d) Armature leakage reactance 1. The effect of space harmonics
134. Ans: (d) 2. The entire effect of crawling
3. Magnetic noise
135. A synchronous motor operates at 0.8 pf 4. Vibration due to unequal force developed
lagging. If the field current of the motor is on rotor
continuously increased 137. Ans: (d)
1. The power factor decreases upto a
certain value of field current and 138. It is desirable to eliminate 5th harmonic
thereafter it increases. voltage from the phase voltage of an
2. The armature current increases upto a alternator. The coils should be short pitched
certain value of field current and by, an electrical angle of
thereafter it decreases. (a) 30o (b) 36o
3. The power factor increases upto a certain (c) 72o (d) 18o
value of field current and thereafter it 138. Ans: (b)
decrease
4. The armature current decreases upto a 139. The speed of a 3-phase induction motor is
certain value of field current and controlled by controlling its supply
thereafter it, increases. frequency. If the speed of the machine is
From these, the correct answer is reduced by reducing the frequency by 50%
(a) 1, 2 (b) 3, 4 of the rated frequency; to keep the flux in
(c) 1, 3 (d) 2, 4 the machine constant, the motor voltage
135. Ans: (b) compared to rated voltage must be
(a) increased by 25%
Jo
o o
(a) 90 (b) 180 (d) decreased by 25%
P U
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 24 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
: 25 : TSPSC-AEE-2017 Questions with Key
1 s
(a) n full pitch (b) full pitch (c) (1 s) (d)
n 1 s
2 3 147. Ans: (c)
(c) full pitch (d) full pitch
n n
145. Ans: (b) 148. For C coils and P poles, the distance
between the coils connected by an equalizer
146. Consider the following statements: ring is
1. A grid connected induction generator C C
(a) (b)
always supplies leading reactive power P 2
to the bus 2C C
(c) (d)
2. An overexcited synchronous motor P 2P
4. The torque angle of a synchronous the alternator in one hour (assume 100%
machine is the angle between the efficiency of generator and turbine) will be
nuclear reactors?
147. The approximate value of efficiency of a
@
‘s’ is given by
B
1 s
(a) (b)
C
1 s 1 s
H
-T
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
HEARTY CONGRATULATIONS
TO OUR ESE - 2016 TOPPERS
Total No. of Ranks In Top 100 In ESE - 2016 E&T : 50 | ME : 47 | EE : 46 | CE : 45
E
& 1
st
RANK
NAVEEN
BHUSHAN 2
RANK
nd
VINIT RANJAN 6
RANK
th
13 ATUL JOSHI
th
14 AYUSH MEHTO
RANK
15 YOGESH PURI
GOSWAMI
RANK
th
17
RANK
th
U KARTHIK
th
18 AMIT KUMAR
RANK
T
th
22
nd
SANDEEP th
ANKIT
24 BHATNAGAR 25
th
MANOJ th
27 CHAWLA 31
st
ANKIT ANIL
nd
32 SINGH NISHANT
th
35 CHAUDHARY M GIRISH
th
38 KUMAR
st
41 AKSHAY GARG 44
th
ADITYA 45
th
ADITYA PRAKASH
48
th
RANGARI
49
th
GANTA th
YADAV ANKIT
20 MAYANK GAUR RANK GOYAL RANK RANK SINGH RANK RANK RANK KUMAR SHARMA RANK PATEL RANK RANK REDDY RANK RANK SINGH PAL RANK PANDEY RANK VINAY VYANKAT RANK GANESH KUMAR 50 RANK SHRIOMPRAKASH
RANK
nd
AKSHAT KANNAM
rd
SURYA
th
57 CHOUDHARY 63
rd
64
th
JITENDRA 65
th
PRAVEEN 67
th
SATISH 68
th
RUTHALA
70
th
MANISH 74
th
75 RAJESH
th
KUMAR 76
th
79 GUGULOTH
th
81 BHUVNESHWAR
st
87 VINAY MEENA
th
52 53 VIJAY KUMAR SINGH SACHIN BHOI KULAHARI KUMAR CHANDRA SEKHAR KUMAR VIKAS DOHARE NITIKA YUGENDER PANWAR
RANK CHOUREY RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK
M
E
nd
1 MOHAMMAD
2 GAUSH ALAM 3 8 JGMV
9 GAURAV KANT VINAY RAUNAK
st rd th th th
CHIRAG th th
KHILENDRA
th th
SAMARTH
nd rd
AMARJEET th
RAMESH KUMAR th nd th
36
th
AVINASH 38
th
PRAKHAR 39
th
GOUTAM 43 DURGA VINOD
th
44
th
MUNISH 48
th
50
th
VADREVU
54
th
ADARSH th
th
GAUTAM th
PATIL AMEY th th PANKAJ th
PANCHALWAR th
UMA SHANKAR nd
SANDEEP rd ARUN KUMAR th th th SUNIL KUMAR th HARGOVIND th DAVANDE th UPPULURI th V VENKATA SAI
WASU AKSHAYKUMAR
93 KUMAR
96 KAMALAKAR
100 SHANKAR 104 PARASHRAM 107 KUNAL RAJENDRA
120
RANK BARNAWAL
122
RANK KUMAR
123
RANK DEWANGAN
136
RANK
ANMOL UKEY 147
RANK
MANISH ARYA 163
RANK MEENA
164
RANK MEENA
166
RANK ABHISHEK PRADIP 168 SATYA SRI PRANAV
RANK
174
RANK SESHAGIRI RAO
RANK RANK RANK RANK
GADHAVE RANK
E
E 4
nd th
VARSHA th
GURU
3 5 6 8 9
th
BHALLAMUDI rd th th th th
ARVIND GAURAV POOJA ANSHUL ANKIT DEEPANSHU ABHISHEK
2 TANUJ KUMAR SK TAUSHIFUR th th th th th th st
GADRE BALAJI 25
RANK VENKATESH RANK SHARMA RANK SHUKLA RANK
ASHISH VERMA
RANK
MUFEED KHAN
RANK REHMAN RANK BISWAL 10RANK TYAGI 12RANK AGARWAL 13RANK BANSAL 14RANK PANDEY 18
RANK KAMALAKAR 20RANK SINGH 21 AKHIL MATTU 24
RANK RANK MISHRA RANK SRINIVAS
RUCHI
th th th
KUMAR MAYANK th
KARAN
53 MRITYUNJAY
st
SOMA SEKHAR
th st
KOLLA th th
SHASHIKUMAR th th rd th th th th
31RANK CHAUDHARY
37
RANK
APPARAO KOTARU 38RANK
VIDYA 39 ANKIT GOYAL 40
RANK RANK ARCHIT 41RANK
RAJESH KRISHNA 44 Y RAVI TEJA
RANK
45RANK GURIJALA 46RANK SHARMA 48 VIPUL KUMAR
RANK VARSHNEY
RANK
54RANK
PANDITRAO
KAUSHIK RAMAKANT 55RANK
MUKUL KUMAR 57
RANK SAREEN 59RANK
MANISH KUMAR 66 JAG PRAVESH
RANK
GAURAV DHARMENDRA nd rd
SURENDER KUMAR th
104 SUDHANSU SEKHAR
th th
74 75 79 80 RAGHUNATH 82 92
th st
C
in
@
E PRAKHAR
nd th th th th
2 4 6 8 9 AVDHESH 10 HIMANSHU 12 NITIN KUMAR ASHISH 19 YESVENDER PRASHANT VIPUL ULHAS VAIBHAV
th th th th th rd th th th
ADARSH PARVATHREDDY 40 JETTY KRANTHI
th th
RANK RANK
RISHI SRIVASTAV RANK RANK RANK MEENA RANK TIWARI RANK TRIPATHI RANKAGARWAL RANK GUPTA RANK SINGH RANK
DEEPTHI RANK TRIPATHI RANK DEBADWAR RANK RANKKUMAR REDDY RANK PODDAR
PU
B
85 SUNDARAM
th th th
DIGVIJAY PRIYANK MANOJ KUMAR PRATYUSH ALOK th
ANURAG
TE
th th th th th th th th th
rd
59 64 70 89 RANABOTHU 97
53 AYUSH TIWARI 54 HARSHAVARDHAN AKHILESH 67 P JAMSHEER PRANAV PANDEY AMARENDAR REDDY CHAUHAN
108
GUPTA
109
MISHRA
146
KATIYAR
154
KUMAR VERMA
157
MAURYA
RANK
RANK REDDY RANK RANK RATUSARIA RANK RANK RANK RANK DWIBEDI RANKCHAUBE RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK RANK
C
H
-T
166
th
PUKHA RAM
th rd
DHEERESH th
VINITENDRA th nd
SHIV KUMAR nd
SHASHANK rd
PRADEEP th
VIJAY SINGH th
AMIT KUMAR 205 MOHIT VIKRAM
th th
VIVEKANAND th
el
170 A THENAMUDHAN 173 177 178 C SREENIVASULU 182 192 193 197 199 209 225 AJAY KUMAR
RANK RANK RANK
KUMAR RANK
SINGH RANK RANK MEENA RANK
BURMAN RANK KUMAR MEENA RANK
MEENA RANK
MEENA RANK SINGH RANK
THAGRIA RANK
eg
ra
# 204, Rahman Plaza, Opp Methodist School,Fernendez Hospital Lane, Near Taj Mahal Hotel,Abids, Hyderabad – 500001,Telangana,India.
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Contact No: 040-23234418,040-23234419,040-23234420 , 040-24750437 | E-Mail: [email protected]
Basic Electrical Engineering Multiple choice questions
d) Cannot be determined
SP
Answer: c
P U
Explanation: Hysteresis loss and eddy current loss are the losses which take place in core of the
B
transformer thus they are also termed as core losses. While other losses take place in winding or in air gap
TE
transformer. These parameters include low viscosity, high stability, high flash point, high electrical
in
a) kW
U
B
b) kVAR
TE
c) HP
C
d) kVA
H
-T
el
Answer: d
Explanation: There are two types of losses in a transformer, Copper Losses and Iron Losses or Core
Losses or Insulation Losses. Copper losses (I 2R) depends on current passing through transformer winding
while Iron losses or Core Losses or Insulation Losses depends on Voltage. That’s why the rating of
Transformer is in kVA.
advertisement
in
@
13. The insulating material that can withstand the highest temperature safely is _______________
SP
a) Cellulose
b) Asbestos
P U
c) Mica
B
TE
d) Glass fibre
C
Answer: c
H
-T
el
Explanation: Mica is extremely stable when it is exposed to moisture and extreme temperatures to
maintain superior electrical properties as an insulator. The mechanical properties of mica allow it to be
cut, punched, stamped and machined to close tolerances along with maintenance of a high thermal
conductivity.
14. The part of a transformer which is visible from outside _______________
a) Bushings
b) Core
c) Primary winding
d) Secondary winding
Answer: a
Explanation: Core, primary winding, secondary winding of a transformer are generally kept in closed
container filled with an oil so that, oil acts as a coolant and provides electrical neutrality also. Thus, only
bushings are visible from outside.
d) Cannot be determined
@
Answer: c
SP
Explanation: Transformer core is so chosen that it will provide low reluctance path and will transfer
P
maximum amount of flux from one winding to other, providing most effective magnetic linkage between
U
two windings.
B
TE
or time varying magnetic flux in order to transfer power from primary side to secondary side. Since
induced emf in the winding is due to flux linkage.
in
@
7. Different core construction is required for core type and shell type transformer.
SP
a) True
P
b) False
U
B
Answer: a
TE
Explanation: In the “closed-core” type transformer, the primary and secondary windings are wound
C
H
-T
el
outside and surround the core ring. In the “shell type” transformer, the primary and secondary windings
pass inside the steel magnetic circuit (core) which forms a shell around the windings.
8. There is only one magnetic flux path in the circuit. The transformer is definitely ________________
a) Core type
b) Shell type
c) Can be any of the above
d) Depends on other parameters
Answer: a
Explanation: In core type transformer, winding is placed on two core limbs, while in case of shell type
transformer, winding is placed on mid arm of the core. Other limbs will be used as mechanical support.
Core type transformers have only one magnetic flux path.
9. Which of the following is correct statement?
a) Core type transformer has more output than shell type
b) Core type transformer has higher efficiency compare to shell type
c) Core type transformer has lower efficiency than shell type
d) Can’t predict
Answer: c
Explanation: In core type winding is surrounded with considerable part of core whereas in shell type core
is surrounded with considerable part of winding of transformer. In core type output is less, because of
losses. In shell type transformer output is high because of less loss, thus efficiency will be more in case of
shell transformer.
10. Core type transformer is with ____________________
a) Large size
b) Small size
c) High voltage
d) Everywhere
Answer: a
Explanation: Core type is very useful when we need large size of the transformer with operation at low
voltage. While shell type transformer is very useful when we need small size high voltage. Cooling is
more in core type.
advertisement
Explanation: Shell type has less mechanical protection to coil while Core type has better mechanical
B
TE
protection to coil. Core type is easy to repair and maintain. In core type transformer concentric cylindrical
C
winding are used. In shell type transformer sandwiched winding are used.
H
-T
el
d) Cannot be determined
in
Answer: c
@
Explanation: Primary winding used in a transformer, can be at higher or lower voltage potential,
SP
depending on the number of turns with secondary winding. For step up and step-down transformers
P
c) Primary winding
d) Secondary winding
Answer: b
Explanation: High voltage winding always has a large number of turns, as voltage is directly proportional
to the number of turns. If large numbered winding is present on primary side then the transformer is step
down transformer.
4. Part of the transformer which undergoes most damage from overheating is ___________
a) Iron core
b) Copper winding
c) Winding insulation
d) Frame or case
Answer: c
Explanation: Copper windings carry current through them. The heat loss producing in any winding
carrying current is proportional to the square of the current passing through it multiplied with resistance.
For large transformers, current is very high, so heating causes most of the damage to insulation material.
5. If a transformer is continuously operated the maximum temperature rise will occur in ___________
a) Core
b) Windings
c) Tank
d) Cannot be determined
Answer: b
Explanation: Copper windings carry currents in a transformer. The loss in form of heat in copper winding
carrying current is proportional to the square of the current passing through them multiplied by the
resistance of the winding. This loss is dissipated in heat and corresponding temperature rise.
a) Step-down
@
b) Step-up
SP
c) One-one
P
d) Autotransformer
U
B
Answer: a
TE
Explanation: When primary number of turns are higher compare to secondary, voltage induced in
C
H
-T
el
secondary windings will obviously low compare to primary. Thus, this transformer is used for stepping
down the output voltage by keeping frequency constant.
8. If a transformer is having equal number of turns at primary and secondary then transformer is called as
_______________
a) Step-down
b) Step-up
c) One-one
d) Autotransformer
Answer: c
Explanation: A transformer is having equal number of turns at primary and secondary then transformer is
called as one-one transformer. This transformer have turns ratio equal to 1, so is the voltage ratio for the
one-one transformer.
a) In all transformers
in
Explanation: According to the construction of transformers core type transformers don’t require
B
TE
sandwiched wiring. While, in the shell type transformer, the primary and secondary windings pass inside
C
the steel magnetic circuit (core) which forms a shell around the winding.
H
-T
el
“Ideal Transformer”.
1. A transformer cannot work on the DC supply because __________________
a) There is no need to change the DC voltage
b) A DC circuit has more losses
c) Faraday’s laws of electromagnetic induction are not valid since the rate of change of flux is zero
d) Cannot be determined
Answer: c
Explanation: For DC supply the direction and the magnitude of the supply remains constant, produced
flux will be constant. Thus, rate of change of flux through the windings will be equal to zero. As a result,
voltage at secondary will always be equal to 0.
Explanation: There is no leakage flux so that all the flux is confined to the core and links both the
in
windings. An actual transformer does have a small amount of leakage flux which can be accounted in
@
5. An ideal transformer will have maximum efficiency at a load such that _____________
P U
d) cannot be determined
-T
el
Answer: a
Explanation: Maximum efficiency of a transformer is defined at the that values when, copper losses
become completely equal to the iron losses. In all other cases the efficiency will be lower than the
maximum value.
6. Which of the following statement regarding an ideal single-phase transformer is incorrect? Transformer
is having a turn ratio of 1: 2 and drawing a current of 10 A from 200 V AC supply is incorrect?
a) It’s a step-up transformer
b) Its secondary voltage is 400 V
c) Its rating is 2 kVA
d) Its secondary current is 20 A
Answer: d
Explanation: Since turns ratio is equal to 1:2 the transformer will give higher voltage at secondary with
respect to the primary voltage, and current in secondary thus will be halved. In last option current is
doubled which is opposite to the ratings given.
7. Ideal transformer core has permeability equal to _____
a) Zero
b) Non-zero finite
c) Negative
d) Infinite
Answer: d
Explanation: The core has infinite permeability so that zero magnetizing current is needed to establish the
requisite amount of flux in the core. The core-loss (hysteresis as well as eddy-current loss) is considered
zero.
8.Turns ratio of the transformer is directly proportional to ____________
a) Resistance ratio
b) Currents ratio
c) Voltage ratio
d) Not proportional to any terms
Answer: c
Explanation: According to the voltage expression, emf induced in the primary is directly proportional to
the change in the flux with respect to the time and number of turns of the primary winding. Similarly, for
secondary winding.
Answer: a
U
B
Explanation: Voltage ratio of transformer winding is exactly similar to the turns ratio of transformer,
TE
while voltage ratio and turns ratio is exactly inverse of the currents ratio. Hence, by knowing any of these
C
10. Which of the following is the expression for emf induced in primary with voltage applied to primary
of an ideal transformer?
a) e=V
b) V= √2*e*cos ωt
c) e= √2*V*cos ωt
d) Cannot say
Answer: c
Explanation: For an ideal transformer having a primary of N1 turns and a secondary of N2 turns on a
common magnetic core. The voltage of the source to which the primary is connected is v = √2 V cos wt.
while the secondary is initially assumed to be an open circuited. As a consequence, flux f is established in
the core such that e = v = N1 dφ/dt.
11. Which of the following is the wrong expression?
a) i1N1=i2N2
b) i1v1=i2v2
c) i1N2=i2N1
d) v2N1=v1N2
Answer: c
Explanation: According to the transformation ratio, current flowing through the transformer is inversely
proportional to the number turns of winding and voltage applied across it. While, voltage applied is
directly proportional to the number of turns.
12. For transformer given, turns ratio is equal to a, what will be the impedance of primary with respect to
secondary?
a) a2 times the secondary impedance
b) a times secondary impedance
c) secondary impedance/a
d) secondary impedance/a2
Answer: d
Explanation: The ratio of impedances on primary to the secondary is directly proportional to the inverse
of square of turns ratio of transformer. Hence primary impedance to the secondary impedance ratio will
be 1/ a2.
advertisement
13. Power transformed in the ideal transformer with turns ratio a is _______
a) a2 times primary
Jo
b) a times primary
in
c) primary power/ a2
@
d) primary power
SP
Answer: d
P
Explanation: In an ideal transformer, voltages are transformed in the direct ratio of turns, currents in the
U
B
inverse ratio and impedances in the direct ratio squared; while power and VA remain unaltered. Thus,
TE
14. For a transformer with primary turns 100, secondary turns 400, if 200 V is applied at primary we will
get ___________
a) 80 V at secondary
b) 800 V at secondary
c) 1600 V at secondary
d) 3200 V at secondary
Answer: b
Explanation: Voltage in the primary of the transformer will get modified in the transformer secondary,
according to the number of turns. Thus, turns are modified with 4 times the primary, we’ll get 4 times
higher voltage at secondary.
15. For a transformer with primary turns 400, secondary turns 100, if 20A current is flowing through
primary, we will get ___________
a) 80A at secondary
b) 5A at secondary
c) 800A at secondary
d) 40A at secondary
Answer: a
Explanation: Current in the primary of the transformer will get modified in the transformer secondary,
according to the number of turns, in inverse proportion. Thus, turns are modified with 1/4 times the
primary, we’ll get 4 times higher current at secondary.
c) Protect the transformer from damage when oil expends due to heating
SP
d) Cannot be determkned
P
Answer: c
U
Explanation: When transformer is loaded and when ambient temperature rises, the volume of oil inside
B
TE
transformer increases as oil expands. A conservator tank properly installed on transformer provides
C
H
-T
el
required space to this expanded transformer oil. It performs another function as a reservoir for transformer
insulating oil.
3. Natural oil cooling method have some limitations due to which it is adopted for transformers up to a
rating of ____________
a) 3000 kVA
b) 1000 kVA
c) 500 kVA
d) 250 kVA
Answer: a
Explanation: For the transformers n higher kVA ratings can be used with this cooling method. While
transformers having capacity beyond 5 MVA, due to some improper limitations forced cooling is used.
Natural cooling is based on the important phenomenon seen in fluids that when oil is heated up, moves in
upward direction.
a) Asbestos fibre
in
b) Silica sand
@
c) Sodium chloride
SP
d) Silica gel
P
Answer: d
U
B
Explanation: In order to absorb moisture from air while breathing process, breather chemical is used. So,
TE
breather chemical should possess the required ability of absorbing moisture. In all chemicals available as
C
on today, silica gel is most perfect and best material that can be used for such process.
H
-T
el
9. Gas is liberated due to temperature limit and due to dissociation of transformer oil after ___________
a) 50°C
b) 80°C
c) 100°C
d) 150°C
Answer: d
Explanation: Gas is usually not liberated due to dissociation of transformer oil. But when the oil
temperature exceeds 1500, it dissociates and liberates. It is found that hydrogen H 2 and methane CH4 are
produced in large quantity if internal temperature of transformer rises up to 150 oC to 300oC due to
abnormal thermal stresses.
10. Buchholz’s relay will give warning and protection against ___________
a) Electrical fault inside the transformer itself
b) Electrical fault outside the transformer in outgoing feeder
c) For both outside and inside faults
d) Cannot be determined
Answer: a
Jo
Explanation: Buchholz relay is used in transformers for protection against all kinds of faults which are
in
tend to happen inside a transformer. It is most famous gas-actuated relay which is installed in an oil-
@
SP
immersed transformer.
P
11. Which of the following listed component will see and perform according to changes in volume of
U
B
transformer cooling oil due to variation of atmospheric temperature during day and night?
TE
a) Conservator
C
b) Breather
H
-T
el
c) Bushings
d) Buchholz relay
Answer: a
Explanation: Conservator is an additional tank provided with transformer which stores oil when it gets
expanded due to temperature rise. It also serves another important purpose that is, as a reservoir of
transformer oil. Thus, at all temperature variations of day and night transformer can work without any
problem.
12. What should be ideal volatility and ideal viscosity of the transformer oil?
a) Low, low
b) High, high
c) Low, high
d) High, low
Answer: a
Explanation: Transformer oil has a low viscosity, high flash point, high dielectric strength, high
resistivity. It has a low pour point and low volatility with good gas absorbing properties, while It resists
oxidation, sludging and emulsification with water.
13. What is the function of breather in a transformer?
a) To provide oxygen inside the tank
b) To cool the coils during reduced load
c) To cool the transformer oil
d) To arrest flow of moisture when outside air enters the transformer
Answer: d
Explanation: Most of the power generation stations use silica gel breathers fitted to conservator of oil
filled transformers. The most used purpose of these silica gel breathers is to arrest the moisture when the
outside air is sucked in by the transformer during the breathing process.
14. Natural air cooling method can’t be adopted because of some unavoidable effects, beyond _______
a) 1.5 MVA
b) 5 MVA
c) 15 MVA
d) 50 MVA
Answer: a
Explanation: Smaller size transformers are immersed in a tank containing transformer oil. The
transformer oil because temperature properties, which is surrounding the core and windings gets heated,
expands and moves upwards. It then flows downwards by the inside of tank walls which cause it to drop
Jo
temperature and oil goes down to the bottom of the tank from where it rises once again completing the
in
circulation cycle
@
SP
P U
a) load on it increases
-T
el
b) load on it decreases
c) load remains constant
d) cannot be determined
Answer: b
Explanation: Transformer in the low loading condition, also called extreme condition (lower
temperature), oil inside contracts and then air is taken inside thus breath in to main via the balloon like
structure through silica gel breather.
4. Which of the following is not the purpose of iron core in a step-up transformer?
a) to provide coupling between primary and secondary
b) to increase the magnitude of mutual flux
c) to decrease the magnitude of magnetizing current
d) to provide all above features
Answer: c
Explanation: In real transformers, the two coils are generally wound onto the same iron core. The purpose
of the iron core is to provide the path for the magnetic flux generated by the current flowing around the
primary coil, so that as much of it as possible also links the secondary coil, with minimum losses.
Jo
in
a) Primary side
SP
b) Secondary side
P
Answer: d
C
Explanation: The turns ratio is different with different tappings and hence different voltages are obtained
H
-T
el
with different tappings adjustment. The tappings are placed either on high voltage or low voltages or
sometimes on both high and low voltage windings to get required output.
d) Cannot be determined
in
Answer: c
@
Explanation: We consider all resistances i.e. of primary and secondary as series parameters of equivalent
SP
circuit of transformer, while all leakage reactances are also connected into the circuit as series parameters.
P U
a) Gi and Bm
b) R1 and X1
C
H
c) R2 and X2
-T
el
d) Cannot be determined
Answer: a
Explanation: Primary and secondary resistances and leakage reactances are the series parameters in the
transformer equivalent circuit. So, these are not included in parallel parameters. Parallel parameters
contain Gi and Bm in which current Ii and Im flows respectively.
14. A 25 KVA transformer is constructed to a turns ratio of N1/N2 = 10. The impedance of primary
in
winding is 3+j5 ohms and of secondary winding is 0.5+j0.8 ohms. What will be the impedance of
@
a) 53j + 85 ohms
P
b) 53 + 85j ohms
U
B
d) Can’t be calculated
C
Answer: b
H
-T
el
Explanation: Given turns ratio is 10. Thus, secondary resistance when referred to the primary is equal to
k2*Z2, so net impedance on primary is equal to primary impedance + k^2*Z2 . Substituting all the terms
we get net impedance = 53 + 85j ohms.
a) Primary winding
@
b) Secondary winding
SP
Answer: d
TE
Explanation: Winding having less cross-sectional area may be primary or secondary winding. For high
C
H
-T
el
voltage winding cross sectional area is less while for low voltage winding cross sectional are is more, due
to inverse proportionality.
5. In constant frequency (50 Hz) power transformers, approximate form is used with ___________
a) π equivalent model
b) T equivalent model
c) π and T equivalent both
d) Another model
Answer: b
Explanation: In constant frequency (50 Hz) power transformers, approximate forms of the exact T-circuit
equivalent of the transformer are commonly used. Thus, we lump all series parameters of the circuit on
either side of T circuit.
6. Exciting current in an electrical transformer will not be affected much if primary is excited with E
rather than V.
a) True
b) False
Answer: a
Explanation: Since winding resistances and leakage reactances are very small, V1 = E1 even under
conditions of load. Therefore, the exciting current drawn by the magnetizing branch (Gi || Bm) would not
be affected significantly by shifting it to the input terminals, i.e. it is now excited by V1 instead of E1.
7. In approximate equivalent circuit of the transformer _______________
a) All resistances and inductances are lumped before magnetizing branch
b) All resistances and inductances are lumped after magnetizing branch
c) Resistances and inductances aren’t changed
d) Any of the above will work
Answer: b
Explanation: Since Io is very small compare to like about 5-10% of full load current, voltage drop can be
approximated to very large extent. These all resistances and inductances are in series, combined with each
other to give approximate equivalent circuit.
advertisement
Answer: a
SP
Explanation: We combine all series parameters of equivalent circuit together to get approximate
equivalent circuit of the transformer, where we assume that equivalent resistance is zero as it is negligible,
P U
“Transformer Losses”.
1. In a given transformer for given applied voltage, which of the following losses remain constant
irrespective of load changes?
a) Friction and windage losses
b) Copper losses
c) Hysteresis and eddy current losses
d) Cannot be determined
Answer: c
Explanation: Hysteresis and eddy current losses together called as core-loss in a transformer. These losses
remain constant for constant voltage and frequency applied to a transformer, these components remain
same irrespective of load.
2. On which of the following degree of mechanical vibrations produced by the laminations of a
transformer depends?
a) Tightness of clamping
b) Gauge of laminations
c) Size of laminations
d) Tightness of clamping, gauge and size of laminations
Answer: d
Explanation: Mechanical vibrations produced in a transformer are directly effective due to the tightness of
the clamping, gauge og laminations, size of laminations as well. There are various methods in order to
reduce their effects.
3. Variations in a hysteresis loss in a transformer (Bmax = maximum flux density) ____________
a) Bmax
b) Bmax1.6
c) Bmax3.83
d) Bmax/2
Answer: b
Explanation: According to Steinmetz’s formula, the heat energy dissipated due to hysteresis is given by
Wh=ηβmax1.6, and hysteresis loss is thus given by Ph≈ Whf ≈ηfβmax1.6. That exponetital term varies
fraom 1.4 -1.8 and is equal to 1.6 for iron.
Answer: a
P
Explanation: Leakage flux is directly proportional to the current, as if is current increased net value of
U
B
flux increases thus, flux leakage also increases which further contribute to the losses as it is then not able
TE
5. The full-load copper loss of a transformer is 1600 W. At half-load, the copper loss will be _______
a) 6400 W
b) 1600 W
c) 800 W
d) 400 W
Answer: d
Explanation: Copper losses are defined as I2*R losses many times, as they are directly proportional to the
square of current flowing through them. Thus, copper losses will reduce if load is reduced that too in
square proportion.
7. If the supply frequency to the transformer is increased, the iron loss will ___________
a) Not change
b) Decrease
c) Increase
d) Cannot be determined
Answer: c
Explanation: As frequency increases, the flux density in the core decreases but as the iron loss is directly
proportional to the frequency hence effect of increased frequency will be reflected in increase of the iron
losses.
8. Which of the following can measure iron loss of a transformer?
a) Low power factor wattmeter
b) Unity power factor wattmeter
c) Frequency meter
d) Any type of wattmeter
Answer: a
Explanation: As the secondary side is open in OC, the entire coil will be purely inductive in nature. So,
Jo
the power will be lagging due to inductive property of the circuit. So LPF (Low power factor) wattmeter
in
9. How reduction in core losses and increase in permeability can be obtained simultaneously in a
P
transformer?
U
B
c) Cannot be determined
H
-T
el
d) Frequency Meter
Answer: a
Explanation: CRGO is supplied by the producing mills in coil form and has to be cut into laminations,
which are then used in transformer core, which is an integral part of any transformer. Grain-oriented steel
is used in large power, distribution transformers and in certain audio output transformers also.
10. Losses which occur in rotating electric machines and do not occur in transformer are ______
a) Friction and windage losses
b) Magnetic losses
c) Hysteresis and eddy current losses
d) Copper losses
Answer: a
Explanation: Windage and friction losses occur in rotating parts of a machine generally in rotor of the
machine, thus they will never occur in transformer, as transformer does not contain any rotating part at its
secondary unlike induction motor.
advertisement
11. In a given transformer for a given applied voltage, which losses remain constant irrespective of load
changes?
a) Hysteresis and eddy current losses
b) Friction and windage losses
c) Copper losses
d) Cannot be determined
Answer: a
Explanation: Hysteresis and eddy current losses are voltage and frequency dependent losses that too from
primary side thus, load change will not make any effect on these losses and they will remain constant as
long as voltage and frequency is constant.
12. Which of the following loss in a transformer is zero even at full load?
a) Core loss
b) Friction loss
c) Eddy current loss
d) Hysteresis loss
Answer: b
Explanation: Friction losses are involved with rotating parts of a machine. Since in a transformer all parts
are stationary, friction losses will always be equal to zero, irrespective of the loading condition.
Jo
in
d) Cannot be determined
B
TE
Answer: b
C
Explanation: Since windings are brought closer in shell type compare to core type transformer, leakage of
H
-T
el
flux is very less in shell type transformer. Most of the flux gets linked with both of the coils though there
is some leakage which can’t be avoided.
“Efficiency”.
1. When will be the efficiency of a transformer maximum?
a) Copper losses = hysteresis losses
b) Hysteresis losses = eddy current losses
c) Eddy current losses = copper losses
d) Copper losses = iron losses
Answer: d
Explanation: When the variable copper losses of a transformer becomes equal to the fixed iron losses of a
transformer then we will get maximum efficiency. From these losses we’ll get the value of current
required.
d) No load
SP
Answer: a
P U
Explanation: Every device is manufactured to get maximum efficiency at the rated loads, i.e. full load.
B
Thus, transformer will give the maximum efficiency at nearly full load. Internal losses are so adjusted to
TE
6. Power transformers other than distribution transformers are generally designed to have maximum
efficiency around ______
a) No-load
b) Half-load
c) Near full-load
d) 10% overload
Answer: c
Explanation: Similar to normal transformers power transformers are also designed to get maximum
efficiency at load which is near to the full load of a transformer specified. Only in the case distribution
transformer maximum efficiency is achieved at 60% of full load.
7. For a transformer given, operating at constant load current, maximum efficiency will occur at ______
a) 0.8 leading power factor
b) 0.8 lagging power factor
c) Zero power factor
d) Unity power factor
Answer: d
Explanation: Maximum efficiency for a transformer will be achieved at full load. While in the case of
power factor also every device is set to get maximum efficiency at unity power factor. Thus, one will
have maximum efficiency if load is nearly equal to full load and at unity power factor.
Explanation: At heavy loads current drawn by the transformer circuit increases, as we know, variable
in
copper losses are proportional to the square of the current. Thus, we’ll get higher copper loss in
@
SP
9. The efficiencies of transformers compared to electric motors of the same power are ___________
U
B
b) Much smaller
C
c) Much higher
H
-T
el
d) Can’t comment
Answer: c
Explanation: Transformer is a highly efficient device compare to all other electrical instruments. In motor
we need to add windage and friction losses along with the copper losses and iron losses thus, we’ll get lee
efficiency for motor compare to transformer.
10. A transformer having maximum efficiency at 75% full load will have ratio of iron loss and full load
copper loss equal to ___________
a) 4/3
b) 3/4
c) 9/16
d) 16/9
Answer: c
Explanation: Condition for maximum efficiency is, Copper loss= Iron loss, i.e. Pc= I2 R = Pi. transformer
can be operated at any load but maximum efficiency occurs at a particular load condition only. Let x be
that load factor corresponds to maximum efficiency. Given that, maximum efficiency will occur at 3/4
load. The load factor= (3/4)2.
11. What is the correct formula of efficiency of a device?
a) Input /output
b) Output/losses
c) 1- (losses/ (output + losses))
d) Cannot be determined
Answer: c
Explanation: Efficiency of any device is equal to the ratio of output power to the input power. Here, one
can write input power is equal to the addition of output power with losses. Thus, expressing all these
terms mathematically will give the answer.
12. A 500 kVA transformer is having efficiency of 95% at full load and also at 60% of full load; both at
unity power factor. Then Pi is ___________
a) 16.45 kW
b) 9.87 kW
c) 14.57 kW
d) Can’t be calculated
Answer: b
Explanation: Efficiency of a transformer is given by, [transformer capacity*loading/ (capacity*loading +
Pi + k2*PC)]. Thus, η= 500*1/ (500 + Pi +PC) = 0.95. also from the second condition given η= 500*0.6/
Jo
13. A 500 kVA transformer is having efficiency of 95% at full load and also at 60% of full load; both at
SP
a) 16.45 kW
U
B
b) 9.87 kW
TE
c) 14.57 kW
C
d) Can’t be calculated
H
-T
el
Answer: a
Explanation: Efficiency of a transformer is given by, [transformer capacity*loading/ (capacity*loading +
Pi + k2*PC)]. Thus, η= 500*1/ (500 + Pi +PC) = 0.95. also from the second condition given η= 500*0.6/
(500*0.6 + Pi +0.62*PC) = 0.95. Thus, solving simultaneously we get an answer 16.45 kW.
14. For a power transformer operating at full load it draws voltage and current equal to 200 V and 100 A
respectively at 0.8 pf. Iron and copper losses are equal to 120 kW and 300kW. What is the efficiency?
a) 86.44%
b) 96.44%
c) 97.44%
d) 99.12%
Answer: c
Explanation: Power output= VI cosθ= 200*100*0.8 = 16000 W (Independent of lag and lead). While total
losses are equal to iron loss+ k2*copper losses =120+ 300= 420 W. Efficiency is equal to 1-
420/(16000+420)= 97.44%.
“Voltage Regulation-1”.
1. The highest voltage for transmitting electrical power in India is _______
a) 33 kV
b) 66 kV
c) 132 kV
d) 00 kV
Answer: d
Explanation: Transmission voltage in power transfer in India (highest) is 750KV AC and these lines are
erected by Power Grid Corporation for interstate connections throughout India. However, work on
800KV is in the progress. DC transmission voltage (highest) in India is 600KV.
2. A transformer can have zero voltage regulation at _______
a) Leading power factor
b) Lagging power factor
c) Unity power factor
d) Zero power factor
Answer: a
Explanation: At leading power factor the voltage regulation is given by I*(Rcosφ- Xsinφ). Thus, at a
Jo
particular condition of angle φ we may get zero voltage regulation. While in lagging power factor case we
in
3. What will happen to a given transformer if it made to run at its rated voltage but reduced frequency?
SP
Answer: d
-T
el
Explanation: E=4.44fNAB is the emf equation for a transformer, now as E is kept constant we can say
frequency is inversely proportional to the B value. Thus, as frequency increases we will get less core flux
density and vice-versa.
4. In an actual transformer the iron loss remains practically constant from no load to full load because
___________
a) Value of transformation ratio remains constant
b) Permeability of transformer core remains constant
c) Core flux remains practically constant
d) Primary voltage remains constant
Answer: c
Explanation: The reason behind core-iron loss being constant is that hysteresis loss and eddy current loss
both are dependent on the magnetic properties of the material which is used in the construction and design
of the core of the transformer.
Answer: a
P
Explanation: Voltage regulation is defined as rise in the voltage when the transformer is thrown off from
U
B
full load condition to no-load condition. Thus, least voltage regulation means output fluctuations
TE
8. Which of the following acts as a protection against high voltage surges due to lightning and switching?
a) Horn gaps
b) Thermal overload relays
c) Breather
d) Conservator
Answer: a
Explanation: Arcing horns in a transformer form a spark gap across the insulator with a lower breakdown
voltage than the air path along the insulator surface, so an overvoltage it will cause the air to break down
and the arc to form between the arcing horns, diverting it away from the surface of the insulator.
9. Minimum voltage regulation occurs when the power factor of the load is ______________
a) Unity
b) Lagging
c) Leading
d) Zero
Answer: c
Explanation: When the leading load is connected to the transformer difference of Rcosφ and Xsinφ is
multiplied with the current, thus we may get -ve, zero voltage regulations at this condition. That is
minimum voltage regulation.
c) Leading
in
d) Lagging
@
Answer: c
SP
Explanation: At leading power factor the voltage regulation can be negative or zero. This can be found
from this equation % regulation = εxcosθ – εrsinθ. Bu substituting the appropriate value of angle one can
P U
3. A transformer has resistance and reactance in per unit as 0.01 and 0.04 pu respectively. What will be its
C
H
5. Which is the correct phasor equation indicating the transformer voltages lagging?
a) V1 = V2 + I*(R cosφ+ X sinφ)
b) V2 = V1 + I*(R cosφ+ X sinφ)
c) V1 = V2 + I*(X cosφ+ X sinφ)
d) V1 = V2 + I*(R cosφ+ R sinφ)
Answer: a
Explanation: According to the phasor diagram drawn for lagging current, we will have positive sign in the
voltage regulation formula thus, V1 = V2 + I*(R cosφ+ X sinφ) gives the correct relation, while
V1 indicates the primary voltage.
6. Which is the correct phasor equation indicating the transformer voltages leading?
a) V1 = V2 + I*(R cosφ- X sinφ)
b) V2 = V1 + I*(R cosφ- X sinφ)
c) V1 = V2 + I*(X cosφ- X sinφ)
d) V1 = V2 + I*(R cosφ- R sinφ)
Answer: a
Explanation: According to the phasor diagram drawn for leading current, we will have negaitive sign in
Jo
the voltage regulation formula thus, V1 = V2 + I*(R cosφ- X sinφ) gives the correct relation, while V1
in
7. What is the correct formula to get power factor angle in leading condition?
P
a) tan φ= X/R
U
B
b) tan φ= R/X
TE
c) cos φ = R/√(R2+X2)
C
d) cos φ= R/X
H
-T
el
Answer: b
Explanation: For leading condition derivative of voltage regulation with respect to φ is obtained and
solved for the power factor angle calculations we’ll get tan φ = R/X for leading condition, for lagging
condition we’ll get tan φ= X/R.
advertisement
8. What is the correct formula to get power factor angle in lagging condition?
a) sin φ= X/R
b) tan φ= R/X
c) cos φ = R/√(R2+X2)
d) cos φ= R/X
Answer: c
Explanation: For lagging condition derivative of voltage regulation with respect to φ is obtained and
solved for the power factor angle calculations we’ll get tan φ = R/X for leading condition, for lagging
condition we’ll get tan φ= X/R. In terms of cosine function, we’ll get cos φ = R/√(R2+X2).
9. Zero voltage regulation of a transformer is achieved at 1 pf leading.
a) True
b) False
Answer: b
Explanation: Though zero voltage regulation occurs at leading power factor condition, it is not occurring
at unity power factor leading. As at unity power factor leading, cos term will be equal to 1. Hence, we’ll
get some non-zero VR at unity power factor.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
“Electrostatic Properties”.
B
TE
a) Electrostatic energy
-T
el
b) Dielectric constant
c) Dipole moment
d) Susceptibility
Answer: b
Explanation: The term permittivity or dielectric constant is the measurement of electrostatic energy stored
within it and therefore depends on the material.
5. Which of the following properties distinguish a material as conductor, insulator and semiconductor?
a) Free electron charges
b) Fermi level after doping
c) Energy band gap
Jo
d) Electron density
in
Answer: c
@
Explanation: The only parameter that classifies the material as conductor or insulator or semiconductor is
SP
the band gap energy. It is the energy required to make the electrons conduct. This is low of conductors,
P
average for semiconductors and very high for insulators. This means it requires very high energy to make
U
B
an insulator conduct.
TE
a) Metallic
-T
el
b) Covalent
c) Ionic
d) Magnetic
Answer: b
Explanation: Conductors exhibit metallic bonding. Insulators exhibit ionic bonding and semiconductors
exhibit covalent bonding due to sharing of atoms.
8. The bound charge density and free charge density are 12 and 6 units respectively. Calculate the
susceptibility.
a) 1
b) 0
c) 2
d) 72
Answer: c
Explanation: The electric susceptibility is given by, χe = Bound free density/Free charge density. χe =
12/6 = 2. It has no unit.
9. The susceptibility of free space is
a) 1
b) 0
c) 2
d) ∞
Answer: b
Explanation: For free space/air, the relative permittivity is unity i.e, εr = 1. Thus χe = εr – 1 = 0. The
susceptibility will become zero in air.
Jo
10. When the electric field becomes zero, which of the following relations hold good?
in
a) E = P
@
b) D = P
SP
c) B = P
d) H = P
P U
Answer: b
B
Explanation: The electric flux density of a field is the sum of εE and polarisation P. It gives D = εE + P.
TE
C
“Electric Fields”.
1. The conventional direction of electric field is ________
a) Positive to negative
b) Negative to positive
c) No specific direction
d) Direction cannot be determined
Answer: a
Explanation: The conventional direction of field lines is from positive to negative. The field lines
originate at the positive charge and terminate at the negative charge.
4. Which among the following statements is true with regard to electric field lines?
a) Electric field lines always intersect
b) Electric field lines may or may not intersect
c) Electric field lines can be seen
d) Electric field lines never intersect
Jo
Answer: d
in
Explanation: Electric field lines can never intersect because the field lines represent the field strength. If
@
the lines intersect it means that at that point there are two different values for electric field which is not
SP
possible.
P U
B
5. Which, among the following, is the field where electric charge experiences a force?
TE
a) Electric field
C
b) Magnetic field
H
-T
el
c) Gravitational field
d) Electric, magnetic or gravitational field
Answer: a
Explanation: Charges experience a force in an electric field because charges come under the influence of
a field which already has charges- electric field.
Answer: b
@
Explanation: When one material is rubbed against another, there is transfer of charges from one material
SP
10. The insulant between the two plates of a capacitor is called _______
B
TE
a) Conductor
b) Semi-conductor
C
H
c) Dielectric
-T
el
d) Superconductor
Answer: c
Explanation: The material between the two plates of a capacitor is an insulator, more specifically known
as a dielectric.
2. “Total electric flux through any closed surface is equal to the charge enclosed by that surface”. This is
the statement for?
a) Gauss law
b) Lenz law
c) Coloumb’s law
d) Faraday’s law
Answer: a
Explanation: Total electric flux through any closed surface is equal to the charge enclosed by that surface
is the statement for Gauss law because among the four laws, Gauss law deals with electric flux.
3. Electric flux density is a function of_______
a) Volume
b) Charge
c) Current
d) Voltage
Answer: b
Explanation: Electric flux density is the charge per unit area. Hence it is a function of charge and not any
of the other values.
Jo
in
a) Increases
SP
b) Decreases
P
c) Remains constant
U
B
d) Becomes zero
TE
Answer: a
C
Explanation: Electric flux density is the charge per unit area. The expression for flux density is:
H
-T
el
D=Q/A. Electric flux is directly proportional to charge, hence as charge increases, electric flux also
increases.
6. Which, among the following, is the correct expression for electric flux density?
a) D=epsilon*E
b) D=epsilon/E
c) D2=epsilon*E
d) D=epsilon*E2
Answer: a
Explanation: Electric flux density is directly proportional to the electric field, epsilon(permittivity of free
space) being the constant of proportionality. Hence D=epsilon*E.
Explanation: Electric field intensity is the force per unit charge. The formula is:
in
9. What is the electric flux density in free space if the electric field intensity is 1V/m?
a) 7.76*10-12C/m2
P U
b) 8.85*10-12C /m2
B
c) 1.23*10-12C /m2
TE
d) 3.43*10-12C /m2
C
H
Answer: b
-T
el
10. If the charge in a conductor is 16C and the area of cross section is 4m2. Calculate the electric flux
density.
a) 64C/m2
b) 16C/m2
c) 4C/m2
d) 2C/m2
Answer: c
Explanation: Flux density is the charge per unit area. The formula is:
D=Q/A= 16/4= 4C/m2.
“Relative Permittivity”.
1. In order to obtain a high value for capacitance the permittivity of the dielectric medium should be?
a) Low
b) High
c) Zero
d) Unity
Answer: b
Explanation: Form the expression:
C=epsilon*A/d.
From this expression, it is seen that capacitance is directly proportional to the permittivity, hence for
capacitance value to be high, permittivity value should be high.
2. Find the capacitance of a capacitor whose area of cross section of the plates is 4m2 and distance of
separation between the plates is 2m. The capacitor is placed in vacuum.
a) 1.77*10-11F
b) 1.34*10-11F
c) 2.33*10-11F
d) 5.65*10-11F
Answer: a
Explanation: The expression for finding the value of capacitance is:
C=epsilon*A/d.
Jo
Answer: b
-T
el
Explanation: Relative permittivity is the ratio of actual permittivity to the relative permittivity of the
medium. As the actual permittivity increases the relative permittivity also increases.
b) Fm
B
c) F/m2
TE
d) No unit
C
H
Answer: d
-T
el
Explanation: Relative permittivity is the ratio of actual permittivity to the relative permittivity of the
medium. Since it is a ratio, and we know that a ratio does not have any unit, relative permittivity does not
have any unit.
2. The electric field strength is 10N/C and the thickness of the dielectric is 3m. Calculate the potential
in
a) 10V
SP
b) 20V
P
c) 30V
U
B
d) 40V
TE
Answer: c
C
Explanation: The potential drop in a dielectric= electric field strength*area of cross section= 10*3= 30V.
H
-T
el
3. The electric fields of dielectrics having the same cross sectional area in series is related to their relative
permittivities in which way?
a) Directly proportional
b) Inversely proportional
c) Equal
d) Not related
Answer: b
Explanation: Let us consider two plates having fields E1 and E2 and relative permittivities e1 and e2.
Then, E1=Q/(e0*e1*A) and E2=Q/(e0*e2*A), where e0=absolute permittivity and A=area of cross
section. From the given expression, we see that E1/E2=e2/e1, hence the electric field is inversely
proportional to the relative permittivities.
4. What happens to the capacitance when a dielectric is introduced between its plates?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) Becomes zero
Answer: a
Explanation: The capacitance of a capacitance increases when a dielectric is introduced between its plates
because the capacitance is related to the dielectric constant k by the equation:
C=ke0A/d.
5. Calculate the relative permittivity of the second dielectric if the relative permittivity of the first is 4.
The electric field strength of the first dielectric is 8V/m and that of the second is 2V/m.
a) 32
b) 4
c) 16
d) 8
Answer: c
Explanation: The relation between the two electric fields and the relative permittivities is:
E1/E1=e2/e1. Substituting the given values, we get e2=16.
6. What happens to the potential drop between the two plates of a capacitor when a dielectric is
introduced between the plates?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
Jo
d) Becomes zero
in
Answer: b
@
SP
Explanation: When a dielectric is introduced between the two plates of a parallel plate capacitor, the
potential difference decreases because the potential difference of the dielectric is subtracted from it.
P U
B
7. If the potential difference across the plates of a capacitor is 10V and a dielectric having thickness 2m is
TE
introduced between the plates, calculate the potential difference after introducing the dielectric. The
C
a) 4V
b) 6V
c) 8V
d) 10V
Answer: b
Explanation: When a dielectric is introduced between the plates of a capacitor, its potential difference
decreases.
New potential difference= potential difference without dielectric-potential difference of dielectric= 10-
2*2= 6V.
8. Calculate the capacitance if the dielectric constant=4, area of cross section= 10m2 and the distance of
separation between the plates is 5m.
a) 7.08*10-11F
b) 7.08*1011F
c) 7.08*10-12F
d) 7.08*10-10F
Answer: a
Explanation: The expression to find capacitance when a dielectric is introduced between the plates is:
C=ke0A/d. Substituting the given values in the equation, we get C= 7.08*10 -11F.
10. What happens to the potential difference between the plates of a capacitor as the thickness of the
dielectric slab increases?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) Becomes zero
Answer: b
Explanation: When a dielectric is introduced between the plates of a capacitor, its potential difference
decreases.
Jo
New potential difference= potential difference without dielectric-potential difference of dielectric. Hence
in
as the thickness of the dielectric slab increases, a larger value is subtracted fro the original potential
@
SP
difference.
P U
B
“Dielectric Strength”.
TE
C
H
-T
el
4. If the potential difference in a material is 4MV and the thickness of the material is 2m, calculate the
dielectric strength.
a) 2MV/m
b) 4MV/m
c) 6MV/m
d) 8MV/m
Jo
Answer: a
in
Explanation: Dielectric strength is the potential gradient required to cause a breakdown in the material.
@
SP
5. If the dielectric strength of a material is 4MV/m and its potential difference is 28MV, calculate the
TE
a) 4m
H
-T
el
b) 7m
c) 5m
d) 11m
Answer: b
Explanation: Dielectric strength is the potential gradient required to cause a breakdown in the material.
Potential gradient is the ratio of voltage and thickness.
V/dielectric strength= t= 28/4=7m.
6. If the thickness of the material increases, what happens to the dielectric strength?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) Becomes zero
Answer: b
Explanation: Dielectric strength is the potential gradient required to cause a breakdown in the material.
Potential gradient is the ratio of voltage and thickness. Hence as thickness increases, dielectric strength
decreases.
7. The thickness of a material having dielectric strength 10MV/m is 5m, calculate the potential difference.
a) 2MV
b) 10MV
c) 50MV
d) 100MV
Answer: c
Explanation: Dielectric strength is the potential gradient required to cause a breakdown in the material.
Potential gradient is the ratio of voltage and thickness.
V=t*dielectric strength= 5*10=50MV.
8. What happens to the potential drop between the two plates of a capacitor when a dielectric is
introduced between the plates?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) Becomes zero
Answer: b
Explanation: When a dielectric is introduced between the two plates of a parallel plate capacitor, the
potential difference decreases because the potential difference of the dielectric is subtracted from it.
Jo
in
a) Capacitor
SP
b) Conductor
P
c) Insulator
U
B
d) Semiconductor
TE
Answer: c
C
Explanation: A dielectric is basically an insulator because it has all the properties of an insulator.
H
-T
el
10. What happens to the potential difference between the plates of a capacitor as the thickness of the
dielectric slab increases?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) Becomes zero
Answer: b
Explanation: When a dielectric is introduced between the plates of a capacitor, its potential difference
decreases.
New potential difference= potential difference without dielectric-potential difference of dielectric. Hence
as the thickness of the dielectric slab increases, a larger value is subtracted fro the original potential
difference.
“Capacitors in Parallel”.
1. What is the total capacitance when three capacitors, C1, C2 and C3 are connected in parallel?
a) C1/(C2+C3)
b) C1+C2+C3
c) C2/(C1+C3)
d) 1/C1+1/C2+1/C3
Answer: b
Explanation: When capacitors are connected in parallel, the total capacitance is equal to the sum of the
capacitance of each of the capacitors. Hence Ctotal=C1+C2+C3.
2. Calculate the total capacitance.
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
) 10F
b) 15F
c) 13F
d) 20F
Answer: c
Explanation: The equivalent capacitance when capacitors are connected in parallel is the sum of all the
capacitors= 1+2+10= 13F.
3. Calculate the voltage across AB if the total change stored in the combination is 13C.
a) 1V
b) 2V
c) 3V
d) 4V
Answer: a
Explanation: The equivalent capacitance when capacitors are connected in parallel is the sum of all the
capacitors= 1+2+10= 13F. V=Q/C= 13/13=1V.
4. Calculate the charge in the 2F capacitor.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
a) 200C
b) 100C
c) 300C
d) 400C
Answer: a
Explanation: Since the capacitors are connected in parallel, the voltage across each is the same, it does not
get divided. Q=CV= 2*100=200C.
a) 200C
b) 100C
c) 300C
d) 400C
Answer: b
Explanation: Since the capacitors are connected in parallel, the voltage across each is the same, it does not
get divided. Q=CV= 1*100=100C.
6. Calculate the total charge of the system.
Jo
in
@
SP
a) 200C
b) 100C
P U
c) 300C
B
TE
d) 400C
Answer: c
C
H
-T
el
Explanation: The equivalent capacitance when capacitors are connected in parallel is the sum of all the
capacitors=1+2=3F. Q=CV= 3*100= 300V.
7. When capacitors are connected in parallel, the total capacitance is always __________ the individual
capacitance values.
a) Greater than
b) Less than
c) Equal to
d) Cannot be determined
Answer: a
Explanation: When capacitors are connected in parallel, the total capacitance is equal to the sum of the
capacitance of each of the capacitors. Hence Ctotal=C1+C2+C3. Since it is the sum of all the capacitance
values, total capacitance is greater the the individual capacitance values.
8. When capacitors are connected in parallel, what happens to the effective plate area?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) Becomes zero
Answer: a
Explanation: When capacitors are connected in parallel, the top plates of each of the capacitors are
connected together while the bottom plates are connected to each other. This effectively increases the top
plate area and the bottom plate area.
9. Three capacitors having capacitance equal to 2F, 4F and 6F are connected in parallel. Calculate the
effective parallel.
a) 10F
b) 11F
c) 12F
d) 13F
Answer: c
Explanation: When capacitors are connected in parallel, the total capacitance is equal to the sum of the
capacitance of each of the capacitors. Hence Ctotal=C1+C2+C3= 2+4+6=12F.
10. Two capacitors having capacitance value 4F, three capacitors having capacitance value 2F and 5
capacitors having capacitance value 1F are connected in parallel, calculate the equivalent capacitance.
a) 20F
Jo
b) 19F
in
c) 18F
@
d) 17F
SP
Answer: b
P
Explanation: When capacitors are connected in parallel, the total capacitance is equal to the sum of the
U
B
“Capacitors in Series”.
1. What is the total capacitance when two capacitors C1 and C2 are connected in series?
a) (C1+C2)/C1C2
b) 1/C1+1/C2
c) C1C2/(C1+C2)
d) C1+C2
Answer: c
Explanation: When capacitors are connected in series, the equivalent capacitance is:
1/Ctotal=1/C1+1/C2, therefore Ctotal= C1C2/(C1+C2).
2. N capacitors having capacitance C are connected in series, calculate the equivalent capacitance.
a) C/N
b) C
c) CN
d) N/C
Answer: d
Explanation: When capacitors are connected in series, the equivalent capacitance is:
1/Ctotal= 1/C+1/C+1/C+……..N times.
1/Ctotal=N/C.
Ctotal=C/N.
3. When capacitors are connected in series, the equivalent capacitance is ___________ each individual
capacitance.
a) Greater than
b) Less then
c) Equal to
d) Insufficient data provided
Answer: b
Explanation: When capacitors are connected in series, the equivalent capacitance is:
1/Ctotal=1/C1+1/C2. Since we find the reciprocals of the sum of the reciprocals, the equivalent
capacitance is less than the individual capacitance values.
4. What is the equivalent capacitance?
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
a) 1.5F
C
H
b) 0.667F
-T
el
c) 2.45F
d) 2.75F
Answer: b
Explanation: When capacitors are connected in series, the equivalent capacitance is:
1/Ctotal=1/C1+1/C2= 1/2+1= 0.667F.
) 66.67C
b) 20.34C
c) 25.45C
d) 30/45C
Answer: a
Explanation: When capacitors are connected in series, the equivalent capacitance is:
1/Ctotal=1/C1+1/C2= 1/2+1=0.667F.
Q=CV= 1.5*100= 66.67C.
9. Calculate the voltage across the 1F capacitor.
a) 33.33V
b) 66.67V
c) 56.56V
d) 23.43V
Answer: b
Explanation: When capacitors are connected in series, the equivalent capacitance is:
1/Ctotal=1/C1+1/C2= 1/2+1=0.667F.
Q=CV= 1.5*100= 66.67C.
V across the 1F capacitor= 66.67/1= 66.67V.
10. Calculate the voltage across the 2F capacitor.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
a) 33.33V
TE
b) 66.67V
C
c) 56.56V
H
-T
el
d) 23.43V
Answer: a
Explanation: When capacitors are connected in series, the equivalent capacitance is:
1/Ctotal=1/C1+1/C2= 1/2+1=0.667F.
Q=CV= 1.5*100= 66.67C.
V across the 1F capacitor= 66.67/2= 33.33V.
capacitance is larger than the largest individual capacitance when connected in parallel. The relation
in
Energy=CV2/2, hence as the capacitance increases, the energy stored in it also increases.
SP
P
4. If the charge stored in a capacitor is 4C and the value of capacitance is 2F, calculate the energy stored
U
B
in it.
TE
a) 2J
C
b) 4J
H
-T
el
c) 8J
d) 16J
Answer: b
Explanation: The expression for finding the value of energy is:
U=Q2/2C= 4*4/(2*2)= 4J.
5. If the charge in a capacitor is 4C and the energy stored in it is 4J, find the value of capacitance.
a) 2F
b) 4F
c) 8F
d) 16F
Answer: a
Explanation: The expression for finding the value of energy is:
U=Q2/2C.
Substituting the values of U and Q, we get C=2F.
6. If the charge in a capacitor is 4C and the energy stored in it is 4J, calculate the voltage across its plates.
a) 2V
b) 4V
c) 8V
d) 16V
Answer: a
Explanation: The expression for finding the value of energy is:
U=Q2/2C.
Substituting the values of U and Q, we get C=2F.
V=Q/C, hence V=4/2=2V.
a) 8.6kJ
H
b) 64kJ
-T
el
c) 64J
d) 6.4kJ
Answer: d
Explanation: From the expression:
WD= CV2/2= 2*802/2=6400J=6.4kJ.
a) 128kJ
b) 1.28kJ
c) 12.8kJ
d) 1280J
Answer: c
Explanation: From the expression:
WD= CV2/2= 4*802/2=12800J=12.8kJ.
a) 192kJ
b) 1.92kJ
c) 19.2kJ
d) 1920J
Answer: c
Explanation: The equivalent capacitance is: Ceq=4+2=6F.
From the expression:
WD= CV2/2= 6*802/2=19200J=19.2kJ.
10. What is the energy in a capacitor if the voltage is 5V and the charge is10C?
a) 6.25J
b) 2.35J
c) 6.54J
d) 4.55J
Answer: a
Explanation: We know that Q/V=C. Hence the value of capacitance is 2F.
From the expression:
U=Q2/2C, we get U= 6.25J.
a) Time constant
in
b) Current
@
c) Power
SP
d) Voltage
P
Answer: a
U
B
Explanation: The time constant in a circuit consisting of a capacitor is the product of the resistance and
TE
the capacitance. Smaller the time constant, faster is the charging and discharging rate and vice versa.
C
H
-T
el
5. A capacitor is charged to a voltage of 400V and has a resistance of 20ohm. Calculate the initial value of
discharge current.
a) 10A
b) 0A
c) Infinity
d) 20A
Answer: d
Explanation: When the capacitor is discharging the value of initial current is a finite one. The finite initial
current value is found using ohm’s law: I=V/R= 400/20= 20A.
Jo
6. A capacitor is charged to a voltage of 400V and has a resistance of 20ohm. Calculate the final value of
in
discharge current.
@
a) 10A
SP
b) 0A
P
c) Infinity
U
B
d) 20A
TE
Answer: b
C
Explanation: In a discharging circuit, the final voltage is equal to zero as all the positive and negative
H
-T
el
charges have combined. Since the voltage is equal to zero, the current is also equal to zero as voltage is
directly proportional to current by ohm’s law.
8. What happens to the capacitor when the capacitor voltage is equal to the source voltage?
a) The charging phase of the capacitor is over
b) The discharging phase of the capacitor is over
c) The capacitor is switched off
d) The capacitor is switched on
Answer: a
Explanation: When the capacitor voltage is equal to the source voltage, it means that all the charges have
moved from one plate of the capacitor to the other. Hence the capacitor is charged and the charging phase
is over.
9. A capacitor is charged to a voltage of 400V and has a resistance of 20ohm. Calculate the final value of
charging current.
a) 10A
b) 0A
c) Infinity
d) 20A
Answer: d
Explanation: The final value of charging current in a capacitor is equal to the initial value of discharging
current in it. Hence the final value of charging current is: Vc/R=20A.
10. A capacitor is charged to a voltage of 400V and has a resistance of 20ohm. Calculate the initial value
of charging current.
a) 10A
b) 0A
c) Infinity
Jo
d) 20A
in
Answer: b
@
Explanation: Initially, there’s 0V voltage in a capacitor. As the capacitor charges, the voltage increases.
SP
Since voltage is proportional to current by ohm’s law, initial current is also equal to zero.
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
𝐸2 = 4.44𝑓∅𝑚 𝑁2 𝑉𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑠
𝑁
● Transformation Ratio,𝐾 = 𝑁2
1
𝐸 𝑁2 𝐼
● Voltage Ratio,𝐸2 = 𝑁1
= 𝐾𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝐶𝑢𝑟𝑟𝑒𝑛𝑡 𝑅𝑎𝑡𝑖𝑜, 𝐼1 = 𝐾
1 2
𝑉𝐼 𝑉𝐼
1 1
● KVA Rating of Transformer = 1000 2 2
= 1000 ….1000 to express in KVA
𝐾𝑉𝐴 𝑅𝑎𝑡𝑖𝑛𝑔 ×1000
● 𝐼1 𝑎𝑡 𝑓𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 = , 𝐼2 𝑎𝑡 𝑓𝑢𝑙𝑙 𝑙𝑜𝑎𝑑 =
𝑉1
𝐾𝑉𝐴 𝑅𝑎𝑡𝑖𝑛𝑔 ×1000
… … (1000 𝑡𝑜 𝑐𝑜𝑛𝑣𝑒𝑟𝑡 𝐾𝑉𝐴 𝑡𝑜 𝑉𝐴)
𝑉2
𝑅
● 𝑅𝑒𝑠𝑖𝑠𝑡𝑎𝑛𝑐𝑒 𝑟𝑒𝑓𝑒𝑟𝑟𝑒𝑑 𝑡𝑜 𝑝𝑟𝑖𝑚𝑎𝑟𝑦 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑠𝑒𝑐𝑜𝑛𝑑𝑎𝑟𝑦 𝑅′ 2 = 𝐾22 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑅′ 1 = 𝐾 2 𝑅1
𝐸2 −𝑉2
● % Voltage Regulation = × 100
𝑉2
1.67
● Hysteresis Loss =𝐾ℎ 𝐵𝑚 𝑓𝑣𝑤𝑎𝑡𝑡𝑠
Kh =Hysteresis constant depends on material, B m=Maximum flux density, f= frequency
V= volume of the core
● Eddy current loss = 𝐾𝑒 𝐵𝑚 2 𝑓 2 𝑡 2 𝑤𝑎𝑡𝑡𝑠𝑝𝑒𝑟𝑢𝑛𝑖𝑡𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑢𝑚𝑒
Ke= Eddy current constant and t= Thickness of core
● Pi= Iron loss = Hysteresis + Eddy current loss
● Pcu=I2= (KVA)2
● Total Losses = Iron Loss + Copper Losses =Pi+Pcu
(𝑉𝐴𝑅𝑎𝑡𝑖𝑛𝑔)×𝑐𝑜𝑠𝑐𝑜𝑠 ∅
● % 𝜂 = (𝑉𝐴𝑅𝑎𝑡𝑖𝑛𝑔)×𝑐𝑜𝑠𝑐𝑜𝑠 ∅+𝑃 +𝑃 × 100
𝑖 𝑐𝑢
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
1
eg
ra
m
Objective Type Questions & Answers for Online Examination
a. Eddy current lo
in
b. Hysteresis loss
@
c. Copper loss
SP
d. Friction loss
Q.9 The vertical portion on which coils are wound in a transformer is called----.
P U
a. Core
B
b. Yoke
TE
c. Joint
C
H
d. limb
-T
el
2
eg
ra
m
Q.10 Generally ----- is used for laminations of a transformer core.
a. High grade silicon steel
b. Copper
c. Iron
d. Manganin
Q.11The core provides---- path to the flux produced.
a. Low resistance
b. Low reluctance
c. Low voltage
d. None of these
Q.12 The laminations in transformer core are overlapped so as ----
a. To keep core resistance small
b. To increase the flux in the core
c. To avoid the air gap at the joints
d. To provide high reluctance path
Q.13 In a core type transformer----
a. The core encircles the winding
b. The winding encircles the core
c. The limb encircles yoke
d. None of the above
Q.14 ------ construction has a double magnetic circuit.
a. Berry type
b. Core type
c. Shell type
d. None of these
Q.15 In a shell type construction ------
a. The core encircles the winding
b. The winding encircles the core
c. The limb encircles yoke
d. None of the above
Q.16 ------ coils are generally used in shell type construction.
a) Single layer
b) Sandwich
c) Cylindrical
d) PVC
Q.17 ------ coils are generally used in core type construction
a) Single layer
b) Sandwich
c) Cylindrical
Jo
d) PVC
in
Q.18 In ---- of transformer, the coils can be easily removed for maintenance purpose.
@
a. Berry type
SP
b. Core type
c. Shell type
P U
d. None of these
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
3
eg
ra
m
Q.19 ---- construction is used for high voltage transformers
a. Berry type
b. Core type
c. Shell type
d. None of these
Q.20 The average e.m.f. per turn in a transformer is ----
a. 4 𝑓∅𝑚
b. 4.44 𝑓∅𝑚
c. 2𝑓∅𝑚
d. 𝑓∅𝑚
Q.21For a 50 Hz transformer, the primary turns are 100 and maximum flux in the core
is 0.08 Wb,then the primary induced e.m.f. is------
a. 1856 V
b. 1276 V
c. 176 V
d. 1776 V
Q.22 R.M.S. Value of the induced e.m.f. per turn in transformer is ----
a. 4.44 𝑓∅𝑚
b. 4 𝑓∅𝑚
c. 2𝑓∅𝑚
d. 𝑓∅𝑚
Q.23For a transformer, the induced e.m.f. on primary is 199.8 V with 50 turns at 50 Hz
Frequency then the maximum flux in the core is ------
a) 79.92 mWb
b) 18 mWb
c) 18 Wb
d) 0.999 Wb
Q.24 An ideal transformer is the one having ------
a) No losses
b) Zero resistance windings
c) Zero leakage flux
d) All of these
Q.25The turns ratio is ---- to current ratio.
a) Directly proportional
b) Equal
c) Inversely proportional
d) None of these
Q.26 For a 250/25 V transformer having 1 KVA rating, the full load primary current is ---
a) 40 A
Jo
b) 4 A
in
c) 0.4A
@
d) 0.04 A
SP
a) 𝐸1
U
2
B
𝑁1
b)
TE
𝑁2
𝑁2
C
c)
H
𝑁1
-T
el
4
eg
ra
m
𝐼2
d) 𝐼1
Q.28The transformer rating is expressed in VA because -----
a) On both sides it is constant
b) Losses are independent of load power factor
c) The frequency is constant on the load side
d) The flux in the core remains constant
Q.29 An isolation transformer has turns ratio of ----
a) 1:10
b) 10:1
c) 1:1
d) None of these
Q.30 A transformer has secondary full load current of 10 A and secondary no
load inducede.m.f. of 200 V, then its KVA rating is ----
a) 2000
b) 200
c) 2
d) 20
Q.31The regulation of a transformer is defined as ------
a) Rise in terminal voltage when loaded
b) Fall in terminal voltage when loaded
c) Change in secondary terminal voltage from no-load to full load as a percentage
Of secondary no load terminal voltage
d) Change in flux from no-load to full-load
Q.32 For better performance of transformer, the regulation must be -----
a) high
b) infinite
c) very low
d) none of these
Q.33The no load voltage of transformer is 400 volts, while it drops to 395 V on full
load then its regulation is ------ %
a) 1.265
b) 12.65
c) -1.265
d) 0
Q.34 Losses which do not occur in transformer are ----
a) Copper loss
b) Magnetic losses
c) Friction losses
d) None of these
Q.35 The losses which vary with load in a power transformer are ------
Jo
b) Copper losses
@
d) Hysteresis losses
P
a. Heat
TE
b. Magnetic hum
C
c. Light
H
d. Electric energy
-T
el
5
eg
ra
m
Q.37 A transformer core is laminated to reduce the -----
a. Hysteresis loss
b. Eddy current loss
c. Leakage reactance
d. All of these
Q.38 Which loss is variable in a transformer?
a. Eddy current loss
b. Copper loss
c. Core loss
d. Friction loss
Q.39 When the supply frequency of a transformer is doubled then the hysteresis
losses ------
a. Remain same
b. Reduced by 50%
c. Doubled
d. Becomes 4 times
Q.40 The expression for the hysteresis loss is -----
a. 𝐾ℎ 𝐵𝑚 2.67 𝑓𝑣
b. 𝐾ℎ 𝐵𝑚 1.67 𝑓𝑣
c. 𝐾ℎ 𝐵𝑚 2.67 𝑓 2 𝑣
d. 𝐾ℎ 𝐵𝑚 1.67 𝑓𝑣 2
Q.41 The expression for the eddy current loss is -----
a. 𝐾𝑒 𝐵𝑚 𝑓 2 𝑡 2
b. 𝐾𝑒 𝐵𝑚 𝑓𝑡 2
c. 𝐾𝑒 𝐵1.67 𝑚 𝑓 2 𝑡 2
d. 𝐾𝑒 𝐵𝑚 2 𝑓 2 𝑡 2
Q.42 Regulation and efficiency of a transformer should be respectively ----
a. High, high
b. High, low
c. Low, high
d. Low, low
Q.43 The advantage of direct loading test is ----
a. Efficiency at any load can be predicted without actually loading
b. Equivalent circuit parameters can be obtained
c. The results are accurate
d. None of these
Q.44 On no load efficiency of the transformer --------
a. 100
b. 0
Jo
c. 90
in
d. 98
@
Q.45As the load current increases, the regulation of the transformer ------
SP
a. Increases
P
b. Decreases
U
B
c. Remains same
TE
d. None of these
C
H
-T
el
6
eg
ra
m
Q.46 An autotransformer -------
a. Increases the iron losses
b. Converts single phase to three phase supply
c. Uses common winding between primary and secondary
d. None of these
Q.47 The advantage of autotransformer is -------
a. Gives highly stable voltage
b. Copper saving
c. Efficiency is 100%
d. None of these
Q.48 In ------ of the following an autotransformer is used.
a. Dimmerstat
b. Traction
c. Leath machine
d. Tube light
Q.49 The efficiency of autotransformer is ---- the two winding transformer.
a. Less than
b. More than
c. Same as
d. None of these
Q.50 What will be eddy current loss if the supply frequency of a transformer
becomes double?
a. Eight times
b. Remains same
c. Doubled
d. Four times
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
7
eg
ra
m
Unit 3:Electrostatics
𝑄1 = 𝐶1 𝑉, 𝑄2 = 𝐶2 𝑉, 𝑄3 = 𝐶3 𝑉
𝑄 = 𝑄1 + 𝑄2 + 𝑄3 = 𝐶1 𝑉 + 𝐶2 𝑉 + 𝐶3 𝑉
𝐶𝑒𝑞 = 𝑡𝑘 = 𝑡1 𝑡2 𝑡𝑛
∑𝑛𝑘=1
𝜀𝑟1 + 𝜀𝑟2 + ⋯ + 𝜀𝑟𝑛
in
𝜀𝑟𝑘
@
SP
P
The expression for the charging current and the voltage across the capacitor are,
U
B
TE
𝑉
R-C charging, 𝐶𝑢𝑟𝑟𝑒𝑛𝑡𝑖 = 𝑅 𝑒 −𝑡𝑖𝐶𝑅 𝑎𝑛𝑑𝑉𝑐 = 𝑉(1 − 𝑒 −𝑡𝑖𝐶𝑅 )
C
H
-T
el
8
eg
ra
m
𝜏 = 𝐶𝑅𝑠𝑒𝑐𝑜𝑛𝑑𝑠 = 𝑇𝑖𝑚𝑒𝑐𝑜𝑛𝑠𝑡𝑎𝑛𝑡
The expressions for the discharging current and the voltage across the capacitor,
𝑉 −𝑡𝑖𝐶𝑅
R-C discharging, 𝑉𝑐 = 𝑉𝑒 −𝑡𝑖𝐶𝑅𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑠𝑎𝑛𝑑𝑖=𝑅𝑒
a. displacement intensity
in
c. electric potential
SP
a. c/m
B
TE
b. c/m2
c. N/C
C
H
d. N/m2C
-T
el
9
eg
ra
m
Q.9 The electric field intensity at a point is -------
a. F/Q
b. Q/F
c. B/Q
d. ½ VQ
𝜀
c) 𝐸 = 𝐷
in
d) 𝐸 = 𝜀𝐷
@
a) Potential difference
P U
b) electric potential
B
c) potential gradient
TE
d) electric force
C
10
eg
ra
m
a) Electric field strength, potential difference
b) Electric field strength, potential gradient
c) Electric field strength, electric flux density
d) electric flux density, potential gradient
𝜀𝑑
a) 𝐴
H
-T
el
11
eg
ra
m
𝜀
b) 𝑑𝐴
𝜀𝐴
c) 𝑑
𝐴
d) 𝜀𝑑
Q.27 The capacitor is charged to 10V and its capacitance is 1µF then charge on it is----
a) 10µC
b) 10 nC
c) 10C
d) 1µC
Q.28 A capacitor uses the plates of area 25 cm2 and distance between the plates
is 5cm.Then its capacitance with air as a dielectric is -----
a) 0.4427 µF
b) 0.4427 pF
c) 0.4427 nF
d) 0.4427 F
Q.29 The charge transferred on the plates of a capacitor is 2 nC while the
distance between the plates is 1mm.If area of cross section is 10 cm2 and air is used
as
A dielectric then the voltage across the plates is -------V.
a) 22.580
b) 2.5588
c) 225.88
d) 22.558
Q.30 A capacitor of 10µF has a charge of 1mC.If the distance between the plates is 1 cm
Then the electric field intensity between the plates is -----
a) 10 KV/m
b) 10V/m
c) 0.1 V/m
d) 8.854 KV/m
Q.31 For a 5µF capacitor, distance between the plates is 0.5 cm and the electric field
Intensity is 20kV/m then the charge on the capacitor is --------
a) 5 µC
b) 0.5 µC
c) 5 nC
d) 0.5 mC
Q.32 A capacitor uses a dielectric of 𝜀𝑟 =2. It is charged to 500 V and the
distance between the plates is 10 cm then the electric flux density between the plate
Is ------nC/m2.
Jo
a) 0.8854
in
b) 88.54
@
c) 8.854
SP
d) 0.00885
P
Q.33 The p.d. between the plates of a 5µF capacitor with a charge of 2mC on it is ----V
U
a) 200
B
TE
b) 100
C
c) 400
H
d) 4000
-T
el
12
eg
ra
m
Q.34A 2 µF capacitor connected in a circuit has one plate at +6 V and the other plate at
-6 V. the charge on the negative plate of the capacitor is -----
a) +12 µC
b) -12 µC
c) +24 µC
d) -24 µC
Q.35 A parallel plate capacitor with air as dielectric remains connected across a battery
ofe.m.f. 6V.The charge on the capacitor in this condition is Q.If the separation
between the plates is decreased by 10% in this condition and sufficient time is
allowed to attain steady state, the charge on the capacitor will be ------
a) Increased by 11% approximately
b) Increased by 9 % approximately
c) Decreased by 9 % approximately
d) Decreased by 11 % approximately
Q.36 The ability of an insulating medium to resist its breakdown is called its -----
a) Dielectric constant
b) Dielectric strength
c) Relative permittivity
d) Insulation resistance
Q.37 For the capacitor in series, -------- remains same for all of them.
a) Coltage
b) Capacitance
c) Charge
d) None of these
Q.38 If three capacitors are connected in series, the equivalent capacitance is ------
1
a) 1 1 1
+ +
𝐶1 𝐶2 𝐶3
b) 𝐶1 + 𝐶2 + 𝐶3
1 1 1
c) + +
𝐶1 𝐶2 𝐶3
d) 𝑛𝑜𝑛𝑒𝑜𝑓𝑡ℎ𝑒𝑠𝑒
Q.39 The two capacitors 3µF and 6µF are in series then the equivalent capacitance is -----
a) 9 µF
b) 4.5 µF
c) 2 µF
d) 1 µF
Q.40 Three capacitors connected in series have equivalent capacitance of 2 µF. If one of
the capacitor is removed the effective capacitance becomes 3µF, then the value of
capacitance which is removed is --------µF.
a) 0.5
Jo
b) 8
in
c) 2
@
d) 4
SP
a) Voltage
U
B
b) Charge
TE
c) Flux
C
d) None of these
H
-T
el
13
eg
ra
m
Q.42 Two capacitors 3 µF and 6 µF are in parallel and combination is connected across
100 V supply then the charge on 6 µF is -------µC.
a) 300
b) 600
c) 1200
d) 100
Q.43 Two capacitors in series give equivalent capacitance of 20 µF and when in parallel
give equivalent capacitance of 3.75 µF then the two capacitors are ------
a) 4 µF, 16 µF
b) 5 µF, 15 µF
c) 10 µF, 10 µF
d) 11 µF, 9 µF
Q.44 Four,2µF capacitors are connected in parallel then the effective capacitance
is ---- µF.
a) 0.5
b) 8
c) 2
d) 4
Q.45 A capacitor C1 is charged to a voltage V0 from battery.After disconnecting
from battery, is connected to other uncharged capacitor C2.Then the new
voltage across the combination will be --------
𝐶1
a) 𝐶 +𝐶 𝑉0
1 2
𝐶2
b) 𝑉
𝐶1 +𝐶2 0
𝐶1 +𝐶2
c) 𝑉0
𝐶 1
𝐶1 +𝐶2
d) 𝑉0
𝐶2
Q.46 A capacitor is made up of three dielectrics of relative permittivity values
of 𝜀𝑟1, 𝜀𝑟2 , 𝜀𝑟3 and thicknesses of 𝑡1 , 𝑡2 , 𝑡3 respectively ------------
𝑡 𝑡 𝑡
a) 𝜀0 𝐴 (𝜀 1 + 𝜀 2 + 𝜀 3 )
𝑟1, 𝑟2, 𝑟3,
b) 𝜀0 𝐴[𝑡1 𝜀𝑟1 + 𝑡2 𝜀𝑟2 + 𝑡3 𝜀𝑟3 ]
𝜀 𝐴
c) 𝑡1 𝑡02 𝑡3
+ +
𝜀𝑟1, 𝜀𝑟2, 𝜀𝑟3,
d) None of these
Q.47 A capacitor is made up of two dielectric having constants 2 and 5 with thicknesses
1 mm and 2mm respectively. If area of cross section is 50 cm2 then capacitance is--
a) 110.075 pF
b) 49.188 pF
Jo
c) 8.854 µF
in
d) 2.03 nF
@
1
a) 2 𝐶𝑉
P
1
U
b) 𝐶𝑉 2
B
2
TE
1
c) 𝑄𝑉 2
2
C
1𝐶
H
d) 2𝑉
-T
el
14
eg
ra
m
Q.49 A capacitor is charged to 100 mC and the energy stored is 10 J then voltage across
capacitor is -----
a) 100V
b) 1KV
c) 200V
d) 2KV
Q.50If the p.d. between the plates is increased by 10% then the energy stored in the
Capacitor increases by ----------%
a) 11
b) 10
c) 2.1
d) 21
Q.51 What fraction of the energy drawn from the charging battery is stored in a capacitor?
a) 100%
b) 50%
c) 75%
d) 70.7%
Q.52As capacitor charges, the voltage across it ------
a) Decreases exponentially
b) Increases instantly
c) Increases exponentially
d) Decreases instantly
Q.53 Initially the capacitor acts as --------
a) Open circuit
b) Short circuit
c) Breakdown
d) None of these
Q.54In the steady state, the capacitor acts as ------
a) Open circuit
b) Short circuit
c) Breakdown
d) None of these
Q.55 If capacitor ‘C’ is charged through resistance R then the time constant is --------
1
a) 𝑅𝐶
𝑅
b) 𝐶
c) 𝑅𝐶
𝐶
d) 𝑅
Q.56 A charging time constant of RC circuit is time required by the capacitor voltage to rise
Jo
From -----------
in
d) None of these
U
B
Q.57 A charging time constant of RC circuit is time required by charging current to fall --
TE
15
eg
ra
m
d) None of these
Q.58 The expression for the charging current through while charging C through
resistor R is
𝑉 −𝑡𝑖𝑅𝐶
a) 𝑅𝐶 𝑒
𝑉
b) 𝑒 −𝑡𝑖𝑅𝐶
𝑅
c) 𝑉(1 − 𝑒 −𝑡/𝑅𝐶 )
𝑉
d) 𝑅 (1 − 𝑒 −𝑡/𝑅𝐶 )
Q.59 A capacitor of 1 µF is charged through resistor of 1M𝛺 from a 100 V source
then voltage across capacitor after 2 sec is ------
a) 36.8 V
b) 63.212 V
c) 86.466 V
d) 100 V
Q.60 Initial charging current through a capacitor is 40µA when charged through 1.5 M𝛺
resistance then supply voltage is -----
a) 20 V
b) 40 V
c) 60 V
d) 80 V
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
16
eg
ra
m
MULTIPLE CHOICE QUESTIONS
Unit 3- Single Phase A. C circuits
1. In purely resistive circuit voltage and current are _________with each other.
a. Lagging
b. Leading
c. In Phase
d. None of above
a. Zero
SP
b. VI Cos Ø
c. VI sin Ø
P U
d. None of these
B
TE
b. Lags
-T
1
el
eg
ra
m
c. Align
d. None of above
9. Current equation in purely inductive circuit is given by _________.
a. i = Im Sin ωt
b. i = Im Sin ωt + 90°
c. i = Im Sin ωt - 90°
d. None of above
10. Capacitive reactance is given by the formula ________.
a. Xc= 1/ 2πfc
b. Xc = 2πfc
c. Xc= 0
d. None of above.
11. In pure capacitive circuit, the power is _________.
a. Infinite
b. Maximum
c. Minimum
d. Zero
12. In single phase a.c circuits VI represents __________Power?
a. Active
b. Reactive
c. Apparent
d. Real
13. Reactive power is given as _________?
a. VI
b. VI Cos Ø
c. VI sin Ø
d. None of these
14. ____________Equation gives power factor of circuit.
a. R/Z
b. R x Z
c. XZ
d. None of above
15. In a capacitive circuit when Capacitance increases then power factor ________?
a. Increases
b. Decreases
c. Remains same
d. None of above
16. If current and Voltage are 90 Degree out of phase ,then power will be ______?
a. Maximum
Jo
b. Normal
in
c. Minimum
@
d. Zero
SP
P
a. Voltage of circuit
TE
b. Current of circuit
C
2
el
eg
ra
m
d. None of above
21. At resonant frequency, the voltage across capacitor is _______ the voltage across
inductor.
a) greater than
b) less than
c) greater than or equal to
d) equal to
22. In series RLC circuit, the voltage across capacitor and inductor are ______ with each
other.
a) in phase
b) 180⁰ out of phase
c) 90⁰ out of phase
d) 45⁰ out of phase
b. Z = 1+ Y
in
c. Z= 1-Y
@
d. Z= 2Y
SP
P
3
el
eg
ra
m
d. None of above
24. For the circuit given below, the approximate value of reactance, impedance, current and
power factor is———-respectively.
25. For the circuit given in previous question, the power consumed is—-
1. 200 Watts
2. 361 Watts
3. 300 Watts
4. 500 Watts
1. 1
2. 0.8
3. 0.9
4. 0.5
4
el
eg
ra
m
28. Magnitude of current at resonance in R-L-C circuit
A. wLC = 1
B. wL2C2 = 1
C. w2LC = 1*
D. w2L2C = 1
32. Under the condition of resonance in R-L-C series circuit, the power factor of the
circuit is
A. 0.5 lagging
B. 0.5 leading
C. Unity
D. Zero
33. A series R-L-C circuit will have unity power factor if operated at a frequency of
A. 1/LC
B.1/w2 LC
C. 1/w2 LC
D. 1/ 2 Π √ LC*
34. The voltage applied across an R-L circuit is equal to..........of VR and VL
Jo
in
A. Phasor sum*
@
B. Arithmetic sum
SP
5
el
eg
ra
m
B. Sine of the phase angle
C. Unity for a resistive circuit
D. Unity for a reactive circuit
A. 0 and 1
B. -1 and 1
C. 0 and -1
D. None of these
37. A circuit component that oppose the change in the circuit voltage is
A. Resistance
B. Capacitance*
C. Inductance
D. All of the above
A. C only
B. L only
C. R only
D. All of the above
A. Low efficiency
B. High power factor
C. Unity power factor
D. Maximum load current
A. Cycle
B. Cycle-second
C. Hertz/second
D. Hertz
41. When an alternating current passes through an ohmic resistance the electrical power
converted into heat is
A. Apparent power
B. True power*
Jo
C. Reactive power
in
6
el
eg
ra
m
43. In AC circuit the power curve is a sine wave having
A. Magnitude only
B. Direction only
C. Both magnitude and direction*
D. None of the above
45. A boiler at home is switched on to the a.c. mains supply in power at 230 V, 50 Hz.
The frequency of instantaneous power consumed is
A. 0 Hz
B. 50 Hz
C. 100 Hz*
D. 150 Hz
A. Zero
B. Unity
C. Slightly more than unity
D. Slightly less than unity*
A. Unity
B. Zero
C. Lagging*
D. Leading
A. VA
B. Watt
C. VAR*
D. Ohm
Jo
49. Real part of admittance is.......... and the imaginary part is........
in
@
A. Impedance, resistance
SP
B. Resistance, impedance
C. Susceptance, inductance
P U
D. Conductance, Susceptance*
B
TE
C
H
-T
7
el
eg
ra
m
50. Capacitive Susceptance is a measure of
A. Henry
B. Millihenry
C. Wb
D. Ohm*
52. A pure capacitance connected across 50 Hz, 230 V supply consumes 0.04 W. This
consumption is attributed to
53. A circuit with a resistor, inductor and capacitor in series is resonant of fo Hz. If the all
the component of values are now doubled the new resonant frequency is
A. 2fo
B. Still fo
C. fo/4
D. fo/2*
8
el
eg
ra
m
57. In a purely inductive circuit if the supply frequency is reduced to 1/2, the current will
A. Be reduced by half
B. Be doubled*
C. Be four times as high
D. Be reduced to ¼
58. In a pure capacitive circuit if the supply frequency is reduced to 1/2, the current will
A. Be reduced by half*
B. Be doubled
C. Be four times at high
D. Be reduced to one fourth
60. Find the value of the instantaneous voltage if the resistance is 2 ohm and the
instantaneous current in the circuit is 5A.
a) 5V
b) 2V
c) 10V*
d) 2.5V
62. The correct expression for the instantaneous current in a resistive circuit is?
a) i=Vm(sinwt)/R*
b) i=Vm(coswt)/R
c) i=V(sinwt)/R
d) i=V(coswt)/R
63. The correct expression for the instantaneous current if instantaneous voltage is
Vm(sint) in an inductive circuit is?
a) i = Vm(sint)/X L
Jo
b) i = Vm(cost)/XL
in
c) i = -Vm(sint)/X L
@
d) i = -Vm(cost)/XL *
SP
circuit is connected to a 100V 50Hz sinusoidal supply. Calculate the current in the
B
TE
circuit.
a) 2.2A
C
H
b) 4.2A
-T
9
el
eg
ra
m
c) 6.2A
d) 8.2A*
a) maximum
@
b) minimum*
SP
c) zero
d) cannot be determined
P U
B
TE
b) XL/R
-T
10
el
eg
ra
m
c) R/Z
d) Z/R
11
el
eg
ra
m
Padmashree Dr. D Y Patil Institute of Engineering and Technology,
Pimpri, Pune 411018
a) Wb b) F / m
c) none d) m / F
2. The single phase a c circuit operates at 230 V supply, frequency 50 Hz the time required to reach
positive maximum value is …..
a) 00 b) 600
c) 900 d)1800
4. The copper losses of transformer at 80% of full load is 512 watt, then the value of it at full load…
a) 80 watt b) 512 watt
c) 640 watt d) 800 watt
5. The a c circuit consist Z = 0 + j 20 Ω, having frequency of 50 Hz, the 20 Ω represents
a) capacitive reactance b) inductive reactance
c) resistance d) impedance
6. The form factor of ac fundamental voltage is …….
a) V / Vav b) Vav / V
c) Vm / Vav d) Vm / V
7. The voltage in a c circuit is v = 100sinwt and current i = 20sinwt the value of resistance is …
a) 5 Volt b) 5 amp
c) 5 Ohm d) 5 ohm / m
8. The single phase a c transformer having rating of 100 kVA, 440 V / 11 kV, 50 Hz, the secondary
current at 0.8 p f lagging is ……
a) 9.09 A b) 9.09 mA
c) 90.9 A d) 0.909 A
9. The parallel plate capacitor having dielectric medium air, distance between plates is 30 mm, cross section
area 30 mm2 , the capacitance of capacitor will be …..
a) 885.4 pF b) 88.54 pF
c) 0.8854 pF d) 8.854 pF
10. The single phase transformer with iron losses of 100 W, copper losses at full load 512 W having
10 kVA, 440 / 230 V, 50 Hz , 0.8 leading power factor, then the efficiency of transformer at Half of
Jo
a) 94.607 % b) 92.89 %
SP
c) 96.607 % d) 96.89 %
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
11. An a c circuit v = 200sin(wt – π/3) and i = 100sin(wt + π/6), the phase difference between voltage
and current is ……
a) 900 b) 600
c) 300 d) 1200
17. The cylindrical capacitor has capacitance of 100 µF with potential difference of 100 Volt then the
energy stored in circuit is ------- J
a) 50 b) 5
c) 0.5 d) 0.05
18. The eddy current losses in transformer is a part of ……
a) Copper losses b) Iron losses
c) Variable losses d) mechanical losses
19. “The current is leading to the voltage by π/2 angle” is true for ….. a c circuit.
a) purely capacitive b) purely inductive
c) purely resistive d) collective
20. The charging action of capacitor is like…..
a) resistance b) inductance
c) reluctance d) cell or battery
21. Transformer of 440 / 200 V , 50 Hz , 0. 8 p f having direct loading test data as follows:
No load: – 400 V, 0 A, 0 watt, Full load: – 398 V, 4.5 A, 100 watt on secondary side, then the
regulation of transformer is …. %
a) 1 b) 2
c) 3 d) 4
22. The a c circuit having v = 200 sinwt and i = 100 sin(wt + π/2) , then the capacitance of the
Jo
a) 132.96 b) 1326.96
@
c) 1.3296 d) 0.13296
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Padmashree Dr. D Y Patil Institute of Engineering and Technology,
Pimpri, Pune 411018
Roll No. Div. Date
MCQ Test of Basic Electrical Engg.
Attempt all the questions given below: (only √ tick to the right answer)
a) Wb b) AT / Wb
c) Tesla d) Wb / AT
2. Three lamps of rating 100 W is connected in parallel and combination operates on 230 Volt, if
middle lamp get blown OFF then what will be the current in other two lamps of the circuit and
voltage across the middle lamp.
a) 0 A, 0 V b) 0.435 A, 230 V
c) 0 A, 230V d) 0.435A, 0 V
3. The electric pump is lifting the 30 m3 of water per hour to the height of 1500 cm having overall
efficiency of system is 80%, what will be the current taken by motor if supply voltage is 200 Volt.
a) 5.109 A b) 7.664 A
c) 5. 333 A d) 5. 666A
4. A 400 W lamp operates for 4 hours per day then its energy consumption per day is
a) 4 units b) 4 Wh
c) 1.6 units d) 0.4 Wh
5. A coil has resistance of 12 Ω at 20 OC and its RTC at is 0.003 / OC at 0 OC then it’s resistance at
50 OC is ------ Ω
a) 13.77 b) 13.55
c) 13.02 d) 13.88
6. A uniformly wound air cored circular coil has length of magnetic path is 20 cm and dia. of 25 cm.
The flux produced is 20 mWb , then the MMF of the coil will be ….. AT
a) 64828.89 b) 30522.85
c) 22966.85 d) 50522.85
7. The magnetic circuit having self inductance of 0.2 H when a current of 5 A is reversed in 0.2 sec
then the induced emf across the coil is ….
a) 5 Volt b) – 5 Volt
c) 5 Ohm d) 5 Volt/amp
8. A cable has conductor diameter of 1.2 cm and the thickness of the insulation is 1.5 cm. If the
resistivity of insulation is 2.758 x 1012 Ω-m then find the length of the cable having insulation
resistance of 550 MΩ.
Jo
a) 700 m b) 800 m
in
c) 1 Km d) 5 Km
@
SP
9. The force exerted on a body rotating at a perpendicular distance of 5 cm from the axis is 100 N
PU
a) 111.1 b) 11.1
c) 1.111 d) 1111.1
11. In Flemings Left Hand rule the middle finger and thumb of the right hand represents
respectively…..
a) Magnetic Flux, Force b) Magnetic Flux, Current
c) Current, Force d) EMF, Motion
12 The two coils having no. of turns 400, 600 respectively with total reluctance value of 1200000
then the mutual inductance of the coil is …. H
a) 0.1 b) 0.2
c) 0.01 d) 0.02
13 The coil having self inductance 0.5 H with no. of turns 1000 and exciting current of 2 amp then
the flux produces in the coil ….. mWb
a) 10 b) 0.1
c) 1 d) 0.01
14 The filament lamp temperature increases then the value of resistance …….
a) remains same b) decreases
c) increases d) increases as well as decreases
15 Two current carrying conductor placed in the magnetic field with medium air or vacuum carries
current 1A each, length of magnetic region is 1 m and distance between them is 1 m then the force
experienced is ……. N
a) 2 b) 2 π
c) 2 x 10-7 d) 4 π
17. The cylindrical coil has no. of turns 300 with current of 6 A having flux of 20 mWb then the
energy stored in magnetic circuit is ------- J
a) 1.8 b) 0.18
c) 180 d) 18
18. The hot resistance of a tungsten lamp is about 10 times the cold resistance. Accordingly, cold
resistance of a 100 W, 200 V tungsten lamp will be --------- Ω.
a) 4000 b) 400
c) 40 d) 4
19 The EMF is the term in electric circuit then similar term in magnetic circuit is ……
Jo
a) MMF b) PPF
in
c) Permittivity d) Reliability
@
Answers
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
1) b
2) d
3) b
4) c
5) c
6) a
7) a
8) c
9) c
10) b
11) d
12) b
13) c
14) c
15) c
16) d
17) c
18) c
19) a
20) b
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit 1: Electromagnetism
“Magnetic Field”.
1. What is the magnetic field outside a solenoid?
a) Infinity
b) Half the value of the field inside
c) Double the value of the field inside
d) Zero
Answer: d
Explanation: There are no magnetic lines of force outside a solenoid, hence the magnetic field
outside a solenoid is zero.
2. Which, among the following qualities, is not affected by the magnetic field?
a) Moving charge
b) Change in magnetic flux
c) Current flowing in conductor
d) Stationary charge
Answer: d
Explanation: A stationary charge is not affected by a magnetic field because stationary charges do
not have any velocity. Magnetic field cannot occur in a particle having zero velocity.
3. When a charged particle moves at right angles to the magnetic field, the variable quantity is?
a) Momentum
b) Speed
c) Energy
d) Moment of inertia
Answer: a
Explanation: When a charged particle moves perpendicular to the field, its speed remains the same
whereas its velocity keeps on changing. Momentum is the product of the mass of the particle and the
velocity if the particle, hence since velocity varies, momentum also varies.
4. If the flow of electric current is parallel to the magnetic field, the force will be ______
a) Zero
b) Infinity
c) Maximum
d) Half the original value
Jo
Answer: a
in
@
Explanation: Force is a cross product. A cross product involves the sine of the angle between them. If two
SP
quantities are parallel to each other, the angle between them is zero. Sin(0) is zero, hence force is zero.
P
5. The ratio of magnetic force to electric force on a charged particle getting undeflected in a field is?
U
B
a) 1
TE
b) 0
C
c) 2
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
d) 4
Answer: a
Explanation: When a charged particle is undeflected in a field, the magnitude of the magnetic force and
electric force acting on the particle is the same, hence the ratio is 1.
Explanation: No, we cannot see magnetic flux lines as the “lines of magnetic flux” is purely an imaginary
in
b) South to north
B
TE
c) West to east
d) East to west
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Answer: a
Explanation: Magnetic field lines originate at the north pole and terminate at the south pole of the magnet.
4. Which of the following is used to determine the direction of magnetic field in a current carrying
Jo
conductor?
in
Answer: b
B
TE
Explanation: The right hand thumb rule determines the direction of magnetic field in a current carrying
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
conductor. The rule states that when we align our right thumb in the direction of the current and curl our
fingers around it, the direction of our fingers is the direction of the magnetic field.
5. According to Flemming’s left hand rule, the index finger denotes?
a) Direction of magnetic field
b) Direction of current
c) Direction of force
d) Direction of force as well as current
Answer: a
Explanation: According to Flemming’s left hand rule, the index finger denotes the direction of magnetic
field, the thumb denoted the direction of force and the middle finger denoted the direction of current.
6. According to Flemming’s left hand rule, the middle finger denotes?
a) Direction of magnetic field
b) Direction of current
c) Direction of force
d) Direction of force as well as current
Answer: b
Explanation: According to Flemming’s left hand rule, the index finger denotes the direction of magnetic
field, the thumb denoted the direction of force and the middle finger denoted the direction of current.
other.
in
9. The relation between the direction of current and the direction of magnetic field is ________
@
SP
a) Same direction
b) Opposite direction
P U
c) Perpendicular
B
TE
d) Unrelated
Answer: c
C
H
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force developed in the conductor,
-T
el
eg
ra
m
the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each
other.
10. The relation between the direction of current and the direction of force is _________
a) Same direction
b) Opposite direction
c) Perpendicular
d) Unrelated
Answer: c
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force developed in the conductor,
the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each
other.
1. If the flow of electric current is parallel to the magnetic field, the force will be ______
a) Zero
b) Infinity
c) Maximum
d) Half the original value
Answer: a
Explanation: Force is a cross product. A cross product involves the sine of the angle between them. If two
quantities are parallel to each other, the angle between them is zero. Sin(0) is zero, hence force is zero.
2. The force existing between two infinite parallel conductors is inversely proportional to ________
a) Radius of the conductors
b) Current in one of the conductors
c) The product of the current in the two conductors
d) The distance between the two conductors
Answer: d
Explanation: When current is flowing in two different conductors, the force between the two conductors
is directly proportional to the product of the current in the two conductors and inversely proportional to
Jo
3. When the distance of operation between the two conductors increases, what happens to the force
SP
a) Increases
U
b) Decreases
B
TE
d) Becomes zero
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Answer: b
Explanation: When the distance of separation increases, the force between the two conductors decrease
because force between two conductors is inversely proportional to the distance of separation between
them.
4. Which of the following is used to determine the direction of magnetic field in a current carrying
conductor?
a) Left hand thumb rule
b) Right hand thumb rule
c) Right hand palm rule
d) Left hand palm rule
Answer: b
Explanation: The right hand thumb rule determines the direction of magnetic field in a current carrying
conductor. The rule states that when we align our right thumb in the direction of the current and curl our
fingers around it, the direction of our fingers is the direction of the magnetic field.
5. According to Flemming’s left hand rule, the index finger denotes ________
a) Direction of magnetic field
b) Direction of current
c) Direction of force
d) Direction of force as well as current
Answer: a
Explanation: According to Flemming’s left hand rule, the index finger denotes the direction of magnetic
field, the thumb denoted the direction of force and the middle finger denoted the direction of current.
6. According to Flemming’s left hand rule, the middle finger denotes _________
a) Direction of magnetic field
b) Direction of current
c) Direction of force
d) Direction of force as well as current
Answer: b
Explanation: According to Flemming’s left hand rule, the index finger denotes the direction of magnetic
field, the thumb denoted the direction of force and the middle finger denoted the direction of current.
Answer: c
@
Explanation: According to Flemming’s left hand rule, the index finger denotes the direction of magnetic
SP
field, the thumb denoted the direction of force and the middle finger denoted the direction of current.
P U
8. The relation between the direction of force and the direction of magnetic field in a current carrying
B
TE
conductor is?
a) Same direction
C
H
b) Opposite direction
-T
el
eg
ra
m
c) Perpendicular
d) Unrelated
Answer: c
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force developed in the conductor,
the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each
other.
9. The relation between the direction of current and the direction of magnetic field in a current carrying
conductor is?
a) Same direction
b) Opposite direction
c) Perpendicular
d) Unrelated
Answer: c
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force developed in the conductor,
the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each
other.
10. The relation between the direction of current and the direction of force in a current carrying conductor
is?
a) Same direction
b) Opposite direction
c) Perpendicular
d) Unrelated
Answer: c
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force developed in the conductor,
the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each
other.
Explanation: The Magnetic field of a solenoid increases when we insert a iron core because, iron is a
in
ferromagnetic material and ferromagnetic materials help in increasing the magnetic property.
@
SP
2. If a coil is wound around a steel core and electric current is passed through the coil, the steel core acts
as a?
P U
a) Electromagnet
B
TE
b) Permanent magnet
C
5. What happens to the magnetic field in the solenoid when the current increases?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains constant
d) Becomes zero
Answer: a
Explanation: The magnetic field of a solenoid is directly proportional to the current in it. Hence as the
current increases, the magnetic field also increases.
6. What happens to the magnetic field in the solenoid when the length of the solenoid increases?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains constant
d) Becomes zero
Answer: b
Jo
Explanation: The magnetic field of a solenoid is inversely proportional to the length. Hence as the length
in
Answer: d
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Explanation: There are no magnetic lines of force outside a solenoid, hence the magnetic field outside a
solenoid is zero.
8. The current in a solenoid is 30A, the number of turns per unit length is 500 turns per metre. Calculate
the magnetic field if the core is air.
a) 18.84T
b) 18.84mT
c) 1.84T
d) 1.84mT
Answer: b
Explanation: The magnetic field in a solenoid is given by:
B=μnI
Substituting the values in the given values in the equation, B=18.84mT.
9. The magnetic field of the solenoid is 18.84mT, the number of turns per unit length is 500 turns per
metre. Calculate the current if the core is air.
a) 300A
b) 30A
c) 3A
d) 300mA
Answer: b
Explanation: The magnetic field in a solenoid is given by:
B=μnI
Substituting the values in the given values in the equation, I=30A.
10. The magnetic field of the solenoid is 18.84mT, the current is 30A. Calculate the number of turns per
unit length if the core is air.
a) 1500 turns/m
b) 1000 turns/m
c) 500 turns /m
d) 2000 turns/m
Answer: c
Explanation: The magnetic field in a solenoid is given by:
B=μnI
Substituting the values in the given values in the equation n=500 turns/m
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
“Force on a Current Carrying Conductor”.
1. What is the expression for force in a current carrying conductor?
a) F=Kq1/r2
b) F=Kq2/r2
c) F=Kq1q2/r2
d) F=Kq1q2/r
Answer: c
Explanation: The force in a current carrying conductor is directly proportional to the product of the two
charges and inversely proportional to the square of the distance between them. Hence F=Kq1q2/r 2, where
K is the constant of proportionality.
b) 13.5kN
in
c) 1.35N
@
d) 1.35kN
SP
Answer: b
P
5. If the flow of electric current is parallel to the magnetic field, the force will be?
C
H
a) Zero
-T
el
eg
ra
m
b) Infinity
c) Maximum
d) Half the original value
Answer: a
Explanation: Force is a cross product. A cross product involves the sine of the angle between them. If two
quantities are parallel to each other, the angle between them is zero. Sin(0) is zero, hence force is zero.
6. The ratio of magnetic force to electric force on a charged particle getting undeflected in a field is
______
a) 1
b) 0
c) 2
d) 4
Answer: a
Explanation: When a charged particle is undeflected in a field, the magnitude of the magnetic force and
electric force acting on the particle is the same, hence the ratio is 1.
7. Weakest force in nature is __________
a) Electric force
b) Gravitational force
c) Weak force
d) Magnetic force
Answer: a
Explanation: Gravitational force is the weakest force in nature as it does not bind anything strongly with
its help.
8. According to Flemming’s left hand rule, the thumb denotes?
a) Direction of magnetic field
b) Direction of current
c) Direction of force
d) Direction of force as well as current
Answer: c
Explanation: According to Flemming’s left hand rule, the index finger denotes the direction of magnetic
field, the thumb denoted the direction of force and the middle finger denoted the direction of current.
9. The relation between the direction of force and the direction of magnetic field is __________
a) Same direction
b) Opposite direction
Jo
c) Perpendicular
in
d) Unrelated
@
Answer: c
SP
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force developed in the conductor,
P
the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each
U
B
other.
TE
10. The relation between the direction of current and the direction of force is ________
C
H
a) Same direction
-T
el
eg
ra
m
b) Opposite direction
c) Perpendicular
d) Unrelated
Answer: c
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force developed in the conductor,
the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each
other.
“Force Determination”.
1. Which, among the following, is the correct expression for force in a current carrying conductor?
a) F=Bi
b) F=B2il
c) F=Bil
d) F=Bl2
Answer: c
Explanation: The correct expression for force in a current carrying conductor in a magnetic field is F=Bil,
where B is the magnetic field, i is the current in the conductor and l is the length of the conductor.
2. When the current in the current carrying conductor increases, what happens to the force in the
conductor which is at right angles to the magnetic field?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) Becomes zero
Answer: a
Explanation: The force at right angles to the magnetic field of a current carrying conductor increases
when the current increases because it is directly proportional to the force.
3. When the length of the conductor in the current carrying conductor increases, what happens to the force
in the conductor which is at right angles to the magnetic field?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
Jo
d) Becomes zero
@
Answer: a
SP
Explanation: The force at right angles to the magnetic field of a current carrying conductor increases
P
when the length of the conductor increases because it is directly proportional to the force.
U
B
4. When the magnetic field intensity in the current carrying conductor increases, what happens to the
TE
a) Increases
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) Becomes zero
Answer: a
Explanation: The force at right angles to the magnetic field of a current carrying conductor increases
when the magnetic field intensity increases because it is directly proportional to the force.
5. The unit for force in a current carrying conductor is _________
a) Newton
b) Tesla
c) Weber/metre
d) Ampere
Answer: a
Explanation: The unit foe force in a current carrying conductor is newton because it is a force and the unit
of force is newton.
6. If the flow of electric current is parallel to the magnetic field, the force will be ________
a) Zero
b) Infinity
c) Maximum
d) Half the original value
Answer: a
Explanation: Force is a cross product. A cross product involves the sine of the angle between them. If two
quantities are parallel to each other, the angle between them is zero. Sin(0) is zero, hence force is zero.
7. The ratio of magnetic force to electric force on a charged particle getting undeflected in a field is
___________
a) 1
b) 0
c) 2
d) 4
Answer: a
Explanation: When a charged particle is undeflected in a field, the magnitude of the magnetic force and
electric force acting on the particle is the same, hence the ratio is 1.
8. If the intensity of magnetic field is 100T, the length of the conductor is 3m and the current in the
conductor is 10A, calculate the magnitude of force perpendicular to the electric field.
a) 300N
Jo
b) 30N
in
c) 30kN
@
d) 3kN
SP
Answer: d
P
Explanation: The formula for calculating the value of the force which is perpendicular to the electric field
U
B
is:
TE
F=Bil
C
10. The relation between the direction of force and the direction of magnetic field is _________
a) Same direction
b) Opposite direction
c) Perpendicular
d) Unrelated
Answer: c
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force developed in the conductor,
the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each
other.
b) Weak magnets
in
c) Temporary magnets
@
SP
d) Permanent magnets
Answer: c
P U
Explanation: Materials having low retentivity are temporary magnets because they can retain the
B
TE
7. When an electric current flows into the page, what is the direction of the magnetic field?
Jo
a) Clockwise
in
b) Anti-clockwise
@
c) Cannot be determined
SP
Answer: a
U
B
Explanation: when the current flows into the page, the magnetic field is clockwise because of the right
TE
hand thumb rule, we orient our thumb into the page and our fingers curl in the clockwise direction.
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
8. When an electric current flows out of the page, what is the direction of the magnetic field?
a) Clockwise
b) Anti-clockwise
c) Cannot be determined
d) Parallel to the current
Answer: b
Explanation: when the current flows out of the page, the magnetic field is anti-clockwise because of the
right hand thumb rule, we orient our thumb out of the page and our fingers curl in the anti-clockwise
direction.
9. Which of the following is used to determine the direction of magnetic field in a current carrying
conductor?
a) Left hand thumb rule
b) Right hand thumb rule
c) Right hand palm rule
d) Left hand palm rule
Answer: b
Explanation: The right hand thumb rule determines the direction of magnetic field in a current carrying
conductor. The rule states that when we align our right thumb in the direction of the current and curl our
fingers around it, the direction of our fingers is the direction of the magnetic field.
10. The relation between the direction of current and the direction of magnetic field is?
a) Same direction
b) Opposite direction
c) Perpendicular
d) Unrelated
Answer: c
Explanation: When a conductor carries a certain value of current, the force developed in the conductor,
the current in the conductor and the magnetic field in the conductor are mutually perpendicular to each
other.
a) Magnetic constant
@
b) Electric constant
SP
c) Electrostatic constant
P
d) Magnetostatic constant
U
Answer: a
B
TE
Explanation: The permeability of free space is also known as magnetic constant. The permittivity of free
C
5. A substance whose permeability is more than the permeability of free space is?
a) Diamagnetic
b) Paramagnetic
c) Ferromagnetic
d) Not a magnetic substance
Answer: b
Explanation: A paramagnetic material creates a magnetic field which is weakly attracted to that of the
external magnetic field. Hence its permeability is more than that of free space.
Jo
a) Henry
@
b) Henry-m
SP
c) Henry/m
P
d) Henry/m2
U
B
Answer: c
TE
Explanation: Magnetic permeability is the constant of proportionality between the magnetic flux density
C
and magnetic field strength of a given medium. Hence it has units henry/m.
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
7. Which, among the following, is a correct expression for ∫0.
a) ∫0=BH
b) ∫0=B/H
c) ∫0=H/B
d) ∫0=BH2
Answer: b
Explanation: Magnetic permeability is the constant of proportionality between the magnetic flux density
and magnetic field strength of a given medium. Hence ∫0=B/H.
8. Calculate the magnetic flux density if the magnetic field strength is 2A/m.
a) 4*pi/10-7T
b) 8*pi/10-7T
c) 10*pi/10-7T
d) 12*pi/10-7T
Answer: b
Explanation: We know that:
∫0=B/H
Substituting the value of H from the question, we get B= 8*pi/10 -7T.
9. Calculate the magnetic field strength if the magnetic flux density is 4*piT.
a) 10-7/16*pi2A/m
b) 10-7A/m
c) 107A/m
d) 10-7A
Answer: c
Explanation: We know that:
∫0=B/H
Substituting the value of B from the question, we get H = 107A/m.
10. Calculate the magnetic flux density if the magnetic field strength is 3A/m.
a) 4*pi/10-7T
b) 8*pi/10-7T
c) 10*pi/10-7T
d) 12*pi/10-7T
Answer: d
Explanation: We know that:
∫0=B/H
Substituting the value of H from the question, we get B= 12*pi/10 -7T.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
“Relative Permeability”
1. What is the unit for relative permeability?
a) H-m
b) H/m
c) H2/m
d) No unit
Answer: d
Explanation: Relative permeability is the ratio of permeability of the material to the permeability of free
space. Since it is a ratio, it does not have any units.
2. Which of the following expressions is correct with respect to relative permeability?
a) B=∫r∫0/H
b) B=∫r∫0H
c) B=∫r/∫0H
d) B=∫r∫0/H2
Answer: b
Explanation: For a non magnetic material: B=∫0H. Hence for a material having relative permeability ∫r,
B=∫r∫0H.
3. A substance whose relative permeability is less than the permeability of free space is?
a) Diamagnetic
b) Paramagnetic
c) Ferromagnetic
d) Not a magnetic substance
Answer: a
Explanation: A diamagnetic material creates a magnetic field opposing that of the external magnetic field
and it repels the external magnetic field. Hence its relative permeability is less than that of the free space.
4. A substance whose relative permeability is more than the permeability of free space is?
a) Diamagnetic
b) Paramagnetic
c) Ferromagnetic
d) Not a magnetic substance
Answer: b
Explanation: A paramagnetic material creates a magnetic field which is weakly attracted to that of the
external magnetic field. Hence its permeability is more than that of free space.
Jo
a) Greater than 1
@
b) Less than 1
SP
c) Equal to 1
d) Zero
P U
Answer: b
B
TE
Explanation: A diamagnetic material creates a magnetic field opposing that of the external magnetic field
C
and it repels the external magnetic field. Hence it has relative permeability less than 1.
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
6. Paramagnetic substances have relative permeability_____________
a) Greater than 1
b) Less than 1
c) Equal to 1
d) Zero
Answer: a
Explanation: A paramagnetic material creates a magnetic field which is weakly attracted to that of the
external magnetic field. Hence it has relative permeability greater than 1.
7. As the temperature increases up to the Curie temperature, the relative susceptibility of ferromagnetic
materials?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains constant
d) Becomes zero
Answer: a
Explanation: The susceptibility of ferromagnetic materials increases with the increase in temperature and
then it decreases when the temperature goes beyond the Curie temperature.
8. As the temperature increases beyond the Curie temperature, the relative susceptibility of ferromagnetic
materials?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains constant
d) Becomes zero
Answer: b
Explanation: The susceptibility of ferromagnetic materials increases with the increase in temperature and
then it decreases when the temperature goes beyond the curie temperature.
a) Diamagnetic
SP
b) Paramagnetic
P
c) Ferromagnetic
U
B
Answer: a
C
“Reluctance”.
1. Reciprocal of reluctance is __________
a) Permeance
b) Susceptibility
c) Resistance
d) Conductance
Answer: a
Explanation: The reciprocal of reactance is permeance. It is the ability of a material to allow the passage
of magnetic lines of flux.
2. Reactance is ________________ to the length of the material.
a) Directly proportional
b) Inversely proportional
c) Not related
d) Depends on the area of the material
Answer: a
Explanation: The formula for reluctance is:
S= l/∫0 ∫rA.
From the formula, we can see that reluctance is directly proportional to the length of the material.
material.
in
a) Increases
SP
b) Decreases
P
d) Becomes zero
TE
Answer: a
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Explanation: Reluctance is directly proportional to the length of the material hence as length increases,
reluctance also increases.
5. When the area of cross section of the material increases, what happens to reluctance?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains the same
d) Becomes zero
Answer: b
Explanation: Reluctance is inversely proportional to the area of cross section of the material hence as area
increases, reluctance decreases.
6. Unit of reluctance is?
a) AWb
b) A2/Wb
c) Wb/A
d) A/Wb
Answer: d
Explanation: Reluctance is the force per unit flux, hence its unit is A/Wb.
a) Increases
in
b) Decreases
@
SP
Answer: b
B
TE
Explanation: Reluctance is inversely proportional to the magnetic flux density, hence as magnetic flux
density increases, reluctance decreases.
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
10. Calculate the reluctance when the magnetomotive force is 10A turns and the flux is 5Wb.
a) 0.5A/Wb
b) 5A/Wb
c) 10A/Wb
d) 2A/Wb
Answer: d
Explanation: We know that:
F=phi*S
Substituting the given values from the question:
S=2A/Wb.
“Electromagnetic Induction”.
1. An E.M.F. can be induced by _________
a) Change in magnetic field
b) Change in the area of cross section
c) Change in angle between magnetic field and area
d) Change in magnetic field, area and angle
Answer: d
Explanation: It is the dot product of magnetic field vector and area vector.
emf=BAcos(theta), hence if either of the three, that is, magnetic field, area or angle changes, thee emf
will change.
2. What happens to the current in a coil while accelerating a magnet inside it?
a) Increases
b) Decreases
c) Remains constant
d) Reverses
Answer: a
Explanation: A chance in magnetic field induces an emf. When there is an emf, there has to be a current.
Hence, when the magnet is moved inside a coil, the current in it increases.
a) Current
in
b) Voltage
@
c) Electromagnetic induction
SP
d) EMF
P
Answer: c
U
Explanation: Motor effect is when a current carrying conductor in a magnetic field experiences a force,
B
TE
7. Find the length of a conductor which is moving with a velocity 0.4m/s in a magnetic field of 8T,
inducing an emf of 20V.
a) 50m
b) 5m
c) 6.25m
d) 0.5m
Answer: c
Explanation: The formula for induced emf is: emf=Blv. Substituting the values of B, emf and v from the
question, we get l=6.25m.
Jo
8. Find the strength of magnetic field in a conductor 0.5m long moving with a velocity of 10m/s, inducing
in
an emf of 20V.
@
a) 1T
SP
b) 2T
P
c) 3T
U
B
d) 4T
TE
Answer: d
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Explanation: The formula for induced emf is: emf=Blv. Substituting the values of l, emf and v from the
question, we get B=4T.
9. What does emf stand for?
a) Electronic magnetic force
b) Electromotive force
c) Electromagnetic force
d) Electromated force
Answer: b
Explanation: emf stands for electromotive force. It is the voltage developed by any source of electrical
energy.
10. What is emf?
a) Force
b) Voltage
c) Current
d) Flux
Answer: b
Explanation: Electromotive force is not actually a force. It is basically a voltage. It is the voltage
developed by any source of electrical energy.
the conductor in a magnetic field cuts the magnetic lies of flux, varying the flux per unit area, and hence
@
c) Faraday’s law
C
H
3. “The direction of an induced e.m.f. is always such that it tends to set up a current opposing the motion
or the change of flux responsible for inducing that e.m.f.”, this is the statement for?
a) Fleming’s left hand rule
b) Fleming’s right hand rule
c) Faraday’s law
d) Lenz’s law
Answer: d
Explanation: The above statement is that of Lenz’s law. It is used to determine the direction of the
induced emf.
4. According to Fleming’s right hand rule, the thumb points towards?
a) Current
b) E.M.F.
c) Motion of the conductor
d) Magnetic flux
Answer: c
Explanation: Fleming’s left hand rule stated that if the index finger points towards magnetic flux, the
thumb towards the motion of the conductor, then the middle finger points towards the induced emf.
5. According to Fleming’s right hand rule, the index finger points towards?
a) Current
b) E.M.F.
c) Motion of the conductor
d) Magnetic flux
Answer: d
Explanation: Fleming’s left hand rule stated that if the index finger points towards magnetic flux, the
thumb towards the motion of the conductor, then the middle finger points towards the induced emf.
6. According to Fleming’s right hand rule, the middle finger points towards?
a) Current
b) E.M.F.
c) Motion of the conductor
d) Magnetic flux
Answer: b
Jo
Explanation: Fleming’s left hand rule stated that if the index finger points towards magnetic flux, the
in
thumb towards the motion of the conductor, then the middle finger points towards the induced emf.
@
SP
7. The relation between direction of induced emf and direction of motion of the conductor is?
a) Parallel
P U
b) Equal
B
TE
c) Not related
d) Perpendicular
C
H
Answer: d
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Explanation: According to Fleming’s right hand rule, the induced emf, the motion of the conductor and
the magnetic flux are mutually perpendicular.
8. The relation between direction of induced emf and direction of magnetic flux is _______
a) Parallel
b) Equal
c) Not related
d) Perpendicular
Answer: d
Explanation: According to Fleming’s right hand rule, the induced emf, the motion of the conductor and
the magnetic flux are mutually perpendicular.
9. The relation between direction of magnetic flux and direction of motion of the conductor is _______
a) Parallel
b) Equal
c) Not related
d) Perpendicular
Answer: d
Explanation: According to Fleming’s right hand rule, the induced emf, the motion of the conductor and
the magnetic flux are mutually perpendicular.
b) emf=Bil
SP
c) emf=Blv
d) emf=B2v
P U
Answer: c
B
TE
Explanation: The formula for induced emf is: emf=Blv, where B is the magnetic field, l is the length of
C
the conductor and v is the velocity with which it is moving in the magnetic field.
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
2. Which, among the following, is the formula for induced emf?
a) e=d(phi)/dt
b) e=dt/d(phi)
c) e=t*phi
d) e=t2phi
Answer: a
Explanation: The formula foe induced emf is e=d(phi)/dt because the induced emf is the flux linkage per
unit time.
3. Find the length of a conductor which is moving with a velocity 0.4m/s in a magnetic field of 8T,
inducing an emf of 20V.
a) 50m
b) 5m
c) 6.25m
d) 0.5m
Answer: c
Explanation: The formula for induced emf is: emf=Blv. Substituting the values of B, emf and v from the
question, we get l=6.25m.
4. If a conductor 0.2m long moves with a velocity of 0.3m/s in a magnetic field of 5T, calculate the emf
induced.
a) 0.3V
b) 0.03V
c) 30V
d) 3V
Answer: a
Explanation: The formula for induced emf is: emf=Blv. Substituting the values of B, l and v from the
question, we get emf=0.3V.
5. What is emf?
a) Force
b) Voltage
c) Current
d) Flux
Answer: b
Explanation: Electromotive force is not actually a force. It is basically a voltage. It is the voltage
developed by any source of electrical energy.
Jo
in
@
SP
6. Find the strength of magnetic field in a conductor 0.5m long moving with a velocity of 10m/s, inducing
P
an emf of 20V.
U
B
a) 1T
TE
b) 2T
C
c) 3T
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
d) 4T
Answer: d
Explanation: The formula for induced emf is: emf=Blv. Substituting the values of l, emf and v from the
question, we get B=4T.
10. The total number of magnetic field lines passing through an area is termed as _______
a) Voltage
b) EMF
c) Magnetic flux
d) Magnetic flux density
Jo
Answer: b
in
Explanation: The number of magnetic flux lines per unit area is the magnetic flux, because flux is the
@
3. If a conductor 0.2m long moves with a velocity of 0.3m/s in a magnetic field of 5T, calculate the emf
induced.
a) 0.3V
b) 0.03V
c) 30V
d) 3V
Answer: a
Explanation: The formula for induced emf is: emf=Blv. Substituting the values of B, l and v from the
question, we get emf=0.3V.
4. Find the length of a conductor which is moving with a velocity 0.4m/s in a magnetic field of 8T,
inducing an emf of 20V.
a) 50m
Jo
b) 5m
in
c) 6.25m
@
d) 0.5m
SP
Answer: c
P
Explanation: The formula for induced emf is: emf=Blv. Substituting the values of B, emf and v from the
U
5. Find the strength of magnetic field in a conductor 0.5m long moving with a velocity of 10m/s, inducing
C
an emf of 20V.
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
a) 1T
b) 2T
c) 3T
d) 4T
Answer: d
Explanation: The formula for induced emf is: emf=Blv. Substituting the values of l, emf and v from the
question, we get B=4T.
6. What is emf?
a) Force
b) Voltage
c) Current
d) Flux
Answer: b
Explanation: Electromotive force is not actually a force. It is basically a voltage. It is the voltage
developed by any source of electrical energy.
7. An E.M.F. can be induced by _________
a) Change in magnetic field
b) Change in the area of cross section
c) Change in angle between magnetic field and area
d) Change in magnetic field, area and angle
Answer: d
Explanation: The dot product of magnetic field vector and area vector.
emf=BAcos(theta), hence if either of the three, that is, magnetic field, area or angle changes, thee emf
will change.
8. The emf induced in a coil having N turns is?
a) e=phi/t
b) e=N*phi/t
c) e=N*phi*t
d) e=N2*phi*t
Answer: b
Explanation: The emf induced in a coil having N turns is, e=N*phi/t. This is because, the emf in a single
coil is the flux linkage per unit time, that is, phi/t. Hence the flux induced in N turns is N*phi/t.
9. The total number of magnetic field lines passing through an area is termed as ________
a) Voltage
Jo
b) EMF
in
c) Magnetic flux
@
Answer: b
P
Explanation: The number of magnetic flux lines per unit area is the magnetic flux, because flux is the
U
B
a) Current
-T
el
eg
ra
m
b) Voltage
c) Electromagnetic induction
d) EMF
Answer: c
Explanation: Motor effect is when a current carrying conductor in a magnetic field experiences a force,
hence its consequence is electromagnetic induction.
2. What is the power in the magnetic field if the current in a coil has a constant inductance of L henrys
grows at a uniform rate?
a) LI/2t
b) LI2/2t
c) L/2It
d) L/2I2t
Answer: b
Explanation: The average current is I/2. The e.m.f. induced in the coil is LI/t V. Power= VI, hence the
average power= I/2*LI/t.
3. What is the energy stored in the magnetic field if the current in a coil has a constant inductance of L
henrys grows at a uniform rate?
a) LI/2
b) LI2/2
Jo
c) L/2I
in
d) L/2I2
@
Answer: b
SP
Explanation: The average current is I/2. The e.m.f. induced in the coil is LI/t V. Power= VI, hence the
P
4. Find the average current in an inductor if the total current in the inductor is 26A.
C
a) 10A
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
b) 26A
c) 13A
d) 5A
Answer: c
Explanation: Average current= I/2.
Substituting the value of I from the equation, average current= 13A.
5. Calculate the power in an inductive circuit if the inductance is 10H, the current flowing in the inductor
is 2A in 4s.
a) 50W
b) 4W
c) 5W
d) 10W
Answer: c
Explanation: The expression for power in an inductive circuit is:
P= LI2/2
Substituting the values from the given question, we get P=5W.
6. Calculate the value of stored energy in an inductor if the value of inductance is 20H and 4A of current
flows through it.
a) 220J
b) 150J
c) 190J
d) 160J
Answer: d
Explanation: The expression for energy in an inductor is:
W= LI2/2t
Substituting the values from the given question, we get W= 160J.
7. Calculate the emf induced in an inductor if the inductance is 10H and the current is 2A in 4s.
a) 2.5V
b) 1.5V
c) 3.5V
d) 5V
Answer: a
Explanation: The expression for emf in an inductive circuit is:
emf= LI/2t
Substituting the values from the given question, we get emf= 2.5V.
Jo
in
8. Calculate the value of emf in an inductor if the value of inductance is 15H and an average current of 5A
@
a) 15V
P
b) 7.5V
U
B
c) 10V
TE
d) 5.5V
C
Answer: b
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Explanation: The expression for emf in an inductive circuit is:
emf= LI/2t, where I/2 is the average current.
Substituting the values from the given question, we get emf= 2.5V.
9. Calculate the current in an inductor if the energy stored is 160J and the inductance is 20H.
a) 1A
b) 2A
c) 3A
d) 4A
Answer: d
Explanation: The expression for energy in an inductor is:
W= LI2/2t
Substituting the values from the given question, we get I=4A.
10. Find the time taken for the current in an inductor to change to 2A from 0A if the power in the inductor
is 5W. The value of inductance is 10H.
a) 1s
b) 2s
c) 3s
d) 4s
Answer: d
Explanation: The expression for power in an inductive circuit is:
P= LI2/2
Substituting the values from the given question, we get t=4s.
c) Ampere-turn/weber
in
d) Ampere/meter
@
Answer: B
SP
P
a) Resistance
TE
b) Resistivity
C
c) Conductivity
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
d) Conductance
Answer: C
4. Conductance is analogous to
a) Permeance
b) Reluctance
c) Flux
d) Inductance
Answer: A
5. Reciprocal of reluctance is
a) Reluctivity
b) Permeance
c) Permeability
d) Susceptibility
Answer: B
Answer: D
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
OBJECTIVE
TYPE
QUESTIONS
ELECTRICAL
ENGINEERING
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans : B
Q.2 A salient pole synchronous motor is running at no load. Its field current is switched off.
The motor will
(A) come to stop.
(B) continue to run at synchronous speed.
(C) continue to run at a speed slightly more than the synchronous speed.
(D) continue to run at a speed slightly less than the synchronous speed.
Ans: B
Q.3 The d.c. series motor should always be started with load because
Ans: A
Jo
Q.4 The frequency of the rotor current in a 3 phase 50 Hz, 4 pole induction motor at full
in
Ans: C
TE
C
H
1
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: A
Ans: A
Ans: A
Q.8 When a synchronous motor is running at synchronous speed, the damper winding
produces
(A) damping torque.
(B) eddy current torque.
(C) torque aiding the developed torque.
(D) no torque.
Ans: D
Q.9 If a transformer primary is energised from a square wave voltage source, its output
Jo
voltage will be
in
Ans: A
U
B
TE
C
H
2
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(A) I a . (B) I a2 .
1 1
(C) . (D) .
Ia I a2
Ans: B
Q.11 In a 3 – phase induction motor running at slip ‘s’ the mechanical power developed
in terms of air gap power Pg is
Pg
(A) (s − 1)Pg . (B)
(1 − s ) .
(C) (1 − s )Pg . (D) s ⋅ Pg .
Ans: C
(C) is proportional to r2 .
Ans: B
Ans: B
P
U
B
TE
C
H
3
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.15 The maximum power in cylindrical and salient pole machines is obtained respectively
at load angles of
Ans: D
Q.18 The relative speed between the magnetic fields of stator and rotor under steady state
operation is zero for a
(A) dc machine. (B) 3 phase induction machine.
(C) synchronous machine. (D) single phase induction machine.
Ans: all options are correct
Q.19 The current from the stator of an alternator is taken out to the external load circuit
through
(A) slip rings. (B) commutator segments.
(C) solid connections. (D) carbon brushes.
Ans: C
Jo
Q.20 A motor which can conveniently be operated at lagging as well as leading power
in
factors is the
@
(A) squirrel cage induction motor. (B) wound rotor induction motor.
SP
Ans: C
TE
C
H
4
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: B
Ans: C
Q.24 Out of the following methods of heating the one which is independent of supply
frequency is
(A) electric arc heating (B) induction heating
(C) electric resistance heating (D) dielectric heating
Ans: C
Q.25 A two-winding single phase transformer has a voltage regulation of 4.5% at full-load
and unity power-factor. At full-load and 0.80 power-factor lagging load the voltage
regulation will be
(A) 4.5%. (B) less than 4.5%.
(C) more than 4.5%. (D) 4.5% or more than 4.5%.
Jo
in
Ans: C
@
% R = Vr cos Φ + Vx sin Φ
SP
= Vr
P
∴
TE
C
H
5
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Q.26 In a dc shunt motor the terminal voltage is halved while the torque is kept constant.
The resulting approximate variation in speed ' ' ' I a ' will be
Ans: B
N α V – IaR or N α Eb
T α Ia Φ , Φ α Ia
∴ T α Ia2
Q.27 A balanced three-phase, 50 Hz voltage is applied to a 3 phase, 4 pole, induction
motor. When the motor is delivering rated output, the slip is found to be 0.05. The
speed of the rotor m.m.f. relative to the rotor structure is
(A) 1500 r.p.m. (B) 1425 r.p.m.
(C) 25 r.p.m. (D) 75 r.p.m.
Ans: D
Ans: B
P U
B
Over excitation gives leading power factor and under excitation gives lagging p.f .
TE
C
H
6
-T
el
eg
ra
m
ωis
anddoubled
constant
armature
while
and
butcurrent www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: D
Ans: A
The sheath in underground cable is provided to give mechanical strength.
Ans: D
P U
B
7
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.33 A 1:5 step-up transformer has 120V across the primary and 600 ohms resistance
across the secondary. Assuming 100% efficiency, the primary current equals
(A) 0.2 Amp. (B) 5 Amps.
(C) 10 Amps. (D) 20 Amps.
Ans: A
I1= V1 /R1 = 120/600 = 0.2 (η = 100%, losses are zero ∴V1 = VR = I1R1)
Q.34 A dc shunt generator has a speed of 800 rpm when delivering 20 A to the load at the
terminal voltage of 220V. If the same machine is run as a motor it takes a line
current of 20A from 220V supply. The speed of the machine as a motor will be
(A) 800 rpm. (B) more than 800 rpm.
(C) less than 800 rpm. (D) both higher or lower than 800 rpm.
Ans: C
Ng= Eg (60A / Φpz) Eg = V + Ia Ra ; in generator
Nm= Eb (60A / Φpz) Eb = V - Ia Ra ; in motor
Eg > E b for same terminal voltage
Therefore, Ng > N m
Q.35 A 50 Hz, 3-phase induction motor has a full load speed of 1440 r.p.m. The number of
poles of the motor are
(A) 4. (B) 6.
(C) 12. (D) 8.
Ans: A
N= Ns (1-S) = NS –NS x S
1440 = Ns (1-S)
Ns = 1440 / (1-S)
Ns = (120 f/ p) = 120 x 50/p = 6000 p
Jo
8
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: B
To make single phase motor self start. We split the phases at 90 degree. Hence, motor
behaves like a two phase motor.
Q.38 A synchro has
(A) a 3-phase winding on rotor and a single-phase winding on stator.
(B) a 3-phase winding on stator and a commutator winding on rotor.
(C) a 3-phase winding on stator and a single-phase winding on rotor.
(D) a single-phase winding on stator and a commutator winding on rotor.
Ans: C
Synchros : The basic synchro unit called a synchro transmitter. It’s construction
similar to that of a Three phase alternator.
Q.39 As the voltage of transmission increases, the volume of conductor
Jo
Ans: C
P
9
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
measurement.
in
Q.44 Slip of the induction machine is 0.02 and the stator supply frequency is 50 Hz.
@
SP
10
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: C
Given : s = 0.02 ; f = 50 Hz
Therefore, frequency of rotor induced emf = s f
= 0.02 x 50 = 1.0 Hz
Q.45 A 4 pole lap wound dc shunt motor rotates at the speed of 1500 rpm, has a flux of 0.4
mWb and the total number of conductors are 1000. What is the value of emf?
(A) 100 Volts. (B) 0.1 Volts.
(C) 1 Volts. (D) 10 Volts.
Ans: D
Given N = 1500 rpm, Φ = 0.4 mWb, Z = 1000, P = 4, & A= 4
Therefore, Eb = NΦPZ / 60 A
= 1500 x 0.4 x 4 x 1000 x 10-3 / 60 x 4
= 60/6 = 10 volts
Q.46 The synchronous reactance of the synchronous machine is ______________.
(A) Ratio between open circuit voltage and short circuit current at constant field
current
(B) Ratio between short circuit voltage and open circuit current at constant field
current
(C) Ratio between open circuit voltage and short circuit current at different field
current
(D) Ratio between short circuit voltage and open circuit current at different field
current
Ans. A
The Synchronous reactance of a synchronous machine is a total steady state reactance,
presented to applied voltage, when rotor is running synchronously without excitation.
Therefore , XS = Ef / IS
= Emf of OC for same If / short circuit current
Q.47 A 3 stack stepper motor with 12 numbers of rotor teeth has a step angle of
____________.
Jo
Ans. D
P U
Given m = 3, Nr = 12
B
11
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.50 Inverse definite minimum time lag relay is also called ___________
(A) pilot relay. (B) differential relay.
(C) over current relay. (D) directional overcurrent relay.
Ans: B
Inverse definite minimum time lag relay characteristic is inverse but minimum time is
fixed. The operating time is inversely proportional to the magnitude of actuating
quantity.
12
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: D
Polarity test is required for parallel operation of transformers to know the direction of
current flow in secondary circuit w.r.t primary circuit.
Q.53 The short-circuit ratio of a typical synchronous machine is obtained from the OCC
and SCC curves of Fig.2 as
oa
(A)
ob
oa ′
(B)
ob ′
oa
(C)
ob ′
oc ′
(D)
ob
Ans: B
As shown in SCC curve the ratio of two field currents
Ans: A
Universal motor has same characteristics as DC series motor and also known as an a.c
series motor.
Q. 55 The rotor frequency for a 3 phase 1000 RPM 6 pole induction motor with a slip of
0.04 is________Hz
(A) 8 (B) 4
(C) 6 (D) 2
Ans: D
Jo
= 10006/120
SP
= 50 Hz
P
= 2.0 Hz
B
TE
C
H
13
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: C
If torque is zero then speed may exceed up to infinite, that is dangerous for machine
and machine can be damaged.
N α 1/ T
Q.57 In the heating process of the ________type a simple method of temperature control is
possible by means of a special alloy which loses its magnetic properties at a particular
high temperature and regains them when cooled to a temperature below this value.
(A) Indirect induction over (B) core type induction furnace
(C) coreless induction furnace (D) high frequency eddy current
Ans: D
Magnetic property of alloy changes with change of the temperature and
Heat is produced due to eddy current = i2R and i α f2
Q.58 In order to reduce the harmful effects of harmonics on the A.C. side of a high voltage
D.C. transmission system ______are provided.
(A) synchronous condensers (B) shunt capacitors
(C) shunt filters (D) static compensators
Ans: C
Xc= 1/ ωc
Q.59 An a.c. tachometer is just a ________with one phase excited from the carrier
frequency.
(A) two-phase A.C. servomotor (B) two-phase induction motor
Jo
Ans: D
SP
This is a special purpose machine whose stator coil can be energized by electronically
P U
switched current.
B
TE
C
H
14
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.60 The torque, in a _____________is proportional to the square of the armature current
(A) DC shunt motor (B) stepper motor
(C) 2-phase servomotor (D) DC series motor
Ans: D
Ta α Φ.Ia and Φ α Ia ; therefore Ta α Ia2
Q.61 The synchronous speed for a 3 phase 6-pole induction motor is 1200 rpm. If the
number of poles is now reduced to 4 with the frequency remaining constant, the rotor
speed with a slip of 5% will be _________.
(A) 1690 rpm (B) 1750 rpm
(C) 1500 rpm (D) 1710 rpm
Ans: D
Given : Ns1 =1200 , P1= 6,
P2 = 4, s = 0.05,
Frequency f = NsP/120
= 1206/120 = 60 Hz
rotor frequency f/ = s.f = 0.05 60 = 3.0 Hz
Now, Ns2 = 120 60 /4 = 1800 and Ns – N = 120 f / P2
Therefore, N=Ns- 120 f / P2 = 1800-1200.0560/4 = 1800-90 = 1710
Q.62 The eddy current loss in an a-c electric motor is 100 watts at 50 Hz. Its loss at 100
Hz will be
(A) 25 watts (B) 59 watts
(C) 100 watts (D) 400 watts
Ans: D
Eddy current losses α f2
New loss α (2f)2
New loss α 4f2
∴ 4 times
Q.63 The maximum power for a given excitation in a synchronous motor is developed
when the power angle is equal to
(A) 0o (B) 45o
Jo
in
Ans: A
SP
P = VI cosΦ
P U
Pmax = VI
B
∴Φ = 00
TE
C
H
15
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
4 2
1 1
@
8 16
P
Ans: B
U
B
16
-T
el
eg
ra
m
/Φ
or N, so E
initially
less speed is less. www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.69 A 3-phase, 400 votts, 50 Hz, 100 KW, 4 pole squirrel cage induction motor with a
rated slip of 2% will have a rotor speed of
(A) 1500 rpm (B) 1470 rpm
(C) 1530 rpm (D) 1570 rpm
Ans: B
N = NS (1-S) and NS =120 f / p
=120 x 50 /4 = 1500 rpm
∴N= 1500 (1-0.02) =1470 rpm
Q.70 If the phase angle of the voltage coil of a directional relay is 50 o , the maximum
torque angle of the relay is
(A) 130o (B) 100o
(C) 50 o (D) 25o
Ans: C
Torque α Power
Power α Voltage
Therefore, It has same angle as ‘V’ has.
Q.71 The voltage at the two ends of a transmission line are 132 KV and its reactance is
40 ohm. The Capacity of the line is
(A) 435.6 MW (B) 217.8 MW
(C) 251.5 MW (D) 500 MW
Ans: A
Line capacity is determined by power of line
P = (V2/R) or (V2/Z) when cos Φ =1
Q.72 A 220/440 V, 50 Hz, 5 KVA, single phase transformer operates on 220V, 40Hz
supply with secondary winding open circuited. Then
(C) Eddy current loss remains the same but hysteresis loss increases.
Jo
(D) Eddy current loss increases but hysteresis loss remains the same.
in
Ans: A
@
SP
Wh = khfBm e = ke f m
Therefore, hysteresis and eddy current losses will be decreased when frequency
P U
decreases.
B
TE
C
H
17
-T
el
eg
ra
m
2.B
kand
1.6 W www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.73 A synchronous motor is operating on no-load at unity power factor. If the field
current is increased, power factor will become
(A) Leading & current will decrease
(B) Lagging & current will increase.
(C) Lagging & current will decrease.
(D) Leading & current will increase.
Ans: A
Initially synchronous motor is operating at no load and unity power factor. When
field current increases, the excitation will increase. Therefore, p.f will be leading and
current will be I CosΦ < I
Q.74 A d.c. shunt motor runs at no load speed of 1140 r.p.m. At full load, armature reaction
weakens the main flux by 5% whereas the armature circuit voltage drops by 10%. The
motor full load speed in r.p.m. is
(A) 1080 (B) 1203
(C) 1000 (D) 1200
Ans: A
N2 / N1 =Eb2 /Eb1 x Φ 1 / Φ2 ; Φ2 = 0.95Φ 1 ; Eb2 = 0.9Eb1
∴ N2 /1140 = 0.9 x 1/0.95
N2 = 1080
Q.75 The introduction of interpoles in between the main pole improves the performance of
d.c. machines, because
(A) The interpole produces additional flux to augment the developed torque.
(B) The flux waveform is improved with reduction in harmonics.
(C) The inequality of air flux on the top and bottom halves of armature is
removed.
(D) A counter e.m.f. is induced in the coil undergoing commutation.
Ans: D
Jo
Q.76 The rotor power output of a 3-phase induction motor is 15 KW and corresponding slip
@
18
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: B
Rotor copper losses = rotor input- rotor output
and output = (1-s) input
∴ Input = output/(1-s) = 15000 /1-0.04 = 15625
∴ loss = 15625 -1500 = 625 watt
Q.77 The direction of rotation of hysteresis motor is reversed by
(A) Shift shaded pole with respect to main pole
(B) Reversing supply lead
(C) Either A or B
(D) Neither A nor B
Ans: A
This motor used single phase, 50Hz supply and stator has two windings. These are
connected continuously from starting to running.
Q.78 A 1.8°step, 4-phase stepper motor has a total of 40 teeth on 8 pole of stator. The
number of rotor teeth for their rotor will be
(A) 40 (B) 50
(C) 100 (D) 80
Ans: B
Step angle ‘β’ = NS – Nr / NS Nr x 360
∴ 1-8 = -40 + Nr/40 Nr x 3600
Nr = 50
Q.79 Low head plants generally use
(A) Pelton Turbines (B) Francis Turbine
(C) Pelton or Francis Turbine (D) Kaplan Turbines
Ans: A
In the hysterisis motor, the direction of rotation can be reversed by shifting the
shaded pole region with respect to main pole. But not by changing supply lead
because it has ac supply.
Jo
Q.80 The charging reactance of 50 Km length of line is 1500Ω. The charging reactance for
in
19
-T
el
eg
ra
m
0
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: B
Characteristic reactance per km = 1500/50 = 30 ohms
∴ Characteristic reactance per 100km = 30 x 100 = 3000 ohms
Q.81 Electric ovens using heating elements of _______________ can produce temperature
upto 3000°C.
(A) Nickel (B) Graphite
(C) Chromium (D) Iron
Ans: C
Chromium has high melting point.
Ans: A
Transformers having higher kVA rating will share more load.
Q.84 As compared to shunt and compound DC motors, the series DC motor will have the
highest torque because of its comparatively ____________ at the start.
(A) Lower armature resistance. (B) Stronger series field.
(C) Fewer series turns. (D) Larger armature current.
Ans: D
T α Φ Ia
Φ α Ia
Jo
T α Ia 2
in
Q.85 A 400kW, 3-phase, 440V, 50Hz induction motor has a speed of 950 r.p.m. on full-
@
load. The machine has 6 poles. The slip of the machine will be _______________.
SP
P
20
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Ans: D
N = Ns (1-S)
950 = 120 x 50 (1-S)/6
S = 0.05
Q.86 Reduction in the capacitance of a capacitor-start motor, results in reduced
(A) Noise. (B) Speed.
(C) Starting torque. (D) Armature reaction.
Ans: C
Reduction in the capacitance reduces starting voltage, which results in reduced
starting torque.
Q.87 Regenerative braking
(A) Can be used for stopping a motor.
(B) Cannot be easily applied to DC series motors.
(C) Can be easily applied to DC shunt motors
(D) Cannot be used when motor load has overhauling characteristics.
Ans: B
Because reversal of Ia would also mean reversal of field and hence of Eb
Q.88 At present level of technology, which of the following method of generating electric
power from sea is most advantageous?
(A) Tidal power. (B) Ocean thermal energy conversion
(C) Ocean currents. (D) Wave power.
Ans: A
At present level of technology, tidal power for generating electric power from sea
is most advantageous because of constant availability of tidal power.
Q.89 If the field circuits of an unloaded salient pole synchronous motor gets suddenly open
circuited, then
(A) The motor stops.
(B) It continues to run at the same speed.
Jo
Ans: B
The motor continues to run at the same speed because synchronous motor speed
P U
21
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: B
Disc type electrodes are used for electric resistance seam welding.
Q.91 For LV applications (below 1 kV), ______________ cables are used.
(A) Paper insulated. (B) Plastic.
(C) Single core cables. (D) Oil filled.
Ans: C
For low voltage applications single core cables are suitable.
Ans: B
The primary input current under no load conditions has to supply (i) iron losses in
the core i.e hysteresis loss and eddy current loss (ii) a very small amount of Cu loss
in the primary (there being no Cu loss in secondary as it is open)
Q.93 A transformer operates most efficiently at 3/4th full load. Its iron (PI) and copper
loss (PCu) are related as:
(A) PI PCu = 16 9 (B) PI PCu = 4 3
Ans: D
Jo
in
If PCu is the Cu loss at full load, its value at 75% of full load is
@
At maximum efficiency, it equals the iron loss PI which remains constant through
P U
22
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
PI = 9/16 PCu
Or PI / PCu = 9/16
Ans: C
Since reluctance on the q axis is higher, owing to the larger air gap, hence xq < xd
Ans: A
Thinner the laminations, greater is the resistance offered to the induced e.m.f.,
smaller the current and hence lesser the I2R loss in the core.
Ans: A
Mechanical Power developed by the rotor (Pm) or gross power developed by rotor
(Pg)
= rotor input –rotor Cu losses
= (3I/2 R2/ / S) -(3I/2 R2/ )
= 3I/2 R2/ (1/ S -1)
Jo
23
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: A
The rotor revolves synchronously because the rotor poles magnetically lock up with
the revolving stator poles of opposite polarity
Ans: D
Temperature of resistance furnaces can be controlled by changing either applied
voltage or by number of heating elements or by circuit configuration.
Ans: B
The line trap unit employed in carrier current relaying offers high impedance to
carrier frequency signal.
Because carrier frequency range is 35 km – 500 kHz
XL = 2 Π f l
Where f increases XL will also increases
Ans: B
in
@
R α 1/V
SP
Therefore R α 1/V
B
TE
C
H
24
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
NUMERICALS
Q.1 Calculate the voltage regulation of a transformer in which ohmic drop is 2% and
the reactance drop in 5% of the voltage at 0.8 lagging power factor. (7)
Ans: The expression for % voltage regulation is
V 20 − V 2 ,
% voltage regulation= X …(1)
V 2 , fl
where V2 fl = rated secondary voltage while supplying full load at a specified power
factor.
I ( R cos X sin )
% Voltage regulation = X 100
V2
= 100 +
_________
…(2)
V V
The quantities within the brackets are given in the problem as 2%( percent ohmic
drop) and 5% (percent reactance drop). Also
plus sign in Equation (2) is because of the lagging nature of current.
Now
= (1.6 + 3.0)%
in
@
= 4.6%
SP
25
-T
el
eg
ra
m
IR
.2+
fl φ
= 0 cos
1is0 the φ 1power
lagging IX φfactorsin
2.100 www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
The (2)
angle.
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
c)
Fig. C1 shows the flux density wave in the air gap and the conductor current
distribution in the developed armature for one pole-pair. The force on the
conductors is unidirectional. Each conductor, as it moves around with the
armature, experiences a force whose time variation is a replica of the flux
density(B).
Therefore, the average conductor force
f c ( av ) = Bav l I c (1)
where Bav = average flux density over a pole.
l = active conductor length, and I c =conductor current
Total force
F = zf c ( av ) = Bav I c lz , where z=total number of conductors (2)
This force (and therefore torque) is constant because both the flux density wave and
current distribution are fixed in space at all times. Now the torque developed is
T = B I lzr (3)
where r is the mean air gap radius
The flux/pole can be expressed as
Jo
in
Bav p l (4)
@
SP
2π r
where τ p = polepitch =
P U
P
B
TE
C
H
26
-T
el
eg
ra
m
φ
=
ductors
conductor τ current
fluxdensity
___________
av c B (I www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
so
2π r
φ = B av l
P
or
P 1
Bav = X (5)
2 rl
zP
T =K I where K a = =constant (6)
2π A
Q.3 A 230 V d.c. shunt motor with constant field drives a load whose torque is
proportional to the speed. When running at 750 rpm it takes 30 A. Find the speed
at which it will run if a 10 ohm resistance is connected in series with the armature.
The armature resistance may be neglected. (7)
Ra
230 V
Jo
in
Ia
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
27
-T
el
eg
ra
m
aπ a
Iφ
⇒
_____________ φπ www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
T= K a I a
T1 K a 1I a 1 Ia
Now = = 1 (1)
T2 K a 2Ia 2 I a2
T1 N1 I a1
= = from equation (1) (2)
T2 N 2 I a 2
N2
And I a 2 = I a1 (3)
N1
Ea1 VT 0 K N
Back emf = = a 1
Ea2 VT − I a2 R Ka N2
230 − I a 2 X 10 N 2
Or =
230 N1
N
230 − 10 X I a1 X N2
1 N2
Or =
230 N1
N
230 −10 X 30 X N2
Jo
1 N2
Or =
in
230 N1
@
This gives
SP
P
N2
( 230 + 300) = 230
U
N1
B
TE
C
H
28
-T
el
eg
ra
m
φ
=
−nd φ
aand www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Therefore
230
N 2 = N1
530
230
= 750 X
530
= 326rpm
Q.4 The power input to a 500 V, 50 Hz, 6 pole 3 phase squirrel cage induction motor
running at 975 rpm is 40 KW. The stator losses are 1 KW and the friction and
windage losses are 2 KW. Calculate
120 f 50
Ans: Synchronous speed(N s )= = 120 X = 1000RPM
P 6
ωs − ωm 2π X 1000 − 2π X 975 25
Slip = = = = 0.025
ωs 2π X 1000 1000
Power across air gap(PG) = power input - stator copper loss
Thus PG=40KW-1KW=39KW
= (38.025-2.000)KW
=36.025KW
36.025
Efficiency = =
Jo
Power input
in
≈ 90%
@
Note: Assume that the core loss is included in friction and windage loss and the total
SP
29
-T
el
eg
ra
m
40
Net Mech output www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.5 A 120V, 60Hz, 1/4hp universal motor runs at 2000 rpm and takes 0.6A when
connected to a 120V d.c. source. Determine the speed, torque and power factor of the
motor when it is connected to a 120V, 60 Hz, supply and is loaded to take 0.6A (rms)
of current. The resistance and inductance measured at the terminals of the motor are
20 ohm and 0.25H respectively. (7)
Ans: Universal Motor: (A) When connected to a d.c. source it runs at 2000RPM and
takes 0.6A [Fig F1]
120V
DC Source b
1 n2 Z P Kn ac
E a ( ac ) RM S *
2 60 A 2
Rmotor=20 Ω
Lmotor=0.25H
Xmotor=2 π X60X0.25
Or, Xmotor=94.25 Ω
Jo
Ea( ac ) + Ia R = V 2 − (Ia X )2
SP
P
30
-T
el
eg
ra
m
φ
=
Ω
E
0.6A
20 = == www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Assume, same flux for the same current (i.e. 0.6 Adc and 0 .6 rm s
Therefore
93.84
nac = 2000 X = 1737.78rpm
108
Ea( ac ) + Ia R 93.84 +12
Power factor, cosφ = = = 0.88 lag
V 120
Pmech = Ea( ac ) I a = 93.84 X 0.6 = 56.3W
Pmech 56.3
Tdev = = = 0.309N − m
ωm 2π X
1737.78
60
Q.6 For a 4 KVA, 200/400 V, 50 Hz, 1 – phase transformer, calculate the efficiency,
voltage at the secondary terminals and primary input current when supplying a full
– load secondary current at 0.8 lagging power factor.
The following are the test results:
Open circuit with 200 V applied to the L.V. side: 0.8 A, 70 W. Short circuit with
20 V applied to the H.V. side: 10 A, 60 W. (14)
Ans: The transformer is supplying full-load secondary current at 0.8 lagging power
factor
4 KVA 4000VA
Full load secondary current = = = 10 A
400V 400V
From the open circuit test, core losses = 70W
From the S.C. test, full load copper losses = 60W
Jo
(a) Efficiency
in
@
V2 I 2 cos θ
SP
η = X 100
V2 I 2 cos θ + core losses + full load copper losses
P
U
B
TE
C
H
31
-T
el
eg
ra
m
A
) www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
4000 X 0.8
= X 100
4000 X 0.8 + 70 + 60
3200
= X 100 = 96.1%
3300
(b) voltage at the secondary terminals is determined as follows with the help of
equivalent circuit of Fig A3
eq
Xeq
200V E1 E2
V1
I2
a X e/
θ E 1 = V2 a I2
a R e/
0.6
Equt. Resistance referred to primary Re′ = a 2 R = = 0.15 Ω
SP
4
P U
1.91
Equt. reactance referred to primary X e′ = a 2 X = ≈ 0.48Ω
B
4
TE
C
H
32
-T
el
eg
ra
m
R www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.7 Draw the per phase approximate equivalent circuit of a 3 – phase induction motor
at slip ‘s’ and derive the expression for electromagnetic torque developed by the
motor. Derive also the condition for maximum torque and the expression for the
maximum torque. (14)
Ans:
R1 X1 X’2
a
I1 I0 I’2
V
Xm R
R1
a
Fig B3 shows the per-phase exact equivalent circuit of a 3-phase induction motor. The
power crossing the terminals ’ab’ in Fig B3 is the electrical power input per phase
minus the stator copper loss and iron loss; Thus it is the power that is transferred from
the stator to the rotor via the air gap. It is also known as the power across the air gap.
3(I 2′ ) R 2′
2
s
in
(1 - s) s m = (1 – s) PG
P U
B
TE
C
H
33
-T
el
eg
ra
m
’2ω
−=
T P www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
3 ( I 2′ ) R2′
2
PG
or T = =
ωs sωs
dT
The condition (that is, slip) for maximum torque is obtained by equating to zero.
ds
With the approximation of I1 = I 2′ in Fig. B3 or using the approximate equivalent
circuit.
V
I 2′ = 1/ 2
( R1 + R2 / s ) + ( X 1 + X 2 )
2
3( I2′ ) R2′
2
′ 2
3RV
T= = 2
(I)
sωs sωs ( R1 + R2 / s) +( X1 + X2 )
2 2 1/2
dT
Equating to zero gives the slip at maximum torque as
ds
R2′
sm = ±
2 1/ 2
R12 + ( X 1 + X 2 )
3 V2
Tmax =
2ωs R + R 2 + X + X 2
1 1 ( 1 2)
Q.8 A 230 V d.c. series motor has an armature resistance of 0.2 Ω and series field
resistance of 0.10 Ω . Determine:
(i) the current required to develop a torque of 70 Nm at 1200 rpm
(ii) percentage reduction in flux when the machine runs at 2000 rpm at half the
current. (14)
Ans:
DC Series Motor:
Jo
in
= =
@
Back emf a .
60 A 60 A
SP
60 A
P
Define K n
U
B
TE
C
H
34
-T
el
eg
ra
m
=
φ
′_____________________________
Z
ZP
E Pn ′ ′ n
ZP www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
n _____________
So Ea ( A)
Kn
1 P ZP
Also T = φ Ia Z = φ Ia .
2π A 2π A
ZP ZP 60 1 60
= . = .
2π A 60 A 2π K n 2π
I 60
So T= aX
Kn 2
Also for a series motor
Ea = V-Ia (Ra+Rse)----------------(B)
where V is the applied voltage and Ia is the current through armature and series field.
n
230 I a (0.2 0.1)
Kn
1200
230 0.3I a _____________ (C )
Kn
60
also 70 = .I a
2 Kn
or
70 2 _____________
X ( D)
Kn 60 I a
1200 X 70 X 2π
= 230 − 0.3I a
60 I a
8796
Jo
or = 230 − 0.3I a
in
Ia
@
35
-T
el
eg
ra
m
π
φ
= − π+ www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
n2 2
230 0.3 X 20.17
Kn
2
2000 230 6.05
Kn
2000 2
224 ______________ ( E )
Kn
1200
From (C) 230 0.3(40.33) 217.9 _____________ ( F )
Kn
Ans: The occ and scc characteristics of the synchronous generator are given in
Fig. M4
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
36
-T
el
eg
ra
m
φ
= − φ = www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
1100
Thus Xs ≈ Zs = = 3.18Ω
3 X200
E f − Vt ( rated )
Percentage voltage regulation is defined as X100%
Vt ( rated )
The phasor diagram is given in Fig. M5
Ef
s
Jo
in
a
@
SP
37
-T
el
eg
ra
m
θ
δφ
Icos
t=
V
IX 0.8
200A
f(rated)
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
40
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
2200
Here Vt ( rated ) =
3
cos 0.8
(Vt )
2
Ef 2 Ira cos IX s sin ( IX s cos Ira sin ) 2
where Vt(terminal voltage) and Ef (field voltage) are per phase values
E f − Vt ( rated )
Percent regulation = X 100
Vt ( rated )
1788.8 − 1270
⇒ % reg n = X 100 = 48.85%
1270
448.8
tan δ = = 0.259
1731.6
δ =14.5o
Thus power angle = 14.5
o
Q.10 A 100 KVA, 2400/240 V, 50 Hz, 1-phase transformer has no-load current of 0.64
A and a core loss of 700 W, when its high voltage side is energized at rated voltage
and frequency. Calculate the two components of no-load current. If this transformer
supplies a load current of 40 amp at 0.8 lagging power factor at its low voltage
side, determine the primary current and its power factor. Ignore leakage impedance
Jo
drop. (12)
in
@
Ans:
SP
38
-T
el
eg
ra
m
φ
= + φ + φ+ www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
φ −
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
No load: -
Io = 0.64 A
Wo= 700W
Iron loss current = 700/2400 =0.2916 A
Now , Io2 = Iw2 + Iµ2
= (0.642 – 0.29162)1/2
= 0.5697 A
On load :-
I2 = 40 A
Φ2 = 0.8 lag
= 62.88o
Jo
in
Φ2 = cos –1 0.8
@
= 36.86o
SP
P
39
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
= 26.02o
I0 = 0.64 ∠–62.88o
I21 = 4∠–36.86o
Ans:
Eg = 254 V
V = 240 V
Ra= 0.04 Ω, Rsh = 24Ω
Eg = V + Ia Ra
Eg = V + (IL + Ish) Ra
Jo
IL = 340A
TE
C
H
40
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.12 The shaft output of a three-phase 60- Hz induction motor is 80 KW. The friction
and windage losses are 920 W, the stator core loss is 4300 W and the stator copper
loss is 2690 W. The rotor current and rotor resistance referred to stator are
respectively 110 A and 0.15 Ω . If the slip is 3.8%, what is the percent efficiency?
(12)
Ans:
Pm =output = 80 KW
41
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans:
N = 950 rpm
V= 550 V
f = 50 Hz.
cosϕ = 0.88
= 32.34 ampere
42
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans:
P=120 * 50/1000=6;
Q.15 Three single-phase, 50 kVA, 2300/ 230 V, 60 Hz transformers are connected to form
a 3-phase, 4000V / 230-V transformer bank. The equivalent impedance of each
transformer referred to low-voltage is 0.012 + j 0.016 Ω . The 3-phase transformer
supplies a 3-phase, 120 kVA, 230 V, 0.85 power-factor (lagging) load.
Ans: Given :
43
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
44
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.16 A pair of synchronous machines, on the same shaft, may be used to generate power at
60 Hz from the given source of power at 50 Hz. Determine the minimum number of
poles that the individual machines could have for this type of operation and find the
shaft-speed in r.p.m. (4+4)
Ans: Motor & generator (synchronous machine) are coupled. Therefore,
NS(m) = NS(g)
NS(m) = 120 fm /Pm ; NS(g) = 120 fg / Pg
Where : NS(m) = synchronous speed of motor
NS(g) = synchronous speed of generator
fm = frequency of motor power
fg = frequency of generator power
Pm = motor poles
Pg = generator poles
∴ 120 fm /Pm = 120 fg / Pg
120 x 50 / Pm = 120 x 60 /Pg
∴ Pg /Pm = 6/5
Pg : Pm = 6 : 5
Therefore minimum requirement of poles for motor
Pm = 10 (5 x 2)
Pg = 12 (6 x 2)
Now synchronous speed or shaft speed = 1200 x 50 / 10 = 600 rpm
Q.17 A 240V dc shunt motor has an armature resistance of 0.4 ohm and is running at the
full-load speed of 600 r.p.m. with a full load current of 25A. The field current is
constant; also a resistance of 1 ohm is added in series with the armature. Find the
speed (i) at the full-load torque and (ii) at twice the full-load torque.
(6)
Ans: In a DC shunt motor
V = 240V
Ra = 0.4Ω
Jo
in
Eb1 = V - IaRa
B
TE
C
H
45
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.18 A 400V, 4-pole, 50 Hz, 3-phase, 10 hp, star connected induction motor has a no
load slip of 1% and full load slip of 4%. Find the following:
(i) Syn. speed (ii) no-load speed (iii) full-load speed.
(iv) frequency of rotor current at full-load (v) full-load torque. (5 x 2 = 10)
Ans: Given :
VL = 400 volts ; P = 4 nos, 50 Hz,
P0 = 10 HP = 735.5 x 10 = 7355 watt
i. Synchronous speed NS = 120 f / p
= 120 x 50 / 4 = 1500 rpm
ii. No load speed at s = 0.01
Jo
N0 = NS ( 1 – s) = 1500 ( 1- 0.01)
in
= 1485 rpm
@
SP
= 1440 rpm
B
TE
C
H
46
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
= 10 (4.950)
@
= 49.50 Volts
SP
47
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
∴ Eb1 = V – Ia1 Ra
in
48
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
49
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
= 0.4924Ω
@
50
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.25 A 250 Volts dc shunt motor has Rf=150 ohm and Ra = 0.6 ohm. The motor
operates on no-load with a full field flux at its base speed of 1000 rpm with Ia = 5
Amps. If the machine drives a load requiring a torque of 100 Nm, calculate
armature current and speed of the motor. (8)
Jo
Rf = 150 Ω
@
Ra = 0.6Ω
SP
51
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.26 A 400Volts, 1450 rpm, 50 Hz, wound-rotor induction motor has the following
Jo
Rotational loss =1500 W. Calculate the starting torque and current when the motor
B
52
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans:
V = 400V; N = 1450 rpm ; f =50 Hz
R1 = 0.3 Ω R2’ = 0.25 Ω ; X1 =X2’ = 0.6 Ω ; X0 = 35Ω
Rotational losses =1500 W
Find starting torque T1 = ? If =?
Or If = V/Z01 = 400/√3
1.32
= 175.16 amp.
= 606.86 Nm
SP
P
2πN /60
TE
C
H
53
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(N = (1-S)NS )
= 606.86 - 1500/151.67
= 596.97 Nm
Q.27 A universal motor (ac–operated) has a 2-pole armature with 960 conductors. At a
certain load the motor speed is 5000 rpm and the armature current is 4.6 Amps, the
armature terminal voltage and input power are respectively 100 Volts and 300
Watts.
Compute the following, assuming an armature resistance of 3.5 ohm.
(i) Effective armature reactance.
(ii) Maximum value of useful flux/pole. (8)
Ans: P = 2; Z = 960; N= 5000
Ii =Ia= 4.6 amp ; V1 =100 volts
Pi =300W find Xa and φm = ?
P1 = V1I1cos φ
∴ cos φ = P1 / V1I1
= 300/ 100 x 4.6 = 0.652
Ebdc = V - IaRa or (NφPZ / 60A )
= 100 - 4.6 x 3.5
= 100 -16.1 = 83.9 volts
54
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Xa = 16.48 ohms
∴ φm = E bdc x 60 A/ NPZ
Flux
= 1.048 x 10-3 wb
Ans:
Given 1 φ, 50 Hz ; cosφ = 0.707 lagging
Transmission length = 20 km
Generator supply inductive load = 5000kW = kVAR
R = 0.0195 ohms/km , L = 0.63 mH
VR = 10kV
Find sending end voltage VS = ? & % regulation =?; distance =20km
∆V = VS -VR ( drop in line )
(VS -VR )=RP + XQ/ VR {Active Power (P) = Reactive Power (Q)}
= 0.0195 x 20 x 5000 x 103 + 3.96 x 5000 x 10-3 / 10 x 103
Vs ={0.0195 x 20 x 5000 x 103 + 3.96 x 5000 x 10-3 / 10 x 103 } + 10 x
103 volts
= 1.2175 x 104 volts
Jo
= 12.175 kVolts
in
= 17.86%
PU
B
TE
C
H
55
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.29 A 37.7 HP, 220 V d.c shunt motor with a full load speed of 535 rpm is to be braked
by plugging. Estimate the value of resistance which should be placed in series with
it to limit the initial current to 200 A. (8)
Ans:
P0 = 37.7 HP = 37.7 x 735.5 W = 27.73 kW
NL = 535 rpm braked by plugging ; Ia = 200A
V =220 v
Under plugging :
Ia = V + Eb / (R + Ra )
and Eb = 27.73 x 103 / 200 (assume negligible losses)
= 138.65 Volts
200 = 220 + 138.65/(R + Ra )
R + Ra = 358.65 /200 = 1.79 ohm
R = value of added resistance in series with armature resistance
Ra = armature resistance
56
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
= 97.28 %
(ii) At half load and unity p.f.
Wc = 480( ½)2 = 120 W
Wi = 360 W
Total losses = 360+120 = 480 W
At half load, output at unity p.f = 30/21= 15 kW
Therefore, Efficiency = (15/(15+0.48)) 100
= 96.90 %
(iii) The load for maximum efficiency and condition for max. efficiency.
Efficiency ( ή ) = ( V1I1 cosΦ - losses )/ V1I1 cosΦ
= ( V1I1 cosΦ - I12R01- Wi )/ V1I1 cosΦ
I 1 Ro 1 Wi
=1 −
V 1 R 1 cos Φ V 1 R 1 cos Φ
Differentiating above equation for maximum efficiency
Therefore,
dn R01 Wi
=0- - =0
dI1 V1cosΦ V1I1cosΦ
and
R01 Wi
=
V1cosΦ V1I1cosΦ
Therefore,
Wi = Wc
and load current, Il = (√ Wi /R02 )
Ans:
Given : VL = 33 kV, 3 phase, star connected Synchronous Generator
∴ Vph = 33/√3 = 19.1 kV
Zph = 1.4Ω
P01 = 240 MW = 240 x 106 Watt
Jo
cos Φ 1 = 1
in
57
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ψ2
Eg2 /ph = Eg1 /ph *
Ψ1
∴ Eg2 /ph = 31.23kV
or Eg2 /ph = Vph + I2 Zph
I2 ph = Eg2 -V/Zph = 12.125 x 103 / 1.4
= 8.66 kA
Now P02 =√3 VL IL2 cos Φ 2 ( IL2 = Iph 2 : VL = VL1 = VL2 ; P02 = 280 MW )
cos Φ 2 = P02 /√3 VL IL2
= 280 x 10 6 / √3 x 33 x 8.66 x 106
= 280 / 495
= 0.565 leading
Q.32 A 250 V DC shunt motor has an armature resistance of 0.55 Ω and runs with a full
load armature current of 30A. The field current remaining constant, if an additional
resistance of 0.75 Ω is added in series with the armature, the motor attains a speed of
633 rpm. If now the armature resistance is restored back to 0.55 Ω , find the speed
with (i) full load and (ii) twice full load torque. (12)
Ans:
Given Ra =0.55 Ω,
RT =0.75 additional resistance in series with armature
V = 250V
Ia = 30A at full load Then N2 = 633 rpm
Ish = Constt.
Find N1 = ? at full load ; N3 = ? at double load
N1 α V - Ia1Ra
Jo
N 1 V − I a1 Ra
∴ =
@
N2 − a2 Ra
SP
P
58
-T
el
eg
ra
m
IV www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
N2
= 1.106
N1
N1 = N2 *1.106 = 700.5
N1 = 701 r.p.m at full load without Rt
N 1 V − I a1 Ra
=
N3 − a3 Ra
N1
= 1 . 076
N3
Q.33 A 4-pole, 3 phase, 400 V, 50 Hz, induction motor has the following parameters for its
circuit model (rotor quantities referred to the stator side) on an equivalent-star basis:
R 1 = 1.6Ω. X1 = 2.4Ω. R 12 = 0.48 Ω, X 12 = 1.2Ω and = 40 Ω . Rotational
losses are 720 W. Neglect stator copper losses. For a speed of 1470 rpm, calculate the
input current, input power factor, net mechanical power output, torque and efficiency.
(12)
Ans:
Given:
P =4
VL = 400 V
f = 50 HZ
R1 = 1.6 Ω, X1 = 2.4 Ω ; R2/ =0.48 Ω ; X2/ = 1.2 Ω
Xm = X0 = 40 Ω
Rotational losses = 720 W; Wi = 0 Watt
N=1470 rpm
Jo
59
-T
el
eg
ra
m
IV
X
m www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
TS = 29.18 Nm
in
= 3 x 167.77
U
B
= 503.31 Watt
TE
C
H
60
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.34 A universal motor has a 2-pole armature with 1020 conductors. When it is operated
on load with a.c. supply with an armature voltage of 150, the motor speed is 5400
RPM. The other data is:
Input power : 360 W
Armature current : 5.2 A
Armature resistance: 5.5 Ω
Compute (i) the effective armature reactance and (ii) maximum value of armature
flux per pole. (10)
Ans: Given:
P=2; Va = 150 V; N = 5400 rpm
Z=1020; Pi = 360 MW; Ia = 5.2A;
Ra = 5.5Ω
Find Xa =?; Φmax per pole=?
Now Ia = Va /Za
@
61
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans:
Given : P0 = 50 kVA, V1 = 2300V , V2 = 230V, f = 60 Hz
R1 = 0.65Ω (H.V.Side), R2 = 0.0065Ω (L.V Side)
Lab test: O.C (H.V.Side) : V= 230 V, I =5.7A, P = 190 watt
S.C (L.V.Side), : V= 41.5 V, I =21.7A, P = ? watt
Find (a) V1 for rated V2 when acts as step up transformer and delivering 50kVA at
cos Φ = 0.8
(b) efficiency
At S.C test
Z02 = VSC / I2 = 41.5 /21.7 = 1.912Ω & K =1/10
∴Z01 = Z02 / K2 = 1.912 x 102 = 191.2 Ω
R01 = R1 + R2/ = 0.65 + 0.0065/100 (K =1/10, H.V side is R2)
R01 = 0.13 Ω
R02 = R01 x K2 = 0.13 / 100 = 0.0013 Ω
Now X01 = √ Z012 – R201 = √ (191.2)2 – (0.13)2
X01 = 191.2 Ω
& X02 = √ Z022 – R202 = √ (1.912)2 – (0.0013)2
Jo
X01 = 1.912 Ω
in
= 25.02 Volts
U
62
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
∴V1 =255.02 volts for V2 = 2300 volts rated value as step up.
= 50 x 1000 x 0.8 .
output + losses (core Losses + Cu losess)
40000 .
40000 + 190 + I1 R1+ I22 R2
2
40000 .
40000 + 190 + (5.7)2 x 0.65+ (21.7)2 x 0.0065
(note: low voltage winding is short circuited)
40000 .
40000 + 32.49 x 0.65+ 470.89 x 0.0065
40000 .
40000 + 21.12 + 3.06
= 99.93%
x φ = 77Ω
The rotational losses are 4100 watts. Using the approximate equivalent circuit,
compute for a slip of 1.5%.
a. the line power factor and current.
b. developed torque.
c. efficiency. (8+4+4)
Ans:
Jo
P0 = 335 x 735.5 watt Rotational losses = 4100 watt; Slip (s) = 0.015
@
P = 6 nos., Y connected
SP
63
-T
el
eg
ra
m
= www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
= 2.529Amp
TE
C
H
64
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.37 A 2300-V, three phase, 60 Hz, star-connected cylindrical synchronous motor has a
synchronous reactance of 11 Ω per phase. When it delivers 200 hp, the efficiency is
found to be 90% exclusive of field loss, and the power-angle is 15 electrical degrees
as measured by a stroboscope. Neglect ohmic resistance and determine:
(a) the induced excitation per phase.
Ans:
Given : 2300V , 3 phase, 60Hz, Synch. Motor
XS = 11Ω /ph , Star connected, VPh = 2300/ √3 V
P0 = 200 hp = 200 x 735.5 = 147.1 kW
η = 90%
∴ Pi = P0 /0.9 = 163.44 kW
Power angle α = 150 ( electrical)
Find: induced excitation / ph (Eg ) = ?
Line Current Ia = ?
Power Factor Cos Φ =?
= 41.02 + j 32.42
Ia = 52.28 ∟38.320
in
@
65
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.38 When a 250-V, 50 hp, 1000 rpm d.c shunt motor is used to supply rated output power
to a constant torque load, it draws an armature current of 160A. The armature circuit
has a resistance of 0.04 Ω and the rotational losses are equal to 2 KW. An external
resistance of 0.5 Ω is inserted in series with the armature winding. For this condition
compute
(i) the speed
(ii) the developed power
(iii) the efficiency assuming that the field loss is 1.6 K.W (8+4+4)
Ans:
Given VL = 250 V P0 = 50 hp = 50 x 735.5 36.78 kw
N1 = 1000 rpm Ia = 160 amp. , Ra= 0.04Ω, R = 0.5 Ω ,
Rotational losses = 2 kw ; Field losses = 1.6 kW
66
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
= 17.42 kW
= 33.46%
Q.39 The following data were obtained on a 20KVA, 50Hz, 2000/200V distribution
transformer
Open Circuit Test (on L.V. side): 200V, 4A, 120W
Short Circuit Test (on H.V. side): 60V, 10A, 300W
Draw the approximate equivalent circuit of the transformer referred to H.V. Side. (8)
Ans:
Given : 20 kVA, 50Hz , 2000/ 200V
O.C Test : V0 = 200 V ; I0 = 4A ; W1 = 120 W
S.C Test : VSC= 60 V ; ISC = 10A ; WSC = 300 W
V0I0 cosΦ0 = W0
∴ cosΦ0 = W0 / V0I0 = 120 / 200 x 4 = 0.15
∴ sinΦ 0 = 0.988
Jo
67
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.40 The efficiency of a 3-phase 400V, star connected synchronous motor is 95% and it
takes 24A at full load and unity power factor. What will be the induced e.m.f. and
total mechanical power developed at full load and 0.9 power factor leading? The
synchronous impedance per phase is (0.2+j2)Ω. (9)
Ans:
Given : 3Φ , 400V star connected synchronous motor
Jo
VPh = 400/√3
@
68
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
cos Φ = 0.9
∴ Φ = 25.840
ER = IZS = 24 (0.2 +j2) volts
= (4.8 +j48) volts = 48.23∟84.290
θ =84.290
Now at leading p.f
Eb/ph = V + IaZS cos {180 – (θ + Φ)} + j IaZS sin {180 – (θ - Φ )}
∴ Eb/ph = 231+24x2cos {180 – (84.29 + 25.84)} + j24x2 sin
{180 – (84.29 - 25.84)}
=231 + 48 cos (69.87) + j 48 x 0.938
= 231 + 16512 + j45
Eb/ph = 247.5 + j 45
Eb/ph = 251.55∟10.3
Synchronous motor input power = √3 VLILcos Φ
= √3 VIacos Φ = √3 x 400 x 24 x 0.9
= 14,964.92 watt
2
total copper losses = 3 I Ra
= 3 x (24)2 x 0.2 = 3 x 576 x 0.2
= 345.6 watt
∴ Mechanical output developed = Input – losses
= 14964.92 -345.6
= 14619.32 watt
Q.41 A 200V shunt motor with a constant main field drives a load, the torque of which
varies at square of the speed, when running at 600 r.p.m., it takes 30A. Find the speed
at which it will run and the current it will draw, if a 20Ω resistor is connected in series
with armature. Neglect motor losses. (9)
Ans:
Given: V =200v, shunt motor
N1 = 600 rpm
I1 = 30A = Ia1
Find : N2 & I2 ; when R =20Ω added with Ra in series
= 573Nm
T α N2
SP
∴ T1 / T2 = N1 2 / N2 2
P U
∴ N2 2 / T2 = N1 2 / T1 = 6002 / 573
B
69
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.42 A 3-phase induction motor has a starting torque of 100% and a maximum torque of
200% of full load torque. Find
(i) Slip at maximum torque.
(ii) Full load slip.
(iii) Neglect the stator impedance (8)
let a = R2 / X2
@
SP
2a /(1+a2) = 1/2
B
TE
C
H
70
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
4a = 1+a2
a2 - 4a + 1 = 0
a = 4 ± √ 16 – 4 x 1 x 1
2
a = 4 ± √ 12
2
a = 3.73 or 0 .2679
Sf = 0.9995 or 0.07145
Q.43 A universal motor (a.c. operated) has a 2-pole armature with 960 conductors. At a
certain load the motor speed is 5000 r.p.m. and the armature current is 4.6A. The
armature terminal voltage and input are respectively 100 V and 300 W. Compute the
following, assuming an armature resistance of 3.5Ω.
(i) Effective armature reactance
(ii) Max. value of useful flux per pole. (8)
Ra = 3.5 ohms
Find Xa = ?
in
Φm / pole = ?
@
Pi = VI cos Φ
SP
P
= 0.652
TE
C
H
71
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: Given:
3Φ , 50Hz, d = 250km
P0 = 25mVA, cos Φ = 0.8 (lagging), VR = 132 KV
VR/ph = 132000/ √ 3 V
Spacing between conductors = 3m
R = 0.11 Ω/km
Dia (D) = 1.6 x 10-2 m
Find : Vs= ? and % regulation =?
Iph = Po / VR/ph
Jo
72
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
For Y : Vp = VL/√3 , Ip = IL
∆ : Vp = VL , Ip = IL/√3
VPP /VPS = N1 / N2
VLP /VLS = √3 VPP/VPS = √3 N1/N2 = 12 √3
VLS = VLP / 12√3 = 6600 / 12 √3
VLS = 315.33 Volts
IPP / IPS = N2 / N1
ILP / ILS = IPP / √3 x 1/ IPS =(1/√3 ) x ( N2 / N1)
= 120√ 3 Amp.
in
@
= 6600 x 12√3 x 10
P
12 √3
U
o/ρ = 66kVA
B
TE
C
H
73
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(ii) ∆/Y
For Y : Vp = VL/√3 , Ip = IL
∆ : Vp = VL , Ip = IL/√3
VPP /VPS = N1 / N2
VLP /VLS = VPP/√3 VPS = 1/√3 x N1/N2 = 12 /√3
VLS =√3VLP / 12 = √3 x 6600 / 12
VLS = 550√3 Volts
IPP / IPS = N2 / N1
ILP / ILS = √3IPP / IPS =√3 N2 / N1 = √3/12
Q.46 A 3300V, delta-connected motor has a synchronous reactance per phase (delta) of
18Ω. It operates at a leading power factor of 0.707 when drawing 800kW from the
mains. Calculate its excitation emf. (8)
74
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
N = 662.6 rpm
SP
75
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.48 A 150kW, 3000V, 50Hz, 6-pole star-connected induction motor has a star-connected
slip-ring rotor with a transformation ratio of 3.6 (stator/rotor). The rotor resistance is
0.1Ω/phase and its per phase leakage inductance is 3.61 mH. The stator impedance
may be neglected. Find (i) the starting current and torque on rated voltage with short-
circuited slip-rings, and (ii) the necessary external resistance to reduce the rated
voltage starting current to 30A and the corresponding starting torque.
Q.49 An ac operated universal motor has a 2-pole armature with 960 conductors. At a
certain load the motor speed is 5000 rpm and the armature current is 4.6A; the
armature terminal voltage and input are respectively 100 V and 300 W. Calculate the
following quantities assuming an armature resistance of 3.5 Ω.
(i) Effective armature reactance
(ii) Max. value of useful flux/pole. (8)
Jo
Ans:
in
@
The operating conditions in terms of voltage and current of the armature circuit are
SP
76
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ea is in phase with Ia
Or 65.2 + j75.8 - Ea = 16.1 + j 4.6 Xa
Q.50 Define voltage regulation of a single phase transformer. The primary and secondary
winding of a 40kVA, 6600/250V, single phase transformer have resistance of 10 ohm
and 0.02 ohm respectively. The total leakage reactance is 35 ohm as referred to the
primary winding. Find full load regulation at a pf of 0.8 lagging. (8)
= 0.03435Ω
B
TE
C
H
77
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.51 A star connected synchronous motor at 187 kVA, 3-φ, 2300V, 47A, 50Hz, 187.5 rpm
has an effective resistance of 1.5 ohm and a synchronous reactance of 20 ohm per
phase. Determine internal power developed by the motor when it is operating at rated
current and 0.8 power factor leading. (6)
78
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Let the additional resistance required in armature current be of R ohms to reduce the
speed to 800 rpm when the load torque is proportional to speed.
T2 = T1 N2/ N1 = T1 800/ 1000 = 0.87
Or Ia2 Φ2 = 0.8Ia1 Φ 1
Or Ia3 Φ3 = 0.64Ia1 Φ1
79
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Find VS =? ; % regulation = ?
@
SP
Drop in line ∆V = VS - VR
P U
VS - VR = RP + XQ / VR
B
TE
C
H
80
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
81
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
DESCRIPTIVES
Q.1 Draw and explain the phasor diagram of a transformer on load at a lagging power
factor.
(7)
Ans: (D)
Fig. AA1
Fig. AA2
Fig AA2 shows the phase diagram of a transformer on a load at lagging power factor
and corresponds to the equivalents circuit of transformer (Fig. AA1) in which all
quantities are referred to the primary. Thus V2 is the secondary terminal voltage
referred to the primary [where over bar implies a phasor].
2
N
Jo
R = Req = R1 + R2′ = R1 + R2 1
in
N2
@
Where R1 and R2 are primary and secondary resistances, N1 and N2 are primary and
SP
secondary number of turns and X l1 and X l 2 are leakage reactances of primary and
P U
secondary windings.
B
TE
C
H
82
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Also
2
N
X = X eq = X l1 + X l′2 = X l1 + 1 X l2
N2
The voltage V1 which is applied to the primary can be written as
V 1 = V 2 + I (R + jX )
Q.2 Explain with proper phasor diagrams the operation of a 3 phase synchronous
machine with normal excitation at the following conditions:
(i) The machine is floating on the supply bus. (7)
(ii) The machine is working as a synchronous motor at no load. (7)
Ans:
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
83
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Fig B1 shows the circuit diagrams and phasor diagrams of a synchronous machine at
generating mode [Fig B1(a)& (c)] and motoring mode [Fig B1(b)&(d)] . The machine
is assumed to be connected to an infinite busbar of voltage Vt and its resistance is
taken to be zero. It is seen from [Fig B1(c)] that in the generating mode, the excitation
emf Ef leads Vt by an angle δ ; on the other hand in the motoring mode Ef lags Vt.
It can be inferred from the above that, when the machine is floating, it is working
neither as a generator nor as a motor and Ia will be equal to zero. E f and Vt will be
equal and have the same phase [Fig. B2]
When the machine is working as a synchronous motor at no load, the figures B1 (b)
Jo
and (d) will hold good, but with a very small value for the current Ia; correspondingly
the angles δ and
in
will take that much power which is the sum of friction and windage losses. [Fig B3]
SP
84
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
φwill be small. The reason for this is, that at no
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.3 Draw the torque speed characteristics of a 3 phase induction motor and clearly
indicate the effect of change in rotor resistance. (7)
Ans: The Thevenin equivalent of an induction motor circuit model is given in Figure
D1
R′
3V T h 2 2
T = s __________
__________
____
2 (A
R
+ ( X T H + X 2′ )
2
ωs RT H + 2
s
Equation (A); for different values of rotor resistance are shown in Fig.D2
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
85
-T
el
eg
ra
m
)′ www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(1) The starting torque is affected: it increases with increase in R2, goes to a
maximum of Tmax and then decreases with further increase in R2.
(2) Tmax, remains the same but the slip at which it occurs is changed with R2.
Q.4 For a small and sensitive servo mechanism give four reasons why a.c. servo motors
are generally preferred to d.c. servo motor. (7)
86
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Fig. E3
The two phase ac servomotor [Fig E2] on the other hand is ideally suited for low
power control applications. The two phases are called control phase (phase a) and
reference phase (phase m), the latter being excited at a fixed magnitude of
synchronous a.c. voltage, both voltages being taken from the same source. The control
phase voltage is shifted in phase by 90o from the reference phase voltage by means of
phase-shifting networks. The motor torque gets reversed by phase reversal of the
control phase voltage.
(iv) it has no brushes that contact the commutator segments. The rotor can withstand a
SP
87
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: In resistance welding a heavy current is passed through the joint to be welded
and the heat caused by the resistance of the joint is sufficient to cause fusion of the
metal. Three types of resistance welding exist and they are as follows:
(i) Butt Welding:This method is used for welding of rods, wires or small pipes;
the two ends are pressed together mechanically to form a butt joint as shown
in Fig G1
(ii) Spot Welding: For jointing two or even three sheets of metal by means of an
overlapping joint, as shown in Fig G2, The sheets are held between two
electrodes and current is passed between these electrodes, causing fusion at a
single spot.
Q.6 What are different welding controls used in resistance welding? (4)
@
switch connected in the primary circuit of the welding transformer and driven
B
88
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(iii) Current and energy- actuated control: With this control, current is allowed
to flow until a predetermined amount of energy has been supplied to the weld.
Q.7 Explain the principle of high frequency induction heating. What factors control the
depth of penetration of heat? Give the industrial application of this mode of heating.
(7)
Ans: Induction heating processes make use of currents induced by electromagnetic
action in the material to be heated. Sufficient currents that cause effective heating can
be produced only in materials of low resistivity, however it is necessary to use a
magnetic field of very high frequency.
For coreless induction furnaces, the depth of penetration(t) is given by the formula
1 ρ .109
t=
2π µf
-6
where ohm/cm for steel]
f =frequency(Hz)
For normal supply frequency, with the power factor in the range 0.8-0.85 and in sizes
upto about 1 tonne, the vertical core-type furnace is widely used in foundries for
melting and refining brass and other non –ferrous metals. On the other hand the
coreless induction furnace is used for the production of very high grade alloy steels; in
small sizes it is widely used for work on alloys and precious metals.
Q.8 What is the fundamental difference between thermal and nuclear power plants? (3)
Ans: In a thermal power plant heat is released in combustion of coal; this heat is used
in a boiler to raise steam.
Jo
Here the coal is conveyed to a mill and crushed into a fine powder, this being termed
as pulverization. The pulverized coal is blown into the boiler where it mixes with the
in
supply of air for combustion. Heat is transferred to steam pipes located in the top
@
region of the boiler, these being initially fed with hot water from the boiler feed
SP
pump; the hot water then gets converted to steam at high temperature and pressure.
P
This steam is fed to the steam turbines which are the prime movers for electric
U
B
generators.
TE
C
H
89
-T
el
eg
ra
m
ρpermeability
µ
= specific resistance
(this factor
of the has
molten www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
a value
charge
of 1.0
[200X10
for m
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.9 List the advantages of nuclear power plants over conventional thermal power
plants. (4)
Ans:
(ii) It requires very little fuel in terms of volume and weight and therefore poses
no transportation problems. The nuclear power plant may be sited,
independently of nuclear fuel supplies, close to load centres. However safety
considerations require that these plants be normally located away from
populated areas.
(iii) When one pound of pure uranium is completely fissioned it will create as
much heat as the burning of 1500 tons of coal.
(iv) Whereas the stock of coal is limited and the supply of coal will go down in the
coming decades, it is the nuclear energy that is promising. Nuclear power
plants will therefore be important sources of electrical power in future.
Q.10 Discuss briefly the solid state circuits used for the stator voltage control of
induction motor derives. (7)
Ans : Fig H1 shows the block diagram for a scheme of stator voltage control. Here
the ratio V/f is kept constants, with the frequency being varied by means of an
inverter. This in turn will help in maintaining the field flux constant. The rectifier and
inverter are rigged by means of the thyristors or GTOs or MOSFETs. Because of its
high cost, this type of control is justified only for drives wherein rugged,
maintenance-free characteristics of the induction motor are essential.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
90
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
91
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.12 What are the advantages of high voltage transmission? Give its limitations also.
(4)
Ans: High voltage transmission is subdivided into HVAC and HVDC transmission
systems.
(i) HVAC transmission: Advantages of HVAC transmission are as follows:
As the voltage is increased, the current carried by the conductors decreases. The i2R
losses correspondingly get reduced. However the cost of transmission towers,
transformers, switches and circuit breakers rapidly increases with increase in voltage,
Jo
Advantages They (HVDC lines) are economical for bulk power transmission. The
P
voltage regulation problem is much less in DC since only IR drop is involved. There
U
B
TE
C
H
92
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
is easy reversibality and controllability of power flow through a DC link. Also there is
considerable insulation economy.
Limitations: The systems are costly since installation of complicated converters and
DC switchgear is expensive. The converters require considerable reactive power.
Lack of HVDC circuit breakers hampers network operation. Moreover there is
nothing like DC transformer; voltage transformation has to be provided on the a.c.
sides of the system.
Ans : Overcurrent relay: This relay operates when current through it (sample of
power system current) satisfies the condition
2
Q = K1 I − K 4 > 0
K4
or I > = Ip
K1
where I p is said to be the pickup value of the relay. Such a relay is an over current
relay and would operate in the shortest possible time (depending upon the type of
hardware employed), and is called instantaneous overcurrent relay.
Thus if:
I > I p the relay trips the circuit broker
and
if I < I p the relay blocks or does not trip the circuit breaker.
The directional feature can be incorporated for the above o/c relay by means of an
induction cup type of structure (Fig L1) one of the coils being current excited and the
other, voltage excited.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
93
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The phasor diagram of a directional relay is shown in Fig. L2. I v , the voltage coil
current lags the voltage applied by an angle depending upon the coil impedance. Since
the fluxes are proportional to the coil currents, and have the same angle separation as
coil currents, the relay torque can be expressed as
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
94
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
T = K 3 V I sin(θ − φ ) (A)
where Iv
and θ = angle by which the current applied to the relay leads its voltage
The proportionality
( av ) 1 2 (B)
where 1 2 ge coils and
F(AV), net (average) force or an induction type of disc.
Q.14 Explain the working of nickel cadmium cells with its merits and demerits over lead
acid cell. (7)
Ans: Nickel- Cadmium cells: In a Nickel-Cadmium cell the positive plates are made
of nickel hydroxide enclosed in finely perforated steel tubes or pockets, the electrical
resistance being reduced by the addition of flakes of pure nickel or graphite. These
tubes or pockets are assembled in nickelled-steel plates. The active material in this
cell is Cadmium mixed with a little iron, the latter being used to prevent caking of the
active material and hence an impairment to porosity.
Chemical reaction
Jo
95
-T
el
eg
ra
m
φ
ca∝
F ,τ(φ
=aan θnd φbe the
when
phase
relay treated
parameter)
angle
relay
ofas
develops
voltage
fluxes
as thecoil
value
from
maximum www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
current
the currentB and
torque, then volta
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Underground cables are generally required in urban areas where there is a high
density of population. The highest load density and the most restrictive limitations on
P U
feeder layout occur simultaneously in the central cores of major cities. Load densities
B
96
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
rotor is noncylindrical such that the reluctance of the magnetic path offered by the
in
rotor to the rotating field is a function of the space angle. Here the rotor has the
@
tendency to align itself in the minimum reluctance position with respect to the
SP
synchronously rotating flux of the forward field. The motor is made self starting by
P
the induction principle by providing short-circuited copper bars in the projecting parts
U
of the rotor.
B
TE
C
H
97
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
In the single phase reluctance motor the rotating field can be produced by one of the
phase-splitting methods. The salient pole structure is given to the rotor by removing
some of the teeth of an induction motor rotor as shown in Fig M2. The remaining
teeth carry short-circuited copper bars to provide the starting induction torque. After
starting, the rotor reaches near synchronous speed by induction action and is pulled
into synchronism during the positive half-cycle of the sinusoidally varying
synchronous torque.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
98
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
This would only be possible if the rotor has low inertia and the load conditions are
light. The torque speed characteristic of a typical reluctance motor with induction start
is given in Fig M3. Here the starting torque is highly dependent upon the rotor
position because of the projecting nature of the rotor. This phenomenon is known as
“cogging”. For satisfactory synchronous motor performance the frame size to be used
must be much larger than that for normal single- phase induction motor. This accounts
for the high value of starting torque shown in Fig M3.
(ii) Parallel operation of transformers: when the load exceeds the capacity of an
existing transformer, it may be economical to install another one in parallel rather
than replacing it with a single larger unit. Also for reliability two smaller units in
parallel are preferred. The cost of maintaining a spare is also less with two units in
parallel.
For satisfactory parallel operation of transformers the following conditions have to be
fulfilled:
(i) They must be connected with proper polarities; this is to ensure that the net
voltage around the local loop is zero. A wrong polarity connection results in a dead
short circuit.
(ii) 3 phase transformers must have zero relative phase displacement on the secondary
sides and must be connected with proper phase sequence. Only the transformers of the
same group can be paralleled. For example Y/Y and Y/ ∆ transformers cannot be
paralleled as their secondary voltages will have a phase difference of 300
(iii)The transformers must have the same voltage ratio to avoid no-load circulating
current, when the transformers are in parallel on both primary and secondary sides.
(iv) There should exist only a limited disparity in the per unit impedances (on their
own bases) of the transformers. The currents carried by the two transformers are
proportional to their ratings if their p.u. impedances on their own ratings are equal.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
Fig N1 shows two transformers paralleled on both sides with proper polarities but on
B
no load. The primary voltages V1 and V2 are equal. If the voltage ratios of the two
TE
C
H
99
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
transformers are not identical, the secondary voltages E1 and E2 though in phase will
not be equal in magnitude. The difference (E1-E2) will appear across the switch S.
When the secondaries are paralleled by closing the switch, a circulating current
appears even though the secondries are not supplying any load. The circulating
current will depend upon the total leakage impedance of the two transformers and also
the difference in their voltage ratios. Only a small difference in the voltage ratios will
be tolerated.
Division of load between transformers in parallel. Equal voltage ratios When the
transformers have equal ratios E1=E2 in Fig N1, the equivalent current of the two
transformers would then be as shown in Fig N2 on the assumption that the exciting
current can be neglected in comparison to the load current.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
100
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
also I 1 + I 2 = I L
Z2
S1 = SL
Z1 + Z 2
Z1
S2 = SL
Z1 + Z 2
where S1 = VL * I1
S2 =VL *I 2
SL = VL * IL
The above equations S1 , S2 and S L are phasor relationships giving loadings in the
magnitude and phase angle.
(iii) Selsyns: Selsyns or synchros are control system components which are used for
transmission of small torques or motions electrically. They can be categorize into
three kinds:
(a) for transmission of small torques electrically, as sinchro-transmitter-receiver
pair (Fig P2)
(b) for indicating the difference in positions, as generator – transformer
combination (Fig P3)
(c) as differential selsyns(Fig P4)
In the synchro-transmitter-receiver pair (Fig P2) which is a single phase
Jo
selsyn, the stator has three windings like the polyphase induction motor. The
in
rotor is similar to the rotor of a small alternator and of one winding. Fig P1
@
101
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Although it shows three stator windings, it is still a single –phase device. Any
a.c. current in the rotor will produce at “stand–still” three stator voltages
which are in time phase. Two of these devices in the circuit of Fig P2 provides
a system for transmission of motion.
It is assumed that the generator and motor are similar units and that for the initial
conditions the voltages produced on the stator of the generator by the generator rotor
are equal in magnitude and 1800 out of phase with those produced by the motor rotor
in the motor stator. Under these conditions the stator currents will be zero and no
Jo
If the rotor of the generator is turned through an angle θ while the position of the
SP
rotor of the motor is left unchanged, a circulating current Ia will result in the stators.
P
The current acting on the air gap flux will tend to restore the generator to its original
U
position. The current will produce a torque in the motor which wil tend to cause the
B
rotor of the motor to assume an angle corresponding to that occupied by the rotor of
TE
C
H
102
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
the generator. If the rotor of the motor is free to turn, it will follow the angular
position of the generator rotor. The rotor of the motor therefore is an indicator of the
position of the generator rotor or any device connected mechanically to it.
Selsyns as position indicators: If the circuit to the rotor of the motor is opened (Fig
P3) a voltage will be produced in the rotor winding, the magnitude of which is a
function of the angular position of the rotor of the motor w.r.t. that of the generator
rotor. When the motor rotor is at a position of 90 electrical degrees from the position
occupied and the rotor is electrically connected and free, the magnitude of the rotor
voltage will be zero. Then any movement of the generator rotor will produce a voltage
in the motor rotor which is a function of the angular position of the generator rotor (or
other equipment coupled to it). This circuit has found use in many servomechanism
systems. For this application the motor unit serves just as a control transformer.
A third useful application of the selsyn system is that of the differential selsyn shown
in Fig P4; this is constructed like a wound rotor induction motor having a 1:1 ratio of
turns. When the rotors of the motor and generator of Fig P3 are in a given position,
the differential selsyn will adjust the position of the rotor to its stator such that
minimum current flows in its windings. With the rotor of the motor locked in a
particular position, a change in the position of the generator rotor will cause a
corresponding change in the position of the rotor of the differential selsyn. In this way
Jo
the circuit of Fig P4 performs the same function as that shown in Fig P3.
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
103
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.17 Give the layout of a hydro – electric power plant and briefly explain the working of
any two of its main components. (14)
Ans: A typical hydroelectric development consists of a dam, which raises the water
surface of the stream to create head, pondage, storage or the facility or diversion into
conduits, an intake containing racks and gates to control the flow into the conduits, a
conduits system to convey the water to the turbines which transform the energy of the
water into mechanical energy, generators to transform the mechanical energy of the
hydraulic turbines into electrical energy, a power house to contain the turbines,
generators and accessories and a draft tube to convey the water from the turbine to the
tailrace which leads back to the stream.
104
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
From the reservoir, the water flows through the intake 1 and penstock 2 to the
hydraulic turbines 3. On flowing through the turbines where it gives up its energy ,
the water flows through the draft tube to the tail race. The turbine rotates the rotor of
the generator 4. As a result, electric current is induced in the generator stator 5. The
current is conveyed via the buses 6 to the step-up transformer 7, and then to the
switchgear 8. From the switchgear, the current is directed through the power lines 9 to
the loads.
Two of its main components are described below:
Hydraulic Turbines
A hydraulic turbine is a prime mover which transforms the energy of falling water
into mechanical energy of rotation and whose primary function is to drive a water
wheel hydroelectric generator. The turbine runner and rotor of the water wheel
generator are usually mounted on the same shaft, which is why the entire assembly is
frequently referred to as the turbo- generator.
An impulse turbine is one in which the driving energy is supplied by the water in
kinetic form; and a reaction turbine is one in which the driving energy is provided by
the water partly in kinetic and partly in pressure from.
Switchgear
The functions of the switchgear may be briefly summarized as follows
(i) To localize the effects of faults by operation of protective equipment and to
automatically disconnect faulty plant from the system.
(ii) To break efficiently, short-circuits without giving rise to dangerous conditions.
(iii) To facilitate re-distribution of loads, inspection and maintenance of the
system.
The design and construction of the switchgear layout should be such that a
reliable service is obtained under all operating conditions and in, as direct a
route as possible from the alternators to the outgoing feeders. The choice of
suitable switchgear is governed by the maximum short circuit-MVA it is
called upon to deal with and also to some degree upon its relation to the
system of which it forms a part. The figure of short circuit MVA is needed for
installing suitable circuit breakers.
Jo
in
105
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
2
K1 I 2 + K 2 V > 0
in
or
@
1 2
K1
SP
V
= < = rs
− 2
P U
B
TE
C
H
106
-T
el
eg
ra
m
µ
. With the K
IZ combination
Z www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
of superior
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
If K2 is made negative, such a relay senses impedance magnitude, and operates if the
magnitude of impedance seen from its location(in any direction) is less than a
specified value. Since V prevents relay operations, K 2 being negative, and I tries
to operate it, voltage is the restraining quantity and current is its operating quantity.
A modified impedance relay called mho relay results if a directional relay is
restrained by voltage. Thus
2
Q = K2 V I cos(θ −τ ) − (−K1) V − K4
or
V K3 ___________
(1)
= Z < cos(θ − τ )
I − K1
The right hand side of Eqn (1) is a circle with centre located in the line determined by
the parameter τ and passing through the origin as shown in Fig D3. The characteristic
in this case is inherently directional. This characteristic can be alternatively expressed
as
:
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
107
-T
el
eg
ra
m
−
Z ZZrsr><
s Z r sblock
Z rs tr ip www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(iv) What is welding process and explain principle of electric welding. (14)
Ans:
(i) Servomotor: Servomotors are of two kinds, d.c. and a.c. These are described
below:
The two-phase ac servomotor [Fig E4] on the other hand is ideally suited for
low power control applications. The two phases are called control phase
(phase a) and reference phase (phase m), the latter being excited at a fixed
Jo
magnitude of synchronous a.c. voltage, both voltages being taken from the
in
same source
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
108
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The control phase voltage is shifted in phase by 90o from the reference phase voltage
by means of phase shifting networks. The motor torque gets reversed by phase
reversal of control phase voltage. This motor has low rotor inertia and hence faster
response; also it has no brushes that contact the commutator segments.
109
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
• Surface hardening
• Deep hardening
• Tempering
• Soldering
• Melting
• Smelting etc.
(iv) Electrical welding
Welding is the process of joining metals of similar composition by heating to suitable
temperature with or without application of pressure and addition of filter material.
The result of welding is a continuity of the homogeneous material and is of the same
composition and characteristics as the parts, which are joined together.
Welding process may be classified as :
(i) Pressure welding: The process in which the metal parts to be joined are heated
to a plastic stage and then joined by applying external forces are known as plastic or
pressure welding.
(ii) Fusion welding: The process in which the metal parts to be joined are heated
to molten state and then allowed to solidify joining a localized homogeneous union of
Jo
commonly used kind of pressure welding. It can be applied to almost any metals with
B
110
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
halved and when it is quadrupled then current is reduced to 1/4th of its initial value.
in
@
Thus we conclude that if voltage is increased to n times then the current will be
SP
reduced to 1/nth times for the same power.With the reduction of the current to 1/nth
times, the conductor area will also be reduced to 1/nth times of its original area for
PU
the same current density, Hence less material is required when the voltage is increased
B
TE
C
H
111
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
We also know that when the current passes through any conductor, there is loss of
power in that particular conductor according to the relation, I2 R. As the loss is
proportional to the square of the current. So if the current is reduced to ½ value , then
the loss will be reduced to 1/4th its original value. Hence the efficiency of the
transmission line and all others equipments associated with the line will increase and
more power will be available for use.
When current is passing through a conductor there will be a voltage drop according to
the relation V=IR. So, when the current is reduced the drop of the voltage is less in
the line, of course with the same cross sectional area of the conductor.
With the reduction of cross sectional area, considered the main advantage of
transmitting electrical energy at very high voltage viz 132kV , 220kV or even 400kV.
But in case of distribution system such high voltage is dangerous, so distribution
voltage is generally 400/230V.
Receiving unit comprises an attenuator, which reduces the signals to a safe value.
in
Band pass filter, which restricts the acceptance of unwanted signals. Matching
@
transformer or matching elements to match the impedances of line and receiving unit.
SP
P
Different frequencies are used in adjacent line sections. The choice of frequency
U
bands for various sections should be coordinated. The modulator, modulates 50Hz
B
TE
C
H
112
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
signals and the modulated signal is fed to the amplifier and is then transmitted via
coupling unit.
Q.21 What are the various types of electric drives? Compare their advantages and
disadvantages. State and explain the various factors which affect the selection of an
electric motor as industrial drive. (14)
Closed-loop control of d.c. drives usually involves one or more feddback loops. The
relevant signals are sampled through transducers at discrete instants for computational
purposes; also switching of power semiconductor devices is accomplished by
gate/base control. Fig M14 shows a block–cum schematic diagram of a typical
separately excited d.c. drive which has an outer speed loop and an inner current
control loop. The motor speed is sensed by a tachometer, the output of which is fed
Jo
through an A/D converter to the microcomputer. However a shaft encoder can also be
in
used for this purpose, and the digital output of the shaft encoder can be directly fed to
the microcomputer. The armature current of the motor can be sensed by measuring the
@
SP
113
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Field
A/D Field
power
converter converter
Current
sensing
Technogenerator Single-
phase
ac supply
Fig. M14 Block diagram of a separately excited dc drive
Till recent times variable speed drive application were dominated by d.c.
motors. Squirrel cage induction motor which costs approximately one – third
of a d.c.-motor of the same rating, is quite rugged, maintenance free, can be
built for higher speeds, torques and power ratings. Wound rotor induction
motors, through costlier than squirrel cage ones, also need less maintenance
and are available in higher power ratings. Thus a.c. drives have succeeded in
replacing dc drives in a number of variable speed applications. For control of
a.c. motors that include both types of induction motors as well as synchronous
motors fed from d.c. supply, thyristor, transistor or MOSFET based inverters
are employed. These semiconductor switching circuits transfer energy from dc
supply to an a.c. load of variable frequency and/or variable voltage. The
switching operation results in considerable harmonics in the input a.c.
waveforms which are filtered out by the a.c. motor. The normal power supply
being of the a.c. type, the complete scheme involves a converter and then an
inverter.
A cycloconverter is a direct a.c. to a.c. converter for obtaining variable
voltage low frequency a.c. supply from a fixed frequency one. Thus it
Jo
eliminates the necessity of on intermediate d.c. stage. Inspite of their direct a.c
in
114
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Speed
circuitry
motor
dc
Microcomputer www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(iii) the input power factor is low. Cycloconverters are used for low-speed
drives and controlling linear motors in high-speed transportation systems.
Ans:
(i) Induction Furnace: Induction heating processes make use of currents induced
by electro-magnetic action in the material to be heated. It is, however only in
materials of low resistivity such as metals that sufficient currents to cause effective
heating can be produced. For this purpose it is often necessary to use a magnetic field
of very high frequency. For melting or refining metals, various kinds of induction
furnaces are available, while for other purposes such as case hardening and soldering,
the necessary currents are induced in the article at the appropriate stage of its
manufacture; the latter process requires a high frequency and is called as the high-
frequency eddy current heating.
The core type furnace is essentially a transformer in which the charge to be heated
forms the secondary circuit and is magnetically coupled to the primary by an iron-
core as shown in Fig N1. It can be seen from this figure that the magnetic coupling
between the primary and the secondary is poor. The electromagnetic forces cause
turbulence of the molten metal which, although useful upto a point, is liable to
become to severe. A crucible of inconvenient shape from metallurgical point of view
is used. In order to start the furnace, a complete ring of metal must be present in the
crucible, otherwise the secondary circuit will not be complete.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
115
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Chore
Cone
An improvement over the conventional core type furnace is the vertical core type
furnace which overcomes some of the above mentioned difficulties. It is known as the
Ajax-Wyatt furnace [Fig N2] and uses a vertical instead of horizontal channel for the
charge. The tendency of the circuit to repture due to the pinch effect is counteracted
by the weight of the charge in the main body of the crucible. The circulation of
molten metal is kept up round the Vee portion by convection currents and by the
electromagnetic forces between the currents in the two halves of the Vee. Such a
furnace is very widely used in foundries for melting and refining brass and other not-
ferrous metals.
(ii) Buchholz’s relay : The Buchhloz’s relay is a gas operated relay in which the
development of a fault within the transformer, particularly in the incipient stage is
guarded. Also major breakdowns and sudden disruption of supply are avoided, thus
Jo
having conservator vessels and is installed in the pipeline between the transformer and
@
its conservator tank. The relay comprises an oil tight container fitted with two internal
SP
floats which contain mercury switches connected to external alarm and tripping
P
circuits. Normally the device is full of oil and the floats, due to their buoyancy rotate
U
116
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
a) An incipient fault within the transformer generates small bubbles of gas which
pass upward, towards the conservator, become trapped in the top of the chamber,
thereby, causing the oil level to fall. The upper float gets deflected as the oil level
within the relay falls and when sufficient oil has been displaced, the mercury
switch contacts close, thus completing the electrical alarm circuit.
GAS AND OR
ACTUATED RELAY
b) For a serious fault within the transformer, the gas generation is more violent and
the oil displaced by the gas bubbles flows through the connecting pipe to the
conservator. This abnormal flow of oil causes the lower floats to be deflected thus
actuating the contacts of the second mercury switch and completing the tripping
circuit of the transformer circuit breaker, thus disconnecting the transformer from
the supply. The arrangement for mounting the gas and oil actuated relay is shown
Jo
in Fig N3.
in
@
117
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
the conductors of a three phase line with unsymmetrical spacing. For the purpose of
this discussion it is assumed that there is no neutral wire so that the conductor currents
sum upto zero. That is
This arrangement causes each conductor to have the same average inductance over the
transposition cycle. It can be shown that over the length of one transposition cycle, the
total flux linkages and hence the net voltage induced in a nearby telephone line is zero
and also that the power line transposition is ineffective in reducing the induced
telephone line voltage
i) when the power line currents are unbalanced (that is the sum I a + I b + I c ≠ 0 ) or
Jo
ii) when they contain third harmonics. These harmonic line currents are undesirable
in
because:
@
SP
b) higher frequencies come within the audible range. Thus there a need to avoid the
U
B
118
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
From figure, flux increases from its zero value to maximum value Φm in one quarter of the
cycle i.e. 1/4f second
Average rate of change of flux = Φ m /(1/4f)
Jo
= 4 f Φ m Wb/s
in
Average emf/turn =4 f Φm
SP
P
If flux Φ varies sinusoidally, then rms value of induced emf is obtained by multiplying the
U
B
119
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.24 Draw the characteristic curves and state two applications for
(i) a dc shunt motor
(ii) a dc series motor. (4)
Ans:
3(a) Characteristic curves & applications
D.C. shunt motor :-
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
120
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Applications :- Due to the constancy of their speed shunt motors are suitable for driving
shafting, machine tools, lathes, wood working machines and for all purposes where an
approximately constant speed is required.
DC Series Motor:-
Jo
in
@
SP
Applications:- Traction work, trolley cars, hoists & cranes, conveyors — etc.
P U
B
TE
C
H
121
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.25 With a neat diagram explain the working of a universal motor. Also draw its
torque-speed characteristics when it is fed from both ac & dc sources. (7)
Ans:
4. (a) Universal motor :-
Q.26 Explain the construction, working and applications of a stepper motor. (7)
Ans:
Stepper motor :-
Jo
Construction: Stepper motor consists of a slotted stator equipped with two or more
in
individual coils and a rotor structure that carries no winding .The classification of the stepper
@
motor is determined by how the rotor is designed. If the rotor is made up of a permanent
SP
magnet, it is called a PM stepper motor. If no magnet exists on the rotor (only a rotor core) it
is called a reluctance type stepper motor. The presence of the permanent magnet in the rotor
P U
122
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Operation:-
The elementary operation of a four phase stepping motor with a 2-pole rotor is explained
below.
With the above construction of a stepper motor the rotor assumes the angles θ = 0°, 45°,
90°, 135°, 180°…etc. as the windings are excited in the sequence of Na, Na+ Nb, Nb, Nb+ Nc,
Nc…etc.
The same motor can also be used for 90° steps by exciting the coils singly i.e. Na, Nb,
Nc , Nd only. For the use of 90° steps only the permanent magnet rotor can be used.
Applications :-
(1) Typewriters, printers
(2) Positioning of disk drives
(3) Plotters
(4) Recording heads in computer disk drives
(5) Worktable and tool positioning in CNC machines.
Major advantage of using stepper motors is that no feedback is required from the rotor
Jo
Ans:
P U
123
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The transfer of energy from stator to the rotor of an induction motor takes place entirely
inductively with the help of flux mutually linking the two. Hence an induction motor is
essentially a transformer with stator forming the primary and rotor forming the rotating
secondary.
Transformer Induction Motor
(1) Secondary is stationary (1) Secondary winding is rotating
(2) Secondary is not short circuited (2) Secondary is always short circuited
(3) No-load current is about 1% of full load (3) No-load current is approximately 30 to 50%
current (due to low reluctance path of full current (due to high reluctance
of steel core) of air gap)
(4) emf induced in secondary depends on (4) Depends on K and slip also
K (turns ratio)
(5) Frequency of primary and secondary currents (5) Frequency of stator current (f)and rotor
are same current (sf) are not the same.
(iii) A C servomotors.
OR
Switched reluctance motors. (5+5+4)
Ans:
For power transformers frequency response is of no serious interest because these units are
operated at a single fixed frequency. Frequency response is to be studied in communication
circuits where the frequency of source voltage is likely to vary.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
124
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Equivalent circuit :
Frequency Response :
Fig (a)
125
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Fig (a)
Fig (b)
Jo
in
@
SP
Fig (c)
P
U
B
TE
C
H
126
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
When only IF is present the, mmf is perpendicular to MNA (Figure (a). When only
Jo
armature current is present, mmf is along the MNA. When the machine is actually working,
in
the resultant mmf vector is at an angle form MNA. This causes the brushes to be shifted to a
@
new MNA perpendicular to resultant mmf. Now at this new MNA, mmf of Ia is along new
SP
MNA. This mmf is resolved into two component Fd and Fc which are demagnetizing and
P U
127
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(iii) AC Servomotors :
Generally a large X/R ratio is used in induction motor to have high torque at the
operating region i.e. around 5% slip. But in a servomotor, for a small X/R the characteristic is
nearly a linear in contrast to high nonlinear characteristic of large X/R. When large X/R is
used for servo application because of the positive slope for part of characteristic (a) the
system using such a motor becomes unstable.
OR
Jo
It has either the conventional split phase stator and a centrifugal switch for cutting out
@
the auxiliary winding after startup. The squirrel cage type rotor is of unsymmetrical magnetic
SP
construction. The rotor offers variable magnetic reluctance to the stator flux, the reluctance
P
varying with the position of the rotor. The basic operating principle is that when a magnetic
U
B
piece of material is located in a magnetic field a force acts on the material, tending to bring it
TE
C
H
128
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
into the densest portion of the field. The force tends to align the specimen of material
in such a way that the reluctance of the magnetic path that lies trough the material will be
minimum.
When the stator winding is energized the revolving magnetic field exerts reluctance
torque on the unsymmetrical rotor tending to align the salient pole axis of the rotor with axis
of the RMF (due to minimum reluctance). If the reluctance torque is sufficient to start the
motor and its load, the rotor will pull into step with the rotating field and to run at the speed
of the revolving field.
The switched reluctance machine is a special variation of the simple reluctance machine
that relies on continuous switching of currents in the stator to guarantee motion of the rotor. It
is also a true reluctance machine in that it has salient poles both in rotor and in the stator.
Q.29 What do you understand by electric heating? State its advantages over other
methods of heating. (7)
Ans:
Electric heating
Electric heat is provided by use of a high temperature wire, which is resistant to electric
flow with more heat being produced by more electric current being fed into the heating
element, creating more resistance and more heat. This method of producing heat is called
electric heating.
1. Cleanliness
5. Quicker operation
Jo
6. Higher efficiency
in
129
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.30 Describe the resistance welding method and name the other welding methods. (7)
Ans:
Types of Welding :
Resistance Welding :
Resistance welding is a process used to join metallic parts with electric current. In all forms
of resistance welding, the parts are locally heated until a molten pool forms. These parts are
then allowed to cool and the pool freezes to form a weld nugget. To create heat electric
current is passed through work pieces. The heat generated depends on the resistance and
thermal conductivity of the metal and the time for which the electric current is applied. The
heat is expressed by the equation.
E= I2Rt
E is the heat energy
I is the current
R is the electrical resistance
t is the time for which the current is applied.
Q.31 List out the advantages of nuclear power plants over conventional thermal power
plants. (4)
Ans:
Advantage of Nuclear Power Plants
1. Nuclear Power station reduces the demand for oil coal and gases.
2. Weight of nuclear fuel required for a given station capacity is negligible compared to
that required for a conventional thermal power station. As a result the problems of
Jo
3. The area and volume need for a nuclear power station is less in comparison to a
@
130
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.32 Draw a flow diagram of a thermal power station and explain its main components.
(10)
Ans:
Flow diagram of thermal power station :
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
131
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.33 Draw the per phase equivalent circuit of a 3 phase induction motor and derive the
expression for torque. (2)
Ans:
(a) Per phase Equivalent circuit of Induction Motor
Torque Equation:
Rotor input = torque x ws
Torque/phase = rotor input / ws = rotor cu loss/ (ws s)
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
132
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.34 What do you mean by transmission line efficiency and regulation? Can it be
negative also? (4)
Ans:
Transmission Efficiency:-
The ratio of receiving end power to the sending end power of a transmission line is
known as the transmission efficiency of the line.
% Transmission Efficiency =(Receiving end power /Sending end power) x 100;
= (VR IR cosφR/ VS IS cosφS) x100;
where VR ,IR and cosφR are the receiving end voltage, current and power factor while VS, IS
cosφS are the corresponding values at sending end.
Voltage Regulation :-
The difference in the voltage at the receiving end of a transmission line between the
conditions of no load and full load is called voltage regulation and is expressed as a
percentage of the receiving end voltage.
Mathematically,
% voltage regulation =(VS –VR)/VR x 100;
%Voltage regulation is also given by= (I R cos φR ± I X sin φR)/ER x100;
+ for lagging pf
– for leading pf;
When the pf is leading, and the term IX sin φR is more than the I R cosφR, then the voltage
regulation becomes –ve.
Q.35 With the help of neat sketches explain different types of distribution systems. (10)
Ans:
Different types of distribution systems :-
(i) Radial system :
In this system separate feeders radiate from a single sub station and feed the distributors at
one end only. Figure shows a single line diagram of a radial system for a DC distribution
Jo
The radial system is employed only when power generated at low voltage and sub-station is
located at the center of the load.
P U
B
TE
C
H
133
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The sub-station supplies to the closed feeder LMOPQRS. The distributors are tapped from
different points M, O, and Q of the feeder through distribution transformer. This system has
the advantage of continuity of supply and less voltage fluctuations.
Jo
When the feeder ring is energized by two or more than two generating stations or substations
SP
134
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
In the above diagram of the inter-connected system the closed feeder ring ABCD is
supplied by two sub stations S1 and S2 at D and C. Inter connected system has the advantages
of increased service reliability and increasing efficiency of the system by reducing reserve
power capacity.
Ans:
(i) Industrial drive and their control :-
Any motor with a speed control arrangement can be termed as a drive. The application
of these drives for industrial purposes are almost universal since they posses inherent
advantages over other forms of conventional drives viz, it’s cleaner, more easily controllable
and more flexible. Both AC and DC are used for electric drives.
There are two types of drives viz, group drive and individual drive. Each machine
having its own driving motor is called individual drive. When a no. of machines are driven
through belts from a common shaft ,it is called group drive. Selection of the type drive
depends on the application to be served.
Control :- Mostly DC shunt /series motor and induction motor are used as drive motors in
industry.
Jo
135
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(b) Draw in system : In this method, conduit or duct of glazed stone or cast iron or
concrete are laid in the ground with manholes at suitable positions. The cables are then
pulled into position from manholes. Figure shows section through four way underground
duct line. Three of the ducts carry information cables and fourth duct carries relay
protection connection, pilot wires. Care must be taken that where the duct line changes
the direction, depths, dips and offsets are made with a very long radius or it will be
difficult to pull a very large cable between manholes.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
136
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(c) Solid system : In this method of laying the cable is laid in open pipes or troughs
dug out in earth along the cable route. The troughing is of iron, stone ware, asphalt or
treated wood. After the cable is laid in position, the troughing is filled with a bituminous
or asphaltic compound and covered. Cables laid in this manner are usually plain lead
covered because troughing affords good mechanical protection.
On long lines carrier pilot relaying is cheap and more reliable than the pilot wire
relaying even though it is expensive and complicated than with pilot wire relaying.In this
type of protection the phase angle between two ends of the line decides whether the fault is
internal or external. When a voltage of positive polarity is impressed on the control circuit , it
generates a high frequency o/p between on phase conductor and ground. Each carrier current
receiver receives carrier current from its local transmitter as well as from the transmitter at
the other end of the line. These signal are then compared for any fault condition and action is
taken correspondingly. Traps are used to confine the carrier currents to the protected section
so as to avoid interference from other carrier current channels.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
137
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.37 Can a transformer be used to transform direct voltage and direct current? Justify
your answer. (5)
Ans: The transformer can not be used for dc supply system (dc voltage & current).
According to working principle of the transformer, it works on Faraday laws of
Electromagnetic Induction. Therefore, induced emf e = (-dΦ /dt). The changing rate of
magnetic flux is responsible for e.m.f generation, which opposes the change of magnetic
flux, that is indicated by negative sign. But in case of dc supply system (d.c Voltage &
Current), there is no change of magnetic flux, dΦ = 0, so that induced emf at secondary
side of transformer is zero. Therefore, we can not use transformer for dc supply system.
Q.38 How does a salient-pole rotor differ from a cylindrical rotor in synchronous
machines. Where are the salient-pole type of synchronous machines used?
(3+3)
Ans:
Q.39 Explain the effect of ‘armature reaction’ on the performance of D.C. motor. (8)
Armature reaction means effect on magnetic field distribution, this works in two ways:
Jo
138
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Fig - (i)
Fig - (ii)
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
Fig - (iii)
TE
C
H
139
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The first effect leads to reduce the speed of dc motor and second to produce sparking
at brushes. For armature reaction illustration, two poles have been considered and
initially assumed that there is no current in the armature conductors. The assumptions
are as under:
- That the flux is distributed symmetrically with respect to polar axis, which is
line joining the centres of NS poles.
- The magnetic neutral axis or plane (M.N.A) coincides with the geometrical
neutral axis(G.N.A)
The figure (i) shows flux distribution by poles (N&S) without armature current and
figure (ii) shows field or flux set up by armature conductors. And figure (iii) shows
the resultant flux or (mmf) component ‘OF’ which is found by vectorally combining
OFm and OFA.
- To transfer power from one circuit to another circuit, used in control and
Jo
regulation devices.
in
140
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
- Signal Pulse Transformer: These are used for delivery of signal at output.
SP
The transformers deliver pulse like signal or series of pulses. The turns ratio of
P
141
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
This motor is similar to a 3-phase induction motor except its stator is provided
with a single phase winding and a centrifugal switch is used in some types of
motors, in order to cut out a winding used only for starting purpose. This
motor has distributed stator winding and squirrel cage rotor. When stator is fed
from single phase supply, its stator winding produces a flux which is only
alternating. This alternating or pulsating flux acting on a stationary squirrel
cage rotor cannot produce rotation (only a revolving field can). Therefore,
single phase motors are not self-started.
142
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Total torque T = Tf + Tb
Tf = forward torque
Tb = backward torque
To make single phase induction motor self starting, it is temporarily converted
into a two phase motor during starting period. For this purpose, the stator of a
single phase motor is provided with an extra winding known as starting
winding. Two windings are spaced at 900 electrically apart and connected in
parallel across single phase supply.
These motors are widely useful in home, offices, factories/workshop & in
business establishment etc.
143
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
• Smaller in size.
(b) What are the essential differences between H.V. and L.V. switchgears? (7)
Ans: (a) Different Levels Of Voltages For Generation, Transmission And Distribution:
- The long distance high power transmission is by EHVAC lines 220 kV,
400 kV & 760 kV Ac. In special cases, HVDC line is preffered. The rated
voltages of HVDC lines are ±250 kV, ± 400 kV, ± 500 kV & ± 600 kV.
- Utilization is at the low voltages upto 1kV and medium voltage upto 11 kV.
SP
and step down it to 440 V AC. Larger industries receive power at 132 kV and
U
B
144
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
- alkaline cells.
@
SP
Lead acid cells are used in electric substation for emergency lighting, to
P
provide d.c supply for various relays, to provide d.c supply for telephone
U
145
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.45 Why are solid-state controllers preferred over conventional controllers? Give
examples of their applications and explain their features. (14)
Ans: Solid State controllers Vs Conventional Controllers:
Primarly motor control circuit of conventional type consists of switches, fuses, relays,
contactors and associating cabling. This type of conventional contactor control system
become bulky if implemented for complicated logic. The trouble shooting also
becomes difficult and time consuming.
On the other side, solid state controller made up by electronic components / devices
are used to implement such schemes in place of conventional contactor control which
are efficient, reliable and need less time for trouble shooting.
A PLC (Programmable Logic Controller) is known as solid state controller. The main
difference between relay logic controller and computer based solid state controller
(PLC) are:
- All input, output variables are in binary form
- In relay logic programming whenever any event sequence is to be changed,
rewiring of panel is necessary which was cumbersome. In computer based
Jo
that allow any process logic to be implemented by programming of PLC. It avoids lot
P
of external control wiring. The PLC can be programmed according to user’s need and
U
146
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
PLC operation: A PLC work is based on continuous scanning program. It has three
steps
- Check input status.
- Execute program.
- Update output status.
147
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The rotor is made by a smooth chrome steel cylinder having high retentivity
so that the hysteresis loss is high. It has no winding. The rotor poles are
magnetically locked up with revolving stator poles of opposite polarity.
However rotor poles lag behind the stator poles by an angle α. The mechanical
power developed in a hysteresis motor :
Pm = Ph (1-s)/s where Pm = Mechanical power developed
Ph = Hysteresis loss in rotor
Th = Hysteresis torque
and Th = 9.55 Pm / NS
These motors are useful for driving tape- decks, turn table and other precision
Jo
audio equipments. The commercial motors have two poles, they run at 3,000
rpm at 50 Hz , single phase supply.
in
@
SP
148
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
149
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
- Electrolyte : Alkali or organic, alkali required for zinc cathode and organic
for lithum cathode.
- Nominal voltage : for Zinc cathode = 1.5V to 1.65V ; for lithium cathode =
1.5 V to 3.0V
- End point Voltage : for Zinc cathode = 1.0V to 1.4V ; for lithium cathode =
1.2 V to 2.0V
Over excited synchronous motors having leading power factor are widely used for
improving power factor of those systems which employ a large number of induction
motors and other devices having lagging power factor such as welders and fluorescent
lights etc.
In constant speed applications, synchronous motors are well suited due to their high
efficiency and high speed, such as centrifugal pumps, belt driven reciprocating
compressors, blowers, line shafts, rubber and paper mill etc.
Voltage in long transmission lines varies greatly at the end when large inductive load
are present and when inductive load disconnected suddenly, the voltage tends to rise
considerably above its normal value because of line capacitance. Therefore, by
installing a synchronous motor with field regulator, the voltage rise can be controlled.
150
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
N α 1/Φ ; By decreasing flux, speed can be increased and vice – versa. The
flux of DC motor can be changed by changing the field current with the help
of shunt field rheostat.
N α (V-Ia Ra), The speed / armature current characteristics show that greater
the resistance in armature circuit , greater fall in speed.
Shunt field of motor is connected permanently to a fixed exciting voltage, but
armature is supplied with different voltages by connecting it across one of the
several different voltage by means of suitable switchgear.
Q.49 Why are starters used for starting 3-phase induction motors? (4)
- With transformers having different kVA ratings, the equivalents impedances should be
in
avoided
SP
In case of 3 phase transformers’ parallel operation, the following conditions are also added
P
- The voltage ratio must refer to terminal voltage of primary and secondary.
TE
C
H
151
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
- The phase displacement between primary & secondary voltages must be the same for all
transformers, which are to be connected for parallel operation.
- The Phase sequence must be the same.
- All 3-Φ transformers must have same construction either core or shell.
CLASS APPLICATIONS
(1) Variable torque, power output α N2. Fans, centrifugal pumps.
(2) Constant –torque power output α N. Conveyors, stokers, reciprocating
Compressors, printing presses.
(3) Inverse torque power output rating constant. Machine Tools, lathes, boring mills,
drill, planers,.
The Multi-speed motors are of slip ring type used for hoist, conveyor and elevator.
Jo
in
(i) Cogeneration.
SP
P
152
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ans: Co-generation
The interconnection of hydro and thermal power generation plant or reuse of waste product of
first generator as a fuel of second generator or other machine :
The large power system comprising several power stations load centres interconnected to
form a single grid operation of such a grid is controlled from a load centre or load dispatch
centre. The national load control centre is linked with various regional despatching stations.
The regional load centres send commands from power stations to control room periodically
by telemetric data transmission system.
The automatic load frequency control in the control system of generator turbine governor
basically aim to maintain a constant frequency/speed as a primary control. But setting of the
governor for turbine is changed according to instruction of regional control centres.
Therefore, The input of turbine from governor gets automatically adjusted by primary load
frequency control and frequency is maintained. The governor setting is determined by
economy load dispatch instructions from regional load control centres. The total load
cogeneration control is achieved by:
(ii) Diesel Generator: These are used in medium power plants upto 25MW for industrial
and marine applications. The transportable diesel generator sets are for remote location, and
small power plants for small lawns /farms etc.
Generators are usually gear driven to speeds of 1000 to 1500 rpm for 50 Hz. Diesel engines
have a speed range of 1500 rpm to 2250 rpm (higher speed for gas turbine driven set)
The critical speed and torsional or natural frequencies are checked for diesel generator set to
avoid resonance. Brushless excitation is commonly used. The diesel generators are mounted
on same bed plate of prime mover.
Q.52(a) Explain the functions and basic requirements of a protective relay. (7)
(b) Compare the merits and demerits of overhead lines with an underground distribution
Jo
system. (7)
in
Functions:
P U
The protective relaying senses the abnormal conditions as a part of the power system and
B
TE
gives an alarm or isolate that part from the healthy system. The relays are compact, self-
C
H
153
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Basic requirements
- Selectivity, discrimination: The protective relaying should select the faulty part of the
system and should isolate, as far as possible only faulty part from the remaining healthy
system.
- Speed, Time: It is the time between fault instant and closing of relay. A rapid contact
fault cleaning i.e. 0.07 second with 60 kA rms value of current, has no damage to the
system but if it is 7 sec, the bus bar will destroy complete. Therefore, relay time must be
minimum as much as possible (i.e. in millisecond.)
Stability : A quality of protective system by the virtue of which , the protective system
remains operating and stable under certain specified conditions such as system disturbances,
through faults, transient etc.
Reliability : The protective relaying should not fail to operate in the event of faults in
protected zone. The reliability of protective systems depends on diverse aspects such as
protective gear manufactures, Electricity Boards & Associates.
154
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(b)
(A) Merit 1. Easy maintenance & 1. Less disturbances for other system
Repair 2. system looks neat and beautiful
2. Low cost of installation 3. Mostly used in distribution system .
(b) What is inductive interference? How is it caused and what steps are necessary to
reduce its effect? (7)
A welding process is required to join two metal parts by heating them to melting point.
Electrical welding is used for joining of fabricating structures, machinery parts, pipes, bus
bars, bridges, ships railway bogies etc.
- Resistance welding : In resistance welding the current is passed through the joint to be
Jo
welded and the heat is caused by I2 R losses in the joint, melting of metal and subsequent
in
- Arc welding : The heat is produced by the arc struck between the welding electrode and the
P
155
-T
el
eg
ra
m
400Less
(Medium
4.
High
3.
HV transmission.
kV
maintenance
Mostly
lightening
and low used
voltages
and
thunder
repair
upto
in
effect
costwww.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
11kW)
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.54 Identify the motor being used in the ceiling fan and explain the method of its control.
(14)
Single phase induction motor is used for ceiling fan; this motor is more or less similar
to polyphase induction motor, except that
(ii) Centrifugal switch is used in some types of motors in order to cut out a winding
used only for starting purposes; it has distributed stator winding and squirrel
cage rotor.
When single phase supply is fed, its stator winding produces a flux (or field) which is only
alternating i.e: one which alternates along one space axis only. It is not a synchronously
revolving (or rotating flux, as in the case of a two or three phase stator winding fed from 2 or
3 phase supply). Now, an alternating or pulsating flux acting on stationary squirrel cage rotor
can not produce rotation (only revolving flux can). Therefore, single phase is not self-starting.
To make single phase induction motor self starting the following method is adopted.
Split Phase method: In this method, phase is split by introducing a resistance and a switch
in starting winding and both windings are connected in parallel with supply.
reaches about 75% of full speed, the centrifugal switch ‘S’ is open and cuts out both the
in
starting winding and capacitor from supply, thus leaving only running winding across the
@
line.
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
156
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
157
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
i. AC Techometer:
158
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Ans: www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(iii) The carrier current protection: The carrier current protection scheme is used for
protection of transmission lines. The information about short circuit/earth fault of the
power transmission line is conveyed through carrier communication link. The carrier
current of frequency range 30 to 200 KHZ or 80 to 500 KHZ and received through the
transmission lines for the purpose of protection. In this system, each end of the line is
provided with identical carrier current equipment consisting of a transmitter, receiver,
line tuning unit, master oscillator, power amplifier etc.
Q.56 How are the power angle characteristics of synchronous machine obtained. (8)
Ans: Power angle characteristics of a synchronous machine :
P = (VE/ X ) sinδ
Where;
P = Power
V= Terminal voltage
E= Induced e.m.f.
P = ± Vi Ef. sinδ / XS
Jo
in
δ is considered positive for generator mode and negative for motor mode.
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
159
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The power output of a synchronous machine can be changed only by changing its
power output. Change in excitation does not change in power output. The change in
excitation will give only change in e.m.f and negative power supplied by the machine.
Ans:
Ia = (V-Eb)/Ra
160
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
When motor is at rest, no back emf will develop in armature. Now, if full supply
voltage is applied to stationary armature, it will draw very large current because
armature resistance is relatively very small.
∴ Ia = (V/Ra) ; Eb = 0
This excessive current is large and this will damage commutator, brushes etc. To
avoid this situation, a resistance is introduced in series with the armature for short
duration with the help of starter, which limit the starting current to safe value.
The starting resistance is gradually cut off and motor gets full speed with back e.m.f
under safe limit
Now Ia = (V-Eb )/Ra
However, very small motor can be started from rest by connecting directly to supply
These motors have relatively large armature resistance than larger motors. These
small motors also have low value of inertia.
When stationary coils are supplied with 3 phase supply, a uniform rotating magnetic
SP
field of constant value is produced. The flux due to current flowing in each phase
winding is assumed sinusoidal and is represented in figure (b) The direction of fluxes
PU
are shown in Fig. (c). Let maximum value of flux due to any one of the 3 phases be
B
TE
C
H
161
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Φm. The resultant flux Φr at any instant is given by the vector sum of the 3 individual
fluxes, Φ 1, Φ2, Φ3 due to 3 phases
Fig. (a)
φ1 = √3/2 φm
φ2 = - √3/2 φm
Jo
φ3 = 0
in
@
∴ φr = 3/2 φm
SP
And θ = 120o
PU
B
φ1 = √3/2 φm , φ2 = 0, φ3 = - √3/2 φm
TE
C
H
162
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Mathematical proof :
Q.59 Derive the hystersis torque expression of the hystersis motor. (8)
Jo
Usually, the shaded pole principle is employed for hystersis motor. The rotor of this
SP
motor is smooth, having high retentively, so that, hystersis loss is high. It has no
P
winding, the rotor poles magnetically locked up with the revolving stator poles of
U
B
TE
C
H
163
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
opposite polarity. However, rotor poles always lag behind stator poles by a small
angle ‘α’ and the rotor revolves synchronously.
The mechanical power developed by rotor is given by
Pm = Ph (1-S)/ S
Pm = Mech power developed
Ph = Hysteresis loss in rotor and hysteresis torque
Th = (9.55 Pm )/NS
Pm = (Eb Ia - losses)
= (60/2π ). (Pm/NS)
= (9.55 Pm / Ns)
This hysteresis torque is solely dependent on the area of rotor’s hysteresis loop.
• Generating stations
• Transmission systems
Jo
• Receiving station
in
@
• Distribution system
SP
P
• Load points
U
B
TE
C
H
164
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Generating stations:
In all these regions, there are switchgears. Bus bars are connecting bars to
which a number of local feeders are connected. Bus bars operate at constant
voltage. Besides the bus bars, there are other equipment in the electrical
schemes such as circuit breakers, CTs, PTs, etc. These equipments can be
installed according to various schemes depending upon requirements.
The power transformers are installed between two bus bars of different voltage
levels. A power transformer is the costliest, heaviest, and most important
equipment in substation.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
165
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Receiving system & load points for a medium size industrial work:
The switch gear is installed in the substation of local points, such as industrial
works, railway substation, cinema house, large building, foundries etc. The
substation has following items:
Jo
- Transformer section
@
SP
166
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The periodic rise and fall of water level of the sea can be used to convert wave energy
into electrical energy by moving turbine blades from fall and rise of water waves. In
about 24 hrs, there are two high & two low waves/ tides. The rise and fall of wave
follow sinusoidal curve.
The world first wave/dual power plant was commissioned at ‘Range’ in France. This
Jo
plant is of 240 mW capacity. There are three main components of a wave energy
in
- Power house
TE
C
H
167
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The turbines, electric generators and other auxiliary equipments are the main
equipments of power house.
Advantage
- Tidal/wave power has a unique capacity to meet peak power demand effectively
when it works in combination with hydropower plant or thermal power
Disadvantage:
- Power transmission cost is high because the tidal/wave power plant are located away
from load centre.
Opening time: interval of time between energizing the shunt trip coil and instant of
@
Breaking time: it is time between energizing of opening release and the instant of
P
168
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Closing time: The time interval between energizing of closing circuit and contact
touch with all poles.
Open close time: it is time between separation of arcing contacts all the poles and
contact touch in first pole deriving open close operation.
Reclosing time: Time between energizing of shunt trip release and contact toad in all
poles.
Close-open time: Time between contact touch in first pole and separation of arcing
contact in all poles during close open operation.
The rated characteristics of circuit breaker include rated normal current, rated voltage,
rated insulation level, rated transient recovery voltage, rated short circuit breaking
current, rated short circuit making current, rated operation sequence etc.
Q.62 Give a list of the factors involved for selecting a factory drive. (8)
Ans: Factors involved in selection of factory drives:
- Supply system : DC or AC
- Rating : kW, MW
- Drive : constant speed, Variable speed
- Special Condition : High starting torque, Hazardous location,
Traction duty etc.
- User’s requirement : Duty cycle, noise level, load characteristics etc
off load, load condition
- Enclosures & cooling requirement.
- Environment condition
- Applicable standards
- Cost considerations
(i). Core or iron losses: Core flux in transformer remains constant for all load. Its
in
variation is 1 to 3%. This losses are due to eddy current and hysteresis in the core of
@
transformer.
SP
2 2 2
We = PB max f t watt (eddy current losses)
B
TE
C
H
169
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(ii) Copper losses : These losses are due to ohmic resistance of transformer windings.
Therefore, WC I12R1 + I22 R2 = I12 R01 or I22 R02
Q.64 Describe how the synchronous reactance of a synchronous machine is determined. (6)
Ans: Synchronous reactance determination of a synchronous machine
Eo = No load e.m.f.
E= On load induced e.m.f.
V= Terminal voltage
Z= √(Ra2 + X L2) i.e: impedance
I= Armature current/phase
Φ= Load p.f. angle
Xs = Synchronous reactance
Hence, Xs = XL + Xa
Jo
Q.65 Explain how speed control is achieved for DC shunt motors. (4)
in
@
(i) Flux control method: N α 1 /Φ, By decreasing flux, the speed can be increased and
P
vice-versa. The flux of d.c. motor can be changed by changing Ish with the help of
U
B
170
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
N1 α (V - Iao Ra)
N1 α Eb1
@
Or
N2 α ( V - I a2 Rt)
SP
and
Rt = (R + Ra) Additional resistance added with armature in series
P U
B
TE
C
H
171
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
N 2 E b2
∴ =
N 1 E b1
V − I a. R t
=
− ao R a
Ward Leonard System: This system is used for wide range of speed control (i.e:
10:1) and it will provide a very sensitive speed control as required in colliery winders,
electric excavators, elevators.
By applying variable voltage across its armature, any desired speed can be
obtained. This variable voltage is supplied by a motor-generator set which consists of
either d.c. or an a.c motor M2 directly coupled to the generator.
Q.66 Explain how the circuit model of an induction motor is obtained from no-load and
block-rotor tests. (4)
Ans: (a) Induction Motor model :
Jo
in
Go = conductance
U
B
Bo = exciting susceptance
TE
C
H
172
-T
el
eg
ra
m
IV www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The method is for finding Go and Bo in running motor synchronously so that slip S = 0. In
practice it is impossible for an induction motor to run at synchronous speed, due to friction
and windage losses. Therefore, induction motor runs at synchronous speed by another
machine, which supplies the friction and windage losses. In this case, the above circuit
behaves like an open circuit.
Therefore, s= 0
RL = ∞
Hence current drawn by motor is I0 only.
Let V= applied voltage/phase
Io = Motor no load current /phase
W= Wattmeter reading i.e. input power in watt
Y0= exciting admittance of Motor
W= 3Go.V2 or Go = W/3V2 ; ( Go is no load conductance )
Wo = √3 . VL. Io .cos Φo
Jo
in
173
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.67 Draw the torque-speed characteristics of a single phase induction motor and explain
in
Torque developed by a single phase induction motor depends on its speed. But relationship
B
can not be represented by simple equation. It is easier to show the relationship between
TE
C
H
174
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
torque T and speed N in the form of curve. In this curve, it has been observed that at N=0, T1
= 1.5T and Tmax = 2.5T. This is called breakdown Torque.
At full load, the motor runs at a speed of N. when mechanical load increases, the motor speed
decreases till motor torque again becomes equal to the load torque. As long as the torques are
in balance, the motor will run at constant speed but lower speed. If the load torque exceeds to
2.5T, then motor will suddenly stop.
Q.69 (a) Describe the primary and back-up protection features that are provided for
transmission lines. (8)
(b) Describe a typical coreless type of induction furnace and its special features. (8)
Ans: a Primary and back-up protection:
The primary protection is essential protection provided for protecting a machine. As a
precautionary measure, an additional protection is generally provided and is called a
Jo
“Back up protection”. The primary protection is the first to act and back-up protection
in
is the next in the line of defence. Therefore, if primary protection fails, the back-up
@
protection comes into action and removes the faulty part from one healthy system.
SP
When main protection is inoperative for purpose of maintenance, testing etc. The
P
back-up protection acts like main protection. The back up protection can be classified
U
B
as:
TE
C
H
175
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
- Relay back-up : Same circuit breaker is used by both main and back-up
protection, but protective systems are different. Separate trip coils may be
provided for the same-breaker.
- Breaker Back-up: Different breakers are provided for main and back up
protection, both the breakers are being in the same station.
- Remote back-up: Main & back up protection provided at different stations and
are completely independent.
- Centrally coordinated back-up: Here system is having central control and it can
be provided with centrally controlled back-up. The central coordinating station
receives information about the abnormal conditions through high frequency
carrier signals. The stored programme in digital computer determines the correct
switching operation as regard severity of faults, system stability etc. Main
protection at various stations and back-up protection for all stations is at central
control centre.
The differential relay responds to vector difference between two or more similar
@
quantities.
SP
- The differential relay has at least two actuating quantities say I1, I2
P
U
- The two or more actuating quantities should be similar i.e. current 1 & current 2.
B
TE
C
H
176
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
- The relay responds to the vector difference between two i.e. I1~ I2 which includes
magnitude and/or phase angle difference.
Differential protection is generally a unit protection. The protected zone is exactly
determined by location of CTs. The vector difference is achieved by suitable
connection of CT or PT secondaries.
(ii) Inductive Interference in Transmission lines:
Inductive interference depends upon gradient of voltage at surface of conductor or
corona. The inductive reactance affected from conductor attenuation at 1000 kHz
varies from 0.3 to 0.9 dB/mtr.
(iii) Nickel cadmium cell
Nickel cadmium cells employ a solution of potassium hydroxide in distilled water as
electrolyte with a specific gravity of 1.200 at 16oC.
- Anode: NiOH and specially treated graphite
- Cathode: CdO, Fe2 O3
Cadmium oxide or iron oxide.
- AV. Voltage 1.2 V/Cell
1.3 V/Cell when fully charged.
The condition of battery can be determined with a voltmeter during charge or
discharge, while charging Ni-Cd battery, the temperature of electrolyte should not be
allowed to exceed 46oC. The battery does not bubble the gas until after the first
41/2 hrs when charging at the 7 Amp rate. No finishing rate is needed. The voltage of
charger should not be above 1.85 volt per cell.
Application : Type:
(1) Air craft, Emergency power application, Vent type
Industrial power supply communication
Equipment
Q.72 Give the lay-out of a typical thermal-power plant and briefly explain the working of
the super heater and the condenser. (8+4+4)
Jo
in
177
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(i) Super heater: The steam produced inside boiler is nearly saturated. This steam as
such should not be used in the turbine because the dryness fraction of the steam-
leaving boiler will be low. This results in the presence of moisture, which causes
corrosion of turbine blades etc. Therefore, to rise the temperature of steam, super
heater is used. It consists of several tube circuits in parallel with one or more return
bends connected between headers. Super heater tube range is from 1 to 2 inch in
diameter.
Jo
in
(ii) Steam condenser: Steam condenser is required to receive the exhaust steam from the
@
turbine or engine to condense it and maintain a pressure of the exhaust lower than
SP
atmospheric. Some extra work is obtained due to exhaust at pressure lower than the
P
atmospheric. This improves the efficiency of the plant. Air inside the condenser
U
178
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Advantages:
Q.73 With a neat diagram describe the construction of a lead acid cell and explain the
process of charging and discharging of the cell. (8+4+4)
Ans: Construction of lead acid cell and process of charging and discharging of cell:
A lead acid type batteries are known as secondary battery or cell, which can be
charged for reuse. This cell has following components:
- Separator : These are thin porous sheet suspended between positive and negative
electrode to prevent short circuit.
- Container : It contains all plates, electrolyte, separators, vent plug, cell connectors
and battery terminals. It is made of hard rubber.
- Cell connectors : These are used to connect a number of cells of same type (either
negative or positive) in series so as to provide required voltage.
Charging process:
Jo
in
positive electrode to negative electrode through the electrolyte and back to the source.
SP
This process results in rise in cell voltage 2 or 2.1 volts and specific gravity 1.230
P U
B
TE
C
H
179
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Discharging process:
When cell is fully charged anode is PbO2 and cathode is Pb. An external load is
connected to electrodes of cell, therefore, an electric current flows in load. The process is
known as discharging. A fully discharge cell has a voltage 1.8 volts and specific gravity
1.180.
The reaction-taking places at electrodes are
At anode : PbO2 + H2 + H2SO4 → PbSO4 + H2O
At Cathode: Pb + SO4→ PbSO4
Q.74 (a) What are the criteria for the classification of transmission lines as short, medium
and long lines? (8)
(b) Draw the schematic diagram of a directional overcurrent relay and explain its
working. (4)
(c) What are the advantages of high voltage transmission and its limitations. (4)
Ans: (a) Classification of transmission lines (Power)
The network of transmission lines is formed by three phase AC system. This is required
for Bulk power transfer from large group of generating stations to main transmission
network.
Short distance power transmission lines has voltage ≤ 11000 volts. These lines are
required to carry power from main sub-station to local distribution area. Further power
supply is distributed through pole mounted sub- station or plinth mounted sub-station.
voltages for medium lines an approximate rule is 1 kV/mile or 0.6 kV/km. kV= 5.5 √km x
in
0.6 + kW/100. These lines supply power directly to big organization or industry, which
@
180
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
A long distance power transmission line has voltage range 220 kV to 750 kV. These lines
are used for transfer of power from sending end to receiving end or for system inter-
connection for exchange of power between independently controlled networks. For longer
transmission lines, higher power transmission voltages are necessary (p α v2). Higher
voltage gives lesser current, lesser I2R losses, higher power transferability.
(b) : Schematic diagram of directional over current relay with its working:
Diagram:
The directional over current protection comprises over current relay and power
directional relay in a single relay casing. The power directional relay does not measure
the power but it is arranged to respond the direction of power flow. The directional
operation of relay is used where the selectivity can be achieved by directional relaying.
The directional relay recognizes the direction in which fault occur relative to the location
of relay. It is set such that it will actuate for fault occurring in one direction only. It does
not act for faults occurring in the other directions. In above diagram consider a feeder AB
phasing through subsection 1. The circuit breaker in feeder 1B is provided with a
directional relay R, which will trip the CB, if fault power flow in direction 1B alone.
Therefore, for faults in feeder 1A, the CB does not trip unnecessarily. However, for
faults in feeder 1B, CBB trips.
The choice of transmission systems and rated voltages for a transmission line is made
from HV AC (upto 220 kV) EHV AC (400 kV – 750 kV) UHVAC (above 760 kV AC)
Jo
Advantages :
SP
181
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
- Bulk power transfer from large group of generating stations upto main
transmission network.
Limitations:
In case of very long lines of above 500 km, intermediate switching sub-stations
are necessary to install the shunt reactors for compensation.
- Right of way:
- Line insulation:
The creep age distance (leakage distance) determined on the basis of required
impulse with stand level.
- Corona:
The critical value of voltage stress depends upon pressure, temperature, humidity,
pollution level in air.
182
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Jo
in
capacitor in series with the starting winding as shown in above figure. The capacitor is
SP
generally electrolyte type and mounted on the outside of the motor. This capacitor is
P
designed for extremely short duty service and is guaranteed for not more than 20 periods of
U
B
operation per hour, each period not to exceed 3 seconds. When motor reaches about 75% of
TE
C
H
183
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
full speed, a centrifugal switch S opens and cuts off both starting winding and capacitor from
the supply. Thus leaving only the running winding.
The torque developed by split phase motor is proportional to size of the angle between IS &
Im.
(ii) Switched Reluctance Motor :
This type of motor has either conventional split phase stator and a centrifugal switch for
cutting off auxiliary winding or a stator similar to that of permanent split capacitor run motor.
The stator produces resolving field. The working of this motor is that when a piece of
magnetic material is located in a magnetic field, a force acts on the material, tending to bring
it into the most dense portion of a field. The force tends to align the specimen of material in
such a way that the reluctance of the magnetic paths that lies through the material will be
minimum.
When stator winding is energized, the revolving magnetic field exerts reluctance
torque on the unsymmetrical rotor tending to align the salient pole axis of the rotor with the
axis of resolving magnetic field. If the reluctance torque is sufficient to start the motor and
its load, the rotor will pull into step with the revolving field and continue to run at speed of
revolving field. However, rotor poles lag behind stator poles by certain angle known as
torque angle.
The constant speed characteristic of a reluctance motor makes it very suitable for
signaling devices, recording instruments, timers, phonograph etc.
(iii) Stepper Motors
This motor rotate through a fixed angular step in response to each input current pulse
received by its controller. These motors can be controlled directly by computers,
microprocessors and programmable controllers. These motors used for precise positioning of
an object or precise control of speed without using closed loop feed back. The unique feature
of this motor is that its output shaft rotates in series of discrete angular interval or steps, one
step being taken each time a command pulse in received. When a definite number of pulses
are supplied, the shaft turns through a definite known angle. So that the motor is well suited
for open loop position control because no feed back is taken from output shaft.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
184
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Jo
in
@
SP
P
U
B
TE
C
H
185
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Truth Table
A B C θ
+ 0 0 0
0 + 0 30
0
+ 0 0 90
These motors develop torques ranging from 1 MN upto 40 N-m in a motor of 15 cm diameter
suitable for machine tool applications. Their power output ranges from about
1 W to Max of 2500 W. The moving part in stepper motor is its rotor which has no winding,
commutator or brushes. Therefore, the motor is quite robust and reliable.
Q.76 What are the conditions for satisfying parallel operation of single phase transformer?
Deduce an expression for the load shared by the two transformers in parallel when
the transformers have equal voltage ratio. (8)
186
-T
el
eg
ra
m
60
+
00
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
V = Secondary voltage
I1 = Input current
I2 = output current
v = voltage drop
v = I1 Z1 = I2Z2 = IZ12
Z12 = Z1 || Z2
I = equivalent current at output
∴ I2 = I Z1 / (Z1 + Z2)
∴ I1 = I Z2 / (Z1 + Z2)
187
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.77 Explain two important functions served by the damper winding in a synchronous
motor. State the various applications of synchronous motor. (7)
- The oscillatory motion of the rotor about the operating point is considerably reduced
in amplitude and rotor quickly returns to the steady position.
- At starting, the rotor achieves a speed close to synchronous speed and the rotor and
stator fields lock into each other as soon as field excitation is switched on.
- It is capable of being operated under a wide range of power factors, both lagging and
leading. Hence, it can be used for power factor correction purpose.
- In textile industry high speed drives are necessary with wide range of control.
Variable frequency drives with synchronous motors are used for speed control.
- An artificial fibre plant needs variable frequency synchronous motor and are supplied
by static frequency converters.
Q.78 Explain the process of building up of voltage in d.c. shunt generator and give the
conditions to be satisfied for voltage built-up. (7)
Ans: The DC shunt generator runs at constant speed and some emf will be generated due to
residual magnetism in the main poles. This small e.m.f circulates a field current,
which produces an additional flux to reinforce the original residual flux. This process
will continue and generator builds up the normal generated voltage.
∴ E0 = iRf + L di/dt
188
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
capacitor in series with starting winding. The Capacitor is generally electrolytic type
and its usually mounted on the outside of motor. The capacitor is designed for short
P U
duty service and when motor reaches 75% of full load speed. The centrifugal switch
B
‘S’ opens and cuts out starting winding and capacitor from supply only main winding
TE
C
H
189
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
remains in circuit. The torque developed depends on angle between Im & Is, that is
approximate 800.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
190
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.80 Explain the principle of operation of two phase servo motor. Draw its torque-slip
characteristics. (8)
For low power (few hundred watts) control applications, the two phases
(balanced) servo motor is ideally switched. As it can be driven by means of a
relatively rugged (drift free) as an amplifier. The motor torque can be easily controlled
by varying the magnitude of a.c voltage applied to the control phase (Va) of the
motor, while second phase called reference phase (phase Vin) is excited at a fixed
voltage. Synchronous a.c voltage must be drawn from the same source. The control
phase is shifted in phase by 900 from the reference phase voltage by means of a phase
shifting networks included in voltage application stages of amplifier. The motor
torque gets reversed by phase reversal of control phase voltage.
For linear stable operation, the speed torque- characteristics of a servomotor must be
linear with negative slope (torque reducing with increasing speed). It is suitable for
the position control system.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
191
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The steam after expansion through the turbine goes to condenser to improve efficiency of the
power plant by decreasing the exhaust pressure of the steam below atmosphere. Another
advantage of condenser is that condensed steam can be recovered and this provides a source
of good and pure feed water to the boiler. Thereby, reducing considerably the water softening
plant capacity. The air and non condensable gases are removed from the steam, when it
passes through the condenser.
Once fission process is started in a few nuclei of fission materials, it should be able to
continue throughout the remaining material without external interference. For each act of
fission, nearly 2.5 neutrons capable of causing further fission are proceeded. A self-sustaining
chain reaction is not possible. The leakage of neutron through it is inevitable. Both fission
and non fission reduces the number of neutrons actually available to maintain the chain
reaction.
The reproduction factor (k) is defined as:
k=
The desirable requirement of power reactor is that the system should be critical i.e
k =1. When we want to control reactor, we have to change the value of k. At the
Jo
time of starting the reactor value of k has to be raised above 1. This will increase the power
level.
in
@
Once the required power level has been reached, k is to be reduced to 1 and should
SP
be kept at this value as long as the out-put rate is to be kept constant. When the load on the
P U
B
TE
C
H
192
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
reactor is to be lowered, the k has to be reduced to slightly less than 1 till the required
power level has been reached. At this point k has to be brought back to 1. Similarly, while
shifting down the reactor, the k has to be reduced to less than 1, the chain reaction will die
down.
Q.82 Describe the construction, principle of operation and advantages of SF6 circuit
breaker. (8)
In general, the circuit breakers consist of two main parts, the poles and the mechanism. The
poles consist of contact and arc-extinguishing devices. The mechanism is the part to open or
close the contacts in the poles at the same time instantaneously (with max. 5 millisec.
Tolerance). The closing and opening procedures are performed through springs which are
charged by a servomotor and a driving lever. In the system, the closing springs are first
charged. If "close" button is pressed, the opening springs get charged while the contacts get
closed. Thus, circuit breaker will be ready for opening. The mechanical operating cycle of the
circuit breaker is (OPEN-3 Min CLOSE/OPEN-3 Min- CLOSE/OPEN) or (OPEN-0.3 sec-
CLOSE/OPEN-3 Min CLOSE/OPEN). The second cycle is valid when the circuit breaker is
used with re-closing relay. In that case, after the closing operation, the closing springs are
charged by the driving lever or by driving motor (if equipped). Thus, the circuit breaker will
be ready for opening and re-closing.
When manual or motor-drive is used, the circuit breaker will be ready to close. The closure
can be actuated by pressing the closing button located on the circuit breaker. It is
recommended to close it using remote control system for secure operations. The opening can
be performed either by opening button or remote controlled opening coil. In case of a fault,
the relay signal actuates the opening coil and circuit breaker opens. (This is mechanically a
primary protection system). In addition, there is an anti-pumping relay for preventing the re-
closing and opening of the circuit breaker more than one cycle (O - C - O) and for preventing
possible troubles created by remote closing button.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
193
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Applications:
194
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
- Since cost of dielectric heating is very high, so it is employed where other methods
are not applicable.
- For baking of sand cores, which are used in the moulding process.
- For drying of tobacco after glycerine has been mixed with in making cigarettes.
- The baking of biscuits and cakes etc. in the bakeries with the help of automatic
machine.
195
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The average output voltage of a thyristor controlled rectification can be changed with
the help of a thyristor chopper circuit, which can be made to interrupt dc supply at
different rate to give different average value of dc supply. The dc voltage so obtained
can be thus chopped with the help of thyristor chopper circuit.
Since the thyristor can be switched ON- OFF very rapidly, they are used to interrupt a
dc supply at regular frequency in order to produce an average (mean) dc supply
voltage. This is achieved from low level dc voltage to high level dc voltage. The
thyristor T1 is used for dc chopping and resistance ‘R’. The capacitance ‘C’ &
Thyristor ‘T2’ are used for commutation purposes. When T1 is fixed into conduction
by its control circuit, the current is set up through the load and common capacitance
‘C’ gets charged Via ‘R’ with polarity during ‘ON’ period. When T1 is ‘OFF’, second
thyristor ‘T2’ is triggered into conduction allowing ‘C’ to discharge through it (since
it acts as short circuit while conducting) which is reversed biased, T1 thus turns it
OFF. The discharge from ‘C’ leaves T2 with reverse polarity, so it is turned OFF,
where as T1 is triggered into conduction again.
Jo
in
It is seen that output voltage is present only when T1 is ON and OFF. The mean value
@
196
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
A differential relay is defined as the relay that operates when the phaser
difference of two or more similar electrical quantities exceed by a predetermined
amount. Suppose that current ‘I’ flows through the primary circuit to external fault. If
the two CTs have the same ratio and are connected as shown, no current will flow
through the relay and it will remain un-operational.
If now an internal fault occurs and if current flows to the fault from both sides, the
current flow through the relay will be I1 & I2. It may be noted that the fault current
need not necessary flow to the fault from both sides to cause current flow in the relay.
There may be flow of one side only or even same current flowing out of one side,
while a large current entering the other side will cause a different current.
This type of differential relay is likely to operate inaccurately with heavy load
through faults (external load). suppose identical CTs may not have identical
secondary current due to constructional feature and errors or under severe fault
condition CTs may saturate and cause unequal secondary currents and its difference
of secondary currents may approach the pick-up value of relay. This disadvantage is
overcome in percentage differential relay.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
197
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
The simple element of a transformer consists of two coils having mutual inductance and a
laminated steel core. The two coils are insulated from each other with steel core. Other
necessary parts are : some suitable container for assembled core windings from its container:
Suitable bushings (either of porcelain, oil- filled or capacitor type) for insulating and bringing
out the terminals from the tank. Core is constructed of transformer sheet steel laminations,
assembled to provide a continuous magnetic path with a minimum of air gap included. Steel
used is of high silicon content, sometimes heat treated to produce a high permeability and low
hysterisis loss at the usual operating flux-densities. Lamination is of varnish or an oxide
layer, which reduces eddy current loss. Thickness of lamination varies with frequency
inversely.
Transformers are of 2 general types distinguished by the manner in which primary and
secondary coils are placed around the laminated core :
Working principle :
A transformer is a static piece of apparatus by means of which electric power in one circuit is
transformed into electric power of the same frequency in other circuit. It can raise or lower
the voltage in a circuit but with a corresponding decrease or increase in current. The physical
basis of transformer is mutual induction between two circuits linked by a common magnetic
flux. It consists of two inductive coils which are electrically and magnetically linked through
a path of low reluctance. The 2 coils possess high mutual inductance. If one coil is connected
to a source of alternating voltage , an alternating flux is set-up in laminated core, most of
which is linked with other coil in which it produces mutually induced emf (according to
Faraday’s law of EMI e = MdI/dt). If the second coil circuit is closed, a current flows in it
and so electric energy is transferred (entirely magnetically) from the first coil to the second
coil. The first coil in which electric energy is fed from A.C. supply mains is called primary
winding and other from which energy is drawn out, is called secondary winding.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
198
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.85 What are the two types of constructions that are employed in synchronous machines?
Explain the two machines and give with reasons which of them are simple to model
and analyze. (2+4+2)
Ans: Two types of construction employed in synchronous machine are salient pole and
smooth cylindrical rotor type.
(i) Salient pole type or Projecting Pole Type:
It is used in low and medium speed (engine driven) alternators. It has a large
number of projecting (Salient) poles, having their cores bolted or dove tailed
onto a heavy magnetic steel of cast iron or steel of good magnetic quality.
Such generators are characterized by their large diameters and short axial
lengths. The poles and pole shoes (which cover 2/3 of pole–pitch) are
laminated to minimize heating due to eddy currents.
(ii) Smooth Cylinder Type:
Used for steam turbine driven alternators i.e. turbo alternators which run at
very high speeds. Rotor here is deigned mostly for 2-pole (or 4 pole) turbo
generators running at 3600rpm (or1800 rpm).
The central polar area is surrounded by the field windings placed in slots and
the field coils are so arranged around these polar areas that flux density is
maximum on the central polar line and gradually falls away on either side. It
should be noted that poles are non-salient i.e., they do not project out from the
Jo
surface of rotor. To avoid excessive peripheral velocity, such rotors have very
in
small diameters and very long axial (or rotor) length. The cylindrical
SP
windage losses.
U
B
TE
C
H
199
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Cylindrical types are much easier to analyze than salient pole types because
they have uniform air gap, whereas in salient pole type air gap is much greater
between the pole than along the poles. Fortunately cylindrical rotor theory is
reasonably accurate in predicting the steady state performance of salient pole
type. Hence salient pole theory is required only when very high degree of
accuracy is needed or when problems concerning transients or power system
stability are not handled.
Q.86 Explain the characteristics of DC motors. Also give their applications. (6+3)
Ans: The characteristic curves of a motor are those curves which show relationships
between the following quantities:
1. Torque and armature current i.e Ta / Ia characteristic. It is known as
electrical characteristic.
2. Speed and armature current i.e N / Ia characteristic.
3. Speed and Torque i.e N / Ta characteristic. It is known as mechanical
characteristic.
Characteristics of series motor :
i. Ta / Ia characteristic:
Ta α Φ Ia
Φ α Ia (up to the point of magnetic saturation.)
Hence, before saturation
Ta α Φ Ia and therefore Ta α Ia2
As Ia increases, Ta increases as the square of the current. Hence , Ta / Ia
curve is a parabola before saturation. After saturation characteristic,
becomes straight line because Ta α Ia (for Φ is independent of Ia)
Ta
Jo
in
@
ii. N / Ia characteristic:
SP
N α Eb / Φ
P U
B
TE
C
H
200
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
iii. N / Ta characteristic :
i. Ta / Ia characteristic:
Ta α Ia
ii. N / Ia characteristic:
iii. N / Ta characteristic can be deduced from (i) and (ii) above and is
shown in Fig :
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
201
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Current Ia
202
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Applications of DC motors:
203
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
starting.
in
@
(b) Auto-transformers
SP
This method can be used for both star and delta connected motors with starting
P U
has run upto say, 80% of its normal speed, connections are so changed that
TE
C
H
204
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
autotransformers are cut out and full supply voltage applied across motor. The
switch taking these adjustments from start to run may be air break (for small
motors) or oil immersed (for large motors) to reduce sparking.
the same time starting torque is also increased due to improvement in p.f. The
in
operated or automatic.
SP
P
205
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
current. Hence such motors can be started with load. This additional resistance
is for starting purpose only. It is generally cut out as motor comes up to speed.
Q.88 What are the two advantages of stepper motors? Give a few applications of them &
explain permanent magnet stepper motors. (2+2+4)
Applications:
i) Operation control:
Others:
It has wound stator poles and permanently magnetized rotor poles. It has a
cylindrical rotor. Its direction of rotation depends on the polarity of stator current.
The stator has projecting poles. Rotor has 2 poles whereas stator has 4 poles and
the two stator poles are energized by one winding, the motor has two windings or
phases.
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
206
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Working :
When a particular stator phase is energized, the rotor magnetic poles move into
alignment with excited stator poles. The stator wdgs. A and B can be excited with
either polarity current (A+ refers to the +ve current i+A in phase A and A- to
negative current (i-A). Fig, shows condition when phase A is excited with the
current i+A. Here θ = 0o. If excitation is now switched to phase B, the rotor rotates
by a full step of 90o clockwise direction. When phase A is excited with –ve
current i-A, the rotor turns through another 90o in clockwise direction. Similarly
excitation of phase B with i+B further turns rotor through another 90o in same
direction. After this excitation of phase A with i+A makes rotor run through one
complete revolution of 360o.
Jo
in
@
It will be noted that in a permanent magnet stepper motor, the direction of rotation
SP
207
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.89 (a) Explain the three main blocks of a solid state relay. (8)
(b) What is meant by grading of cables? Explain the two methods of grading. (8)
Ans: Solid-state relays
A solid-state relay conducts load current through one or more power transistors or
thyristors.
There are three main types of SSRs, classified by the type of input.
Reed-relay coupled SSRs send the input signal through the coil of a reed relay.
Closure of the reed switch triggers the thyristor into conduction.
Transformer-coupled SSRs send an ac control signal through the primary of a small
transformer. (In the case of dc control signals, the input first goes through a DC/AC
converter before hitting the transformer primary). Voltage from the transformer
secondary triggers the thyristor.
Finally, photo coupled SSRs isolate the input from the output through a
photosensitive diode or transistor. A control current actuates a light source which in
turn, lets a photosensitive semiconductor conduct trigger-current to actuate the power
device.
(b) The method of equalizing the stress in the dielectric of the cable is called the
grading of cables.
Methods of grading.
(i) Capacitance grading
(ii) Intersheath grading
Capacitance grading is provided within gas insulated lightning arresters containing
stacked zinc oxide varistors by means of a grading ring electrically connected to the
Jo
line terminal or, for arresters of the higher voltage ratings, by means of a plurality of
in
telescoping external electrostatic shields. The shields are arranged so that the degree
@
of overlap between sequential shields decreases from the line end to the ground end of
SP
the varistor stacks. The capacitance grading is provided by the degree of overlap
P
between the sequential shields and the ratio of the radii of the overlapping shields.
U
B
TE
C
H
208
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Intersheath Grading
In this method of grading, the same insulating material is used throughout the cable,
but is divided into two or more layers by means of cylindrical screens or intersheaths .
These intersheaths are connected to tappings from the supply transformer, and the
potentials are maintained at such values that each layer of insulation takes its proper
share of the total voltage. The intersheaths are relatively flimsy, and are meant to
carry only the charging current. Since there is a definite potential difference between
the inner and outer radii of each sheath, we can treat each section separately as a
single core cable.
Q.90 (a) Explain the features of a nuclear power plant with a suitable diagram. (6)
(b) Explain the term “cogeneration” and give two possible ways of cogeneration. (2+2)
(c) Write a short note on solar energy. (6)
Ans: Nuclear power station :
In the nuclear power station, energy is produced by nuclear fission of Uranium (U235),
Thorium (Th232), Plutonium (Pu239). The fission process takes place in a nuclear
reactor and material in certain circumstances can be made to become unstable and
transform themselves into ordinary chemical elements, iron nickel, silicon and
calcium and in this process set free a considerable amount of heat energy. Heat thus
generated will be taken away by fluid such as molten bismuth or liquid sodium. This
hot molten metal will convert feed water into high-pressure steam in a heat exchanger.
The steam thus generated is utilized to drive steam turbine coupled to an alternator
and exciter, thereby generating electrical energy.
Low temperature and low pressure steam from turbine is condensed in a condenser
with the help of circulated cooling water. From the condenser, water is again fed to
heat exchanger with the help of a feed water pump for converting it into steam.
In this power station transportation of fuel is not a problem, because one kg of atomic
fuel can generate as much electrical energy as can be generated from about
2500 tonnes of high grade coal.
The most suitable areas in our country for atomic power stations are western UP,
Rajasthan, Punjab and Haryana
Few examples of atomic or nuclear power stations are as follows:
1. Tarapur Atomic Power Stations, Tarapur near Mumbai.
Jo
in
209
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(b) Co-generation
Cogeneration is a highly efficient means of generating heat and electric power at the
same time from the same energy source. Displacing fossil fuel combustion with heat
that would normally be wasted in the process of power generation, it reaches
efficiencies that can triple, or even quadruple conventional power generation.
Cogeneration equipment can be fired by fuels other than natural gas. There are
installations in operation that use wood, agricultural waste, peat moss, and a wide
variety of other fuels, depending on local availability.
Jo
The environmental implications of cogeneration stem not just from its inherent
in
transport heat over any distance, cogeneration equipment must be located physically
SP
close to its heat user. Cogeneration plants tend to be built smaller, and owned and
P
operated by smaller and more localized companies than simple cycle power plants. As
U
B
a general rule, they are also built closer to populated areas, which causes them to be
TE
C
H
210
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
(c) Solar energy is the utilization of the radiant energy from the Sun. Solar power is often
used interchangeably with solar energy but refers more specifically to the conversion
of sunlight into electricity, either by photovoltaic and concentrating solar thermal
devices, or by one of several experimental technologies such as thermoelectric
converters, solar chimneys and solar ponds.
Solar energy and shading are important considerations in building design. Thermal
mass is used to conserve the heat that sunshine delivers to all buildings. Daylighting
techniques optimize the use of light in buildings. Solar water heaters heat swimming
pools and provide domestic hot water. In agriculture, greenhouses expand growing
seasons and pumps powered by solar cells (also known as photovoltaics) provide
water for grazing animals. Evaporation ponds are used to harvest salt and clean waste
streams of contaminants.
Solar distillation and disinfection techniques produce potable water for millions of
people worldwide. Simple applications include clotheslines and solar cookers which
concentrate sunlight for cooking, drying and pasteurization. More sophisticated
concentrating technologies magnify the rays of the Sun for high-temperature material
testing, metal smelting and industrial chemical production. A range of prototype solar
vehicles provide ground, air and sea transportation.
Q.91(a) What are the advantages of electrically produced heat? Explain the various types of
electric heating with their applications. (2+6)
(b) Explain the salient features of electrical propulsion. (8)
Ans: (a) Electrically produced heat possesses the following advantages over other forms of
Heat:
i. Cleanliness: The complete absence of dust and ash keeps cleaning cost to a
minimum.
ii. High efficiency of utilization : Practically 75% to 100% 0f heat produced can be
utilized.
Jo
iv. Ease of control : Simple and accurate control of temperature can be provided.
SP
P
211
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
adequate amount of heating frequencies between 10MHz and 30MHz must be used
SP
212
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Applications:
• Seaming and welding in manufacture of synthetics.
• In wood processing industry.
• For baking foundry cores.
• For food processing.
iv. Arc Heating :
If an air gap is subjected to a very high voltage , the air in between gets ionized due to
electrostatic forces. The ionized air is the conducting material, therefore, the current
starts flowing through the air gap in the form of continuous spark or arc. This arc is
produced in the arc furnaces by having air gap and electrode. With graphite or carbon
electrode the temperature obtained from the arc is between 3000oC and 3500oC.
There are two types of arc furnaces.
• Direct arc furnace.
• Indirect arc furnace.
Applications:
• In production of steel direct arc furnace is used.
• Submerged arc furnace is used for ferrous alloy manufacturer.
• Indirect arc furnace are used for melting of non ferrous metals, it is also used in
foundries where small quantities of metal is required intermittently.
(b) Salient features of electrical propulsion.
Electric propulsion is a form of space craft propulsion used in outer space. This type
of reaction utilizes electric energy to obtain thrust from propellant carried with the
vehicle.
Types of electric propulsion :
The various technologies of electric propulsion are usually grouped in three types
based on the type of forces used to accelerate the ions of the plasma.
Electrostatic: If the acceleration is caused mainly by the coulomb forces the device is
considered electrostatic.
i. Electrothermal: In this type, electromagnetic fields are used to generate a plasma
Jo
to increase the heat of the bulk propellant. The thermal energy imparted to the
in
propellant gas is then converted into kinetic energy by a nozzle of either physical
@
electromagnetic fields where the electric field is not in the direction of the
B
acceleration.
TE
C
H
213
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Advantages of Electric Propulsion used in the battery electric vehicle that uses
chemical energy stored in rechargeable battery packs.
As Electric vehicle, it employs electric motors and motor controllers instead of
internal combustion engine
The concept of baterry electric vehicle is to charge batteries on board of vehicles
for propulsion using the electric grid.
1. No pollutants are emitted directly by the vehicle potentially reducing urban pollution.
2. Gasoline is indirectly replaced by whatever is being used to generate domestic
electricity, reducing dependence on foreign commodities. The electrical energy
stored within the battery can be generated by any source, including renewable,
nuclear, natural gas, coal and petroleum.
magnetizing current.
in
@
Y-∆ Connection:
SP
Used at substation end of transmission line where voltage is stepped down. There
P U
is 30o shift between primary and secondary line voltages which means Y-∆ can be
B
TE
C
H
214
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
paralleled with Y-Y or ∆-∆ bank. 3rd harmonic flows in ∆ to provide a sinusoidal
flux VLS/VLP = k /√3
∆-Y connection:
Used at beginning of high TTS to step up the voltage. Because of 30o shift it is
impossible to paralleled such bank with ∆-∆ or Y-Y even if voltages ratio
correctly adjusted. Best suited for 3Φ, 4 wire service. VLS/VLP = √3 k.
Open delta or V-V connection: Method of transforming 3Φ power by means of
only transformer at a reduced rate of 58% of normal value. Ratio of operating
capacity to available capacity of an V-V is 0.866 (utility factor). Overload on each
of transformer is 73.2%. The addition of 3rd transformer increases total capacity
by √3 or 173.2%.
Scott or T-T connection :
Q.93 Explain the constructional features of synchronous generator. What are the two types
of generators? Derive emf equation of a synchronous machine. (10)
Jo
field. Armature winding mounted on a stationary element called stator and field
SP
The stator consists of a cast iron frame which supports the armature core having slots
B
on its inner periphery for housing the armature conductor. The rotor is like a flywheel
TE
C
H
215
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
having alternate N and S poles fixed to its outer rim. The magnetic poles are excited
from direct current supplied by a d.c source which is belted or mounted on the shaft of
the alternator itself. Because the field magnets are rotating, this current is supplied
through two slip rings. As the exciting voltage is relatively small, the slip ring and
brushes gear are of light construction.
Types of synchronous generator :
There are two types of rotor used in synchronous generator. Accordingly, A
synchronous generator may be classified as:
(i) Salient pole type
(ii) smooth cylindrical type.
Salient pole type has a large number of projecting poles having their cores bolted or
dovetailed on to a heavy magnetic wheel of cast iron or steel of good magnetic
quality. Such generators are characterized by their large diameter and short axial
length.
Smooth cylindrical type runs at very high speed. The rotor consists of a smooth solid
forged steel cylinder having a number of slots milled out at intervals along the outer
periphery for accommodating field coils. Such rotors are designed mostly for 2 pole
turbo generator running at 3600 rpm. These are characterized by small diameter and
long axial rotor length. The cylindrical construction of the rotor gives better balance
and quieter operation and less windage losses.
E.M.F equation of synchronous machine :
Let Z = no. of conductor or coil sides in series / phase.
= 2T – where T is the no of coils or turns/phase.
P = No. of poles.
F = frequency of induced e.m.f in Hz.
Φ = flux /pole in webers
Kd = distribution factor = sin m β/2 / msin β/2
KC & KP = Pitch or coil span factor = cos α /2
Kf = form factor = 1.11 – if e.m.f is assumed sinusoidal
N = rotative speed of the rotor in r.p.m
In one revolution of the rotor (i.e in 60/N seconds) each stator conductor is cut by a flux of
Φ p webers
Jo
in
216
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.94 (a) Give comparison between squirrel cage and slip ring induction machine? Discuss
the working principle of three phase induction motor. (8)
(b) State different methods of speed control of three phase induction motor. Explain
any one of the method in detail. Also draw torque-speed characteristics. (8)
Almost 90% of induction machines are Squirrel-cage type, because this type of rotor
has the simplest and most rugged construction imaginable and is almost
indestructible. Rotor is of cylindrical type laminated core.
Rotor slots are skewed for (a) quiet running by reducing magnetic hum. (b) helps in
reducing locking tendency of the rotor i.e. tendency of rotor teeth to remain under
Jo
alternators.
B
TE
C
H
217
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
But under normal running conditions wound rotor is short circuited on itself just like
squirrel case rotor.
In A.C. motors, rotor does not receive electric power by conduction but by induction
in exactly the same way as the secondary of 2-wdg transformer receives its power
from the primary. So such motors are known as induction motors.
The principle of a 3Ø 2 pole stator having 3 identical wdg placed 120o apart. The flux
(assumed sinusoidal) due to 3 Ø wdg is shown. Let Ø m be maximum value of flux
due to any one of the 3Ø . The resultant flux Ør at any instant, is given by vector sum
of individual fluxes Ø 1 Ø 2 Ø 3 due to 3 Ø. Let us consider values of Ør at four
instants 1/6th time period apart corresponding to points marked 0,1, 2 and 3.
Here Ø1 = -√3 Øm
2
Ø2 = √3 Øm,
2
Ø3 = 0
2 2
@
Ør = 3
SP
2
P U
B
TE
C
H
218
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Ø1 = 0, Ø2 = √3 Øm; Ø3 = -√3 Øm
2 2
Hence
1. Resultant flux is 3 Øm i.e. 1.5 times the maximum value of flux
2
due to any phase.
2. Resultant flux rotates around stator at synchronous speed given by
Ns = 120 f/p
(b) Different methods of speed control of three phase induction motor
The speed of an induction motor is given by
N = (f/p) x (1-S)
Where, N is speed
F is frequency
P is the no of poles.
S is the slip.
Thus speed of three phase induction motor is controlled by the following methods:
a. Rheostatic control
b. pole control
c. cascade control
e. Frequency control
Pole changing method: Winding on the stator may be so arranged that with different
connection, different numbers of poles are available which give different speeds. The
Jo
choice of the number of poles on the pole changing winding is in the ratio 2:1,
in
219
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
Q.95 Describe the construction of hystersis motor and show that it builds a running torque
both at synchronous and asynchronous speed of the rotor. (8)
The fact that the rotor has no teeth or winding of any sort results in making the motor
@
extremely quiet in the operation and free from mechanical and magnetic vibrations.
SP
This makes the motor particularly useful for sound equipment applications.
P U
B
TE
C
H
220
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
This motor builds a running torque both at synchronous and asynchronous speed of
the rotor It accelerates rapidly, changing from rest to full speed almost
instantaneously.
Q.96 (a) What do you understand by the term cogeneration? Give its significance. (8)
Ans: (a) Cogeneration is a high efficiency energy system that produces both electricity
(or mechanical energy) and valuable heat from single fuel source. Cogeneration is
some times known as combined heat and not only generates power but also provides
heat for industrial purposes. For example a hospital cogeneration plant would
produce some of power and all hot water needed for its laundry and hot water system
from the waste heat it generates.
Significance :
It reduces energy costs and green house gas emissions typically by upto two-third. In
Jo
major economic and environmental facilities because it turns otherwise wasted heat
@
Cogeneration is a proven and reliable technology currently operating at over 100 sites
U
across Australia.
B
TE
C
H
221
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
There is significant potential for cogeneration plants fired by other fuels, including
biomass (e.g., plant waste from sugar or cotton harvesting), or biogas (e.g., methane
produced by sewage works or piggeries).
(b)
(i) Wind
Wind energy used in wind mills to pump water from wells and low level to high level.
Windmills do not generate electricity but are used to grind grains with large grinding
stones. Today wind is used to make electricity, blowing wind spins the blades on a
wind turbine, which is called wind turbine. The blade of turbine is attached to a hub
i.e. mounted on a turning shaft. The shaft goes through a gear transmission box where
the turning speed is increased. The transmission is attached to a high-speed shaft,
which turn generator that makes electricity. If wind gets too high, turbine has a brake
that will keep blades from turning to fast and being damaged. For efficient working,
wind speeds must be above 12 to 14 miles/hr., to turn the turbines fast enough to
generate electricity. Turbines usually produce 50 to 500 kW of electricity each.
(ii) Wave
Waves are caused by action of winds on sea. Waves can be many meters high and
contain a great deal of energy, which can be harnessed to drive turbines that generate
electricity.
Wave energy can be harnessed in coastal areas, close to shore. There has been one
such device working on the island of Islay in Scotland since early 1990s producing
75 kW of electricity. Wave energy collectors are of 2 main types :
(a) First type directs waves into man-made channels, where the water passes
through a turbine that generates electricity.
(b) Second type uses up and down movement of wave to push air.
Advantages : Non-polluting and don’t affect wild life.
Disadvantages : Turbines can be unsightly and no constant supply of energy. Wave
heights vary.
(iii) Bio fuel:
Bio fuel are transportation fuel like ethanol and bio-diesel that are made from biomass
materials. These are usually blended with petroleum fuels-gasoline and diesel fuel,
but they can also be used on their own. Ethanol and bio-diesel are expensive than
Jo
fossil fuels that they replace but are cleaner fuels, producing fewer air pollutants.
in
Ethanol is an alcohol fuel made from sugars found in grains, such as corn, sorghum
@
and wheat as well as potato skins, rice etc. Most of ethanol in US is distilled from
SP
corn.
P
Bio-diesel is a fuel made with vegetable oils, fats or greases such as recycled
U
B
restaurant grease. Bio-diesel fuels can be used in diesel engine without changing
TE
C
H
222
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
Code: AE10 ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING
223
-T
el
eg
ra
m
www.EngineeringBooksPdf.com
UNIT IV
Part A- polyphase AC Circuit
A. 0.1H, 8 Ohms
@
SP
B. 0.5H, 10 Ohms
P
D. 1H, 7 Ohms
TE
Ans: C
C
H
D. 4. Ohms, 0.02H
TE
Ans: B
C
H
Explanation: Given
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Line Voltage, VL = 400 Volts
Frequency, f = 60 Hz
Ans: A
in
Ans: A
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
12. Polyphase is characterized by two or more sinusoidal voltages, each having a
different phase angle.
A. True
B. False
Ans: A
13. If in a Y-connected ac generator, each phase voltage has a magnitude of 90 VRMS,
what is the magnitude of each line voltage?
A. 0 V
B. 90 V
C. 156 V
D. 180 V
Ans: C
14. In a certain three-wire Y-connected generator, the phase voltages are 2 kV. The
magnitudes of the line voltages are
A. 2,000 V
B. 6,000 V
C. 666 V
D. 3,464 V
Ans: D
Ans: B
in
A. Load voltage and line voltage are one-third the source voltage for a given
SP
phase
P
B. Load voltage and line voltage are two-thirds the source voltage for a given
U
phase
B
TE
2. In a R-L-C circuit
a. Power is consumed in resistance and is equal to IR
b. Exchange of power takes place between inductor and supply line
c. Exchange of power takes place between capacitor and supply line
d. All above are correct
Answer: d
Answer: b
Answer: b
Answer: d
6. The product of apparent power and cosine of the phase angle between circuit voltage and current is
a. True power
b. Reactive power
c. Volt-amperes
Jo
d. Instantaneous power
in
@
Answer: a
SP
PU
a. Minimum
TE
b. Maximum
C
c. Zero
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
d. None of the above
Answer: a
Answer: c
Answer: d
10. A sine wave has a frequency of 50 Hz. Its angular frequency is _______ radian/second.
a. 100 π
b. 50 jt
c. 25 JT
d. 5 π
Answer: a
11. The apparent power drawn by an A.C. circuit is 10 kVA and active power is 8 kW. The reactive power in the
circuit is
a. 4 kVAR
b. 6 kVAR
c. 8 kVAR
d. 16 kVAR
Answer: b
Answer: b
a. Squares
in
b. Parallelograms
@
c. Rhombus
SP
d. Trapeziums
PU
B
Answer: b
TE
C
Answer: c
Answer: d
16. The impedance of circuit is given by 15.5∠-30 Ω. It means that the circuit is
a. capacitive
b. inductive
c. purely resistive
d. none of the above
Answer: c
17. In RLC series circuit, the inductive reactance is 10 Ω and capacitive reactance is 15 Ω. The total reactance of the
circuit is
a. 25 Ω
b. 18.03 Ω
c. 5 Ω
d. 1.5 Ω
Answer: c
18. In series RL circuit, R = 5 Ω, XL = 10 Ω and XC = 15 Ω. If this circuit is connected to a voltage source v = 100
sin (314t + 30) V, the rms value of the current will be
a. 14.14 A
b. 10 A
c. 5 A
d. 3.33 A
Answer : b
19. An alternating voltage of 80+j60 V is applied to a circuit and the current flowing is 4-j2 A. Find impedance of
circuit.
a. 22.37 Ω
b. 23.27 Ω
Jo
c. 21.88 Ω
in
d. 27.22 Ω
@
SP
Answer: a
PU
B
20. An alternating voltage of 80+j60 V is applied to a circuit and the current flowing is 4-j2 A. Find power factor of
TE
circuit.
C
a. 0.5 lag
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
b. 0.447 lead
c. 0.447 lag
d. none of the above
Answer: c
21. The voltage applied to a circuit is e =100 sin (ωt+30) and the current flowing in the circuit is i = 15 sin (ωt+60).
Determine impedance of the circuit.
a. 6.67 Ω
b. 5.57 Ω
c. 7.67 Ω
d. 1.67 Ω
Answer: a
22. The voltage applied to a circuit is e =100 sin (ωt+30) and the current flowing in the circuit is i = 15 sin (ωt+60).
Determine resistance of the circuit.
a. 6.67 Ω
b. 5.77 Ω
c. 7.67 Ω
d. 1.67 Ω
Answer: b
23. A resistor of 20 Ω, inductor of 0.005 H and capacitor of 50μF are connected in series. A supply voltage 230 V,
50 Hz is connected across the series combination. Calculate inductive reactance.
a. 16.67 Ω
b. 15.71 Ω
c. 17.67 Ω
d. 14.67 Ω
Answer: b
24. A resistor of 20 Ω, inductor of 0.005 H and capacitor of 50μF are connected in series. A supply voltage 230 V,
50 Hz is connected across the series combination. Calculate capacitive reactance.
a. 53.67 Ω
b. 55.71 Ω
c. 63.67 Ω
d. 57.67 Ω
Answer : c
25. Two impedances Z1 = 40∠30 and Z2 = 30∠60 are connected in series across a single phase 230 V, 50 Hz
supply. Calculate the current drawn
a. 4.3 A
b. 2.3 A
c. 3.4 A
Jo
d. 5.0 A
in
@
Answer: c
SP
PU
26. A coil having a impedance of 50.39∠7.16 is connected in parallel with capacitor having impedance of
B
127.32∠-90. If supply voltage is 200 V, single phase, 50 Hz. Calculate current in the coil.
TE
a. 4.47∠7.16 A
C
b. 5.57∠8.16 A
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
c. 4.97∠90 A
d. 3.97∠-7.16 A
Answer: d
26. A coil having a impedance of 50.39∠7.16 is connected in parallel with capacitor having impedance of
127.32∠-90. If supply voltage is 200 V, single phase, 50 Hz. Calculate current in the capactor.
a. 4.47∠90 A
b. 5.57∠8.17 A
c. 4.97∠90 A
d. 1.57∠90 A
Answer: d
27. An impedance of (7+j5) Ω is connected in parallel with another impedance of (10-j8) Ω across a 230 V, 50
Hz supply. Calculate admittance of the circuit.
a. 0.16∠-7.04 mho
b. 0.16∠7.04 mho
c. -0.16∠7.04 mho
d. none of the above
Answer: b
Answer: c
Answer: a
30. A series RLC circuit has following parameter values: R = 10 Ω, L = 0.01 H and C = 100 μF. Calculate
resonant frequency.
a. 159.15 Hz
b. 169.15 Hz
a. 179.15 Hz
a. 150.15 Hz
Jo
in
Answer: a
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-3 Single phase AC ckt
1.In a series R-L circuit, VL—VR by—degrees.
voltage.
P U
B
TE
1. c 2. c 3. a 4. B 5.c
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-3 Single phase AC ckt
1. What is the power factor of a circuit if the inductive susceptance and conductance have
the same value?
A. 0.325
B. 0.525
C. 0.673
D. 0.707
Ans D
2. If a circuit has an admittance of Y = 0.2 + j0.6, the circuit is
A. purely inductive
B. inductive
C. capacitive
D. reactive
Answer: Option C
The circuit admittance Y = 0.2 – j0.6, the circuit is
A. resistive
B. inductive
C. capacitive
D. reactive
Answer: Option B
If you need an LC circuit to be resonant at 2500 Hz and use a 150 mH coil, what should the
capacitance value be?
Jo
A. 0.027 μF
in
@
B. 0.015 μF
SP
P
C. 0.15 μF
U
B
TE
D. 27 μF
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-3 Single phase AC ckt
Answer: Option A
What is the resonant frequency of a circuit when L of 3 microhenry and C of 40 picofarad are in
series?
A. 1.33 MHz
B. 14.5 MHz
C. 14.5 kHz
D. 1.33 kHz
Answer: Option B
A series circuit at resonance would mean, the circuit is
A. resistive
B. inductive
C. capacitive
D. reactive
Answer: Option A
Characteristics of the current in a series R-L-C circuit at resonance.
A. It is dc
B. It is a minimum
C. It is zero
D. It is at maximum
Jo
Answer: Option D
in
@
A. Real power
U
B
TE
B. Useful power
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-3 Single phase AC ckt
C. Apparent power
D. DC power
Answer: Option C
The relationship of the voltage across an inductor to its current is described as
Answer: Option A
A 220-V, 60Hz is driving a series RL circuit. Determine the current if R = 100 ohms and 20 mH
inductance
A. 2.2 A (lagging)
B. 2.0 A (lagging)
C. 2.2 A (leading)
D. 2.0 A (leading)
Answer: Option A
What is the relationship between frequency and the value of X C ?
A. Frequency has no effect
Answer: Option B
@
SP
A. 785 ohms
TE
C
B. 785000 ohms
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-3 Single phase AC ckt
C. 13 ohms
D. 0.0012 ohms
Answer: Option A
A resistive and a capacitive load of equal magnitude is connected in series, determine the phase
difference between the voltage and the current.
Answer: Option A
What will happen when the power factor of a circuit is increased?
Answer: Option B
A series RL network is supplied with a 200-volt, 60-cycle source. If the voltage across the
resistor R is 100 V, what is the voltage across the inductor L?
A. 0 V
B. 100 V
Jo
C. 173.2 V
in
@
SP
D. 200 V
P U
Answer: Option C
B
TE
A 6-Ω resistor is connected in series with a capacitive reactance of 8 Ω. If the supply voltage is
C
A. 2400 W
B. 4000 W
C. 5000 W
D. 6666.67 W
Answer: Option A
A 6-Ω resistor is connected in series with a capacitive reactance of 8 Ω. If the supply voltage is
200 V, what is the circuit current magnitude?
A. 14.28 A
B. 20 A
C. 25 A
D. 33.33 A
Answer: Option B
The apparent power of a series RC network is given to be 4000 W. If R = 6 Ω, and XC = 8 Ω,
calculate the true power of the network.
A. 1200 W
B. 2400 W
C. 3200 W
D. 4000 W
Answer: Option B
A series RC circuit has an apparent power of 4000 W. If R = 6 Ω, and XC = 8 Ω, determine the
reactive power.
Jo
in
A. 1200 W
@
SP
B. 2400 W
P U
B
TE
C. 3200 W
C
H
D. 4000 W
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-3 Single phase AC ckt
Answer: Option C
A network has a true power and a reactive power of 2400 W and 3200 W respectively. What is
its apparent power?
A. 800 W
B. 1600 W
C. 4000 W
D. 5600 W
Answer: Option C
What is the total impedance of a series circuit consisting of R = 6 Ω, XC = 8 Ω, and XL = 16 Ω?
A. 10 Ω
B. 14 Ω
C. 24.73 Ω
D. 30 Ω
Answer: Option A
A parallel RL circuit with R = 60 Ω, and XL = 40 Ω has a total impedance of
A. 24.3 Ω
B. 28.3 Ω
C. 33.3 Ω
D. 38.3 Ω
Jo
Answer: Option C
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-4A Single phase transformer
b. 250
@
c. 400
SP
P
d. 1250
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-4A Single phase transformer
6. The primary and secondary induced e m f E1 and E2 in a two winding transformer are
always___________
a. Equal in magnitude
b. Anti phase with each other
c. In-phase with each other
d. Determined by load on transformer secondary
7. In a core type transformer__________
a. The core encircles the winding
b. The winding encircles the core
c. The limb encircles the yoke
d. None of the above
b. Unity
@
c. Leading
SP
P
d. Lagging
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-4A Single phase transformer
20. For a 10 KVA 2000/200 V transformer, the half load secondary current is
in
_________________
@
a. 50A
SP
P
b. 5A
U
B
c. 25A
TE
C
d. 10A
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-4A Single phase transformer
Answers
Q A Q A
1 D 11 A
2 D 12 C
3 D 13 C
4 B 14 A
5 A 15 C
6 C 16 C
7 B 17 C
8 C 18 B
9 A 19 C
10 D 20 C
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-4B Three phase AC ckt
A. 96%
1. B. 90%
C. 66%
D. 50%
A. 90°E
2. B. 120º E
C. 180°E
D. 360°E
3.
alternator:
The alternator has a 24-slot stator and is wound with 24 coils in sets of:
Jo
in
@
supply:
5. The displacement between the voltage is:
A. 120°E
B. 60°E
C. 90°E
D. 30°E
Jo
in
@
In a three-phase system, where the three voltage sources are, connected to feed
SP
because the:
U
6.
B
TE
A. parallel connection
7.
B. delta connection
C. star connection
D. mesh connection
8
.
The three-phase winding shown in figure have been connected in the:
A. delta configuration
Jo
in
C. parallel configuration
P
U
B
D. star configuration
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-4B Three phase AC ckt
9
.
The three-phase winding shown in figure has:
A. A B C rotation
B. BAC rotation
C. CAB rotation
D. ACB rotation
Figure shows one method of determining the line voltage of a three-phase star
A. VA + VB
B. Ö2 VA
C. 1.414 x VA
D. Ö3 VA
Figure shows the phasor diagram method of determining the line voltage of a
15.
reversed:
The waveforms of the three phase voltages then have a displacement of 120º E
between A and B, and:
Jo
in
@
A. parallel connection
16.
B. wye connection
C. star connection
D. delta connection
17
.
The three-phase winding shown in figure have been connected in the:
A. delta configuration
C. parallel configuration
Jo
in
D. star configuration
@
SP
P
U
18.
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-4B Three phase AC ckt
Figure shows one a Delta connected 400 V three-phase system in which one
phase has been mistakenly connected with reversed
connections:
20. In the diagram, the voltage between the open connections will be:
A. 230 V
Jo
B. 400 V
in
@
C. 415 V
SP
P
D. 800 V
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-4B Three phase AC ckt
21
.
Figure shows a phasor diagram for determining the line current in a three-
phase delta connected
load:
22
.
Jo
in
@
SP
Electrical power can be transmitted using low voltage and high currents. Higher
currents result in:
In economic terms, the higher the voltage used for power transmission
systems, the:
Transmission system voltages are far higher than the voltages required by the
average consumer, therefore the voltage is:
26.
The distribution system shown in figure is a:
Jo
Figure shows a 4-wire distribution system with the star point of the phase
A. zero
28.
B. the current in any phase
For any type of load, the current in a neutral conductor of any three-phase,
four-wire system is equal to:
Jo
in
29.
SP
30. A. 28 A
B. 10 A
C. 8A
D. 12 A
Figure shows the readings obtained when checking the voltages of a faulty
230/400 V three-phase four-wire
31.
system:
The most likely cause of the fault will be a:
A. P = √3 V I cos ø
32.
B. P = 3 V I cos ø
C. P = √3 V I
D. P = √3 V I sin ø
A three-phase 400 V motor draws 10 A at 0.8 lagging power factor. The power
is consumed by this motor will be approximately:
A. 6.93 kW
33.
B. 5.54 kW
C. 4.00 kW
D. 3.20 kW
34
.
Jo
in
@
SP
system:
P U
35.
system:
One advantage of using this method is that:
The power consumed by a three-phase motor has been measured using the
Jo
and 3 kW. At this load, the power factor of the motor will be:
@
SP
36.
A. 0.866 lagging
P U
B
B. 0.866 leading
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-4B Three phase AC ckt
C. 0.189 lagging
D. 0.189 leading
system:
37.
To find the total power, the following calculation must be made using the
readings: PTOTAL =
A. W1 + W2 / W3
B. W1 + W2 + W3
C. W 1 – W 2. / W 1 + W 3
D. W1 / W2 + W3
38.
in
@
SP
system.
P U
B. unbalanced loads
In power stations operating under normal conditions, the values of voltage and
current are generally too high and unwieldy to be used directly with portable
instruments. To avoid these high-energy circuits when measuring voltage,
current and power, in these cases:
(b) duality
in
(c) non-linearity
(d) linearity
@
SP
Ans: d
7. Thevenin resistance Rth is found
P U
Ans: b
B
TE
Ans: d
B
TE
(c) 30 Q
in
(d) 40 Q
Ans: c
@
SP
Ans: c
30. An ideal voltage source has
@
SP
Ans: a
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-5 DC Circuit MCQS
31. A network which contains one or more than one source of e.m.f. is known
as
(a) linear network
(b) non-linear network
(c) passive network
(d) active network
Ans: c
32. The superposition theorem is applicable to
(a) linear, non-linear and time variant responses
(b) linear and non-linear resistors only
(c) linear responses only
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
33. Which of the following is not a nonlinear element ?
(a) Gas diode
(b) Heater coil
(c) Tunnel diode
(d) Electric arc
Ans:
34. Application of Norton’s theorem to a circuit yields
(a) equivalent current source and impedance in series
(6) equivalent current source and impedance in parallel
(c) equivalent impedance
(d) equivalent current source
Ans: a
35. Millman’s theorem yields
(a) equivalent resistance
(6) equivalent impedance
(c) equivalent voltage source
(d) equivalent voltage or current source
Ans: d
36. The superposition theorem is applicable to
(a) voltage only
(b) current “only
Jo
37. Between the branch voltages of a loop the Kirchhoff s voltage law imposes
(a) non-linear constraints
P U
(c) no constraints
C
Ans: b
38. A passive network is one which contains
(a) only variable resistances
(b) only some sources of e.m.f. in it
(c) only two sources of e.m.f. in it
(d) no source of e.m.f. in it
Ans: d
39. A terminal where three on more branches meet is known as
(a) node
(b) terminus
(c) combination
(d) anode
Ans: a
40. Which of the following is the passive element ?
(a) Capacitance
(b) Ideal current source
(c) Ideal voltage source
(d) All of the above
Ans: a
41. Which of the following is a bilateral element ?
(a) Constant current source
(b) Constant voltage source
(c) Capacitance
(d) None of the above
Ans: c
42. A closed path made by several branches of the network is known as
(a) branch
(b) loop
(c) circuit
(d) junction
Ans: b
43. A linear resistor having 0 < R < °o is a
(a) current controlled resistor
(6) voltage controlled resistor
Jo
44. A star circuit has element of resistance R/2. The equivalent delta elements
will be
P U
(a) R/6
B
TE
(b) 3R/2
C
(c) 2R
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-5 DC Circuit MCQS
(d) 4R
Ans: b
45. A delta circuit has each element of value R/2. The equivalent elements of
star circuit with be
(a) R/6
(b) R/3
(c) 2R
(d) 3R
Ans: a
56. In Thevenin’s theorem, to find Z
(a) all independent current sources are short circuited and independent
voltage sources are open circuited
(b) all independent voltage sources are open circuited and all independent
current sources are short circuited
(c) all independent voltage and current sources are short circuited
(d) all independent voltage sources are short circuited and all independent
current sources are open circuited
Ans: d
57. While calculating Rth in Thevenin’s theorem and Norton equivalent
(a) all independent sources are made dead
(b) only current sources are made dead
(c) only voltage sources are made dead
(d) all voltage and current sources are made dead
Ans: a
58. The number of independent equations to solve a network is equal to
(a) the number of chords
(b) the number of branches
(c) sum of the number of branches and chords
(d) sum of number of branches, chords and nodes
Ans: a
59. The superposition theorem requires as many circuits to be solved as there
are
(a) sources, nodes and meshes
(b) sources and nodes
Jo
(c) sources
in
(d) nodes
Ans: c
@
SP
(b) A branch formed by the parallel connection of any resistor R and a short
C
(c) A branch formed by the series connection of any resistor R and an open
circuit has the characteristic of an open circuit.
(d) A branch formed by the series connection of any resistor R and a short
circuit has the characteristic of resistor R.
Ans: a
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-6 Elementary concepts
b. Coulomb
@
c. Ampere
SP
P
d. Volt
U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-6 Elementary concepts
7. The resistance of wire is 10.If its length is doubled its resistance will be
________________
a. 20
b. 40
c. 10
d. 1
a. Alloys
P
b. Semiconductors
U
B
TE
c. Insulators
C
d. Metals
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-6 Elementary concepts
13. A coil has a resistance of 20 at 20C and its R.T.C at 0C is 0.003C then its resistance
at 50C
a. 23
b. 21.8
c. 21.698
d. 218
b. Radially inward
U
B
TE
c. Radially outward
C
d. None of these
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-6 Elementary concepts
19. A 100 w lamp operates for 4 hours per day then its energy consumption per day
is_______________
a. 4 units
b. 4Wh
c. 0.4 units
d. O.4Wh
Jo
in
a. J-Kg/-K
P
b. J-/Kg-K
U
B
TE
c. J-Kg-K
C
d. None of these
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-6 Elementary concepts
21. 1KWh=_____________________Kcal
a. 0.24x106
b. 0.116
c. 860
d. 0.86
22. 7.2MJ =
a. 1KWh
b. 2KWh
c. 1000Wh
d. 1Wh
24. A 40 kg fuel is burned to produce 1720kcal energy then its calorific value
is_____________
a. 180J/Kg
b. 180KJ/Kg
c. 43KJ/Kg
d. 43J/Kg
Jo
in
25. A 60W light bulb is in a socket supplied with 120v.What is the current in the bulb?
@
SP
a. 0.50A
P
b. 2.0A
U
B
TE
c. 60A
C
d. 200A
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-6 Elementary concepts
29. The resistance of the coil increases from50 to 59.6from 20C. If its R.T.Cat20C
is 0.0032/C,then its final temperature is ____________C
a. 80
b. 60
c. 40
d. 20
Jo
in
a. Increases
P
b. Decreases
U
B
TE
c. Remain same
C
31. The force exerted on a body rotating at a particular distance of 5cm from the axis is 100
N then the torque acted on that body is _______
a. 0.5N-m
b. 5N-cm
c. 5N-m
d. 500N-m
33. The quantity of heat gained or lost due to change in temperature is called
_______________
a. Sensible heat
b. Specific heat
c. Latent heat
d. Enthalpy
34. The quantity of heat produced by burning unit mass of the substance is called
______________of the fuel
a. Calorific value
b. Specific heat
Jo
in
c. Latent heat
@
SP
d. Enthalpy
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-6 Elementary concepts
35. The meters used to measure the domestic power consumption by the electrical company
are__________
a. Voltmeters
b. Wattmeter’s
c. Energy meters
d. Ammeters
36. The water pump used to lift the water converts ___________energy into
___________energy
a. Mechanical, electrical
b. hydraulic, electrical
c. electrical ,Mechanical
d. Electrical, thermal
37. A wire carries a current of 5 A for 10 seconds to generate the heat of 500 joules then the
resistance of the wire is ______________
a. 1
b. 0.5
c. 5
d. 2
38. A cable has conductor diameter of 5cm and thickness of the insulation is 2cm.if the
resistivity of insulation is 6x1010-m then the insulation resistance of 250m cable is
approximately ______________M
a. 22.45
Jo
b. 12.85
in
c. 32.75
@
SP
d. 100.25
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-6 Elementary concepts
a. Fully obeyed
b. Partially obeyed
b. Positive
c. Negative
a. Almost zero
b. Negative
c. Positive
42. A wire has a resistance of 10Ω.It is stretched by one tenth of its original length. then its
resistance will be
a. 10Ω
b. 12.1Ω
c. 9Ω
d. 11Ω
Jo
43. Tap supplies water at 22°C.A man takes 1 liter of water per minute at 37°C from the
geyser. the power of geyser is
in
@
a. 1050W
SP
P
b. 1575W
U
B
c. 525W
TE
C
d. 2100W
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-6 Elementary concepts
44. If the current in electric bulb drops by 2% then power decreases by ________%
a. 1
b. 2
c. 4
d. 16
45. The quantity of heat required to change the state of the substance without change in
temperature is called ____________
a. Sensible heat
b. Specific heat
c. Latent heat
d. Enthalpy
b. Amperes/volt
c. Ampere-volts
d. Amperes2 x ohm
a. 100ohm
b. 200ohm
c. 400ohm
d. 1600ohm
Jo
48. A wire carries a current of 5A for 10 sec to generate the heat of 500 joules then the
resistance of the wire is ________Ω
in
@
a. 1
SP
P
b. 0.5
U
B
c. 5
TE
C
d. 2
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Unit-6 Elementary concepts
a. Molecular energy
b. Potential energy
c. Atomic energy
d. Kinetic energy
a. 5J/C
b. 5V/C
c. 5 C / sec
d. 5 w / sec
Answers
Q A Q A Q A Q A Q A
1 a 11 c 21 c 31 c 41 a
2 a 12 c 22 d 32 b 42 b
3 c 13 c 23 a 33 a 43 a
4 c 14 b 24 b 34 a 44 c
5 d 15 c 25 a 35 c 45 c
6 c 16 a 26 d 36 c 46 b
7 b 17 c 27 c 37 d 47 c
8 b 18 b 28 a 38 a 48 d
9 a 19 c 29 a 39 a 49 d
10 a 20 b 30 b 40 c 50 c
Jo
in
@
SP
P U
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
UNIT I
Electromagnetism
Topic covered:
Review: resistance, emf, current, potential difference and ohm’s law
Magnetic effect of an electric current, cross and dot convention
Right hand thumb rule, nature of magnetic field of long straight conductor, solenoid and
toroid
Concept of mmf, flux, flux density, reluctance, permeability and field strength, their units
and relationships
Simple series and parallel magnetic circuit
Jo
in
Comparison of electric and magnetic circuit, force on carrying conductor placed in
@
magnetic field
SP
PU
Fleming’s left hand rule, faraday’s law of electromagnetic induction, Fleming's right
B
TE
hand rule
C
H
Statically and dynamically induced emf, self and mutual inductance, coefficient of
-T
el
couplings, Energy stored in magnetic field.
eg
ra
m
Resistance: The property of an electric circuit opposing the flow of current and at the same time
causes electrical energy to be converted to heat is called resistance.
ρ𝑙
R= Where,
𝑎
l= Length in metres
a= cross-sectional area in square metres
ρ= resistivity in ohms-metres
R= resistance in ohms
EMF(electromotive force): An electrical effort required to drift the free electrons in one particular
direction, in a conductor is called “EMF” . It is denoted as E and measured in volts.
Current: the rate of flow of charge in an electric circuit is called as current. It is denoted as I and
measured in Amperes or coulombs/sec
Electric Potential: Ability of a charged particle to do work is called its electric potential.
Jo
Potential Difference: The difference between the electric potentials at any two given points in a
in
circuit is known as Potential difference(p.d). It is denoted as V and measured in volts.
@
SP
Ohm’s law: It states that, “ The current flowing through the electric circuit is directly proportional
PU
to the potential difference across the circuit and inversely proportional to the resistance of the
B
TE
circuit, provided the temperature remains constant.
C
H
-T
mathematically,
el
eg
𝑉
I∝
ra
𝑅
m
Electromagnetism: It is the branch of engineering dealing with the magnetic effect of an electric
current.
Laws of magnetism:
1. Like magnetic poles repel and unlike poles attract each other.
2. the force exerted by one pole in another pole is directly proportional to the product of pole
strength and inversely proportional to the square of the distance between them.
Mathematically,
𝑚1𝑚2
F∝
𝑑2
Magnetic Field: It is a vector field that describes the magnetic influence on an electric charge
of other moving charges or magnetized materials.
Magnetic Effect of an Electric Current: The magnetic effect of electric current is known as
electromagnetic effect. It is observed that when a compass is brought near a current carrying
conductor the needle of compass gets deflected because of flow of electricity. This shows
Jo
that electric current produces a magnetic effect.
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
Cross and Dot Convention: cross and dot convention applies on electric current. It is generally
used to denote the direction of an electric current passed through a conductor.
cross(×) means current is going into the plane i.e away from you.
Dot(▪) means current is going out from the plane i.e coming towards you.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
Right Hand Thumb Rule: According to the right hand thumb rule if we hold the current carrying
TE
conductor in the right hand such that the thumb points in the direction of flow of current then the
C
H
fingers encircle the wire in the direction of the magnetic field lines.
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Nature of magnetic field of long straight conductor: The nature of the magnetic field lines
around a straight current carrying conductor is concentric circles with centre at the axis of
the conductor. The strength of the magnetic field created depends on the current through
the conductor.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Nature of magnetic field of Solenoid: When a long conductor is wound with number of turns
close together to form a coil whose axial length is several times greater than the diameter of
its turns, it is known as Solenoid.
Jo
in
Magnetic field strength inside a long solenoid:
@
SP
𝑁𝐼
H= where,
PU
𝑙
B
TE
H= magnetic field strength in newton's /weber or Amp/ meter
C
H
N= Number of turns of solenoid
-T
el
I= Current in Amperes
eg
ra
l= length of solenoid in meters
m
Nature of magnetic field of Toroid: A Toroid is a long solenoid which is bend into circular form.
The magnetic field in the open space inside (point P) and exterior to the toroid (point Q) is zero.
Jo
The field B inside the toroid is constant in magnitude for the ideal toroid of closely wound turns.
in
@
The direction of the magnetic field inside is clockwise as per the right-hand thumb rule for circular
SP
loops. Three circular Amperian loops 1, 2 and 3 are shown by dashed lines. By symmetry, the
PU
magnetic field should be tangential to each of them and constant in magnitude for a given loop.
B
TE
C
The magnetic field due to infinite solenoid is, B= µNI (Tesla)
H
-T
µ𝑵𝑰
el
The magnetic field due to toroid is, B= (Tesla)
eg
𝟐𝝅𝑹
ra
m
Concept of mmf, flux, flux density, reluctance, permeability and
field strength, their units and relationships:
Magneto-motive Force(MMF): The magneto-motive force which produces or tend to produce the
flux in the magnetic circuit is given by the product of turns on the magnetizing coil (N) and the
current flowing in the coil(I) i.e MMF=NI amperes
Magnetic Flux(Φ): The total number of lines of force in any particular magnetic field is called the
magnetic flux. Its unit is weber. 1 weber means 108 lines.
Magnetic Flux Density(B): The magnetic flux per unit area in a plane at right angles to the flux is
known as magnetic flux density.
𝜱
B= Tesla or wb/𝒎𝟐
𝒂
Magnetic Field strength: The force experienced by unit north pole placed at any point in a
magnetic field is known as Magnetic Field strength at that point.
𝑵𝑰
Jo
H= Amperes/ meter
𝒍
in
@
Permeability: It is defined as the ease with which a magnetic flux permits a medium. It is divided
SP
into three types.
PU
B
TE
1. Permeability of free space or vacuum(µ0 )
C
H
2. Absolute Permeability(µ)
-T
el
Relative Permeability(µ𝑟 )
eg
3.
ra
m
1. Permeabilty of free space or vacuum(µ𝟎 ): For a magnetic field in vacuum (or free space) the ratio
of flux density to magnetic field strength producing that flux density is called the permeability of free
space or magnetic space.
𝐵0
µ0 = =4π × 10−7 H/m
𝐻
2. Absolute Permeability(µ) : The ratio of magnetic flux density in a particular medium to the
magnetic field strength at the same location producing that flux density is called the absolute
permeability of that medium.
𝐵
µ= H/m
𝐻
3. Relative Permeability(µ𝑟 ): The ratio of the flux density produced in a material to the flux density
produced in a vacuum (or free space) by the same magnetic field strength under identical conditions is
called the relative permeability of that material. For Air, µ𝒓 =1
𝐵
µ𝑟 =
𝐵0
Jo
𝐵0
in
We have, µ0 = i.e 𝐵0 =µ0 H
@
𝐻
SP
𝐵
PU
µ= i.e B=µH
B
𝐻
TE
𝐵 µ𝐻 µ
C
µ𝑟 = = =
H
𝐵0 µ0 𝐻 µ0
-T
el
eg
µ=µ𝟎 µ𝒓
ra
m
Reluctance: Reluctance is the property of a material which opposes the magnetic flux in it.
Reluctance = mmf/ Flux AT/wb
It is denoted by S and is given as
S= l/µ𝟎 µ𝒓a
Jo
consist of materials having high permeability such as iron, soft steel etc.
in
@
Series Magnetic circuit are those magnetic circuits in which magnetic flux (ϕ) is same in
SP
PU
all the sections and the equivalent reluctance of such magnetic circuit equals summation of
B
reluctance of individual sections.
TE
C
H
Consider a composite series magnetic circuit consisting of three different magnetic
-T
el
materials of different relative permeabilities along with an air gap as shown in figure.
eg
ra
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
A parallel magnetic circuit has more than one path for the magnetic flux and can be
compared to a parallel electric circuit which has more than one path for electric current.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Comparison between Electric and Magnetic circuit:
Similarities:
Electric Circuit Magnetic Circuit
1. Path traced by the current is called electric circuit 1. Path traced by the magnetic flux is defined as
magnetic circuit
2. EMF is the driving force in electric circuit, the 2. MMF is the driving force in the magnetic circuit,
unit is volts the unit is ampere turns
3. Current-is the flow of electrons through a con- 3.Flux- is the lines of force through a medium
ductor. from N to S pole.
4.Limited by resistance (R) -opposition offered by 4. Limited by reluctance (S)- opposition offered by
the conductor to the flow of current. the magnetic path to the flow of flux.
Unit – ohm. Unit- AT/wb
Jo
in
5. Resistance is directly proportional to the length 5. Reluctance is directly proportional to the length
@
of the conductor. of the magnetic path.
SP
PU
6. Current Density (δ) is the rate of the electric 6. Flux Density (B) is the amount of magnetic flux
B
TE
currents flowing per unit cross-sectional area of per unit area of surface taken perpendicular to
C
a material. direction of magnetic flux.
H
-T
el
7. The KVL and KCL are applicable to electrical 7. The Kirchhoff’s flux and m.m.f laws are appli
eg
circuit. cable to the magnetic circuit.
ra
m
Dissimilarities:
Electric Circuit Magnetic Circuit
Jo
4. Energy needed as long as current flows through 4. Once magnetic flux is setup in a magnetic circuit,
in
electric circuit. no energy is needed.
@
SP
PU
5. The electric field is produced by a unit pole
5. The magnetic field is caused by a dipole of the
B
charge, i.e., either by a positive or through a
TE
magnet (i.e., the north and south pole).
C
negative charge.
H
-T
el
6. The electric field lines do not form a loop. 6. The magnetic field lines form a closed loop.
eg
ra
m
Force on a Current Carrying Conductor Placed in a Magnetic Field :
If a current carrying conductor is placed perpendicular to the direction of
magnetic field between the poles, it experiences a force which is
perpendicular to both the direction of current and the magnetic field.
When an electric current is passed through the wire, the wire if lifted
upwards showing that an upward force is acted on a current carrying
conductor. On reversing the direction of current, the wire moves downwards
indicating the force downwards.
The direction of force acting on a current carrying conductor placed in a
uniform magnetic field can be found by Fleming’s Left-hand Rule.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Fleming’s Left-hand Rule : Stretch out the first finger, second finger and Thumb of
your left hand so that they are at right angles to one another. If the first finger
points in the direction of magnetic field i.e. from north to south and the second
finger i.e. the middle finger points towards the direction of current, then the
thumb will point in the direction of motion of the conductor.
If the conductor lies at an angle θ with the magnetic flux, then the force
experienced on the current carrying conductor is given by ,
F = BI l sin θ
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Faraday’s Law of Electromagnetic Induction :
First Law: The first law states that whenever the magnetic flux linking a conductor or the coil changes,
an emf gets induced in it. Such an emf lasts so long as this change is taking place.
Second Law: The magnitude of emf induced in a conductor or coil is directly proportional to the rate of
change of flux linkages where
flux linkage = Flux x Number of turns of the coil.
Induced emf e = rate of change of flux linkage
Φ1 = initial value of flux linked with the coil.
Φ2 = final value of flux linked with the coil.
Change in flux linkages = N Φ2 – N Φ1
Rate of change of flux linkage = change in flux linkages / Time
In differential form
𝑑Φ
e= N
𝑑𝑡
Jo
in
The direction of induced emf and current in a closed circuit can be determined by
@
SP
(i) Lenz’s Law
PU
B
(ii) Fleming’s Right Hand Rule
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Fleming’s Right Hand Rule: This rule is to find out the direction of induced current in a
conductor which is moving perpendicular to the magnetic field.The Thumb, the first
(fore finger) and the second (middle finger) on the right hand are held so thatnthey are
mutually perpendicular to each other.
First Finger → Magnetic field
Thumb → Direction of motion of the conductor.
Middle Finger → direction of induced current.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Statically and dynamically induced emf : An electromotive force or emf is said to be
induced when the flux linking with a conductor or coil changes. This change in flux
linkage can be obtained in two different ways.
(i) Statically Induced EMF
(ii) Dynamically Induced EMF
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Consider a conductor of length l meters placed in a uniform magnetic field of B wb/m2 with a
velocity of v m/s.
Suppose the conductor moves through a small distance dx in dt seconds.
Area swept by the conductor = l dx m2
Flux cut d f = B l dx weber
Emf induced,
𝑑Φ
e= N
𝑑𝑡
e= B l v volts
Maximum flux is cut when the conductor moves perpendicular to the magnetic field as shown in
figure, hence emf induced is maximum.
If the conductor moves at an angle θ with respect to the magnetic field, then its velocity component is
given as v sinθ.
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Statically Induced emf : When the conductor is stationary and the field is moving or
changing, the emf induced in the conductor is called statically induced emf.
Statically induced emf is further classified as
(i) Self Induced emf
(ii) Mutually Induced emf
Self Induced emf: The emf induced in a coil due to the change of its own flux linked
with it is called self-induced emf.
Consider a coil with N number of turns. The variable resistance R is used to change the
current flowing through the coil which in turns changes the flux linked with the coil.
The change in the flux is achieved by increasing or decreasing the current through the
coil.
If the flux linked with the coil is Φ Webers, then the flux linkage with the coil = N Φ .
Due to the change in the flux linking with the coil, an emf is induced in the coil
Jo
according to Faraday’s law of electromagnetic Induction. This emf is called the self-
in
@
induced emf.
SP
PU
The direction of this emf according to Lenz’s law is such to oppose the very cause
B
TE
producing it i.e. the current and hence the field in the coil. The self-induced emf will
C
persist so long as the current in the coil is changing.
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
Self Induced EMF:
Self and mutual inductance : The property of a coil that opposes any change in the
amount of current flowing through it is known as Self-inductance or inductance.
If the current in the coil is increasing, the self-induced emf produced in the coil will
oppose the rise of current, that means the direction of the induced emf is opposite to the
applied voltage.
On the other hand, if the current in the coil is decreased, then the self-induced emf will
be in the same direction as that of the applied voltage i.e. self-induced emf will try to
maintain the coil current constant.
𝑑Φ
Induced emf e= N
𝑑𝑡
e =L di/ dt
The magnitude of self-induced emf is directly proportional to the rate of change of current
in the coil. L is constant of proportionality and called as Self Inductance or the Coefficient
Jo
of Self Inductance or Inductance of the coil.
in
L =N Φ/ I Henry
@
SP
Also
𝑁2
PU
L=
B
𝑆
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
Mutually induced emf:
Mutually Induced emf : The emf induced in a coil due to the change of flux produced by another
neighbouring coil linking to it, is called Mutually Induced emf.
Consider two coils A and B placed close to each other. When the switch (S) is closed in the circuit,
current I1 flows through the coil A, and it produces the flux Φ 1.
A part of the magnetic flux produced by coil A links with coil B i.e. Φ 12. is the flux linked with the
coil B due to the change of current in the coil A.
If the current flowing through the coil A is changed by changing the value of variable resistor R,it
changes the flux linking with the other coil B and hence emf is induced in both the coils.
The emf induced in coil A is called self-induced emf and the emf induced in coil B is called
Mutually Induced emf. The mutually induced emf in coil B persists so long as the current in coil A
is changing.
According to Lenz’s law, the direction of induced emf is such to oppose the very cause responsible
for it, i.e. it opposes the change of current in the first coil.
Since the rate of change of flux linking with the coil B depends upon the rate of change of
current in the coil A.
𝑑𝐼1
Jo
e=M
𝑑𝑡
in
Where M is a constant called mutual inductance between the two coils. Its unit is Henry.
@
SP
𝑁2 Φ12
PU
M=
B
I1
TE
C
Where Φ12 is the flux linked with coil B due to change of current in the coil A.
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Coefficient of Coupling :
The fraction of magnetic flux produced by the current in one coil that links with the
other coil is called the coefficient of coupling between the two coils.
It is denoted by (k). i.e. It gives the information of the flux which is linked between the
two coils. When k =1, the flux produced by one coil, completely links with the other
coil and is called magnetically tightly coupled.
When k = 0, the flux produced by one coil, does not link at all with the other coil and
thus the coils are said to be magnetically isolated.
The coefficient of coupling varies between 0 and 1.
Consider two magnetic coils 1 and 2 having N1 and N2 turns respectively. When
current I1 flows through coil 1, flux links with coil 1. If the coefficient of coupling
between the two coils is K, then the flux linked with coil 2 is K Φ1.
𝑁1 Φ1 𝑁2 KΦ1 𝑁1 KΦ2
By Self and Mutual inductance, L= and 𝑀12 = & 𝑀21=
Jo
𝐼1 𝐼1 𝐼2
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
𝐿1 𝐿2
𝑀
K=
Energy Stored in a Magnetic Field :
Consider an inductor connected to a d.c source. The inductor is equivalent to
inductance L in series with a small resistance R.
Consider an inductor connected to a d.c source. When the switch is ON, the current flowing
in the circuit rises gradually from zero to its final value and the magnetic field is established.
During this rise of current, an emf is induced across the inductor due to the change in flux
linkages. The self-induced emf across L is given as, e =L di/ dt
After the magnetic field is established, and the current has reached its maximum or
steady value, any further energy given to it, is dissipated as heat .i.e. once the steady
Jo
state has achieved ,no additional energy is required to maintain the magnetic field. The
in
induced voltage across L opposes the applied voltage. Electrical energy must be
@
SP
supplied to overcome this opposition. This supplied energy is stored in the magnetic
PU
field.
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
UNIT III
• A.C. Through Pure Resistance Alone :
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
• The circuit is shown in Fig. Let the applied voltage be given by the
el
equation. eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Pure Resistance Alone :
• v = Vmsin θ = Vmsin ωt... (i)
• Let R = ohmic resistance ; i= instantaneous current
• Hence for equilibrium
v = iR;
• Putting the value of ‘v’ from above,
we get Vmsin ωt= iR
𝑉𝑚
Jo
𝑖= sin 𝜔𝑡(ii)
in
𝑅
@
SP
• Current ‘i’ is maximum when sin ωtis unity ∴ Im= Vm/R Hence,
PU
B
equation (ii) becomes,
TE
C
H
• i= Imsin ωt... (iii)
-T
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Pure Resistance Alone :
• Comparing (i) and (ii), we find that the alternating voltage and current
are in phase with each other as shown in above Fig.
Jo
𝑉𝑚 𝐼𝑚
• Power consists of a constant part and a fluctuating part
in
@
2
SP
𝑉𝑚 𝐼𝑚
cos 2𝜔𝑡 of frequency double that of voltage and current waves.
PU
2
B
TE
𝑉𝑚 𝐼𝑚
C
• For a complete cycle. the average value of cos 2𝜔𝑡 Is zero.
H
-T
2
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Pure Resistance Alone :
• or P = V × I watt
• where V = r.m.s. value of applied voltage.
I = r.m.s. value of the current.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Pure Inductance Alone
• Whenever an alternating voltage is applied to a purely inductive coil,
a back e.m.f. is produced due to the self-inductance of the coil.
• The back e.m.f., at every step, opposes the rise or fall of current
through the coil.
• As there is no ohmic voltage drop, the applied voltage has to
overcome this self-induced e.m.f. only.
𝑑𝐼 𝑉𝑚
•𝑣=𝐿 = 𝑉𝑚 sin 𝜔𝑡 , ∴ 𝑖 = sin 𝜔𝑡
𝑑𝑡 𝐿
𝑉𝑚 𝜋 𝑉𝑚 𝜋
•=
Jo
sin 𝜔𝑡 − = sin 𝜔𝑡 −
in
𝜔𝐿 2 𝑋𝐿 2
@
SP
𝑉𝑚 𝜋
• Maximum value of Im= when sin 𝜔𝑡 −
PU
is unity.
B
𝜔𝐿 2
TE
C
𝜋
• Hence the equation for current becomes 𝑖 = 𝐼𝑚 sin 𝜔𝑡 −
H
-T
2
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Pure Inductance Alone
Jo
• Clearly, the current lags behind the applied voltage by a quarter cycle.
in
@
SP
• We have Im = Vm/ω L = Vm/XL.
PU
B
• Here ‘ωL’ plays the part of ‘resistance’.
TE
C
H
• It is called the (inductive) reactance XL of the coil and is given in ohms
-T
el
eg
if L is in henry and ω is in radian/second.
ra
m
A.C. Through Pure Inductance Alone
• Now, XL = ω L = 2π f L ohm.
• It is seen that XL depends directly on frequency of the voltage.
• Higher the value of f, greater the reactance offered and vice-versa.
• Power:
• Instantaneous Power
𝜋 𝑉𝑚 𝐼𝑚 2𝜋
• =𝑉𝑚 𝐼𝑚 sin 𝜔𝑡 − ∴𝑃= − 0 sin 2𝜔𝑡 𝑑𝑡 = 0
2 2
• It is also clear from Fig. that the average demand of power from the
Jo
supply for a complete cycle is zero.
in
@
• Here again it is seen that power wave is a sine wave of frequency
SP
PU
double that of the voltage and current waves.
B
TE
C
H
• The maximum value of the instantaneous power is VmIm/2.
-T
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Pure Capacitance Alone
• When an alternating voltage is applied to the plates of a capacitor, the
capacitor is charged first in one direction and then in the opposite
direction.
• When reference to Fig. shown below, let
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Pure Capacitance Alone
• v = p.d. developed between plates at any instant
• q = Charge on plates at that instant.
• Then q = Cv...where C is the capacitance
= C Vmsin ωt...putting the value of v.
• Now, current iis given by the rate of flow of charge.
𝑑𝑞 𝑑 𝑉𝑚 𝑉𝑚 𝜋
•𝑖= = 𝐶 𝑉𝑚 sin 𝜔𝑡 = 1 cos 𝜔𝑡 = sin 𝜔𝑡 + =
𝑑𝑡 𝑑𝑡 ൗ𝜔𝐶 𝑋𝐶 2
𝜋
Jo
𝐼𝑚 sin 𝜔𝑡 +
in
2
@
SP
• The denominator XC = 1/ωCis known as capacitive reactance and is in
PU
B
ohms if C is in farad and ω in radian/ second.
TE
C
H
• It is seen that if the applied voltage is given by v = Vmsin ωt, then the
-T
el
eg
current is given by i= Imsin (ωt+ π/2).
ra
m
A.C. Through Pure Capacitance Alone
• Power:
• Instantaneous Power = p=vi
= VmImsin (ωt+ π/2)
1 2𝜋
•𝑝= 𝑉 𝐼 sin 2𝜔𝑡 𝑑𝑡 = 0
2 𝑚 𝑚 0
• We find that in a purely capacitive circuit, the average demand of
power from supply is zero (as in a purely inductive circuit).
• Again, it is seen that power wave is a sine wave of frequency double
Jo
that of the voltage and current waves.
in
@
SP
• The maximum value of the instantaneous power is VmIm/2.
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Resistance and Inductance
• A pure resistance R and a pure inductive coil of inductance L are
shown connected in series in Fig.
• The series combination is connected across a.c. supply given by 𝑣 =
𝑉𝑚 sin 𝜔𝑡.
• The circuit draws a current I from the supply.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Resistance and Inductance
• There are two voltage drops as under:
• Drop across resistance R VR = IR
• Drop across Inductance L VL =IXL
• I = RMS value of current drawn
• VR, VL = RMS values of voltage drops.
• The Kirchhoff’s voltage law can be applied to a.c. circuit, but only
point to be considered here is the addition of voltages should be
phasor addition and no longer algebraic as in the case of d.c.
Jo
in
• ∴ 𝑉ത = 𝑉𝑅 + 𝑉𝐿
@
• 𝑉ത = 𝐼𝑅 + 𝐼𝑋𝐿 SP
PU
B
TE
• For series ac circuit, current is taken as reference phasor as it is
C
H
-T
common to both elements.
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Resistance and Inductance
• Steps to draw phasor diagram:
1. Take current as reference phasor.
2. In case of resistance, v& I are in phase, so VR will be along current
phasor.
3. In case of inductor, I lags V by 900. As current is reference, VL must be
shown leading with respect to current by 900.
4. The supply voltage being vector sum of these two vectors, VL and VR
is obtained by Law of parallelogram.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
A.C. Through Resistance and Inductance
• From the voltage triangle, we can write
•𝑉= 𝑉𝑅2 + 𝑉𝐿2 = 𝐼 𝑅2 + 𝑋𝐿2 = 𝐼𝑍
• Where, 𝑍 = 𝑅2 + 𝑋𝐿2 ,
• The impedance Z is measured in ohms.
• From the phasor diagram it is clear that current I is lagging the
resultant voltage V by an angle. Therefore the expression for the
instantaneous current I will be as under:
• 𝒊 = 𝑰𝒎 𝐬𝐢𝐧 𝝎𝒕 − ∅
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Resistance and Inductance
• Power consumed in the circuit will be
• 𝑃 = 𝑣 × 𝑖 = 𝑉𝑚 sin 𝜔𝑡 × 𝐼𝑚 sin 𝜔𝑡 − ∅
• = 𝑉𝑚 𝐼𝑚 sin 𝜔𝑡 sin 𝜔𝑡 − ∅
𝑉𝑚 𝐼𝑚
•= cos ∅ − cos 2𝜔𝑡 − ∅
2
𝑉𝑚 𝐼𝑚 𝑉𝑚 𝐼𝑚 cos 2𝜔𝑡−∅
•= cos ∅ −
2 2
• The second term is a cosine term whose average value over a
Jo
complete cycle is zero.
in
@
𝑉𝑚 𝐼𝑚 𝑉𝑚 𝐼𝑚
SP
• ∴ 𝑃𝑎𝑣 = cos ∅ = cos ∅ = 𝑉𝐼 cos ∅ 𝑤𝑎𝑡𝑡𝑠
PU
2 2 2
B
TE
• 𝑤ℎ𝑒𝑟𝑒 𝑉 & 𝐼 𝑎𝑟𝑒 𝑡ℎ𝑒 𝑟. 𝑚. 𝑠. 𝑣𝑎𝑙𝑢𝑒𝑠 𝑜𝑓 𝑣𝑜𝑙𝑡𝑎𝑔𝑒 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑐𝑢𝑟𝑟𝑒𝑛𝑡.
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Resistance and Capacitance:
• Consider a circuit consisting of pure resistance R ohms connected in
series with a pure inductance of L Henries as shown in Fig.
• The series combination is connected across a.c. supply given by 𝑣 =
𝑉𝑚 sin 𝜔𝑡.
• The circuit draws a current I from the supply.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Resistance and Capacitance:
• There are two voltage drops as under:
• Drop across resistance R VR = IR
• Drop across Inductance L VL =I XC
• I = RMS value of current drawn
• VR, VC = RMS values of voltage drops.
• The Kirchhoff’s voltage law can be applied to a.c. circuit, but only
point to be considered here is the addition of voltages should be
phasor addition and no longer algebraic as in the case of d.c.
Jo
in
• ∴ 𝑉ത = 𝑉𝑅 + 𝑉𝐶
@
SP
PU
• 𝑉ത = 𝐼𝑅 + 𝐼𝑋𝐶
B
TE
C
• For series ac circuit, current is taken as reference phasor as it is
H
-T
el
common to both elements.
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Resistance and Capacitance:
• Steps to draw phasor diagram:
• Take current as reference phasor.
• In case of resistance, v& I are in phase, so VR will be along current
phasor.
• In case of capacitor, I lead V by 900. As current is reference, VL must
be shown lagging with respect to current by 900.
• The supply voltage being vector sum of these two vectors, VC and VR
is obtained by Law of parallelogram.
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
A.C. Through Resistance and Capacitance:
• From the voltage triangle, we can write
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
Fig: AC through series R-L-C series circuit
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
• Consider R-L-C series circuit as shown in above figure.The ac supply is
given by
• The voltage drops across R, L & C are as under:
• VR=IR Volts
• VL= I XL Volts
• VC= I XC Volts
According to Kirchoff’s Law, we can write,
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo
• The phasor diagram depends on the conditions of magnitudes of VL
and VC . Let us consider the different cases:
• Case I . XL > XC
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
Fig: Phasor diagram and voltage triangle
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
m
ra
eg
el
-T
H
C
TE
B
PU
SP
@
in
Jo XC > XL
Case II
Fig: Phasor diagram and voltage triangle
Jo
in
@
SP
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
Sketch Impedance triangle and Admittance triangle and define admittance and Impedance
Jo
in
@
SP
Fig: Admittance triangle
PU
B
TE
C
H
-T
el
eg
ra
m
• Impedance: Impedance is defined as the resistance offered by the
circuit to the flow of alternating current through it.Its denoted by Z
and measured in ohms.
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1000171_T1 BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGG.
Time : 1hr
Max Marks : 50
N.B
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. If the effective value of the sinusoidal voltage is 111 Volts. Its average value is
A : 100 V
B : 123.21 V
C : 156.51 V
D : 78.48 V
A : increases
B : decreases
Q.no 3. From the following which is not the property of line of magnetic force ( Flux )
Q.no 4. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 150 Hz
A : nodal analysis
B : mesh analysis
A : meter / weber
B : Amp / meter
C : Tesla
D : weber / meter
A : linear curve
B : sinusoidal curve
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : exponential curve
D : parabolic curve
Q.no 9. When the supply frequency of transformer is doubled then the eddy current loss
A : remains same
B : is reduced by 50 percent
C : is doubled
Q.no 10. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 10 Amp
C : 5 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
A:1
B : 1.11
C : 1.41
D : 1.21
Q.no 12. In a three phase star connected system the phase difference between phase voltages and
their respetive line voltages is
A : 30 degrees
B : 120 degrees
C : 60 degrees
D : 45 degrees
A : Silicon steel
B : Copper
C : Manganin
D : Aluminium
A : increases
B : decreases
C : remaims constant
D : slightly increases
A : The type of material, the area of cross section and the length of the conductor
B : The area of cross section and the length of the conductor only
Q.no 17. Frequency of the primary and secondary parameters of the transformer
Q.no 18. In a transformer, which of the following windings has more number of turns ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 4/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 19. In superposition theorem, when we consider the effect of one current source, all the
other voltage sources are
A : removed
B : shorted
C : open circuited
D : connected
A : infinite
B : zero
C : high
D : low
Q.no 21. During charging or discharging of a capacitor, no current actually passes through the
A : connecting wires
B : battery
C : dielectric
D : circuit switch
A:Y/G
B:B/G
C:G/Y
D:B/Y
Q.no 23. Which of the material has negative temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : PVC
A : Purely inductive
B : Purely capacitive
C : Purely resistive
Q.no 25. For a fixed supply voltage, the current flowing through a conductor will decrease if
A : Load current
B : Leakage current
C : Leakage flux
D : Conventional current
Q.no 27. Electrical network having only resistances without energy sources is known as
________________
A : Passive network
B : active network
C : lateral network
D : source network
A : Amp-turm
B : Weber/turn
D : Tesla
Q.no 30. The direction of induced emf in a rotating conductor in stationary magnetic field is
given by
Q.no 31. For better performance of a transformer , the voltage regulation must be
A : 1 percent
B : as high as possible
C : as low as possible
Q.no 32. EMF induced in a coil because of self / own changing flux cutting is known as
A : 3.6 J
B : 3.6 kJ
C : 3.6 MJ
D : 3600 J
Q.no 34. If the frequency of power supply is 60 Hz , the time peroiod of one cycle will be
A : 0.02 sec
B : 20 msec
C : 16.67 msec
D : 0.1667 sec
A : Linear networks
B : Non-Linear networks
Q.no 36. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
C : Flux direction can be reversed but field strength can not be altered
Q.no 38. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
A : store energy
B : dissipate energy
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
Q.no 43. Certain coil has 100 turns and is carrying 4 ampere current, MMF of the coil is
A : 100 amp-turn
B : 400 amp-turn
C : 25 amp-turm
D : 40 amp-turn
Q.no 44. For a three phase delta connected load , the line current is equal to ------------ times that
of its phase current.
A : 1.73
B : 1.42
C:2
D:3
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
Q.no 46. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature coefficient of the filament is
A : negative
B : zero
C : infinite
D : positive
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
D : 31.4 ohms
Q.no 48. A balanced star connected load is supplied from three phase 400 V 50 Hz system. Its
phase voltage is
A : 400 V
B : 230.94 V
C : 692.8 V
D : 100 V
Q.no 50. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 51. A current of 2A flows through a 100 Ohm resistance for 10 hours. The energy consumed
is
A : 0.5 KWh
B : 4 KWh
C : 2 KWh
D : 0.02 KWh
Q.no 52. Which of the following lamps will have the least resistance at room temperature?
A : 25W, 220V
B : 100W, 220V
C : 200W, 220V
D : 60W, 220V
Q.no 53. When Two coils are tightly coupled, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to 1
Q.no 54. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 100 V
B : 141.4 V
C : 200 V
D : 90.21 V
Q.no 55. In a three phase balanced delta connected system all the phase currents are displaced
from each other by
A : 30 degrees
B : 45 degrees
C : 120 degrees
D : 60 degrees
Q.no 57. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
will be
A : three times
B : one third
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 58. When Two coils are magnetically isolated , then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A:0
B:1
C : less than 1
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 12/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 1.5
Q.no 59. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 60. If 03 equal resistances are connected in delta, their equivalent each STAR resistance will
be
A : one third
B : three times
C : two times
D : two third
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1000171_T1 BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGG.
Time : 1hr
Max Marks : 50
N.B
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half cycle
is
A : r.m.s. value
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
Q.no 2. From the following which is not the property of line of magnetic force ( Flux )
A : infinite
B : zero
C : high
D : low
Q.no 6. If the current in an electric bulb drops by 2 percent, then the power developed reduces by
A : 1 percent
B : 2 percent
C : 4 percent
D : 16 percent
Q.no 7. If the frequency of power supply is 60 Hz , the time peroiod of one cycle will be
A : 0.02 sec
B : 20 msec
C : 16.67 msec
D : 0.1667 sec
A : nodal analysis
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : mesh analysis
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : iron
A : Resistance
B : Inductor
C : Capacitor
D : Diode
Q.no 12. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
C : Reluctance
D : Capacitance
Q.no 13. In a transformer, which of the following windings has more number of turns ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 14. Which of the material has positive temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : mica
C : pvc
D : dry paper
Q.no 15. Current variation in the one coil causes voltage induced in the other nearby coil is
known as
Q.no 17. For a fixed supply voltage, the current flowing through a conductor will decrease if
A : Purely inductive
B : Purely capacitive
C : Purely resistive
C : Directly proportional to the product of current in conductor and turns of the coil
D : Directly proportional to the ratio of current in conductor and turns of the coil
B : Hysteresis loss
C : Copper loss
D : Frictional loss
C : power transformers
D : distribution transformers
Q.no 22. If the active and apperent power of an a c circuit are equal in magnetude then its power
factor is
A : 0.5 lag
B : 0.707 lag
C : 0.8 lead
D : unity
A : increases
B : decreases
Q.no 24. A circuit content one or more sources of energy, then circuit is known as
A : passive
B : active
C : linear
D : non linear
Q.no 25. The phasor addition of all the phase voltages at any instant in three phase symmetrical
system is always
A:0
B:1
C : 120
D : 90
Q.no 26. For same rating , the size of three phase machine is ---------- to that of single phase
machine.
A : more
B : same
C : less
A : The type of material, the area of cross section and the length of the conductor
B : The area of cross section and the length of the conductor only
A : 1.57
B : 1.11
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 0.636
D : 1.414
Q.no 30. Every current carrying conductor placed in magnetic field will
A : Load current
B : Leakage current
C : Leakage flux
D : Conventional current
A : meter / weber
B : Amp / meter
C : Tesla
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : weber / meter
Q.no 34. Which of the material has negative temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : PVC
A : Absolute permittivity
B : Relative permittivity
D : Absolute permeability
C : Flux direction can be reversed but field strength can not be altered
Q.no 37. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
A : 4 ohm
B : 12 ohm
C : 36 ohm
D : 6 ohm
Q.no 38. A balanced star connected load is supplied from three phase 400 V 50 Hz system. Its
phase voltage is
A : 400 V
B : 230.94 V
C : 692.8 V
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 100 V
Q.no 39. For a three phase delta connected load , the line current is equal to ------------ times that
of its phase current.
A : 1.73
B : 1.42
C:2
D:3
A : store energy
B : dissipate energy
Q.no 41. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in star, their equivalent each resistance
in delta will be--
A : 6 ohm
B : 36 ohm
C : 12 ohm
D : 2 ohm
Q.no 43. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If value of resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 1A
B : 0A
C : 0.5A
D : 2A
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
Q.no 46. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
D : 31.4 ohms
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : power
Q.no 49. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
Q.no 50. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
C : 20A
D : 0A
Q.no 51. The total capacitance of four capacitors each of 10 mF connected in series is
A : 0.4 mF
B : 2.5 mF
C : 40 mF
D : 10 mF
Q.no 52. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 53. A 10 mF, 20 mF, 25 mF, and 100 mF capacitor are in parallel. The total capacitance is
A : 0.2 mF
B : 5 mF
C : 100 mF
D : 155 mF
Q.no 54. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
C : 10
D : 13
Q.no 55. If 03 equal resistances are connected in delta, their equivalent each STAR resistance will
be
A : one third
B : three times
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 56. A current of 2A flows through a 100 Ohm resistance for 10 hours. The energy consumed
is
A : 0.5 KWh
B : 4 KWh
C : 2 KWh
D : 0.02 KWh
Q.no 57. Three 100 ohm resistances are connected in star across 400 V three phase supply. If one
of the resistances is disconnected then the line current is
A : 2 Amp
B : 4 Amp
C : 8 Amp
D : 6.92 Amp
Q.no 58. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 100 V
B : 141.4 V
C : 200 V
D : 90.21 V
Q.no 60. A series R-L circuit has resistance of 6 ohms and reactance of 8 ohms. The impedance of
the circuit is
A : 10 ohms
B : 14 ohms
C : 2 ohms
D : 13.43 ohms
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1000171_T1 BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGG.
Time : 1hr
Max Marks : 50
N.B
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in series, the equivalent resistance is--ohm
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
A : increases
B : decreases
C : power transformers
D : distribution transformers
Q.no 5. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in parallel, the equivalent resistance is
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
A : The type of material, the area of cross section and the length of the conductor
B : The area of cross section and the length of the conductor only
Q.no 7. Pure inductor connected to 200V, 50Hz 1 phase AC supply draws a current of 20A. what
will be the power consumed by it
A : 200 Watt
B : 0 Watt
C : 4000 Watt
D : 2000 Watt
A : Irms / Iav
B : Iav / Irms
C : Im/Irms
D : Irms/Im
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : PVC
A : meter / weber
B : Amp / meter
C : Tesla
D : weber / meter
A : Amp-turm
B : Weber/turn
D : Tesla
B : frequency is constant
Q.no 13. Frequency of the primary and secondary parameters of the transformer
A:1
B : 1.11
C : 1.41
D : 1.21
A : ohm
B : siemens
C : ampere
D : micro farad
Q.no 16. When the supply frequency of transformer is doubled then the eddy current loss
A : remains same
B : is reduced by 50 percent
C : is doubled
Q.no 17. EMF induced in a coil because of self / own changing flux cutting is known as
Q.no 18. In a transformer electrical power is transferred from one circuit to other without
change in the
A : Voltage
B : Current
C : Impedance
D : Frequency
Q.no 19. The value of Resistance Temperature Coefficient of material depends upon
Q.no 20. EMF induced in a conductor when magnetic field is stationary and conductor is moving
is known as
Q.no 21. The maximum flux produced in the core of the transformer is
A : infinite
B : zero
C : high
D : low
A : nodal analysis
B : mesh analysis
A : Purely inductive
B : Purely capacitive
C : Purely resistive
Q.no 26. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half
cycle is
A : r.m.s. value
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
Q.no 27. If the frequency of power supply is 60 Hz , the time peroiod of one cycle will be
A : 0.02 sec
B : 20 msec
C : 16.67 msec
D : 0.1667 sec
Q.no 28. The direction of induced emf in a rotating conductor in stationary magnetic field is
given by
A : Mesh
B : Branch
C : Path
D : Junction
A : iron loss
B : copper loss
D : no losses
A : increases
B : decreases
C : remaims constant
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : slightly increases
A : 1.57
B : 1.11
C : 0.636
D : 1.414
Q.no 35. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 150 Hz
A : store energy
B : dissipate energy
A : mutual induction
B : self-induction
C : magnetic induction
D : electrostatic induction
Q.no 38. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
Q.no 40. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature coefficient of the filament is
A : negative
B : zero
C : infinite
D : positive
Q.no 41. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
A : 4 ohm
B : 12 ohm
C : 36 ohm
D : 6 ohm
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
Q.no 43. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
Q.no 44. When 40 resistances each of 40 ohms are connected in parallel, their equivalent
resistance will be--
A : 20 ohm
B : 8 ohm
C : 1 ohm
D : 40 ohm
Q.no 46. For a three phase star connected load , the relation between phase voltage and line
voltage is
Q.no 47. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
Q.no 48. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in star, their equivalent each resistance
in delta will be--
A : 6 ohm
B : 36 ohm
C : 12 ohm
D : 2 ohm
Q.no 49. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
C : 20A
D : 0A
Q.no 50. When Two coils are magnetically isolated, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to zero
Q.no 51. When Two coils are magnetically isolated , then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A:0
B:1
C : less than 1
D : 1.5
Q.no 52. A current of 2A flows through a 100 Ohm resistance for 10 hours. The energy consumed
is
A : 0.5 KWh
B : 4 KWh
C : 2 KWh
D : 0.02 KWh
Q.no 53. The total capacitance of four capacitors each of 10 mF connected in series is
A : 0.4 mF
B : 2.5 mF
C : 40 mF
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 10 mF
Q.no 54. What will be current drawn by a 1 kW electric heater if its resistance in fully heated
condition is 40 ohm?
A : 5A
B : 2.5 A
C : 10A
D : 1.25A
Q.no 55. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
will be
A : three times
B : one third
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 56. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
C : 10
D : 13
Q.no 57. Which of the following lamps will have the least resistance at room temperature?
A : 25W, 220V
B : 100W, 220V
C : 200W, 220V
D : 60W, 220V
Q.no 58. In a three phase balanced delta connected system all the phase currents are displaced
from each other by
A : 30 degrees
B : 45 degrees
C : 120 degrees
D : 60 degrees
Q.no 59. When Two coils are tightly coupled, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to 1
Q.no 60. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1000171_T1 BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGG.
Time : 1hr
Max Marks : 50
N.B
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. During charging or discharging of a capacitor, no current actually passes through the
A : connecting wires
B : battery
C : dielectric
D : circuit switch
A : linear curve
B : sinusoidal curve
C : exponential curve
D : parabolic curve
Q.no 3. EMF induced in a conductor when magnetic field is stationary and conductor is moving
is known as
A:Y/G
B:B/G
C:G/Y
D:B/Y
Q.no 5. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(377t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 314 Hz
Q.no 6. In an ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of
1A. Its terminal voltage will be
A : 11 V
B : 12 V
C : 12.5 V
D : 11.5 V
Q.no 7. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in series, the equivalent resistance is--ohm
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
A : very high
B : very low
C : zero
A : backelite
B : mica
C : cotton
D : copper
Q.no 10. In a transformer electrical power is transferred from one circuit to other without
change in the
A : Voltage
B : Current
C : Impedance
D : Frequency
Q.no 11. For parallel combination of capacitors, which of the following remains constant?
A : Flux
B : Charge
C : Current
D : Voltage
C : Directly proportional to the product of current in conductor and turns of the coil
D : Directly proportional to the ratio of current in conductor and turns of the coil
Q.no 13. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half
cycle is
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
A : r.m.s. value
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
Q.no 14. When the supply frequency of transformer is doubled then the eddy current loss
A : remains same
B : is reduced by 50 percent
C : is doubled
Q.no 16. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
C : Reluctance
D : Capacitance
Q.no 17. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its Average value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 10 Amp
C : 9 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
A : infinite
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 4/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : zero
C : high
D : low
Q.no 20. For same rating , the size of three phase machine is ---------- to that of single phase
machine.
A : more
B : same
C : less
Q.no 21. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in parallel, the equivalent resistance is
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
A : 1.57
B : 1.11
C : 0.636
D : 1.414
A : Reluctance
B : Resistance
C : Reactance
D : Impedance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : iron
Q.no 26. The maximum flux produced in the core of the transformer is
A : nodal analysis
B : mesh analysis
A : Resistance
B : Inductor
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : Capacitor
D : Diode
C : power transformers
D : distribution transformers
A : kilo amper
B : amper
C : milli amper
D : micro amper
A : Load current
B : Leakage current
C : Leakage flux
D : Conventional current
Q.no 32. If the voltage applied to a 250 W,250 V incandescent lamp is 250 V, then the current
flowing at the instant of switching would be
A : 1.25 A
A : infinite
B : zero
C : high
D : low
Q.no 34. Pure inductor connected to 200V, 50Hz 1 phase AC supply draws a current of 20A. what
will be the power consumed by it
A : 200 Watt
B : 0 Watt
C : 4000 Watt
D : 2000 Watt
A : increases
B : decreases
C : remaims constant
D : slightly increases
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
D : 31.4 ohms
Q.no 37. When 40 resistances each of 40 ohms are connected in parallel, their equivalent
resistance will be--
A : 20 ohm
B : 8 ohm
C : 1 ohm
D : 40 ohm
Q.no 38. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
Q.no 40. A balanced star connected load is supplied from three phase 400 V 50 Hz system. Its
phase voltage is
A : 400 V
B : 230.94 V
C : 692.8 V
D : 100 V
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
C : Flux direction can be reversed but field strength can not be altered
Q.no 43. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
A : 4 ohm
B : 12 ohm
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 36 ohm
D : 6 ohm
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
Q.no 46. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
Q.no 47. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature coefficient of the filament is
A : negative
B : zero
C : infinite
D : positive
Q.no 48. When Two coils are magnetically isolated, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to zero
Q.no 49. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
C : 20A
D : 0A
Q.no 50. The power factor of series R-L-C ac series circuit , at resonance is
A : unity
B : zero
C : 0.5 lagging
D : 0.5 leading
Q.no 51. What will be current drawn by a 1 kW electric heater if its resistance in fully heated
condition is 40 ohm?
A : 5A
B : 2.5 A
C : 10A
D : 1.25A
Q.no 52. Which of the following lamps will have the least resistance at room temperature?
A : 25W, 220V
B : 100W, 220V
C : 200W, 220V
D : 60W, 220V
Q.no 53. Three 100 ohm resistances are connected in star across 400 V three phase supply. If one
of the resistances is disconnected then the line current is
A : 2 Amp
B : 4 Amp
C : 8 Amp
D : 6.92 Amp
Q.no 54. Soft iron electro-magnet has cross sectional area 10 square centimeter and has 0.6 mWb
flux, what will be the flux density in the core
A : 0.6 Tesla
B : 6 Tesla
C : 3 Wb/sq. meter
D : 0.06 Tesla
Q.no 55. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
will be
A : three times
B : one third
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 56. A current of 2A flows through a 100 Ohm resistance for 10 hours. The energy consumed
is
A : 0.5 KWh
B : 4 KWh
C : 2 KWh
D : 0.02 KWh
Q.no 57. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 100 V
B : 141.4 V
C : 200 V
D : 90.21 V
Q.no 58. If 03 equal resistances are connected in delta, their equivalent each STAR resistance will
be
A : one third
B : three times
C : two times
D : two third
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1000171_T1 BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGG.
Time : 1hr
Max Marks : 50
N.B
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. In a three phase star connected system the phase difference between phase voltages and
their respetive line voltages is
A : 30 degrees
B : 120 degrees
C : 60 degrees
D : 45 degrees
Q.no 2. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 10 Amp
C : 5 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
Q.no 3. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
C : Reluctance
D : Capacitance
Q.no 4. A circuit content one or more sources of energy, then circuit is known as
A : passive
B : active
C : linear
D : non linear
Q.no 5. During charging or discharging of a capacitor, no current actually passes through the
A : connecting wires
B : battery
C : dielectric
D : circuit switch
Q.no 6. If the voltage applied to a 250 W,250 V incandescent lamp is 250 V, then the current
flowing at the instant of switching would be
A : 1.25 A
Q.no 7. In a transformer, which of the following windings has more number of turns ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 8. The insulation resistance of a single core cable is inversely proportional to its
A : width
B : thickness
C : length
D : resistivity
A : increases
B : decreases
B : Hysteresis loss
C : Copper loss
D : Frictional loss
A : infinite
B : zero
C : high
D : low
A : linear curve
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : sinusoidal curve
C : exponential curve
D : parabolic curve
Q.no 14. Which of the material has negative temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : PVC
Q.no 15. If the current in an electric bulb drops by 2 percent, then the power developed reduces
by
A : 1 percent
B : 2 percent
C : 4 percent
D : 16 percent
Q.no 16. The phasor addition of all the phase voltages at any instant in three phase symmetrical
system is always
A:0
B:1
C : 120
D : 90
Q.no 17. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 150 Hz
Q.no 18. Electrical network having only resistances without energy sources is known as
________________
A : Passive network
B : active network
C : lateral network
D : source network
A : increases
B : decreases
C : remaims constant
D : slightly increases
A : Absolute permittivity
B : Relative permittivity
D : Absolute permeability
Q.no 22. In a transformer electrical power is transferred from one circuit to other without
change in the
A : Voltage
B : Current
C : Impedance
D : Frequency
Q.no 23. Which of the material has almost zero temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : Nichrome
A : Silicon steel
B : Copper
C : Manganin
D : Aluminium
A : ohm
B : siemens
C : ampere
D : micro farad
A : Load current
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : Leakage current
C : Leakage flux
D : Conventional current
Q.no 29. For a fixed supply voltage, the current flowing through a conductor will decrease if
Q.no 30. For same rating , the size of three phase machine is ---------- to that of single phase
machine.
A : more
B : same
C : less
Q.no 31. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(377t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 314 Hz
Q.no 32. For better performance of a transformer , the voltage regulation must be
A : 1 percent
B : as high as possible
C : as low as possible
Q.no 33. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half
cycle is
A : r.m.s. value
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
A : Resistance
B : Inductor
C : Capacitor
D : Diode
Q.no 35. EMF induced in a coil because of self / own changing flux cutting is known as
Q.no 37. For a three phase star connected load , the relation between phase voltage and line
voltage is
A : store energy
B : dissipate energy
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
Q.no 40. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If value of resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 1A
B : 0A
C : 0.5A
D : 2A
C : Flux direction can be reversed but field strength can not be altered
Q.no 42. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
A : 4 ohm
B : 12 ohm
C : 36 ohm
D : 6 ohm
Q.no 43. The power factor of series R-L-C ac series circuit , at resonance is
A : unity
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : zero
C : 0.5 lagging
D : 0.5 leading
Q.no 44. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
C : 20A
D : 0A
A : mutual induction
B : self-induction
C : magnetic induction
D : electrostatic induction
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
Q.no 47. When Two coils are magnetically isolated, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to zero
Q.no 48. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature coefficient of the filament is
A : negative
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : zero
C : infinite
D : positive
Q.no 49. When 40 resistances each of 40 ohms are connected in parallel, their equivalent
resistance will be--
A : 20 ohm
B : 8 ohm
C : 1 ohm
D : 40 ohm
Q.no 50. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 52. When Two coils are tightly coupled, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to 1
Q.no 53. In a three phase balanced delta connected system all the phase currents are displaced
from each other by
A : 30 degrees
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 45 degrees
C : 120 degrees
D : 60 degrees
Q.no 54. Soft iron electro-magnet has cross sectional area 10 square centimeter and has 0.6 mWb
flux, what will be the flux density in the core
A : 0.6 Tesla
B : 6 Tesla
C : 3 Wb/sq. meter
D : 0.06 Tesla
Q.no 55. Three 100 ohm resistances are connected in star across 400 V three phase supply. If one
of the resistances is disconnected then the line current is
A : 2 Amp
B : 4 Amp
C : 8 Amp
D : 6.92 Amp
Q.no 56. A 10 mF, 20 mF, 25 mF, and 100 mF capacitor are in parallel. The total capacitance is
A : 0.2 mF
B : 5 mF
C : 100 mF
D : 155 mF
Q.no 58. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 12/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 59. A current of 2A flows through a 100 Ohm resistance for 10 hours. The energy consumed
is
A : 0.5 KWh
B : 4 KWh
C : 2 KWh
D : 0.02 KWh
Q.no 60. A series R-L circuit has resistance of 6 ohms and reactance of 8 ohms. The impedance of
the circuit is
A : 10 ohms
B : 14 ohms
C : 2 ohms
D : 13.43 ohms
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1000171_T1 BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGG.
Time : 1hr
Max Marks : 50
N.B
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
A : 3.6 J
B : 3.6 kJ
C : 3.6 MJ
D : 3600 J
Q.no 2. The insulation resistance of a single core cable is inversely proportional to its
A : width
B : thickness
C : length
D : resistivity
A : Load current
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : Leakage current
C : Leakage flux
D : Conventional current
Q.no 4. Current variation in the one coil causes voltage induced in the other nearby coil is known
as
Q.no 5. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in parallel, the equivalent resistance is
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
Q.no 6. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
C : Reluctance
D : Capacitance
Q.no 7. From the following which is not the property of line of magnetic force ( Flux )
A : Silicon steel
B : Copper
C : Manganin
D : Aluminium
Q.no 10. In superposition theorem, when we consider the effect of one current source, all the
other voltage sources are
A : removed
B : shorted
C : open circuited
D : connected
A : ohm
B : siemens
C : ampere
D : micro farad
Q.no 12. Which of the material has positive temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : mica
C : pvc
D : dry paper
Q.no 13. If the current in an electric bulb drops by 2 percent, then the power developed reduces
by
A : 1 percent
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 2 percent
C : 4 percent
D : 16 percent
Q.no 14. The value of Resistance Temperature Coefficient of material depends upon
A : mesh analysis,
B : nodal analysis
Q.no 16. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its average value will be
A : 90.21 V
B : 99.23 V
C : 100 V
D : 141.4 V
Q.no 17. The phasor addition of all the phase voltages at any instant in three phase symmetrical
system is always
A:0
B:1
C : 120
D : 90
A : kilo amper
B : amper
C : milli amper
D : micro amper
A : meter / weber
B : Amp / meter
C : Tesla
D : weber / meter
Q.no 21. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 10 Amp
C : 5 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
Q.no 22. Electrical network having only resistances without energy sources is known as
________________
A : Passive network
B : active network
C : lateral network
D : source network
B : frequency is constant
A : increases
B : decreases
C : remaims constant
D : slightly increases
Q.no 25. 100 micro farad capacitor on 50Hz supply offers capacitive reactance
A : 21.33 ohms
B : 3.18 47 ohms
C : 15.92 ohms
D : 31.847 ohms
C : Directly proportional to the product of current in conductor and turns of the coil
D : Directly proportional to the ratio of current in conductor and turns of the coil
A:1
B : 1.11
C : 1.41
D : 1.21
Q.no 28. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its Average value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 10 Amp
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 9 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
A : Absolute permittivity
B : Relative permittivity
D : Absolute permeability
A:Y/G
B:B/G
C:G/Y
D:B/Y
Q.no 31. If the frequency of power supply is 60 Hz , the time peroiod of one cycle will be
A : 0.02 sec
B : 20 msec
C : 16.67 msec
D : 0.1667 sec
Q.no 33. In a three phase star connected system the phase difference between phase voltages and
their respetive line voltages is
A : 30 degrees
B : 120 degrees
C : 60 degrees
D : 45 degrees
Q.no 34. Every current carrying conductor placed in magnetic field will
A : The type of material, the area of cross section and the length of the conductor
B : The area of cross section and the length of the conductor only
Q.no 37. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If value of resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 1A
B : 0A
C : 0.5A
D : 2A
Q.no 38. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
Q.no 39. When 40 resistances each of 40 ohms are connected in parallel, their equivalent
resistance will be--
A : 20 ohm
B : 8 ohm
C : 1 ohm
D : 40 ohm
Q.no 40. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
A : 4 ohm
B : 12 ohm
C : 36 ohm
D : 6 ohm
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
Q.no 43. When Two coils are magnetically isolated, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to zero
Q.no 44. The power factor of series R-L-C ac series circuit , at resonance is
A : unity
B : zero
C : 0.5 lagging
D : 0.5 leading
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
Q.no 47. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
C : 20A
D : 0A
Q.no 48. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
Q.no 49. Certain coil has 100 turns and is carrying 4 ampere current, MMF of the coil is
A : 100 amp-turn
B : 400 amp-turn
C : 25 amp-turm
D : 40 amp-turn
Q.no 50. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 51. A series R-L circuit has resistance of 6 ohms and reactance of 8 ohms. The impedance of
the circuit is
A : 10 ohms
B : 14 ohms
C : 2 ohms
D : 13.43 ohms
Q.no 52. When Two coils are tightly coupled, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to 1
Q.no 53. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 10
D : 13
Q.no 55. If 03 equal resistances are connected in delta, their equivalent each STAR resistance will
be
A : one third
B : three times
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 56. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
will be
A : three times
B : one third
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 57. When Two coils are magnetically isolated , then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A:0
B:1
C : less than 1
D : 1.5
Q.no 59. Which of the following lamps will have the least resistance at room temperature?
A : 25W, 220V
B : 100W, 220V
C : 200W, 220V
D : 60W, 220V
Q.no 60. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1000171_T1 BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGG.
Time : 1hr
Max Marks : 50
N.B
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. From the following which is not the property of line of magnetic force ( Flux )
A : 1 percent
B : as high as possible
C : as low as possible
A : ohm
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : siemens
C : ampere
D : micro farad
A : Purely inductive
B : Purely capacitive
C : Purely resistive
B : frequency is constant
Q.no 6. The rms value of sinusoidal alternating current is given by the relation
Q.no 7. The phasor addition of all the phase voltages at any instant in three phase symmetrical
system is always
A:0
B:1
C : 120
D : 90
Q.no 9. Which of the material has almost zero temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : Nichrome
A:1
B : 1.11
C : 1.41
D : 1.21
A : Amp-turm
B : Weber/turn
D : Tesla
Q.no 12. EMF induced in a coil because of self / own changing flux cutting is known as
Q.no 13. During charging or discharging of a capacitor, no current actually passes through the
A : connecting wires
B : battery
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : dielectric
D : circuit switch
Q.no 15. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half
cycle is
A : r.m.s. value
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
C : Directly proportional to the product of current in conductor and turns of the coil
D : Directly proportional to the ratio of current in conductor and turns of the coil
Q.no 17. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
C : Reluctance
D : Capacitance
Q.no 19. Frequency of the primary and secondary parameters of the transformer
A : infinite
B : zero
C : high
D : low
Q.no 21. If the voltage applied to a 250 W,250 V incandescent lamp is 250 V, then the current
flowing at the instant of switching would be
A : 1.25 A
A : mesh analysis,
B : nodal analysis
A : kilo amper
B : amper
C : milli amper
D : micro amper
Q.no 24. In superposition theorem, when we consider the effect of one current source, all the
other voltage sources are
A : removed
B : shorted
C : open circuited
D : connected
Q.no 26. In a transformer electrical power is transferred from one circuit to other without
change in the
A : Voltage
B : Current
C : Impedance
D : Frequency
Q.no 28. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its average value will be
A : 90.21 V
B : 99.23 V
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 6/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 100 V
D : 141.4 V
Q.no 29. If the active and apperent power of an a c circuit are equal in magnetude then its power
factor is
A : 0.5 lag
B : 0.707 lag
C : 0.8 lead
D : unity
A : meter / weber
B : Amp / meter
C : Tesla
D : weber / meter
A : Linear networks
B : Non-Linear networks
Q.no 33. Which of the material has negative temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : PVC
Q.no 34. Electrical network having only resistances without energy sources is known as
________________
A : Passive network
B : active network
C : lateral network
D : source network
A : iron loss
B : copper loss
D : no losses
Q.no 36. A balanced star connected load is supplied from three phase 400 V 50 Hz system. Its
phase voltage is
A : 400 V
B : 230.94 V
C : 692.8 V
D : 100 V
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
Q.no 39. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
Q.no 40. For a three phase star connected load , the relation between phase voltage and line
voltage is
Q.no 41. Certain coil has 100 turns and is carrying 4 ampere current, MMF of the coil is
A : 100 amp-turn
B : 400 amp-turn
C : 25 amp-turm
D : 40 amp-turn
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
Q.no 43. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature coefficient of the filament is
A : negative
B : zero
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : infinite
D : positive
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
D : 31.4 ohms
Q.no 45. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in star, their equivalent each resistance
in delta will be--
A : 6 ohm
B : 36 ohm
C : 12 ohm
D : 2 ohm
A : mutual induction
B : self-induction
C : magnetic induction
D : electrostatic induction
C : Flux direction can be reversed but field strength can not be altered
Q.no 49. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
Q.no 50. When Two coils are magnetically isolated, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to zero
Q.no 51. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
C : 10
D : 13
Q.no 53. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
will be
A : three times
B : one third
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 54. A series R-L circuit has resistance of 6 ohms and reactance of 8 ohms. The impedance of
the circuit is
A : 10 ohms
B : 14 ohms
C : 2 ohms
D : 13.43 ohms
Q.no 55. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 100 V
B : 141.4 V
C : 200 V
D : 90.21 V
Q.no 56. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 57. A 10 mF, 20 mF, 25 mF, and 100 mF capacitor are in parallel. The total capacitance is
A : 0.2 mF
B : 5 mF
C : 100 mF
D : 155 mF
Q.no 59. Which of the following lamps will have the least resistance at room temperature?
A : 25W, 220V
B : 100W, 220V
C : 200W, 220V
D : 60W, 220V
Q.no 60. If 03 equal resistances are connected in delta, their equivalent each STAR resistance will
be
A : one third
B : three times
C : two times
D : two third
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1000171_T1 BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGG.
Time : 1hr
Max Marks : 50
N.B
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
Q.no 1. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its Average value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 10 Amp
C : 9 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
B : Hysteresis loss
C : Copper loss
D : Frictional loss
A : Amp-turm
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : Weber/turn
D : Tesla
Q.no 6. A circuit content one or more sources of energy, then circuit is known as
A : passive
B : active
C : linear
D : non linear
A : nodal analysis
B : mesh analysis
Q.no 8. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 100 Hz
D : 150 Hz
A : Absolute permittivity
B : Relative permittivity
D : Absolute permeability
A : Silicon steel
B : Copper
C : Manganin
D : Aluminium
A : increases
B : decreases
Q.no 13. Current variation in the one coil causes voltage induced in the other nearby coil is
known as
Q.no 14. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its average value will be
A : 90.21 V
B : 99.23 V
C : 100 V
D : 141.4 V
A:X/R
B:R/X
C:R/Z
D:Z/R
Q.no 16. In a three phase star connected system the phase difference between phase voltages and
their respetive line voltages is
A : 30 degrees
B : 120 degrees
C : 60 degrees
D : 45 degrees
Q.no 17. In superposition theorem, when we consider the effect of one current source, all the
other voltage sources are
A : removed
B : shorted
C : open circuited
D : connected
Q.no 18. The phasor addition of all the phase voltages at any instant in three phase symmetrical
system is always
A:0
B:1
C : 120
D : 90
A : increases
B : decreases
C : remaims constant
D : slightly increases
Q.no 20. For parallel combination of capacitors, which of the following remains constant?
A : Flux
B : Charge
C : Current
D : Voltage
Q.no 21. The value of Resistance Temperature Coefficient of material depends upon
A : 1.57
B : 1.11
C : 0.636
D : 1.414
A : linear curve
B : sinusoidal curve
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 5/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : exponential curve
D : parabolic curve
A : infinite
B : zero
C : high
D : low
Q.no 25. 100 micro farad capacitor on 50Hz supply offers capacitive reactance
A : 21.33 ohms
B : 3.18 47 ohms
C : 15.92 ohms
D : 31.847 ohms
A : iron loss
B : copper loss
D : no losses
A : Linear networks
B : Non-Linear networks
Q.no 29. If the current in an electric bulb drops by 2 percent, then the power developed reduces
by
A : 1 percent
B : 2 percent
C : 4 percent
D : 16 percent
A : Mesh
B : Branch
C : Path
D : Junction
Q.no 31. For a fixed supply voltage, the current flowing through a conductor will decrease if
A : meter / weber
B : Amp / meter
C : Tesla
D : weber / meter
Q.no 33. In a transformer electrical power is transferred from one circuit to other without
change in the
A : Voltage
B : Current
C : Impedance
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : Frequency
A : mesh analysis,
B : nodal analysis
Q.no 35. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(377t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 314 Hz
Q.no 36. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
D : 31.4 ohms
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
Q.no 39. For a three phase star connected load , the relation between phase voltage and line
voltage is
Q.no 40. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature coefficient of the filament is
A : negative
B : zero
C : infinite
D : positive
Q.no 41. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in star, their equivalent each resistance
in delta will be--
A : 6 ohm
B : 36 ohm
C : 12 ohm
D : 2 ohm
A : mutual induction
B : self-induction
C : magnetic induction
D : electrostatic induction
Q.no 43. Certain coil has 100 turns and is carrying 4 ampere current, MMF of the coil is
A : 100 amp-turn
B : 400 amp-turn
C : 25 amp-turm
D : 40 amp-turn
Q.no 44. For a three phase delta connected load , the line current is equal to ------------ times that
of its phase current.
A : 1.73
B : 1.42
C:2
D:3
Q.no 45. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
Q.no 47. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If value of resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 1A
B : 0A
C : 0.5A
D : 2A
Q.no 48. When Two coils are magnetically isolated, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : Equal to zero
Q.no 49. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
A : store energy
B : dissipate energy
Q.no 51. A current of 2A flows through a 100 Ohm resistance for 10 hours. The energy consumed
is
A : 0.5 KWh
B : 4 KWh
C : 2 KWh
D : 0.02 KWh
Q.no 52. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
will be
A : three times
B : one third
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 53. When Two coils are magnetically isolated , then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A:0
B:1
C : less than 1
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
D : 1.5
Q.no 54. Soft iron electro-magnet has cross sectional area 10 square centimeter and has 0.6 mWb
flux, what will be the flux density in the core
A : 0.6 Tesla
B : 6 Tesla
C : 3 Wb/sq. meter
D : 0.06 Tesla
Q.no 55. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
C : 10
D : 13
Q.no 56. A 10 mF, 20 mF, 25 mF, and 100 mF capacitor are in parallel. The total capacitance is
A : 0.2 mF
B : 5 mF
C : 100 mF
D : 155 mF
Q.no 57. Which of the following lamps will have the least resistance at room temperature?
A : 25W, 220V
B : 100W, 220V
C : 200W, 220V
D : 60W, 220V
Q.no 58. What will be current drawn by a 1 kW electric heater if its resistance in fully heated
condition is 40 ohm?
A : 5A
B : 2.5 A
C : 10A
D : 1.25A
Q.no 59. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 60. If 03 equal resistances are connected in delta, their equivalent each STAR resistance will
be
A : one third
B : three times
C : two times
D : two third
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1000171_T1 BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGG.
Time : 1hr
Max Marks : 50
N.B
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
C : power transformers
D : distribution transformers
A : Mesh
B : Branch
C : Path
D : Junction
Q.no 3. From the following which is not the property of line of magnetic force ( Flux )
A : copper
B : mica
C : pvc
D : dry paper
Q.no 5. The direction of induced emf in a rotating conductor in stationary magnetic field is given
by
Q.no 6. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 150 Hz
B : Hysteresis loss
C : Copper loss
D : Frictional loss
Q.no 8. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(377t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 314 Hz
Q.no 9. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 10 Amp
C : 5 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
A:X/R
B:R/X
C:R/Z
D:Z/R
Q.no 11. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half
cycle is
A : r.m.s. value
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
C : Directly proportional to the product of current in conductor and turns of the coil
D : Directly proportional to the ratio of current in conductor and turns of the coil
Q.no 13. In a three phase star connected system the phase difference between phase voltages and
their respetive line voltages is
A : 30 degrees
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 3/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 120 degrees
C : 60 degrees
D : 45 degrees
Q.no 14. The rms value of sinusoidal alternating current is given by the relation
A : kilo amper
B : amper
C : milli amper
D : micro amper
Q.no 16. EMF induced in a conductor when magnetic field is stationary and conductor is moving
is known as
Q.no 17. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in series, the equivalent resistance is--
ohm
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
A : nodal analysis
B : mesh analysis
A : Reluctance
B : Resistance
C : Reactance
D : Impedance
Q.no 21. The phasor addition of all the phase voltages at any instant in three phase symmetrical
system is always
A:0
B:1
C : 120
D : 90
Q.no 22. Frequency of the primary and secondary parameters of the transformer
A : Amp-turm
B : Weber/turn
D : Tesla
Q.no 25. A circuit content one or more sources of energy, then circuit is known as
A : passive
B : active
C : linear
D : non linear
Q.no 26. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its average value will be
A : 90.21 V
B : 99.23 V
C : 100 V
D : 141.4 V
Q.no 27. The insulation resistance of a single core cable is inversely proportional to its
A : width
B : thickness
C : length
D : resistivity
Q.no 28. For same rating , the size of three phase machine is ---------- to that of single phase
machine.
A : more
B : same
C : less
A : backelite
B : mica
C : cotton
D : copper
Q.no 30. During charging or discharging of a capacitor, no current actually passes through the
A : connecting wires
B : battery
C : dielectric
D : circuit switch
Q.no 31. Which of the material has negative temperature coefficient of resistance
A : copper
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : PVC
Q.no 32. In an ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of
1A. Its terminal voltage will be
A : 11 V
B : 12 V
C : 12.5 V
D : 11.5 V
A : Irms / Iav
B : Iav / Irms
C : Im/Irms
D : Irms/Im
Q.no 35. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
C : Reluctance
D : Capacitance
Q.no 36. For a three phase delta connected load , the line current is equal to ------------ times that
of its phase current.
A : 1.73
B : 1.42
C:2
D:3
C : Flux direction can be reversed but field strength can not be altered
Q.no 40. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
A : 4 ohm
B : 12 ohm
C : 36 ohm
D : 6 ohm
Q.no 41. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
Q.no 42. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If value of resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 1A
B : 0A
C : 0.5A
D : 2A
Q.no 43. Certain coil has 100 turns and is carrying 4 ampere current, MMF of the coil is
A : 100 amp-turn
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 9/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : 400 amp-turn
C : 25 amp-turm
D : 40 amp-turn
Q.no 44. The hot resistance of the filament of a bulb is higher than its cold resistance because the
temperature coefficient of the filament is
A : negative
B : zero
C : infinite
D : positive
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
A : mutual induction
B : self-induction
C : magnetic induction
D : electrostatic induction
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
D : 31.4 ohms
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
Q.no 50. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
C : 20A
D : 0A
Q.no 51. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 52. A 10 mF, 20 mF, 25 mF, and 100 mF capacitor are in parallel. The total capacitance is
A : 0.2 mF
B : 5 mF
C : 100 mF
D : 155 mF
Q.no 53. If 03 equal resistances are connected in star, their equivalent each DELTA resistance
will be
A : three times
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 11/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : one third
C : two times
D : two third
Q.no 54. When Two coils are tightly coupled, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to 1
Q.no 55. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
C : 10
D : 13
Q.no 56. Capacitive reactance of a capacitor at 50 Hz is 100 ohms. Its capacitive reactance at 100
Hz will be
A : 50 ohms
B : 100 ohms
C : 200 ohms
D : 300 ohms
Q.no 57. Three 100 ohm resistances are connected in star across 400 V three phase supply. If one
of the resistances is disconnected then the line current is
A : 2 Amp
B : 4 Amp
C : 8 Amp
D : 6.92 Amp
Q.no 58. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 100 V
B : 141.4 V
C : 200 V
D : 90.21 V
Q.no 60. In a three phase balanced delta connected system all the phase currents are displaced
from each other by
A : 30 degrees
B : 45 degrees
C : 120 degrees
D : 60 degrees
Seat No -
Total number of questions : 60
1000171_T1 BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGG.
Time : 1hr
Max Marks : 50
N.B
1) All questions are Multiple Choice Questions having single correct option.
7) Use only black/blue ball point pen to darken the appropriate circle.
A : iron loss
B : copper loss
D : no losses
A : Purely inductive
B : Purely capacitive
C : Purely resistive
A : copper
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 1/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
B : aluminium
C : silver
D : PVC
A : linear curve
B : sinusoidal curve
C : exponential curve
D : parabolic curve
Q.no 5. For a fixed supply voltage, the current flowing through a conductor will decrease if
Q.no 6. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its average value will be
A : 90.21 V
B : 99.23 V
C : 100 V
D : 141.4 V
A : Linear networks
B : Non-Linear networks
A : Irms / Iav
B : Iav / Irms
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 2/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : Im/Irms
D : Irms/Im
Q.no 9. Current variation in the one coil causes voltage induced in the other nearby coil is known
as
Q.no 10. The value of Resistance Temperature Coefficient of material depends upon
Q.no 11. The direction of induced emf in a rotating conductor in stationary magnetic field is
given by
Q.no 12. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in parallel, the equivalent resistance is
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
Q.no 13. If the active and apperent power of an a c circuit are equal in magnetude then its power
factor is
A : 0.5 lag
B : 0.707 lag
C : 0.8 lead
D : unity
Q.no 14. Frequency of the primary and secondary parameters of the transformer
Q.no 15. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(377t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 314 Hz
A : Resistance
B : Inductor
C : Capacitor
D : Diode
Q.no 17. The alternating current is given by i= 14.14 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 10 Amp
C : 5 Amp
D : 7.07 Amp
Q.no 19. If the voltage applied to a 250 W,250 V incandescent lamp is 250 V, then the current
flowing at the instant of switching would be
A : 1.25 A
Q.no 21. The maximum flux produced in the core of the transformer is
Q.no 22. EMF induced in a conductor when magnetic field is stationary and conductor is moving
is known as
A : infinite
B : zero
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 5/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : high
D : low
Q.no 24. If 10 resistances each of 15 ohm are connected in series, the equivalent resistance is--
ohm
A : zero
B : 15
C : 150
D : 1.5
Q.no 25. The ratio of electric flux density to electric field intensity is called
A : Permeability
B : Permittivity
C : Reluctance
D : Capacitance
Q.no 26. The ratio of the area of a sinusoidal wave over a half-cycle to the time period of half
cycle is
A : r.m.s. value
B : Average value
C : Form factor
D : Instantineous value
Q.no 27. In a three phase star connected system the phase difference between phase voltages and
their respetive line voltages is
A : 30 degrees
B : 120 degrees
C : 60 degrees
D : 45 degrees
Q.no 28. In an ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of
1A. Its terminal voltage will be
A : 11 V
B : 12 V
C : 12.5 V
D : 11.5 V
Q.no 29. When the supply frequency of transformer is doubled then the eddy current loss
A : remains same
B : is reduced by 50 percent
C : is doubled
Q.no 31. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its frequency will be
A : 60 Hz
B : 50 Hz
C : 100 Hz
D : 150 Hz
A : Reluctance
B : Resistance
C : Reactance
D : Impedance
Q.no 33. During charging or discharging of a capacitor, no current actually passes through the
A : connecting wires
B : battery
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 7/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : dielectric
D : circuit switch
A:1
B : 1.11
C : 1.41
D : 1.21
Q.no 35. In superposition theorem, when we consider the effect of one current source, all the
other voltage sources are
A : removed
B : shorted
C : open circuited
D : connected
A : Current
B : voltag
C : frequency
D : power
A : 1000 MHz
B : 1 Hz
C : 0 Hz
D : 10000 MHz
Q.no 38. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in star, their equivalent each resistance
in delta will be--
A : 6 ohm
B : 36 ohm
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 8/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 12 ohm
D : 2 ohm
Q.no 39. A balanced star connected load is supplied from three phase 400 V 50 Hz system. Its
phase voltage is
A : 400 V
B : 230.94 V
C : 692.8 V
D : 100 V
Q.no 40. In a transformer, which of the following windings has larger cross-sectional area ?
A : Primary winding
B : Secondary winding
C : High-voltage winding
D : Low-voltage winding
A : mutual induction
B : self-induction
C : magnetic induction
D : electrostatic induction
Q.no 43. Certain coil has 100 turns and is carrying 4 ampere current, MMF of the coil is
A : 100 amp-turn
B : 400 amp-turn
C : 25 amp-turm
D : 40 amp-turn
Q.no 44. The impedance of a circuit is given by 15 + j 20 ohms. It means that the circuit is
A : Purely capacitive
B : Inductive
C : Resistive
D : Purely inductive
Q.no 45. When 40 resistances each of 40 ohms are connected in parallel, their equivalent
resistance will be--
A : 20 ohm
B : 8 ohm
C : 1 ohm
D : 40 ohm
A : 3.6 MJ
B : 36 kJ
C : 360 J
D : 3600 J
Q.no 47. What must be known in order to calculate the energy used by an electrical appliance?
Q.no 48. An ideal current source of 5A flowing through a resistance of 100 ohm. If value of
resistance is doubled then current is _____
A : 5A
B : 10A
Join @SPPUBTECH - Telegram
https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1 10/13
12/8/2020 https://sppu.wheebox.com/WAC-3/allqusdownloadhtml.ils?testNo=4535&code=1052000&showTest=320&actForm=edit&set=1
C : 20A
D : 0A
A : 37.680 ohms
B : 63.847 ohms
C : 318.47 ohms
D : 31.4 ohms
Q.no 50. Three resistances each of 12 ohms are connected in delta, their equivalent each
resistance in star will be--
A : 4 ohm
B : 12 ohm
C : 36 ohm
D : 6 ohm
Q.no 51. When Two coils are tightly coupled, then coefficient of coupling 'K' is
A : Greater than 1
B : Less than 1
C : Equal to 0.5
D : Equal to 1
Q.no 52. In a three phase balanced delta connected system all the phase currents are displaced
from each other by
A : 30 degrees
B : 45 degrees
C : 120 degrees
D : 60 degrees
Q.no 53. Soft iron electro-magnet has cross sectional area 10 square centimeter and has 0.6 mWb
flux, what will be the flux density in the core
A : 0.6 Tesla
B : 6 Tesla
C : 3 Wb/sq. meter
D : 0.06 Tesla
Q.no 54. Capacitive reactance of a capacitor at 50 Hz is 100 ohms. Its capacitive reactance at 100
Hz will be
A : 50 ohms
B : 100 ohms
C : 200 ohms
D : 300 ohms
Q.no 55. The rms value of an ac sinusoidal current is 10 Amp. Its peak value is
A : 14.14 Amp
B : 7.07 Amp
C : 10 Amp
D : 28.28 Amp
Q.no 56. The alternating voltage is given by v = 141.4 sin(314 t) Volt, its RMS value will be
A : 100 V
B : 141.4 V
C : 200 V
D : 90.21 V
Q.no 57. A series R-L circuit has resistance of 6 ohms and reactance of 8 ohms. The impedance of
the circuit is
A : 10 ohms
B : 14 ohms
C : 2 ohms
D : 13.43 ohms
Q.no 58. Three 100 ohm resistances are connected in star across 400 V three phase supply. If one
of the resistances is disconnected then the line current is
A : 2 Amp
B : 4 Amp
C : 8 Amp
D : 6.92 Amp
Q.no 59. A 10 mF, 20 mF, 25 mF, and 100 mF capacitor are in parallel. The total capacitance is
A : 0.2 mF
B : 5 mF
C : 100 mF
D : 155 mF
Q.no 60. An ideal voltage source of 12V when connected to load resistance produce current of 1A.
If its current is doubled then terminal voltage _____V
A:6
B : 12
C : 10
D : 13
24. Three capacitors each of the capacity C are given. The resultant
capacity 2/3 C
can be obtained by using them
(a) all in series
(b) all in parallel
(c) two in parallel and third in series with this combination
(d) two in series and third in parallel across this combination
Ans: c
25. For which of the following parameter variation, the capacitance
of the capacitor remains unaffected ?
(a) Distance between plates
(b) Area of the plates
(c) Nature of dielectric
(d) Thickness of the plates
Ans: d
26. Which of the following statement is true ?
(a) The current in the discharging capacitor grows linearly
(b) The current in the dicharging capacitor grows exponentially
(c) The current in the discharging capacitor decays exponentially
(d) The current in the discharging capacitor decreases constantly
Ans: b
27. Which of the following expression is correct for electric field
strength ?
(a) E = D/E
(b) E = D2/t
(c) E = jtD
(d) E= nD2
Ans: a
28. In a capacitor the electric charge is stored in
(a) metal plates
(b) dielectric
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
inserting a
(a) capacitor in parallel with contacts
(6) capacitor in series with each contact
(c) resistance in line
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
34. In the case of a lossy capacitor, its series equivalent resistance
value will be
(a) small
(b) very small
(c) large
(d) zero
Ans: c
35. The power dissipated in a pure capacitor is
(a) zero
(6) proportional to applied voltage
(c) proportional to value of capacitance
(d) both (b) and (c) above
Ans: a
36. In a capacitive circuit
(a) a steady value of applied voltage causes discharge
(b) an increase in applied voltage makes a capacitor charge
(c) decrease in applied voltage makes a capacitor charge
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
37. When a dielectric slab is introduced in a parallel plate capacitor,
the potential difference between plates will
(a) remain uncharged
(b) decrease
(c) increase
(d) become zero
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
Ans: b
38. Capacitance increases with
(a) increase in plate area and decrease in distance between the
plates
(b) increase in plate area and distance between the plates
(c) decrease in plate area and value of applied voltage (d) reduction in plate area
and distance between the plates
Ans: a
39. A capacitor consists of
(a) two insulators separated by a conductor
(b) two conductors separated by an insulator
(c) two insulators only
(d) two conductors only
Ans: b
40. A gang condenser is a
(a) polarised capacitor
(6) variable capacitor
(c) ceramic capacitor
(d) none of the above
Ans:
41. A paper capacitor is usually available in the form of
(a) tubes
(b) rolled foil
(c) disc
(d) meshed plates
Ans: b
42. Air capacitors are generally available in the range
(a) 10 to 400 pF
(b) 1 to 20 pF
(c) 100 to 900 pF
(d) 20 to 100 pF
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
Ans: a
43. The unit of capacitance is
(a) henry
(b) ohm
(c) farad
(d) farad/m
Ans: c
44. A capacitor charged to 200 V has 2000 (iC of charge. The value
of capacitance will be
(a) 10 F
(6) 10 uF
(c) 100 nF
(d) 1000 uF
Ans: b
45. A capacitor in a circuit became hot and ultimately exploded due
to wrong connections, which type of capacitor it could be ?
(a) Paper capacitor
(b) Ceramic capacitor
(c) Electrolytic capacitor
(d) Any-of the above
Ans: c
46. Energy stored in the electric field of a capacitor C when charged
from a D.C source of voltage V is equal to joules
(a) CV2
(b) C2V
(c) CV2
(d) CV
Ans: a
47. The absolute permittivity of free space is given by
(a) 8.854 x 1(T9 F/m)
(6) 8.854 x 1(T10 F/m)
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
(b) kVA
(c) kVAR
(d) volts
Ans: c
53. While testing a capacitor with ohm meter, if the capacitor shows
charging, but the final resistance reading is appreciably less than
normal, it can be concluded that the capacitor is
(a) short-circuited
(b) open circuited
(c) alright
(d) leaky
Ans: d
54. If a 6 uF capacitor is charged to 200 V, the charge in coulombs
will be
(a) 800 uC
(b) 900 uC
(c) 1200 uC
(d) 1600 uC
Ans: c
55. Which capacitor will be physically smaller for the same ratings ?
(a) Ceramic capacitor
(b) Paper capacitor
(c) Both will be of equal size
(d) None of the above
Ans: a
56. What is the value of capacitance that must be connected in
parallel with 50 pF condenser to make an equivalent capacitance of
150 pF ?
(a) 50 pF
(b) 100 pF
(c) 150 pF
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
(d) 200 pF
Ans: b
57. A mica capacitor and a ceramic capacitor both have the same
physical dimensions. Which will have more value of capacitance ?
(a) Ceramic capacitor
(b) Mica capacitor
(c) Both will have identical value of capacitance
(d) It depends on applied voltage
Ans: a
58. Which of the following material has least value of dielectric
constant ?
(a) Ceramics
(b) Oil
(c) Glass
(d) Paper
Ans: b
59. Which of the following capacitors will have the least value of
breakdown voltage ?
(a) Mica
(b) Paper
(c) Ceramic
(d) Electrolytic
Ans: d
60. The breakdown voltage for paper capacitors is usually
(a) 20 to 60 volts
(b) 200 to 1600 volts
(c) 2000 to 3000 volts
(d) more than 10000 volts
Ans:
61. Dielectric constant for mica is nearly
(a) 200
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
(b) 100
(c) 3 to 8
(d) 1 to 2
Ans: c
62. The value of dielectric constant for vacuum is taken as
(a) zero
(b) 1
(c) 4
(d) 10
Ans: b
63. Which of the following capacitors is marked for polarity ?
(a) Air
(b) Paper
(c) Mica
(d) Electrolytic
Ans: d
64. Which of the following capacitors can be used for temperature
compensation ?
(a) Air capacitor
(b) Ceramic capacitor
(c) Paper capacitor
(d) None of the above
Ans: b
65. Which of the following statements is incorrect ?
(a) The thinner the dielectric, the more the capacitance and the
lower the voltage breakdown rating for a capacitor .
(b) A six dot mica capacitor colour coded white, green, black, red
and yellow has the capacitance value of 500 pF
(c) Capacitors in series provide less capacitance but a higher voltage
breakdown rating for the combination
(d) A capacitor can store charge because it has a dielectric between
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
two conductors
Ans: b
66. Paper capacitors usually have a tolerance of
(a) ± 5%
(b) ± 10%
(c) ± 15%
(d) ± 20%
Ans: b
67. For closer tolerances which of the following capacitors is usually
preferred ?
(a) Paper capacitor
(b) Mica capacitor
(c) Ceramic disc capacitor
(d) None of the above
Ans: b
68. The electrostatic force between two charges of one coulomb
each and placed at a distance of 0.5 m will be
(a) 36 x 10fa
(b) 36 x 107 N
(c) 36 x 108 N
(d) 36 x 109 N
Ans: d
69. The units of volume charge density are
(a) Coulomb/meter
(b) Coulomb/meter
(c) Coulomb/meter
(d) Coulomb/meter
Ans: c
70. “The surface integral of the normal component of the electric
displacement D over any closed surface equals the charge enclosed
by the surface”.
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
(a) Ceramic
(b) Paper
(c) Air
(d) Electrolytic
Ans: a
76. capacitors are used for audio frequency and radio frequency
coupling and tuning.
(a) Air
(b) Mica
(c) Plastic film
(d) Ceramic
Ans: b
77. The inverse of capacitance is called
(a) reluctance
(b) conductance
(c) susceptance
(d) elastance
Ans: d
78. When the dielectric is homogeneous,the potential gradient is
(a) uniform
(b) non-uniform
(c) zero
(d) any of the above
Ans: a
79. The potential gradient across the material of low permittivity is
than across the material of high permittivity.
(a) smaller
(b) greater
(c) both (a) and (b)
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
(b) voltage
(c) potential gradient
(d) charge
Ans: d
85. The relative permittivity has the following units
(a) F/m
(b) m/F
(c) Wb/m
(d) no units
Ans: c
86. The phenomenon of an uncharged body getting charged merely
by the nearness of a charged body is known as
(a) pholoelectric effect
(b) chemical effect
(c) magnetic effect
(d) induction
Ans: d
87. A unit tube of flux is known as tube
(a) Newton
(b) Faraday
(c) Michale
(d) None of the above
Ans: b
88. The number of Faraday tubes of flux passing through a surface
in an electric field is called
(a) electric flux
(6) electric flux density
(c) magnetic flux density
(d) electric charge density
Ans: a
89. The unit of electric instensity is
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
(a) N/C2
(b) Wb/m2
(c) N/C
(d) N2/C
Ans:
90. The value of E within the field due to a point charge can be
found with the help of
(a) Faraday’s laws
(b) Kirchhoff s laws
(c) Coulomb’s laws
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
91. at a point may be defined as equal to the lines of force passing
normally through a unit cross section at that point.
(a) Electric intensity
(6) Magnetic flux density
(c) Electric flux
(d) None of the above
Ans: a
92. Electric intensity at any point in an electric field is equal to the
at that point.
(a) electric flux
(b) magnetic flux density
(c) potential gradient
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
93. Electric displacement is a______quantity.
(a) scalar
(b) vector
(c) both of the above
(d) none of the above
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
Ans: b
94. at a point is equal to the negative potential gradient at that
point.
(a) Electric intensity
(6) Electric flux
(c) Magnetic flux
(d) Magnetic flux density
Ans: a
95. The unit of dielectric strength is given by
(a) V/m
(b) V2/m
(c) m/V
(d) m/V2
Ans: a
96. Dielectric strength ______ with increasing thickness
(a) increases
(b) decreases
(c) remains unaltered
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
97. The property of a capacitor to store electricity is called its
(a) capacitance
(b) charge
(c) energy
(d) none of the above
Ans: a
98. is that property of a capacitor which delays any change of
voltage across it.
(a) Inductance
(b) Capacitance
(c) Potential gradient
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
Ans: a
103. The capacitance of a capacitor is influenced by
(a) plate area
(b) plate separation
(c) nature of dielectric
(d) none of the above
(e) all of the above
Ans:
104. A capacitor consists of two
(a) ceramic plates and one mica disc
(b) insulators separated by a dielectric
(c) silver-coated insulators
(d) conductors separated by an insulator
Ans: d
105. Permittivity is expressed in
(a) Farad/sq-m
(b) Farad/meter
(c) Weber/meter
(d) Weber/sq-m
Ans: b
106. Dielectric strength of a material depends on
(a) moisture content
(b) temperature
(c) thickness
(d) all of the above
(e) none of the above
Ans: d
107. What will happen to an insulating medium if voltage more than
the breakdown voltage is applied on it ?
(a) It will become magnetic
(b) It will melt
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
(b) 1/RC
(c) RC
(d) RIC
Ans: c
113. The bridge used for the measurement of the value of the
capacitance is
(a) Wien’s bridge
(b) Wheatstone bridge
(c) Schering bridge
(d) Hay’s bridge
Ans: c
114. If an ohmmeter reading immediately goes practically to zero
and stays there, capacitor is
(a) charged
(b) short-circuited
(c) lossy
(d) satisfactory
Ans: b
115. Out of the following capacitors of identical rating which one
will have the smallest dimensions ?
(a) Aluminium foil capacitor
(b) Mica capacitor
(c) Ceramic capacitor
(d) Paper capacitor
Ans: c
116. An uncharged conductor is placed near a charged conductor,
then
(a) the uncharged conductor gets charged by conduction
(6) the uncharged conductor gets charged by induction and then
attracted towards the charging body
(c) the uncharged conductor is attracted first and then charged by
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
induction
(d) it remains as such
Ans: b
117. The presence of an uncharged conductor near a charged one
increases the
(a) charge of the charged conductor
(6) capacity of the charged conductor
(c) potential of the charged conductor
(d) all of the above
Ans: b
118. Paper condenser is
(a) always polarised
(6) usually of fixed value
(c) electrolytic condenser
(d) a variable condenser
Ans: b
119. Mica capacitors are characterised by all of the following except
(a) stable operation
(b) accurate value
(c) low leakage reactance
(d) low losses
Ans: c
120. A potential of 400 V is applied to a capacitor, the plates of
which are 4 mm apart. The strength of electric field is
(a) 100 kV/m
(b) 10 kV/m
(c) 5 kV/m
(d) 2 kV/m
Ans: a
121. For a good 0.05 uF capacitor ohmmeter reading should
(a) show low resistance momentarily and back off to a very high
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
resistance
(6) show high resistance momentarily and then a very low
resistance
(c) go quickly to 50 ohm approximately and remain there
(d) not move at all
Ans: a
122. The ohmmeter reading for a short circuited capacitor is
(a) infinity
(b) few kilo ohms
(c)few megohms
(d) zero
Ans: d
123. Which of the following statements is correct ?
(a) Mica capacitors are available in capacitance values of 5 to 20 uF
(b) Air capapitors have a black band to indicate the outside foil
(c) Electrolytic capacitors must be connected in correct polarity
(d) Ceramic capacitors must be connected in correct polarity
Ans: c
124. Which of the following capacitors preferred for high frequency
circuits ?
(a) Air capacitor
(6) Electrolytic capacitor
(c) Mica capacitor
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
125. An electrolytic capacitor is generally made to provide
(a) low capacitance
(b) fixed capacitance
(c) variable capacitance
(d) large value of capacitance
Ans: d
UNIT 02
Electrostatic
(b) dielectric
(c) dielectric as well as metal plates
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
MCQ’s - UNIT NO-01
ELECTROMAGNETISM Prof. Ajay K. Lohate
4) While comparing magnetic and electric circuits, the flux of magnetic circuit is
compared with which parameter of electrical circuit?
A)E.m.f.
B)Current
C)Current density
D) Conductivity
7) MMF is analogous to
A)Electric current in electrical circuit
B)Electromotive force
C)Current density in conductor
D) Voltage
MCQ’s - UNIT NO-01
ELECTROMAGNETISM Prof. Ajay K. Lohate
A)Linearly
B)Non-linearly
C)Parabolically
D) Sinusoidally
A)The product of the number of the turns and current of the coil
B)The number of the turns of a coil through which current is flowing
C)The currents of all turns of the coil
D) The turns of transformer winding
12) EMF induced in a coil rotating in a uniform magnetic field will be maximum when
the
A)Rate of cutting flux by the coil sides is minimum
B)Flus linking with the coil is maximum
C)Rate of change of flux linkage is minimum
D) Rate of changes of flux linking is maximum (Ans.)
MCQ’s - UNIT NO-01
ELECTROMAGNETISM Prof. Ajay K. Lohate
13) The law that the induced e.m.f. and current always oppose the cause producing
them is due to
A)Faraday
B)Lenz
C)Newton
D) Coulomb
15) The phenomenon due to which there is an induced current in one coil due to the
current in a neighbouring coil is?
A)Electromagnetism
B)Susceptance
C)Mutual inductance
D) Steady current
16) If the current in one coil becomes steady, the current in neighbouring coil is?
A)Zero
B)Infinity
C)Doubles
D) Halves
19) The property of coil by which a counter emf is induced in it when the current
through the coil changes is known as
A)Self inductance
B)Mutual inductance
C)Series aiding inductance
D) Capacitance
20) Which of the following circuit element stores energy in the electromagnetic field?
A)Inductance
B) Condenser
C)Variable resistor
D) Resistance
21) Both the number of turns and the core length of an inductive coil are double. Its self
inductance will be
A) Unaffected
B) Doubled
C) Halved
D) Quadrupled
A) Laplace's law
B)Lenz's law
C) Kirchhoff's voltage law
D)None of the above
A)Ohm
B)Henry
C)Ampere turns
D) Wb/meter2
26) If in an iron cored coil the iron core is removed so as to make the air cored coil, the
inductance of the coil will be
A)More
B)Less
C) The same
D) None of these
27) Which of the following circuit elements will oppose the change in circuit current?
A)Capacitance
B)Inductance
C)Resistance
D) All of the above
28) A coil is wound on iron core which carries current . The self induced voltage in the
coil is not affected by
29) The coefficient of coupling between two air core coils depends on
30) The law that the induced e.m.f. and current always oppose the cause producing
them is due to
A) Faraday
B) Lenz
C) Newton
D) Coulomb
31) If current in a conductor increases then according to Lenz's law self-induced voltage
will
33) A 500 turns solenoid develops an average induced voltage of 60 V. Over what time
interval must a flux change of 0.06 Wb occur to produce such a voltage?
A) 0.01 s
B) 0.1 s
C) 0.5 s
D) 5 s
34) A coil induces 350 mV when the current changes at the rate of 1 A/s. The value of
inductance is
A) 3500 mH
B) 350 mH
C) 250 mH
D) 150 mH
35) A coil with negligible resistance has 50V across it with 10 mA. The inductive
reactance is
A) 50 ohms
B) 500 ohms
MCQ’s - UNIT NO-01
ELECTROMAGNETISM Prof. Ajay K. Lohate
C) 1000 ohms
D) 5000 ohms
37) A conductor 2 meters long moves at right angles to a magnetic field of flux density 1
tesla with a velocity of 12.5 m/s. The induced e.m.f. in the conductor will be
A) 10 V
B) 15 V
C) 25 V
D) 50 V
A) 20 Wb
B) 2 Wb
C) 0.2 Wb
D) 0.02 Wb
39) Current changing from 8 A to 12 A in one second induced 20 volts in a coil. The
value of inductance is
A) 5 mH
B) 10 mH
C) 5 H
D) 10 H
A) Unchanged inductance
B) Increased inductance
C) Zero inductance
D) Reduced inductance
42) An e.m.f. of 16 volts is induced in a coil of inductance 4H. The rate of change of
current must be
A) 64 A/s
B) 32 A/s
C) 16 A/s
D) 4 A/s
43) The inductance of a coil will increase under all the following conditions except
44) Both the number of turns and the core length of an inductive coil are doubled. Its
self-inductance will be
A) Unaffected
B) Doubled
C) Halved
D) Quadrupled
45) The basic requirement for inducing e.m.f in a coil is that…….
46) The e.m.f induced in a coil is ……the rate of change in flux linkages.
a) directly proportional to
b) inversly proportional to
c) independent of
d) none of the above
a) dф/dt
MCQ’s - UNIT NO-01
ELECTROMAGNETISM Prof. Ajay K. Lohate
b) (N )dф/dt
c) (-N) dф/dt
d) N dt/dф
a) work law
b) ampere law
c) fleming's right hand rule
d) fleming's left hand rule
a) d.c.generator
b) transformer
c) d.c.motor
d) none of the above
a) choke coil
b) transformer
c) d.c.generator
d) none of the above
a) only increase
b) only decrease
c) change
d) none of these
a) independent of
b) directly proportional to
c) inversly proportional to
d) none of the above
55) If the no.of turns of a coil is increased two times , its inductance is…..
56) A circuit has self inductance of 2H. If the circuit current changes at the
rate of 10 A/second,then self induced emf is…….
a) 5V
b) 0.2V
c) 20V
d) 10V
a) 1H
b) 10 H
c) 0.1H
d) 5H
a) directly proportional to
b) inversly proportional to
c) independent of
d) none of these
MCQ’s - UNIT NO-01
ELECTROMAGNETISM Prof. Ajay K. Lohate
a) 8V
b) 2V
c) 0.5 V
d) None of the above
a) is increased
b) is decreased
c) remains unchanged
d) none of the above
62) The mutual inductance between the two coils is zero when fluxes
produced by them…...
a) directly proportional to
b) inversly proportional to
c) directly proportional to square of
d) inversly proportional to square of
a) 1J
b) 0.5 J
c) 2J
d) 4J
65) when the rate of change of current is unity, the induced emf is equal to
a) inductance of coil
b) number of turns in the coil
c) total flux linked with the coil
d) none of the above
67) A coil has 2000 turns and area of 70 cm2 . The magnetic field
perpendicular to the plane of the coil is 0.3 Wb/m 2 and takes 0.1
sec to rotate through 180⁰. The magnitude of induced emf is
a) 84 V
b) 42 V
c) 64 V
d) 24 V
a) 1.4 mH
b) 0.8 mH
c) 0.25mH
d) 1.25mH
a) doubled
b) four times
c) halved
d) two times
71) When a magnet is moved with its N-pole towards a closed coil,
the nearer end of coil acts as
a) N-pole
b) S-pole
c) sometimes N-pole and sometimes S-pole
d) none of above
72)
A coil of wire of radius r has 600 turns and a self inductance
of 108 mH.Self-inductance of a similar coil of 500 turns will be
a) 90mH
b) 75mH
c) 108mH
d) 180mH
a) 1 Wb
b) 0.1 Wb
c) 0.01 Wb
d) none of above
74)
A mettalic ring is attached to the wall of a room.When the north pole of a
magnet is brought near ring,the induced current in the ring is
MCQ’s - UNIT NO-01
ELECTROMAGNETISM Prof. Ajay K. Lohate
a) anticlockwise
b) clockwise
c) zero
d) infinite
75) When the core of a inductance coil is moved away from its winding ,
the inductance of the coil is
a) increases
b) decreases
c) remains same
d) becomes zero
a) mutual inductance
b) self inductance
c) dynamically induced emf
d) none of the above
a) NI
b) NI × L
c) L/NI
d) NI/L
fig 1
79) The reluctance of the magnetic circuit shown in fig.1 is
a) NI/L
b) ф/NI
c) NI/ф
d) ф/L
MCQ’s - UNIT NO-01
ELECTROMAGNETISM Prof. Ajay K. Lohate
The SI unit of
80) reluctance is
a) AT/Wb
b) AT/m
c) AT
d) N/Wb
a) 2 X 105 Wb
b) 2 X 10-3 Wb
c) 1.5 X 10-2 Wb
d) 2.5 X 10-4 Wb
82) A 2cm long coil has 10 turns & carries a current of 750mA.
The magnetizing force of the coil is
a) 225 AT/m
b) 675 AT/m
c) 450 AT/m
d) 375 AT/m
83)
A magnetic device has a core with cross section of 1 inch 2. If
the flux in the core is 1m Wb,then flux density(1 inch=2.54cm)is
a) 2.5T
b) 1.3T
c) 1.55T
d) 0.25T
a) length x area
b) length/ area
c) area+ length
d) (length)2+ area
Directly proportional
a) to
Inversly proportional
b) to
c) Independent of
d) none of the above
a) voltage drop
b) Potential difference
c) Electric intensity
d) e.m.f
Inversly proportional
a) to
Directly proportional
b) to
c) Independent of
d) none of the above
88) The magnitude of AT required for air gap is much greater than
that required iron part of a magnetic circuit because……….
a) Air is a gas
Air has the lowest relative
b) permeability
c) Air is a conductor if magnetic flux
d) None of the above
dynamically induced
a) e.m.f
forcefully induced
b) e.m.f
c) statically induced
MCQ’s - UNIT NO-01
ELECTROMAGNETISM Prof. Ajay K. Lohate
e.m.f.
d) none of these
90) A magnetic circuit carries flux Фi in the iron part & flux Фg in the
air gap.
Then leakage coefficient is……………..
a) Фi/Фg
b) Фg/Фi
c) Фg X Фi
d) none of the above
a) Volt
b) Ampere/Volt
c) Henry
d) Linkages
Whatever may be the flux density in ….., the material will never
92) saturate.
a) Air
b) Soft iron
c) Hardened steel
d) Silicon steel
93) A magnetising force of 800 AT /m will produce a flux density of …….. In air.
a) 1m Wb/ m2
b) 1 Wb/ m2
c) 10 m Wb/ m2
d) 0.5 Wb/ m2
a) 0.5 Wb/ m2
b) 10 Wb/ m2
MCQ’s - UNIT NO-01
ELECTROMAGNETISM Prof. Ajay K. Lohate
c) 2 Wb/ m2
d) 1 Wb/ m2
a) AT/m
b) N/Wb
c) AT/m2
d) unitless
96)
The permeability in the core in fig 2 is 6 x 10-5 Wb/AT-m. The flux
density in the core is
a) 0.5 T
b) 1.2 T
c) 1.5 T
d) 0.1 T
fig. 2
97) What is the magnetic field intensity in a material whose relative
permeability is 1 when the flux density is 0.005 T ?
a) 250 AT/m
b) 452 AT/m
c) 3980 AT/m
d) 1715 AT/m
a) very small
b) large
c) very large
a) 1
b) 4
c) 3 fig3
d) 2
MCQ’s - UNIT NO-01
ELECTROMAGNETISM Prof. Ajay K. Lohate
SINGLE PHASE TRANSFORMER
Ans: d
(a) voltage
(b) current
(c) power
(d) frequency
Ans: c
(c) The transformers will not share load in proportion to their kVA
ratings
(d) none of the above
Ans: b
(a) no-load
(b) half-load
(c) near full-load
(d) 10% overload
Ans: c
79. During short circuit test iron losses are negligible because
(a) the current on secondary side is negligible
(b) the voltage on secondary side does not vary
(c) the voltage applied on primary side is low
(d) full-load current is not supplied to the transformer
Ans: c
Ans: a
96. The transformer oil should have _____ volatility and _____
viscosity.
(a) low,low
(b) high,high
(c) low,high
(d) high,low
Ans: a
97. The function of breather in a transformer is
(a) to provide oxygen inside the tank
(b) to cool the coils during reduced load
(c) to cool the transformer oil
(d) to arrest flow of moisture when outside air enters the
transformer
Ans: d
104. Which of the following is not the standard voltage for power
supply in India ?
(a) llkV
(b) 33kV
(c) 66 kV
(d) 122 kV
Ans: d
107. For given applied voltage, with the increase in frequency of the
applied voltage
(a) eddy current loss will decrease
(b) eddy current loss will increase
(c) eddy current loss will remain unchanged
(d) none of the above
Ans: c
Ans: b